summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorpgww <pgww@lists.pglaf.org>2025-08-30 16:22:02 -0700
committerpgww <pgww@lists.pglaf.org>2025-08-30 16:22:02 -0700
commitaa1454d76e8a3acee26c4a091b7c3c136dec9c27 (patch)
tree00d3dc937a4c0c1f2a59be87ea40b9b9b685f3ac
Update for 76768HEADmain
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--76768-0.txt14148
-rw-r--r--76768-h/76768-h.htm18125
-rw-r--r--76768-h/images/cover.jpgbin0 -> 855170 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
6 files changed, 32289 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/76768-0.txt b/76768-0.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..731e191
--- /dev/null
+++ b/76768-0.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,14148 @@
+
+*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 76768 ***
+
+
+
+
+
+ ENGLISH GRAMMAR
+
+ BY
+ LILLIAN G. KIMBALL
+ FORMERLY HEAD OF ENGLISH DEPARTMENT, STATE NORMAL
+ SCHOOL, OSHKOSH, WISCONSIN
+ AUTHOR OF “THE STRUCTURE OF THE ENGLISH SENTENCE”
+ “ELEMENTARY ENGLISH, BOOK ONE,” AND
+ “ELEMENTARY ENGLISH, BOOK TWO”
+
+ NEW YORK ·:· CINCINNATI ·:· CHICAGO
+ AMERICAN BOOK COMPANY
+
+ COPYRIGHT, 1912, BY
+ AMERICAN BOOK COMPANY.
+
+ ENTERED AT STATIONERS’ HALL, LONDON.
+
+ KIMBALL’S ENG. GRAMMAR.
+
+
+
+
+PREFACE
+
+
+The purpose of this book is to set forth in a simple and practical manner
+the principles of modern English Grammar. The aim has been not only to
+give the pupils an insight into the structure of the English sentence,
+but also to provide them with exercises helpful to the formation of good
+habits of speech.
+
+It is a matter of common knowledge among teachers of grammar that a
+mere understanding of the rules of syntax does not insure the avoidance
+of errors and the use of correct forms. The use of language by young
+persons is instinctive and spontaneous rather than reflective, hence the
+most effective way for them to secure correctness of speech is through
+imitation and practice. Recognizing this fundamental fact in language
+teaching, the author has provided many exercises both for the learning
+of correct forms and for practice in their use. These the teacher is
+expected to supplement by constant criticism, example, and stimulus.
+
+After the pupil has been led to appreciate and strive for correctness of
+speech, he naturally wishes to understand why a certain form is correct
+or incorrect, to have a test for his own speech and a standard by which
+to judge the speech of others. Only by such an understanding does he gain
+a mastery of the form of a language so that he can use it with ease,
+freedom, and certainty. To promote such a mastery of English, the author
+has made each construction perfectly clear, and has led the pupil through
+accurate reasoning to conclusions which are strengthened and established
+by their application to many illustrative sentences chosen from standard
+literature.
+
+The selection and the arrangement of subject matter have been carefully
+considered in the light of experience in the classroom. The arrangement
+is at the same time pedagogical and logical. Each point is taken up where
+it is called for by the preceding lesson and where it will be of greatest
+use in making clear what follows. Technical points that have little or no
+practical value have been omitted, but whatever is of benefit in helping
+the pupil to use or to interpret the English language has been included.
+
+Thanks are due to many teachers for helpful criticisms of the manuscript
+of this book.
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+
+ LESSON PAGE
+
+ I. Declarative Sentences. Subject and Predicate 9
+
+ II. Simple Subject. Nouns 11
+
+ III. Classification of Nouns 13
+
+ IV. Verbs 15
+
+ V. Pronouns 18
+
+ VI. Compound Subject and Compound Predicate 19
+
+ VII. Transposed Subject and Predicate 22
+
+ VIII. Interrogative Sentences 23
+
+ IX. Adjectives 25
+
+ X. Adverbs 28
+
+ XI. Phrases. Analysis of Sentences 31
+
+ XII. Prepositions 34
+
+ XIII. Term of Address. Exclamatory Noun 39
+
+ XIV. Imperative Sentences 41
+
+ XV. Interjections 43
+
+ XVI. Exclamatory Sentences 44
+
+ XVII. Conjunctions 46
+
+ XVIII. Clauses. Simple Sentences 48
+
+ XIX. Compound Sentences 50
+
+ XX. Dependent Clauses. Complex Sentences 52
+
+ XXI. Review: Classification of Sentences 55
+
+ XXII. Review: Parts of Speech 57
+
+ XXIII. Transitive Verbs. Object of Verb 60
+
+ XXIV. Intransitive Verbs asserting Action 64
+
+ XXV. Intransitive Verbs asserting Being. Nouns as Subjective
+ Complements 66
+
+ XXVI. Adjectives as Subjective Complements 69
+
+ XXVII. Review of Verbs 72
+
+ XXVIII. Nouns: Number 74
+
+ XXIX. Nouns: Gender 77
+
+ XXX. Possessive Nouns 80
+
+ XXXI. Nouns: Case 83
+
+ XXXII. Nouns: The Appositive 85
+
+ XXXIII. Appositive Adjectives 88
+
+ XXXIV. Indirect Object 89
+
+ XXXV. Adverbial Noun Phrases 91
+
+ XXXVI. Adverbial Noun Phrases 92
+
+ XXXVII. Objective Complement 94
+
+ XXXVIII. Parsing of Nouns 96
+
+ XXXIX. Personal Pronouns 98
+
+ XL. Uses of Personal Pronouns 100
+
+ XLI. Uses of Possessive Personal Pronouns 103
+
+ XLII. Compound Personal Pronouns 106
+
+ XLIII. Interrogative Pronouns 108
+
+ XLIV. Descriptive Adjectives 110
+
+ XLV. Limiting Adjectives 113
+
+ XLVI. Comparison of Adjectives 116
+
+ XLVII. Review of Adjectives 120
+
+ XLVIII. Adjective Pronouns 121
+
+ XLIX. Verbs: Tense 123
+
+ L. The Indicative Mode 127
+
+ LI. The Interrogative Form of the Indicative Mode 129
+
+ LII. The Subjunctive Mode 131
+
+ LIII. The Imperative Mode 134
+
+ LIV. Principal Parts of Verbs. Regular and Irregular Verbs 135
+
+ LV. Voice 140
+
+ LVI. The Passive Voice 144
+
+ LVII. The Progressive Conjugation 148
+
+ LVIII. The Emphatic Conjugation 149
+
+ LIX. Parsing of Verbs 150
+
+ LX. The Auxiliary Verbs _Shall_ and _Will_ 151
+
+ LXI. Defective Verbs. Verb Phrases 154
+
+ LXII. Direct and Indirect Discourse 162
+
+ LXIII. Agreement of Verb and Subject. Collective Nouns 165
+
+ LXIV. Review of Verbs 168
+
+ LXV. Classification of Adverbs. Simple Adverbs 169
+
+ LXVI. Conjunctive Adverbs 171
+
+ LXVII. Summary of Adverbs 173
+
+ LXVIII. Coördinate Conjunctions 174
+
+ LXIX. Subordinate Conjunctions 176
+
+ LXX. Adverbial Clauses of Time, Place, and Manner 180
+
+ LXXI. Adverbial Clauses of Cause, Purpose, and Result 183
+
+ LXXII. Adverbial Clauses of Condition and Concession 186
+
+ LXXIII. Adverbial Clauses of Comparison 188
+
+ LXXIV. Analysis of Sentences 191
+
+ LXXV. Adjective Clauses 193
+
+ LXXVI. Relative Pronouns 196
+
+ LXXVII. Noun Clauses 200
+
+ LXXVIII. Introductory Words of Noun Clauses 203
+
+ LXXIX. Review of Clauses 206
+
+ LXXX. Review of Pronouns 207
+
+ LXXXI. Infinitives 209
+
+ LXXXII. Infinitives as Subjects or Complements 212
+
+ LXXXIII. Infinitives as Modifiers of Nouns 215
+
+ LXXXIV. Infinitives as Parts of “Double Objects.” As Modifiers
+ of Verbs 216
+
+ LXXXV. Other Uses of Infinitives 220
+
+ LXXXVI. Summary of Infinitives 224
+
+ LXXXVII. Analysis of Sentences containing Infinitive Phrases 225
+
+ LXXXVIII. Participles 228
+
+ LXXXIX. Participles modifying Nouns 231
+
+ XC. Participial Phrases in the Predicate 234
+
+ XCI. Absolute Participial Phrases 237
+
+ XCII. Agreement of Participles. Other Words in _-ing_ 239
+
+ XCIII. Summary of Participles 243
+
+ XCIV. Analysis of Sentences 244
+
+ XCV. Anticipative Subject 247
+
+ XCVI. Elliptical Sentences 249
+
+ XCVII. Review of Analysis 252
+
+ General Review 257
+
+ Index 265
+
+
+
+
+I. DECLARATIVE SENTENCES. SUBJECT AND PREDICATE
+
+
+=1.= The purpose of English Grammar is to set forth the laws and customs
+governing the use of the English language. We study grammar in order that
+we may express our thoughts correctly.
+
+A group of words, sometimes few, sometimes many, that completely
+expresses a thought is called a =sentence=. In speech one sentence is
+set off from another by a slight pause. On the written or printed page
+sentences are separated from each other by a slight space, while the
+first word of every sentence begins with a capital letter, and the last
+word is followed by some sort of terminal mark.
+
+Most sentences are made to state, or declare, something, and hence are
+called =declarative= sentences. The following are declarative sentences:—
+
+ Molly danced up and down with delight.
+
+ My grandfather’s desk had the best light in the room.
+
+=2.= Declarative sentences consist of two distinct parts. One part names
+the person, place, or thing which the sentence tells something about.
+This part is called the subject. The other part is the telling part. It
+is called the predicate.
+
+In the first example _Molly_ is the subject, because it names the person
+about whom something is told. _Danced up and down with delight_ is the
+predicate, because it tells something about Molly.
+
+What is the subject in the second example? the predicate? How do you
+know? What terminal mark follows a declarative sentence?
+
+=Summary.=—A =sentence= is a group of words that completely expresses a
+thought.
+
+A =declarative sentence= is one that states, or declares, something.
+
+A declarative sentence is always followed by a period.
+
+The =subject= of a sentence is the part which names that about which
+something is said.
+
+The =predicate= of a sentence is the part which says something about the
+subject.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Tell why each of the following sentences is declarative.
+Select the subject, and tell why it is the subject. Select the predicate,
+and tell why it is the predicate. Tell all this in good language. Write
+it about one of the sentences, and be sure to underline the words that
+should be printed in italics. (See § 2.) Remember that all the words in
+the sentence belong either in the subject or in the predicate.
+
+ 1. The village street was as quiet as the fields.
+
+ 2. The great crashes of deep bass notes sent little thrills
+ down our backs.
+
+ 3. The cat could not find anything to eat except a thin,
+ dried-up old mole.
+
+ 4. Little gray-eyed Caroline went to live with her Aunt Fogg.
+
+ 5. The traveler, being quite faint for lack of food, helped
+ himself to the leg of a roast chicken.
+
+ 6. Four is the right number for a pie.
+
+ 7. A young girl of wonderful beauty lay asleep on the bed.
+
+ 8. Mary shut the parlor door with a great slam.
+
+ 9. Beauty, full of surprise but very happy, permitted the
+ prince to lead her to his palace.
+
+ 10. The magic song still rose from the vines outside the
+ chamber window.
+
+ 11. We cats are confined entirely to the society of each other.
+
+ 12. The glassy water was sparkling with stars.
+
+ 13. Locusts devoured the green things of the valley.
+
+ 14. Not a living soul was to be seen.
+
+ 15. My little half-starved cat grew white and plump and pretty.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Find five interesting declarative sentences in a story
+book. Write them with the subject underlined.
+
+=Exercise 3.=—Write a fitting predicate for each of the following
+subjects:—
+
+ 1. A boy with a fish pole
+
+ 2. Abraham Lincoln
+
+ 3. My last dime
+
+ 4. The man on the ice wagon
+
+ 5. Our old white rooster
+
+ 6. Not a girl in the class
+
+ 7. The battered old musket
+
+ 8. The haymakers
+
+ 9. The miner’s cabin
+
+ 10. Moving picture shows
+
+
+
+
+II. SIMPLE SUBJECT. NOUNS
+
+
+=3.= It is evident from the sentences in Exercise 1, p. 10, that the
+subject of a sentence may consist of one word or of a group of words. In
+the sentence, “Peter was sitting by himself,” the subject is only the one
+word _Peter_. In the sentence, “A lovely old lady with white hair and a
+gentle, noble face came to the door,” the subject is a group of twelve
+words. What are they?
+
+When the subject of a sentence is a group of words, there is always
+a base word in the group, which, more than any other word, names or
+designates the person, place, or thing about which something is said.
+This word is called the simple subject.
+
+What is the simple subject in the sentence that tells who came to the
+door? What are the simple subjects in sentences 1, 2, 5, 7, 12, 14, and
+15 in Exercise 1, p. 10?
+
+=4.= Every word in a sentence is used for a particular purpose. Because
+words are used for different purposes they have been divided into classes
+called =parts of speech=.
+
+In the sentences just studied the words _Peter_ and _lady_ are used to
+name certain persons. Name words are called nouns. A noun is a part of
+speech.
+
+=5.= Not every noun is the name of a person. Many are names of places;
+as, _Oshkosh_, _pasture_, _corner_. Many more are names of things of all
+sorts; as, _peach_, _violet_, _bee_, _thimble_, _automobile_.
+
+In the sentence about the lovely old lady, find three nouns that are
+names of things.
+
+Any noun may be used as the simple subject of a sentence. Write sentences
+in which the nouns _hair_, _face_, and _door_ are so used.
+
+=Summary.=—The =simple subject= of a sentence is the base word, or most
+important word, of the subject.
+
+=Parts of speech= are the classes into which words are divided according
+to their use.
+
+A =noun= is a name word.
+
+A noun may be used as the simple subject of a sentence.
+
+=Exercise.=—Write a list of all the nouns you can find in the following
+paragraphs. Tell what each noun is the name of. Point out five nouns that
+are simple subjects. What are their predicates?
+
+ 1. At last Purun Dass went to England on a visit, and had to
+ pay enormous sums to the priests when he came back to India;
+ for even so high-caste a Brahmin as he lost caste by crossing
+ the black sea. In London he met and talked with every one
+ worth knowing—men whose names go all over the world—and saw a
+ great deal more than he said. He was given honorary degrees by
+ learned universities, and he made speeches and talked of Hindu
+ social reform to English ladies in evening dress, till all
+ London cried, “This is the most fascinating man we have ever
+ met at dinner since cloths were first laid.”
+
+ 2. Her godmother laughed, and touched Cinderella also with the
+ wand; at which her wretched, threadbare jacket became stiff
+ with gold, and sparkling with jewels; her woolen petticoat
+ lengthened into a gown of sweeping satin, from underneath
+ which peeped out her little feet, no longer bare, but covered
+ with silk stockings and the prettiest glass slippers in the
+ world. “Now, Cinderella, depart; but remember, if you stay one
+ instant after midnight, your carriage will become a pumpkin,
+ your coachman a rat, your horses mice, and your footmen
+ lizards; while you yourself will be the little cinder wench you
+ were an hour ago.”
+
+
+
+
+III. CLASSIFICATION OF NOUNS
+
+
+=6.= There are certain beings in the world that are called men, and
+certain other beings that are called horses, certain things that are
+called cities, and certain other things that are called rivers, hence
+the words _man_, _horse_, _city_, and _river_ are names, or nouns. Since
+these nouns belong in common to a great many individuals, we call them
+=common nouns=.
+
+=7.= On the other hand, every man, every horse, every city, and every
+river is likely to have a _special_ name that distinguishes that
+particular man or horse or city or river from all others. _Cæsar_,
+_Gypsy_, _Denver_, and _Penobscot_ are such names. Since these names
+belong to only one thing instead of to a class of things, we call them
+=proper nouns=.
+
+=8.= A common noun is a name that belongs to a person, a place, or a
+thing because of its nature or qualities. A boat is entitled to the name
+_boat_ because it has the characteristics of boats. A proper noun is a
+name conferred or given by some person, as when a certain boat was named
+by its owners _Westernland_.
+
+It sometimes happens that the same name is conferred upon several
+objects. There is more than one city named Madison, more than one dog
+named Shep. Still these names are proper names, because they are names
+conferred upon a special city and a special dog to distinguish them from
+other cities and other dogs.
+
+A proper noun always begins with a capital letter.
+
+=9.= When a word denoting relationship, like _father_, _mother_, _uncle_,
+is used as the name of a particular person, it is a proper noun and
+should therefore begin with a capital letter; as, “Did Father say that
+Grandma and Auntie are coming?”
+
+=10.= A title like _Colonel_, _Judge_, _Duke_, is a proper noun when
+it is used to denote a special person; as, “Thousands had gathered to
+welcome the Colonel home.” When such a word is the name of a class of
+persons, it is a common noun; as, “A new uniform was designed for the
+colonels.”
+
+When a title is followed by another name, as, _Colonel Bouck_, _Judge
+Gary_, the two words are considered as one proper noun. In the same way,
+any group of two or more words forming one special name may be considered
+as one proper noun; as, _Liberty Bell_, _Bay of Biscay_, _Mountains of
+the Moon_. In such groups of words, each important word begins with a
+capital letter.
+
+ NOTE.—Names of qualities, conditions, or actions are often
+ called =abstract nouns=; as, _honesty_, _power_, _boyhood_, the
+ _passing_ of the train, sound _thinking_, _suspense_.
+
+=Summary.=—A =common noun= is a noun that belongs in common to each one
+of a class of persons, places, or things.
+
+A =proper noun= is a name that has been conferred upon a particular
+person, place, or thing.
+
+Every proper noun should begin with a capital letter.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the nouns in the following sentences, and tell
+whether they are common or proper nouns. Give your reason in each case.
+Account for the capitalization.
+
+ 1. The Bermudas are a cluster of small islands, lying as far
+ south as Charleston, as far east as Nova Scotia.
+
+ 2. Hotel Hamilton is a large, commodious building with many
+ pillars and broad verandas.
+
+ 3. The _Tenedos_ is lying off Grassy Bay, making herself fine
+ to receive the Princess Louise, and her jolly tars are in high
+ spirits.
+
+ 4. On the Sunday of the christening, Mrs. Howe and her children
+ watched the merrymaking in Poverty Lane from a second story
+ window.
+
+ 5. Where was Prospero’s cell? Where slept the fair Miranda?
+ Upon what bank sat Ferdinand when Ariel sang?
+
+ 6. The Duluth High School is a fine structure built of red
+ sandstone.
+
+ 7. The _Deliverance_ was a ship of eighty tons.
+
+ 8. Old Lobo, or the King, as the Mexicans called him, was the
+ gigantic leader of a remarkable pack of gray wolves, that had
+ ravaged the Currumpaw Valley for a number of years.
+
+ 9. About this time I met with an odd volume of the _Spectator_.
+
+ 10.
+
+ Wynken, Blynken, and Nod one night
+ Sailed off in a wooden shoe.
+
+ 11. Let us all go to the station Monday to meet Uncle.
+
+ 12.
+
+ The cows were coming one by one;
+ Brindle, Ebony, Speckle, and Bess,
+ Shaking their horns in the evening wind.
+
+ 13. Gunpowder had been a favorite steed of his master’s, the
+ choleric Van Ripper, who was a furious rider.
+
+ 14. Upstream, at the bend of the sluggish pool round the Peace
+ Rock, stood Hathi, the wild elephant, with his sons, gaunt and
+ gray in the moonlight.
+
+ 15. In his eighth year Charles Lamb entered Christ’s Hospital,
+ a famous school in London.
+
+It is evident from this exercise that several different sorts of things,
+as hotels, streets, books, and ships, may have special names conferred
+upon them. Think of ten other things that may have special names, and
+write two names for each one.
+
+
+
+
+IV. VERBS
+
+
+=11.= Just as the subject of a sentence may consist of only one word, so
+may the predicate. Hence it is that a declarative sentence may contain
+only two words, one being the subject and the other the predicate; as in
+the sentence, “Water runs.” Here the noun _water_ names the thing about
+which something is told, and the word _runs_ tells something about water.
+
+=12.= In every predicate, no matter how long it is, there is always one
+word, or a little group of words, which does more of the telling than all
+the rest of the predicate. In fact, without this word or group of words,
+there would be no statement at all. In the sentence, “A red sash with
+fringes of gold wraps his waist several times,” the predicate consists of
+five words, but the one word that counts for most in making the statement
+is the word _wraps_. This word is called a verb. A verb is a part of
+speech.
+
+A verb, being the essential part of a predicate, is called the =simple
+predicate=.
+
+=13.= Sometimes a verb consists of two, or three, or even four words.
+What is the verb in each of the following sentences?—
+
+ All the cherries had been picked from the trees near the house.
+
+ The watchman on the roof was listening for the first sounds of
+ day.
+
+ A tall, dark figure might have been seen at the end of the
+ avenue.
+
+=14.= When the verb in a given sentence has been found, the subject may
+be discovered by asking the question formed by placing the word _who_
+or _what_ before the verb. For example, in the sentence, “The parrot’s
+story, with the various pauses and interruptions, occupied a good deal of
+time,” _occupied_ is the verb because it is the telling word. Asking the
+question _what occupied_? we get the answer, _the parrot’s story, with
+the various pauses and interruptions_, hence this group of words is the
+subject. What is the simple subject?
+
+=15.= In grammar we often use the word _assertion_ instead of
+_statement_, and the word _assert_ instead of _make a statement_.
+
+=Summary.=—A =verb= is an asserting word.
+
+A verb may consist of one word, two, three, or four words, but never of
+more than four words.
+
+A verb is the necessary part of every predicate, hence it is called the
+=simple predicate=.
+
+To find the subject of a verb, ask the question made by using the word
+_who_ or _what_ before the verb.
+
+=Exercise.=—Divide the following sentences into subject and predicate.
+Select the predicate verb, and tell why it is a verb. Find the simple
+subject of each sentence. Tell what part of speech it is, and why.
+
+ 1. The procession moved from the palace to the church with
+ great pomp.
+
+ 2. The blue eyes of the Greek sparkled.
+
+ 3. The magnificent buildings of the hospital stand on level
+ land near the river.
+
+ 4. The gentle young bride was frightened by the silent,
+ mysterious ways of the old Indian.
+
+ 5.
+
+ The poorest twig on the elm tree
+ Was ridged inch deep with pearl.
+
+ 6. The great hall of the palace was illuminated with a thousand
+ lamps.
+
+ 7. His anvil makes no music on Sunday.
+
+ 8. The raccoon’s story was received with general approbation.
+
+ 9. This old hunter must have told many tales.
+
+ 10. Our conference under the peepul tree had been growing
+ noisier and noisier.
+
+ 11. One great name can make a country great.
+
+ 12. The camels slept.
+
+ 13. No European could have made five miles a day over the ice
+ rubbish and the sharp-edged drifts.
+
+ 14. The cows should have been milked before sundown.
+
+ 15.
+
+ The deep waters of the bay
+ Stir with the breath of hurrying day.
+
+ 16. Wully could not have imagined any greater being than his
+ master.
+
+ 17. Everything out of doors was sheathed in silver mail.
+
+ 18. The duck mother would have liked the eel’s head herself.
+
+In sentence 18 is _herself_ in the subject or in the predicate?
+
+
+
+
+V. PRONOUNS
+
+
+=16.= When a person makes an assertion about himself he uses for the
+subject of his sentence, not his name, but the word _I_ instead. Will
+Dunlap does not say, “Will Dunlap saw a flock of wild geese this morning,
+and heard them too.” He says, “I saw a flock of wild geese this morning,
+and heard them too.” The word _I_, which is used instead of a name, or
+noun, is called a =pronoun=. A pronoun is a part of speech.
+
+What pronoun besides _I_ do you find in the sentence quoted? For what
+noun is it used?
+
+=17.= Pronouns are used a good deal, especially in conversation, for
+often instead of using the name of the person we are speaking to, we use
+the pronoun _you_; and in speaking _of_ persons, we use, provided their
+names are already known to our listeners, the pronouns _he_, _she_, or
+_they_.
+
+=Summary.=—A =pronoun= is a word used instead of a noun.
+
+A pronoun can be the subject of a sentence.
+
+By the use of pronouns we avoid the repetition of nouns and the use of
+clumsy expressions.
+
+=Exercise.=—In the following conversation select all the pronouns.
+Rewrite a portion of the conversation, using the nouns that the pronouns
+stand for. In changing pronouns to nouns it is sometimes necessary to
+make a change in the verb also. After using nouns for pronouns, tell what
+you think about the usefulness of pronouns.
+
+ “What do you think, Tirzah? I am going away.”
+
+ Tirzah dropped her hands with amazement.
+
+ “Going away! When? Where? For what?”
+
+ Judah laughed, then said, “Three questions, all in a breath.
+ What a body you are!” Next instant he became serious. “You know
+ the law requires me to follow some occupation. Our good father
+ set me an example. Even you would despise me if I spent in
+ idleness the results of his industry and knowledge. I am going
+ to Rome.”
+
+ “Oh, I will go with you.”
+
+ “You must stay with Mother. If both of us leave her, she will
+ die.”
+
+ The brightness faded from her face.
+
+ “Ah, yes, yes! But—must you go? Here in Jerusalem you can learn
+ all that is needed to be a merchant—if that is what you are
+ thinking of.”
+
+ “But that is not what I am thinking of. The law does not
+ require the son to be what the father was.”
+
+ “What else can you be?”
+
+ “A soldier,” he replied, with a certain pride of voice.
+
+ Tears came into her eyes.
+
+ “You will be killed.”
+
+ “If God’s will, be it so. But, Tirzah, the soldiers are not all
+ killed.”
+
+ She threw her arms around his neck, as if to hold him back.
+
+ “We are so happy! Stay at home, my brother.”
+
+ “Home cannot always be what it is. You yourself will be going
+ away before long.”
+
+ “Never!”
+
+ He smiled at her earnestness.
+
+ “A prince will come soon and claim my Tirzah, and ride away
+ with her, to be the light of another house.”
+
+ She answered with sobs.
+
+ “War is a trade,” he continued, more soberly. “To learn it
+ thoroughly, one must go to school, and there is no school like
+ a Roman camp.”
+
+ —LEW WALLACE.
+
+
+
+
+VI. COMPOUND SUBJECT AND COMPOUND PREDICATE
+
+
+=18.= It frequently happens that a person performs several actions at
+the same time, and that all of them are worth telling. In such a case we
+do not make several separate sentences, but one sentence with several
+predicates; as, “I looked at my plate and winked back the tears.” Here we
+have two predicate verbs, _looked_ and _winked_, hence two assertions. In
+such a sentence we say that there is a =compound predicate=.
+
+=19.= The compound predicate is used also when we tell of a number of
+actions performed in succession by one subject; as, “Father Wolf woke up
+from his day’s rest, scratched himself, yawned, and spread out his paws
+one after the other to get rid of the sleepy feeling in the tips.” How
+many predicates are there in this sentence? What mark separates them?
+Two or more predicates in succession, having the same subject, form what
+is called a =series=. Words or groups of words in a series are separated
+from each other by the comma unless some joining word is used; but when
+only the last two of a series are joined by some word, the comma is used
+before this word.
+
+=20.= We frequently wish to make the same assertion about several persons
+or things, but we do not make several sentences, repeating the predicate
+each time, for that would be tedious. Instead, we make one sentence with
+several subjects; as, “The fresh fruit and milk and the slices of cold
+chicken looked very nice.” This sentence has three distinct subjects.
+What are they? In such a sentence we say that there is a =compound
+subject=. Why is no comma used in this sentence?
+
+=Summary.=—A =compound subject= is one that consists of two or more
+distinct subjects united into one.
+
+A =compound predicate= is one that consists of two or more distinct
+predicates united into one.
+
+Two parts of a compound predicate are separated from each other by a
+comma unless they are very short. When there are more than two parts, and
+the last two are joined by some such word as _and_, a comma is placed
+after each part, even before the joining word.
+
+When a compound subject consists of more than two parts, a comma is
+placed after each part, unless all the parts are joined by some word.
+
+Any sentence may have a compound subject, or a compound predicate, or
+both.
+
+=Exercise.=—Tell why the following sentences are declarative. Tell
+whether each has a compound subject, or a compound predicate, or both.
+Write each sentence, and draw a vertical line between subject and
+predicate. Underline the simple subjects, and tell what part of speech
+they are. Underline also the simple predicates, or predicate verbs.
+Account for the punctuation.
+
+ 1. The oars dipped, arose, poised a moment, then dipped again,
+ with winglike action, and in perfect time.
+
+ 2. The eyes and mouths of the auditors opened wide.
+
+ 3. This poor child became the scapegoat of the house, and was
+ blamed for everything.
+
+ 4. The four cane-seated chairs, the walnut table, the haircloth
+ sofa, and the little stand always spoke to me of my childhood
+ days.
+
+ 5. She took the key bravely, but opened with a trembling hand
+ the door of the little room.
+
+ 6. Such timber and such workmanship don’t come together often
+ in houses built nowadays.
+
+ 7. Vast crowds of spectators lined the way, or gazed upon the
+ scene from the housetops.
+
+ 8. The rider then put his foot upon the camel’s slender neck,
+ and stepped upon the sand.
+
+ 9. The laborers paused, sat up, wrung the water from their
+ hands, and returned the salutation.
+
+ 10. The statue of the Indian chief or the soldiers’ monument in
+ the public square was given to the city by one of the pioneers.
+
+ 11. Spruce bachelors looked sidelong at the pretty maidens, and
+ fancied that the Sabbath sunshine made them prettier than on
+ week days.
+
+ 12. Grandmothers, mothers, and aunts sat across the end of the
+ hall.
+
+ 13. He brought a carpet or square rug from the litter, and
+ covered the floor of the tent on the side from the sun.
+
+ 14. Children with bright faces tripped merrily beside their
+ parents, or mimicked a graver gait in the conscious dignity of
+ their Sunday clothes.
+
+
+
+
+VII. TRANSPOSED SUBJECT AND PREDICATE
+
+
+=21.= The sentences studied thus far have been arranged so that the
+subject comes first, then the predicate. This is called the =natural
+order=. Sometimes, for the sake of emphasis, we reverse this order, as in
+the sentence, “In a long shed behind the church stood a score of wagons
+and chaises and carryalls.” This is called the =transposed order=.
+
+Sometimes, for the sake of a pleasing arrangement, we put only a portion
+of the predicate before the subject, as in the sentence, “Over the
+highest peaks a vulture sailed on broad wings into widening circles.”
+Here the subject is very short and the predicate very long. The sentence
+balances better with a portion of the predicate coming first. This also
+is a case of transposed order.
+
+=Summary.=—The =natural= order in a sentence is first the subject and
+then the predicate.
+
+When the words of a sentence are not in their natural order, we say that
+the sentence is =transposed=.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Rearrange the following sentences so that they will be in
+the natural order, then proceed as you did with the sentences in the
+exercise on p. 21. Tell in each case whether you like the natural or the
+transposed order better, and why.
+
+ 1. Around him, within hand’s reach, lie osier boxes full of
+ almonds, grapes, figs, and pomegranates.
+
+ 2. This challenge Fortunatus accepted.
+
+ 3. On traveled the lady and the bull through many dreadful
+ forests and lonely wastes.
+
+ 4. On that first Christmas morning in their own home, the
+ children found their gifts in little piles on two of the parlor
+ chairs.
+
+ 5. Through the wide nostrils the camel drank the wind in great
+ draughts.
+
+ 6. Out of the wide hall could be heard in the stillness the old
+ clock.
+
+ 7. At full speed a genuine Syrian dromedary overtakes the
+ ordinary winds.
+
+ 8. Very hard Johnny worked on the house.
+
+ 9. “Come in,” said a warm, comfortable voice on the other side
+ of the door.
+
+ 10.
+
+ Down will come Baby,
+ Bough, cradle, and all.
+
+ 11. In the garret meet together all the broken-down chairs of
+ the household, all the spavined tables, all the seedy hats, all
+ the intoxicated-looking boots, all the split walking sticks
+ that have retired from business, “weary with the march of life.”
+
+Account for the commas in sentences 10 and 11.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Change the following sentences to the transposed order.
+Tell why you like them better so.
+
+ 1. Pussy walked along with a slow and deliberate gait directly
+ behind my sister and me.
+
+ 2. A red rose, a yellow rose, a woodbine, and a clematis grew
+ up the four walls.
+
+ 3. The roll of the drum was hushed at the old man’s word and
+ outstretched arm.
+
+ 4. A mat of long, uncombed hair hangs over his eyes and face,
+ and down his back.
+
+ 5. The whole carpet came out right on my head.
+
+ 6. A little rabbit sat on a bank one morning.
+
+ 7. Daylight and safety were on the other side of that door.
+
+ 8. The bird flew on and on, up the steep mountain.
+
+ 9. A very amusing thing in this story comes now.
+
+ 10. The remains of a great elephant have been found in the
+ curious potholes near Cohoes, New York.
+
+
+
+
+VIII. INTERROGATIVE SENTENCES
+
+
+=22.= Most of the sentences in books are declarative sentences, written
+to make statements, but in speech we frequently make use of another kind
+of sentence, one that asks a question; as, “Do you know how to tell a
+sheep’s age?” This is called an =interrogative= sentence.
+
+=23.= The interrogative sentence, “What dwarfs made that armor?” is in
+the natural order, but this is not the usual order in interrogative
+sentences. In the sentence, “Do you know how to tell a sheep’s age?” we
+find first a part of the verb, then the subject, then the other part of
+the verb and the rest of the predicate. How would this sentence read if
+it were in the natural order? Would it then be an interrogative sentence?
+
+ NOTE.—Since an interrogative sentence does not make a
+ statement, it may seem strange to define the verb in such a
+ sentence as an asserting word, but in making definitions we
+ must think of the fundamental nature and the typical use of
+ what we are defining. The primary office of the verb is to
+ assert, as in declarative sentences; hence, we define the verb
+ as an asserting word, though it may also be used in asking
+ questions.
+
+=Summary.=—An =interrogative sentence= is one that asks a question.
+
+An interrogative sentence is usually in the transposed order, and is
+always followed by a question mark.
+
+=Exercise.=—Tell whether the following sentences are in the natural
+or the transposed order. Put into the natural order those which are
+transposed. Divide each sentence into subject and predicate. Select the
+simple subject and the predicate verb, or simple predicate.
+
+ 1. Did you ever hear of a cat’s playing hide and seek?
+
+ 2. What became of you after the Princess’s death?
+
+ 3. Will no other diet serve you but poor Jack?
+
+ 4. Which flower does your mother like best?
+
+ 5. What harm can a naked frog do us?
+
+ 6. Will the town crier tell us of an auction, or of a lost
+ pocket-book, or of a show of beautiful wax figures, or of some
+ monstrous beast more horrible than any in the caravan?
+
+ 7. Why did no smile of welcome brighten upon his face?
+
+ 8. What did Peterson-Sahib mean by the elephant dance?
+
+ 9. How many people have ever come to know a wild animal?
+
+ 10. What important business made you late to dinner?
+
+ 11. What plant we in this apple tree?
+
+ 12. What other man would have discovered so many virtues under
+ so mean a dress?
+
+ 13. What do people fish for in this country?
+
+ 14.
+
+ Does that star-spangled banner yet wave
+ O’er the land of the free, and the home of the brave?
+
+ 15. Where did you get your eyes so blue?
+
+ 16. Who will exchange old lamps for new ones?
+
+ 17. What makes your cheek like a warm, white rose?
+
+
+
+
+IX. ADJECTIVES
+
+
+=24.= From the sentence, “The road led us to a gate, and that to a
+dooryard and a house,” we get a picture, but it is neither definite nor
+attractive. Contrast it with the picture that we get from this sentence,
+“The pleasant, elm-shaded road led us to a rustic gate, and that to a
+green dooryard, and a long, low, brown house.” The difference is caused
+by the descriptive words in the second sentence. Which words describe the
+road? the gate? the dooryard? the house?
+
+These descriptive words go with nouns, and describe the object named by
+the noun. We call them =adjectives=. An adjective is a part of speech.
+
+Adjectives are said to =modify= the nouns they go with, and are called
+=modifiers=.
+
+=25.= Most adjectives describe objects by telling size, shape, color,
+texture, or other qualities. A few adjectives tell number or amount;
+as, _five_ minutes, _much_ patience. A few merely point out; as, _this_
+meadow, _next_ Christmas. The words _a_, _an_, and _the_ are adjectives.
+
+=26.= When several adjectives modify the same noun, they form a series,
+and are usually separated from each other by commas; as, “A hollow,
+booming, ominous cry rang out suddenly, and startled the dark edges
+of the forest.” In such a sentence as this, “Four little old French
+ladies rose to dance the minuet,” no commas should be used, because the
+adjectives modify more than the noun _ladies_. _Four_ modifies _little
+old French ladies_; _little_ modifies _old French ladies_; _old_ modifies
+_French ladies_; and _French_ modifies _ladies_.
+
+=27.= Sometimes adjectives modify a pronoun instead of a noun, as in
+the sentence, “Tom missed the word, and I, happy and triumphant, took
+his place at the head.” How do we know that the adjectives _happy_ and
+_triumphant_ modify the pronoun _I_?
+
+=Summary.=—An =adjective= is a word used to point out or describe an
+object and modify a noun or a pronoun.
+
+Adjectives usually precede the nouns they modify but follow the pronouns.
+
+When several adjectives modify a single noun, they are separated by
+commas.
+
+A =modifier= is a word or a group of words that goes with another word to
+affect its meaning.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Select all the adjectives in the following sentences, and
+tell what they modify. Account for the punctuation.
+
+ 1. On another side stood an old piano, a tinkling, rattling,
+ merrymaking old piano, played by a young lady with a melancholy
+ smile.
+
+ 2. In the dark valley that ran down to a little river, Father
+ Wolf heard the dry, angry, snarly, singsong whine of a tiger.
+
+ 3. A small girl, with twinkling eyes and a merry face, got up
+ and made her way to the front.
+
+ 4. Only loving fingers could have taken those tiny, even
+ stitches.
+
+ 5. Charles carried water for the circus men, while I, scornful
+ and lazy but envious, sat on the fence and watched him.
+
+ 6. Mammy Tittleback is a splendid, great tortoise-shell cat.
+
+ 7. I found myself sinking into some horrible, soft, slimy,
+ sticky substance.
+
+ 8. Few ships come to Rivermouth now.
+
+ 9. Cæsar has one of the finest, deepest-toned voices I ever
+ heard.
+
+ 10. You can speak and smile cheerfully while you are enjoying
+ every comfort of a snug, warm fireside, but you should not
+ expect us, hungry, wet, and cold, to be in the same cheerful
+ mood.
+
+ 11. Suddenly the church clock tolled a deep, dull, hollow,
+ melancholy “one.”
+
+ 12. The next best thing to cold potato and cream is cold roast
+ chicken, and occasionally I found a good fat drumstick or a
+ curling neck from whose corrugated bones I nibbled savory
+ morsels.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Write sentences using the following words as adjectives.
+Make your sentences such that they reveal the meaning of the adjectives.
+
+ awkward
+ brilliant
+ clammy
+ false
+ glassy
+ graceful
+ greedy
+ huge
+ mild
+ moist
+ pathetic
+ shaggy
+ slight
+ sly
+ soggy
+
+=Exercise 3.=—Write sentences containing the following nouns, each
+modified by two or more adjectives:—
+
+ cabbage
+ carpet
+ cloud
+ deed
+ garden
+ grapes
+ hand
+ hat
+ machine
+ mill
+ pupil
+ room
+ ship
+ story
+ teacher
+
+=28.= In the following sentences, what word describes the statue? the
+bureau? the lamp? the rings?
+
+ A bronze statue of Benjamin Franklin stood in Lafayette Park.
+
+ The mahogany bureau contained a desk with many drawers and
+ pigeon holes.
+
+ We grew tired of the gorgeousness of our parlor lamp.
+
+ Indians of both sexes are fond of bracelets, necklaces, and
+ finger rings.
+
+These four descriptive words are name words, hence by nature they are
+nouns; but in these sentences they are used as adjectives, and should
+therefore be called adjectives.
+
+=Exercise 4.=—Write sentences in which the following nouns are used as
+adjectives:—
+
+ silver, copper, tin, iron, steel.
+
+ maple, oak, pine, hickory, cedar.
+
+ kitchen, hall, cellar, roof, library.
+
+ hand, head, foot, cheek, neck.
+
+Think of ten other nouns that may be used as adjectives.
+
+
+
+
+X. ADVERBS
+
+
+=29.= In the sentence, “The donkey ate an armful of green grass,” we are
+told what action the donkey performed, but we are not told the manner in
+which he performed the action. Very often manner is worth telling, as in
+the sentence, “The donkey ate leisurely an armful of green grass.”
+
+Since the word _leisurely_ tells how the donkey ate, it must go with the
+word _ate_. We say of it what we said of adjectives, that it _modifies_
+the word it goes with. Since it modifies a verb, it is different from any
+part of speech that we have studied before. We call it an =adverb=.
+
+=30.= The great difference between adjectives and adverbs is this, that
+the adjective modifies a noun or a pronoun, and the adverb usually
+modifies a verb. Adjectives describe objects, which are named by nouns,
+and adverbs usually describe actions, which are asserted by verbs.
+
+=31.= Not all adverbs tell manner. They frequently tell time, place,
+direction, degree, or other circumstances; as in these sentences:—
+
+ _Now_ the cow would be eating in one place, and _then_ she
+ would walk to another.
+
+ _Here_ and _there_ a snag lifted its nose out of the water like
+ a shark.
+
+ For weeks his ship sailed _onward_ over a lonely ocean.
+
+ Mother’s sudden cry frightened me _terribly_.
+
+=32.= It was pointed out in Lesson IX that adjectives frequently tell
+some quality of an object. Sometimes we wish to tell in what degree
+this quality is possessed, as in the expressions, _a very tall man_,
+_an exceedingly hot day_, _too ripe fruit_. Here the words _very_,
+_exceedingly_, and _too_ go with the adjectives _tall_, _hot_, and _ripe_
+to denote degree. Such words are said to modify the adjectives they go
+with. Words that modify adjectives are also called adverbs.
+
+ NOTE.—A group of words like _very tall_ and _exceedingly hot_
+ may be called an =adjective element=. Its base word is an
+ adjective, modified by an adverb. It is the whole element, or
+ group of words, that modifies the noun.
+
+Adverbs of degree may modify adverbs as well as adjectives, as in the
+sentences, “The fox ran very swiftly,” “You speak too rapidly.”
+
+=Summary.=—An =adverb= is a word that modifies a verb, an adjective, or
+another adverb.
+
+Adverbs usually tell time, place, manner, direction, or degree.
+
+Unless a sentence is transposed, the adverb should be as near as possible
+to the word it modifies.
+
+Adverbs in a series are separated from each other by commas.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Select all the adverbs in the following sentences. Tell
+what each adverb modifies, and what it denotes.
+
+ 1. People with lanterns rushed hither and thither.
+
+ 2. The island is separated from the mainland by a scarcely
+ perceptible creek.
+
+ 3.
+
+ And so the teacher turned him out,
+ And still he lingered near,
+ And waited patiently about
+ Till Mary did appear.
+
+ 4. Faintly, in gentle whiffs, the lilies on the low marble
+ shelf threw off their delicate fragrance.
+
+ 5. Quackalina was sitting happily among the reeds with her dear
+ ones under her wings, while Sir Sooty waddled proudly around
+ her.
+
+ 6. In youth the tulip tree has a trunk peculiarly smooth.
+
+ 7. On one occasion Gypsy put in her head, and lapped up six
+ custard pies that had been placed by the casement to cool.
+
+ 8. No wild animals were ever trained by the ancients.
+
+ 9. The paper was passed skillfully from desk to desk until it
+ finally reached my hands.
+
+ 10. Messua’s husband had some remarkably fine buffaloes that
+ worried him exceedingly.
+
+ 11. The charcoal burners went off very valiantly in single file.
+
+ 12. Sometimes my head almost aches with the variety of my
+ knowledge.
+
+ 13. Knots of gossips lingered here and there near the place.
+
+ 14. This talk amused me greatly, but it went in at one ear and
+ out at the other.
+
+ 15. My father invested his money so securely in the banking
+ business that he was never able to get any of it out again.
+
+ 16. Yonder I shall sit down and get knowledge.
+
+ 17. Then he would crawl forward inch by inch, and wait till the
+ seal came up to breathe.
+
+ 18. No one can work well without sleep.
+
+ 19. This jackal was peculiarly low, a cleaner-up of village
+ rubbish heaps, desperately timid, or wildly bold, everlastingly
+ hungry, and full of cunning that never did him any good.
+
+ 20. The Black Panther raised his head and yawned—elaborately,
+ carefully, and ostentatiously.
+
+Account for the commas in the last sentence.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Write sentences containing adverbs of manner modifying the
+following verbs:—
+
+ comes
+ goes
+ plays
+ reads
+ sings
+ skates
+ speaks
+ studies
+ walks
+ works
+
+=Exercise 3.=—Write sentences containing the following adverbs:—
+
+ upward, downward, forward, backward, headlong, north, southward.
+
+ everywhere, nowhere, somewhere, anywhere.
+
+ seldom, often, always, sometimes, forever.
+
+ perfectly, unusually, unspeakably, positively, miserably.
+
+Use the last five adverbs to modify adjectives or adverbs. What will they
+denote when so used?
+
+=Exercise 4.=—Form adverbs from the following adjectives:—
+
+ careless
+ dreary
+ firm
+ gentle
+ hasty
+ noble
+ painful
+ sharp
+ slow
+ wide
+
+What part of speech are the words _chilly_, _deadly_, _holy_, _kindly_,
+_lively_, _lovely_? Use them in sentences to find out.
+
+
+
+
+XI. PHRASES. ANALYSIS OF SENTENCES
+
+
+=33.= We cannot always describe or point out objects as fully as we wish
+by means of adjectives, and so we use another sort of modifier, which is
+not a single word, but a group of words. In the sentence, “Broad, flat
+fields without fences stretch in every direction,” we describe the fields
+by the two adjectives _broad_ and _flat_, and by the group of words,
+_without fences_. Thus the noun _fields_ has three modifiers, and they
+are very well placed, two of them coming before the noun, and one of them
+after it.
+
+In the group of words _without fences_, the two words are closely related
+to each other. In fact, neither of them could be in the sentence at all
+without the other. Such a group of related words is called a =phrase=.
+When a phrase modifies a noun, we say it is an =adjective phrase=.
+
+=34.= In the same sentence there is another phrase, _in every direction_,
+telling where the fields stretch. Since this phrase modifies the verb,
+it performs the same office as an adverb, and we therefore call it an
+=adverbial phrase=.
+
+=35.= Phrases never consist of fewer than two words, and they may consist
+of a good many, for it is possible to have one or more phrases within
+a phrase. In the sentence, “I was born in a stable on the outskirts
+of a small town in Maine,” the verb _was born_ is modified by a long
+phrase, _in a stable on the outskirts of a small town in Maine_. The noun
+_stable_ in this phrase is modified by the phrase _on the outskirts of
+a small town in Maine_. The noun _outskirts_ in this second phrase is
+modified by the phrase _of a small town in Maine_. The noun _town_ in
+this third phrase is modified by the fourth phrase, _in Maine_.
+
+=36.= Phrases do not always modify the word they come next to; they
+modify the word whose meaning they tell something about. In the sentence,
+“I scrambled through the evergreens to my friend’s little hut just before
+sunset,” there is no phrase within another phrase, but there are three
+entirely distinct phrases. What are they?
+
+=37.= A series of phrases consists of two or more phrases each modifying
+the same word; as, “Ours is a government _of the people_, _for the
+people_, and _by the people_.” Phrases in a series are separated from
+each other by a comma. Why do not the phrases in the sentence in § 35
+form a series?
+
+It might seem at first thought that the sentence in § 36 contains a
+series of three phrases; but it does not, for the phrases do not modify
+the same word. _Through the evergreens_ modifies _scrambled_; _to my
+friend’s little hut_ modifies _scrambled through the evergreens_. What
+does the third phrase modify?
+
+In the punctuation of phrases a good deal must be left to the judgment
+of the writer. That punctuation is best which most clearly reveals the
+structure and meaning of the sentence.
+
+=Summary.=—A =phrase= is a group of related words having neither a
+subject nor a predicate, and used like a part of speech.
+
+A phrase is often used like an adjective to modify a noun, or like an
+adverb to modify a verb.
+
+Phrases in a series are separated from each other by a comma.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the phrases in these sentences, and tell what each
+phrase modifies. Account for the punctuation of the phrases in sentences
+2 and 9. Why are commas omitted in sentence 5?
+
+ 1. I passed a very comfortable night in the carrot bin.
+
+ 2. The four little rabbits lived with their mother, in a sand
+ bank, underneath the root of a very big fir tree.
+
+ 3. He went along over hills and mountains, and on the third day
+ came to a wide forest.
+
+ 4. During those long winter evenings I read six of Scott’s
+ novels aloud to my mother.
+
+ 5. Mr. Jeremy Fisher lived in a little damp house amongst the
+ buttercups at the edge of a pond.
+
+ 6. On that evening, before sunset, some women were washing
+ clothes on the upper step of the flight that led down into the
+ basin of the Pool of Siloam.
+
+ 7. On the fourth day after our arrival came a letter from my
+ mamma.
+
+ 8. Jelly fishes generally float near the surface of the sea,
+ and are often washed up on the shore by the waves.
+
+ 9. Where no human hand would have dared to rest, the young
+ lions crawled fearlessly—across the knotty muscles of the back,
+ over the sinewy neck, across the death-dealing paws, even
+ between the frightful jaws.
+
+ 10. Tom arched his back like a contortionist at a circus.
+
+ 11. The women of the different provinces in Holland are known
+ by their head dresses.
+
+ 12. The last words rang out like silver trumpets.
+
+ 13. A farm without a boy would very soon come to grief.
+
+ 14. In winter I get up at night.
+
+=38.= =Analyzing= a sentence is the process of separating it into its
+parts, and telling the relation between those parts. In analyzing the
+sentences in the following exercise proceed according to this outline:—
+
+(1) Tell whether the sentence is declarative or interrogative.
+
+(2) Divide it into subject and predicate.
+
+(3) Select the simple subject and give its modifiers.
+
+(4) Select the simple predicate and give its modifiers.
+
+(5) If a predicate is compound, select the two or more predicate verbs,
+and then give the modifiers of each.
+
+Tell the exact truth in good, clear English. For example, in analyzing
+the expression, _the four little rabbits_, do not say that _the_, _four_,
+and _little_ are adjectives modifying _rabbits_, but say that _rabbits_
+is modified by the adjectives _little_, _four_, and _the_. Why should
+they be given in this order?
+
+=Exercise.=—Analyze sentences 2, 3, 5, 7, 8, 11, 12, 13, and 14 in the
+exercise on p. 33.
+
+
+
+
+XII. PREPOSITIONS
+
+
+=39.= In the preceding lesson we considered a phrase as a unit. We shall
+now examine its structure, and see what parts it is composed of. If we
+look carefully at these phrases,—
+
+ with their mother
+
+ to a wide forest
+
+ over the sinewy neck
+
+ like silver trumpets
+
+we see that the first word is not a noun, a pronoun, a verb, an
+adjective, or an adverb. If we try to put this word anywhere else in the
+phrase, we see that it must come at the beginning; in short, that it is
+the introductory word of the phrase. If we had only this introductory
+word given, the word _with_, for instance, we should ask at once _with
+what?_ or _with whom?_ The answer to this second question is _their
+mother_, the rest of the phrase.
+
+If we examine the other three phrases in the same way, we shall come
+to the conclusion that a phrase is made up of two parts: (1) an
+introductory word, (2) an answer to the question made by putting _whom_
+or _what_ after the introductory word. We call the introductory word a
+=preposition=, and we say that the rest of the phrase is the =object of
+the preposition=. A preposition is a part of speech.
+
+A phrase that consists of a preposition and its object is called a
+=prepositional phrase=. Not all phrases are of this kind. We shall study
+the other kinds later.
+
+=40.= There are not a great many prepositions in the English language,
+hardly more than a hundred in all. Most of them are short words, and of
+very great usefulness. Some of the commonest are: _across_, _after_,
+_before_, _between_, _by_, _for_, _from_, _in_, _over_, _to_, _through_,
+_toward_, _under_, _with_, _without_.
+
+=41.= The object of a preposition may be a single word, as in the phrase
+_without fences_, but oftener it is a group of words. The base word
+of the group is usually a noun. A pronoun also may be the object of a
+preposition, as in the phrases _for me_, _to him_, _with us_. The object
+of a preposition may be compound, as in the phrases, _over land and sea_,
+_by day and night_.
+
+=42.= In Lesson XI, it was pointed out that a phrase modifies a noun
+or a verb. It does so because the preposition shows a certain relation
+between its object and the noun or verb that the phrase modifies. In
+the sentence, “The porters at the German railroad stations are dressed
+in fine green uniforms,” the preposition _at_ shows a relation of place
+between the porters and the German railroad stations, and the preposition
+_in_ shows a relation of manner between the act of dressing and the fine
+green uniforms.
+
+=Summary.=—A =prepositional phrase= consists of a preposition and its
+object.
+
+A =preposition= is a word that is used with its object to form a phrase,
+and shows the relation of its object to the word the phrase modifies.
+
+ NOTE.—A prepositional phrase in its natural order consists of
+ (1) the preposition and (2) its object.
+
+The =object= of a preposition is found by asking the question made by
+putting _whom_ or _what_ after the preposition.
+
+The object of a preposition may be simple or compound.
+
+The base word of the object may be a noun or a pronoun.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select the prepositional phrases in the following sentences.
+Tell what each phrase modifies. Divide each phrase into preposition and
+object. Find the base word of the object, and tell what part of speech it
+is.
+
+ 1. This monster lives in a den under yonder mountain with a
+ brother of his.
+
+ 2. I carried both letters in my apron pocket.
+
+ 3. At the age of ten years he fled from the multiplication
+ table and ran away to sea.
+
+ 4. In the dusk of spring evenings we sat on the window seat
+ and watched the lights come out on the high bluff and the long
+ bridge.
+
+ 5.
+
+ The stormy March is come at last,
+ With wind, and cloud, and changing skies.
+
+ 6. With a fair and strong breeze we soon ran into the little
+ cove to the northward of Fort Moultrie.
+
+ 7. On the projecting bluffs, and occasionally on the very
+ mountain tops, stand the ruins of great castles of the olden
+ times.
+
+ 8. In the ancient city of London on a certain autumn day in the
+ second quarter of the sixteenth century, a boy was born to a
+ poor family of the name of Canty.
+
+ 9. Now I was comforted by the thought of a tassel, and an ivory
+ handle, and blue and gold changeable silk.
+
+ 10. A polar storm can blow for ten days without a break.
+
+ 11. The aërial path of Hushwing, from his nest in the swamp to
+ his watchtower on the clearing’s edge, led him past the pool
+ and the crouching panther.
+
+ 12.
+
+ All the little boys and girls,
+ With rosy cheeks and flaxen curls,
+ And sparkling eyes and teeth like pearls,
+ Tripping and skipping, ran merrily after
+ The wonderful music, with shouting and laughter.
+
+What part of speech are these words: _yonder_, sentence 1, _apron_ 2,
+_multiplication_ 3, _spring_ 4, _very_ 7, _autumn_ 8, _break_ 10?
+
+What is peculiar about the object of _at_ in sentence 5, and of _to_ in
+sentence 6?
+
+=43.= Good English requires accuracy in the use of prepositions. Study
+the following prepositions, and avoid errors in their use.
+
+=Among= and =between=. The word _between_ usually refers to only two
+persons or things, while _among_ refers to more than two.
+
+ I walked between my father and my mother.
+
+ She walked among us like an angel.
+
+=At= and =in=. We use _in_ when speaking of countries and large cities,
+_at_ when speaking of villages or buildings.
+
+ The train arrives in Los Angeles at noon.
+
+ The train stopped at every little station.
+
+=At= and =to=. _At_ conveys the idea of _being_ in a place, and _to_
+conveys the idea of _going_ to a place.
+
+ Were you at school yesterday?
+
+ I came to school early this morning.
+
+ My sister is at home.
+
+We speak of going to school, to church, to the factory, to the store,
+to the office, etc., but we do not use _to_ before _home_. We say “I am
+_at_ home,” or “Come home,” in the latter case omitting the preposition
+entirely.
+
+=Beside= and =besides=. _Beside_ means by the side of, and _besides_
+means in addition to.
+
+ Little Em’ly sat beside David.
+
+ Nobody remained besides the old nurse.
+
+=By= and =with=. _By_ refers to the agent, or doer of an action, and
+_with_ to the instrument, or means employed.
+
+ The cherry tree was cut down by George Washington with a little
+ hatchet.
+
+=In= and =into=. _In_ usually conveys the idea of rest, and _into_ of
+motion.
+
+ We stayed in the library all the evening.
+
+ Our hostess took us into the Simmons Library.
+
+ I went into the Bank.
+
+ I put my money in the Bank.
+
+=Off.= This preposition should not be followed by _of_. We should say,
+
+ The pitcher fell off the table.
+
+ I got off the car.
+
+In place of the word _onto_ we should use _on_ or _upon_.
+
+ He climbed upon the roof of the pilot house.
+
+ He stepped on a loose board.
+
+Some words are followed by certain prepositions to express certain
+meanings; as,
+
+ _Agree with_ thine adversary.
+
+ Brutus _agreed to_ the plan.
+
+ Brutus _differed with_ Cassius.
+
+ My watch is _different from_ yours.
+
+ Imogen _parted from_ him with tears.
+
+ Imogen would not _part with_ her bracelet.
+
+ Many people _died of_ yellow fever.
+
+ I am _sorry for_ the mistake.
+
+=Exercise.=—Supply the correct preposition in each of these sentences,
+and give your reason in each case:—
+
+ 1. The fugitive slave ran —— the trees, and took his stand ——
+ two large cypresses.
+
+ 2. While we were —— New Orleans, we stayed —— the St. Charles
+ Hotel.
+
+ 3.
+
+ And so —— the silent sea
+ I wait the muffled oar.
+
+ 4. In that Sunday school class there was no girl —— Gertrude.
+
+ 5. This mark must have been made —— a knife.
+
+ 6. When you are —— Rome, you must do as the Romans do.
+
+ 7. Come —— the garden, Maud.
+
+ 8. Put the silver —— a safe place.
+
+ 9. John Gilpin’s wig fell —— his head.
+
+ 10. Get —— this stump so that you can see better.
+
+ 11. I left the programs —— home.
+
+ 12. Nobody agrees —— Kate about renting the cottage.
+
+ 13. Did Will agree —— your plans for the wedding?
+
+ 14. Charlie differed —— his family about saving his money.
+
+ 15. An apricot has a different flavor —— a peach.
+
+ 16. What did the crew die ——?
+
+ 17. Aren’t you sorry —— his misfortune?
+
+ 18. The child cried when he parted —— his playthings, and would
+ not be comforted when he parted —— his old playmates.
+
+
+
+
+XIII. TERM OF ADDRESS. EXCLAMATORY NOUN
+
+
+=44.= When we speak directly to persons, we often call them by name; as,—
+
+ Anne, sister Anne, do you see any one coming?
+
+We do this for several reasons,—sometimes for politeness, sometimes to
+show clearly just whom we are speaking to. This name is not necessary to
+the structure of the sentence; that is, it forms no part of the subject
+or the predicate. We say, therefore, that it is =independent=. We call it
+a =term of address=.
+
+=45.= Sometimes, instead of using a person’s name, we invent a term of
+address, as when the Arab said to his horse,
+
+ “We are far from home, O _racer with the swiftest winds_, but
+ God is with us.”
+
+What noun is the base word of this term of address?
+
+=46.= A term of address may come at the beginning of a sentence, or at
+the end, or somewhere within the sentence. It must be set off by commas
+to show that it is independent.
+
+=47.= Sometimes a noun or a noun with modifiers is used as an
+=exclamation=; thus,—
+
+ A rainbow! it is too late in the day for that.
+
+ Joy to the world! the Lord has come.
+
+A noun used like _rainbow_ and _joy_ is called an =exclamatory noun=.
+What feeling does the exclamatory noun in the first sentence express? in
+the second?
+
+=Summary.=—A =term of address= is a word or a group of words used as a
+name to show to whom a remark is made.
+
+The base word of a term of address is usually a noun.
+
+An =exclamatory noun= is a noun used to express strong or sudden feeling.
+It may be modified or unmodified.
+
+When a word or a group of words is no part of the subject or the
+predicate of a sentence, it is said to be =independent=.
+
+A term of address and an exclamatory noun are independent elements in a
+sentence.
+
+A term of address is set off from the rest of the sentence by a comma.
+
+An exclamatory noun is set off by an exclamation point.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select the terms of address in the following sentences. Find
+the base word of each. Select also the exclamatory nouns, and tell what
+feeling they express.
+
+ 1. Little brother, canst thou raise me to my feet?
+
+ 2. “Now, my dears,” said old Mrs. Rabbit one morning, “you may
+ go into the fields or down the lane, but don’t go into Mr.
+ McGregor’s garden.”
+
+ 3. Indeed I was seeking thee, Flathead, but each time we meet
+ thou art longer and broader by the length of my arm.
+
+ 4. Come, Lillie, it is time to go to bed.
+
+ 5. Sweet, sweet home! there’s no place like home.
+
+ 6. Why, Father, you are rather old to play cat’s cradle.
+
+ 7.
+
+ Sail on, sail on, O ship of State!
+ Sail on, O Union strong and great!
+
+ 8. Sir, I humbly beg your pardon.
+
+ 9. I understand, noble lord, that you have lost two of your men.
+
+ 10. Jefferson, I think I will go down into the kitchen and bake
+ a pie.
+
+ 11. A horse! a horse! my kingdom for a horse!
+
+ 12. There is none like thee in the jungle, wise, old, strong,
+ and most beautiful Kaa.
+
+ 13. Our price, your royal highness, is three shillings.
+
+ 14. Grand old outlaw, hero of a thousand lawless raids, in a
+ few minutes you will be but a great load of carrion.
+
+ 15.
+
+ Brood, kind creature, you need not fear
+ Thieves and robbers while I am here.
+
+ 16. Catch me, cowardly knaves, if you can.
+
+ 17. The stately homes of England! how beautiful they stand!
+
+ 18. O Captain! my Captain! rise up and hear the bells.
+
+
+
+
+XIV. IMPERATIVE SENTENCES
+
+
+=48.= Besides declarative and interrogative sentences there is another
+kind of sentence used when we speak directly to a person for the purpose
+of telling him what to do; as, “Run into the garden, and fetch me the
+largest pumpkin you can find.” This is called an =imperative sentence=.
+
+=49.= The imperative sentence is often used in giving orders, commands,
+or directions, but it is used also in giving advice, and in making
+requests or entreaties; as,—
+
+ Fling away ambition.
+
+ Kindly reply by return mail.
+
+ Give us this day our daily bread.
+
+=50.= Usually only the predicate of an imperative sentence is expressed,
+and so the first word of such a sentence is likely to be a verb. The
+subject is the pronoun _you_, _thou_, or _ye_, signifying the person
+or persons addressed. It is customary to omit this pronoun, and we say
+that the subject is “understood.” Occasionally, however, it is expressed
+in familiar conversation; as, “You go away.” Sometimes, too, in solemn
+commands the pronoun _thou_ or _ye_ is expressed; as, “Go and do thou
+likewise.” “Keep ye the law.”
+
+Note that the verb in an imperative sentence commands rather than asserts.
+
+An imperative sentence is frequently preceded by a term of address, but
+this must not be mistaken for the subject; as, “Father, hear our prayer.”
+
+=Summary.=—An =imperative sentence= is one that expresses a command or an
+entreaty.
+
+The subject of an imperative sentence is the pronoun _you_, _thou_, or
+_ye_. This pronoun is usually omitted.
+
+=Exercise.=—Tell what the following imperative sentences denote. Select
+the predicate verbs, and the subjects whenever they are expressed. Select
+also the terms of address.
+
+ 1. Open everything, go everywhere except to this little room.
+
+ 2. Come and hold this skein of yarn for me.
+
+ 3. Go and wash Kala Nag, and attend to his ears, and see that
+ there are no thorns in his feet.
+
+ 4. Don’t count your chickens before they are hatched.
+
+ 5. Rouse to some high and holy work of love.
+
+ 6. Don’t you show your face here with a pocket on you. If your
+ heavy pants have any in ’em, rip ’em out.
+
+ 7.
+
+ Give freely and receive, but take from none
+ By greed, or force, or fraud, what is his own.
+
+ 8. Learn to box, to ride, to pull an oar, and to swim.
+
+ 9. Polly dear, say good morning to Mrs. Chatterton, and then
+ run away.
+
+ 10. Do the work first which is next at hand.
+
+ 11.
+
+ Turn again, Whittington,
+ Lord Mayor of London.
+
+ 12. O Lord of Hosts, provide a champion for thy people.
+
+ 13.
+
+ O brave marsh Mary-buds, rich and yellow,
+ Give me your money to hold.
+
+ 14.
+
+ O Columbine, open your folded wrapper
+ Where two twin turtledoves dwell.
+
+ 15.
+
+ O Cuckoopint, toll me the purple clapper
+ That hangs in your clear, green bell.
+
+Account for the commas in sentences 1, 3, 8, 9, and 11.
+
+
+
+
+XV. INTERJECTIONS
+
+
+=51.= There are certain words like _oh_, _alas_, _pshaw_, _ugh_, that
+are used to express strong feeling,—joy, surprise, pain, disgust, anger,
+etc. These words are called =interjections=. An interjection is a part of
+speech.
+
+=52.= Interjections are no part of the subject or the predicate of a
+sentence; hence, like terms of address, they are said to be independent.
+They are set off from the rest of the sentence by some mark of
+punctuation, usually an exclamation point, sometimes only a comma.
+
+=53.= We may use a noun or a verb in such a way that it becomes an
+interjection; as, “_Goodness!_ what a fright you gave me!” “_Hurrah!_
+the lake is frozen over!” Such a verb as _hark_ is often used as an
+interjection, not to express sudden feeling so much as to arrest
+attention; as, “_Hark! hark!_ the dogs do bark.”
+
+=54.= The interjection _O_ is often used before a term of address; as, “O
+Lord, how manifold are thy works!”
+
+=Summary.=—An =interjection= is a word used to express sudden or strong
+feeling.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the interjections in the following sentences, and
+tell what each one is used for:—
+
+ 1. Boom! Boom!—two of the guns had gone off together.
+
+ 2. Alas! Amanda, by mistake, had waked up the little boys an
+ hour too early.
+
+ 3. Bah! men are blood brothers of the monkey people.
+
+ 4. Hallelujah! in one day more we shall be sitting in the
+ sunshine on our own doorstep.
+
+ 5.
+
+ O mother dear, Jerusalem,
+ When shall I come to thee?
+
+ 6. Ping! ping! ping! went the rifles; and Boom! boom! boom!
+ answered the waves.
+
+ 7. Aha! the world is iron in these days.
+
+ 8. Alas! it was the head of old Silverspot.
+
+ 9. Scrooge said, “Pooh! Pooh!” and closed the door.
+
+ 10. Hark! hark! the lark at heaven’s gate sings.
+
+ 11. Alack-a-day! travelers encounter all the unusual bits of
+ weather.
+
+ 12. Hey! Willie Winkie, are you coming then?
+
+ 13. O comrades, if we must fight, let us fight for ourselves.
+
+ 14. Hush! the winds roar hoarse and deep.
+
+ 15. Lo, the star which they saw in the east went before them
+ till it came and stood over where the young child was.
+
+ 16. Piff! the packet landed exactly as it was intended, on the
+ corn-husk mat in front of the screen door.
+
+ 17. Oh, London is a man’s town.
+
+
+
+
+XVI. EXCLAMATORY SENTENCES
+
+
+=55.= We have found that sentences are made to _state_, or to _ask_, or
+to _command_, and hence are classified as _declarative_, _interrogative_,
+and _imperative_.
+
+There is a fourth class of sentence which resembles an interjection,
+being used to express sudden or strong feeling; as, “How calm and lovely
+the river was!” “What a pity it is!” These are called =exclamatory
+sentences=. They are always followed by an exclamation point.
+
+=56.= Such sentences as those just quoted, which begin with _how_ or
+_what_, are exclamatory in form as well as in sense, and are therefore
+sometimes called pure exclamatory sentences. They are always in the
+transposed order. Some sentences, however, are exclamatory only in
+sense. They are in the natural order, and when printed, could not be
+distinguished from declarative or imperative sentences if it were not
+for the exclamation point, which indicates that they were spoken with
+strong feeling; as, “Now you may see that noblest of all ocean sights for
+beauty, a full-rigged ship under sail!” “Helen Maria! leave the room this
+moment!”
+
+=Summary.=—An =exclamatory sentence= is one that expresses sudden or
+strong feeling.
+
+=Exercise.=—Tell why each of these sentences is exclamatory. Rearrange in
+the natural order those which are transposed. Divide each of them into
+subject and predicate. Select the simple subject and the simple predicate.
+
+ 1. How soundly he sleeps! From what a depth he draws that easy
+ breath!
+
+ 2. What tales he had told that day!
+
+ 3. How doubly delicious things tasted in the clear, spicy air
+ of the woods!
+
+ 4. How keen a scent those children had for apples in the cellar!
+
+ 5. Oh, how sweet the water was! How it soothed the tender spots
+ under her weary wings! How it cooled her ears and her tired
+ eyelids!
+
+ 6. With what a glory comes and goes the year!
+
+ 7. What a racket those rusty cannon had made in the heyday of
+ their unchastened youth! What stories they might tell now if
+ their puffy, metallic lips could only speak!
+
+ 8. Burn the hut over their heads!
+
+ 9. Ugh! may the red mange destroy the dogs of this village!
+
+ 10. Talk of the curiosity of women!
+
+ 11. So blessedly evanescent is the memory of seasickness!
+
+ 12. Hark! how the music leaps out from his throat!
+
+
+
+
+XVII. CONJUNCTIONS
+
+
+=57.= Notice the sentences,—
+
+ Every pine and fir and hemlock wore ermine too dear for an earl.
+
+ I stood and watched by the window.
+
+The parts of the compound subject in the first sentence and of the
+compound predicate in the second are joined by the word _and_. This very
+common word has a use different from that of any word studied thus far;
+hence it is considered another part of speech. Because it is a joining
+word, it is called a =conjunction=.
+
+There are many conjunctions besides _and_ that we all have frequent
+occasion to use. Among these are _nor_, _or_, _but_, _yet_, _therefore_,
+_so_, and _hence_.
+
+=58.= Conjunctions may join not only single words, such as nouns, verbs,
+pronouns, adjectives, and adverbs, but also phrases, and even whole
+sentences; as,—
+
+ You may enter without money and without price.
+
+ The stiff rails were softened to swan’s down,
+ And still fluttered down the snow.
+
+=59.= Although the word _but_ is commonly used as a conjunction, yet,
+in the sentence, “I work every day but Sunday,” it is a preposition,
+and means _except_. What is its object? The great difference between a
+conjunction and a preposition is that a preposition always has an object,
+whereas a conjunction never has one.
+
+=Summary.=—A =conjunction= is a word that joins sentences or parts of
+sentences.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the conjunctions in the following sentences, and
+tell what they join:—
+
+ 1. Crow was ten years old now, and he was very black and
+ polished and thin.
+
+ 2. Mount St. Michael was not only strongly fortified, but it
+ was well guarded by nature.
+
+ 3. The horse neither switches his tail, nods his head, nor
+ stamps his feet.
+
+ 4. Thirty years later, the remnants of her wedding gowns,—the
+ blue silk, the black silk, the striped silk, and the plaid
+ silk,—were cut into diamonds and squares, and then pieced
+ together lovingly and proudly into a patchwork quilt.
+
+ 5. There are several steamboats which run up and down the Seine
+ like omnibuses, and the charge to passengers is about two cents
+ apiece.
+
+ 6. After steaming for several hours over the smooth river and
+ between these flat lowlands, we reach the city of Rotterdam.
+
+ 7. These great ice streams are always moving slowly downwards;
+ hence they carry off, year by year, the snow which falls upon
+ the mountain above.
+
+ 8. The stars danced overhead, and by his side the broad and
+ shallow river ran over its stony bed with a loud but soothing
+ murmur that filled all the air with entreaty.
+
+ 9. The things that Mowgli did and saw and heard when he was
+ wandering from one people to another, with or without his four
+ companions, would make many stories.
+
+ 10. I drove the cows home through the sweet ferns and down the
+ rocky slopes.
+
+ 11. The sucker’s mouth is not formed for the gentle angleworm
+ nor the delusive fly of the fisherman.
+
+ 12. Our ancestors were very worthy people, but their wall
+ papers were abominable.
+
+ 13. The keeper of the lodgings did not supply meals to his
+ guests; so we breakfasted at a small chophouse in a crooked
+ street.
+
+ 14. The Northmen had no compass; they must steer by the sun or
+ by the stars, guess at their rate of sailing, and tell by that
+ how many more days distant was their destination.
+
+ 15. Through this silence and through this waste, where the
+ sudden lights flapped and went out again, the sleigh and the
+ two that pulled it crawled like things in a nightmare.
+
+ 16. There may be times when you cannot find help, but there is
+ no time when you cannot give help.
+
+ 17.
+
+ Over the meadows and through the woods,
+ To grandfather’s house we go.
+
+ 18. The world has never had a good definition of the word
+ liberty, and the American people are much in want of one.
+
+
+
+
+XVIII. CLAUSES. SIMPLE SENTENCES
+
+
+=60.= We have learned that a sentence must contain a subject and a
+predicate. We have another name for a combination of subject and
+predicate. We call it a =clause=.
+
+=61.= When a sentence consists of but one clause, we call it a =simple
+sentence=; and we say that this clause is =independent=, because it can
+stand alone and make sense.
+
+=62.= A simple sentence may have a compound subject or a compound
+predicate, or both, and yet so long as these subjects and predicates go
+together, we say that there is only one clause; as in the sentence, “The
+lion and the mouse helped each other and became friends.”
+
+=Summary.=—A =clause= is any combination of subject and predicate.
+
+An =independent clause= is one that can stand alone and make sense.
+
+A =simple sentence= contains but one independent clause.
+
+A simple sentence may have a compound subject or a compound predicate, or
+both.
+
+=Exercise.=—Analyze the following simple sentences:—
+
+MODEL.—_Then a piece of mica, or a little pool, or even a highly polished
+leaf will flash like a heliograph._
+
+This is a simple, declarative sentence.
+
+The subject is _a piece of mica, or a little pool, or even a highly
+polished leaf_. The predicate is _will flash like a heliograph then_.
+
+The subject is compound. The simple subjects are the nouns _piece_,
+_pool_, and _leaf_, which are joined by the conjunction _or_. _Piece_
+is modified by the prepositional phrase _of mica_ and the adjective
+_a_. _Pool_, is modified by the adjectives _little_ and _a_. _Leaf_ is
+modified by the adjective element _highly polished_, and the adjectives
+_a_ and _even_. The base word of the adjective element is the adjective
+_polished_, which is modified by the adverb _highly_.
+
+The simple predicate is _will flash_. It is modified by the prepositional
+phrase _like a heliograph_, and the adverb _then_.
+
+ 1. Through three good months the valley was wrapped in cloud
+ and soaking mist.
+
+ 2. In the very heart of London stands the great Bank of England.
+
+ 3. Would not any boy respond to the sweet invitation of those
+ ripe berries?
+
+ 4. A fool and his money are soon parted.
+
+ 5. A large, warm tear splashed down on the program.
+
+ 6. In the sunny days the sucker lies in the deep pools, by some
+ big stone or near the bank.
+
+ 7. The feeling of a boy towards pumpkin pie has never been
+ properly considered.
+
+ 8. Shall the adventures of the Peterkin family be published?
+
+ 9. No healthy boy could long exist without numerous friends in
+ the animal kingdom.
+
+ 10. No sound of joy or sorrow was heard from either bank.
+
+ 11. At length has come the bridal day of beauty and of strength.
+
+ 12. On one hot summer morning a little cloud rose from the sea
+ and floated lightly and happily across the blue sky.
+
+ 13. Donkeys, horses, negroes of every age, size, and shade,
+ carts, crates, sacks, barrels, and boxes are mingled in
+ seemingly inextricable confusion.
+
+ 14. In the midst of the wild confusion the voice of the Boots
+ was heard.
+
+ 15. Then he strolled across the pasture, between the black
+ stumps, the blueberry patches, the tangles of wild raspberry;
+ pushed softly through the fringe of wild cherry and young
+ birch saplings, and crept silently under the branches of a low
+ hemlock.
+
+ 16. The moss was supported by solid earth or a framework of
+ ancient tree roots.
+
+ 17. Alas! with every blow of the chisel the brick crumbled at
+ my feet.
+
+ 18. A dish of apples and a pitcher of chilly cider were always
+ served during the evening.
+
+ 19. I sat down in the middle of the path and never stirred for
+ a long time.
+
+ 20. The mayor and other civic authorities in London came down
+ to Greenwich in barges.
+
+
+
+
+XIX. COMPOUND SENTENCES
+
+
+=63.= We have seen that sentences may be joined together by conjunctions.
+When two or more independent clauses are joined together in this way, we
+say that the sentence is =compound=; as, “Coral reefs resemble great rock
+ledges, and vessels are often wrecked upon them.”
+
+=64.= The conjunctions most used in compound sentences are _and_, _or_,
+_but_, _yet_, _therefore_, and _so_.
+
+_And_ shows that two clauses are in the same line of thought; as, “His
+eye was bright, and his face was ruddy.”
+
+_Or_ shows a choice between two clauses; as, “You must work, or you must
+go hungry.”
+
+_But_ and _yet_ show a contrast; as, “I mailed the letter, but Uncle Joe
+never received it.”
+
+_Therefore_ and _so_ show that the second clause is a consequence of the
+first; as, “There are fires in the forests north of us, therefore the air
+is full of smoke.”
+
+=65.= Sometimes when the relation between clauses is perfectly evident,
+the conjunction is omitted; as, “I came; I saw; I conquered.”
+
+In order that the reader may have no doubt as to where a clause ends, it
+is usually followed by a comma, which speaks to the eye of the reader
+just as a pause speaks to the ear of the listener. When the clauses are
+long or the conjunction is omitted, a semicolon may be used instead of
+the comma.
+
+=Summary.=—A =compound sentence= contains two or more independent clauses.
+
+The clauses of a compound sentence are separated from each other by a
+comma or a semicolon.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the clauses in the following compound sentences.
+Tell the relation between them, and how they are joined. Tell the subject
+and predicate of each clause. Account for the punctuation.
+
+ 1. Over the porch grew a hop-vine, and a brandy-cherry tree
+ shaded the door, and a luxuriant cranberry vine flung its
+ delicious fruit across the window.
+
+ 2. Mr. Peterkin liked to take a doze on his sofa in the room,
+ but the rest of the family liked to sit on the piazza.
+
+ 3. Prosperity makes friends; adversity tries them.
+
+ 4. The whole family planted the potatoes; George dug the holes
+ with his hoe, Mollie dropped into each one three pieces of an
+ old potato, Paul raked the black earth over them, and Mother
+ supervised and praised them all.
+
+ 5. Some of the letter-carriers must take very long walks, but
+ English people do not appear to object to that sort of thing.
+
+ 6. Oh, come ye in peace here, or come ye in war?
+
+ 7. At the end of the first year the young lions shed their
+ teeth, the first indications of manes appeared on the males,
+ and the playfulness between brother and sister ceased.
+
+ 8. The clumsy wheels of several old-fashioned coaches were
+ heard, and the gentlemen and ladies composing the bridal party
+ came through the church with the sudden and gladsome effect of
+ a burst of sunshine.
+
+ 9. I had never been called pretty before, so I was flattered.
+
+ 10. The yellow cur has not the speed of the greyhound, but
+ neither does he bear the seeds of lung and skin diseases.
+
+ 11. The party did not return to Skarpsno until half-past eight
+ in the evening, yet the sun was still above the horizon.
+
+ 12. We cherish every memorial of our worthy ancestors; we
+ celebrate their patience and fortitude; we admire their daring
+ enterprise; we teach our children to venerate their piety.
+
+ 13. Every animal has some great strength, or it could not live;
+ every animal has some great weakness, or the other animals
+ could not live.
+
+ 14. Human action can be modified to some extent, but human
+ nature cannot be changed.
+
+ 15. Captain John Smith was exasperatingly sure of himself, and
+ older men found his pretensions well-nigh unbearable.
+
+
+
+
+XX. DEPENDENT CLAUSES. COMPLEX SENTENCES
+
+
+=66.= We have seen that in both simple and compound sentences the clauses
+are independent. There is a third class of sentences, however, containing
+=dependent clauses=.
+
+In the simple sentence, “At night his antelope skin was spread on the
+ground,” the prepositional phrase _on the ground_ tells place, and
+modifies the verb _was spread_.
+
+In the sentence, “At night his antelope skin was spread _where the
+darkness overtook him_,” the group of words where the darkness overtook
+him has the same use as the phrase _on the ground_, for it tells place
+and modifies the verb _was spread_.
+
+But this group of words contains a subject and a predicate; hence it is
+a clause. It could not stand alone and make sense; hence it cannot be
+an independent clause. It could not be in the sentence at all unless
+the verb _was spread_ were there too for it to modify. It is therefore
+dependent on the verb, and so we call it a =dependent clause=. It has the
+same use as an adverb, because it modifies a verb. We find many dependent
+clauses used in this way, because our language does not afford enough
+adverbs or even prepositional phrases to express our meaning.
+
+=67.= When dependent clauses modify verbs, they answer such questions as
+these,—_was spread where?_ _was spread why?_ _how?_ _when?_ _under what
+condition?_ _for what purpose?_
+
+=68.= In the sentence, “They went into a small parlor, which smelt very
+spicy,” the parlor is described by the adjective _small_ and by the group
+of words _which smelt very spicy_. What is this group of words? How do we
+know? What words does it modify? What, then, is the use of some dependent
+clauses? When dependent clauses modify nouns, they point out or describe
+objects just as adjectives do.
+
+=69.= In the sentences that we have just been studying there is an
+independent clause as well as a dependent clause. A sentence of this kind
+is called a =complex sentence=.
+
+A complex sentence may contain any number of dependent clauses, but
+only one independent clause, for as soon as a sentence contains two
+independent clauses it becomes a compound sentence.
+
+=Summary.=—A =dependent clause= is one that is used like a part of speech
+and does not make sense when it stands alone.
+
+A dependent clause may be used like an adjective to modify a noun, or
+like an adverb to modify a verb.
+
+A =complex sentence= consists of one independent clause and one or more
+dependent clauses.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the clauses in the following sentences, and
+classify them. Tell what the dependent clauses modify. Tell the subject
+and predicate of each clause.
+
+ NOTE.—Frequently a dependent clause modifies more than the
+ verb. In the sentence, “The little boys wanted a house with a
+ great many doors, so that they could go in and out often,” the
+ dependent clause _so that they could go in and out often_ tells
+ the purpose of their wanting a house with a great many doors;
+ hence, it modifies not merely the verb _wanted_, but the whole
+ predicate _wanted a house with a great many doors_. Try to tell
+ the exact truth about each sentence that you study.
+
+ 1. He was always catching sculpins when every one else with the
+ same bait was catching mackerel.
+
+ 2. If we cross the Atlantic by one of the fast steamships, we
+ shall make the voyage in about a week.
+
+ 3. The Rotterdam quays, which stretch for more than a mile
+ along the river, are busy and lively places.
+
+ 4. Every Sunday morning the wash boiler was filled with water,
+ and the largest tub was set in the middle of the kitchen floor,
+ so that the three children might have their weekly scrubbing.
+
+ 5. People who devote themselves too severely to study of the
+ classics are apt to become dried up.
+
+ 6. He charged upon the rows of the mullein stalks as if they
+ were rebels in regimental ranks, and hewed them down without
+ mercy.
+
+ 7. Every boy who is good for anything is a natural savage.
+
+ 8. Rude soldiers now eat, drink, and sleep, where popes and
+ cardinals once moved about in state.
+
+ 9. Mowgli, who had never known the meaning of real hunger, fell
+ back on stale honey three years old.
+
+ 10. Iron-clads are so called because their sides are covered
+ with thick plates of iron or steel, capable of resisting very
+ heavy shot.
+
+ 11. Although many people ascend Mont Blanc every year, the
+ undertaking requires a great deal of muscular as well as
+ nervous strength.
+
+ 12. If a boy repeats _Thanatopsis_ while he is milking, that
+ operation acquires a certain dignity.
+
+ 13. The thrill that ran into my fingers’ ends then has not run
+ out yet.
+
+ 14. Even a dog, who is very far removed from the wild wolf,
+ his ancestor, can be waked out of deep sleep by a cart wheel
+ touching his flank, and can spring away unharmed before that
+ wheel comes on.
+
+ 15. The boys slipped off down the roadside to a place where
+ they could dig sassafras or the root of the sweet flag.
+
+ 16. The little company of Englishmen who, in 1620, exchanged
+ Holland for America were not soldiers and traders like the men
+ who had led and established the colony at Jamestown.
+
+ 17. Miles Standish came with the Pilgrims to America because he
+ liked both them and their enterprise.
+
+ 18. The early settlers went to church in military array and
+ laid their arms down close by them while they worshiped and
+ heard the sermon.
+
+ 19. The colonists chose for their place of settlement a high
+ bluff, which rose upon the eastern bank of a little stream.
+
+Tell the part of speech and use of _always_, sentence 1, _Sunday_ 4,
+_too_ and _severely_ 5, _now_, _once_, and _about_ 8.
+
+Analyze the predicate _was set in the middle of the kitchen floor_.
+
+What is the grammatical use of the group of words _as well as_ in
+sentence 11?
+
+
+
+
+XXI. REVIEW: CLASSIFICATION OF SENTENCES
+
+
+=70.= We have seen that sentences are classified according to =purpose=,
+as declarative, interrogative, imperative, or exclamatory.
+
+A =declarative= sentence is one that states, or declares, something.
+
+An =interrogative= sentence is one that asks a question.
+
+An =imperative= sentence is one that expresses a command or an entreaty.
+
+An =exclamatory= sentence is one that expresses sudden or strong feeling.
+
+=71.= We have seen also that sentences may consist of one clause or of
+several, and that clauses may be independent or dependent. Sentences are
+therefore classified according to =structure=, as simple, compound, or
+complex.
+
+A =simple= sentence is one that contains but one independent clause.
+
+A =compound= sentence is one that contains two or more independent
+clauses.
+
+A =complex= sentence is one that contains one independent clause and one
+or more dependent clauses.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Write a complex declarative sentence, a compound
+interrogative sentence, a complex imperative sentence, and a simple
+exclamatory sentence.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Classify the following sentences according to both purpose
+and structure. Give the reasons for your classification. Tell what the
+dependent clauses modify. Tell also the subject and predicate of each
+clause.
+
+ 1. The oxen sagged along in their great clumsy way.
+
+ 2. Give me quickly my seven-league boots, that I may go after
+ those boys and catch them.
+
+ 3. How sweet and demure the girls looked!
+
+ 4. Within sight of that tall elm tree were passed my happiest
+ years.
+
+ 5. Did you ever know a child who was not interested in animals?
+
+ 6. My grandfather never skipped over an advertisement, even if
+ he had read it fifty times before.
+
+ 7.
+
+ Woodman, spare that tree!
+ Touch not a single bough!
+
+ 8. Must I keep order along the whole line?
+
+ 9. All the trees and the bushes and the bamboos and the mosses
+ and the juicy-leaved plants wake with a noise of growing that
+ you can almost hear.
+
+ 10.
+
+ How dear to my heart are the scenes of my childhood,
+ When fond recollection presents them to view!
+
+ 11. Sometimes it is impolite to tell the truth, and then one
+ can only say nothing or talk of the weather.
+
+ 12. Toll ye the church bell sad and slow.
+
+ 13. Some boys go scowling always through life, as if they had a
+ stone bruise on each heel.
+
+ 14. Proud bird of the mountain, thy plume shall be torn!
+
+ 15. Mowgli had the good conscience that comes from paying debts.
+
+ 16. Cease to do evil; learn to do well.
+
+ 17. The first was a brass band, the second was a string band,
+ the third was a rubber band, and the fourth was a man who
+ played on the jew’s-harp.
+
+ 18.
+
+ Lo, all our pomp of yesterday
+ Is one with Nineveh and Tyre!
+
+ 19. On Sunday the hens went silently about, and the roosters
+ crowed in psalm tunes.
+
+ 20.
+
+ Up! up! my friend, and quit your books,
+ Or surely you’ll grow double!
+
+ 21. Is the world growing better or are we moving in a circle?
+
+ 22. Remember thy Creator in the days of thy youth.
+
+ 23. When a man has heard the great things calling to him, how
+ they call and call, day and night!
+
+ 24. O ye who have young children, if it is possible, give them
+ happy memories.
+
+Find an interjection in this exercise.
+
+What independent elements do you find in sentences 7, 14, and 24? What is
+the base word of each?
+
+
+
+
+XXII. REVIEW: PARTS OF SPEECH
+
+
+=72.= We have seen that words are classified according to their use into
+eight parts of speech,—nouns, verbs, pronouns, adjectives, adverbs,
+prepositions, conjunctions, and interjections.
+
+A =noun= is a name word.
+
+A =verb= is an asserting word.
+
+A =pronoun= is a word used instead of a noun.
+
+An =adjective= is a word used to point out or describe an object and
+modify a noun or a pronoun.
+
+An =adverb= is a word that modifies a verb, an adjective, or another
+adverb.
+
+A =preposition= is a word that is used with its object to form a phrase,
+and shows the relation of its object to the word the phrase modifies.
+
+A =conjunction= is a word that joins sentences or parts of sentences.
+
+An =interjection= is a word used to express sudden or strong feeling.
+
+=Exercise.=—Tell what part of speech each word is in the following
+sentences. Tell in each case how you know.
+
+ 1. Toto’s good grandmother bore this commotion quietly for some
+ time.
+
+ 2. “Now, set those baskets down.” He spoke sharply.
+
+ 3. Mowgli knew the manners and customs of the villagers very
+ fairly.
+
+ 4. No other mother ever made such deep, smooth, golden custard
+ pies, or fried such light and spicy doughnuts.
+
+ 5. Queen Elizabeth and Mary Queen of Scots are strongly
+ associated together in the minds of all readers of English
+ history.
+
+ 6. The tamest tiger is a tiger still.
+
+ 7. The negro cleared for us a path to an enormously tall tree.
+
+ 8. Nobody scolded me or laughed at me.
+
+ 9. Then my eyes came back to the wall paper, and I studied out
+ figures in its spreading vines.
+
+ 10. Perhaps a little starch would have some effect.
+
+ 11. The roaring hot wind of the Jungle came and went between
+ the rocks and the rattling branches.
+
+ 12. Ring-ting! I wish I were a primrose.
+
+ 13. O love, they die in yon rich sky.
+
+=73.= In sentence 13 in the preceding exercise, it is evident that the
+word _love_, which is often a verb, is used as a term of address, and
+therefore is a noun. Many words may be used as verbs or as nouns.
+
+=Exercise.=—Tell what part of speech the italicized words are in the
+following sentences. Give your reason in each case.
+
+ 1. Don’t scour your porcelain _sink_ with sapolio.
+
+ 2. When bodies _sink_ in Lake Superior, they never rise.
+
+ 3. Oh, what _fall_ was there, my countrymen.
+
+ 4. We _fall_ to rise, are baffled to fight better.
+
+ 5. Alice gave the branch a vigorous _shake_.
+
+ 6. Nay, do not _shake_ your gory locks at me.
+
+ 7. Will you _show_ me your lineage book?
+
+ 8. There are ten thousand moving picture _shows_ in the United
+ States.
+
+ 9. What a good _catch_ our right fielder made.
+
+ 10. Did you _catch_ this sturgeon last night?
+
+Make sentences in which the following words shall be used as nouns and as
+verbs: _fight_, _pay_, _rap_, _shed_, _shoe_, _sting_, _tread_.
+
+=74.= Many words that are usually adjectives may also be used as nouns.
+Such words fall into different classes:—
+
+(1) Adjectives denoting color; as, _black_, _white_, _red_. We may say,
+“The blacks were once slaves of the whites.” We may also say, “Red and
+green are complementary colors.”
+
+(2) Certain adjectives denoting qualities of persons, which may also
+be used to name classes of persons having those qualities; as, _rich_,
+_poor_, _old_, _young_, _bad_, _good_. We say, “The rich should not scorn
+the poor,” “The good die young.”
+
+(3) Certain adjectives denoting qualities, which may also be used to name
+classes of things having those qualities; as, _good_, _evil_, _true_,
+_false_. We say, “Love the good, cherish the true, admire the beautiful.”
+
+(4) Certain other adjectives, such as _native_, _secret_, _fat_, _lean_,
+_thick_. We say, “The natives had no secrets,” “Jack Sprat would eat no
+fat,” “He was always in the thick of the fight.”
+
+=Exercise.=—Make sentences containing the following words used as
+adjectives and as nouns: _purple_, _blue_, _brave_, _righteous_, _evil_,
+_wet_, _cold_, _sweet_, _right_, _wrong_, _solid_, _strong_.
+
+=75.= Some words may be used both as adjectives and as adverbs. When
+_well_ means the opposite of _sick_, as in the sentence, “Grace never was
+a well child,” it is an adjective. When _well_ means in a good manner, as
+in the sentence, “Esther sings well,” it is an adverb.
+
+=Exercise.=—Tell what part of speech the italicized words are in the
+following sentences. Give your reason in each case.
+
+ 1. The paper is large _enough_, but I have not _enough_ string.
+
+ 2. As she came _near_ I recognized one of my _near_ neighbors.
+
+ 3. _All_ flesh is grass.
+
+ 4. The girls playing basket ball are _all_ tired out.
+
+ 5. The doctor liked a _fast_ horse.
+
+ 6. We must walk _fast_ this cold morning.
+
+ 7. Nobody could play golf _worse_ than I.
+
+ 8. May I never do a _worse_ deed!
+
+ 9. Have you _any_ ribbon to match this sample?
+
+ 10. Will this color do _any_ better?
+
+ 11. Somebody _else_ will marry her then.
+
+ 12. How _else_ could I get there in time?
+
+Make sentences containing the following words used as adjectives and
+as adverbs: _high_, _last_, _long_, _low_, _much_, _round_, _slow_,
+_straight_.
+
+=76.= Some words may be used both as adverbs and as prepositions. In the
+sentence, “I looked in as I went by,” both _in_ and _by_ are adverbs. How
+do we know this? In the sentence, “As I went by the house, I looked in
+the window,” both _in_ and _by_ are prepositions. What are their objects?
+What do the phrases modify?
+
+=Exercise.=—What part of speech are the italicized words in the following
+sentences? Give your reason in each case.
+
+ 1. _Beyond_ lay the city of their dreams.
+
+ 2. Our house stands _beyond_ the church.
+
+ 3. _Over_ the Alps lies Italy.
+
+ 4. Come _over_ this evening if you can.
+
+ 5. She fainted and did not come _to_ for an hour.
+
+ 6. The granary is _behind_ the barn.
+
+ 7. Ichabod looked _behind_ for an instant.
+
+ 8. A storm of sleet was raging _without_.
+
+ 9. Civilized man cannot do _without_ cooks.
+
+Make sentences in which the following words are used both as adverbs
+and as prepositions: _about_, _above_, _along_, _down_, _off_, _on_,
+_through_, _under_, _up_, _within_.
+
+
+
+
+XXIII. TRANSITIVE VERBS. OBJECT OF VERB
+
+
+=77.= We have seen that a noun may be related to a verb as its subject.
+When the verb asserts action, as in the sentence, “Many birds eat flies,”
+then the subject _many birds_ names the doer, or performer, of the action.
+
+There is another very common relation that a noun may bear to a verb. In
+the sentence above, the verb _eat_ asserts an action that is not only
+performed _by_ something, but is also performed _upon_ something. That
+is, there is a doer of the action, many birds, and a receiver of the
+action, flies. If we had merely the subject and the verb, our sentence
+would be incomplete, and we should ask at once, _eat what?_
+
+Since the word _flies_ completes the meaning of the verb _eat_, we call
+it the =complement= of the verb. Since it names the receiver of the
+action that is asserted by the verb _eat_, we call it the =object= or
+=direct object= of the verb.
+
+=78.= Not all verbs require an object—only those which assert action
+which the subject performs _upon_ some person or thing. Such verbs are
+called =transitive= verbs.
+
+=79.= The object of a verb is not always a single word. The object may
+be compound, as in the sentence, “Many birds eat flies and gnats and
+mosquitoes.” Again, the object may be a group of words, of which a noun
+is the base word. In the following sentence there are three transitive
+verbs. What is the object of each verb? What is the base word of each
+object?—“Miss Dorothea dusted the banisters round the porch, straightened
+the rows of shoes in mother’s closet, and folded the daily papers in the
+rack.”
+
+=80.= Just as we can find the subject of a verb by asking the question
+made by placing _who_ or _what_ before the verb, so we can find the
+object of a verb that asserts action by asking the question made by
+placing _whom_ or _what_ after the verb.
+
+These questions are often a great help, especially if a sentence is long
+or transposed. In the sentence, “A more miserable little beast I had
+never seen,” what is the verb? Ask a question to find the subject. Ask a
+question to find the object.
+
+=Summary.=—A =transitive verb= is one that asserts action performed upon
+some person or thing.
+
+A =complement= is a word or a group of words used to complete the meaning
+of a verb.
+
+The =direct object= of a verb is a word or a group of words that
+completes the meaning of a transitive verb and names the receiver of the
+action.
+
+ NOTE.—Not all transitive verbs denote action that is
+ accompanied by motion. Some denote action of the senses; as,
+ “I _see_ the star,” “I _taste_ the pepper.” Others denote
+ action of the feelings; as, “I _love_ the truth,” “I _hate_ a
+ lie.” Still others do not denote action at all; as, “I _mean_
+ you,” “Our forefathers _owned_ slaves,” “I _kept_ her letter.”
+ We must enlarge our notion of transitive verbs so as to make
+ it include all verbs that take a complement which denotes a
+ different person or thing from the subject.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Select all the transitive verbs in these sentences. Find
+both their subjects and their objects by asking the proper questions.
+
+ NOTE.—A transitive verb may be modified before it is completed.
+ This is true of _lifts_ in sentence 2. Oftener the idea
+ expressed by the verb and its object together is modified;
+ as in sentence 1, where the phrase _in despair_ modifies not
+ _shook_ but _shook her head_.
+
+ 1. Dotty Dimple shook her head in despair.
+
+ 2. At the word of command, the two horsemen stop, each man
+ lifts up his right leg, throws it over the back of his horse,
+ and drops it to the ground so that the two boots tap the
+ pavement at the same instant.
+
+ 3. Her father found a pleasant seat on the shady side, hung the
+ basket in a rack, and opened a window.
+
+ 4. When the young surveyor left Detroit, he carried a huge
+ green bandbox, and his wife in her far frontier home received
+ in due time a beautiful blue bonnet.
+
+ 5. I threw off an overcoat, took an armchair by the crackling
+ logs, and awaited patiently the arrival of my hosts.
+
+ 6. All the world likes molasses candy.
+
+ 7. The children brought home great bunches of the brilliant
+ leaves, and some they pressed and varnished, while others
+ Katherine dipped in melted wax.
+
+ 8. John trod down the exquisite ferns and the wonderful mosses
+ without compunction. But he gathered from the crevices of the
+ rocks the columbine and the eglantine and the blue harebell;
+ he picked the high-flavored alpine strawberry, the blueberry,
+ the boxberry, wild currants and gooseberries and fox grapes; he
+ brought home armfuls of the pink and white laurel and the wild
+ honeysuckle; he dug the roots of the fragrant sassafras and of
+ the sweet flag; he ate the tender leaves of the wintergreen and
+ its red berries; he gathered the peppermint and the spearmint;
+ he gnawed the twigs of the black birch; he dug the amber gum
+ from the spruce-tree; he brought home such medicinal herbs for
+ the garret as the goldthread, the tansy, and the loathsome
+ “boneset,” and he laid in for the winter, like a squirrel,
+ stores of beechnuts, hazelnuts, hickorynuts, chestnuts, and
+ butternuts.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Analyze the following sentences:—
+
+ NOTE.—If any part of a sentence is compound, state that fact
+ before analyzing it. If the subject or object is compound, give
+ the base words first, and then the modifiers of each. If the
+ predicate is compound, analyze the first predicate completely,
+ then the second, and so on. If any adverb or prepositional
+ phrase modifies the idea denoted by the verb and the object, be
+ sure to say so in your analysis. For instance, in the sentence,
+ “We have seen his star in the east,” the predicate verb is
+ _have seen_. It is completed by the direct object _his star_,
+ and then modified by the prepositional phrase _in the east_.
+
+ 1. Sometimes a perfume like absinthe sweetened all the air.
+
+ 2. The little brown field mouse ran along in the grass, poked
+ his nose into everything, and finally spied a smooth, shiny
+ acorn.
+
+ 3. My son, descend those steps and enter that door.
+
+ 4. Many and many a pair of mittens had those busy fingers knit.
+
+ 5. Always within a few moments the rabbits would resume their
+ leaping progress through the white glitter and the hard, black
+ shadows.
+
+ 6. The visit of the tax collector seldom gives unmixed joy.
+
+ 7. Scrooge took his melancholy dinner in his usual melancholy
+ tavern.
+
+ 8. The first glimpse of a new country always quickens the sense
+ of the traveler.
+
+ 9. Rebecca took off her hat and cape and hung them in the hall,
+ put her rubber shoes and umbrella carefully in the corner, and
+ then opened the door of paradise.
+
+ 10. The scent of herbs and the fragrance of fruit filled the
+ great unfinished chamber.
+
+ 11. A polished brazen rod on a broad wooden pedestal beside the
+ armchair held half a dozen lamps of silver on sliding arms.
+
+ 12. Messala hugged the stony wall with perilous clasp.
+
+ 13. Amrah rubbed her eyes, bent closer down, clasped her hands,
+ gazed wildly around, looked at the sleeper, then stooped and
+ raised his hand, and kissed it fondly.
+
+ 14. The proprietor of the fruit stand has a bald head, a long
+ face, and a nose like the beak of a hawk.
+
+ 15. Without more ado Mr. Cary grasped his arm firmly, and
+ fairly lifted him into the room.
+
+
+
+
+XXIV. INTRANSITIVE VERBS ASSERTING ACTION
+
+
+=81.= Transitive verbs, as we have seen, assert action performed upon
+some person or thing. There are many other verbs in our language that
+assert action, but the action is not performed _upon_ anything. On the
+contrary, the action ends in itself; as in the sentence, “The wind in the
+chimney sighed and moaned and shivered.” Here the wind is said to perform
+three actions, but these actions were not received by anything. Verbs
+like _sighed_, _moaned_, and _shivered_ are said to be =intransitive
+verbs=.
+
+=82.= Not all intransitive verbs assert action. The verb _be_ and a
+few others (see Lesson XXV) which assert merely _being_, are also
+intransitive verbs; as, “I _am_ hungry,” “You _are_ kind,” “He _is_
+extravagant,” “They _were_ careless.”
+
+=83.= It frequently happens that the same verb may be used in one
+sentence as a transitive verb, and in another as an intransitive verb. If
+we say, “The horse kicked his master,” the verb _kicked_ is transitive.
+Why? If we say, “The poor boy kicked and squirmed and groaned,” the verb
+_kicked_ is intransitive. Why?
+
+We should always classify a verb as it is used in the particular sentence
+under consideration.
+
+=Summary.=—An =intransitive verb= is one that asserts (1) being, or (2)
+action that is not received by any person or thing.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Select all the verbs in the following sentences, and
+classify them as transitive or intransitive. Tell the subject of each
+verb. If the verb is transitive, tell its object.
+
+ 1. The princess sat at table next to the king and queen.
+
+ 2. At these words a grave smile of approval lighted the gaunt
+ face of the Hindu.
+
+ 3. The spring murmured drowsily beside him. The branches waved
+ dreamily across the blue sky overhead. A deep sleep fell upon
+ David Swan.
+
+ 4.
+
+ While shepherds watched their flocks by night,
+ All seated on the ground,
+ An angel of the Lord came down,
+ And glory shone around.
+
+ 5. Mr. Jeremy stuck his pole into the mud, and fastened the
+ boat to it.
+
+ 6. The cat got up and stretched herself, and came and sniffed
+ at the basket.
+
+ 7. I would have spared the woman who gave thee the milk.
+
+ 8. His hair had fallen about his shoulders.
+
+ 9. They sang patriotic songs, they told stories, they fired
+ torpedoes, they frightened the cats.
+
+ 10. I could have killed a buck while thou wast striking.
+
+ 11. Away rolled the bogghun, away and away, over the meadows
+ and into the forest; away and away bounded the Princess in
+ pursuit. The golden nose ring flashed and glittered in the
+ sunlight, the golden bangles on her wrists and ankles tinkled
+ and rang their tiny bells as she went. The monkeys swinging
+ by their tails from the branches, chattered with astonishment
+ at us; the wild parrot screamed at us; all the birds sang and
+ chirped and twittered.
+
+ 12. The chipmunk appeared at the mouth of his den, looked
+ quickly about, took a few leaps to a tussock of grass, paused a
+ breath with one foot raised, slipped quickly a few yards over
+ some dry leaves, paused again by a stump beside a path, rushed
+ across the path to the pile of loose stones, went under the
+ first and over the second, gained the pile of posts, made his
+ way through that, surveyed his course a half moment from the
+ other side of it, and then darted on to some other cover, and
+ presently beyond my range, where he must have gathered acorns,
+ for no other nut-bearing trees than oaks grew near.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Tell whether the italicized verbs in the following
+sentences are transitive or intransitive. Give your reason in each case.
+If a verb is transitive, tell how it is completed. If it is intransitive,
+tell how it is modified.
+
+ 1. All the brooks _have burst_ their icy chains.
+
+ 2. The boiler _burst_ with a tremendous noise.
+
+ 3. _Do_ your duty; that is best.
+
+ 4. Such language _will_ never _do_ for a teacher.
+
+ 5. Miss Clarissa _draws_ and paints very well.
+
+ 6. Giotto _drew_ a perfect circle with one sweep of his arm.
+
+ 7. The swallow _flies_ with a graceful dipping motion.
+
+ 8. The boys _are flying_ their kites on the common.
+
+ 9. _Give_ us this day our daily bread.
+
+ 10. The rope was stretched so tightly that it _did_ not _give_
+ with his weight.
+
+ 11. All day he sits in his arm chair and _reads_.
+
+ 12. _Have_ you _read_ “The Man without a Country”?
+
+ 13. The woodworkers _have struck_ for shorter hours.
+
+ 14. David _struck_ Uriah Heep on the cheek.
+
+ 15. Aunt Betsy _swept_ down upon the trespassers.
+
+ 16. I _must sweep_ the spiders off the porch.
+
+
+
+
+XXV. INTRANSITIVE VERBS ASSERTING BEING. NOUNS AS SUBJECTIVE COMPLEMENTS
+
+
+=84.= There is no other verb used oftener than the verb _be_, with its
+various forms,—_is_, _are_, _am_, _was_, _will be_, _has been_, etc. In
+the sentence, “The lake is the mother of the great rivers,” there would
+be no assertion without the verb _is_, and yet it does not assert action
+of any sort. The sentence plainly means that the lake and the mother
+of the great rivers are identical; that is, they are one and the same
+thing. The verb _is_ enables us to assert identity. A verb of this kind
+is intransitive. It is often called a verb of =being=, to distinguish it
+from verbs that assert action.
+
+=85.= Some other verbs of this kind are _seem_, _appear_, _become_,
+_grow_, _feel_, _look_, _smell_, _taste_, and _sound_. They are classed
+as verbs of being because they mean—to be in appearance, in looks, in
+smell, in taste, etc., as, “You appear ill,” “She looks young,” “The milk
+tastes sour.”
+
+Verbs that assert being are intransitive verbs.
+
+=86.= Intransitive verbs of being usually need a complement. In the
+sentence, “I am a spinner of long yarns,” if we had merely the subject
+and the verb, _I am_, we should ask, _am what?_ The group of words _a
+spinner of long yarns_ answers this question, and so completes the
+predicate. It is not an object complement, however, for it cannot name
+the receiver of an action since the verb does not assert action at all.
+This complement denotes identity with the subject; hence it is called a
+=subjective complement=.
+
+Often the subjective complement denotes the class to which the person or
+thing named by the subject belongs; as, “Corn is a grain,” “My friend is
+a farmer.”
+
+=87.= The subject and the object complement denote two different persons
+or things, but the subject and the subjective complement always refer to
+the same person or thing.
+
+=88.= The subjective complement is sometimes a single noun, as in the
+sentence, “Stars are suns.” When the subjective complement is a group of
+words, a noun is usually the base word; as, “Procrastination is the thief
+of time.”
+
+In sentences containing a subjective complement, the subject comes before
+the verb, and the subjective complement after the verb, unless the
+sentence is transposed; as, “Lords of the sea are we.”
+
+=89.= Sometimes, instead of having a complement, a verb of being is
+modified by a prepositional phrase, or even by an adverb, denoting place;
+as, “My bark is on the sea,” “Yonder is my home.”
+
+=Summary.=—Verbs that assert =being= or =identity= are intransitive verbs.
+
+A =subjective complement= is a word or a group of words that completes a
+verb and refers to the same person or thing as the subject.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the intransitive verbs of being in the following
+sentences. Find their subjects and their complements, and the base words
+of each. Analyze sentences 1, 3, 4, 5, 7, 9, 14.
+
+ 1. This palace was the residence of the queen consort of
+ England.
+
+ 2.
+
+ The king was in his counting house, counting out his money,
+ The queen was in the parlor, eating bread and honey.
+
+ 3. My name is Beautiful Joe, and I am a brown dog of medium
+ size.
+
+ 4. Her worship of God was unselfish service, and her prayers
+ were worthy deeds.
+
+ 5. The one great poem of New England is her Sunday.
+
+ 6. This guinea pig’s name was Jeff, and he and I became good
+ friends.
+
+ 7. Patient waiters are no losers.
+
+ 8. In this fine open square are magnificent fountains, handsome
+ statuary on tall pedestals, and crowds of vehicles and foot
+ passengers crossing it in every direction.
+
+ 9. A jackknife in his expert hand was a whole chest of tools.
+
+ 10. One of the best things in the world to be is a boy.
+
+ 11. Backbiting is the meanest kind of biting, not excepting the
+ bite of fleas.
+
+ 12. The rattle of a bucket in a neighbor’s yard, no longer
+ mixed with other weekday noises, seemed a new sound.
+
+ 13.
+
+ Little Boy Blue, come blow your horn.
+ The sheep’s in the meadow, the cow’s in the corn.
+
+ 14. I became an enthusiastic little cook.
+
+ 15. King Arthur’s son was a handsome, polite, and brave knight.
+
+ 16. The bees are abroad under the calling sky, and the red of
+ apple buds becomes a sign in the orchards.
+
+ 17. Always darker turns the growing hemp as it rushes upward.
+
+Account for the punctuation of sentences 3, 4, 6, 8, and 15.
+
+
+
+
+XXVI. ADJECTIVES AS SUBJECTIVE COMPLEMENTS
+
+
+=90.= In the sentences, (1) “The tomato is a fruit,” (2) “That tall boy
+is the winner of the race,” the base word of the subjective complement is
+a noun, because we wish to assert (1) class, (2) identity.
+
+In the sentence, “The old gentleman’s face was serene and rosy,” the base
+words of the subjective complement are the two adjectives _serene_ and
+_rosy_, because we wish to assert the characteristics, or qualities, of
+the old gentleman’s face.
+
+This is a very common use of the adjective, as seen in the familiar
+sentences, “Grass is green,” “Honey is sweet,” “Ice is cold.”
+
+=91.= The verbs of being that were given in Lesson XXV,—_be_, _become_,
+_look_, _seem_, _appear_, _feel_, _smell_, _taste_, _sound_, and
+_grow_,—often take adjectives for subjective complements; as, “My head
+feels dizzy,” “This sentence sounds queer,” “Mary grew plump and strong.”
+
+In some cases where the language affords no adjectives that exactly
+express the meaning, we use a prepositional phrase as subjective
+complement; as in the common expressions, “The house is _on fire_,” “The
+girl is _in love_,” “The man is _in debt_.” None of these phrases denote
+place, but each of them denotes a condition.
+
+ NOTE.—An adjective used as a subjective complement is often
+ modified by a prepositional phrase. If we say “The bin is
+ full,” somebody will ask “full of what?” If we say “full of
+ apples,” it is evident that the phrase _of apples_ modifies
+ _full_. We also say _glad of it_, _tired of play_, _wild with
+ joy_, _green with envy_, etc. These expressions are different,
+ however, from what we find in the sentence, “I was tired in the
+ evening,” where the phrase _in the evening_, denoting time,
+ modifies not the adjective _tired_, but the two words _was
+ tired_.
+
+=Summary.=—An adjective, or a group of words of which an adjective is the
+base word, may be the subjective complement of an intransitive verb.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the intransitive verbs of being in the following
+sentences. Find their subjects and their complements, and the base words
+of each. Analyze sentences 1, 2, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 13, 15.
+
+ 1. The sting of a bee is sometimes deadly.
+
+ 2. The woodchuck looked sulky, and scratched his nose
+ expressively.
+
+ 3. The traveler’s limbs were numb, for the ride had been long
+ and wearisome.
+
+ 4. She might be poor in purse and weak in body, this brave
+ young mother, but she was rich in hope and strong in spirit.
+
+ 5. By the third day I felt too weak and sick to stir.
+
+ 6. At these words the king grew purple in the face.
+
+ 7. Conrad will keep quiet over his books.
+
+ 8. Mary was beautiful, feminine in spirit, and lovely.
+ Elizabeth was talented, masculine, and plain. Mary was artless,
+ unaffected, and gentle. Elizabeth was heartless, intriguing,
+ and insincere.
+
+ 9. Your grandfather looked very funny in his red nightcap, and
+ without his teeth.
+
+ 10. Very few poetic people are good at arithmetic.
+
+ 11. The garden at the back of the house was sweet with the
+ scent of newly blossomed lilacs and the freshness of young
+ grass.
+
+ 12. Snow-white was the foam that flashed upward underneath the
+ curving prow.
+
+ 13. Is not Little Annie afraid of such a tumult?
+
+ 14. His mouth felt as dry and stiff and hard as a chip.
+
+ 15. The people went nearly mad for joy.
+
+=92.= A common error is the misuse of an adverb for an adjective as the
+subjective complement of a verb of being. We should say, “I feel _bad_,
+or _ill_, or _unhappy_” (not _badly_).
+
+Another common error is the misuse of an adjective for an adverb as a
+modifier of a verb of action. We should say, “The child learns _easily_”
+(not _easy_).
+
+If we wish to tell a quality or condition of the subject, we should use
+an adjective; as, “The oak leaves turned _brown_.” If we wish to tell
+the manner of an action, we should use an adverb; as, “The leaves turned
+_quickly_ this fall.”
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Tell the part of speech of each italicized word in these
+sentences, and justify its use.
+
+ 1. Mary dresses _neatly_ and always looks _charming_.
+
+ 2. The children must keep _quiet_ to-night.
+
+ 3. Stand _straight_ and breathe _deeply_.
+
+ 4. Look at them _kindly_ and speak _gently_.
+
+ 5. The old bishop looks _kind_ and _gentle_.
+
+ 6. This pie tastes very _queer_.
+
+ 7. Mother feels _uneasy_ if we are _out late_.
+
+ 8. The boy seemed _nervous_ and felt _uneasily_ of his watch
+ chain.
+
+ 9. Poor oil made the lamp smell very _disagreeable_.
+
+ 10. All the doors stood _open_.
+
+ 11. The air grew _cold steadily_.
+
+ 12. Keep the box _carefully_ till I return.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Select the right word for each of the following sentences,
+and give your reason in each case:—
+
+ 1. The light is so poor that I cannot see the picture (_plain_
+ or _plainly_).
+
+ 2. I am frightened when she speaks (_cross_ or _crossly_) to me.
+
+ 3. Sit with me so that you can hear (_good_ or _well_).
+
+ 4. Does he always deal (_honest_ or _honestly_) with you?
+
+ 5. The miser died (_miserable_ or _miserably_).
+
+ 6. You came so (_sudden_ or _suddenly_) that I was taken by
+ surprise.
+
+ 7. No wonder you fell, you move too (_quick_ or _quickly_).
+
+ 8. How (_stylish_ or _stylishly_) she dresses.
+
+ 9. I (_sure_ or _surely_) mailed the letter.
+
+ 10. Next time I shall act more (_sensible_ or _sensibly_).
+
+ 11. Money comes (_easy_ or _easily_) to him, and is soon gone.
+
+ 12. I felt so (_bad_ or _badly_) that I cried.
+
+ 13. I was ill yesterday, but I feel pretty (_good_ or _well_)
+ this morning.
+
+ 14. All my rose bushes look (_fine_ or _finely_).
+
+
+
+
+XXVII. REVIEW OF VERBS
+
+
+=93.= A =verb= is an asserting word.
+
+A =transitive verb= is one that asserts action performed upon some person
+or thing.
+
+A transitive verb is completed by a =direct object=.
+
+The =direct object= of a transitive verb is a word or a group of words
+that completes the meaning of the verb and names the receiver of the
+action.
+
+The =base word= of a =direct object= is usually a noun.
+
+An =intransitive verb= is one that asserts, (1) being, or (2) action not
+performed upon any person or thing.
+
+An =intransitive verb of action= needs no complement.
+
+An =intransitive verb of being= is usually completed by a subjective
+complement.
+
+A =subjective complement= is a word or a group of words that completes a
+verb and refers to the same person or thing as the subject.
+
+A subjective complement denotes identity with the subject, or tells the
+class to which the subject belongs, or some quality of the subject.
+
+The =base word= of a =subjective complement= may be a noun or an
+adjective.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select and classify all the verbs in the following sentences.
+Tell the subject of each verb, and tell how each verb is completed or
+modified.
+
+ 1. As soon as he saw the cat in the soap barrel, he set the
+ lamp down on the cellar bottom, and laughed so that he could
+ hardly move.
+
+ 2. When night came, I felt still more lonesome.
+
+ 3. Little Toomai shall become a great tracker.
+
+ 4. The wind whistled around the low, unplastered chamber, but
+ the beds were soft and warm, and the guests were ready for
+ sleep.
+
+ 5. The youngest daughter was the gentlest and most beautiful
+ creature ever seen, and the pride of all the people in the land.
+
+ 6. I am too stiff and sore from a terrible fall I have had, to
+ write more than one line.
+
+ 7. Next month, when the city had returned to its sunbaked
+ quiet, the Hindu did a thing that no Englishman would have
+ dreamed of doing; for, so far as the world’s affairs went, he
+ died.
+
+ 8. The knoll in the tamarack swamp was a haven of peace amid
+ the fierce but furtive warfare of the wilderness.
+
+ 9. Beauty rose by four o’clock every morning, lighted the
+ fires, cleaned the house, and prepared the breakfast for the
+ whole family.
+
+ 10. More years sped swiftly and tranquilly away.
+
+ 11. What a place the old market must have been in the days of
+ Herod the Builder!
+
+ 12. The lizard belonging to my mistress was a very beautiful
+ creature.
+
+ 13. The rocky walls are red with the scarlet of the geranium,
+ aglow with the orange of the lantana, or they are hidden by the
+ purple veil of the wild convolvulus. The dainty sweet alyssum
+ clings to the rock in great patches, and the little rice plant
+ lays its pink cheek against it lovingly.
+
+ 14. The spring had been a trying season for the lank she-bear.
+
+ 15. Right proud the baron was of his gallant steed.
+
+ 16. There is the house with the gate red-barred.
+
+ 17. The big male cuffed the cubs aside without ceremony,
+ mounted the carcass with an air of lordship, glared about him,
+ and suddenly with a snarl of wrath, fixed his eyes upon the
+ green branches wherein the boy was concealed.
+
+ 18. Rip Van Winkle was a kind neighbor and an obedient,
+ hen-pecked husband.
+
+ 19. The great error in Rip’s composition was an insuperable
+ aversion to all kinds of profitable labor.
+
+ 20. The same sweet clover smell is in the breeze.
+
+ 21. David stooped down and piled the fagots in the hollow of
+ his arm.
+
+ 22. Gentle are the days when the year is young.
+
+ 23. The winter sunshine on the fields seems full of rest.
+
+ 24. I feel out of place under this roof.
+
+ 25. Strips of snow still whitened the fields, but on the stumps
+ were bluebirds, and they warbled of spring.
+
+ 26. The great limb of the cedar snapped off, rolled over in the
+ air, and lay on the ground like a huge animal.
+
+
+
+
+XXVIII. NOUNS: NUMBER
+
+
+=94.= When we wish a noun to denote more than one object, we often change
+its form slightly. _Man_ becomes _men_, _child_ becomes _children_,
+_river_ becomes _rivers_.
+
+This change in the form of a noun by which it denotes one object or more
+than one is called =number=.
+
+Number is said to be one of the =properties= of a noun.
+
+=95.= When a noun denotes one object, it is said to be in the singular
+number; as, _lion_, _mouse_, _knife_.
+
+When a noun denotes more than one object, it is said to be in the
+=plural= number; as, _lions_, _mice_, _knives_.
+
+=96.= Most nouns form their plural by adding _s_ or _es_ to the singular;
+as, _key_, _keys_; _hand_, _hands_; _rope_, _ropes_; _mass_, _masses_;
+_fox_, _foxes_; _church_, _churches_; _bush_, _bushes_.
+
+This is said to be the =regular= way of forming the plural. Why is it
+that some words add _es_ instead of _s?_
+
+=97.= Nouns ending in _o_ preceded by a vowel form their plural by adding
+_s_; as, _folio_, _folios_; _cameo_, _cameos_.
+
+Some nouns ending in _o_ preceded by a consonant add _es_, and others
+_s_; as, _potato_, _potatoes_; _mosquito_, _mosquitoes_; _solo_, _solos_;
+_piano_, _pianos_.
+
+=98.= Some nouns form their plural =irregularly=.
+
+(1) A few nouns change the vowel; as, _man_, _men_; _goose_, _geese_;
+_mouse_, _mice_; _foot_, _feet_; _tooth_, _teeth_.
+
+(2) A few nouns add _en_; as, _ox, oxen_; _child, children_.
+
+(3) Nouns ending in _y_, preceded by a consonant sound, change _y_ to _i_
+and add _es_; as, _fly, flies_; _fairy, fairies_.
+
+(4) Some nouns ending in _f_ or _fe_ change _f_ or _fe_ to _v_ and add
+_es_; as, _wolf_, _wolves_; _knife_, _knives_.
+
+=99.= Some nouns have the same form in both the singular and the plural;
+as, _deer_, _grouse_, _salmon_.
+
+=100.= Some nouns ending in _s_ look like plural nouns, but are regarded
+as singular; as, _news_, _athletics_, _gymnastics_.
+
+=101.= Some nouns are used only in the plural; as, _scissors_, _pincers_,
+_thanks_.
+
+=102.= Compound nouns form their plural in three different ways:—
+
+(1) By adding _s_ to the last word; as, _forget-me-not_, _forget-me-nots_.
+
+(2) By adding _s_ to the principal word; as, _son-in-law_, _sons-in-law_.
+
+(3) By pluralizing both words; as, _manservant_, _menservants_.
+
+=103.= When a title is used with one name, we may pluralize either the
+name or the title. We may say the _Misses Gray_ or the _Miss Grays_, the
+_Messrs. Greenwood_ or the _Mr. Greenwoods_.
+
+When a title is used with more than one name, we pluralize the title. We
+say the _Misses Morgan and Adams_. The title _Mrs._ has no plural, so we
+must say _Mrs. Morgan and Mrs. Adams_.
+
+=104.= Letters, signs, or figures form their plurals by adding an
+apostrophe and _s_; as, 6’s, i’s, _t_’s.
+
+=105.= A few foreign nouns have kept their foreign plurals. Some of these
+in common use are _stratum_, _strata_; _alumnus_, _alumni_; _axis_,
+_axes_.
+
+=106.= Some nouns have two plurals used with slightly different meanings;
+as, _penny_ has _pennies_ and _pence_; _brother_ has _brothers_ and
+_brethren_; _die_ has _dies_ and _dice_. Find out from the dictionary the
+meanings of these plurals.
+
+The correct plural of a noun cannot always be reasoned out. It should
+never be guessed. It can always be learned from a dictionary.
+
+=Summary.=—=Number= is that property of a noun by which it denotes one
+object or more than one.
+
+A =singular= noun denotes one object.
+
+A =plural= noun denotes more than one object.
+
+Nouns form their plural =regularly= by adding _s_ or _es_ to the singular.
+
+Many nouns form their plural =irregularly=.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Tell the plural of each of the following nouns. Tell how it
+is formed. Consult the dictionary when you are in doubt.
+
+ alto
+ apostrophe
+ box
+ brush
+ calf
+ chromo
+ crisis
+ cupful
+ deer
+ Dutchman
+ elf
+ enemy
+ fez
+ fife
+ foot
+ German
+ half
+ hero
+ hoof
+ lasso
+ lioness
+ loaf
+ monkey
+ motto
+ mouse
+ negro
+ noose
+ Norman
+ oasis
+ piano
+ pony
+ sheaf
+ size
+ soprano
+ tableau
+ tooth
+ vertebra
+ volcano
+ wharf
+ court-martial
+ Dr. Wright
+ eyelash
+ flagstaff
+ General Allen
+ hanger-on
+ jack-in-the-pulpit
+ Miss Davis
+ passer-by
+ postmaster general
+ will-o’-the-wisp
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Select all the nouns in the following sentences, and tell
+whether they are singular or plural. Give the singular of each plural
+word, and the plural of each singular word.
+
+ 1. Listen! In yonder pine woods what a cawing of crows!
+
+ 2. A washstand in the corner, a chest of carved mahogany
+ drawers, a looking-glass in a filigree frame, and a high-backed
+ chair studded with brass nails like a coffin constituted the
+ furniture.
+
+ 3. There have always been medicine men, rain makers, wizards,
+ conjurers, sorcerers, astrologers, and fortune tellers, ready
+ to trade on the fears of the weak, the ignorant, and the
+ superstitious.
+
+ 4. April brought the blue scylla and the sweet violet; May
+ brought the much-loved narcissus and lily of the valley.
+
+ 5. In came the three Miss Fezziwigs, beaming and lovable.
+
+ 6. People hardly ever do know where to be born until it is too
+ late.
+
+ 7. The bell in the church tower was striking six, but I
+ undressed for the night and buried myself under the bedclothes.
+
+ 8. As it fell out, the three princesses were talking one night
+ of whom they would marry.
+
+ 9. Poor Mrs. Wise! I’m sure she’s to be pitied, living here
+ with all these grandchildren.
+
+ 10. As soon as Pussy heard me shut the gate in the yard at
+ noon, when school was done, she would run up the stairs as hard
+ as she could go.
+
+ 11. The puppy’s nightly couch was outside the stable, even
+ during the coldest weather.
+
+ 12. The fish, strange creatures called groupers, with great
+ sluggish bodies and horribly human faces, come crowding up to
+ be fed.
+
+ 13. What a hardy set of men they were, those Northmen of old!
+
+ 14. The streams that have entered into our American life come
+ from springs very wide apart,—from the Puritan whom James I was
+ persecuting, and from the courtiers whom he was patronizing;
+ from the Dutchmen whom Charles II was fighting, and from the
+ Covenanters whom he was trying to convert at the pistol’s
+ point; from the Scotchmen who had captured the north of
+ Ireland, and from the Huguenots who had been driven out of the
+ south of France.
+
+What is the use of _listen_, sentence 1, _furniture_, 2, _horribly_, 12?
+
+How are the adjectives _weak_, _ignorant_, and _superstitious_ used in
+sentence 3?
+
+
+
+
+XXIX. NOUNS: GENDER
+
+
+=107.= One of the characteristics of living things is sex; that is, all
+living things are male or female. Many nouns that are names of living
+things indicate sex. The noun _king_ indicates the male sex. The noun
+_queen_ indicates the female sex. The property of a noun by which it
+indicates the sex of the object named is called =gender=.
+
+=108.= Since there are two sexes, there must be at least two genders.
+Nouns that indicate the male sex are said to be of the =masculine=
+gender; as, _hero_, _grandfather_.
+
+Nouns that indicate the female sex are said to be of the =feminine=
+gender; as, _hen_, _tigress_, _sister_.
+
+Note that sex, male or female, refers to a distinction, or difference,
+in the living creatures themselves, while gender is merely a property
+of their names that shows this distinction. It is absurd, therefore, to
+speak of a person of the masculine gender, but it is allowable to speak
+of masculine qualities, masculine attire, a masculine voice, etc.
+
+=109.= Since things without life have no sex, the nouns that name such
+things have no gender; as, _sky_, _tent_, _pie_. Such words are said to
+be of the =neuter= gender. _Neuter_ means _neither_.
+
+=110.= Some nouns that may be applied to persons of either male or female
+sex are said to be of =common= gender; as, _child_, _cousin_, _parent_,
+_clerk_.
+
+=111.= Gender is denoted in three ways:—
+
+(1) By a pair of words; as, _man_, _woman_; _bull_, _cow_; _lad_, _lass_.
+
+(2) By inflection, that is, by adding a syllable to the masculine noun
+to form the feminine; as, _hero_, _heroine_; _lion_, _lioness_; _host_,
+_hostess_.
+
+What can you say of the words _widow_ and _widower_?
+
+(3) By prefixing a word whose gender is well known; as, _bull moose_,
+_maidservant_, _she bear_.
+
+ NOTE. —Some feminine nouns are going out of use. We no longer
+ use the words _poetess_ or _authoress_. If a woman preaches,
+ she is a minister; if she practices medicine, she is a doctor,
+ not a “lady doctor.”
+
+=Summary.=—=Gender= is that property of a noun which indicates the sex or
+non-sex of the object named.
+
+There are four genders:—
+
+A noun of the =masculine gender= indicates the male sex.
+
+A noun of the =feminine gender= indicates the female sex.
+
+A noun of the =neuter gender= indicates the absence of sex.
+
+A noun of =common gender= may indicate either the male or the female sex.
+
+Gender is denoted (1) by different words, (2) by inflection, (3) by
+prefixing some gender word.
+
+=Exercise.=—Tell the gender of each noun in the following sentences. Tell
+how its gender is denoted. If you are in doubt about any word, consult
+the dictionary.
+
+ 1. The she wolf lay agonizing in the darkest corner of the
+ cave, licking in grim silence the raw stump of her right
+ foreleg.
+
+ 2. The wild goose winging at the head of the V knew of good
+ feeding grounds near by, which he was ready to revisit.
+
+ 3. Not vague was the fear of the brooding grouse in the far-off
+ thicket, though the sound came to her but dimly.
+
+ 4. At the captain’s signal the _Seabird_ came alongside, and
+ Mr. Wintermute left Mrs. Howe and her little family to go on
+ their journey alone.
+
+ 5. Having sniffed the air for several minutes, without
+ discerning anything to interest him, the great bull moose
+ bethought him of his evening meal.
+
+ 6. Here on the ridge a buck, with his herd of does and fawns,
+ has established his winter “yard.”
+
+ 7. Without a second’s hesitation the cow flung up her tail,
+ gave a short bellow, and charged the bear.
+
+ 8. Another thing that attracts attention is the animals
+ tethered here, there, and everywhere. You see donkeys, goats,
+ cows, even cats, hens, and turkeys, confined by the inevitable
+ tether.
+
+ 9. Never before since the nestlings broke the shell had her
+ mate been so long away.
+
+ 10. The pupils never entered the study except upon the most
+ formal occasions.
+
+ 11. A fine cock grouse alighted on a log some forty paces
+ distant, stretched himself, strutted, spread his ruff and wings
+ and tail, and was about to begin drumming.
+
+ 12. Pedestrians walk where they will, here, there, or yonder.
+
+ 13. Several men-of-war, with a multitude of smaller craft, are
+ at anchor in Grassy Bay, and the admiral’s ship is lying on the
+ great floating dock for repairs.
+
+ 14. Some civilians are buried here, and many little children;
+ and I came upon a pathetic memorial to a fair young English
+ wife, who followed her soldier husband hither with her little
+ child, only to die on these far-off shores.
+
+ 15. Any animal that had died from natural causes the wolves
+ would not touch, and they even rejected anything that had been
+ killed by the stockmen. Their choice and daily food was the
+ tenderer part of a freshly killed yearling heifer. An old bull
+ or cow they disdained, and though they occasionally took a
+ young calf or colt, it was quite clear that veal or horseflesh
+ was not their favorite diet. It was also known that they were
+ not fond of mutton, although they often amused themselves by
+ killing sheep.
+
+
+
+
+XXX. POSSESSIVE NOUNS
+
+
+=112.= Instead of saying, “I borrowed the knife belonging to Will,” we
+are likely to say, “I borrowed Will’s knife.” Here we have a new form of
+the noun _Will_. It is used with the noun _knife_ to denote ownership of
+the knife, and is called a =possessive= noun.
+
+=113.= Since a possessive noun denotes ownership, it must be used with
+another noun, the name of the thing owned. The possessive noun is said to
+modify this other noun. In the expression _doctor’s car_, the possessive
+noun _doctor’s_ modifies the noun _car_.
+
+When the name of the thing owned is well known, it is often omitted. We
+say, “I bought these skates at Percy’s,” and omit the word _store_. A
+word omitted in this way is said to be “understood.”
+
+=114.= Possessive nouns have a certain form of their own. The possessive
+singular of a noun is formed by adding to it the apostrophe and _s_; as,
+_girl’s_ desk; _friend’s_ home; _George’s_ boat.
+
+ NOTE.—In a few common expressions, like _for Jesus’ sake_, _for
+ conscience’ sake_, the possessive is formed, for the sake of
+ euphony, by adding merely the apostrophe.
+
+When the plural of a noun ends in _s_, the possessive plural is formed by
+adding an apostrophe; as, _girls’_ league; _ladies’_ bonnets.
+
+When the plural of a noun does not end in _s_, the possessive plural is
+formed by adding the apostrophe and _s_; as, _women’s_ shoes; _oxen’s_
+yokes.
+
+=115.= When two persons are joint owners of one thing, we give the
+possessive form to the name of the second person only; as, _Lewis and
+Fred’s_ boat.
+
+When two persons own separate things, the name of each person must have
+the possessive form; as, I went to _Mandel’s_ and _Field’s_, meaning two
+different stores.
+
+=116.= Compound nouns form the possessive by adding the sign of
+possession to the last word; as, singular, _son-in-law’s_; plural,
+_sons-in-law’s_.
+
+=117.= The possessive noun does not always express actual ownership.
+Thus, “an _hour’s_ walk” means a walk lasting an hour, “_Lowell’s_
+poems,” means the poems written by Lowell, “a _child’s_ grief” means the
+grief felt by a child. What is the meaning of _the day’s work_? _a good
+night’s rest_? _a year’s vacation_? _the king’s death_?
+
+=118.= Possession may be denoted by a phrase beginning with the
+preposition _of_. This phrase is much used. We say _the back of the
+chair_, not _the chair’s back_; _the roots of the elm_, not _the elm’s
+roots_. This phrase enables us to avoid some awkward possessives. What
+may we say instead of _my cousin’s wife’s sister_? _the king of Greece’s
+court_?
+
+=119.= In the expression “this book of John’s,” we have what is called a
+=double possessive=, for we have the possessive noun _John’s_, and the
+phrase introduced by _of_. We use the double possessive when the noun
+denoting the thing owned is first modified by some adjective, as _a_,
+_the_, _this_, _every_, _both_, _no_.
+
+=Summary.=—A =possessive noun= denotes ownership.
+
+A possessive noun modifies another noun, expressed or understood.
+
+The possessive singular is formed by adding the apostrophe and _s_.
+
+The possessive plural is formed by adding the apostrophe and _s_ if the
+noun does not end in _s_, and the apostrophe alone if the noun does end
+in _s_.
+
+A =double possessive= is a phrase consisting of the preposition _of_
+followed by some possessive word.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Write the possessive of each of these nouns. Tell whether
+it is singular or plural.
+
+ attorney-general
+ chairman
+ city
+ colonies
+ Colonel Cleveland
+ commander in chief
+ Charles Dickens
+ daughters-in-law
+ dwarfs
+ foxes
+ geese
+ goddess
+ groomsman
+ Frenchman
+ John Keats
+ ladies
+ major generals
+ Miss James
+ mulatto
+ sailor boy
+ thief
+ witches
+ woodpecker
+ yeoman
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Select all the possessive nouns in the following sentences.
+Tell what nouns they modify, and whether they are singular or plural.
+Tell also the gender of each possessive.
+
+ 1. The lady’s fondness and the gentleman’s blindness were
+ topics ably handled at every sewing circle in the town.
+
+ 2. St. Paul’s is the largest Protestant church in the world.
+
+ 3. Last year’s nuts are this year’s black earth.
+
+ 4. On the way home we stopped at the baker’s to get some cream
+ puffs.
+
+ 5. Every debt of my partner’s has been paid.
+
+ 6. The woodsman’s aim was true.
+
+ 7. The singers’ seats, where the pretty girls sat, were the
+ most conspicuous of all.
+
+ 8. A half hour’s tramp through difficult woods brought him to
+ the nearest of the waters.
+
+ 9. In August we had two weeks’ vacation.
+
+ 10. This editorial of Roosevelt’s is attracting much attention.
+
+ 11. Sulphur they could buy at the apothecary’s.
+
+ 12. The horse is coal-black, which is the regulation color of
+ the Horse-Guards’ horses.
+
+ 13. My clothes and my father’s were packed in a little leather
+ valise.
+
+ 14. The backwoodsman cast a tender look on the sleepers’ faces,
+ and slipped out of the cabin door as silently as a shadow.
+
+ 15. Just where we leave the highway to go to Gibbs’s Hill we
+ pass a ruined house.
+
+ 16. He had melted up his wife’s gold thimble and his
+ great-grandfather’s gold-bowed spectacles.
+
+ 17. I called on Nancy because she was a friend of Miss Davis’s.
+
+ 18. Can you give a traveler a night’s lodging?
+
+ 19.
+
+ When beechen buds begin to swell,
+ And woods the bluebird’s warble know,
+ The yellow violet’s modest bell
+ Peeps from the last year’s leaves below.
+
+Analyze sentences 2, 3, 5, 6, 8, 9, 11, 16.
+
+
+
+
+XXXI. NOUNS: CASE
+
+
+=120.= We have seen that a noun may be used in different relations to
+other words in the sentence. It may be related to a verb, for instance,
+as subject, as object, and as subjective complement. That property of
+a noun which shows its relation to some other word in the sentence is
+called =case=.
+
+=121.= The three most important and striking relations that a noun may
+bear are these: subject of a verb, object of a verb, and possessive
+modifier. Hence there are three cases.
+
+When a noun is the subject of a verb, we say that it is in the
+=nominative= case.
+
+When it is the object of a verb, we say that it is in the =objective=
+case.
+
+When it is a possessive modifier, we say that it is in the =possessive=
+case.
+
+The pronoun has the same three cases as a noun.
+
+=122.= A noun is said to be =declined= when we give its three case forms
+in both the singular and the plural number.
+
+ DECLENSION OF _child_
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ _Nom._ child children
+ _Poss._ child’s children’s
+ _Obj._ child children
+
+=123.= The noun in the nominative case is used in other relations besides
+that of subject of a verb. The subjective complement is in the nominative
+case, as well as the noun used independently.
+
+When a noun is object of a preposition, it is in the objective case.
+
+=Summary.=—=Case= is that property of a noun or a pronoun which shows its
+relation to some other word in the sentence.
+
+There are three cases.
+
+A noun used as subject of a verb, as subjective complement, as an
+exclamatory noun, or as a term of address is in the =nominative case=.
+
+A noun used as object of a verb or of a preposition is in the =objective
+case=.
+
+A noun used as a possessive modifier is in the =possessive case=.
+
+=Declension= is the arrangement of the three case forms of a noun in the
+two numbers.
+
+=Exercise.=—Tell the use, the case, the number, and the gender of every
+noun in these sentences.
+
+ 1. The chill glitter of the northern summer sunrise was washing
+ down over the rounded top of old Sugar Loaf.
+
+ 2. Thank him according to our customs, Mowgli.
+
+ 3. What a good draught the nag takes!
+
+ 4. Alas! Kitty Clover, they say it is wicked; that I must not
+ catch grasshoppers for a pussy cat on Sunday.
+
+ 5. Why doesn’t your mother make a fresh cup of coffee?
+
+ 6. We might shovel off the snow, and dig down to some of last
+ year’s onions.
+
+ 7. Pilgrim fathers! why should we not glorify the pilgrim
+ mothers?
+
+ 8. What did Peterson Sahib mean by the elephant dance?
+
+ 9. The boy is the shoemaker’s friend.
+
+ 10.
+
+ Mistress Mary, quite contrary,
+ How does your garden grow?
+
+ 11. I didn’t ask the captain’s leave when I attended this
+ ceremony, for I had a general idea that he wouldn’t give it.
+
+ 12. Cæsar is certainly the handsomest and most gentlemanly cat
+ I ever saw.
+
+ 13. How was the Princess’s nose ring the cause of your
+ misfortune?
+
+ 14.
+
+ Comrade, where wilt thou be to-night.
+ When the loosed storm breaks furiously?
+
+ 15. Indeed all the really pretty girls that you see are
+ Americans.
+
+ 16. When I opened the goldfinch’s door on the morning of the
+ blackbird’s arrival, he paid no attention to his beloved
+ bath, but instantly flew over and alighted on the cage of the
+ newcomer.
+
+ 17. These ten cows knew their names after a while, and would
+ take their places as I called them.
+
+ 18. Oh! but he was a tight-fisted hand at the grindstone, was
+ Scrooge.
+
+ 19.
+
+ O time and change! how strange it seems
+ With so much gone to still live on!
+
+
+
+
+XXXII. NOUNS: THE APPOSITIVE
+
+
+=124.= It is frequently necessary to explain some term we use, and there
+is a convenient way for doing this without making a new sentence. For
+instance, an author writes, “One of these buildings belongs to the Horse
+Guards.” Then, for fear we may not know who the Horse Guards are, he adds
+these explanatory words, “a very fine body of English cavalry.”
+
+This group of words consists of the noun _body_ used as a base word,
+modified by the prepositional phrase _of English cavalry_, the adjective
+element _very fine_, and the article _a_. The whole group is placed
+beside the term it explains, and is separated from it by a comma. Such
+a group of words is called an =appositive=, and the base word _body_ is
+called =a noun in apposition=.
+
+=125.= Sometimes we explain who a person is by using his name; as, “I
+heard your friend, _John Richards_, say that he was going to write to
+you.”
+
+Sometimes the name of a person or animal or place is used first, and then
+explained by a group of words; as, “Akela, _the great gray Lone Wolf_,
+lay out at full length on his rock.”
+
+=126.= The appositive and the term it explains are in reality two names
+for the same person or thing. You might think that either one could be
+called the appositive, but this is not so. It is the explanatory term
+that is the appositive, and this is the second of the two terms.
+
+=127.= Sometimes, when there is no danger of any misunderstanding, the
+appositive comes at a little distance from the word it modifies; as,
+“Splendid buildings meet our eyes at every turn,—churches, private
+residences, places of business, and public edifices.” Can you account for
+this arrangement?
+
+=128.= Sometimes an appositive has been used so long with the word it
+modifies that the two have become united into one name; as, Peter the
+Hermit, Peter the Great, William the Conqueror. Such an appositive is not
+set off by a comma.
+
+ NOTE.—In the term Peter the Great, the adjective _great_ has
+ become a noun, and is modified by the adjective _the_.
+
+=129.= When ownership is to be denoted, the sign of possession is added
+to the appositive instead of to the term that it explains; as, “The poet
+Milton’s daughter,” “Mr. Taft, the president’s, cow,” “My friend Julia’s
+husband.”
+
+=Summary.=—An =appositive= is a word or a group of words placed after a
+term to explain it.
+
+When the base word of an appositive is a noun, it is called a =noun in
+apposition=.
+
+The case of a noun in apposition is the same as that of the noun it
+explains.
+
+An appositive is a modifier of a noun or a pronoun.
+
+An appositive is set off from the rest of the sentence by commas unless
+it makes one term with the word it modifies.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the appositives in the following sentences, and
+tell what they modify. Find the nouns in apposition. Tell the case of
+each, giving the reason in each instance. Analyze sentences 1, 2, 3, 5,
+6, 8, 9, 10, 11, 16.
+
+ 1. Alfred the Great loved books and strangers and travelers.
+
+ 2. In the neatest, sandiest hole of all lived Benjamin’s aunt
+ and his cousins,—Flopsy, Mopsy, Cottontail, and Peter.
+
+ 3. The conversation turned to rheumatism, a subject of very
+ remote interest to Polly.
+
+ 4. My son William became a telegraph operator before he was
+ seventeen.
+
+ 5. James II, the bigoted successor of Charles I, had annulled
+ the charters of all the colonies.
+
+ 6. The geography lesson that day was the rivers of Asia,—the
+ Obi, Yenisei, Lena, Amoor, Hoang Ho, and Yang-tse-kiang.
+
+ 7. Some writers tell us that Edward the Confessor had made a
+ will appointing Duke William his successor.
+
+ 8. Foremost among the envious ones was the Princess Panka, the
+ daughter of a neighboring king.
+
+ 9. Close to Charing Cross is Trafalgar Square, a fine open
+ space with a fountain, and a column to Lord Nelson.
+
+ 10. The body of Warwick the kingmaker was exposed for three
+ days on the pavement of St. Paul’s, and then deposited among
+ the ashes of his fathers in the abbey of Bilsam.
+
+ 11. The pass was crowned with dense, dark forest,—deodar,
+ walnut, wild cherry, wild olive, and wild pear.
+
+ 12. Kaa, the big Rock Python, had changed his skin for perhaps
+ the two hundredth time since his birth.
+
+ 13. Eric the Red, a wandering Norseman who was dwelling in
+ Iceland, went to sea and discovered Greenland.
+
+ 14. There are so many things to distract a boy’s attention,—a
+ chipmunk in the fence, a bird on a near tree, and a henhawk
+ circling high in the air over the barnyard.
+
+ 15. Very soundly it slept, that doomed hare crouching under the
+ fir bush!
+
+ 16. They had never been accounted for, Rebecca’s eyes.
+
+
+
+
+XXXIII. APPOSITIVE ADJECTIVES
+
+
+=130.= Adjectives are not always placed before the noun they modify. When
+they are used as subjective complements, they follow the verb, although
+they modify the subject; as, “Life is _real_,” “The air seems _moist_.”
+We also find many sentences like the following, “The camel, restless and
+weary, groans and occasionally shows his teeth.”
+
+Here it is evident that the adjectives _restless_ and _weary_ are in the
+sentence to describe the camel; hence they modify the noun _camel_; but
+instead of preceding this noun, they follow it. Because of their position
+such adjectives are called =appositive adjectives=.
+
+=131.= An appositive adjective is usually set off by a comma or commas.
+It is frequently modified by a phrase, as in the expressions, “restless
+under his heavy load,” “weary with the long journey.”
+
+=Summary.=—An adjective with or without modifiers may be used as an
+appositive.
+
+An appositive adjective is usually set off from the rest of the sentence
+by a comma.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the appositive adjectives in these sentences, and
+tell what they modify. Give the modifiers of each adjective. Account for
+the punctuation. Analyze sentences 2, 4, 5, 6, 7, 11, 12.
+
+ 1. His tunic, scarlet in color, is of the softest woolen fabric.
+
+ 2. The skirt drops to the knee in folds heavy with embroidery.
+
+ 3. Grandfather Nutter was a hale, cheery old gentleman, as
+ straight and as bald as an arrow.
+
+ 4. The pink rose, dear for its old associations, was
+ transplanted to a sunny place close by the south door.
+
+ 5. Presently the Colonel came in, bluff, warm, and hearty.
+
+ 6. From the other window one saw the distant forest, so deep,
+ black, and mysterious.
+
+ 7. The April night, softly chill and full of the sense of thaw,
+ was closing down over the wide salt marshes!
+
+ 8. Presently, from far along the dark heights of the sky, came
+ voices, hollow, musical, confused.
+
+ 9. Here is a foot passenger, dusty and tired, who comes with
+ lagging steps.
+
+ 10. There is no nation known to history in which all citizens,
+ male and female, old and young, native and foreign born, have
+ had the suffrage.
+
+ 11. Ginger hurried off into the darkness, wild with excitement.
+
+ 12. The chief engineer entered the smoking room for a moment,
+ red, smiling, and wet.
+
+
+
+
+XXXIV. INDIRECT OBJECT
+
+
+=132.= We have seen that the direct object names the receiver of the
+action asserted by the verb. In the sentence, “Kotuko made his dog a
+tiny harness,” the direct object of the verb _made_ is a _tiny harness_,
+for this group of words tells what received the making, and answers the
+question _made what?_
+
+If we go further and ask the question, _made a harness for what?_ the
+answer is, _his dog_. This group of words is called the indirect object.
+It names the receiver of the direct object; that is, the dog received the
+harness.
+
+=133.= An indirect object is always in the objective case, but it is
+not a complement of the verb, because it is not a necessary element of
+a sentence. We call it a modifier of the verb. The sentence, “In the
+morning the old wife gave the princess three nuts,” would be complete if
+we left out the indirect object _the princess_, and merely told what the
+old wife gave, namely, three nuts.
+
+Notice that the indirect object comes between the verb and the direct
+object. If we place it after the direct object, we must supply the
+preposition _to_ or _for_, and then instead of an indirect object we
+shall have a prepositional phrase.
+
+=Summary.=—An =indirect object= is a word or a group of words that tells
+to whom or for whom, to what or for what, something is done.
+
+An indirect object names the receiver of the direct object.
+
+An indirect object precedes the direct object.
+
+An indirect object is a modifier of a verb.
+
+An indirect object is in the objective case.
+
+Only a few transitive verbs take both direct and indirect objects. Some
+of them are _bring_, _buy_, _do_, _get_, _give_, _lend_, _make_ _pass_,
+_pay_, _promise_, _sell_, _send_, _show_, _take_, _tell_, _write_.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Write sentences containing both direct and indirect
+objects, using verbs in the list above.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Select both the direct and the indirect objects in the
+following sentences, giving reasons:—
+
+ 1. Carry your grandmamma a custard and a little pot of butter.
+
+ 2. Aladdin made his mother very little reply.
+
+ 3. I showed my comrades a large heap of stones.
+
+ 4. Mrs. Howe had promised the children presents, so she bought
+ George a gun, Mollie two gold rings, and Paul a checkerboard.
+
+ 5. I wish the Lord would give horses voices for just one week.
+
+ 6. Bring my mother six women slaves to attend her.
+
+ 7. If you offer Dash a bit of sheep’s wool now, he tucks his
+ tail between his legs, and runs for home.
+
+ 8. I never told my schoolmates that I was a Yankee.
+
+ 9. I paid Gypsy a visit every half hour during the first day of
+ my arrival.
+
+ 10. Then the magician gave Aladdin a handful of small money.
+
+ 11. Father Andrew also taught Tom a little Latin.
+
+ 12. The sultan granted Aladdin his request and again embraced
+ him.
+
+
+
+
+XXXV. ADVERBIAL NOUN PHRASES
+
+
+=134.= We have learned that a frequent modifier of a verb is a
+prepositional phrase telling the place or time of an action; as, “So off
+we go in the cool, clear morning.”
+
+Sometimes a noun, or a group of words of which a noun is the base word,
+takes the place of this prepositional phrase; as, “_Last summer_ the
+apple trees bore no fruit.”
+
+The words _last summer_ tell time, and modify the predicate _bore no
+fruit_, but there is no preposition in this group of words. _Summer_ is a
+noun modified by the adjective _last_. Such a group of words we call an
+=adverbial noun phrase=. The noun used as base word we call an =adverbial
+noun=.
+
+=135.= An adverbial noun phrase tells not only time and place, but it
+often answers such questions as _how far?_ _how long?_ _how much?_ as,
+“We walked _the whole distance_ before sunset.” “She stayed in London
+_ten days_.” “One orange weighed _twelve ounces_.”
+
+=Summary.=—An =adverbial noun phrase= is a group of words of which a noun
+is the base word, that tells the time or place of an action, or how long,
+how far, or how much.
+
+An adverbial noun phrase modifies a verb.
+
+An =adverbial noun= is always in the objective case.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select the adverbial noun phrases and the nouns used as base
+words. Tell what the phrases modify, and what questions they answer.
+(Notice that these phrases often modify more of the predicate than just
+the verb.) Analyze sentences 1, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10.
+
+ 1. He followed her to school one day.
+
+ 2. Each boy who failed to report himself was fined one cent.
+
+ 3. Elizabeth Eliza went home directly.
+
+ 4. Morning, noon, and night, Dame Van Winkle’s tongue was
+ incessantly going.
+
+ 5. His keen, sonorous, passionate cry rang strangely on the
+ night, three times.
+
+ 6. The trail was an easy one this time.
+
+ 7. There the wild plum each summer fruited abundantly; and
+ there a sturdy brotherhood of beeches each autumn lavished
+ their treasure of three-cornered nuts.
+
+ 8. I worked a whole week to get the traps properly set out.
+
+ 9. The next instant the panther received a smart blow on the
+ top of his head.
+
+ 10. Kala Nag, the elephant, stood ten fair feet at the shoulder.
+
+ 11. Ere the cow had gone twenty-five yards, Lobo was upon her.
+
+ 12. The next morning Mrs. Peterkin began by taking out the
+ things that were already in her trunk.
+
+
+
+
+XXXVI. ADVERBIAL NOUN PHRASES
+
+
+=136.= When we wish to tell how long, or wide, or deep, or thick a thing
+is, we frequently make use of such statements as these:—
+
+ The valley is nine miles long.
+
+ The street is sixty feet wide.
+
+ The water is ten fathoms deep.
+
+ The slices were an inch thick.
+
+It is evident that in the first sentence the question _how long?_ is
+answered by the words _nine miles_. Hence this group of words modifies
+the adjective _long_, having the same use as the adverb _very_ in,
+“The valley is very long.” But the base word of this group is the noun
+_miles_, hence the whole group must be an adverbial noun phrase. We
+conclude from this familiar sentence that an adverbial noun phrase may
+modify an adjective.
+
+What adverbial noun phrase modifies _wide_? _deep_? _thick_?
+
+Make sentences in which an adverbial noun phrase modifies the adjectives
+_old_, _tall_, _high_.
+
+=137.= The adverbial noun phrase may also modify an adverb, as in the
+sentence, “She came two hours afterward,” where _two hours_ answers the
+question _how long afterward?_ How do we know that _afterward_ is an
+adverb?
+
+ NOTE.—A common illustration of this use is found in the
+ familiar expression _a short time ago_, where the adverb _ago_
+ (which is never used by itself) is modified by the adverbial
+ noun phrase _a short time_. Think of five other noun phrases
+ often used to modify _ago_.
+
+=Summary.=—An adverbial noun phrase may modify an adjective or an adverb.
+In such a case it denotes a measure of some sort.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select the adverbial nouns and the phrases of which they are
+the base words. Tell what these phrases modify, and what questions they
+answer.
+
+ 1. About an hour later a big red fox came trotting into the
+ glade.
+
+ 2. When the stone was pulled up, there appeared a staircase
+ about three or four feet deep, leading to a door.
+
+ 3. The trail was perhaps an hour old.
+
+ 4. After viewing old Fort Snelling, we walked a mile farther to
+ the parade ground, and watched the soldiers drill.
+
+ 5. An ordinary wolf’s forefoot is four and one half inches long.
+
+ 6. Lobo stood three feet high at the shoulder, and weighed one
+ hundred and fifty pounds.
+
+ 7. If the crows do not kill the owl, they at least worry him
+ half to death and drive him twenty miles away.
+
+ 8. It is a curious fact about boys that two will be a great
+ deal slower in doing anything than one.
+
+ 9. When the eagle returned an hour later to the point of
+ shoals, the net looked less strange to him.
+
+ 10. Twenty-five years ago the American minister at the court of
+ Turin was conversing with a young Italian of high rank from the
+ island of Sardinia.
+
+ 11. The largest aboriginal structure of stone within the limits
+ of the United States has a circuit of 1480 feet, is five
+ stories high, and once included five hundred separate rooms.
+
+ 12. How many years did Jacob serve for Rachel?
+
+ 13. The week before the election one of the candidates for
+ mayor spoke to an audience of laboring men every evening.
+
+ 14. That day I left the university, and my trial took place a
+ little while later.
+
+ 15. David reflected a few moments longer.
+
+
+
+
+XXXVII. OBJECTIVE COMPLEMENT
+
+
+=138.= In the sentence, “The boys called the turtles Harry Blake’s
+sheep,” the verb is followed by two noun elements. What are they? The
+second element is not an appositive of the first, neither have we here a
+direct and an indirect object. Prove this.
+
+If we ask the question, _What_ did the boys call Harry Blake’s sheep?
+the answer is, _the turtles_; hence this must be the direct object of
+_called_. But the sentence is not complete here. We do not mean that the
+boys _called_ the turtles, that is, _summoned_ them. We mean that they
+_named_ the turtles. If we ask the question, “What did the boys call the
+turtles?” the answer is, “_Harry Blake’s sheep_.” This group of words is
+necessary as a second complement of the verb, and at the same time it
+tells what the turtles became as a result of calling, or naming, them.
+Such an element is called an =objective complement=, because it tells
+something about the direct object.
+
+The base word of an objective complement is in the objective case.
+
+=139.= Not all transitive verbs take an objective complement; but only
+verbs of making or causing, such as _make_, _call_, _name_, _elect_,
+_appoint_, _choose_.
+
+=140.= Sometimes the objective complement has an adjective for its base
+word instead of a noun; as, “The great wood-fire in the tiled chimney
+place made our sitting room _very cheerful_ of winter nights.”
+
+=Summary.=—An =objective complement= is a word or a group of words that
+helps to complete the verb, and tells what the direct object becomes as a
+result of the action asserted by the verb.
+
+The base word of an objective complement may be either a noun or an
+adjective.
+
+=Exercise.=—Find all the objective complements in the following sentences
+and tell about them in this way:—
+
+MODEL.—_Ben called this room his cabin._
+
+_His cabin_ is a noun element used as objective complement of the verb
+_called_, because it tells what the direct object, _this room_, becomes
+as a result of the calling. The base word of this objective complement is
+the noun _cabin_.
+
+ 1. His blue beard made him so ugly and so terrible in
+ appearance that women and children fled from him.
+
+ 2. She kept the cottage always as neat as a new pin.
+
+ 3. By much trampling we had made the salt marsh a mere quagmire.
+
+ 4. This mother, proud of her knowledge of French, always called
+ her little daughter Mademoiselle.
+
+ 5. If ever I have a boy to bring up in the way he should go, I
+ shall make Sunday a cheerful day to him.
+
+ 6. To the great amusement of my grandfather, Sailor Ben painted
+ the cottage a light sky-blue.
+
+ 7. Then, inch by inch, the untempered heat crept into the heart
+ of the Jungle, turning it yellow, brown, and at last black.
+
+ 8. The fish had buried themselves deep in the dry mud.
+
+ 9. The natives of Bermuda call the tamarisk the “salt-cedar.”
+
+ 10. Nature meant him for a frontiersman, but circumstances made
+ him an innkeeper.
+
+ 11. The only way that they could set the king’s head straight
+ was to remove it.
+
+ 12. Columbus rechristened the island San Salvador, but its
+ precise identity has always been a little doubtful.
+
+ 13. A parrot would shriek me wild in a week.
+
+ 14. Skin changing always makes a snake moody and depressed till
+ the new skin begins to shine and look beautiful.
+
+ 15. The giver makes the gift precious.
+
+ 16. The sound of a bell struck the merrymakers dumb.
+
+ 17. Who appointed you judge of your brother?
+
+ 18. The dim light of stars rendered large objects near at hand
+ visible in bulk and outline.
+
+ 19. We call domestic animals dependent creatures; but who made
+ them dependent?
+
+
+
+
+XXXVIII. PARSING OF NOUNS
+
+
+=141.= When we tell all that is true about a noun from a grammatical
+point of view, we are said to =parse= it.
+
+In parsing a noun we should tell:—
+
+(1) Its class,—common or proper.
+
+(2) Its person,—first, second, or third. (See Note.)
+
+(3) Its number,—singular or plural.
+
+(4) Its gender,—masculine, feminine, neuter, or common.
+
+(5) Its case,—nominative, possessive, or objective.
+
+(6) Its use in the sentence.
+
+ NOTE.—Nouns do not change their _form_ for =person=. Since
+ they are almost always the names of persons or things spoken
+ of, they are usually in the _third person_. A noun is in the
+ _first person_ when it is used in apposition with a pronoun of
+ the first person. (See p. 98.) A noun is in the _second person_
+ (1) when it is used in apposition with a pronoun of the second
+ person; (2) when it is used as a term of address.
+
+=Exercise.=—Parse each noun in the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. All the great men of the neighborhood were there on
+ horseback,—militia officers in uniform, the member of Congress,
+ the sheriff of the county, the editors of newspapers, and many
+ a farmer, too, had mounted his patient steed or come on foot.
+
+ 2. Next day Mowgli himself fell into a very cunning leopard
+ trap.
+
+ 3. The Bermudas are, with the exception of Gibraltar, England’s
+ most strongly fortified hold.
+
+ 4. Then Mrs. Howe graciously showed the admiring ladies her
+ collection of fine lace and embroideries.
+
+ 5. The thoughtful, lonely ways of their admiral made Columbus
+ an object of terror to his ignorant seamen.
+
+ 6. I thought that nothing in the world was so beautiful as the
+ sultan my father’s palace.
+
+ 7. Perhaps your fish is eighteen inches long.
+
+ 8. Here comes the boat! This is your waterproof, Hetty. Be
+ careful now, Miss Alice. Mrs. Blank, you will need your sun
+ umbrella. Hold on a minute, skipper, till I get that basket.
+
+ 9. At nine o’clock, Williams, a bronze Hercules, low-voiced,
+ gentle-mannered, a trusty boatman, and an enthusiast in his
+ calling, met us at the dock.
+
+ 10. The savage sticks bright feathers in his hair, carries a
+ tomahawk, and wears moccasins upon his nimble feet.
+
+ 11. Some evenings afterward the same thing happened at another
+ corner of the pasture.
+
+ 12. The innocent savages gave Columbus a new world for Castile
+ and Leon, and he gave them some glass beads and little red caps.
+
+ 13. The sultan received the present from Aladdin’s mother’s
+ hand.
+
+ 14. The elephant was thoughtfully chewing the green stem of a
+ young plantain tree.
+
+ 15. In the good old days the boys on the coast ran away and
+ became sailors.
+
+ 16. I was a favorite with the cooks, and so, although they
+ denied my cousins certain privileges of the kitchen, they
+ freely granted these to me.
+
+ 17. The Norsemen called gold “the serpent’s bed.”
+
+
+SUMMARY OF CASE RELATIONS
+
+Nominative.
+
+ (1) Subject of a verb.
+ (2) Term of address.
+ (3) Exclamatory noun.
+ (4) Subjective complement of a verb.
+ (5) Appositive.
+ (6) Nominative absolute (see p. 237).
+
+Possessive.
+
+ (1) Modifier of a noun.
+
+Objective.
+
+ (1) Object of a verb.
+ (2) Object of a preposition.
+ (3) Appositive.
+ (4) Indirect object.
+ (5) Adverbial noun.
+ (6) Objective complement.
+
+Make an original sentence to illustrate each of the case relations of a
+noun.
+
+
+
+
+XXXIX. PERSONAL PRONOUNS
+
+
+=142.= Certain pronouns, as _I_, _you_, _he_, _it_, etc., show by their
+form that they refer to the person speaking, the person spoken to, or the
+person or thing spoken of.
+
+The pronoun _I_ denotes the person speaking, and is said to be a pronoun
+of the =first person=.
+
+The pronoun _you_ denotes the person spoken to, and is said to be a
+pronoun of the =second person=.
+
+The pronouns _he_, _she_, and _it_ denote the person or thing spoken of,
+and are said to be pronouns of the =third person=.
+
+Such pronouns are called =personal= pronouns.
+
+=143.= The noun that a pronoun stands for, whether it is expressed
+somewhere in the sentence or merely understood, is called the
+=antecedent= of the pronoun.
+
+=144.= All the personal pronouns have several different forms, and if we
+wish to speak our language correctly, we must know these forms and be
+careful in their use. The personal pronouns are declined as follows:—
+
+ FIRST PERSON SECOND PERSON
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ _Nom._ I we you you
+ _Poss._ my, mine our, ours your, yours your, yours
+ _Obj._ me us you you
+
+ THIRD PERSON
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ MASCULINE FEMININE NEUTER
+
+ _Nom._ he she it they
+ _Poss._ his her, hers its their, theirs
+ _Obj._ him her it them
+
+=145.= There is another personal pronoun of the second person—_thou_.
+It is not used in conversation nowadays, but is frequently found in the
+Bible and in poetry. It is declined as follows:—
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ _Nom._ thou ye
+ _Poss._ thy, thine your, yours
+ _Obj._ thee you
+
+=Summary.=—A =personal pronoun= is one that shows by its form whether it
+denotes the person speaking, the person spoken to, or the person or thing
+spoken of.
+
+The personal pronouns are _I_, _thou_, _you_, _he_, _she_, _it_, and
+their various case forms in the two numbers.
+
+The =antecedent= of a pronoun is the word for which it stands.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the personal pronouns. Tell from the form of each
+its person and number, and, if it is a pronoun of the third person, tell
+also its gender. Where it is possible, tell the antecedent of the pronoun.
+
+ 1. Hide me in the oven.
+
+ 2. First lay aside your black veil, then tell us why you put it
+ on.
+
+ 3. While we were following the direction of his finger, a sound
+ of distant oars fell on our ears.
+
+ 4. If you want a thing, and have no money to buy it, go without
+ it until you can pay for it.
+
+ 5. Though the Jungle People drink seldom, they must drink deep.
+
+ 6. The whelps were evidently very young, but their ears were
+ wide open, and they stood up on strong legs when the boy
+ touched them gently with his palm.
+
+ 7. “Well,” said grandfather, “I tell you one thing; the game
+ will last me till that poor cat gets well again.”
+
+ 8. They sent him for troops only the sweepings of the galleys.
+
+ 9.
+
+ My driftwood fire will burn so bright!
+ To what warm shelter canst thou fly?
+ I do not fear for thee, though wroth
+ The tempest rushes through the sky.
+
+ 10. Caught in a steel trap, she had gnawed off her own paw as
+ the price of freedom.
+
+ 11. At recess he gave me the core of his apple, though there
+ were several applicants for it.
+
+
+
+
+XL. USES OF PERSONAL PRONOUNS
+
+
+=146.= The personal pronoun, since it takes the place of a noun, has
+almost all the uses of a noun. It may be,—
+
+(1) The subject of a verb; as, “_I_ only know _I_ cannot drift beyond His
+love and care.”
+
+The subject of an imperative sentence is always the pronoun _you_,
+_thou_, or _ye_, but this pronoun is seldom expressed; as, “Telegraph
+for staterooms at once.”
+
+(2) The base word of a term of address; as, “Ho, _ye_ who suffer, know
+ye suffer for yourselves.”
+
+(3) The subjective complement of a verb; as, “This man, good Ilderim, is
+_he_ who told you of me.”
+
+(4) The base word of an appositive phrase; as, “The fourth lackey, _he_
+of the two gold watches, poured the chocolate out.”
+
+(5) A possessive modifier; as, “All the harmless wood folk were _his_
+friends.”
+
+ NOTE.—The possessive pronoun is often intensified by the
+ adjective _own_, which modifies the same noun that the
+ possessive pronoun modifies; as, “This is _my own_, my
+ native land.”
+
+(6) The direct object of a verb; as, “The farm boy spreads the grass
+after the men have cut _it_.”
+
+(7) The object of a preposition; as, “What a new world did that party
+open to _him_!”
+
+(8) An indirect object; as, “Here will the cattle come to drink, and I
+will kill _me_ a yearling heifer.”
+
+=Exercise.=—Select and parse all the personal pronouns in the following
+sentences. In parsing a personal pronoun we should tell its person,
+number, gender, antecedent, case, and use in the sentence.
+
+ 1. I verily believe that my ill looks alone saved me a flogging.
+
+ 2. Taste the tamarisk, and you get the very flavor of the brine.
+
+ 3. Then I swung my lasso, and sent it whistling over his head.
+
+ 4. They worked together, read together, walked together,
+ planned together, she and her daughter, and in all things were
+ friends and companions.
+
+ 5. Mother Wolf would throw up her head, and sniff a deep snuff
+ of satisfaction as the wind brought her the smell of the tiger
+ skin on the Council Rock.
+
+ 6. The old crow spread the shells out in the sun, turned them
+ over, lifted them one by one in his beak, dropped them, nestled
+ on them as though they were eggs, toyed with them, and gloated
+ over them like a miser.
+
+ 7. The spirits have spoken to Kotuko. They will show him open
+ ice. He will bring us the seal again.
+
+ 8. The rank swamp grass concealed the nest where Raggylug’s
+ mother had hidden him.
+
+ 9.
+
+ Across the lowly beach we flit,
+ One little sandpiper and I.
+
+ 10. Up jumped Scarface, for it was he, and ran.
+
+ 11.
+
+ And a voice that was calmer than silence said,
+ “Lo! It is I. Be not afraid.”
+
+ 12. Nearly every cottage in England has its little garden full
+ of blooming plants and shrubs.
+
+ 13.
+
+ “Who gives himself with his alms feeds three,—
+ Himself, his hungering neighbor, and Me.”
+
+ 14. This is he that was spoken of by the prophet.
+
+ 15. Arise, and take the young child and his mother, and flee
+ into Egypt, and be thou there until I bring thee word.
+
+ 16.
+
+ I called my servant, and he came;
+ How kind it was of him
+ To mind a slender man like me,
+ He of the mighty limb.
+
+ 17. Prepare ye the way of the Lord, make his paths straight.
+
+ 18. It is so slippery and shiny down here, and the stage is so
+ much too big for me, that I rattle round in it till I’m almost
+ black and blue.
+
+ 19. These are they who have passed through much tribulation.
+
+ 20. O thou that rollest above, round as the shield of my
+ fathers, whence comes thy everlasting light?
+
+=147.= Many errors are made in the form of personal pronouns.
+
+(1) When a pronoun is used as the subject of a verb, it must have the
+nominative form, hence the correct answer to the question, Who is there?
+is _I_ (not _me_).
+
+(2) When several pronouns are used as the subject of the same verb, the
+pronoun of the second person should come first, and the pronoun of the
+first person should come last. We should say,—
+
+ _You and he and I_ have been chosen.
+
+ _You and I_ were on time.
+
+ _He and I_ read the book.
+
+Can you justify Whittier’s lines?
+
+ Ah, brother, only _I and thou_
+ Are left of all that circle now.
+
+(3) For the subject of a sentence we may use the expressions _we boys_,
+_we girls_, _we Americans_, etc.
+
+ _We girls_ bought the pictures.
+
+ _We boys_ set up the tents.
+
+ _We Baptists_ had a church supper.
+
+(4) A pronoun used as the complement of an intransitive verb of being
+must have the nominative form. We should say,—
+
+ Yes, it was _I_.
+
+ No, it was not _she_.
+
+ Perhaps it is _he_.
+
+ It is surely _they_.
+
+(5) A pronoun used as object of a verb must have the objective form. We
+should say,—
+
+ Mrs. Albee invited mother and _me_.
+
+ Did you see Julia and _me_ in the gallery?
+
+ Didn’t you expect _him and her_?
+
+ She will never suspect _you and me_.
+
+ That team can’t beat _us boys_.
+
+(6) A pronoun used as object of a preposition must have the objective
+form. We should say,—
+
+ Leo wrote first to _her_ and _me_.
+
+ Father will call for _you_ and _me_.
+
+ Between _you_ and _me_ he was afraid.
+
+ There is a great difference between Carrie and _me_.
+
+ They can never catch up with _us girls_.
+
+=Exercise.=—Fill each blank in the following sentences with a pronoun
+having the correct case form. Give your reasons.
+
+ 1. Mother says that it was —— and not —— that paid off the
+ mortgage.
+
+ 2. Who left the room first? ——, but Mary was close behind ——.
+
+ 3. —— fellows are going to have a debating society.
+
+ 4. The German teacher gave you and —— the same passage to
+ translate.
+
+ 5. There must be no secrets between —— and ——.
+
+ 6. When do you expect Grandmother and ——?
+
+ 7. Perhaps —— girls are most to blame.
+
+ 8. Nobody chose —— or ——, so —— and —— sat on the stairs and
+ talked.
+
+
+
+
+XLI. USES OF POSSESSIVE PERSONAL PRONOUNS
+
+
+=148.= When we studied the declension of personal pronouns, we learned
+that all of them except _it_ and _he_ have two forms in the possessive
+case. These forms are _my_, _mine_; _our_, _ours_; _thy_, _thine_;
+_your_, _yours_; _her_, _hers_; and _their_, _theirs_. There is a
+difference in the use of these two forms.
+
+The pronouns of the first form,—_my_, _our_, _thy_, _your_, _her_,
+and _their_, as well as _his_ and _its_, are used with nouns as
+possessive modifiers. We say, _my father_, _our school_, _her hat_, _its
+population_, etc.
+
+=149.= The pronouns of the second form,—_mine_, _ours_, _thine_, _yours_,
+_hers_, _theirs_, and also _his_, are used alone, that is, they are not
+followed by a noun, the name of the thing possessed. We say, “_Mine_ is
+too heavy,” when the object spoken of—a waterproof, for instance—is well
+known by both speaker and listener. Or we say, “Her writing is clear,
+but I like _his_ better,” where it is unnecessary to repeat the noun
+_writing_ after _his_.
+
+In the first sentence _mine_ is the subject of the verb is, and in
+the second _his_ is the object of the verb _like_. We even find the
+possessive form used as the object of a preposition; as, “If the book
+isn’t in my desk, it must be in _yours_.”
+
+This use of the possessive forms _mine_, _his_, _yours_ as subject or
+object is =idiomatic=; that is, it is peculiar to itself in grammatical
+construction. The one word _mine_ really means _my waterproof_, _his_
+means _his writing_, and _yours_ means _your desk_. But we cannot say
+that the noun is understood after these pronouns, for we cannot supply
+it except after _his_. It is not English to say _mine waterproof_ or
+_yours desk_. Instead of being understood, the nouns are included in
+the pronouns. In speaking of such pronouns we may say that they are
+possessive in form, but are used idiomatically as subject, object, etc.
+
+ NOTE.—The two pronouns _mine_ and _thine_ are sometimes used
+ to modify a noun expressed, especially in poetry; as, “Mine
+ eyes have seen the glory of the coming of the Lord.” It is
+ worth noting that they are not used before words beginning with
+ a consonant sound. We do not say _mine country_, nor _thine
+ liberty_.
+
+=150.= In the expression “a friend of mine,” we have in the phrase _of
+mine_ a “double possessive” (see § 119); for the preposition _of_ denotes
+possession, and so does the object, the possessive pronoun _mine_. In
+this use there is no noun included in the pronoun. _Mine_ does not mean
+_my friends_. It means _me_.
+
+=Summary.=—The possessive pronouns _mine_, _ours_, _thine_, _yours_,
+_hers_, _his_, and _theirs_ may be used idiomatically without a noun to
+modify. These pronouns have then the same use that the noun would have if
+it were expressed.
+
+These pronouns may be used as the object of the preposition _of_ to form
+“double possessives.”
+
+_Mine_ and _thine_ are sometimes used to modify nouns expressed, the same
+as _my_ and _thy_.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the possessive pronouns in these sentences, and
+tell their use:—
+
+ 1. You have no uncle by your father’s side or mine.
+
+ 2. To thine own self be true.
+
+ 3. The people of Europe did not know that America, this great
+ country of ours, was in the world at all.
+
+ 4. This young girl came to Wisconsin to live with an uncle of
+ hers who had seven sons and no daughters.
+
+ 5. Early in the spring I had begun Bingo’s education. Very
+ shortly afterward he began mine.
+
+ 6. Stand! The ground’s your own, my braves!
+
+ 7. A boy who lived in a street behind ours had an awkward
+ three-wheeled machine that he called a “verlosophy.”
+
+ 8.
+
+ He will say, “O Love, thine eyes
+ Build the shrine my soul abides in;
+ And I kneel here for thy grace.”
+
+ 9. The boy saw big, clutching talons outstretched from
+ thick-feathered legs, while round eyes, fiercely gleaming,
+ flamed upon his in passing, as they searched the bush.
+
+ 10. Time hath his work to do, and we have ours.
+
+ 11. The sultan ordered that the princess’s attendants should
+ come and carry the trays into their mistress’s apartment.
+
+ 12. Susie could sew like a woman, and her patchwork quilts were
+ masterpieces of their kind. Neither mine nor Marty’s were well
+ made.
+
+ 13. Your worthy father was my own brother.
+
+ 14. There was more joy in this little brown, battened house of
+ ours than in their mansion with its onyx mantels and mahogany
+ doors.
+
+Are the verbs in sentences 1, 7, 10, transitive or intransitive? How do
+you know?
+
+Account for the punctuation of sentences 3, 6, 10, 12, and 14.
+
+
+
+
+XLII. COMPOUND PERSONAL PRONOUNS
+
+
+=151.= Besides the personal pronouns that have already been considered
+there are certain other forms such as _myself_ and _ourselves_, formed
+by uniting the noun _self_ to a singular personal pronoun, and the noun
+_selves_ to a plural personal pronoun.
+
+These are called =compound personal pronouns=.
+
+ _First person_ myself, ourselves
+ _Second person_ thyself, yourself, yourselves
+ _Third person_ himself, herself, itself, themselves
+
+What is the number of each of these pronouns?
+
+=152.= Compound personal pronouns are never in the possessive case.
+They never change their form for case, but are in the nominative or the
+objective case according to their use. They have two main uses:—
+
+(1) A compound personal pronoun may be used for emphasis, and is then in
+apposition with the noun it makes emphatic; as, “Cæsar himself refused
+the crown.” The pronoun does not always come next to the noun. We may
+say, “Cæsar refused the crown himself.” The pronoun is in the same case
+as the word it goes with.
+
+(2) It may be used reflexively, that is, to show that an action comes
+back to the doer of it; as, “I scratched myself with a pin.” Here the
+pronoun is object of a verb, hence in the objective case.
+
+It may also be the object of a preposition; as, “I was talking to myself.”
+
+It may even be an indirect object; as, “She bought herself a watch.”
+
+ NOTE.—The compound personal pronoun is used as object of a
+ preposition in some familiar idiomatic expressions; as, “He was
+ _beside himself_ with joy.” “She was sitting _all by herself_.”
+
+=Summary.=—The =compound personal pronouns= are _myself_, _ourselves_,
+_thyself_, _yourself_, _yourselves_, _himself_, _herself_, _itself_, and
+_themselves_.
+
+They are commonly used for two purposes:—
+
+(1) For emphasis, (2) reflexively.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select and parse all the compound personal pronouns in the
+following sentences. Tell their person, number, case, and use.
+
+ 1. Love thyself last.
+
+ 2. The men folks, having worked in the regular hours, lie down
+ and rest, stretch themselves idly in the shade at noon, or
+ lounge about after supper.
+
+ 3. Very stupid people are never aware of their stupidity
+ themselves.
+
+ 4. On cold, stormy evenings we would make ourselves toast at
+ the sitting room fire, and eat our supper on the little sewing
+ table.
+
+ 5. At the more remote end of the island Legrand had built
+ himself a small hut.
+
+ 6. A masterly retreat is in itself a victory.
+
+ 7. Now make yourselves at home, and if you find an eel’s head,
+ you may bring it to me.
+
+ 8. The little fox ground his pearly milk teeth into the mouse
+ with a rush of inborn savageness that must have surprised even
+ himself.
+
+ 9. They were returning home for the holidays in high glee, and
+ promising themselves a world of enjoyment.
+
+ 10. Pity for his gallant horse, rage and mortification at the
+ ridiculous plight he was in, anxiety lest he should be late
+ for the tournament, all combined to make the baron for a time
+ beside himself.
+
+ 11. Rivermouth itself is full of hints and flavors of the sea.
+
+ 12. I think the ugly duckling will grow up strong, and be able
+ to take care of himself.
+
+ 13. With what awe, yet with what pride, did I look forward to
+ the day when I myself should enter the doorway of the high
+ school.
+
+ 14. That I may have nobody to blame but myself should my
+ marriage turn out amiss, I will choose for myself.
+
+ 15. Although the English and we ourselves both speak the same
+ tongue, we do not speak it in the same way.
+
+ 16. Heaven helps those who help themselves.
+
+Analyze sentences 1, 3, 4, 6, 9, 11.
+
+
+
+
+XLIII. INTERROGATIVE PRONOUNS
+
+
+=153.= If we ask the question, “Who killed cock robin?” the answer may be
+the declarative sentence, “The sparrow killed cock robin.” The sentences
+are alike, except that in the declarative sentence _the sparrow_ is the
+subject, while in the interrogative sentence _who_ is the subject. It is
+clear then that _who_ is used instead of the noun _sparrow_. _Who_ is
+therefore a pronoun, and since it is used in asking a question, we call
+it an =interrogative pronoun=.
+
+=154.= The other interrogative pronouns are _whose_, _whom_, _which_, and
+_what_. _Whose_ is the possessive form of _who_, and is used, like other
+possessive pronouns, to modify some noun expressed or understood; as,
+“Whose house is the gray stone mansion on the corner?”
+
+_Whom_ is the objective form of _who_, and is used as the object of a
+verb or of a preposition; as, “Whom did he marry?” “To whom did you
+speak?”
+
+ NOTE.—In conversation, the preposition governing an
+ interrogative pronoun is often placed at the end of the
+ question; as, “Whom did you come for?”
+
+=155.= _What_ is used when we inquire for the name, not of a person but
+of a thing; as, “What did he have on his head?”
+
+=156.= _Which_ is used when we wish to know the particular one of several
+persons or things; as, “Which of these moon-stones do you like best?”
+
+=157.= In a sentence like this, “Who is that tall man?” it may be
+difficult at first thought to decide whether _who_ is the subject of _is_
+or the subjective complement. We can always tell by the answer. In this
+case the answer is, “That tall man is Joseph Choate.” It is clear that
+_Joseph Choate_ is the subjective complement, hence in the question the
+word _who_, which means _Joseph Choate_, is the subjective complement.
+
+=Summary.=—An =interrogative pronoun= is one used in asking a question.
+
+The interrogative pronouns are _who_, _which_, and _what_.
+
+_Who_ is declined: Nominative, _who_; possessive, _whose_; objective,
+_whom_.
+
+An interrogative pronoun has the same use in the question that the word
+which takes its place has in the answer.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the interrogative pronouns in these sentences.
+Tell the use and case of each. Determine this by answering the question
+that is asked.
+
+Analyze sentences 1, 4, 6, 8, 10, 11, 12, 15.
+
+ 1. What made you so late?
+
+ 2. Who is there?
+
+ 3. Who is this young and handsome officer now entering the door
+ of the tavern?
+
+ 4. Whose work is this crayon drawing of a castle in the
+ moonlight?
+
+ 5. What do you mean by telling me such nonsense as that?
+
+ 6. What may so bold a hunter kill?
+
+ 7. Who should know better than I?
+
+ 8. What is all this talk about the Red Flower?
+
+ 9. What is gingerbread?
+
+ 10. Whose is this image and superscription?
+
+ 11. With whom did you take that memorable trip on Lake Superior?
+
+ 12. Whose little girl are you, with your rosy cheeks and pretty
+ red hood?
+
+ 13. Whom did the superintendent mean when he announced that the
+ youngest pupil in the grammar school had made one hundred in
+ all her examinations?
+
+ 14. Which should you rather be, an artist or a poet?
+
+ 15. Which shall I take, a new piano or a trip to California?
+
+=158.= A common error in the use of interrogative pronouns is the use of
+the nominative form _who_ when the objective _whom_ is required. This
+error arises from the fact that the pronoun comes at the beginning of the
+sentence, and is separated by intervening words from the verb or the
+preposition of which it is the object, as in these sentences,—
+
+ Whom did the ball hit?
+
+ Whom do you sit with this term?
+
+=Exercise.=—Supply the proper pronoun, _who_ or _whom_, in each of the
+following sentences, and give your reasons:—
+
+ 1. —— does the baby look like?
+
+ 2. —— do I see in the orchard?
+
+ 3. —— did you go to the station for this morning?
+
+ 4. —— are you smiling at, George?
+
+ 5. —— does Mr. Coburn work for now?
+
+ 6. —— will open this window for me?
+
+ 7. —— can we depend upon?
+
+ 8. —— is that child playing with?
+
+ 9. —— have you invited to your party?
+
+ 10. —— can keep a secret?
+
+
+
+
+XLIV. DESCRIPTIVE ADJECTIVES
+
+
+=159.= We learned in Lesson IX that adjectives are used (1) to describe
+objects, (2) to point them out. Adjectives are therefore divided into two
+classes,—(1) =descriptive adjectives=, and (2) =limiting adjectives=.
+
+=160.= Descriptive adjectives tell the qualities of objects. They are
+very useful words, for they enable us to see things with the imagination.
+In the following sentence the well-chosen adjectives make us feel that
+we are looking into the very eyes of the eagle,—“His eyes, clear,
+direct, unacquainted with fear, had a certain hardness in their vitreous
+brilliancy, perhaps by reason of the sharp contrast between the bright
+gold iris and the unfathomable pupil.”
+
+It is also through descriptive adjectives that we are able to identify
+things when we do see them. After reading this sentence we could pick out
+a moose calf from a score of other animals,—“The moose calf is uncouth,
+to be sure, with his high, humped fore shoulders, his long, lugubrious,
+overhanging snout, his big ears set low on his big head, his little
+eyes crowded back toward his ears, his long, big-knuckled legs, and the
+spindling lank diminutiveness of his hind quarters.”
+
+=161.= One variety of descriptive adjective is the adjective derived from
+a proper noun; as, _Scotch_ from _Scotland_, _French_ from _France_, and
+_Greek_ from _Greece_. These are called =proper adjectives=.
+
+Proper adjectives include within themselves many other adjectives. If
+we speak of a Scotch collie, a French costume, or a Grecian nose, the
+listener gets the same picture that he would get if we used a long series
+of other adjectives.
+
+=162.= Many proper adjectives may be used as proper nouns, naming a class
+of people, as when we speak of the Scotch, the French, the Russians, the
+Americans.
+
+What proper noun have we to name the inhabitants of Spain? of Turkey? of
+Denmark? of Sweden?
+
+What proper noun have we to designate one man who is a native of England?
+of Scotland? of France? of China? Italy? Germany? What is the plural of
+each of these nouns?
+
+=Exercise.=—Supply the correct word in each of the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. Three (_French_ or _Frenchmen_) spent the evening at the
+ house.
+
+ 2. The (_French_ or _Frenchmen_) are said to be very polite.
+
+ 3. Why are so many (_Scotch_ or _Scotchmen_) captains of
+ steamships?
+
+ 4. Are the (_Irish_ or _Irishmen_) as thrifty as the Germans?
+
+ 5. Are there many (_Welsh_ or _Welshmen_) in this locality?
+
+=Summary.=—=Descriptive adjectives= are those which tell the qualities of
+objects.
+
+=Proper adjectives= are those derived from proper nouns. They always
+begin with a capital letter.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Write a list of the proper adjectives derived from the
+following proper nouns. Use them in sentences to modify appropriate nouns.
+
+ Africa
+ Alaska
+ Asia
+ China
+ Christ
+ Denmark
+ England
+ Germany
+ India
+ Ireland
+ Italy
+ Japan
+ Jew
+ Malta
+ Norway
+ Paris
+ Portugal
+ Spain
+ Sweden
+ Turkey
+
+=Exercise 2.=—In the following sentences select all the descriptive
+adjectives and tell what objects they describe. In so far as you can,
+tell what qualities the adjectives denote, as color, size, form,
+texture, surface, material, nature, etc. Account for the punctuation and
+capitalization.
+
+ 1. All the time the crocodile’s little eyes burned like coals
+ under the heavy, horny eyelids on the top of his triangular
+ head, as he shoved his bloated barrel body along between his
+ crutched legs.
+
+ 2. It is a little village of great antiquity, having been
+ founded by some of the Dutch colonists in the early times of
+ the province.
+
+ 3. The dog and his master hunted together, fur-wrapped boy and
+ savage, long-haired, narrow-eyed, white-fanged, yellow brute.
+
+ 4. We always smiled to hear the judge’s wife talk about her
+ Turkish carpets, her little Chippendale chairs, her Wedgwood
+ china, and her Persian shawls.
+
+ 5. This crowded, lively, and interesting thoroughfare is over
+ two miles long.
+
+ 6. In queer little _châlets_, or Swiss huts, live the people
+ who attend to the cattle, and make butter and cheese.
+
+ 7. The split and weatherworn rocks of the gorge had been used
+ since the beginning of the Jungle by the Little People of the
+ Rocks,—the busy, furious, black, wild bees of India.
+
+ 8. At every stride the loose-hung, wide-cleft, spreading hoofs
+ of the moose came sharply together with a flat, clacking noise.
+
+ 9. Out comes the negro pilot, and scrambles up on deck.
+
+ 10. Yonder lies a Norwegian ship, with her sailors climbing the
+ shrouds like so many monkeys.
+
+ 11. Mowgli’s voice could be heard in all sorts of wet,
+ starlighted, blossoming places, helping the big frogs through
+ their choruses, or mocking the upside-down owls that hoot
+ through the white nights.
+
+
+
+
+XLV. LIMITING ADJECTIVES
+
+
+=163.= Limiting adjectives are those which merely point out an object
+without telling any quality of it. The most useful limiting adjectives
+are _this_, _that_, and their plural forms _these_ and _those_. These
+four words are often called =demonstrative adjectives=.
+
+Some limiting adjectives tell number or amount, but in a somewhat
+indefinite way, as _all_, _some_, _several_, _few_, _much_, _little_,
+_more_, _most_.
+
+Some tell number definitely, as _one_, _two_, _six hundred_, _three
+million_, _first_, _second_, _fiftieth_.
+
+Number words, like _one_, _two_, _three_, _four_, _five_, etc., are often
+called =numeral adjectives=.
+
+=164.= The limiting adjective _enough_ may precede or follow the noun it
+modifies. We may say _enough butter_ or _butter enough_; _enough time_ or
+_time enough_.
+
+The limiting adjective _else_ always follows the noun or pronoun that it
+modifies. We say _who else_, _nobody else_, _everybody else_, _nothing
+else_.
+
+=165.= When the interrogative pronouns _which_ and _what_ are used to
+modify a noun, as in _which picture?_ _what city?_ they cease to be
+pronouns, and become limiting adjectives. Since they are used to ask
+questions, we call them =interrogative adjectives=.
+
+ NOTE.—_Which_ and _what_, when used as adjectives, are
+ sometimes called =pronominal adjectives=.
+
+=166.= Three very common words, _a_, _an_, and _the_, are classed with
+limiting adjectives. They are called =articles.= _The_ is a =definite
+article=; _an_ and _a_ are the =indefinite article=. _A_ is really the
+same word as _an_, but when it is used before a word beginning with a
+consonant sound, as _bicycle_, the _n_ is dropped for the sake of a more
+pleasing sound.
+
+=167.= We use _the_ when we wish to specify a particular object, and _an_
+or _a_ when we do not care to be specific. What is the difference between
+these sentences?
+
+ The man on horseback came to the turn in the road.
+
+ A man on horseback came to a turn in the road.
+
+=168.= We use _the_ before a singular noun to designate a whole class of
+objects; as, “The oak is a sturdy tree,” “The cow is a domestic animal.”
+
+=169.= We repeat the article when we wish to denote more than one person
+or thing. What is the difference between these pairs of sentences?
+
+ (_a_) The secretary and treasurer came late.
+ (_b_) The secretary and the treasurer came together.
+
+ (_a_) I saw a red and green signal.
+ (_b_) I saw a red and a green signal.
+
+=170.= We use _an_ or _a_ after the adjectives _many_ and _such_ instead
+of before them; as, _many_ a man, _such_ a storm.
+
+=171.= The sentence, “I have _few_ books,” means I have few compared
+with many; but the sentence, “I have _a few_ books,” means I have a few
+compared with none. What is the difference in meaning between these
+sentences?
+
+ I have little time for sewing.
+
+ I have a little time for sewing.
+
+=Summary.=—=Limiting adjectives= are those which merely point out.
+
+Limiting adjectives that denote a definite number are called =numerals=.
+
+_Which_ and _what_ may be used as =interrogative adjectives=.
+
+The =articles= are _the_, _an_, and _a_.
+
+_The_ is a =definite article=. _An_ and _a_ are =indefinite articles=.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Select all the limiting adjectives, including articles, and
+tell what they modify. Give reasons for the articles used.
+
+ 1. What business brings you here?
+
+ 2. In that same village, and in one of these very houses, there
+ lived, many years since, a simple, good-natured fellow of the
+ name of Rip Van Winkle.
+
+ 3. Every change of season, every change of weather, indeed,
+ every hour of the day, produces some change in the magical hues
+ and shapes of these mountains.
+
+ 4. Which fan did your mother carry when she was a young lady in
+ Maine?
+
+ 5. Lobo had only five followers during the latter part of his
+ reign.
+
+ 6. What excuse shall I make to Dame Van Winkle?
+
+ 7. The dog managed so that each fresh rush should be toward the
+ settlement.
+
+ 8. No wild animal dies of old age.
+
+ 9. Which part in the play of _Julius Cæsar_ did Edwin Booth
+ take?
+
+ 10. When this dog of marvelous wind saw that the wolf was dead,
+ he gave him no second glance.
+
+ 11. After much pains on my behalf and many pains on his, Bingo
+ learned to go at the word in quest of our old yellow cow.
+
+ 12.
+
+ I only ask a hut of stone,
+ A very plain brown stone will do,
+ That I may call my own;
+ And close at hand is such a one
+ In yonder street that fronts the sun.
+
+ 13. No other living thing can go so slow as a boy sent on an
+ errand.
+
+ 14. What courage can withstand the ever-during and
+ all-besetting terrors of a woman’s tongue?
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Classify the words _which_ and _what_ in the following
+sentences as interrogative pronouns or interrogative adjectives. Where
+they are pronouns, tell their case. Where they are adjectives, tell what
+they modify.
+
+ 1. What have you in your basket?
+
+ 2. What manner of man is this?
+
+ 3. Which of these pictures did you paint?
+
+ 4. Which is it, a toadstool or a mushroom?
+
+ 5. Which city has the larger population?
+
+ 6. Which boy threw the stone?
+
+ 7. What stone did he throw?
+
+ 8. What did the man come for?
+
+ 9. What do you want?
+
+ 10. Which will you take?
+
+
+
+
+XLVI. COMPARISON OF ADJECTIVES
+
+
+=172.= Since different objects may possess the same quality in different
+degrees, there must be some means of telling this. We do it by changing
+the form of adjectives. For instance, wool, snow, and feathers have
+the same quality of softness, but not in the same degree, so we say
+that wool is _soft_, snow is _softer_, and feathers are _softest_. This
+change in the adjective soft to denote the degree of softness is called
+=comparison=.
+
+=173.= Comparison is a =property= of adjectives. There are three
+=degrees= of comparison,—the =positive=, the =comparative=, and the
+=superlative=.
+
+The positive degree denotes the simple quality, the comparative degree
+denotes more or less of this quality, and the superlative denotes most or
+least of this quality. When we give the three forms of an adjective, we
+are said to =compare= it. We compare _bold_ by saying: positive, _bold_;
+comparative, _bolder_; superlative, _boldest_; or positive, _bold_;
+comparative, _less bold_; superlative, _least bold_.
+
+=174.= Comparison is denoted in three ways:—
+
+(1) By adding the suffixes _er_ and _est_. These are added to adjectives
+of one syllable, and to a few of two syllables; as, _fine_, _finer_,
+_finest_; _lovely_, _lovelier_, _loveliest_.
+
+(2) By prefixing the adverbs _more_ and _most_. This method is used in
+comparing longer adjectives; as, _spacious_, _more spacious_, _most
+spacious_; _disagreeable_, _more disagreeable_, _most disagreeable_.
+
+(3) By prefixing the adverbs _less_ and _least_; as, _rough_, _less_
+_rough_, _least rough_; _elegant_; _less elegant_, _least elegant_. This
+is a mode of comparing adjectives on a descending scale instead of an
+ascending scale.
+
+=175.= Some adjectives cannot be compared at all; as, _asleep_, _dead_,
+_correct_, _round_, _square_, _principal_. Instead of saying _rounder_,
+we may say _more nearly round_.
+
+=176.= Some adjectives are compared irregularly. The following are
+examples:—
+
+ POSITIVE COMPARATIVE SUPERLATIVE
+
+ good better best
+ ill worse worst
+ bad worse worst
+ many more most
+ much more most
+ little less least
+ far farther _or_ further farthest _or_ furthest
+
+=Summary.=—=Comparison= in an adjective is a change of form to express
+quality or quantity in different degrees.
+
+There are three =degrees= of comparison,—=positive=, =comparative=, and
+=superlative=.
+
+Short adjectives are compared by adding the suffixes _er_ and _est_.
+
+Longer adjectives are compared by prefixing _more_ and _most_.
+
+Many adjectives may be compared on a descending scale by prefixing _less_
+and _least_.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the adjectives, and tell the kind and the degree
+of each. Compare each adjective. If any cannot be compared, state that
+fact.
+
+ 1. There was nothing in these woods bigger than a weasel.
+
+ 2. The way led through the deepest and most perilous part of
+ the swamp.
+
+ 3. This brother was younger and handsomer, and much more
+ amiable than William.
+
+ 4. As she grew older, she became less exacting and more
+ tolerant, less certain and more hopeful, less vigorous in body,
+ but gentler in manner and sweeter in spirit.
+
+ 5. The Hotel de Cluny is one of the quaintest, queerest,
+ pleasantest, and most homelike places we are likely to meet
+ with.
+
+ 6. The other captive was of a more restless temperament,
+ slenderer in build, more eager and alert of eye, less
+ companionable of mood.
+
+ 7. Least vague of all was the terror of the usually unterrified
+ weasel.
+
+ 8. Those men are most apt to be obsequious and conciliating
+ abroad, who are under the discipline of shrews at home.
+
+ 9. At the least flourish of a broomstick or a ladle, Wolf would
+ fly to the door with yelping precipitation.
+
+ 10. The lynx was smaller than her mate, somewhat browner in
+ hue, leaner, and of a peculiarly malignant expression.
+
+ 11. The women of the village used to employ Rip to do such
+ little odd jobs as their less obliging husbands would not do
+ for them.
+
+ 12. The singing master’s hair was a little longer, his hands
+ were a little whiter, his shoes a little thinner, his manner a
+ trifle more polished than that of his soberer mates.
+
+Tell the use of adjectives in sentences 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 12.
+
+=177.= Sometimes errors are made in the use of adjectives.
+
+The comparative degree should be used in comparing two objects, the
+superlative in comparing more than two. If only two roads are open to us,
+we ought to say that we shall take the _shorter_.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select the proper adjective for each of these sentences, and
+give your reasons:—
+
+ 1. Which would be the (_cheapest_ or _cheaper_) route—by water
+ or by rail?
+
+ 2. Prince is the (_swifter_ or _swiftest_) horse, but Pete is
+ the (_stronger_ or _strongest_).
+
+ 3. Which is the (_higher_ or _highest_)—the Eiffel Tower or the
+ Washington Monument?
+
+ 4. Of the two leading candidates, Wilson and Harmon, which is
+ (_more likely_ or _most likely_) to be nominated?
+
+Sometimes an ill-chosen adjective is used after the verb _feel_. The
+sentence, “I feel _good_,” is correct only when it means “I feel
+righteous,” while “I feel _well_,” means “I am in good health.” In this
+sentence _well_ is an adjective meaning the opposite of _sick_.
+
+ NOTE.—We also have the adverb _well_, denoting manner, as in
+ the sentence, “LaFollette spoke _well_.”
+
+The sentence, “Rufus looks _good_,” is correct when we mean that Rufus
+looks as if he were a good man; but we should say, “Rufus looks _well_
+(not _good_) in gray.” Here _well_ is an adjective meaning pleasing or
+acceptable.
+
+The limiting adjectives _this_ and _these_ should not be followed by the
+word _here_. We point out sufficiently when we say _this book_, _these
+books_.
+
+The personal pronoun _them_ should never be used for the limiting
+adjective _those_. We should say _those horses_, _those wagons_, _those
+tents_.
+
+If we modify a noun by the limiting adjective _each_, _every_, _either_,
+_neither_, or _no_, we must use a singular pronoun to represent that
+noun; as,—
+
+ Each man took _his_ appointed place.
+
+ Every girl made _her_ own costume.
+
+ Neither man lost _his_ job.
+
+=Exercise.=—Supply the correct pronoun in each of these sentences:—
+
+ NOTE.—The masculine pronoun should be used when there is no
+ word in the sentence that indicates whether the male or the
+ female sex is referred to.
+
+ 1. Everybody came and brought —— appetite.
+
+ 2. Each lady contributed whatever —— chose.
+
+ 3. No young person can afford to waste —— time.
+
+ 4. Neither doctor will give —— assistance.
+
+ 5. No day is without —— disappointments.
+
+ 6. If either man calls, tell —— that I am busy.
+
+ 7. Every girl in the class said that —— did not understand the
+ lesson.
+
+ 8. Every boy wishes that —— might be president.
+
+ 9. No soldier acknowledged that —— was afraid.
+
+ 10. Neither chair is in —— place.
+
+
+
+
+XLVII. REVIEW OF ADJECTIVES
+
+
+=178.= In our study of adjectives in Lessons IX, XXVI, XXXIII, XXXVII,
+XLIV, XLV, and XLVI we have learned that adjectives may be classified
+as limiting adjectives and descriptive adjectives; that _which_ and
+_what_ are interrogative adjectives; that adjectives have the property
+of comparison; and that adjectives may be used in four different ways:
+(1) before a noun to modify that noun; (2) after a noun as an appositive
+modifier; (3) as a subjective complement of certain intransitive verbs,
+and (4) as the objective complement of certain transitive verbs.
+
+=Exercise.=—Make an outline of the subject, Adjectives, to recite from in
+class. Illustrate each point you make with a good sentence of your own
+composition.
+
+=179.= When we parse an adjective, we should tell:—
+
+(1) Its class,—descriptive, limiting, or interrogative.
+
+(2) Its degree (if it admits of comparison).
+
+(3) Its use, and what it modifies.
+
+=Exercise.=—Parse each adjective in the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. The puppy grew bigger and clumsier each day. His most
+ friendly overtures to the cat were wholly misunderstood.
+
+ 2. Paris is an immense city, full of broad and handsome
+ streets, magnificent buildings, grand open places with
+ fountains and statues, great public gardens and parks free to
+ everybody.
+
+ 3. His gray eyes, clear and kind, flashed like fire when he
+ spoke of his adventures.
+
+ 4. Which picture shall we hang between these two front
+ windows—the little Nydia or this pretty landscape?
+
+ 5. It was clear that the whelps of last spring had betaken
+ themselves to other and safer hunting grounds.
+
+ 6. For a moment the boy felt afraid—afraid in his own woods.
+
+ 7. Below us lies a lake, clear and cold, whereon fairies might
+ launch their airy shallops.
+
+ 8. Jo Calone threw down his saddle on the dusty ground, and
+ turned his horses loose.
+
+ 9. What fun the rabbits must have been having!
+
+ 10. The full moon of October, deep orange in a clear, deep sky,
+ hung large and somewhat distorted just over the wooded hills.
+
+ 11. For a long time pain and hunger kept me awake.
+
+ 12. How sweet and demure those girls looked!
+
+ 13. Do you suppose that any old Roman ever had twenty-four
+ different kinds of pie at one dinner?
+
+ 14. There was something in their cries that sounded strangely
+ wild and fierce.
+
+ 15. The cardinal bird drew herself up very straight, raised her
+ crest, and opened her big beak.
+
+ 16. What harm can a naked frog do us?
+
+ 17. Land in London is so valuable that a single acre of it has
+ been sold for four and a half million dollars.
+
+ 18. The old servant made our lives miserable by her
+ cantankerous ways.
+
+
+
+
+XLVIII. ADJECTIVE PRONOUNS
+
+
+=180.= When we say, “This ring was my mother’s,” we use the word _this_
+as an adjective modifying the noun _ring_. When we say, “This was my
+mother’s ring,” we use the one word _this_ in place of _this ring_ as
+subject of the sentence, hence _this_ is no longer an adjective, but has
+become a pronoun. Since its ordinary use is that of an adjective, we call
+it an =adjective pronoun=.
+
+Many limiting adjectives may be used as pronouns. We often make such
+sentences as these:—
+
+ _Few_ shall part where _many_ meet.
+
+ If honor is lost, then _all_ is lost.
+
+ When _two_ or _three_ are gathered together in Thy name, Thou
+ wilt grant their requests.
+
+=181.= The commonest adjective pronouns are _all_, _any_, _each_,
+_either_, _few_, _first_, _former_, _last_, _little_, _many_, _more_,
+_most_, _much_, _neither_, _one_, _other_, _several_, _some_, _this_,
+_that_, _these_, _those_.
+
+Make sentences containing five of these adjective pronouns.
+
+=182.= Two adjective pronouns, _one_ and _other_, may be declined.
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ _Nom._ one ones other others
+ _Poss._ one’s ones’ other’s others’
+ _Obj._ one ones other others
+
+Sentences like these are common:—
+
+ One sometimes tires of _one’s_ occupation.
+
+ Each envied the _other’s_ good fortune.
+
+The two adjective pronouns, _one_ and _other_, may be modified by
+adjectives; as, “Many others came,” “The green ones are the prettiest.”
+
+_Each other_ and _one another_, though consisting of two words, may be
+considered as one adjective pronoun.
+
+=183.= Some adjective pronouns may be modified by articles. We say, “_The
+last_ is the best of all the game,” “I like gooseberries, so I picked _a
+few_.”
+
+=Summary.=—An =adjective pronoun= is a limiting adjective used in place
+of a noun.
+
+The adjective pronouns _one_ and _other_ may be declined.
+
+Some adjective pronouns may be modified by adjectives.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select the adjective pronouns in these sentences. Tell the
+use and case of each. Tell the noun that each pronoun stands for. Supply
+this noun where you can. What part of speech does the adjective pronoun
+become then?
+
+ 1. This is the story of a bad boy.
+
+ 2. Many of the protozoa are very beautiful. Some build shells
+ for themselves of strange and curious shapes.
+
+ 3. The ham turned out to be a very remarkable one.
+
+ 4. There is a vast difference between the styles of 1860 and
+ 1900. The former favored Paisley shawls and flounced skirts,
+ the latter sanctioned the tailor-made suit and the shirt waist.
+
+ 5. A little made us very happy once.
+
+ 6. From time to time one or another of the leaping rabbits
+ would take himself off through the fir trees, while others
+ continued to arrive along the moonlight trails.
+
+ 7. All is of God that is or is to be.
+
+ 8. A bluejay and a red squirrel were loudly berating each other
+ for stealing.
+
+ 9. The convenience of resting one’s self in the open air is one
+ of the comforts of Paris.
+
+ 10. Each of these was a wolf of renown; most of them were
+ above the ordinary size; one in particular, the second in
+ command, was a veritable giant. Several of the band were
+ especially noted. One of them was a beautiful white wolf, that
+ the Mexicans called Blanca; this was supposed to be a female,
+ possibly Lobo’s mate. Another was a yellow wolf of remarkable
+ swiftness.
+
+ 11. It is not easy to change one’s life all in a minute.
+
+ 12. It is a blessed fact that one’s own home is the hub of the
+ universe.
+
+ 13. Every one said that I was a tomboy.
+
+ 14. Some wore short doublets, others jerkins, with long knives
+ in their belts, and most of them had enormous breeches of
+ similar style with that of the guide’s.
+
+ 15. The years hurry onward, treading in their haste on one
+ another’s heels.
+
+What noun is understood after _guide’s_ in sentence 14?
+
+
+
+
+XLIX. VERBS: TENSE
+
+
+=184.= Three very common words are _yesterday_, _to-day_, and
+_to-morrow_. The word _yesterday_ refers to time that has gone, or
+past time; _to-day_ refers to time that now is, or =present= time; and
+_to-morrow_ refers to time that is to come, or =future= time.
+
+=185.= Every event takes place in time, and so when we tell of the
+occurrence of any event, we must have some way of making clear whether
+that event took place in the past, or is taking place in the present, or
+will take place in the future. Of course, we might tell this by adverbs
+or adverbial phrases, but we have a very much better way,—we tell it by
+the form of the verb we use. What time do we think of when we see the
+verbs _eats_, _works_, _plays_, _sleeps_? What time is told by the verbs
+_ate_, _worked_, _played_, _slept_? What change is made in the form of
+the two sets of verbs? What time is told by the verbs _will eat_, _will
+work_, _will play_, _will sleep_?
+
+=186.= In the last group of verbs, where each verb consists of two words,
+it is the first word _will_ that denotes future time. Such a word is
+called a helping word, or =auxiliary= verb.
+
+=187.= The change in the form of a verb to denote time is called =tense=.
+
+=188.= Tense is a property of all verbs. It is evident that there must be
+three tenses,—present, past, and future, as shown in the three sets of
+verbs that have just been examined. These are called =primary= tenses.
+
+There are three other tenses, called =secondary= tenses. We may say, “I
+_have eaten_ my supper,” “I _had eaten_ my supper,” “I _shall have eaten_
+my supper.” These verbs call attention not so much to the time of the
+action as to the fact that it is completed, or perfected.
+
+_Have eaten_ means that a past action is completed at the present time.
+This form is called the =present perfect= tense.
+
+_Had eaten_ means that a past action was completed before some particular
+past time. This form is called the =past perfect= tense.
+
+_Shall have eaten_ means that an action will be completed before some
+definite future time. This is called the =future perfect= tense.
+
+=Summary.=—=Tense= is that property of a verb which denotes the time of
+an action or an event.
+
+There are six tenses:—
+
+(1) The =present tense= denotes that an action is taking place. It
+usually consists of one word, the simplest form of the verb.
+
+(2) The =past tense= denotes that an action did take place. It usually
+consists of one word.
+
+(3) The =future tense= denotes that an action will take place. It
+consists of two words, one of which is the auxiliary _shall_ or _will_.
+
+(4) The =present perfect tense= denotes that a past action is now
+completed. It consists of two words, one of which is the auxiliary _have_
+or _has_.
+
+(5) The =past perfect tense= denotes that a past action was completed
+before a particular past time. It consists of two words, one of which is
+the auxiliary _had_.
+
+(6) The =future perfect tense= denotes that a future action will be
+completed before a particular future time. It consists of three words,
+one of which is the auxiliary _have_, and another the auxiliary _shall_
+or _will_.
+
+ NOTES.—1. The present tense is used also to denote (1) that
+ something is true at all times; as “Waste makes want,” and (2)
+ that something occurs habitually; as, “She teaches school.”
+
+ 2. When a predicate consists of a series of verbs in the same
+ tense, the auxiliary is usually expressed only with the first
+ verb. In the sentence, “Now that he has eaten and slept, he
+ is ready for work,” the second verb is _has slept_, with the
+ auxiliary understood.
+
+=189.= A common error is the use of the present perfect tense for the
+past tense. We say, “I _have been_ in Florida several times,” because
+we mean several times before now; but we say, “I _was_ in Florida last
+year,” because we mean that our being there occurred in past time with
+no reference whatever to the present. If we are still in Florida we may
+say, “I _have been_ in Florida a long time”; but if we are no longer in
+Florida we say, “I _was_ in Florida a long time.”
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Justify the use of the past or the present perfect tense in
+each of these sentences:—
+
+ 1. I learned the poem last evening.
+
+ 2. I have learned the poem already.
+
+ 3. I bought my hat at Stone’s.
+
+ 4. I have bought a new spring hat.
+
+ 5. I came home last Monday.
+
+ 6. I have come to stay a week.
+
+ 7. I tried my skates this afternoon.
+
+ 8. I haven’t tried my new skates.
+
+ 9. I have walked ever since sunrise.
+
+ 10. I walked from sunrise until noon.
+
+ 11. I spoke to the President this morning.
+
+ 12. I have never spoken to the President.
+
+ 13. I spoke to him twice when I was in Washington.
+
+ 14. I have spoken to him several times.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Using the subject _I_, form the six tenses of the following
+verbs. Consult the dictionary for forms of which you are not sure.
+
+ break
+ bring
+ buy
+ come
+ drive
+ go
+ leave
+ love
+ run
+ see
+ sing
+ take
+ turn
+ wait
+
+=Exercise 3.=—Select all the verbs in these sentences, and tell the tense
+of each:—
+
+ 1. Trees wave, flowers bloom, and bright-winged birds flit from
+ palm to cedar.
+
+ 2. The lynx turned to the right, along a well-worn trail,
+ ran up a tree, descended hastily, and glided away among the
+ thickets.
+
+ 3. Tommy and I had played together till five o’clock that
+ Saturday afternoon.
+
+ 4. The children thought, “how long the vacation will be!” but
+ the mother thought, “how soon it will have come and gone.”
+
+ 5. He who knows nothing fears nothing.
+
+ 6. The duck had never seen a guinea egg before in all her life.
+
+ 7. The boy comes nearer to perpetual motion than anything else
+ in nature.
+
+ 8. Nobody has yet discovered how many grasshoppers a turkey
+ will hold.
+
+ 9. I have made no addition to my cabinet since we met.
+
+ 10. The big black pots swinging from the cranes had bubbled and
+ gurgled and sent out puffs of appetizing steam.
+
+ 11. “How many pieces shall I cut this pie into?” said she.
+
+ 12. I have seen wild bees and butterflies feeding at a height
+ of 13,000 feet above the sea.
+
+ 13. You shall go to bed, and I will remain with you a few days
+ until you get over this fever.
+
+ 14. The daisies have shut up their sleepy red eyes.
+
+Analyze sentences 2, 3, 6, 9, 14.
+
+
+
+
+L. THE INDICATIVE MODE
+
+
+=190.= Each of the six verb forms that we have been studying,—I _eat_,
+I _ate_, I _shall eat_, I _have eaten_, I _had eaten_, I _shall have
+eaten_,—is used in the statement of a fact, and is said to be in the
+=indicative mode=.
+
+Mode is that property of a verb which denotes the manner of an assertion.
+
+The indicative mode is used in the statement of a fact.
+
+=191.= In some tenses there is a slight difference between the singular
+and the plural form of a verb, hence verbs are said to have the property
+of =number=. We should always use the verb form that agrees with the
+number of the subject. In the present tense, for example, we say in the
+singular, “The man _goes_;” and in the plural, “The men _go_.”
+
+=192.= In some tenses there is a slight difference in the form of the
+verb to denote person, hence verbs are said to have the property of
+=person=. In the present perfect tense, we say in the first person, “I
+_have_ gone;” and in the third person, “He _has_ gone.”
+
+=193.= When we give all the forms of a verb in the three persons and the
+two numbers of each tense, we are said to =conjugate= the verb.
+
+=194.= Conjugation of the verb _be_ in the indicative mode:—
+
+ PRESENT TENSE PAST TENSE
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ I am we are I was we were
+ thou art you are thou wast you were
+ he is they are he was they were
+
+ FUTURE TENSE PRESENT PERFECT TENSE
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ I shall be we shall be I have been we have been
+ thou wilt be you will be thou hast been you have been
+ he will be they will be he has been they have been
+
+ PAST PERFECT TENSE
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ I had been we had been
+ thou hadst been you had been
+ he had been they had been
+
+ FUTURE PERFECT TENSE
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ I shall have been we shall have been
+ thou wilt have been you will have been
+ he will have been they will have been
+
+=195.= Conjugation of _see_ in the indicative mode:—
+
+ PRESENT TENSE PAST TENSE
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ I see we see I saw we saw
+ thou seest you see thou sawest you saw
+ he sees they see he saw they saw
+
+ FUTURE TENSE PRESENT PERFECT TENSE
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ I shall see we shall see I have seen we have seen
+ thou wilt see you will see thou hast seen you have seen
+ he will see they will see he has seen they have seen
+
+ PAST PERFECT TENSE
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ I had seen we had seen
+ thou hadst seen you had seen
+ he had seen they had seen
+
+ FUTURE PERFECT TENSE
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ I shall have seen we shall have seen
+ thou wilt have seen you will have seen
+ he will have seen they will have seen
+
+=Exercise.=—Conjugate the verbs in Exercise 2, p. 126, in the six tenses
+of the Indicative Mode.
+
+
+
+
+LI. THE INTERROGATIVE FORM OF THE INDICATIVE MODE
+
+
+=196.= The indicative mode is used not only in stating facts, but also in
+asking questions. In interrogative sentences the order of the words that
+make up the verb is changed somewhat. In a simple statement we say, _I
+have paid_. In a question we say, _Have I paid?_ putting the auxiliary
+before the subject.
+
+=197.= Conjugation of _be_ in the indicative mode, interrogative form:—
+
+ PRESENT TENSE PAST TENSE
+
+ am I are we was I were we
+ art thou are you wast thou were you
+ is he are they was he were they
+
+ FUTURE TENSE PRESENT PERFECT TENSE
+
+ shall I be shall we be have I been have we been
+ wilt thou be will you be hast thou been have you been
+ will he be will they be has he been have they been
+
+ PAST PERFECT TENSE
+
+ had I been had we been
+ hadst thou been had you been
+ had he been had they been
+
+ FUTURE PERFECT TENSE
+
+ shall I have been shall we have been
+ wilt thou have been will you have been
+ will he have been will they have been
+
+=198.= When we use the present and past tenses of any verb except _be_
+for asking questions, we do not say _sings she?_ or _sang she?_ but _does
+she sing?_ _did she sing?_ that is, we use the auxiliaries _do_ and _did_.
+
+Conjugate the verb _see_ in the indicative mode, interrogative form.
+
+=Exercise.=—Conjugate the verbs in Exercise 2, p. 126, in the indicative
+mode, interrogative form.
+
+=199.= The use of the negative word _not_ after a verb gives rise to
+many contractions which are permissible in familiar conversation. The
+contractions for which incorrect forms are often used are the following:—
+
+ isn’t
+ wasn’t
+ aren’t
+ weren’t
+ don’t
+ doesn’t
+ haven’t
+ hasn’t
+
+There is no contraction for _am not_; the word _ain’t_ is incorrect.
+
+Contractions are oftenest misused in questions. Notice the following
+correct forms:—
+
+ Isn’t it too bad?
+ Isn’t he tall?
+ Isn’t she pretty?
+ Aren’t you cold?
+ Aren’t they coming?
+ Wasn’t it long?
+ Weren’t you there?
+ Weren’t they slow?
+ Don’t you believe me?
+ Doesn’t it hurt?
+ Doesn’t she work hard?
+ Doesn’t he like it?
+ Haven’t you been there?
+ Hasn’t he any friends?
+
+We should be careful never to say, _you was_ or _was you_; for the
+pronoun _you_, even when it denotes one person, is followed by a verb in
+the plural form. We should say, “You _were_ late,” “_Were you_ late?”
+“_Weren’t you_ late?”
+
+
+
+
+LII. THE SUBJUNCTIVE MODE
+
+
+=200.= When we say, “If I were you, I should be a doctor,” we have a
+dependent proposition, _If I were you_, which states not a fact, but an
+imaginary condition. This condition is, moreover, directly contrary to
+fact, for I am not you, and never can be. The verb used in expressing
+such a condition is said to be in the =subjunctive= mode.
+
+=201.= The subjunctive mode is found not only in dependent propositions
+introduced by if, but in those introduced by _lest_, _whether_,
+_although_, etc.
+
+ (a) Be quiet lest the baby _wake_.
+
+ (b) We cannot tell whether he _be_ the rightful heir or not.
+
+ (c) Though he _wait_ long, yet he will come at last.
+
+In each of these sentences the subjunctive mode is used to express doubt
+or uncertainty, or something imagined but not actually realized.
+
+=202.= The subjunctive mode is so named because it is found principally
+in dependent, or subjoined propositions. It is, however, found also in
+independent propositions expressing a wish; as, “Long _live_ the King!”
+“God _bless_ thee, dear!”
+
+=203.= The subjunctive mode is used in the statement of something that
+is uncertain; as, “If he _come_ in time, dinner will be served at six.”
+This sentence means that his coming is to take place in the future, hence
+we cannot tell whether it will be a fact or not. In the sentence, “If he
+_comes_ in time, dinner is served at six,” we use the indicative mode
+because we mean that sometimes he really does come in time.
+
+=204.= The subjunctive mode is little used, especially in conversation;
+but we find many instances of it in the Bible and in the works of
+Shakespeare, hence we should understand its meaning. Nowadays, except to
+express a wish, as, “Heaven _defend_ thee!” and to express a condition
+contrary to fact, as, “If the ring _were_ gold, it would not discolor
+your finger,” most persons use the indicative mode or some other verb
+phrase. Instead of saying, “If to-morrow _be_ fair,” most persons say,
+“If to-morrow _is_ fair,” or “If to-morrow _should be_ fair.” (See Lesson
+LXI.)
+
+=205.= There are four tenses in the subjunctive mode, but the forms
+do not differ greatly from those of the indicative mode. There is no
+interrogative form.
+
+=206.= Conjugation of _be_ in the subjunctive mode:—
+
+ PRESENT TENSE PAST TENSE
+
+ I be we be I were we were
+ you be you be thou were you were
+ he be they be he were they were
+
+ PRESENT PERFECT TENSE PAST PERFECT TENSE
+
+ I have been we have been I had been we had been
+ thou have been you have been thou had been you had been
+ he have been they have been he had been they had been
+
+=207.= Conjugation of _see_ in the subjunctive mode:—
+
+ PRESENT TENSE PAST TENSE
+
+ I see we see I saw we saw
+ thou see you see thou saw you saw
+ he see they see he saw they saw
+
+ PRESENT PERFECT TENSE PAST PERFECT TENSE
+
+ I have seen we have seen I had seen we had seen
+ thou have seen you have seen thou had seen you had seen
+ he have seen they have seen he had seen they had seen
+
+=Summary.=—The =subjunctive mode= is used in an exclamative sentence
+to express a wish, and in a dependent proposition to express something
+contrary to fact or something uncertain.
+
+The subjunctive mode has no future tenses.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Conjugate all the verbs in Exercise 2, p. 126, in the
+subjunctive mode.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Select all the verbs in the subjunctive mode in these
+sentences, and tell why that mode is used:—
+
+ 1. Misery loves company—even though it be very poor company.
+
+ 2. If the weather be fine, there breaks upon the eye, as
+ we rise higher and higher, a succession of those views of
+ mountain, lake and forest, which can be had only from an
+ elevated position.
+
+ 3. The Lord be between thee and me when we are absent one from
+ the other.
+
+ 4. If the whole world were put into one scale and my mother
+ into the other, the world could not outweigh her.
+
+ 5. If a boy were obliged to work at nut gathering in order to
+ procure food for the family, he would find it very irksome.
+
+ 6.
+
+ Green be the turf above thee,
+ Friend of my better days!
+
+ 7. John convinces himself that he must watch the hawk lest it
+ pounce upon the chicken.
+
+ 8. If chicadee seem preoccupied or absorbed, you may know that
+ he is building a nest.
+
+ 9. If I were a millionaire, city life would be agreeable
+ enough, for I could always get away from it.
+
+ 10.
+
+ And Death, whenever he come to me,
+ Shall come on the wide, unbounded sea.
+
+ 11. In their hands they shall bear thee up, lest at any time
+ thou dash thy foot against a stone.
+
+ 12.
+
+ Christ save us all from a death like this,
+ On the reef of Norman’s Woe!
+
+ 13. If wishes were horses, beggars might ride.
+
+ 14. God be merciful to us, and bless us, and show us the light
+ of his countenance.
+
+ 15. If a man say that he hath no sin, he deceiveth himself, and
+ the truth is not in him.
+
+ 16. If he had told the truth, somebody would have believed him.
+
+ 17. If impressment were the law of the world, if it formed part
+ of the code of nations and were usually practiced, then it
+ might be defended as a common right.
+
+
+
+
+LIII. THE IMPERATIVE MODE
+
+
+=208.= We learned in Lesson XIV that sentences expressing a command or an
+entreaty are called imperative sentences; that the subject of the verb in
+an imperative sentence is a pronoun of the second person,—_you_, _thou_,
+or _ye_; and that this subject is seldom expressed. The verb in an
+imperative sentence is said to be in the =imperative mode=; as, “_Sleep_,
+baby, _sleep_.”
+
+=209.= There is only one form for the imperative mode, hence it is not
+said to have tense at all.
+
+Conjugation of _be_ in the imperative mode:—
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ be (_you_ or _thou_) be (_you_ or _ye_)
+
+Conjugation of _see_ in the imperative mode:—
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ see (_you_ or _thou_) see (_you_ or _ye_)
+
+=Summary.=—The =imperative mode= is used in expressing a command or an
+entreaty. It has but one form. Its subject is always the pronoun _you_,
+_thou_, or _ye_.
+
+=Exercise.=—From these sentences select the verbs in the imperative mode.
+Conjugate these verbs in the indicative, subjunctive, and imperative
+modes.
+
+ 1. Ring, happy bells, across the snow.
+
+ 2. Break, break, break, on thy cold, gray stones, O sea!
+
+ 3. Repent ye, for the kingdom of heaven is at hand.
+
+ 4. Run upstairs and get my glasses.
+
+ 5. Blow, winds, and crack your cheeks.
+
+ 6.
+
+ Build thee more stately mansions, O my soul!
+ As the swift seasons roll.
+ Leave thy low-vaulted past,
+ Let each new temple, nobler than the last,
+ Shut thee from heaven with a dome more vast....
+
+ 7. Laugh, and the world laughs with you.
+
+ 8.
+
+ Work till the last beam fadeth,
+ Fadeth to shine no more.
+
+ 9. Come unto me, all ye that labor and are heavy laden, and I
+ will give you rest.
+
+ 10. Whatsoever thy hand findeth to do, do it with thy might.
+
+ 11. Suffer the little children, and forbid them not to come
+ unto me, for of such is the kingdom of heaven.
+
+ 12. Honor thy father and thy mother.
+
+ 13.
+
+ Tell me not in mournful numbers
+ Life is but an empty dream.
+
+Find all the terms of address in the sentences above.
+
+
+
+
+LIV. PRINCIPAL PARTS OF VERBS. REGULAR AND IRREGULAR VERBS
+
+
+=210.= If we examine the conjugation of the verb _see_, we shall discover
+that most of the tenses are formed by the use of auxiliary verbs, and
+that only four forms of the verb _see_ itself are made use of; namely,
+_see_, _sees_, _saw_, _seen_. The form _sees_ occurs only once, but the
+other three forms occur often. These three forms—_see_, _saw_, _seen_—are
+called the =principal parts= of the verb _see_.
+
+The principal parts of any verb are the present indicative, as, _go_,
+_take_; the past indicative, as, _went_, _took_; and another form, as,
+_gone_, _taken_, called the =past participle=.
+
+=211.= The past participle is used in forming all the perfect tenses.
+It is plain, then, that we should say _I have gone_ (not _have went_),
+_I had taken_ (not _had took_); since _went_ and _took_ are past tense
+forms, not past participles.
+
+The past participle is never used in the primary tenses. That is why we
+say _I saw_ (not _seen_), _I did_ (not _done_).
+
+ NOTE.—The very common word _ought_ is, as we use it to-day,
+ an old past tense form of the verb _owe_, and not a past
+ participle. Hence, we should say _ought to go_, or _ought not
+ to go_ (not _had ought to go_ or _hadn’t ought to go_).
+
+=212.= Most verbs form their past tense and past participle by adding _d_
+or _ed_ to the present tense. The past tense and the past participle of
+_move_ are _moved_ and _moved_; of _plow_ are _plowed_ and _plowed_; of
+_lift_ are _lifted_ and _lifted_. Such verbs are called =regular verbs=.
+
+=213.= Many verbs in very common use form their past tense or past
+participle, not by the addition of a suffix, but by some change within
+the word, such as a change in the vowel. The past tense and past
+participle of _sing_ are _sang_ and _sung_ respectively; of _leave_ are
+_left_ and _left_; of _write_ are _wrote_ and _written_. These verbs are
+called =irregular verbs=.
+
+=214.= Some verbs, like _put_ and _set_, have the same form for each of
+their principal parts. These also are irregular verbs.
+
+=215.= The verb _be_ is very irregular. Its principal parts are: present
+tense _am_, past tense _was_, past participle _been_.
+
+=216.= If we know the proper auxiliaries for the different tenses, we can
+conjugate any verb correctly by first ascertaining its principal parts.
+These can always be found in a dictionary.
+
+=Summary.=—The =principal parts= of a verb are the present tense, the
+past tense, and the past participle.
+
+A =regular verb= is one that forms its past tense and past participle by
+adding _d_ or _ed_ to the present tense.
+
+An =irregular verb= is one whose past tense or past participle is formed
+in some other way than by adding _d_ or _ed_ to the present tense.
+
+ NOTE.—Webster’s New International Dictionary gives the present
+ tense form of every verb. If the verb is irregular, the
+ dictionary gives also the past tense form preceded by _pret._,
+ and the past participle preceded by _p.p._ The abbreviation
+ _pret._ stands for _preterit_, which means past tense. If the
+ verb is regular, the abbreviations are omitted, and the form
+ _d_ or _ed_ is printed but once.
+
+=Exercise.=—Find in the dictionary the past tense and the past participle
+of each of the following verbs. Use the three forms of each verb
+correctly in sentences.
+
+ awake
+ bear
+ beat
+ begin
+ bid
+ bind
+ bite
+ bleed
+ blow
+ break
+ bring
+ build
+ buy
+ catch
+ choose
+ cling
+ come
+ cost
+ creep
+ cut
+ dare
+ dig
+ do
+ draw
+ drink
+ drive
+ eat
+ fall
+ feed
+ fight
+ find
+ flee
+ fling
+ fly
+ forget
+ freeze
+ get
+ give
+ go
+ grind
+ grow
+ hang
+ have
+ hide
+ hit
+ hold
+ hurt
+ keep
+ kneel
+ knit
+ know
+ lay
+ lead
+ lend
+ let
+ lie
+ lose
+ make
+ meet
+ pay
+ read
+ ride
+ ring
+ rise
+ run
+ say
+ seek
+ sell
+ shake
+ shed
+ shine
+ shoot
+ show
+ shrink
+ shut
+ sink
+ sit
+ slay
+ sleep
+ slide
+ sling
+ smite
+ speak
+ spend
+ spin
+ spread
+ spring
+ stand
+ steal
+ stick
+ sting
+ stride
+ strike
+ string
+ strive
+ swear
+ sweat
+ sweep
+ swim
+ swing
+ take
+ tell
+ think
+ throw
+ tread
+ wear
+ weave
+ weep
+ wet
+ win
+ wind
+ wring
+
+=217.= Many errors are made in using the different forms of irregular
+verbs.
+
+Certain verbs, the meaning and principal parts of which are somewhat
+alike, occasion a good deal of trouble to some persons. The most
+important of these are _lie_ and _lay_, _sit_ and _set_, and _rise_
+and _raise_. The first word of each pair, _lie_, _sit_, and _rise_ is
+an intransitive verb. The second verb of each pair, _lay_, _set_, and
+_raise_, is a transitive verb.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Supply the correct form of _lie_ or _lay_ in each of these
+sentences, and give your reason in each case.
+
+_Lie_ means to be at rest in a reclining position.
+
+_Lay_ means to place a thing down in a reclining position.
+
+ 1. —— down, Phiz, and be a good dog.
+
+ 2. Phiz —— at the foot of my couch and gazed out of the nearest
+ window.
+
+ 3. After he had —— there an hour or more, he whined to go out
+ on the street.
+
+ 4. Phiz brought in a notebook and —— it at my feet.
+
+ 5. Go and —— it on your master’s chair, Phiz.
+
+ 6. Did the soldiers —— on the damp ground?
+
+ 7. This land —— too low for grain fields.
+
+ 8. How long has my fan been —— on the window sill?
+
+ 9. Grant —— in bed dictating his Memoirs.
+
+ 10. The tools have —— here in the wet and are rusted.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Supply the correct form of _sit_ or _set_ in each of these
+sentences, and give your reason in each case.
+
+_Sit_ means to be in a sitting position.
+
+_Set_ means to place a thing down in a position of rest.
+
+ 1. By and by we looked in, and there —— Miss Eugene.
+
+ 2. Have you —— here long, or did you just come?
+
+ 3. I will —— my suit case here, and then —— in your seat.
+
+ 4. Why did you —— there so long without speaking?
+
+ 5. Father —— the white hen to-day, so she will be —— for about
+ three weeks.
+
+ 6. The little bird —— and sings at his door in the sun.
+
+ 7. Who has been —— in my chair?
+
+=Exercise 3.=—Supply the correct form of _rise_ and _raise_ in each of
+these sentences, and give your reason in each case.
+
+_Rise_ means to move from a lower to a higher position.
+
+_Raise_ means to cause to rise.
+
+ 1. The bread —— very slowly that cold day.
+
+ 2. Bread —— because of the yeast in it.
+
+ 3. After the bread had ——, we set the pans in the oven.
+
+ 4. They —— the old house so as to put a furnace in the cellar.
+
+ 5. The Black River —— sixteen inches yesterday.
+
+ 6. If the river continues to ——, the dam will go out.
+
+ 7. Shall we —— the flag at sunrise?
+
+The present tense form of some verbs is misused for the past tense. We
+should say, “The tailor _came_ (not _come_) last night,” “I _ran_ (not
+_run_) a mile yesterday,” “And then he _said_ (not _says_), ‘Hurry up.’”
+The verbs oftenest misused in this way are _come_, _give_, _run_, _say_,
+and _see_.
+
+Study the following correct sentences:—
+
+ He _came_ last night.
+
+ She _came_ to meet me.
+
+ It _came_ without warning.
+
+ I _ran_ a mile yesterday.
+
+ He _ran_ in front of me.
+
+ She _ran_ out of sugar.
+
+ At last he _said_, “I will go.”
+
+ John _said_, “The schoolhouse is on fire.”
+
+ I _said_, “Ring the bells.”
+
+ He _gave_ me a dollar.
+
+ I _gave_ the child a penny.
+
+ She _gave_ it to me.
+
+ They _ran_ up a bill.
+
+ The dog _ran_ behind.
+
+ The baby _ran_ to his mother.
+
+ I _saw_ the parade yesterday.
+
+ He _saw_ me go out.
+
+ She _saw_ them at the window.
+
+ I _came_, I _saw_, I _conquered_.
+
+Some persons make a wrong past tense for certain verbs, and use such
+forms as _blowed_ and _drawed_, when they should use _blew_ and _drew_.
+
+=Exercise 4.=—Supply the correct form for the past tense in each of these
+sentences:—
+
+ 1. _Blow._ The wind soon —— the smoke away.
+
+ 2. _Draw._ The boat —— four feet of water.
+
+ 3. _Grow._ Lucy —— too fast to be strong.
+
+ 4. _Know._ Nobody —— the right date but me.
+
+ 5. _Throw._ Who —— the ball last?
+
+Some persons use the past participle of _see_ and _do_ for the past
+tense. We should say, “I _saw_ (not _seen_) my duty, and I _did_ (not
+done) it.”
+
+Study these correct sentences:—
+
+ I _saw_ the boat go down.
+
+ Who _saw_ the star first?
+
+ We _saw_ the elephant dance.
+
+ He _did_ his own work.
+
+ She _did_ it too fast.
+
+ Everybody _did_ what he could.
+
+Another common error is the use of the past tense of a verb for the past
+participle, as in the expressions _is broke_ and _had froze_.
+
+=Exercise 5.=—Supply the correct form in each of these sentences:—
+
+ 1. _Begin._ First we must finish what we have ——.
+
+ 2. _Break._ Dear me! I have —— the bird’s seed dish.
+
+ 3. _Drink._ Have you —— all the milk?
+
+ 4. _Freeze._ If the lagoon is ——, we can go skating.
+
+ 5. _Steal._ Why do you think that the purse was ——?
+
+ 6. _Swim._ Have you ever —— out to the island?
+
+
+
+
+LV. VOICE
+
+
+=218.= When we say, “The fish swallowed the worm,” we have a sentence
+made up of a subject, a verb, and an object complement. The subject
+names the doer of the action, while the object names the receiver of the
+action. The verb _swallowed_ could have nothing for subject but some word
+that indicates the doer of the action. How is it with the verbs _broke_,
+_struck_, _whittled_? A verb that requires for its subject the name of
+the doer of an action is said to be in the =active voice=.
+
+=219.= When we say, “The worm was swallowed by the fish,” we have a
+sentence made up of a subject, a verb, and a prepositional phrase. The
+subject names the receiver of the action, and the phrase tells by whom
+the action was performed. The verb _was swallowed_ could have nothing for
+subject but some word that indicates the receiver of the action. How is
+it with the verbs _was swept_, _has been eaten_, _will be cut_? A verb
+that requires for its subject the name of the receiver of the action is
+said to be in the =passive voice=.
+
+=220.= When a verb is changed from the active to the passive voice, the
+object of the active verb becomes the subject of the passive verb. Hence
+it is evident that only transitive verbs can have the passive voice.
+
+=221.= A verb is conjugated in the passive voice by adding the past
+participle of the verb to the conjugation of the verb _be_.
+
+=222.= Conjugation of the verb _see_ in the passive voice:—
+
+ INDICATIVE MODE
+
+ PRESENT TENSE PAST TENSE
+
+ I am seen we are seen I was seen we were seen
+ thou art seen you are seen thou wast seen you were seen
+ he is seen they are seen he was seen they were seen
+
+ FUTURE TENSE
+
+ I shall be seen we shall be seen
+ thou wilt be seen you will be seen
+ he will be seen they will be seen
+
+ PRESENT PERFECT
+
+ I have been seen we have been seen
+ thou hast been seen you have been seen
+ he has been seen they have been seen
+
+ PAST PERFECT
+
+ I had been seen we had been seen
+ thou hadst been seen you had been seen
+ he had been seen they had been seen
+
+ FUTURE PERFECT
+
+ I shall have been seen we shall have been seen
+ thou wilt have been seen you will have been seen
+ he will have been seen they will have been seen
+
+ SUBJUNCTIVE MODE
+
+ PRESENT PAST
+
+ I be seen we be seen I were seen we were seen
+ thou be seen you be seen thou were seen you were seen
+ he be seen they be seen he were seen they were seen
+
+ PRESENT PERFECT
+
+ I have been seen we have been seen
+ thou have been seen you have been seen
+ he have been seen they have been seen
+
+ PAST PERFECT
+
+ I had been seen we had been seen
+ thou had been seen you had been seen
+ he had been seen they had been seen
+
+ IMPERATIVE MODE
+
+ be seen (_you_ or _thou_) be seen (_you_ or _ye_)
+
+=223.= Conjugation of the verb _see_ in the passive voice, indicative
+mode, interrogative form:—
+
+ INDICATIVE MODE
+
+ PRESENT PAST
+
+ am I seen are we seen was I seen were we seen
+ art thou seen are you seen wast thou seen were you seen
+ is he seen are they seen was he seen were they seen
+
+ FUTURE
+
+ shall I be seen shall we be seen
+ shalt thou be seen shall you be seen
+ will he be seen will they be seen
+
+ PRESENT PERFECT
+
+ have I been seen have we been seen
+ hast thou been seen have you been seen
+ has he been seen have they been seen
+
+ PAST PERFECT
+
+ had I been seen had we been seen
+ hadst thou been seen had you been seen
+ had he been seen had they been seen
+
+ FUTURE PERFECT
+
+ shall I have been seen shall we have been seen
+ shalt thou have been seen shall you have been seen
+ will he have been seen will they have been seen
+
+=Summary.=—=Voice= is that property of a verb which shows whether the
+subject names the doer or the receiver of an action.
+
+The =active voice= shows that the subject names the doer of an action.
+
+The =passive voice= shows that the subject names the receiver of an
+action.
+
+A verb is conjugated in the passive voice by adding the past participle
+of the verb to the conjugation of the verb _be_.
+
+No intransitive verb has a passive voice.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Conjugate the verbs _draw_, _take_, _find_, _forget_, and
+_leave_ in the passive voice, both declaratively and interrogatively.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Select the verbs in the following sentences. Tell whether
+they are transitive or intransitive. Give the tense, mode, voice, and
+subject of each. Change the active verbs to the passive voice and the
+passive to the active.
+
+ NOTE.—When the verb is passive, the name of the doer of the
+ action is often omitted. Sometimes we do not know who the doer
+ is; as, “The art of printing was invented in China long ago.”
+ Sometimes we do not wish to tell who the doer is; as, “A window
+ was broken in the basement yesterday.” Sometimes the subject is
+ so obvious as not to be worth telling; as, “Lying is despised.”
+ In changing sentences like these three to the active voice, we
+ must supply a subject for the verb. For instance, in changing
+ the sentence, “The pie was cut into four pieces,” we might say,
+ “Mother cut the pie into four pieces.”
+
+ 1. The babe was conveyed to the church in a grand procession.
+ The road, all the way, was carpeted with green rushes. Over
+ this road the little infant Elizabeth was borne by one of her
+ godmothers. She was wrapped in a mantle of purple velvet, with
+ a long train. This train was trimmed with ermine, a very costly
+ kind of fur, and was borne by lords and ladies of high rank.
+ These dignitaries were appointed for the purpose by the king.
+
+ 2. The height of the pinnacle is determined by the breadth of
+ the base.
+
+ 3. Leicester Hospital supports twelve old soldiers and their
+ wives.
+
+ 4. After the housework had been done, they went out to the
+ sunny garden, and picked the luscious red raspberries, not
+ forgetful of the time when Mrs. Howe had set out the bushes
+ with her own hands.
+
+ 5. Many of these splendid castles on the Rhine have been
+ destroyed in modern times.
+
+ 6. It is wonderful and beautiful how a man and his dog will
+ stick to one another through thick and thin.
+
+ 7. The door had been very firmly fastened, but the crowd tore
+ it away bodily, and the light of the torches streamed into the
+ room.
+
+ 8. This garden is shaded by long lines of trees, and adorned
+ with fountains and statues.
+
+ 9.
+
+ Away to the window I flew like a flash,
+ Tore open the shutters, and threw up the sash.
+
+ 10. Elephants are very strictly preserved by the English
+ government.
+
+ 11. The farm boy picks up the potatoes after they have been
+ dug; he drives the cows night and morning; he brings wood and
+ water and splits kindling; he gets up the horse and puts out
+ the horse; whether he is in the house or out of it, there is
+ always something for him to do.
+
+ 12.
+
+ They who do their souls no wrong,
+ But keep at eve the faith of morn,
+ Shall daily hear the angel song,
+ “To-day the Prince of Peace is born.”
+
+ 13. Mr. Marley has been dead these seven years.
+
+ 14. The Peterkins told how their mother had put salt in the
+ coffee, and how the chemist had made it worse instead of better.
+
+ 15. We climbed the Alps, veiled our faces before the awful
+ splendors of Mont Blanc, trembled on the verge of dizzy
+ heights, shrank back from fathomless abysses, picked our way
+ across the _Mer de Glace_, and cowered beneath the weight of
+ the whole incumbent mass of mountains as we went through the
+ tunnel.
+
+Tell the part of speech and use of _way_, sentence 1, _forgetful_ 4, _one
+another_ 6, _open_ 9, _up_ 9, _souls_ 12, _years_ 13, _worse_ 14.
+
+
+
+
+LVI. THE PASSIVE VOICE
+
+
+=224.= Every combination of some form of the verb _be_ with the past
+participle of a transitive verb is not necessarily a passive verb.
+
+For example, one passive form of the verb _do_ is _is done_, but it does
+not follow that _is done_ is always a passive verb. In the sentence, “The
+meat is done now,” we do not mean that the meat is receiving an action,
+hence _is done_ cannot be a passive verb. We mean to tell the condition
+of the meat, that it is _done_ meat. The word _done_ is used in precisely
+the same way as an adjective; as if we should say, “The meat is _good_
+now,” In other words, the participle _done_ is a subjective complement.
+
+Past participles are used as subjective complements to tell the condition
+of something _after_ an action has been performed on it; as, “Every
+window in the house is _broken_,” “My dress is badly _torn_,” “The old
+house is _deserted_.”
+
+=225.= When we are in doubt as to whether we have a true passive verb
+or not, we may apply these tests: (1) Does the sentence mean that the
+subject is acted upon? (2) Can we add a phrase, telling the performer of
+the action? (3) Can we change the sentence to the active voice, keeping,
+of course, the same tense?
+
+Let us take, for instance, the sentence, “Courage is praised.” We do mean
+that courage receives the praising. We can add the phrase _by everybody_.
+And we can change the sentence to the active sentence, “Everybody praises
+courage.” Hence _is praised_ is the verb, and is in the passive voice.
+
+But in the sentence, “Every seat in the balcony is taken,” if _is taken_
+is a passive verb, it must mean, since it is present tense, that every
+seat is receiving an action now. It does not mean this, but it does mean
+that every seat is a _taken_ seat, hence _taken_ is used as a subjective
+complement, and the verb is just the one word _is_.
+
+=226.= We learned in Lesson XXXVII that some verbs like _make_, _elect_,
+_appoint_, and _call_, are often followed by a direct object and an
+objective complement; as, “We called our canary Buttercup.”
+
+When such a sentence is changed to the passive voice, the direct object
+becomes, of course, the subject, and we have the sentence, “Our canary
+was called Buttercup.” The word _Buttercup_ has now become a subjective
+complement. How do we know this?
+
+When the objective complement is an adjective, as in the sentence,
+“She kept the polished floor as _bright_ as a mirror,” if we change
+the sentence to the passive voice, the adjective becomes a subjective
+complement; as, “The polished floor was kept as bright as a mirror.”
+
+=227.= We learned in Lesson XXXIV that certain verbs may be followed by
+both an indirect and a direct object; as, “Fred told Arthur the news.”
+
+In changing this sentence to the passive voice we may use the direct
+object for the subject of the passive verb; as, “The news was told to
+Arthur by Fred”; or we may use the indirect object for the subject of
+the passive verb; as, “Arthur was told the news by Fred.” In the latter
+case we have an idiomatic construction—a passive verb _was told_ taking
+a direct object _the news_. The direct object of a passive verb is often
+called a =retained object=, because it remains as an object after the
+sentence has been changed to the passive voice.
+
+Not all sentences containing a direct and an indirect object can be
+changed to the passive voice in two ways. We say, “A rose was given to
+me,” or “I was given a rose.” We say, “A holiday was promised to the
+children,” or “The children were promised a holiday.” But we do not say,
+“I was passed the bread,” “I was written a note,” or “I was poured a cup
+of tea.”
+
+=Summary.=—The past participle of a transitive verb may be used as the
+subjective complement of some form of the verb _be_. In such a case it
+denotes the condition of the subject.
+
+When a sentence containing a direct object and an objective complement is
+changed to the passive voice, the direct object becomes the subject, and
+the objective complement becomes a subjective complement.
+
+Some sentences containing both an indirect and a direct object may be
+changed to the passive voice in two ways, either the direct object or
+the indirect object becoming the subject.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Select each verb in the following sentences. Tell its
+voice, and how it is completed.
+
+ 1. The time of the singing of birds is come, and the voice of
+ the turtle is heard in the land.
+
+ 2. Queen Elizabeth is often familiarly called Queen Bess.
+
+ 3. Rebecca’s face was so swollen with tears and so sharp with
+ misery that for a moment Uncle Jerry scarcely recognized her.
+
+ 4. To put it mildly, Mrs. Howe was greatly pleased when she was
+ elected first president of the Murray Hill Society.
+
+ 5. When the eggs had been beaten stiff, the little cook sifted
+ the sugar.
+
+ 6. Christ the Lord is risen to-day.
+
+ 7. The colonists were so disheartened and alarmed that they
+ sailed at once for England.
+
+ 8. The youngest girl in the senior class was chosen
+ valedictorian.
+
+ 9. When the automobile ran off the bridge, every one was
+ surprised at the driver’s escape.
+
+ 10. The black colt had been named Odin, but he was always
+ called Teddy.
+
+ 11.
+
+ The day is past and gone,
+ The evening shades appear.
+
+ 12. Those people are mistaken who say that hard work does not
+ pay—they have never really tried it.
+
+ 13. The room was made cool and dark, so that the lady might
+ sleep.
+
+ 14. The roofs of the long red barns, which had been stained
+ green by the weather, were struck by the level rays of the low,
+ western sun.
+
+ 15. The fabric of common order in America is sound and strong
+ at the center; the pattern is well marked, and the threads are
+ firmly woven.
+
+ 16. Harvard College may be regarded as the legitimate child of
+ Emmanuel College at Cambridge in England.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Make either one or two passive sentences out of each
+sentence in Exercise 2, page 90. Tell in each case what becomes of the
+subject, the direct object, and the indirect object.
+
+
+
+
+LVII. THE PROGRESSIVE CONJUGATION
+
+
+=228.= We have learned to conjugate verbs both declaratively and
+interrogatively, in both the active and the passive voice. There is
+another form of conjugation, as shown in the statements, _I am laughing_,
+_I was laughing_, _I shall be laughing_, _I have been laughing_, etc.
+
+We use this form of conjugation when we wish to call attention to the
+_continuance_ of the action asserted by the verb, and we call it the
+=progressive conjugation=.
+
+=229.= Just as we use the past participle in conjugating a verb in the
+passive voice, so we use the =present participle= in conjugating a verb
+in the progressive form. _Laughing_ is the present participle of the
+verb _laugh_. The present participle of every verb ends in _ing_; as,
+_running_, _hoping_, _tying_.
+
+=230.= Synopsis of the progressive conjugation of the verb _see_:—
+
+ NOTE.—In the =synopsis= of a conjugation we give only one form
+ for each tense, instead of six forms.
+
+ INDICATIVE MODE
+
+ _Present_ I am seeing
+ _Past_ I was seeing
+ _Future_ I shall be seeing
+ _Present Perfect_ I have been seeing
+ _Past Perfect_ I had been seeing
+ _Future Perfect_ I shall have been seeing
+
+ SUBJUNCTIVE MODE
+
+ _Present_ I be seeing
+ _Past_ I were seeing
+ _Present Perfect_ I have been seeing
+ _Past Perfect_ I had been seeing
+
+ IMPERATIVE MODE
+
+ be seeing (you, thou, ye)
+
+=231.= The progressive conjugation may be made interrogative by changing
+the position of the auxiliary; as, _am I seeing?_ _was I seeing?_ etc.
+
+=Summary.=—The =progressive conjugation= is used to denote a continued
+action.
+
+It is made by joining the present participle of a given verb to the
+conjugation of the verb _be_.
+
+=Exercise.=—Conjugate the verbs _lift_, _dine_, and _get_ in the
+progressive form, both declaratively and interrogatively.
+
+
+
+
+LVIII. THE EMPHATIC CONJUGATION
+
+
+=232.= In the indicative mode, present tense, we may say, _I study_,
+which is the common form, or _I am studying_, which is the progressive
+form, or _I do study_, which is the =emphatic form=.
+
+=233.= The emphatic conjugation is made by using the auxiliary verb _do_.
+It is found only in the present and past tenses of the indicative mode,
+and in the imperative mode.
+
+=234.= Conjugation of the verb _try_ in the emphatic form.
+
+ INDICATIVE MODE
+
+ PRESENT TENSE
+
+ I do try we do try
+ thou dost try you do try
+ he does try they do try
+
+ PAST TENSE
+
+ I did try we did try
+ thou didst try you did try
+ he did try they did try
+
+ IMPERATIVE MODE
+
+ do try (thou, you, or ye)
+
+=235.= The two tenses of the indicative mode, emphatic form, may be made
+interrogative, as we learned in Lesson LI.
+
+=236.= The emphatic form is used for other purposes than for emphasis.
+It is generally used instead of the ordinary forms when the adverb _not_
+modifies the predicate. We say, “I do not love thee, Dr. Fell,” instead
+of “I love thee not.” And in the imperative mode with _not_ we say, “Do
+not run with the ball,” instead of “Run not with the ball.”
+
+
+
+
+LIX. PARSING OF VERBS
+
+
+=237.= When we parse a verb, we should tell,—
+
+(1) Its class as to form,—regular or irregular.
+
+(2) Its principal parts.
+
+(3) Its class as to use,—transitive or intransitive.
+
+(4) Its voice,—active or passive.
+
+(5) Its mode,—indicative, subjunctive, or imperative.
+
+(6) Its tense.
+
+(7) Its person.
+
+(8) Its number.
+
+(9) Its form of conjugation,—interrogative, progressive, or emphatic.
+
+(10) Its simple subject.
+
+(11) Its complement (if any),—direct object, subjective complement, or
+objective complement.
+
+=Exercise.=—Parse each verb in the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. What are you smiling at, Lady Mother?
+
+ 2. The shades were lowered at the windows, the lamps were
+ lighted, the great family table was drawn towards the fire.
+
+ 3. When he went out from the village at the head of his men one
+ fine day, while the sun was shining brightly, and the birds
+ were singing, he did not neglect a single one of the many
+ things which he had been told always brought good luck to the
+ hunting.
+
+ 4. “No,” said Mrs. Howe, “I don’t enjoy moving, but the
+ children do. They have been transporting clocks, and pictures,
+ and lamps all the forenoon, when they haven’t been loading the
+ dray, but they don’t seem a bit tired.”
+
+ 5. What shall it profit a man if he gain the whole world and
+ lose his own soul?
+
+ 6. Child, was not your father called Mustapha the tailor?
+
+ 7. Do look at those gateposts!
+
+ 8. The hens had been mysteriously disappearing for over a month.
+
+ 9. Stir not a step till I come again.
+
+ 10. Do you wonder that I missed a word in spelling?
+
+ 11. Son, have any told thee that thou art beautiful beyond all
+ men?
+
+ 12. Hadn’t you been putting on airs?
+
+
+
+
+LX. THE AUXILIARY VERBS _SHALL_ AND _WILL_
+
+
+=238.= In conjugating a verb in the future tense, indicative mode, we
+make use of the auxiliaries _shall_ and _will_.
+
+ _Singular_ _Plural_
+
+ I shall go we shall go
+ thou wilt go you will go
+ he will go they will go
+
+These verb phrases express simple futurity,—they assert an intention on
+the part of the person indicated by the subject, but not a promise.
+
+=239.= We have another set of verb phrases belonging to the future tense,
+indicative mode:—
+
+ I will go we will go
+ thou shalt go you shall go
+ he shall go they shall go
+
+These phrases are used to express a promise, a vow, or a threat on the
+part of the speaker; that is, the speaker will see to it that the action
+is carried out. There is more of certainty in these phrases than in those
+of the first set.
+
+=240.= _Shall_ and _will_ with _have_ are used also in forming the future
+perfect tense; as, _I shall have gone_, _he will have come_, etc. There
+is much less occasion to use the future perfect tense than there is to
+use the simple future tense, so we shall discuss the use of _shall_
+and _will_ only in the future tense. When that is mastered, the future
+perfect tense will present no difficulties.
+
+=241.= Frequent errors are made in the use of _shall_ and _will_.
+Perhaps the commonest occur in interrogative sentences. Many persons
+say carelessly, “Will I open this window for you?” This question means,
+“Am I going to open this window for you?” and the only possible answer
+is, “I am sure I don’t know.” What is really intended by the question
+is this, “Do you wish me to open this window?” hence we should say,
+“_Shall_ I open this window for you?” The rule is,—When the subject of an
+interrogative sentence is _I_ or _we_, the auxiliary _shall_ should be
+used instead of _will_.
+
+=242.= In questions where the subject is a word of the second or the
+third person, we should use in the question the form we expect in the
+answer. A boy should say to his employer, “Shall you be in your office
+this afternoon?” because he expects the reply, “I shall,” meaning, “I
+intend to be there.” But a boy says to another boy, “Will you pitch
+for us to-morrow?” because he expects the reply, “I will,” meaning “I
+promise.”
+
+=Summary.=—Rules for the use of _shall_ and _will_:—
+
+(1) To assert simple futurity use _shall_ in the first person, and
+_will_ in the second and third persons.
+
+(2) To assert determination, a promise, or a threat, use _will_ in the
+first person, _shall_ in the second and third persons.
+
+(3) In questions use _shall_ in the first person. In the second and third
+persons use _will_ or _shall_ according to the answer you should get. The
+form of the answer is to be determined by rules 1 and 2.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Account for the use of _shall_ and _will_ in the following
+sentences:—
+
+ 1. “What shall we do next?” said I, with a long breath.
+
+ 2. Thou shalt hang for laying thy hand upon me.
+
+ 3. Will you please tell me whether Mrs. Josiah Wheeler lives on
+ this road?
+
+ 4. You shall have a birthday party on the lawn, and I will
+ make you a soldier suit, and papa will get you a drum, and the
+ supper table shall be set under the balm-of-Gilead tree.
+
+ 5. “No,” said the fairy, “this is my ax, and it shall lie upon
+ the shelf, while you must dive for yours, yourself.”
+
+ 6. “We will come into the crop lands to play with thee by
+ night,” said Gray Brother to Mowgli.
+
+ 7. Blessed are the peacemakers; for they shall be called the
+ children of God.
+
+ 8. The first social problem is the problem of rule: who shall
+ exercise it, how far shall it go, and by what means shall it be
+ enforced?
+
+ 9. Whosoever will lose his life for my sake shall find it.
+
+ 10. Let us rest ourselves, and then we shall be better able to
+ pursue our walk.
+
+ 11.
+
+ When shall we three meet again
+ In thunder, lightning, or in rain?
+
+ 12. I will lift up mine eyes unto the hills, whence cometh my
+ strength.
+
+ 13.
+
+ Who will fill our vacant places?
+ Who will sing our songs to-night?
+
+ 14.
+
+ The daisies will be there, love.
+ The stars in heaven will shine;
+ But I shall not feel thy wish, love,
+ Nor thou my hand in thine.
+
+Tell the part of speech and use of _thy_, sentence 2, _me_ 3, _you_ 4,
+_this_ 5, _yours_ 5, _yourself_ 5, _children_ 7, _we_ 11, _mine_ 12.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Fill the blanks with the proper auxiliary, and give your
+reason in each case.
+
+ 1. O mother dear, Jerusalem, when —— I come to thee?
+
+ 2.
+
+ We —— meet, but we —— miss him,
+ There —— be one vacant chair.
+
+ 3. There is no market in the world in which money —— buy brains.
+
+ 4. You —— always have this little blue Wedgwood tea set to
+ remember her by.
+
+ 5. —— you wear the hat even if it is not becoming?
+
+ 6. I —— know him when he comes, happy youth.
+
+ 7. —— you get my watch that was left at the jeweler’s?
+
+ 8.
+
+ Oh, who —— walk a mile with me
+ Along life’s merry way?
+
+ 9. If you do not promise to be home before midnight, you —— not
+ go to the ball.
+
+ 10.
+
+ Three years she grew in sun and shower,
+ Then Nature said, “A lovelier flower
+ On earth was never sown;
+ This Child I to myself —— take;
+ She —— be mine, and I —— make
+ A Lady of my own.
+
+ “The stars of midnight —— be dear
+ To her; and she —— lean her ear
+ In many a secret place
+ Where rivulets dance their wayward round,
+ And beauty born of murmuring sound
+ —— pass into her face.
+
+ “And vital feelings of delight
+ —— rear her form to stately height,
+ Her virgin bosom swell;
+ Such thoughts to Lucy I —— give
+ While she and I together live
+ Here in this happy dell.”
+
+
+
+
+LXI. DEFECTIVE VERBS. VERB PHRASES
+
+
+=243.= Some verbs lack one or more of their principal parts. Such verbs
+are called =defective verbs=.
+
+A very common defective verb, which has only one form, is _ought_. (See
+page 135.)
+
+Other defective verbs are _can_, _may_, _must_, _shall_, and _will_. The
+past tense forms of these verbs are _could_, _might_, _must, should_,
+and _would_, respectively. No one of these verbs is ever used as a
+principal verb, except _would_, as in the familiar expressions, “I
+_would_ I were a bird,” “_Would_ that he were here!”
+
+=244.= _Shall_ and _will_ are used as auxiliary verbs to form the future
+tenses. _Can_, _could_, _may_, _might_, _must_, _should_, and _would_ are
+used to form certain very useful verb phrases that are in the present,
+the past, or the future perfect tense, and in either the indicative or
+the subjunctive mode according to their meaning.
+
+=245.= Using these verb phrases in the indicative mode we say,—
+
+ I _may go_ to Japan. He _may have gone_ home early.
+ I _can see_ seven stars. It _cannot have come_ yet.
+ We _must go_ early. He _must have sold_ it.
+ You _might hurry_ a little. We _might have hurried_.
+ He _could not tell_ a lie. I _could have eaten_ more.
+ She _would talk_ in church. He _would have helped_ me.
+ We _should honor_ the flag. You _should have earned_ it.
+
+If we look closely at the meaning of these sentences, and think of others
+containing the same auxiliaries, we shall conclude (1) that _may_ and
+_might_ denote possibility or permission, (2) that _can_ and _could_
+denote power or ability, (3) that _must_ denotes necessity, (4) that
+_would_ denotes determination, (5) that _should_ denotes obligation or
+duty.
+
+Any one of the verb phrases just studied may be made interrogative by
+transposition; as,—_May I borrow_ your knife?
+
+=246.= _Can_ and _must_ are used only in the indicative mode. Using
+_may_, _might_, _could_, _would_, and _should_ in subjunctive verb
+phrases, we say,—
+
+ Long _may_ it _wave_!
+
+ Oh, that he _would help_!
+
+ Though he _might be telling_ the truth, he would not be
+ believed.
+
+ If I _could go_ with father, I should be happy.
+
+ If it _should freeze_, we could go skating.
+
+If we look closely at these sentences, we shall see that the verbs denote
+(1) a wish, (2) something contrary to fact, (3) something uncertain. (See
+Lesson LII.)
+
+=247.= The seven auxiliaries just studied may be used in making passive
+verb phrases. Use the following phrases or similar ones in sentences:—
+
+ may be broken may have been taken
+ can be cut can have been heard
+ must be paid must have been bought
+ might be driven might have been kept
+ could be seen could have been done
+ would be hurt would have been stung
+ should be met should have been thrown
+
+=248.= Other verb phrases in very common use in speech are formed by
+means of the participle _going_. It is easy to imagine the following
+conversation as really taking place.
+
+ “I _am going to go_ to Niagara Falls next summer.”
+
+ “Why, _you were going to go_ there last summer. In fact, you
+ _have been going to go_ there every summer since I have known
+ you.”
+
+ “True enough. My intentions are good, but my purse is light.
+ Perhaps I _shall be going to go_ all my life, and then get to
+ heaven first after all.”
+
+Each of the four groups of italicized words is a verb phrase denoting an
+intention. Make ten similar phrases; as, _am going to sing_, _was going
+to eat_. Notice that _going_ does not denote the act of going anywhere to
+sing or to eat, as it does in “I am going to the Park to hear the band
+play,” but only the _purpose_ or _intention_ of singing or eating.
+
+=249.= Just as we denote an intended future action by using the word
+_going_, so we often denote a customary past action by a phrase in which
+we employ the verb _used_; as, “She _used to wear_ a little red cape,”
+“Johnson _used to touch_ every fence post that he passed.” The italicized
+words should not be separated here, but should be considered as one
+group or verb phrase.
+
+=250.= In speaking of any of the verb phrases described in this lesson,
+we may call them verbs; we decide their person and number by their
+subject, their voice and mode by their meaning, and their tense by their
+form.
+
+=251.= The verbs _have_ and _do_ are not always auxiliaries. They are
+sometimes principal verbs, and as such are conjugated in the various
+ways. What are the principal parts of _have?_ of _do_?
+
+Conjugate _have_ in the indicative mode; _do_ in the emphatic form;
+_have_ in the progressive form; _do_ in the passive voice, in the third
+person, singular number, using _it_ for the subject.
+
+=252.= Verbs like _rain_, _snow_, _hail_, etc., are sometimes called
+=impersonal verbs=, because they are used only in the third person
+singular with the pronoun _it_.
+
+=Summary.=—A =defective verb= is one that lacks one or more of its
+principal parts.
+
+Defective verbs are used as auxiliary verbs.
+
+The auxiliaries _may_, _can_, _must_, _might_, _could_, _would_, and
+_should_ are used to form certain common verb phrases.
+
+These verb phrases may be active or passive, declarative or
+interrogative, indicative or subjunctive mode, present, past, or present
+perfect tense.
+
+_Going_ is used to form verb phrases that denote a future or intended
+action.
+
+_Used_ is employed to form verb phrases that denote a customary past
+action.
+
+_Have_ and _do_ may be principal verbs as well as auxiliary verbs.
+
+=Impersonal verbs= are used only in the third person singular, with the
+neuter pronoun _it_.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Select all the verb phrases in the following sentences.
+Tell their voice, person, number, subject, and complement if they have
+any.
+
+ 1. What a bird it must be that could utter such wondrous sounds!
+
+ 2. From time to time the two rabbits would halt, sit up on
+ their hind quarters, erect their long, attentive ears, and
+ glance about warily with their bulging eyes.
+
+ 3.
+
+ The rich man’s son inherits cares;
+ The bank may break, the factory burn,
+ A breath may burst his bubble shares,
+ And soft white hands could hardly earn
+ A living that would serve his turn.
+
+ 4. All the girls in the class are going to wear pink chambray
+ dresses, and mother is going to make mine by hand.
+
+ 5. We can go by the North Road, the South Road, or the Middle
+ Road.
+
+ 6. Instead of candy, mother used to give him sugar in a cup,
+ and then he would stretch out on the sunny doorstep and feed
+ his sweet crystals to the flies.
+
+ 7. The Cottontails were now sole owners of the holes, and did
+ not go near them when they could help it, lest anything like a
+ path should be made that might betray their last retreats to an
+ enemy.
+
+ 8. If you are going to make orange marmalade to-morrow, you
+ must peel the oranges this evening.
+
+ 9. I should think that something might be done about covering
+ the cow’s horns; perhaps they might be padded with cotton.
+
+ 10. Governor Winthrop wrote his third wife tender messages in a
+ way that could only have come of long practice.
+
+ 11. The children used to stand at the window in the twilight,
+ and watch the lights appear in the houses; and when they had
+ counted ten, they used to clap their hands, and say, “Now,
+ mother, it is time to light the lamp.”
+
+ 12. On the usual crisp mornings of sugar season the snow at
+ such an hour would have borne a crust to crackle sharply under
+ every footstep.
+
+ 13. I had not told the horse that I was going to whip him, so
+ he was taken by surprise and started forward.
+
+ 14. Grandpa would not be helped into his overcoat.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Select all the verb phrases containing any form of _have_
+or _do_. Tell whether this form is used as an auxiliary or as a principal
+verb.
+
+ 1. Shere Khan does us great honor.
+
+ 2. Whoever has made a voyage up the Hudson must remember the
+ Kaatskill Mountains.
+
+ 3. Do you ever wonder how so much sin and wrong and suffering
+ can be in God’s world?
+
+ 4. Mother never forgot the millionaire’s daughter who said that
+ she did up her father’s shirts.
+
+ 5. All the Offal Court boys had this same hard time, so Tom
+ supposed it was the correct and comfortable thing.
+
+ 6. Where does amber get its strange, poetic charm?
+
+ 7. I never had the pleasure of meeting a crowing hen; but I
+ have known a great many whistling girls, and I cannot recall an
+ instance where their ends were any worse than those of other
+ girls.
+
+ 8. If I could have committed suicide without killing myself, I
+ should certainly have done so.
+
+ 9. She had eaten as many mouthfuls of breakfast as she possibly
+ could in her excited condition, had kissed everybody good-by
+ twice over, and now thought it was time to be starting.
+
+ 10. I can’t write a composition unless I have something to say,
+ can I?
+
+ 11. On these hard, smooth roads one horse will do the work of
+ two.
+
+ 12. I do not feel wholly sure that my Pussy wrote these letters
+ herself.
+
+ 13. The Boy had no fear of the undisputed Master of the Woods,
+ the big black bear.
+
+ 14. Do the duty that lies nearest thee; thy second duty will
+ already have become clearer.
+
+ 15. Jakie had been stolen from the nest before he could fly.
+
+ 16. I do wish that you and your father would turn around
+ directly and come home.
+
+ 17. Jane had had the inestimable advantage of a sorrow.
+
+ 18. The old bell had things all its own way up in the steeple.
+
+ 19. Boys always do the nice splendid things, and girls can only
+ do the nasty dull ones that get left over.
+
+ 20. After the twins had had measles and mumps, whooping cough
+ descended on the household.
+
+Tell the part of speech and use of _us_, sentence 1, _honor_ 1, _shirts_
+4, _same_ 5, _great_ 7, _two_ 11, _wholly_ 12, _herself_ 12, _bear_ 13,
+_clearer_ 14, _father_ 16, _home_ 16.
+
+=253.= Many errors are made in the use of the auxiliaries _may_ and
+_can_, _would_ and _should_.
+
+We should use _may_ to denote permission, liberty, or possibility, and
+_can_ to denote power or ability.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Supply the correct word in each of these sentences, and
+give your reason in each case:—
+
+ 1. What —— I do to help you?
+
+ 2. You —— have a watch when you graduate.
+
+ 3. I —— go by boat, but it is doubtful.
+
+ 4. —— you run an automobile?
+
+ 5. —— we have a school paper?
+
+ 6. Do you think that I —— earn ten dollars a week?
+
+ 7. Fred, you —— open the east windows.
+
+ 8. If we walk fast, we —— surely get there in time.
+
+ 9. We —— get there in time, but we shall have to hurry.
+
+Make three good sentences containing _may_ and three containing _can_.
+
+_Would_ is used to denote,—
+
+(1) Determination; as, “Albert _would_ leave school.”
+
+(2) Inclination; as, “I _would_ read more if I could.”
+
+(3) Customary past action; as, “We _would_ listen to her songs hour after
+hour.”
+
+_Should_ is used to denote,—
+
+(1) Simple intention; as, “I _should_ come often if you did not live so
+far.”
+
+(2) Obligation or duty; as, “We _should_ honor our parents.” Perhaps
+these auxiliaries are oftenest misused when associated with the verb
+_like_. The expression, “I would like to go,” is wrong, because it means
+“I am inclined or determined to like something,” which is not good
+sense. We should say,—
+
+ I should like to go We should like to go
+ You would like to go You would like to go
+ He would like to go They would like to go
+
+In a dependent clause _should_ denotes merely an imaginary condition, and
+_would_ denotes inclination as well as an imaginary condition.
+
+The clauses, “If I should lose my watch,” “If you should lose your
+watch,” “If he should lose his watch,” are equivalent to the present
+tense of the subjunctive mode, and denote merely an imaginary condition.
+
+The clauses, “If I would study harder,” “if you would study harder,” “if
+he would study harder,” denote an imaginary condition that may become
+real according to the inclination of the subject.
+
+What is the meaning of the familiar dependent clause in the following
+sentence: “If it would only snow, we could have a sleigh ride?”
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Supply the correct word in each of these sentences, and
+give your reason in each case:—
+
+ 1. You —— study the text before you undertake the exercise.
+
+ 2. What —— you do with him, Mr. Dick?
+
+ 3. I —— wash him and put him to bed.
+
+ 4. Neither of the boys —— obey me.
+
+ 5. As soon as day broke, the canary —— begin to sing.
+
+ 6. I —— like to meet your grandfather.
+
+ 7. Any girl —— be satisfied with two new hats.
+
+ 8. They —— all like to come, I am sure.
+
+ 9. I —— not take one cent of his money.
+
+ 10. I —— think that you —— be glad to work.
+
+ 11. Each man —— keep himself loyal to truth.
+
+ 12. If I —— tell the story, the children —— not be satisfied.
+
+ 13. If I —— tell them stories all day long, they —— not be
+ satisfied.
+
+Make five good sentences containing _would_, and five containing _should_.
+
+The verb _have got_ is often misused for the verb _have_. “I have it”
+means “I possess it,” while “I have got it” means “I have procured
+it.” “I have to go” means “I must go,” while “I have got to go” is an
+incorrect expression.
+
+=Exercise 3.=—Supply _has_ or _have_, _has got_, or _have got_ in each
+of the following sentences, and give your reason in each case. Use the
+negative word _not_, if necessary.
+
+ 1. —— you tickets for the entertainment?
+
+ 2. No, I —— them yet.
+
+ 3. Can he buy a farm if he —— no money?
+
+ 4. —— you a chisel, Albert?
+
+ 5. No, I —— one, but Herman —— one.
+
+ 6. At last he —— a position on the police force.
+
+ 7. We —— a fruit farm and father —— a new tenant on it.
+
+ 8. We —— to practice at four o’clock.
+
+ 9. I can’t go to the football game for I —— to work Saturday
+ afternoons.
+
+ 10. Nobody —— to leave before nine o’clock.
+
+What correct expressions can you substitute for _has got_ in the familiar
+sentence, “Madge has got to do as I say”?
+
+
+
+
+LXII. DIRECT AND INDIRECT DISCOURSE
+
+
+=254.= In the sentence,—Ruth said, “_I like your cake_,” we have a
+=direct quotation=, the exact words spoken by Ruth. A direct quotation is
+often called =direct discourse=.
+
+In the sentence,—_Ruth said that she liked my cake_, we have an =indirect
+quotation= containing the substance, or thought, of Ruth’s remark, but
+not her exact words. An indirect quotation is often called =indirect
+discourse=.
+
+=255.= In changing from direct to indirect discourse, we are likely to
+make a change in personal pronouns, as well as in the tense of verbs.
+An indirect quotation usually takes the form of a dependent clause
+beginning with the word _that_. If the verb of saying that usually
+precedes an indirect quotation is in the present tense, then the verb in
+the quotation is likely to be in the present or the future tense; but if
+the verb of saying is in the past tense, then the verb in the quotation
+is likely to be in the past tense; as,
+
+ Father _says_ that he _is_ on the jury.
+
+ Father _said_ that he _was_ on the jury.
+
+Can you account for the tense of the verb in the indirect quotation in
+this sentence,—Somebody once said that the pen is mightier than the sword?
+
+=256.= When a direct quotation containing the word _shall_ is changed
+to an indirect quotation, _shall_ is retained if the verb of saying
+preceding the quotation is in the present tense; but if this verb is
+in the past tense, then _shall_ is changed to _should_. In like manner
+_will_ is changed to _would_; as,—
+
+ Mother says, “I shall be voting soon.”
+
+ Mother says that she shall be voting soon.
+
+ Mother said that she should be voting soon.
+
+ Mother says, “I will make him a pillow.”
+
+ Mother says that she will make him a pillow.
+
+ Mother said that she would make him a pillow.
+
+=257.= If a direct quotation is a question, it becomes an indirect
+question when changed to indirect discourse; as,—
+
+ He asked, “Why do you tremble so?”
+
+ He asked me why I trembled so.
+
+=258.= A command may be changed from direct to indirect discourse; as,—
+
+ Christ said, “Love your enemies.”
+
+ Christ said that we should love our enemies.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Account for the use of _shall_, _will_, _should_, and
+_would_ in the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. The teacher said, “I shall be pleased to go.”
+
+ 2. The teacher said that she should be pleased to go.
+
+ 3. Aunt Elsie said, “I will tell you the story to-morrow.”
+
+ 4. Aunt Elsie said that she would tell us the story to-morrow.
+
+ 5. The principal said, “You shall have no recess to-day.”
+
+ 6. The principal said that we should have no recess to-day.
+
+ 7. Mother said, “You will be late.”
+
+ 8. Mother said that I should be late.
+
+ 9. The mayor said, “The matter shall be investigated.”
+
+ 10. The mayor said that the matter should be investigated.
+
+ 11. The director said, “The celebration will be on Tuesday.”
+
+ 12. The director said that the celebration would be on Tuesday.
+
+ 13. The teacher said, “David and Harry shall not take part.”
+
+ 14. David and Harry, the teacher said that you should not take
+ part.
+
+ 15. The boys said, “David and Harry will be sorry.”
+
+ 16. David and Harry, the boys said that you would be sorry.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Change the following sentences from direct to indirect
+discourse:—
+
+ 1. Longfellow said, “Life is real, life is earnest.”
+
+ 2. John wrote, “I know that Shep will give you a warm welcome
+ when you come.”
+
+ 3. The lawyer demanded, “Mr. Christoff, what have you done with
+ the company’s books?”
+
+ 4. The Bible says, “Give to him that asketh.”
+
+ 5. Patrick Henry asked, “When shall we be stronger?”
+
+ 6. The eloquent speaker said, “The declaration of our
+ independence will strengthen us at home, and give us character
+ abroad.”
+
+ 7. The great orator declared, “If we fail, it can be no worse
+ for us. But we shall not fail. The cause will raise up armies.”
+
+ 8. He admitted, “We may not live to the time when this
+ declaration shall be made good.”
+
+ 9. Then he uttered this prophecy: “This declaration must cost
+ treasure, and it may cost blood; but it will stand, and it will
+ richly compensate for both.”
+
+ 10. Every listener was moved when the statesman said, “If it
+ be the pleasure of Heaven that my country shall require the
+ poor offering of my life, the victim shall be ready at the
+ appointed hour of sacrifice.”
+
+ 11. His closing words were these: “All that I have, and all
+ that I am, and all that I hope, in this life, I am now ready
+ here to stake upon it; and I leave off as I began, that live or
+ die, survive or perish, I am for the declaration.”
+
+=Exercise 3.=—Make the following sentences clear by changing them from
+indirect to direct discourse:—
+
+ 1. The teacher told Mrs. Gray that her little girl lost the
+ report she had given her.
+
+ 2. Jennie told Ada that her mother was willing that she should
+ go to the concert with her and her brother.
+
+ 3. Bertrand told George that he ought to sell his sailboat and
+ buy his launch.
+
+ 4. The teachers asked the young men why they had made such a
+ disturbance in the corridor when they had forbidden them to
+ congregate there.
+
+
+
+
+LXIII. AGREEMENT OF VERB AND SUBJECT. COLLECTIVE NOUNS
+
+
+=259.= A verb must agree with its subject in number, and since the verb
+changes its form sometimes to denote number, we must be careful to employ
+the correct form. We should say, “The rose _is_ red, the roses _are_ red;
+the wind _does_ blow, the winds _do_ blow; the bird _flies_, the birds
+_fly_.”
+
+=260.= This agreement of the subject and the verb is a simple matter in
+English, for in our language verbs have the same form in the singular and
+the plural, except in four cases:—
+
+(1) The verb _be_, which changes its form considerably to indicate
+number, in the present and past tenses. See page 128.
+
+(2) Any verb in the second person conjugated in the solemn style. See
+page 128.
+
+(3) Any verb in the third person of the present tense, indicative mode;
+as, he _speaks_, they _speak_.
+
+(4) Any verb in the third person of the present perfect indicative; as,
+he _has_ spoken, they _have_ spoken.
+
+=261.= As _don’t_ is a contraction of _do not_, it should be used only
+with a plural subject, or with the singular pronouns _I_ and _you_. We
+say, “I _don’t_ know,” “You _don’t_ know,” “They _don’t_ know,” but “He
+_doesn’t_ know,” “She _doesn’t_ know,” “It _doesn’t_ come.”
+
+=262.= A compound subject composed of two or more singular nouns should
+have a plural verb when the parts are joined by any conjunction but _or_
+or _nor_. We say, “Either John or Byron _is_ her cousin,” and “Both John
+and Joe _are_ her cousins.”
+
+When two singular subjects refer to one person, the verb, of course,
+should be singular. We say, “The secretary and treasurer _was_ absent.”
+
+=263.= When a singular noun is modified by the limiting adjective _each_,
+_every_, _either_, _neither_, _any_, or _no_, and used as subject of
+a clause, its verb must be singular; as, “Each flower _is_ a thing of
+beauty,” “No man _lives_ but loves something.”
+
+In declarative sentences this rule is not likely to be violated, but it
+is often violated in interrogative sentences, where the verb precedes the
+subject. We should say, “_Has_ either book been returned?” “_Is_ either
+of you willing to stay?” “_Was_ neither of the speakers on time?”
+
+=264.= There is a class of nouns like _flock_, _army_, _herd_, _company_,
+which mean a collection of individuals, and so seem to be plural; but
+since the individuals forming the collection are thought of as one body,
+these nouns are in reality singular. They are =collective nouns=.
+
+=265.= The verb of which a collective noun is subject is a singular verb,
+and the pronoun that stands for a collective noun is the neuter singular
+pronoun _it_. We say, “The company _is_ on _its_ way to the Philippines.”
+
+ NOTE.—When a collective noun is plural in meaning, that is,
+ when the individuals are thought of as acting separately,
+ it takes a plural verb; as, “The faculty _are_ not going to
+ trouble _their_ heads about the kind of shoes we wear.”
+
+=Summary.=—A verb must agree with its subject in person and in number.
+
+A =collective= noun is one that names a group of individuals considered
+as one body.
+
+A collective noun is usually singular and neuter.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—If you do not already know, find out from the dictionary to
+what sort of individuals each of these collective nouns is applied.
+
+ bevy
+ choir
+ committee
+ constellation
+ covey
+ crew
+ drove
+ family
+ fleet
+ flock
+ gang
+ hive
+ horde
+ jury
+ mob
+ orchestra
+ regiment
+ swarm
+ tribe
+ troop
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Find all the collective nouns in these sentences. Find
+evidence as to whether they are singular or plural. If they are plural,
+tell why. Give the reason for the number of each verb.
+
+ 1. Forty wolves make a very fair pack indeed.
+
+ 2. At the edge of the thicket was a straggling colony of low
+ blueberry bushes.
+
+ 3. Here, in course of days, there accumulated a shining cluster
+ of six large white eggs.
+
+ 4. At last cousin Eben came with a double sleigh and the team
+ of prancing grays, and then the whole family was off for
+ Christmas dinner at Aunt Mary’s.
+
+ 5. Has either of the critics ever heard the new organ?
+
+ 6. No man in his senses takes such a risk.
+
+ 7. A school of porpoises were ducking and tearing through the
+ water.
+
+ 8. Through the ancient forest, which was a mixed growth of
+ cedar, water ash, black poplar, and maple, with here and
+ there a group of hemlocks on a knoll, the light drained down
+ confusedly.
+
+ 9. The opinions of this junto were completely controlled by
+ Nicholas Vedder.
+
+ 10. Is either of you going up the river in the houseboat?
+
+ 11. This band of crows numbered about two hundred.
+
+ 12. Each year the old crow came with his troop, and for about
+ six weeks took up his abode on the hill.
+
+ 13. Here and there a band of chimney sweeps were staring in
+ stupid wonder at the miracle of a showman’s box.
+
+ 14. Butler tells of an Indian tribe in the Far North that was
+ all but exterminated by a feud over a dog.
+
+ 15. On a level spot was a company of odd-looking personages
+ playing at ninepins.
+
+ 16. Every word on his papers was correctly spelled.
+
+ 17. The rest of the horses swept dutifully into line, and the
+ herd was off.
+
+
+
+
+LXIV. REVIEW OF VERBS: PARSING
+
+
+=266.= Study again Lessons XXIII-XXVII, XLIX-LXIII. Make an outline of
+verbs, having the following main topics:—
+
+(1) Classification.
+
+(2) Properties.
+
+(3) Conjugation.
+
+(4) Principal Parts.
+
+(5) Auxiliaries.
+
+(6) Agreement.
+
+Fill in the subtopics and recite in detail from your outline with
+illustrations of every point.
+
+=Exercise.=—Parse the verbs in the following sentences according to the
+outline on p. 150:—
+
+ 1. If you have a Halloween party, shall you invite the Cromers?
+
+ 2. At first the chemist said he couldn’t do anything about it;
+ but when Agamemnon said they would pay in gold if he would only
+ go, he packed up his bottles in a leather case, and went back
+ with the Peterkins.
+
+ 3.
+
+ Faith’s journeys end is welcome to the weary,
+ And heaven, the heart’s true home, will come at last.
+
+ 4. We are going to have a tile well, and Mr. Jones is going to
+ oversee the men who dig it.
+
+ 5. This woodchuck was neither handsome nor interesting, but he
+ knew how to take care of himself.
+
+ 6. Sheep are usually kept in flocks of from one thousand to
+ three thousand under one or more shepherds.
+
+ 7. Rabbits telegraph each other by thumping on the ground with
+ their hind feet.
+
+ 8. Lady Moon, Lady Moon, where are you roving?
+
+ 9.
+
+ Breast the wave, Christian, when it is strongest.
+ Watch for day, Christian, when the night’s longest.
+
+ 10. Even so did men talk round the king’s cages at Oodeypore.
+
+ 11. Your Uncle Nathan and I used to be called the bothering
+ Bodleys, because we were always teasing to find out something.
+
+ 12. The Peterkins had been so busy inside the house that they
+ had not noticed the ceasing of the storm outside.
+
+ 13. For thou, Lord, wilt give thy blessing unto the righteous,
+ and with thy favorable kindness wilt thou defend him as with a
+ shield.
+
+ 14. My father’s, like every other young ladies’ school near
+ a village, was very much disturbed by the attentions of the
+ village young men.
+
+ 15. If any man have a hundred sheep, and one of them be gone
+ astray, doth he not leave the ninety and nine and go into the
+ mountains and seek that which goeth astray?
+
+ 16. They were sitting round the breakfast table and wondering
+ what they should do because the lady from Philadelphia had gone
+ away.
+
+
+
+
+LXV. CLASSIFICATION OF ADVERBS. SIMPLE ADVERBS
+
+
+=267.= In Lesson X it was shown that an adverb modifies a verb, an
+adjective, or another adverb. Select the adverbs in the following
+sentences, and tell what words they modify:—
+
+ We proceeded through a tract of country excessively wild and
+ desolate.
+
+ People with lanterns rushed hither and thither.
+
+ John knew that he could spend a day very pleasantly in going
+ over to that pasture.
+
+All the adverbs in these sentences are called =simple adverbs= because
+they have but one office in the sentence,—they merely modify the word
+they go with.
+
+=268.= In the sentence, “Perhaps my pony can carry the load,” the word
+_perhaps_ tells nothing whatever about the action of carrying, but
+rather serves to make the whole statement doubtful. Such a word is said
+to modify the whole sentence. Some other adverbs used in this way are
+_certainly_, _indeed_, _fortunately_, and _not_.
+
+The common use of the adverb _not_ is to change an affirmative statement
+to a negative statement, as in the sentence, “I will not wear my heart
+upon my sleeve.”
+
+=269.= The simple adverbs, _when_, _where_, _why_, _how_, _whence_,
+_whither_, are used in asking questions; as, “_When_ shall we be
+stronger?” “_Why_ do you answer me so?” Such adverbs modify the whole
+predicate. They are called =interrogative adverbs=.
+
+ NOTE.—_The_ is sometimes used as an adverb before comparatives;
+ as, “_The_ more you have, _the_ more you want.”
+
+=270.= When the meaning permits, adverbs may be compared in the same
+manner as adjectives; as, _fast_, _faster_, _fastest_; _pleasantly_,
+_more pleasantly_, _most pleasantly_; _fortunately_, _less fortunately_,
+_least fortunately_.
+
+=Summary.=—A =simple adverb= is one that merely modifies the word or the
+group of words that it goes with.
+
+Some simple adverbs, like _not_, _perhaps_, _certainly_, modify the whole
+sentence.
+
+An =interrogative adverb= is a simple adverb that is used in asking a
+question.
+
+Some adverbs may be compared.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the simple adverbs in the following sentences,
+and tell what each modifies. In so far as you can, tell what each adverb
+denotes. (See Lesson X.)
+
+ 1. How the huge breakers foam and fret!
+
+ 2. People living by the sea are always more or less
+ superstitious.
+
+ 3. No one can work well without sleep.
+
+ 4. Whence came that blessed mother love, so strong, so
+ dauntless, so pure, and whither has it fled?
+
+ 5. Where had the stone been before? Why did it come there? When
+ would it go away?
+
+ 6. Heaven is not reached at a single bound.
+
+ 7. Luckily, poor Pepper was not seriously hurt.
+
+ 8. Meanwhile Mrs. Peterkin was getting quite impatient for her
+ coffee.
+
+ 9. How do you like to go up in a swing, up in the air so blue?
+
+ 10. Why should one hurry when days are long and calm and sweet?
+
+ 11. You may lead a horse to water, but you cannot make him
+ drink.
+
+ 12. Presently a huge black bear poked his nose out of the
+ bushes, and sniffed inquiringly.
+
+ 13. How quickly we learn to claim as our own that in which we
+ delight!
+
+
+
+
+LXVI. CONJUNCTIVE ADVERBS
+
+
+=271.= In Lesson XX we learned that a dependent clause is one that does
+not make sense when standing alone; also that such a clause sometimes has
+the office of an adverb, modifying a predicate, and sometimes that of
+an adjective, modifying a noun. It is, therefore, called an =adverbial
+clause= or an =adjective clause=.
+
+Select and classify the dependent clauses in each of the following
+sentences:—
+
+ (_a_) Old Stony Phiz set out on a visit to the valley where he
+ was born.
+
+ (_b_) When I first came to Rivermouth, I looked upon girls as
+ rather tame company.
+
+=272.= A dependent clause is usually introduced by some word which
+indicates that it is a dependent clause. In the clause _where he was
+born_, this introductory word is _where_. What is the introductory word
+in the clause in sentence (_b_)?
+
+This introductory word does more than introduce the clause; it joins the
+clause to the word the clause modifies. What does _where_ join in (_a_)?
+What does the introductory word in (_b_) join?
+
+But these words do more than join. _Where_ denotes place, and modifies
+the verb _was born_. Hence it is an adverb. What does _when_ denote? What
+does it modify?
+
+Since these words have two uses, that of an adverb and that of a joining
+word, we call them =conjunctive adverbs=.
+
+=Summary.=—A =conjunctive adverb= is one that introduces a clause,
+modifies some part of the clause, generally the predicate, and joins the
+clause to that part of the sentence which the clause modifies.
+
+Some common conjunctive adverbs are _when_, _where_, _whence_,
+_whenever_, _wherever_, _while_, _why_, _how_. (See note, p. 177.)
+
+An =adverbial clause= is a dependent clause that is used like an adverb.
+
+An =adjective clause= is a dependent clause that is used like an
+adjective.
+
+Both the adjective and the adverbial clause may be introduced by a
+conjunctive adverb.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the conjunctive adverbs in the following
+sentences. Tell what clause they introduce, what they join, what they
+denote, and what they modify.
+
+ 1. When his eyes got command of the dusk, he saw to his
+ surprise that the den was empty.
+
+ 2. Mr. Gathergold bethought himself of his native valley, and
+ resolved to go back thither, and end his days where he was born.
+
+ 3. The canals in Amsterdam are crossed by a great many
+ drawbridges, and the people must sometimes wait while a ship or
+ barge is passing.
+
+ 4. Our lunch was only bread and tea and blueberries and cream,
+ but do you remember how delicious it tasted that day when you
+ came home from the circus as tired as a dog and as hungry as a
+ bear?
+
+ 5.
+
+ Whenever I cross the river
+ On its bridge with wooden piers,
+ Like the odor of brine from the ocean,
+ Comes the thought of other years.
+
+ 6. The reason why men succeed who mind their own business is
+ because there is so little competition.
+
+ 7.
+
+ The frugal snail, with forecast of repose,
+ Carries his house with him where’er he goes.
+
+ 8. When all the trees in the forest have the same number of
+ leaves, then will all men be alike in their power and skill.
+
+ 9.
+
+ While the breath’s in his mouth, he must bear without fail,
+ In the name of the Empress the Overland Mail.
+
+ 10.
+
+ Where’er our footsteps range,
+ Comes the chilling breath of change,
+ And the best of friends look strange
+ When the purse is low.
+
+ 11. The reason why men do not obey us is because they see the
+ mud at the bottom of our eye.
+
+ 12.
+
+ So shut your eyes while mother sings
+ Of wonderful sights that be.
+
+ 13. Chip answered me with a cheery little note or two whenever
+ I spoke to him.
+
+ 14.
+
+ My heart leaps up when I behold
+ A rainbow in the sky.
+
+
+
+
+LXVII. SUMMARY OF ADVERBS
+
+
+=273.= We have learned,—
+
+(1) That adverbs may be simple adverbs or conjunctive adverbs.
+
+(2) That simple adverbs merely modify some word or group of words.
+
+(3) That conjunctive adverbs modify, and at the same time introduce a
+dependent clause and join it to whatever the clause modifies.
+
+(4) That one kind of simple adverb is the interrogative adverb, which
+is used in asking a question.
+
+(5) That an adverb may modify a verb, an adjective, an adverb, a whole
+predicate, or even a whole statement.
+
+(6) That adverbs may denote time, place, manner, degree, and direction.
+
+(7) That some adverbs may be compared.
+
+Give a good illustration of each point in this summary.
+
+=274.= When we parse an adverb we should tell,—
+
+(1) Its class as to use,—simple, interrogative, conjunctive.
+
+(2) Its class as to meaning,—time, place, manner, etc.
+
+(3) Its degree (if it admits of comparison).
+
+(4) Its use, and what it modifies.
+
+=Exercise.=—Parse each adverb in the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. Virtue and intelligence will lead our country ever onward in
+ her happy career.
+
+ 2. Oh, why should the spirit of mortal be proud?
+
+ 3. The man in the moon came down too soon.
+
+ 4. Fortunately, what seemed to be a barrel of apples turned out
+ to be an electric lamp.
+
+ 5. The old horse cars rocked along scarcely faster than we
+ could walk.
+
+ 6. Calmly I await the hour when the summons comes for me.
+
+ 7. Somewhere the birds are singing evermore.
+
+ 8. I will lock the door most willingly, but I will not cover
+ the bird.
+
+ 9. Probably Frank was mightily relieved when he saw the mayor’s
+ automobile.
+
+ 10. Our side made a remarkably good score.
+
+ 11. Where shall we sit in the new church?
+
+
+
+
+LXVIII. COÖRDINATE CONJUNCTIONS
+
+
+=275.= We have learned that such words as _and_, _but_, and _or_ are
+conjunctions. Their use is merely to join, and they may join either
+words, phrases, or clauses. Since they join like elements,—a word to
+a word, a phrase to a phrase, a clause to a clause, a sentence to a
+sentence, we call them =coördinate= conjunctions.
+
+=276.= In the sentence, “Either the well was very deep or she fell very
+slowly,” the coördinate conjunction _or_, which joins two sentences, is
+preceded by the word _either_, which hints that _or_ is coming. When
+_either_ and _or_ are used in this way, they are called =correlatives=;
+that is, they are words related to each other. Other correlatives are
+_neither_, _nor_; _not only_, _but_; _both_, _and_. It is always the
+second word of these pairs that does the joining. The first merely tells
+the listener or reader what sort of sentence is to follow.
+
+ NOTE.—Frequently a coördinate conjunction has another word
+ going with it to change or emphasize its meaning. In the
+ sentence, “He is rich and yet he is not generous,” the word
+ _yet_ going with _and_ changes its meaning to _but_. In the
+ sentence, “He is poor, but still he is generous,” the word
+ _still_ reinforces the meaning of _but_. Such a word associated
+ with a conjunction may be said to be a part of the conjunction,
+ that is, the two words together do the joining. In the same way
+ the two words _not only_ form the correlative of _but_ or _but
+ also_; as, “He is not only a teacher but also a student.” What
+ does _but also_ join here?
+
+=Summary.=—A =coördinate conjunction= is one that joins like elements. It
+is sometimes more than one word.
+
+=Correlative coördinate conjunctions= are pairs of words, the second of
+which does the joining.
+
+=Exercise.=—When we parse a coördinate conjunction we tell its class and
+what it joins. If it has a correlative, we state that fact. Parse the
+coördinate conjunctions in the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. The writer who professes to care nothing for fame is
+ probably deceiving himself, or else his liver is out of order.
+
+ 2. Everybody took a holiday, and high and low, rich and poor,
+ feasted and danced and sang, and got very mellow.
+
+ 3. There was neither dust nor mud nor noise to annoy one.
+
+ 4. The mahogany arm chair is very handsome, and the green plush
+ rocker is very comfortable, but still I choose this little
+ chair with the flowers painted on the back, that mother gave to
+ me when I was only five.
+
+ 5. On its southern side is an elevated walk, or terrace, very
+ broad and handsome, and about half a mile long.
+
+ NOTE.—In the preceding sentence, try to discover under
+ what circumstances an appositive is joined to the word it
+ explains by _or_. Notice the punctuation. Make other
+ sentences illustrating this use of _or_.
+
+ 6. The road to Paradise is rough and thorny.
+
+ 7. His chief amusements were gunning and fishing, or sauntering
+ along the beach and through the myrtles.
+
+ 8. Neither hare nor grouse was stirring in the brushy opens.
+
+ 9. You know Mary always bangs things when she is cross, but I
+ never could see what good it does.
+
+ 10. When the two children went down to the river to play, they
+ not only disobeyed their mothers, but they also ran away from
+ school.
+
+ 11. I never looked either neat or clean, though I had my daily
+ bath and a generous allowance of clothes.
+
+ 12. Over the tree tops and from the open spaces in the wood
+ could be seen the first pallor of approaching day.
+
+ 13. In deep snow the moose can neither flee nor fight.
+
+ 14. They always put Mammy Tittleback in the carriage too; but
+ before they had carried her far, she generally jumped out, and
+ walked the rest of the way by their side.
+
+ 15. These Spaniards wished to build ships and to get away; but
+ they had neither knowledge nor tools nor iron nor forge nor tow
+ nor resin nor rigging.
+
+ 16.
+
+ He prayeth best who loveth best
+ All things both great and small.
+
+Tell the part of speech and use of _himself_, sentence 1, _high_, _low_
+2, _mellow_ 2, _when_ 4, _neat_ 11, _allowance_ 11, _pallor_ 12.
+
+
+
+
+LXIX. SUBORDINATE CONJUNCTIONS
+
+
+=277.= We have learned that a dependent clause is often used as an adverb
+to modify a predicate. When so used, it is joined to the predicate it
+modifies by some connecting word.
+
+Sometimes this connecting word is a conjunctive adverb, as was pointed
+out in Lesson LXVI, but more often it is some other word, as in the
+following sentences:—
+
+ Sheep are such senseless creatures _that_ they are liable to be
+ stampeded by the veriest trifle.
+
+ You cannot catch a muskrat _unless_ you put tar on his nose.
+
+ I love hens _because_ they are such good mothers.
+
+What is the dependent clause in each of these sentences? What does it
+modify? What word joins it to that part of the sentence which it modifies?
+
+These connecting words,—_that_, _unless_, and _because_,—are not adverbs,
+for they do not modify any word. They merely connect, hence they are
+conjunctions. Since they connect elements not alike, not equal in rank,
+they are called =subordinate conjunctions=.
+
+=278.= There are many subordinate conjunctions. The most common are
+_after_, _although_, _as_, _because_, _before_, _for_, _if_, _in order
+that_, _lest_, _provided_, _since_, _so that_, _than_, _that_, _though_,
+_till_, and _unless_.
+
+ NOTE.—There is little distinction between the subordinate
+ conjunction and the conjunctive adverb. Both connect a
+ dependent to a principal clause; and some subordinate
+ conjunctions, like conjunctive adverbs, express time, cause, or
+ manner, etc. For this reason, _as_, _after_, _before_, _since_,
+ _till_, etc. are included by some authors among conjunctive
+ adverbs. Compare, “I came _when_ you called me” with “I came
+ _before_ you called me.”
+
+=Summary.=—A =subordinate conjunction= is one that introduces a dependent
+clause, and joins it to that part of the sentence which it modifies.
+
+=Exercise.=—Parse the conjunctions in the following sentences. Tell their
+class and what they join.
+
+ 1. The four cubs, running down hill on their bellies, melted
+ into the thorn and underbrush as a mole melts into a lawn.
+
+ 2. Boys will do any amount of work provided it is called play.
+
+ 3. The great horned owl stood so erect and motionless that he
+ seemed a portion of the pine trunk itself.
+
+ 4. Since the maples were cut down, the elms have flourished.
+
+ 5. Androclus had not lain long quiet in the cavern, before he
+ heard a dreadful noise, which seemed to be the roar of some
+ wild beast, and terrified him very much.
+
+ 6. Harry laughed till the tears ran down his cheeks.
+
+ 7. Unless you have sat on a stone fence and beaten russet
+ apples soft on its hard top, you have missed one of the
+ greatest delicacies that the orchard gives.
+
+ 8. I liked the doctor very much, for he would let me drive
+ around with him, and hold his horse while he made his
+ professional calls.
+
+ 9. Fast the ivy stealeth on, though he wears no wings.
+
+ 10. Even after the invitations were sent out, it seemed to
+ Dolly that the party day would never come.
+
+ 11. The shawl doll was my favorite because it was more nearly
+ the size of a real baby.
+
+ 12. The two young Cratchits crammed spoons into their mouths
+ lest they should shriek for goose before their turn came to be
+ helped.
+
+ 13. A man would laugh if you told him that he had never really
+ seen a burdock.
+
+Select all the verbs in the sentences above. Classify them as transitive
+or intransitive. Tell their voice, mode, and tense.
+
+=279.= Some words may be used as conjunctions, as prepositions, or as
+adverbs.
+
+ =After.=
+
+ Conj.—I came _after_ you called me the second time.
+
+ Adv.—We look before and _after_, and pine for what is not.
+
+ Prep.—Let us walk to the lake _after_ school.
+
+ =Before.=
+
+ Conj.—The roosters woke me _before_ the sun rose.
+
+ Adv.—They had never seen mountains _before_.
+
+ Prep.—In winter we get up _before_ daylight.
+
+ =But.=
+
+ Conj.—I am weak, _but_ Thou art mighty.
+
+ Prep.—He relishes no fruit _but_ apples.
+
+ Adv.—We can _but_ die.
+
+ =Else.=
+
+ Conj.—You must tell the truth, _else_ you will not be trusted.
+
+ Adv.—How _else_ can we get to Berlin?
+
+ Adv.—Where _else_ shall I look for your glasses?
+
+ NOTE.—What part of speech is _else_ in the sentences, “What
+ _else_ can I do for you?” “Who _else_ was there?”
+
+ =For.=
+
+ Conj.—Work _for_ the night is coming.
+
+ Prep.—The faithful slave died _for_ his young master.
+
+ =Hence.=
+
+ Conj.—Smoke is coming out of the chimney, _hence_ the house
+ must be occupied.
+
+ Adv.—Let me go _hence_ and be no more seen.
+
+ =Only.=
+
+ Conj.—I should be glad to go, _only_ I have nothing to wear.
+
+ Adv.—I made the cake; mother _only_ baked it.
+
+ NOTE.—What part of speech is _only_ in the sentence, “Grace
+ is an _only_ child”?
+
+ =Since.=
+
+ Conj.—I have been happy _since_ you became my friend.
+
+ Prep.—Prices have never gone down _since_ the war.
+
+ Adv.—One day the dog disappeared, and he has never been heard
+ of _since_.
+
+ =So.=
+
+ Conj.—The baby monopolized her time, _so_ she withdrew from the
+ club.
+
+ Adv.—Don’t speak _so_ loud, Caroline.
+
+ =Till= or =Until.=
+
+ Conj.—Tarry thou _till_ I come.
+
+ Prep.—We work hard _until_ noon.
+
+ =Yet.=
+
+ Conj.—She speaks much, _yet_ she says very little.
+
+ Adv.—Has the case been settled _yet_?
+
+Explain the use of each italicized word in the sentences above.
+
+=280.= When we parse a preposition, we tell (1) what phrase it
+introduces, and (2) what words it shows a relation between; thus, “In
+the sentence, ‘I bring you tidings of great joy,’ the preposition _of_
+introduces the adjective phrase _of great joy_, and shows a relation
+between its object _great joy_ and the noun _tidings_.”
+
+=Exercise.=—Parse all the conjunctions, adverbs, and prepositions in the
+following sentences:—
+
+ 1. Roger Conant came over from England before 1630.
+
+ 2. We had a cold spell in April, so the peach crop is small.
+
+ 3. Our flag was still there.
+
+ 4. The barn was strongly built, so it was made over into a good
+ house.
+
+ 5. Ours is a government of the people, for the people, and by
+ the people.
+
+ 6. Look before you leap.
+
+ 7. Years have passed since anybody remembered my birthday.
+
+ 8. The poet saw the daffodils beside the lake.
+
+ 9. After the boy arrived in Richmond, he slept under a sidewalk.
+
+ 10. Did anybody besides Rufus go with you to Janesville?
+
+ 11. Mr. Micawber would pay his debts if something would only
+ turn up.
+
+ 12. Jill came tumbling after.
+
+ 13. The turkey was steamed first, else it would not have been
+ so tender.
+
+ 14. The fern has grown fast since Easter.
+
+ 15. I can’t paint well if you look over my shoulder.
+
+ 16. There is nothing to breathe but air.
+
+ 17. Wait till the clouds roll by.
+
+ 18. Disappointments will surely come, yet they need not crush
+ us.
+
+ 19. I will go before the king.
+
+ 20. Did you make your will before you went round the world?
+
+
+
+
+LXX. ADVERBIAL CLAUSES OF TIME, PLACE, AND MANNER
+
+
+=281.= Adverbial clauses are used in many different relations. Frequently
+they denote the =time= when an action is performed; as, “When the pie was
+opened, the birds began to sing.” Here the clause tells when the birds
+began to sing, and hence modifies the predicate. It is joined to _began
+to sing_ by the conjunctive adverb _when_.
+
+A subordinate connective does not have to come _between_ the elements
+that it joins. This enables us to put a dependent clause at the beginning
+of a sentence. What is the advantage of such an arrangement?
+
+An adverbial clause of time answers such questions as _when?_ _how
+often?_ _how long?_ It is joined to what it modifies by the conjunctive
+adverbs _when_, _while_, _whenever_, or by the subordinating conjunctions
+_before_, _after_, _till_, _until_, _since_, _as_.
+
+Sometimes, if the connective is _when_, and the clause comes first, we
+begin the principal proposition with the simple adverb _then_, which we
+call a correlative of _when_. Illustrate this.
+
+=282.= The adverbial clause may be used to tell the =place= where some
+action is performed; as, “The maid is standing with reluctant feet
+where the brook and river meet.” Here the clause tells where the maid
+is standing, and is joined to _is standing_ by the conjunctive adverb
+_where_.
+
+An adverbial clause of place answers such questions as _in what place?_
+_to what place?_ _from what place?_ It is introduced by the conjunctive
+adverbs _where_, _whence_, _whither_, _wherever_. Sometimes _there_ is
+used in the principal proposition as a correlative of _where_ in the
+clause. Which of these correlatives is the connective?
+
+=283.= Frequently the =manner= of an action, the way in which it was
+performed, is told by an adverbial clause; as, “Not as the conqueror
+comes, they the true-hearted came.” What is the clause here? What does
+it tell? What does it modify? What is the connective? What is the use of
+_not_?
+
+A clause of manner answers the question _in what way?_ It is joined to
+what it modifies by the subordinate conjunction _as_, _as if_, or _as
+though_. The simple adverb _so_ may be used as a correlative of _as_.
+
+=284.= The word _like_ is never a subordinate conjunction, hence it
+cannot properly be used for _as_ or _as if_. We should say, “Walk _as_
+(not _like_) I do;” “She walks _as if_ she were tired (not _like_ she was
+tired).” _Like_ may be used as a preposition to introduce a phrase; as,
+“Elizabeth walks _like him_.”
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Fill the blank in each of these sentences with the proper
+word, and explain your choice:—
+
+ 1. Mary sings —— a bird.
+
+ 2. It looks —— it would rain.
+
+ 3. The man speaks —— he knew his subject.
+
+ 4. March came in —— a lion.
+
+ 5. You knit just —— my grandmother does.
+
+ 6. The children ate —— they were hungry.
+
+ 7. Can you dance —— the gypsies do?
+
+ 8. Plant the seeds exactly —— I told you to.
+
+=Summary.=—An adverbial clause of =time= tells when a condition exists,
+or when an action was performed.
+
+An adverbial clause of =place= tells where a condition exists, or where
+an action was performed.
+
+An adverbial clause of =manner= tells in what way something was done.
+
+The connectives _when_, _where_, and _as_ are sometimes accompanied by
+the correlatives _then_, _there_, and _so_ respectively.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Select all the adverbial clauses in the following
+sentences. Tell what each clause denotes, what it modifies, and what its
+connective is. Study the punctuation of these sentences, and make a rule
+for the punctuation of adverbial clauses:—
+
+ 1. Your bicycle is a stationary bit of iron and india rubber,
+ until you put your feet upon the pedals and use your mind to
+ guide the wheel.
+
+ 2. The old man sits as if he were carved in stone.
+
+ 3. Where the snowflakes fall thickest, there nothing can freeze.
+
+ 4. When mother awoke and saw the burglar, she quietly ordered
+ him to leave; and only after she had pursued his obedient
+ figure to the door did it occur to her that the proper thing to
+ do was to scream.
+
+ 5. Where the peak leaned to the valley, the trunk of a giant
+ pine jutted forth slantingly from a roothold a little below the
+ summit.
+
+ 6. As we came up the harbor I had noticed that the houses were
+ huddled together on an immense hill.
+
+ 7.
+
+ I have come to meet judges so wise and so grand
+ That I shake in my shoes while they’re shaking my hand.
+
+ 8.
+
+ She struck where the white and fleecy waves
+ Looked soft as carded wool.
+
+ 9. Whither thou goest, I will go; and where thou lodgest, I
+ will lodge.
+
+ 10. When the blackbird approached that side of the cage, the
+ goldfinch dashed away as though he feared his strange neighbor
+ might come through.
+
+ 11.
+
+ I love to hear thine earnest voice wherever thou art hid,
+ Thou testy little dogmatist, thou pretty Katydid!
+
+ 12. At every little station a man popped out as if he were
+ worked by machinery, and waved a red flag, and appeared as
+ though he would like to have us stop.
+
+ 13. The little bandy-legged dogs had been trotting steadily for
+ many an hour, until their tongues hung out for want of breath.
+
+ 14. Years had passed since that particular panther had strayed
+ from his high fastnesses, where game was plentiful and none
+ dared poach on his preserves.
+
+ 15. I stood up and “hollered” with all my might, as everybody
+ does with oxen, as if they were born deaf, and whacked them
+ with the long lash over the head, just as the big folks did
+ when they drove.
+
+
+
+
+LXXI. ADVERBIAL CLAUSES OF CAUSE, PURPOSE, AND RESULT
+
+
+=285.= One action or condition may cause some other action or condition,
+and when we tell this, we often make such a sentence as the following,
+“Most caged birds are not happy, because few of them are well cared for.”
+Here the dependent proposition, _because few of them are well cared for_
+is an adverbial clause of =cause=, for it tells the cause of the fact in
+the principal clause, or why most caged birds are not happy.
+
+The adverbial clause of cause answers the question _why?_ or _how do you
+know?_ and is usually joined to the predicate that it modifies by the
+subordinate conjunction _for_, _because_, or _since_.
+
+=286.= Sometimes an action is performed in order that some other action
+or condition may come to pass. We say then that the action is performed
+for a =purpose=, and we express this purpose by means of an adverbial
+clause; as, “Leonardo da Vinci would walk the whole length of Milan that
+he might alter a single tint in his picture of the Last Supper.” Here
+the clause _that he might alter a single tint in his picture of the Last
+Supper_ tells the purpose that the artist had in walking the whole length
+of Milan. What does this clause modify? What is it introduced by?
+
+A clause of purpose answers the question _what for?_ It is usually joined
+to the predicate that it modifies by the subordinate conjunction _that_,
+_so that_, or _in order that_.
+
+=287.= A clause of purpose tells an intention without saying that this
+intention ever really comes to pass. But there is another clause which
+tells what really happens as an outcome of the action or condition in the
+principal clause. This is called a clause of =result=; for instance, “So
+porous is the limestone of the roads that in five minutes after a brisk
+shower one has no need of overshoes.” Here the principal clause tells us
+that the roads are porous, and the clause tells us what is the result, or
+outcome, of their being porous. What is the clause in this sentence? What
+does it modify? What is it introduced by?
+
+A clause of result answers the question _what of it?_, and is generally
+introduced by the subordinate conjunction _that_.
+
+=Summary.=—A clause of =cause= tells what produces a certain act or
+condition.
+
+A clause of =purpose= tells the intended consequence of some action.
+
+A clause of =result= tells the real consequence of some action or
+condition.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select the adverbial clauses, classify them, giving your
+reason in each case, tell what they modify, and what they are joined by.
+Account for the punctuation.
+
+ 1. I have explained thus carefully about my Bird Room because I
+ do not approve of keeping wild birds in cages.
+
+ 2. When Chipee had eaten all she could, she would quietly sit
+ down in the seed dish so that Chip couldn’t get any.
+
+ 3. Of course this bird could not be set free, for he did not
+ know how to take care of himself.
+
+ 4. One little nugget of purest gold the surveyor carefully
+ preserved, that it might one day become a wedding ring for the
+ gray-eyed girl in Maine.
+
+ 5. Had his nerves grown so sensitive that the staring of a
+ chipmunk or a rabbit had power to break his sleep?
+
+ 6. So strong was Polly’s liking for green peas that the sight
+ of raw peas made her wild till some were given to her.
+
+ 7. Master Fox said to the Crow, “Sing but one song to me, that
+ I may greet you as the Queen of Birds.”
+
+ 8. It is very convenient to be a reasonable creature, since it
+ enables you to find or make a reason for everything you have a
+ mind to do.
+
+ 9. Rebecca left the screen door ajar, so that flies came in.
+
+ 10. Rolf was called the Goer because he had such long legs that
+ when he mounted one of the little Norwegian horses, his feet
+ touched the ground.
+
+ 11. Dikes are built that the spread and flow of the water may
+ be regulated, and the land protected from destructive floods.
+
+ 12. The sun burned down so fiercely that the people were
+ fainting in its rays; it seemed as if they must die of heat,
+ and yet they were obliged to go on with their work, for they
+ were very poor.
+
+ 13. Then the people ran as only hill folk can run, for they
+ knew that in a landslip you must climb for the highest ground
+ across the valley.
+
+ 14.
+
+ Lord God of Hosts, be with us yet,
+ Lest we forget, lest we forget!
+
+ 15. I go to prepare a place for you, that where I am there ye
+ may be also.
+
+
+
+
+LXXII. ADVERBIAL CLAUSES OF CONDITION AND CONCESSION
+
+
+=288.= Very often an action cannot take place except under a certain
+condition, and this condition is often expressed in a dependent clause;
+as in the sentence, “A man can buy a vote only if some other man is
+willing to sell a vote.” Here the one condition under which a man can buy
+a vote is told in the adverbial clause, _if some other man is willing to
+sell a vote_. This is called a clause of =condition=. It is generally
+introduced by _if_, _unless_ (which means _if not_), _provided_, or
+_providing_. In the illustration what does the clause modify? What is the
+use of _only_?
+
+=289.= Sometimes an action takes place in spite of something else, and we
+tell this in such a sentence as the following, “Though He slay me, yet
+will I trust Him.” Here the fact that I trust Him is true in spite of the
+fact that He may slay me. Such a clause as _though He slay me_ is called
+a clause of =concession=, for it concedes, or grants, something that
+seems to be in direct opposition to what is in the principal clause. What
+does it modify? What can you say of the word _yet_?
+
+A clause of concession is generally joined by the subordinate conjunction
+_though_, or by some such word as _notwithstanding_, or _even if_, which
+means _though_.
+
+Sometimes _though_ has a correlative, the word _yet_, _still_, or
+_nevertheless_ used at the beginning of the principal clause.
+
+=Summary.=—A clause of =condition= answers the question _provided what?_
+It tells the circumstance under which the principal statement is true.
+
+A clause of =concession= answers the question _in spite of what?_ It
+tells the circumstance in spite of which the principal statement is true.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all adverbial clauses. Tell what each clause denotes,
+what it modifies, what it is joined by. Account for the punctuation.
+
+ 1. If your everyday language is not fit for a letter or for
+ print, it is not fit for talk.
+
+ 2. In Bermuda, if you are in want of some choice cologne, do
+ not fail to ask for it at the nearest shoe shop.
+
+ 3. Though delicate in his tastes, an elephant likes quantity as
+ well as quality, and at his meals makes nothing of bales of hay
+ and gallons of water.
+
+ 4. Though the weeping willow and the mountain ash could not
+ endure the cold northeast storms, yet the sturdy elms grew
+ apace and soon spread their branches far.
+
+ 5. Half the pleasure in going out to murder another man with a
+ gun would be wanting, if one did not wear feathers, and gold
+ lace, and stripes on his pantaloons.
+
+ 6. There is something queer about thoughts; you cannot have a
+ good time with them if you have done anything naughty.
+
+ 7.
+
+ Though watery deserts hold apart the worlds of East and West,
+ Still beats the selfsame human heart in each proud Nation’s breast.
+
+ 8. If our forefathers had not chosen to emigrate to America, we
+ should now be English people ourselves.
+
+ 9. Rebecca was so slender and so stiffly starched that she slid
+ from space to space on the leather cushions, though she braced
+ herself against the middle seat with her feet, and extended her
+ cotton-gloved hands on each side.
+
+ 10.
+
+ If the men were so wicked, I’ll ask my papa
+ How he dared to propose to my darling mamma.
+ Was he like the rest of them? Goodness! Who knows?
+ And what should I say if a wretch should propose?
+
+ 11. Though he looked like a bird, he behaved like a monkey.
+
+ 12.
+
+ Though the mills of God grind slowly, yet they grind exceeding small,
+ Though with patience he stands waiting, with exactness grinds he all.
+
+ 13. If the scythes cut well and swing merrily, it is due to the
+ boy who turned the grindstone.
+
+ 14. If a man write little, he had need have a great memory; if
+ he confer little, he had need have a present wit; and if he
+ read little, he had need have much cunning to seem to know
+ that he doth not.
+
+ 15.
+
+ Men must work and women must weep.
+ Though storms be sudden and waters deep.
+ And the harbor bar be moaning.
+
+Account for the mode of the verb in each dependent clause in the
+preceding sentences.
+
+
+
+
+LXXIII. ADVERBIAL CLAUSES OF COMPARISON
+
+
+=290.= Often we are not satisfied to say, “Cousin John is good.” We wish
+to tell _how_ good he is, and a common way of doing this is by means of a
+comparison. We say, “Cousin John is as good as gold.” Here the group of
+words _as gold_ is a clause with the word _is_ omitted. It is called a
+clause of =comparison=. It denotes an =equality= between John’s goodness
+and that of gold. Since this clause answers the question _how good?_ it
+must modify the adjective _good_.
+
+What is the introductory word of the clause of comparison?
+
+=291.= Sometimes we compare two things and yet denote an =inequality=
+between them; as in the sentence, “The river is bluer than the sky.” Here
+the clause of comparison is introduced by the subordinating conjunction
+_than_. It modifies the word _bluer_. We know this because it is the word
+_bluer_ that needs the clause, and without the word _bluer_ the clause
+would not be in the sentence at all.
+
+Notice that a clause of equality modifies an adjective in the positive
+degree, while a clause of inequality modifies an adjective in the
+comparative degree.
+
+=292.= A clause of comparison may modify an adverb as well as an
+adjective, as in these sentences:—
+
+ The old man moved as slowly as a cloud.
+
+ More swiftly than eagles, his coursers they flew.
+
+ NOTE.—The adverb _rather_ is seldom used without being modified
+ by a clause of comparison; as, “Henry Clay said that he would
+ rather be right than be president.” When we supply the words
+ understood, the clause reads, _than he would be president_.
+
+Complete the clauses in the following sentences:—
+
+ Some people would rather have money than brains.
+
+ I should rather earn a college education than go without it.
+
+ A wise American would rather go to Yellowstone Park than to
+ Switzerland.
+
+=Summary.=—A clause of =comparison= tells the degree of some quality or
+quantity by pointing out a likeness or a difference.
+
+A clause of comparison pointing out a =likeness= is introduced by _as_,
+and modifies an adjective or an adverb in the positive degree.
+
+A clause of comparison pointing out a =difference= is introduced by
+_than_, and modifies an adjective or an adverb in the comparative degree.
+
+A clause of comparison is seldom completely expressed.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the clauses of comparison. Tell what they denote,
+what they modify, and what they are introduced by.
+
+ 1. Sitting up on the driver’s high seat is almost as good as
+ climbing the meeting-house steeple.
+
+ 2.
+
+ The muscles of his brawny arms
+ Are strong as iron bands.
+
+ 3. The loons could dive quicker than the eagle could swoop and
+ strike.
+
+ 4. Gertrude was prouder than ever when the president of the
+ college said, “Your mother is handsomer than you will ever be,
+ young lady.”
+
+ 5.
+
+ The hearts that were thumping like ships on the rocks
+ Beat as quiet and steady as meeting-house clocks.
+
+ 6. Truth is stranger than fiction.
+
+ 7. I had rather have a fool to make me merry than experience to
+ make me sad.
+
+ 8.
+
+ Blue were her eyes as the fairy flax,
+ Her cheeks like the dawn of day,
+ Her bosom white as the hawthorn buds,
+ That ope in the month of May.
+
+ 9. One syllable of woman’s speech can dissolve more love than a
+ man’s heart can hold.
+
+ 10.
+
+ I am nearer my home to-day
+ Than I ever have been before.
+
+ 11. Whiter than snow were his locks, and his cheeks were as
+ brown as the oak leaves.
+
+ 12.
+
+ A steed as black as the steeds of night
+ Was seen to pass as with eagle flight.
+
+ 13. Weeds are sure to grow quicker in my garden than anywhere
+ else.
+
+ 14.
+
+ Dark as winter was the flow
+ Of Iser rolling rapidly.
+
+ 15. I should rather see the friezes of the Parthenon molder to
+ dust under the blue veil of the Grecian atmosphere than have
+ them preserved in the grand halls of the British Museum.
+
+ 16. The huge body of the elephant needs less sleep than
+ anything else that lives.
+
+=293.= Since the predicate is usually omitted in clauses of comparison,
+it follows that these clauses often consist of only two words; as, “I
+am as old as Mary.” “I am older than Mary.” One of these words is the
+connective, and the other is often the subject of the clause. When the
+subject is a pronoun, we must be careful to use the nominative form. We
+should say, “Are you older than _I_? than _he_? than _she_?”
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Fill the blank in each of these sentences. Then supply the
+words omitted, and thus show that you have chosen the right pronouns:—
+
+ 1. Our parents are wiser than (_we_ or _us_).
+
+ 2. You are not always so careful as (_she_ or _her_).
+
+ 3. Who knows the day better than (_me_ or _I_)?
+
+ 4. What! You are stronger than (_who_ or _whom_)?
+
+ 5. The Preston girls were just as friendly as (_me_ or _I_).
+
+ 6. No man could be more faithful than (_him_ or _he_).
+
+ 7. Who stands higher in this city than (_they_ or _them_).
+
+ 8. Are you older or younger than (_her_ or _she_)?
+
+ 9. Well, perhaps I am not so polite as (_he_ or _him_).
+
+ 10. Our geese are whiter than (_them_ or _they_).
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Justify the case of the italicized pronoun in each of these
+sentences:—
+
+ 1. Jessie likes Julia as well as _me_.
+
+ 2. I found her brother more easily than _her_.
+
+ 3. I expect an angel sooner than _them_.
+
+
+
+
+LXXIV. ANALYSIS OF SENTENCES
+
+
+=294.= We are ready now to analyze sentences containing adverbial
+clauses. In analyzing such sentences we should state as soon as we come
+to an adverbial clause, (1) what it denotes and (2) what part of speech
+its introductory word is. We should not analyze any dependent clause in
+detail, however, until we have completed our analysis of the principal
+clause.
+
+MODEL.—_The lion fixed his great hind claws in the softer skin of the
+crocodile’s throat, and ripped it open as one would rip a glove._
+
+This is a complex, declarative sentence.
+
+The subject is _the lion_. The predicate is _fixed his great hind claws
+in the softer skin of the crocodile’s throat, and ripped it open as one
+would rip a glove_.
+
+The predicate is compound, the two parts being joined by the conjunction
+_and_. The first predicate verb is _fixed_. It is completed by the direct
+object _his great hind claws_, and then modified by the prepositional
+phrase _in the softer skin of the crocodile’s throat_. The base word
+of the object is _claws_; it is modified by the adjectives _hind_ and
+_great_, and by the possessive pronoun _his_. The base word of the object
+of the preposition _in_ is _skin_. It is modified by the adjectives
+_softer_ and _the_, and by the prepositional phrase of _the crocodile’s
+throat_. The base word of the object of the preposition _of_ is _throat_;
+it is modified by the possessive noun _crocodile’s_, which is modified by
+the adjective _the_.
+
+The second predicate verb is _ripped_. It is completed by the direct
+object _it_ and the objective complement _open_, and then modified by
+the adverbial clause of manner _as one would rip a glove_, which is
+introduced by the subordinate conjunction _as_.
+
+The subject of this clause is the adjective pronoun _one_. The predicate
+is _would rip a glove_. The predicate verb is _would rip_. It is
+completed by the direct object _a glove_.
+
+=Exercise.=—Analyze the following sentences. When you write the analysis
+of a sentence, use abbreviations, and instead of writing out a group of
+words in full, as is done in the model, write only the first and last
+words of the group with a dash between them. Be sure to underline all
+words quoted from the sentence.
+
+ 1.
+
+ He looks the whole world in the face,
+ For he owes not any man.
+
+ 2. The young lion was growing so fast that the milk of three
+ goats was scarcely sufficient for him.
+
+ 3.
+
+ When the glorious sun is set,
+ When the grass with dew is wet,
+ Then you show your little light.
+
+ 4. When Charles was studying shorthand, his mother read sermons
+ to him for an hour every morning, so that he might have
+ practice in the writing of long words.
+
+ 5. If you save the pennies, the dollars will take care of
+ themselves.
+
+ 6.
+
+ Where the purple violet grows,
+ Where the bubbling water flows,
+ Where the grass is fresh and fine,
+ Pretty cow, go there and dine.
+
+ 7. Tommy, though he was getting a big boy, retained some of the
+ habits of a baby.
+
+ 8. I was sitting on the top rail of the front fence, when a
+ party of gypsies went by on their way to a camp.
+
+ 9.
+
+ The day is done, and the darkness
+ Falls from the wings of night,
+ As a feather is wafted downward
+ From an eagle in his flight.
+
+ 10. Whenever you see many drones, you will find plenty of young
+ bees.
+
+ 11. After the robins have pinched and shaken all the life
+ out of an earthworm, as Italian cooks pound all the spirit
+ out of a steak, and then gulped him, they stand up in honest
+ self-confidence, expand their red waistcoats with a virtuous
+ air, and outface you with their bold calm eyes.
+
+ 12. Moti Guj, the elephant, never trampled the life out of his
+ master Deesa, for, after the beating was over, Deesa would
+ embrace his trunk, and call him his love and his life and the
+ liver of his soul, and give him some liquor.
+
+ 13. If imitation be the sincerest form of flattery, the
+ mischief of the monkey should be regarded more leniently.
+
+ 14. I liked dolls well enough, though my assortment was not a
+ choice one.
+
+ 15. Her nails were so hard that they would yield to the
+ scissors only after a day’s soaking in hot soapsuds.
+
+ 16.
+
+ His words were shed softer than leaves from the pine,
+ And they fell on Sir Launfal as snows on the brine.
+
+
+
+
+LXXV. ADJECTIVE CLAUSES
+
+
+=295.= We learned in Lesson XX that a dependent clause often has the use
+of an adjective, that is, it modifies a noun; as in the sentence, “This
+is the house that Jack built.” Such a clause as _that Jack built_ is
+called an adjective clause. Why?
+
+=296.= An adjective clause may be used for two different purposes.
+
+(1) It may serve to point out a particular person, place, or thing; as,
+“This is the maiden all forlorn that milked the cow with the crumpled
+horn.” Here the clause tells what particular maiden is meant. A clause
+of this sort is called a =restrictive= clause, because it limits, or
+restricts, the application of the word it modifies.
+
+(2) An adjective clause may serve merely to bring in a new thought,
+something that is worth telling, of course, but still not necessary to
+the truth of the sentence; as, “My father had ten cows, which I had to
+escort to and from pasture night and morning.” This clause does not tell
+what particular cows my father had, but merely tells an additional fact
+about them. Such a clause as this is called an =unrestrictive= clause. It
+is set off by a comma.
+
+=297.= A restrictive clause is usually necessary to the truth of a
+sentence; as, “A city that is set on a hill cannot be hid,” “A prince
+that is a tyrant is unfit to rule.”
+
+To find out whether a clause is restrictive or not, determine first what
+word it modifies; then ask yourself the question, Did the author put this
+clause into the sentence to point out a particular object?
+
+Could such a term as _The Declaration of Independence_, _my mother’s
+father_, _Theodore Roosevelt_, _the planet Mars_, or _Boston_ be modified
+by a restrictive adjective clause?
+
+=Summary.=—An =adjective clause= is a dependent clause that modifies a
+noun or a pronoun.
+
+A =restrictive= adjective clause is one that points out a particular
+person, place, or thing. A restrictive clause is not set off by commas.
+
+An =unrestrictive= adjective clause is one that merely adds a new thought
+to the sentence. An unrestrictive clause is set off by a comma.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Select the adjective clauses. Tell what they modify. Then
+find out whether they are restrictive or not, and why.
+
+ NOTE.—Always test an adjective clause first to find out whether
+ it is restrictive. If you decide that it is not restrictive,
+ then it must be unrestrictive.
+
+ 1. Charley Marden, whose father had promised to cane him if he
+ ever set foot on sail or row boat, came down to the wharf in a
+ sour-grape humor to see us off.
+
+ 2. A sharp tongue is the only edged tool that grows keener with
+ constant use.
+
+ 3. From one corner of St. Paul’s churchyard runs the lively
+ street called Cheapside, from which John Gilpin started on his
+ famous ride.
+
+ 4. The reason why the women and children slept upon the floor
+ was their fear lest the Indians should fire through the windows
+ and kill them in their beds.
+
+ 5. The king whose despotic power was felt over the entire
+ extent of the cattle range was an old gray wolf.
+
+ 6. The monks who put peas in their shoes as a penance do not
+ suffer more than the country boy in his penitential Sunday
+ shoes.
+
+ 7. There is a girl in the carriage, who looks out at John, who
+ is suddenly aware that his trousers are patched on each knee
+ and in two places behind.
+
+ 8. He could see the pale and naked trunk of a pine tree, which
+ the lightning had shattered.
+
+ 9. The night that was so favorable to the wild rabbits was
+ favorable also to the fox, the wildcat, and the weasel.
+
+ 10. The only days that I can remember in Yonkers were hot.
+
+ 11.
+
+ All things that are on earth shall wholly pass away,
+ Except the love of God, which shall live and last for aye.
+
+ 12. Sleek, unwieldy porkers were grunting in the repose and
+ abundance of their pens, whence sallied forth, now and then,
+ troops of sucking pigs, as if to snuff the air.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Write sentences containing restrictive adjective clauses
+pointing out a certain river, a certain boy, a certain bridge, a certain
+house, a certain day.
+
+Write sentences containing unrestrictive clauses that tell something
+about the moon, the President of the United States, Salt Lake City, the
+Sistine Madonna, the Eiffel Tower.
+
+Write sentences containing adjective clauses introduced by the
+conjunctive adverbs _when_, _where_, and _why_. (See Lesson LXVI.) Tell
+whether your clauses are restrictive or unrestrictive.
+
+
+
+
+LXXVI. RELATIVE PRONOUNS
+
+
+=298.= Just as an adverbial clause is joined to what it modifies by a
+conjunctive adverb or a subordinate conjunction, so an adjective clause
+must be joined to the noun it modifies by some connecting word.
+
+In Lesson LXVI it was shown that this word may be a conjunctive adverb,
+as in the sentence, “I can never forget the night when I first heard the
+whippoorwill sing.” What is the clause here? What does it modify? How is
+it joined to the word that it modifies?
+
+=299.= Most adjective clauses are introduced by some other word than a
+conjunctive adverb. In the sentence, “The hand that rocks the cradle
+rules the world,” the adjective clause _that rocks the cradle_ is joined
+to the noun _hand_, which it modifies, by the word _that_. This word
+is used as subject of the verb _rocks_, and really means _hand_. Since
+it takes the place of a noun, it is a pronoun; and since this noun, or
+antecedent, precedes the pronoun, we say that the pronoun _relates_ to
+its antecedent, and we call it a =relative= pronoun.
+
+=300.= The relative pronouns that introduce adjective clauses are _who_,
+_which_, and _that_.
+
+_Who_ has three case forms: nominative, _who_; possessive, _whose_;
+objective, _whom_.
+
+_Which_ has the possessive form _whose_; _that_ has no possessive form.
+
+_Which_ and _that_ do not change their form for the objective case.
+
+=301.= A relative pronoun always has a use in the adjective clause that
+it introduces. This is the same use that the antecedent would have if it
+were used in place of the pronoun.
+
+The four common uses are:—
+
+(1) Subject of a verb; as, “He who fights and runs away may live to fight
+another day.”
+
+(2) Object of a verb; as, “This is the day that the Lord hath made.”
+
+(3) Object of a preposition; as, “I saw the room in which Shakespeare was
+born.”
+
+ NOTE.—Sometimes the pronoun comes before the preposition; as,
+ “The buggy that we rode in was low and light.”
+
+(4) Possessive modifier; as, “Any boy whose memory is good can learn a
+history lesson.”
+
+=302.= The relative pronoun _that_ introduces only restrictive adjective
+clauses. The pronouns _who_, _whose_, _whom_, and _which_ may introduce
+either restrictive or unrestrictive clauses.
+
+=303.= _Who_ has for its antecedent the name of some person; _which_ has
+for its antecedent the name of some thing. The antecedent of _that_ may
+be the name of a person or a thing.
+
+=304.= The word _but_ may be used as a relative pronoun as a substitute
+for the two words _that not_. Instead of saying, “There is no day that
+has not an end,” we may say, “There is no day _but_ has an end.” This is
+a better sentence than the first because it contains only one negative
+word.
+
+=305.= The word _as_ may be used as a relative pronoun following the
+words _such_, _same_, or _as many_. We say,—
+
+ I like _such_ flowers _as_ you sent me.
+
+ Your dress is the _same_ color _as_ mine.
+
+ I will take _as many_ apples _as_ will fill this basket.
+
+ I want _such_ a chair _as_ you are sitting in now.
+
+In each of the sentences above, what is the use of the relative pronoun
+_as_ in the clause that it introduces?
+
+=Summary.=—A =relative pronoun= is one that refers to a preceding noun or
+pronoun, and joins to it an adjective clause.
+
+The relative pronouns that introduce adjective clauses are _who_,
+_which_, and _that_.
+
+_As_ and _but_ are sometimes used as relative pronouns.
+
+=306.= When we parse a relative pronoun we tell,—
+
+(1) Its antecedent.
+
+(2) What adjective clause it joins to its antecedent.
+
+(3) Its case.
+
+(4) Its use in the adjective clause.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Parse all the relative pronouns in the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. In came the six young followers whose hearts the Misses
+ Fezziwig broke.
+
+ 2. There were the wide sweeps of forest through which the
+ winter tempests howled, upon which hung the haze of summer
+ heat, over which the great shadows of summer clouds traveled.
+
+ 3. Susie was a well-behaved child, who took care of her clothes
+ and played quiet games.
+
+ 4. And now the dandelion is a pest—the same yellow dandelion
+ with its long, bitter, milky stem that we children sought for
+ in the shady fence corners to make into spiral curls.
+
+ 5. Buffers had a small moustache, which he fostered much, and a
+ cane with which he was not yet very familiar.
+
+ 6. She bade me good-by as if I were a friend of her family whom
+ she would gladly meet again.
+
+ 7. There is only one bird that terrifies the crow, and that is
+ the owl.
+
+ 8. Solomon John proposed that they should open the window, a
+ thing which Agamemnon could easily do with his long arms.
+
+ 9. There was one lady whose conversation at the best of times
+ made my mother sleepy.
+
+ 10. The two men shared those mysterious rites of smoking and
+ shaving and discussing stocks which occupy men when they are
+ left to themselves.
+
+ 11. The turkey cock, who had been born into the world with
+ spurs, and thought he was a king, puffed himself out like a
+ ship with full sails, and flew at the duckling.
+
+ 12. In a few moments Ned arrived at a small open glade in the
+ middle of the forest, in which, to his horror, he saw a lion
+ upon the body of a man, whom he seized by the throat, while
+ Nero stood within a few yards, baying him furiously.
+
+ 13. He lives longest who does most.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Analyze the following sentences:—
+
+ 1.
+
+ No time is like the old time when you and I were young,
+ When the buds of April blossomed, and the birds of spring-time sung.
+
+ 2.
+
+ No place is like the old place, where you and I were born,
+ Where we lifted first our eyelids on the splendor of the morn.
+
+ 3. No friend is like the old friend, who has shared our morning
+ days.
+
+ 4. At the teachers’ meeting, which she regularly attended with
+ her mother, Gertrude saw the pale-faced little lady whom the
+ children called a “Grahamite.”
+
+ 5. The old broken gate which a gentleman would not tolerate an
+ hour upon his grounds is a great beauty in the picture which
+ hangs in his parlor.
+
+ 6. Often the road passes between lofty walls of solid rock,
+ from the crevices of which all lovely growths are springing.
+
+ 7.
+
+ Read from some humbler poet,
+ Whose songs gushed from his heart,
+ As rain from the clouds in summer,
+ Or tears from the eyelids start.
+
+ 8. Michel was a vivacious, lean little Frenchman, who fulfilled
+ the duties of a chambermaid very adroitly.
+
+ 9. The first thing that my pet starling imitated was the
+ rumbling of carts and carriages on the street.
+
+ 10. In one corner of the fireplace sat a superannuated crony,
+ whom the sexton called John Ange, and who had been his
+ companion from childhood.
+
+ 11. The good ship _Humber_ is taking home a regiment whose term
+ of service has expired.
+
+ 12. Madame took for breakfast two fresh eggs, which her two
+ hens laid for her every morning with the perfect regularity
+ that is the politeness of all well-bred poultry.
+
+ 13.
+
+ The boy stood on the burning deck,
+ Whence all but him had fled.
+
+ 14. Lay up for yourselves treasures in heaven, where neither
+ moth nor rust doth corrupt, and where thieves do not break
+ through and steal.
+
+ 15. Sycamore Ridge might have been one of the dreary villages
+ that dot the wind-swept plain to-day, instead of the bright,
+ prosperous elm-shaded town that it is.
+
+
+
+
+LXXVII. NOUN CLAUSES
+
+
+=307.= We have seen that a dependent clause may have the use of an
+adverb or of an adjective. It may also have another use, as may be seen
+in the sentence, “Whatever Midas touched with his finger immediately
+glistened and grew yellow.” If we ask the question, _What glistened
+and grew yellow?_ we get the answer, _Whatever Midas touched with his
+finger_; hence this group of words must be the subject. But this group is
+a clause, for it contains the subject _Midas_ and the verb _touched_. A
+clause used as the subject of a predicate is used like a noun, hence we
+call it a =noun clause=.
+
+=308.= The noun clause has several other uses of a noun besides that of
+subject. It may be,—
+
+(1) Object of a verb; as, “I think that life would be very dull without
+meals.”
+
+(2) Subjective complement; as, “The sad part of this tale is that the
+trouble was not with poor little Quackalina’s eyes at all.”
+
+(3) In apposition; as, “He had a theory that the big horned owl might be
+tamed.” Here the clause explains the noun _theory_ telling exactly what
+the theory is. This may seem at first like an adjective clause, but there
+is a clear difference. We can make a sentence by putting the verb _is_
+between the noun _theory_ and the clause. This shows that the two are
+identical, but we cannot do this with the noun _theory_ and an adjective
+clause, as in this sentence, “I do not believe in the theory that he sets
+forth in his book.”
+
+(4) Object of a preposition; as, “Aladdin’s mother listened with surprise
+to what her son told her.” If you ask the question, _listened to what?_
+you get the answer, _what her son told her_. Therefore, the group of
+words _what her son told her_, which is a dependent proposition, must be
+the object of the preposition _to_.
+
+(5) Some adjectives, like _anxious_, _aware_, _careful_, _certain_,
+_glad_, _hopeful_, _sorry_, and _sure_, especially when used as
+subjective complements, are modified by noun clauses that take the place
+of adverbial prepositional phrases. We may say,—
+
+ I am sure _of his election_.
+
+ I am sure _that he will be elected_.
+
+In the first sentence the adjective _sure_ is modified by the phrase _of
+his election_. In the second sentence the adjective _sure_ is modified
+by the noun clause _that he will be elected_, which answers the question
+_sure of what?_ This may be called the adverbial use of the noun clause.
+
+=309.= Often, when a noun clause is used as subject, it is placed after
+the predicate, and the sentence begins with the word _it_; as, “It is
+curious that almost every nation on earth has some particular traditions
+regarding the dog.” If we ask the question, _what is curious?_ the answer
+is not _it_, for that tells nothing, but the clause. The word _it_ is
+called an =anticipative subject=, because it comes before the real
+subject, and signifies also to the reader that the real subject may be
+expected after the predicate.
+
+=310.= The tense of the verb in a noun clause is determined partly by
+the meaning of the sentence and partly by the tense of the verb in
+the independent clause. What is the meaning of each of the following
+sentences, and what is the tense of each verb?
+
+ I understand that he builds bridges.
+
+ I understand that he will build the bridge.
+
+ I understand that he has built the bridge.
+
+ I understood that he builds bridges.
+
+ I understood that he would build the bridge.
+
+ I understood that he had built the bridge.
+
+=Summary.=—A noun clause is a dependent clause having the use of a noun.
+
+The noun clause may be used adverbially to modify certain adjectives.
+
+The word _it_ may be used as an anticipative subject to throw the real
+subject, a noun clause, after the verb.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Select all the noun clauses, and explain the use of each.
+
+ 1. Just then a shout from the boys’ tent proclaimed that the
+ twins were awake.
+
+ 2. There were two summer houses at one end of what we called a
+ park.
+
+ 3. The probability is very great that the Vikings did land on
+ our coast.
+
+ 4. What made the little silver teapot so alluring was that it
+ held just enough for two.
+
+ 5. Be careful how you handle my razor.
+
+ 6. It so happened that one of his neighbors had two very
+ beautiful daughters.
+
+ 7. I discovered that the world was not created exclusively on
+ my account.
+
+ 8. Mr. Cobb had a feeling that he was being hurried from peak
+ to peak of a mountain range without time to take a good breath
+ in between.
+
+ 9. That supply follows demand is a sure rule of political
+ economy.
+
+ 10. The truth is that my dancing days are over.
+
+ 11. In choosing words it is to be remembered that there is not
+ a really poor one in any language.
+
+ 12. Are you aware that Phio has gone to the hospital?
+
+ 13. On the very day of his inauguration Jefferson took a step
+ toward what he called simplicity, and what his opponents
+ thought vulgarity.
+
+ 14. I knew that I was born at the North, but I hoped that
+ nobody in New Orleans would find it out.
+
+ 15. The Austrian commander noticed this peculiarity about the
+ firing,—that every shot seemed to come from the same place.
+
+ 16. That the monkeys had stolen the snuffbox was obvious, for
+ both of them were seized with convulsions of sneezing.
+
+ 17. I am glad that you are going to talk on the peace movement.
+
+ 18. The disadvantage of being a boy is that it does not last
+ long enough.
+
+ 19. We are all sorry that some days never come but once.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Justify the tense of the verb in the noun clause in each of
+these sentences—
+
+ I know that fever produces thirst.
+
+ I knew that tennis is a healthful sport.
+
+ I know that the lake will freeze to-night.
+
+ I knew that the lake would freeze last night.
+
+ I know that my turn comes next.
+
+ I knew that my turn came next.
+
+ I know that she has heard the news.
+
+ I knew that she had heard the news.
+
+
+
+
+LXXVIII. INTRODUCTORY WORDS OF NOUN CLAUSES
+
+
+=311.= We have learned that adjective clauses and adverbial clauses are
+joined to what they modify by some connective. This word also serves to
+show that the clause it introduces is not independent but dependent.
+
+The noun clause also is introduced by some connecting word. In the
+sentence, “That you have wronged me doth appear in this,” the first word
+_that_ could be placed nowhere in the clause except at the beginning, and
+it reveals at once that the clause it introduces is dependent.
+
+=312.= The introductory word of a noun clause may be several parts of
+speech:
+
+(1) The subordinating conjunctions _if_, _that_, and _whether_.
+
+ Go and see _if_ your father is coming home.
+
+ I believe _that_ all men are created free and equal.
+
+ I do not know _whether_ Mary is a suffragist or a suffragette.
+
+Often the connective _that_ is omitted; as, “You said you were coming
+home early,” “David thought Dora was an angel.”
+
+(2) The interrogative pronouns _who_, _whose_, _whom_, _which_, _what_.
+
+ Nobody knows _who_ first wrote the story of little Red Riding
+ Hood.
+
+ Can you tell _whose_ picture this is?
+
+ We cannot tell _whom_ the baby looks like.
+
+ Have you heard _which_ came out ahead?
+
+ Tell me _what_ you like, and I will tell you _what_ you are.
+
+In sentences of this sort the interrogative pronoun is not used in a
+direct question, but always when a noun clause is introduced by an
+interrogative pronoun there is an indirect, or implied question. Make a
+direct question out of each of the noun clauses above.
+
+The interrogative pronoun always has a use in the noun clause that it
+introduces, just as the relative pronoun has a use in the adjective
+clause. What is the use of each interrogative pronoun in the preceding
+sentences?
+
+(3) The relative pronoun _what_. This pronoun is always equivalent to the
+two words _that which_, and there is no question implied in a noun clause
+introduced by this pronoun.
+
+ _What_ Martha told me about the will did not surprise me.
+
+ Getting dinner is _what_ takes most of my time.
+
+(4) The indefinite pronouns _whoever_, _whichever_, _whatever_, etc.
+
+ _Whoever_ came was made welcome.
+
+ Take _whichever_ you like.
+
+ _Whatever_ is, is right.
+
+What is the use of each noun clause in these sentences? What is the use
+in the clause of each indefinite pronoun?
+
+(5) The conjunctive adverbs _when_, _where_, _why_, _how_, _whither_, etc.
+
+ Do you know _when_ the steamer sails?
+
+ I cannot remember _where_ I put my spectacles.
+
+ Can you tell _why_ he never wears a muffler?
+
+ I never understood _how_ the purse was returned.
+
+ It is strange _how_ the memory clings to some things.
+
+ Who knows _whither_ the clouds have fled?
+
+The adverb introducing a noun clause modifies some word within the
+clause, usually the verb.
+
+=Summary.=—The noun clause may be introduced by (1) a subordinate
+conjunction, (2) an interrogative pronoun, (3) the relative pronoun
+_what_, (4) an indefinite pronoun, (5) a conjunctive adverb.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the noun clauses, and tell the use of each in the
+sentence. Tell the introductory word of each clause, and its use in the
+clause.
+
+ 1. What disgusted them still more was that Bluebeard had
+ already been married several times, and no one knew what had
+ become of his wives.
+
+ 2. Ernest was always ready to believe in whatever seemed
+ beautiful and good.
+
+ 3. We asked the boatman why he did not speak Gaelic to his dog
+ as well as to his family.
+
+ 4. Whoever has been hypnotized by a book agent will understand
+ how mother felt about the spectacles that she bought and could
+ not wear.
+
+ 5. I wonder if Burbank ever really produced a deodorized onion.
+
+ 6. Shakespeare’s chair stands in the chimney nook of a small
+ gloomy chamber, just behind what was his father’s shop.
+
+ 7. Whatever was iron or brass in other houses was silver or
+ gold in this.
+
+ 8. The apothecary listened as calmly as he could to the story
+ of how Mrs. Peterkin had put salt in her coffee.
+
+ 9. The lady from Philadelphia asked where the milk was kept.
+
+ 10. Fortunately, what God expects of us is not _the_ best, but
+ _our_ best.
+
+ 11. Why this spot was selected for a mansion was always a
+ mystery, unless it was that the newcomer desired to isolate
+ himself completely.
+
+ 12. Whether the Indians were not early risers, or whether they
+ were away just then on a warpath I couldn’t determine.
+
+ 13. What passes for laziness in a boy is very often an
+ unwillingness to farm in a particular way.
+
+ 14. The direction of a man’s life follows the unseen influence
+ of what he admires and loves and believes in.
+
+ 15. Her only noteworthy achievement was that she had named her
+ twin sons Marquis de Lafayette Randall and Lorenzo de Medici
+ Randall.
+
+ 16. I wonder who could describe those wonderful coral gardens
+ on which we gazed through twenty fathoms of crystal water.
+
+
+
+
+LXXIX. REVIEW OF CLAUSES
+
+
+=313.= We have learned that clauses may be independent or dependent; that
+dependent clauses may be used like nouns, adjectives, or adverbs; that
+adjective clauses may be restrictive or unrestrictive; that adverbial
+clauses may denote various circumstances, such as time, place, manner,
+etc.; that dependent clauses are introduced by some word that indicates
+their dependence.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Study again Lessons XVIII, XX, LXVI-LXXVIII, and then make
+an outline of the subject, Clauses, having for your main topics,—
+
+(1) Classification.
+
+(2) Introductory word.
+
+(3) Use.
+
+Make a good original sentence to illustrate each point.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Analyze the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. Though Diana looked very old, she looked exactly the same
+ during all the years in which I knew her; and Aunt Maria, who
+ had known her all her life, said that she had never looked any
+ younger.
+
+ 2. The only difference between the sisters was that while
+ Miranda only wondered how they could endure Rebecca, Jane had
+ flashes of inspiration in which she wondered how Rebecca would
+ endure them.
+
+ 3. Whether the pigeons dropped exhausted on some ship and were
+ helped across the ocean, or whether some storm at sea swept
+ them away forever, no one ever knew.
+
+ 4. Did mother know who brought the scarlet-runner seeds from
+ Whittier’s birthplace?
+
+ 5. I never quite understood why a girl who climbed trees, clung
+ to the tail end of carts, and otherwise deported herself as a
+ well-conditioned girl should not, was called a tomboy.
+
+ 6. The boy remembers how his mother’s anxiety was divided
+ between the set of his turn-over collar, the parting of his
+ hair, and his memory of the Sunday-school verses.
+
+ 7. Most people think that the best thing they can give to a
+ caged bird is his liberty.
+
+ 8. The horrible thought came coldly over me that the tiger was
+ keeping me company until a good chance offered for a spring.
+
+ 9. Possibly the reason why monkeys have been so little on
+ the stage is that their appearance there would emphasize too
+ strongly the striking similarity between man and monkey.
+
+ 10. An elephant who will not work and is not tied up is about
+ as manageable as an eighty-one ton gun in a heavy seaway.
+
+ 11. Nothing cleverer than was Moufflou had ever walked upon
+ four legs.
+
+ 12. The truth is that boys have always been so plenty that they
+ are not half appreciated.
+
+ 13. The professor was so pleased with his witticism that I was
+ let off without even a scolding.
+
+ 14. Those Indian nations who still preserve their ancient mode
+ of life, have dogs which bear a strong resemblance to wolves.
+
+ 15. The partridge remembered the time when the chickadees had
+ seemed such big, important creatures.
+
+Criticize the use of _between_ in sentence 6.
+
+
+
+
+LXXX. REVIEW OF PRONOUNS
+
+
+=314.= We have learned that pronouns may be classified as follows:—
+
+(1) Personal pronouns.
+
+(2) Compound personal pronouns.
+
+(3) Interrogative pronouns.
+
+(4) Adjective pronouns.
+
+(5) Relative pronouns.
+
+(6) Indefinite pronouns.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Study again Lessons V, XXXIX-XLIII, XLVIII, LXXVI, LXXVIII,
+and then be prepared to explain each class of pronoun, and to tell the
+various uses of each class. Illustrate each point with an original
+sentence or with one that you yourself have found in some book.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Parse all the pronouns in the following sentences. If there
+is anything peculiar in the use of any pronoun, comment upon it. (See pp.
+100, 106, 108, 122, 197.)
+
+ 1. What was the Great Stone Face?
+
+ 2. To make a quarrel needs, indeed, two; but to make peace
+ needs only one.
+
+ 3. When the swarm comes out, it consists of both old and young
+ bees, and, indeed, some say that the old queen leads them, and
+ the young one takes her vacant throne.
+
+ 4. We could easily surmise who the Halloween rascals were, but
+ what was the terrifying apparatus they applied to our window
+ panes we could not imagine.
+
+ 5. All of this is mine and thine.
+
+ 6. Attracted by the smell either of the newly killed waterbuck
+ or of ourselves, the hungry lions were storming our position.
+
+ 7. Oh, give me my lowly thatched cottage again.
+
+ 8. The interior of St. Paul’s is just what one would expect
+ after viewing the outside. A maze of grand arches on every side
+ encompasses the dome, which you gaze up at as at the sky; and
+ from every pillar and wall look down the marble forms of the
+ dead.
+
+ 9. By the wholesome law of the prairie, he who falls asleep on
+ guard is condemned to walk all day.
+
+ 10.
+
+ Who has sight so keen and strong
+ That it can follow the flight of song?
+
+ 11. The schoolhouse was a high brick building, and the yard
+ itself was made of brick.
+
+ 12. The Eskimo dogs are of great use to their masters in
+ discovering by the scent the winter retreats which the bears
+ make under the snow.
+
+ 13. The Taj Mahal is a Mohammedan tomb, the tomb of the
+ favorite wife of an Indian Mogul. It is her tomb, and also his
+ own, for he lies beside her, and it was built in compliance
+ with a request of hers before she died.
+
+ 14. I procured a bowl of soup from the steward, but as I was
+ not able to eat it, I gave it to an old man whose hungry look
+ and wistful eyes convinced me it would not be lost on him.
+
+ 15.
+
+ What’s a fair or noble face
+ If the mind ignoble be?
+
+ 16.
+
+ Keep fresh the grass on Wordsworth’s grave,
+ O Rotha, with thy living wave!
+ Sing him thy best! for few or none
+ Hears thy voice right, now he is gone.
+
+
+
+
+LXXXI. INFINITIVES
+
+
+=315.= Look at the following sentences:—
+
+ Dare _to be_ true.
+
+ It is high time _to go_.
+
+ The bishop seemed _to have talked_ with angels.
+
+ You ought _to have been paying_ attention.
+
+We have here certain verb forms,—_to be_, _to go_, _to have talked_, _to
+have been paying_,—which are very familiar to all of us, but which we
+have not yet studied. They are not forms of the indicative, subjunctive,
+or imperative mode, nor are they like any of the verb phrases that we
+have examined. They all begin with the word _to_, and they contain two,
+three, or four words, the last of which is the important one. We call
+these groups of words =infinitives=.
+
+=316.= An intransitive verb has four infinitives, two of them denoting
+a present action, hence called =present infinitives=; and the other two
+denoting an action already completed, hence called =perfect infinitives=.
+
+The four infinitives of the intransitive verb _laugh_ are these:—
+
+ PRESENT PERFECT
+
+ to laugh to have laughed
+ to be laughing to have been laughing
+
+Which two of these infinitives belong to the progressive conjugation?
+
+=317.= Transitive verbs have six infinitives. The infinitives of the
+transitive verb _eat_ are these:—
+
+ PRESENT PERFECT
+
+ _Active_ to eat to have eaten
+ _Active Progressive_ to be eating to have been eating
+ _Passive_ to be eaten to have eaten
+
+=318.= The infinitives above are called =infinitives with _to_=, because
+they begin with the word _to_. This word is not used as a preposition,
+but merely as a sort of handle, or introduction, to the infinitive.
+
+=319.= Besides the infinitive with _to_ there is another form called the
+=infinitive in _-ing_=. The infinitives in _-ing_ of the verb _eat_ are
+these:—
+
+ PRESENT PERFECT
+
+ _Active_ eating having eaten
+ _Active Progressive_ having been eating
+ _Passive_ being eaten having been eaten
+
+What are the infinitives in _-ing_ of the verb _laugh_? Which two forms
+does it lack?
+
+Find the infinitives in _-ing_ in these sentences:—
+
+ He was fined for losing his temper.
+
+ “Being a Boy” is the title of a book.
+
+ He was vexed at having misspelled so many words.
+
+=320.= All infinitives are forms of verbs, but they cannot be predicate
+verbs because they do not assert. They are spoken of as =verbals=.
+
+=321.= A verbal is used in a sentence like some part of speech,—a noun,
+an adjective, or an adverb. The infinitive is most frequently used like
+a noun. The infinitive in _-ing_ is very much like a noun in another
+respect too,—it _names_ the action or state that the predicate verb
+_asserts_. If we should ask for the name of any action that we saw a
+person performing, the answer would be an infinitive in _-ing_; as,
+_reaping_, _mowing_, _plowing_, _driving_.
+
+=322.= The infinitive in _-ing_ is so much like a noun that it can be
+modified by a possessive noun or pronoun. We say, “_Your_ winning the
+victory depends on your keeping cool.” “The farmer’s chagrin was due to
+his _hay’s_ having spoiled.” Explain the use of all the possessives in
+these sentences.
+
+ NOTE.—The infinitive in _-ing_ is often called a =gerund=.
+
+=323.= The infinitive may take the same complements and modifiers that
+any other form of the same verb might take. The infinitive, together
+with all the words associated with it, makes an =infinitive phrase=. The
+base word of an infinitive phrase is always an infinitive. What are the
+infinitive phrases in all the illustrative sentences in this lesson?
+
+=Summary.=—A =verbal= is a verb form that denotes action or being without
+asserting it.
+
+A verbal is used in a sentence as a noun, an adjective, or an adverb.
+
+An =infinitive= is a verbal that is generally used as a noun.
+
+There are two classes of infinitives,—the infinitive with _to_, and the
+infinitive in _-ing_.
+
+The infinitive has two tenses,—present and perfect.
+
+The infinitive may be active or passive or progressive.
+
+An =infinitive phrase= is a group of words consisting of an infinitive
+together with its complement and modifiers.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Write all the infinitives of the verbs _be_, _bring_,
+_come_, _find_, _freeze_, _go_, _leave_, _seem_, _taste_, _turn_.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Select all the infinitive phrases in the following
+sentences. Tell the voice and tense of each infinitive.
+
+MODEL—_It is hard to teach an old dog new tricks._ _To teach an old dog
+new tricks_ is an infinitive phrase. _To teach_ is the present active
+infinitive of the transitive verb _teach_.
+
+ 1. Am I to give a reason for all I choose to do?
+
+ 2. The cherry pie seemed to have been left in the refrigerator
+ for that hungry young pair.
+
+ 3. Driving between these long lines of dainty-flowering and
+ sweet-smelling rows of hedges is very delightful.
+
+ 4. All the lines of pain smoothed out of her brow, and she
+ seemed to be peacefully sleeping.
+
+ 5. The lights had been extinguished, the buoys removed, and the
+ whole coast seemed to have gone back hundreds of years.
+
+ 6. Your having given me the opera glasses is no reason that you
+ have a right to borrow them continually.
+
+ 7. Any child should know that a hot stove is a thing to be
+ avoided, but I did not seem to realize the fact.
+
+ 8. The boy would like to have thrown a stone at the wagon.
+
+ 9. Did you mind being reproved by your mother for sitting up so
+ late?
+
+ 10. It was already past the appointed hour for Mr. Cobb and his
+ coach to be lumbering down the street.
+
+ 11. From her having been staying at the Antlers the entire
+ season, I should judge her to be wealthy.
+
+ 12. Scrooge was not a man to be frightened by echoes.
+
+ 13. There’s no use in making two bites of a cherry.
+
+ 14. The fact of the letter’s having been opened was evident,
+ but it could not be proved against the mail carrier.
+
+Tell the part of speech and use of _your_, sentence 6, _her_ 11,
+_letter’s_ 14.
+
+
+
+
+LXXXII. INFINITIVES AS SUBJECTS OR COMPLEMENTS
+
+
+=324.= If we wish to make an assertion about a person, a place, or an
+object, we use a noun for the base word of our subject; but if we wish to
+make an assertion about an action, we use an infinitive or an infinitive
+phrase for subject; as, “Just to breathe the air and feel one’s self
+alive was enough,” “Going after the cows was a serious thing in my day.”
+
+=325.= We have seen that a noun clause used as subject may be thrown to
+the end of the sentence by means of the anticipative subject _it_; as,
+“It is a good thing _that somebody likes to cook_.” In the same way an
+infinitive phrase used as subject may come after the predicate; as, “It
+pleased the jackal to see Mother and Father Wolf look uncomfortable.”
+Recast this sentence, omitting _it_.
+
+=326.= The infinitive phrase is often used as the object of a verb. Not
+all transitive verbs, however, can be completed by infinitives—only those
+which can take for an object the name of an action or a condition; as,
+“The cloud began to sink softly down to the earth,” “After a struggle
+Bess gave up using two lumps of sugar in her coffee.”
+
+Why cannot the verbs _break_, _bring_, _buy_, _cut_, _eat_, and _plow_
+take infinitives for objects?
+
+=327.= The infinitive is used as a subjective complement of an
+intransitive verb in two ways that differ slightly; as, “The hunter’s
+first impulse was to laugh at his own folly,” “No trees of any magnitude
+were to be seen.”
+
+In the first sentence the infinitive phrase, _to laugh at his own folly_,
+completes the verb _was_ and explains just what the impulse was, hence it
+denotes identity with the subject. Its use is precisely like that of the
+word _dime_ in the sentence, “My ‘lucky penny’ is a silver _dime_,” hence
+we say that it is used like a noun.
+
+In the second sentence it is clear that the infinitive _to be seen_
+completes the verb _were_ and tells something about the subject, hence it
+must be a subjective complement. But instead of being used like a noun
+to denote identity with the subject, it is equivalent to the adjective
+_visible_, hence may be said to be used like an adjective.
+
+=Summary.=—The infinitive phrase may be the subject of a verb, the object
+of a verb, or a subjective complement.
+
+By means of the anticipative subject _it_, the real subject, an
+infinitive phrase, may be placed at the end of the sentence.
+
+As subjective complement the infinitive phrase may have the use of a noun
+or of an adjective.
+
+=Exercise.=—Tell the grammatical use of all infinitive phrases in these
+sentences, and classify all infinitives:—
+
+ 1. Mowgli said that he never wished to see, or hear, or smell
+ man again.
+
+ 2. That which most resembles living one’s life over again is
+ recalling all the circumstances of it and recording them in
+ writing.
+
+ 3. To fit out a fleet, and to levy and equip an army, and to
+ continue the forces thus raised in action during a long and
+ uncertain campaign would cost a large sum of money.
+
+ 4.
+
+ When the days begin to lengthen,
+ Then the cold begins to strengthen.
+
+ 5. It is delightful to look upon the charming country which
+ springs up under a watering-pot sky.
+
+ 6. One of the best things in farm life is gathering the
+ chestnuts, hickory nuts, butternuts, and beechnuts.
+
+ 7. Speaking of Latin reminds me that I once taught my cows
+ Latin.
+
+ 8. The quaint, picturesque old town seems to bristle with forts.
+
+ 9. When I wanted to hit a mark, my usual way was to aim at
+ something else.
+
+ 10. The one idea in Mowgli’s head was to get Messua and her
+ husband out of the trap.
+
+ 11. This boy was so forward in domestic arts that he undertook
+ sewing on the machine when he was only five years old.
+
+ 12. It is bad manners to find fault with your food at the table.
+
+ 13. To climb a tree and shake it, to club it, to strip it of
+ its fruit, and pass to the next, is the sport of a brief time.
+
+ 14. One of Jakie’s amusements was dancing across the back of
+ a tall chair, taking funny little steps, coming down hard,
+ jouncing his body, and whistling as loud as he could.
+
+ 15. The Englishman learned to fight from behind a tree, to
+ follow a trail, and to cover his body with hemlock boughs for
+ disguise.
+
+ 16. It exactly suits the temperament of a real boy to be very
+ busy about nothing.
+
+ 17. Trotting on city pavements is very hard on the dray horses.
+
+ 18. The reward of a good sentence is to have written it.
+
+Tell the part of speech and use of _that_ and _which_ in sentence 2,
+_sum_ 3, _then_ 4, _years_ 11. What is the object of _from_ in sentence
+15? Think of similar expressions.
+
+
+
+
+LXXXIII. INFINITIVES AS MODIFIERS OF NOUNS
+
+
+=328.= The infinitive phrase is often a modifier of a noun, and may be
+used either like an adjective or like an appositive.
+
+In the sentence, “Ulf still had a name to win,” what noun does the
+infinitive modify? How do you know?
+
+In the sentence, “The mayor gave the order to close the skating rink,”
+the infinitive phrase _to close the skating rink_ modifies the noun
+_order_ by telling exactly what the order was; hence we must say that it
+is in apposition with _order_.
+
+=329.= The infinitive in _-ing_ is not used as an adjective modifier
+of a noun except in some compound words like these: _rolling-pin_,
+_laughingstock_, _meetinghouse_, _drawing-room_.
+
+=330.= Often the infinitive in _-ing_ is used in apposition, as in the
+sentence, “Her household tasks, keeping the bedrooms tidy and caring for
+the canary birds, left her little time for music practice.”
+
+=Summary.=—The infinitive phrase may modify a noun either as an adjective
+or as an appositive.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the infinitive phrases, and explain the use of
+each. Classify also each infinitive, as in the preceding exercise.
+
+ 1.
+
+ Is this a time to be cloudy and sad
+ When our Mother Nature laughs around?
+
+ 2. As the Cloud became larger, this wish to do something for
+ the people of earth was ever greater in her heart.
+
+ 3. This is your last chance to see Chicago, Tom.
+
+ 4. Day after day mother sat at the east window engaged in her
+ favorite pastime—making something dainty and beautiful with her
+ needle.
+
+ 5. Almost all persons who travel in Switzerland have a great
+ desire to go to the top of at least one of the towering peaks
+ they see about them.
+
+ 6. Now bring us something to eat. I have not patience to wait,
+ for I am ravenously hungry.
+
+ 7. The first tracks to meet our eyes were the delicate
+ footprints of the red squirrel.
+
+ 8. The Colonel’s only form of exercise, riding horseback every
+ evening, made him a familiar figure throughout the city.
+
+ 9. Nothing pleased the dog more than an order to go and fetch
+ the cow.
+
+ 10. To the deer a mystery means something to be solved.
+
+ 11. A strange longing to follow the swan took possession of
+ each of the young birds.
+
+ 12. A queer freak of my chewink was her determination to get
+ her feet into her food.
+
+ 13. Never lose an opportunity to see anything beautiful.
+
+ 14. This father was the comrade of his son, made so by the
+ memory of his own boyhood sports,—playing baseball on the
+ common, swimming in the lake off Miller’s Point, skating out to
+ Garlic Island, and gathering hickory nuts and hazelnuts in the
+ autumn woods.
+
+Classify the dependent clauses in sentences, 1, 2, 5, 9. Tell the part of
+speech and use of _figure_, sentence 8.
+
+
+
+
+LXXXIV. INFINITIVES AS PARTS OF “DOUBLE OBJECTS.” AS MODIFIERS OF VERBS
+
+
+=331.= In the sentence, “I want my friends to believe in me,” we find the
+verb to be _want_. If we ask the question _want what_? the answer is the
+group of words _my friends to believe in me_; hence we are sure that this
+group of words is the object.
+
+But this object is different from any group of words that we have studied
+hitherto. It does not consist of a base word and modifiers, but instead
+it consists of two parts that are equally important. These are _my
+friends_ and the infinitive phrase _to believe in me_. The phrase is not
+a modifier of _friends_, but has the logical relation of predicate to
+_friends_, as may be proved by changing the whole group of words to a
+noun clause, _that my friends should believe in me_.
+
+When the object of a verb consists of two parts, a noun element and an
+infinitive, having to each other the logical relation of subject and
+predicate, we call the whole group a =double object=.
+
+=332.= Although the relation between the two parts of a double object
+is logically that of subject and predicate, still this relation is not
+grammatically expressed. A double object does not make sense standing
+alone, and we cannot speak of the infinitive in a double object as a
+predicate, for an infinitive cannot assert. It is customary, however,
+to speak of the noun element in a double object as the subject of the
+infinitive. The subject of an infinitive is always in the objective case,
+as may be plainly seen by substituting a pronoun for the noun used as
+subject. In the sentence quoted, the pronoun that might take the place of
+_my friends_ is the objective pronoun _them_.
+
+=333.= An infinitive in _-ing_ is often used as part of a double object;
+as, “I hear their voices _ringing_ in merry childish glee,” “I can see
+his gallant figure _coming_ down the road.”
+
+=334.= Notice that a double object is not two objects of equal rank, as
+in the sentence, “I want _peace and quiet_;” but is one object consisting
+of two equal parts so closely related, that neither of these parts could
+be the object if used without the other.
+
+=335.= When the infinitive with _to_ is used after the verbs _hear_ and
+_see_, as well as after _feel_, _let_, _make_, the _to_ of the infinitive
+is omitted; as, “Did you hear me (_to_) _rap_ at your door?” “Let us
+(_to_) _be_ true to one another,” “The mosquitoes made us (_to_) _go_
+indoors.”
+
+Find and explain the double objects in each of these three sentences.
+
+=336.= When a sentence containing a double object is changed to the
+passive voice, the noun element of the double object becomes the subject
+of the passive verb, and the infinitive phrase becomes the subjective
+complement of the verb. Change this sentence to the passive voice and
+explain the change, “We expected John to decorate the banquet room.”
+
+=337.= We have seen that the infinitive may be used as the complement of
+a verb in several ways: it may be the direct object of a verb, or the
+subjective complement, or part of a double object. There is another very
+common relation of the infinitive to a verb, as shown in the sentence,
+“Some persons live to eat.” The infinitive _to eat_ is in the predicate,
+but it is not an object of the verb _live_, neither is it a subjective
+complement. How do we know this? As the infinitive answers the question
+_for what purpose_? we conclude that it is a modifier of the verb _live_.
+Furthermore, it could be expanded into the adverbial clause of purpose,
+_that they may eat_.
+
+The infinitive denoting purpose is very common, as seen in the familiar
+sentences: “We go to school to learn,” “We stood up to see,” “I sat down
+to rest.”
+
+=Summary.=—An infinitive phrase and a noun, having the logical relation
+of subject and predicate, may form the =double object= of some transitive
+verbs.
+
+An infinitive phrase denoting the purpose of an action may be used to
+modify a verb.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Write sentences containing double objects of the verbs
+_cause_, _desire_, _expect_, _feel_, _hear_, _let_, _make_, _order_,
+_see_, _wish_.
+
+Explain why there are no double objects in these sentences:—
+
+ 1. They could get no water to drink.
+
+ 2. He has an ax to grind.
+
+ 3. We found plenty to eat.
+
+ 4. She bought a rose to wear.
+
+ 5. I made a cake to sell.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Explain the use of all infinitive phrases in these
+sentences. Classify the infinitives.
+
+ 1. The boy made up his mind that he would take two of
+ the whelps home with him to be brought up in the ways of
+ civilization.
+
+ 2.
+
+ In happy homes he saw the light
+ Of household fires gleam warm and bright.
+
+ 3. More rarely a fox or a hyena quickened his gallop to study
+ the intruder at a safe distance.
+
+ 4. When the car stopped and I looked up at the window with the
+ pink geranium, I saw mother waiting to welcome me.
+
+ 5. The whole family went to the station to see us off.
+
+ 6. I do not quite know what caused me to lift my head from the
+ friendly shelter of the blanket.
+
+ 7. He felt his swift craft quiver with life beneath him in
+ response to the rhythmic stroke of the oarsmen.
+
+ 8. Jupiter bustled about to prepare some marsh hens for supper.
+
+ 9. To keep the artillery dry, we stuffed wads of loose hemp
+ into the muzzles, and fitted wooden pegs to the touch holes.
+
+ 10. Down the elm-bordered road we two walked toward the sunset,
+ and watched the mists rising ghostlike from the fields.
+
+ 11. Mowgli heard the sound rumble, and rise, and fall, and die
+ off in a creepy sort of whine behind him.
+
+ 12. At recess the next noon the Centipedes met in a corner of
+ the schoolyard to talk over the proposed lark.
+
+ 13. Our Heavenly Father himself has planted that pea, and made
+ it grow and blossom to bring joy to you and hope to me, my
+ blessed child.
+
+ 14. Nearly all the finest diamonds in the world are brought to
+ Amsterdam to be cut into shape.
+
+ 15. It was Long Tom who taught Harvey to shoot at a mark with a
+ revolver.
+
+ 16. He’s gone to fight the French for King George upon his
+ throne.
+
+ 17. We heard the meadow larks singing their wistful songs, but
+ always instead of the black hearts upon their yellow breasts
+ they showed us just the two white feathers in their tails.
+
+Change sentences 2, 4, 10, 11, 13, 17 to the passive voice, and explain
+the change in the use of the infinitive.
+
+
+
+
+LXXXV. OTHER USES OF INFINITIVES
+
+
+=338.= The most frequent use of the infinitive in _-ing_ is as the object
+of a preposition; as, “I am tired of _doing_ nothing,” “He earned a
+living by _sharpening_ scissors.”
+
+=339.= The infinitive in _-ing_, like the noun, may be the object of any
+preposition, but the infinitive with _to_ is used as the object of very
+few prepositions, only _about_, _except_, _but_, and _save_, the last two
+meaning _except_.
+
+In the sentence, “He ate nothing but bananas,” the object of the
+preposition _but_ must be a noun because it must be the name of a food.
+But in the sentence, “He did nothing but play tennis,” the object of
+_but_ must be an infinitive because it must be the name of an action.
+
+ NOTE.—We often hear the expression “I was about to say.” In
+ this familiar idiom the prepositional phrase _about to say_ is
+ used as the subjective complement of the verb _was_. How do we
+ know this? What is the use of the infinitive _to say_?
+
+=340.= In the sentence, “The gentleman drew out the chair for the lady to
+sit down,” if we ask the question _for what?_ we get the answer _the lady
+to sit down_, hence the group of words _the lady to sit down_ must be the
+object of the preposition _for_. But this group of words consists of two
+parts, _the lady_ and the infinitive phrase _to sit down_, which have the
+logical relation of subject and predicate, hence we conclude that the
+preposition _for_ may take a double object.
+
+=341.= The sentences, “Sheep are apt,” “I am sorry,” “The traveler was
+glad,” are all incomplete. We wish to know in what respect sheep are apt,
+what I am sorry about, what the traveler was glad of. In other words,
+the adjectives _apt_, _sorry_, and _glad_ need a modifier to make the
+sentence complete in meaning. This modifier may be an infinitive, “Sheep
+are apt _to get lost_,” “I am sorry _to leave Warwick_,” “The traveler
+was glad _to see his home again_.” We learn from these sentences that an
+infinitive phrase may modify an adjective.
+
+=Exercise.=—Complete the following sentences by infinitive phrases. What
+do your phrases modify? How do you know?
+
+ 1. This child is too young—
+
+ 2. A man of twenty-five is old enough—
+
+ 3. The water was so deep as—
+
+ 4. The general was anxious—
+
+ 5. Some lessons are not easy—
+
+=342.= The infinitive may be used independently; as, “_To be frank_, I do
+not like it.” “_To make a long story short_, we were utterly defeated.”
+
+=343.= A common error is the use of the perfect infinitive for the
+present. It is proper to say, “I ought to have gone,” when we mean that
+the time of the going was in the past; as, “I ought to have gone then,
+or yesterday, or a year ago.” But when we mean that the going is at the
+present time or is to be in the future, then we should use the present
+infinitive, and say, “I ought to go.”
+
+What is the difference in the meaning of the following pairs of sentences?
+
+ 1. I am sorry to offend you.
+ I am sorry to have offended you.
+ 2. I am glad to see you.
+ I am glad to have seen you.
+ 3. The train is reported to be late.
+ The train is reported to have been late.
+ 4. The man is said to be a candidate.
+ The man is said to have been a candidate.
+
+It is evident from the four pairs of sentences above that some verbs
+in the present tense may be followed by either a present or a perfect
+infinitive. This is likewise true of some verbs in the past tense. We
+say, “He seemed to be sleeping,” meaning that he was sleeping at the time
+we noted his appearance. We also say, “He seemed to have been sleeping,”
+meaning that he had slept before we noted his appearance.
+
+What is the difference in the meaning of the following pairs of
+sentences:—
+
+ 1. Washington was never known to fight a duel.
+ Hamilton was known to have fought a duel.
+ 2. The ship was reported to be wrecked.
+ The ship was reported to have been wrecked.
+ 3. The child appeared to lead the old man.
+ The child appeared to have led the old man.
+
+Since the verbs _desire_, _expect_, _hope_, _want_, and _wish_ refer
+to something in the present or the future, but never in the past, they
+cannot be followed by a perfect infinitive. It is absurd to say, “I hoped
+to have seen you,” “I expected to have gone,” “I wished to have stayed.”
+We should say:—
+
+ I desire to go. I desired to go.
+
+ I expect to be there. I expected to be there.
+
+ I hope to pass. I hoped to pass.
+
+ I want to know. I wanted to know.
+
+ I wish to speak. I wished to speak.
+
+=Summary.=—The infinitive phrase may be used as the object of a
+preposition. The preposition _for_ may take a double object.
+
+The infinitive phrase may modify an adjective.
+
+The infinitive phrase may be used independently.
+
+=Exercise.=—Explain the use of each infinitive phrase. Classify each
+infinitive.
+
+ 1. The cat was just about to spring upon the window sill where
+ the bird cage sat, when Paul shouted out a warning.
+
+ 2. I am perfectly willing to dine in the kitchen beside this
+ cool north window.
+
+ 3. The gay youths spent their time in walking, hunting,
+ fishing, feasting, and dancing.
+
+ 4. It was so cold at Petoskey in July that the hotel proprietor
+ furnished a large lamp for us to heat our room by.
+
+ 5. The cherries grew too high to be picked except by the robins.
+
+ 6. My lot was indeed a hard one; I was too old to play out of
+ doors with my brothers, and too young to go to parties with my
+ sisters.
+
+ 7. After supper, the boy who has done nothing all day but
+ turn grindstone, and spread hay, and run his little legs off
+ at everybody’s beck and call, is sent on some errand or some
+ household chore lest time may hang heavy on his hands.
+
+ 8. Bark is only good to sharpen claws.
+
+ 9. John was hungry enough to have eaten the New England Primer.
+
+ 10. Franklin was employed in cutting wicks for the candles,
+ filling the molds for cast candles, attending the shop, going
+ of errands, etc.
+
+ 11. To tell the truth, I prefer to stay at home.
+
+ 12. The only way to make the world better is for each man to do
+ his best.
+
+ 13. A dog is good to bite peddlers and small children, and to
+ run out and yelp at wagons that pass by, and to howl all night
+ when the moon shines.
+
+ 14. To sum up, the infinitive is used chiefly as a noun, but
+ also as an adjective and an adverb.
+
+ 15. The teacher’s eyes glanced half a dozen different ways at
+ once,—a habit probably acquired from watching the boys.
+
+ 16.
+
+ None knew thee but to love thee,
+ Nor named thee but to praise.
+
+ 17. To see the sparks rush like swarms of red bees skyward
+ through the smoke is an experience long to be remembered.
+
+ 18. To make way for hemp the magnificent forests of Kentucky
+ were felled.
+
+ 19. The crow and the blackbird seem to love these plants.
+
+ 20. It takes a hundred days to lift out of the tiny seed these
+ powerful hollow stalks.
+
+ 21. The seeds fall to the ground, there to be folded in against
+ the time when they shall rise again.
+
+Classify the dependent clauses in sentence 1. What is the object of
+_except_ in sentence 5?
+
+
+
+
+LXXXVI. SUMMARY OF INFINITIVES
+
+
+=344.=
+
+ I. DEFINITION.—An infinitive is a verbal noun.
+
+ II. FORMS.
+ 1. The infinitive with _to_.
+ (a) Intransitive verbs.
+ _Present_, to go, to be going.
+ _Perfect_, to have gone, to have been going.
+ (b) Transitive verbs.
+ _Present_, to see, to be seeing, to be seen.
+ _Perfect_, to have seen, to have been seeing, to have been
+ seen.
+ 2. The infinitive in _-ing_.
+ (a) Intransitive verbs.
+ _Present_, going.
+ _Perfect_, having gone, having been going.
+ (b) Transitive verbs.
+ _Present_, seeing, being seen.
+ _Perfect_, having seen, having been seeing, having been
+ seen.
+ III. USES.
+ 1. As a =noun=.
+ (a) _Subject of a verb._
+ To err is human.
+ Hunting is a sport.
+ (b) _Object of a verb._
+ He expects to win.
+ They stopped working.
+ (c) _Subjective complement._
+ My desire is to own a boat.
+ His task is feeding the sheep.
+ (d) _Appositive._
+ His idea, to use coal ashes, was carried out.
+ His work, running a machine, is monotonous.
+ (e) _Object of a preposition._
+ The patient did nothing but eat and sleep.
+ The child was praised for telling the truth.
+ 2. As an =adjective=.
+ (a) _Modifying a noun._
+ I have a garden to make.
+ (b) _Completing a verb._
+ These boats are not to let.
+ 3. As an =adverb=.
+ (a) _Modifying a verb._
+ I went back to get some matches.
+ (b) _Modifying an adjective._
+ We are sure to succeed.
+ 4. As part of a =double object=.
+ (a) _Of a verb._
+ I made her tell me.
+ (b) _Of a preposition._
+ I made room for her to sit with me.
+ 5. =Independent use.=
+ To speak plainly, I don’t believe it.
+
+
+
+
+LXXXVII. ANALYSIS OF SENTENCES CONTAINING INFINITIVE PHRASES
+
+
+=345.= The infinitive phrase is analyzed very much like a predicate.
+First, the infinitive should be given as the base word; then its
+complement and modifiers should be given.
+
+MODEL.—_By the law of the jungle the tiger has no right to change his
+quarters without fair warning._
+
+This is a simple, declarative sentence.
+
+The subject is _the tiger_. The predicate is _has by the law of the
+jungle no right to change his quarters without fair warning_.
+
+The predicate verb is _has_; it is completed by the direct object _no
+right to change his quarters without fair warning_, and then modified by
+the prepositional phrase _by the law of the jungle_.
+
+The base word of the object is the noun _right_; it is modified by the
+infinitive phrase _to change his quarters without fair warning_, and then
+denied by the adjective _no_.
+
+The base word of the infinitive phrase is the infinitive _to change_;
+it is completed by the direct object _his quarters_ and modified by the
+prepositional phrase _without fair warning_. The base word of the object
+is the noun _quarters_, modified by the possessive pronoun _his_. The
+base word of the object of the preposition _without_ is the infinitive
+_warning_, which is modified by the adjective _fair_.
+
+The base word of the object of the preposition _by_ is the noun _law_,
+which is modified by the prepositional phrase _of the jungle_ and the
+article _the_.
+
+=Exercise.=—Analyze the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. Turning grindstones to grind scythes is one of those heroic
+ but unobtrusive occupations for which one gets no credit.
+
+ 2. Some books are to be tasted, others to be swallowed, and
+ some few to be chewed and digested.
+
+ 3. When Kotick felt his skin tingle all over, his mother told
+ him he was learning the feel of the water.
+
+ 4. Mother made and embroidered a white linen pocket for me to
+ wear at my belt.
+
+ 5. The neighbors and friends did not wait for an invitation to
+ go to the house of the young wife, so impatient were they to
+ see her treasures.
+
+ 6. The Boy had no desire to investigate further, with the risk
+ of finding the lynx at home.
+
+ 7. It seems hard any day to think what to have for dinner.
+
+ 8. The next thing was to cord up the trunk, and Mr. Peterkin
+ tried to move it.
+
+ 9. I have seen wild bees and butterflies feeding at a height of
+ 13,000 feet above the sea.
+
+ 10. If you wear an automobile veil to pick cherries in, I must
+ get an automobile to take you to the cherry trees.
+
+ 11. No person but yourself is permitted to lift this stone or
+ enter the cave.
+
+ 12. Very sweet were the child’s ways of loving her
+ father,—putting flowers on his study table, learning to read
+ so that she could read his books, reaching up to rub her cheek
+ against his, praying for him, and letting him put her to bed.
+
+ 13. The Oldest Inhabitant refused to go to bed on any terms,
+ but persisted in sitting up in a rocking-chair until daybreak.
+
+ 14. The Eskimo never knows when his own time may come to beg.
+
+ 15. Fate tried to conceal him by naming him Smith.
+
+ 16. The only department of life in which Mr. Randall failed to
+ shine was the making of sufficient money to live upon.
+
+ 17. He saw an eagle swoop across the gigantic hollow, but the
+ great bird dwindled to a dot ere it was halfway over.
+
+ 18. After she began wearing the bracelet, she was unwilling to
+ go without it even for a day.
+
+ 19. Hewing wood and sawing plank leave me no time to take part
+ in disputes.
+
+ 20. The one object of Polly’s life was to get out of her cage.
+
+ 21. The skipper had taken his little daughter to bear him
+ company.
+
+ 22. Every boy is anxious to be a man.
+
+ 23. A man has no more right to say a rude thing to another than
+ to knock him down.
+
+ 24. To travel in Switzerland it is generally necessary to cross
+ the mountains, to go around the sides, or to go through them.
+
+ 25. Even the blind men’s dogs appeared to know Scrooge.
+
+ 26. Let dogs delight to bark and bite.
+
+ 27. When a bear kills a sheep, he skins it deftly and has the
+ politeness to leave the pelt in a neat bundle, just to indicate
+ to the farmer that he has been robbed by a gentleman.
+
+ 28. The first tracks to meet their eyes were the delicate
+ footprints of the red squirrel.
+
+ 29. It is not good to make a jest of thy teacher.
+
+ 30. Angels seemed to have sat with Ernest by the fireside.
+
+ 31. My joy was greater than I can express when I saw the tiger
+ rise and slink into the jungle.
+
+
+
+
+LXXXVIII. PARTICIPLES
+
+
+=346.= In Lesson LIV we learned that the perfect tenses of any verb are
+formed by combining certain auxiliaries with the =past participles= of
+the verb; as, “I have _heard_,” “I had _heard_,” “I shall have _heard_.”
+We learned also that the past participle is one of the principal parts of
+a verb.
+
+In Lesson LV we learned that the passive voice of any transitive verb is
+formed by adding its past participle to the conjugation of the verb _be_;
+as, “It is _caught_,” “It was _caught_,” “It will be _caught_.”
+
+In Lesson LVI we learned that the past participle of a verb may be used
+like an adjective as the subjective complement of a verb; as, “The
+potatoes seem _done_,” “The flowers are _withered_ now.”
+
+=347.= In Lesson LVII we learned that the =present participle= of a verb
+always ends in _-ing_, and that this participle is used in forming the
+progressive conjugation, as, “I am _sleeping_,” “I was _sleeping_,” “I
+shall be _sleeping_.”
+
+We are ready now to study participles in all their relations.
+
+=348.= Intransitive verbs have four participles:—
+
+ PRESENT PAST PERFECT
+
+ coming come having come
+ _Progressive_ having been coming
+
+Transitive verbs have six participles:—
+
+ PRESENT PAST PERFECT
+
+ _Active_ writing having written
+ _Active Progressive_ having been writing[1]
+ _Passive_ being written written having been written
+
+[1] This form is rarely used.
+
+The active participles denote action performed; they make us think of the
+doer of the action. On the other hand, the passive participles denote
+action received; they make us think of the receiver of the action.
+
+The present participle expresses action as still in progress; the
+past participle expresses action completed in past time; the perfect
+participle expresses past action completed before some particular past
+time.
+
+=349.= The participle, like the infinitive, is a verbal, because it is a
+verb form without the power to assert. Just as an infinitive is oftenest
+used as a noun, so the participle is oftenest used as an adjective;
+that is, it is usually associated with some noun. Indeed, it is by
+their adjective use that we are able to distinguish participles from
+infinitives in _-ing_, for in form they are almost exactly the same.
+
+What nouns do the participles belong with in the following sentences?
+
+ I hear the sound of trickling water.
+
+ The lost child had wandered far.
+
+ The diamonds sparkling in her dark hair rivaled the stars.
+
+ The chair made two hundred years ago tilted one forward very
+ uncomfortably.
+
+=350.= The participles used oftenest are the simplest of all, the present
+active participle and the past passive participle.
+
+=351.= A participle, like an infinitive, may have all the complements
+and modifiers that a verb may have; as, “The man _turning the switch_ is
+faithful,” “_Feeling sleepy after lunch_, I took a nap.”
+
+The participle and all its accompanying words form together a
+=participial phrase=.
+
+=Summary.=—A =participle= is a verbal that is generally used as an
+adjective.
+
+Participles may be active or passive or progressive in meaning.
+
+Participles have three tenses,—present, past, and perfect. The present
+participle expresses continuing action, the past participle completed
+action, and the perfect participle past action completed before a
+particular time.
+
+Participles have the same complements and modifiers as verbs.
+
+A =participial phrase= is a group of words consisting of a participle and
+its complement and modifiers.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Form all the participles of the verbs _choose_, _draw_,
+_drink_, _go_, _find_, _know_, _tell_, _think_, _turn_, _shine_.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Select all the participial phrases in these sentences. Tell
+what noun or pronoun they belong with. Classify the participles.
+
+ 1. Two children sat on the grass under the lilacs, making
+ dandelion chains and talking happily.
+
+ 2. Those three tall poles now being lifted to position will
+ enable us to have a telephone.
+
+ 3. From a little hill called Hutchinson’s Hill you could look
+ over three and a half miles of ground covered with fighting
+ seals.
+
+ 4. Having given away the old candle mold, she was anxious to
+ get it back again.
+
+ 5. Mrs. Merrithew, knowing well that little folk are generally
+ troubled with a wonderful thirst, had also brought a cup and a
+ bottle of lemonade.
+
+ 6. The floors were bird’s-eye maple, and having been lately
+ waxed, they looked too fine for my desecrating tread.
+
+ 7. The workmen, having been painting for hours on the sunny
+ side of the house, grew faint and dizzy.
+
+ 8. The boy took his seat, frowning and blinking at the candle
+ light, while his mother, placing his coffee before him, let her
+ hand rest on his shoulder.
+
+ 9. Having passed at the turnstile into the campus, David stood
+ before the college.
+
+ 10. In one hand he carried a faded valise made of Brussels
+ carpet sprinkled with pink roses.
+
+ 11. The old peasant woman, having eaten three meals with the
+ servants and three with the mistress, declared at evening that
+ she was satisfied.
+
+ 12. If all the money being spent for ice-cream sodas were put
+ to some useful purpose—cement sidewalks, for instance,—few of
+ us would be stubbing our toes on old board walks.
+
+ 13. A snowball soaked in water and left out to cool was a
+ projectile which had been resorted to with disastrous results.
+
+ 14. No flying or crawling creature escapes the sharp little
+ eyes of the birds.
+
+ 15. Its roots having been cut, the top of the tree suffered.
+
+ 16. The tourists, having watched the bears nose about among the
+ tin cans in the garbage piles, went back to the hotel to avoid
+ being devoured by mosquitoes.
+
+ 17. Very soon their path led them out into a wide glade, fenced
+ all about with the serried and formal ranks of the young firs.
+
+ 18. That log just being sawed will produce eight hundred feet
+ of lumber.
+
+ 19. The whale is the largest animal now living in the world.
+
+ 20. Having been told by his master that he too could go to the
+ village, Shep bounded away down the road like mad.
+
+ 21. Sleep, having descended upon him, spread a quiet mist
+ through his brain.
+
+ 22. Having been tramped down by the cattle, the snow was smooth
+ like a floor.
+
+Tell the use of all the infinitive phrases in sentences 2, 4, 10, 13.
+
+
+
+
+LXXXIX. PARTICIPLES MODIFYING NOUNS
+
+
+=352.= The participle may be associated with a noun in several ways.
+
+(1) The participle may modify a noun precisely like an adjective, as when
+we say _boiling_ water, _pleading_ eyes, _revolving_ turret, _educated_
+men, _hammered_ brass, _plowed_ land, _dried_ apples.
+
+The participle in this use can be distinguished from a real adjective in
+two ways:—(_a_) it comes from a verb, (_b_) it cannot be compared.
+
+Apply these two tests to the seven participles just given.
+
+Some participles have become real adjectives, as _loving, learned_,
+_striking_ (in _striking appearance_), _annoying_, _exciting_. Any one of
+these adjectives may be compared.
+
+(2) The participle or participial phrase may take the place of an
+adjective clause. Sometimes it is used instead of a restrictive clause,
+thus pointing out a particular thing or class of things; as, “The men
+_shoveling coal on the docks_ were prostrated by the heat.” Sometimes
+the participial phrase takes the place of an unrestrictive clause, thus
+adding a new thought to the sentence; as, “Here comes a turbaned negress,
+_balancing a basket of lemons on her head_.”
+
+In both the sentences just given the participial phrase comes after the
+noun it modifies, thus taking in the sentence the same position as the
+appositive adjective.
+
+The restrictive participial phrase is not set off by a comma. The
+unrestrictive participial phrase is set off by a comma.
+
+(3) The participial phrase may take the place of a clause of time or
+cause, and yet modify a noun, as in the following sentences:—
+
+ Those pens, _having been given to me by my dear master_, were
+ never put to any common uses.
+
+ _Having said these words_, Beowulf plunged into the water and
+ disappeared among the dark waves.
+
+In the first sentence, change the phrase to a clause of cause. What noun
+does the phrase modify?
+
+In the second sentence, what does the participial phrase modify? What can
+you say of its position? Change it to a clause of time.
+
+Note that although the participial phrase may take the place of a clause
+of time or cause, it is still an adjective element; for, as shown in the
+sentences just studied, such a participial phrase may modify a noun.
+
+=Summary.=—The participle may be used alone to modify a noun precisely
+like an adjective.
+
+The participial phrase may modify a noun, taking the place of a clause.
+
+The participial phrase sometimes comes before, and sometimes after, the
+noun it modifies.
+
+A participial phrase is set off by a comma when it is unrestrictive,
+whether it follows or precedes the word it modifies.
+
+=Exercise.=—Explain the use of all the participial phrases. Classify the
+participles. Account for the punctuation.
+
+ 1.
+
+ The breaking waves dashed high
+ On a stern and rock-bound coast.
+
+ 2. Being direct descendants of Adam and Eve, we had much of
+ their inquiring turn of mind.
+
+ 3. Worms are elongated, soft-bodied animals, differing greatly
+ in form and habits.
+
+ 4. The books bound in red morocco belonged to my mother, and
+ the “Iliad” illustrated by Flaxman was one of my father’s
+ treasures.
+
+ 5. The Temple School was a two-story brick building, standing
+ in the center of a great square piece of land, surrounded by a
+ high picket fence.
+
+ 6.
+
+ Then [comes] the whining schoolboy with his satchel
+ And shining morning face, creeping like snail
+ Unwillingly to school.
+
+ 7. That tree toad squatting on the trellis and peering down at
+ us reminds me of the gargoyles on the Cathedral of Notre Dame.
+
+ 8. The boys looked like a legion of imps, coming and going in
+ the twilight, busy in raising some infernal edifice.
+
+ 9. At last, finding himself hungry and weary, and seeing that
+ there were herds of wild asses in the plain which he was
+ traversing, Rustum thought that he would catch one of them for
+ his meal, and rest for the night.
+
+ 10. It is only he who is weary of life that throws himself in
+ the way of a roaring lion.
+
+ 11. Like most things connected in their first associations with
+ schoolbooks and schooltimes, the Leaning Tower of Pisa seemed
+ much too small.
+
+ 12. In the morning it was raining, with little prospect of fair
+ weather, but having expected nothing better, we set out on foot
+ for the Causeway.
+
+ 13. In this tavern the visitor may derive good entertainment
+ from real Genoese dishes,—sausages, strong of garlic, sliced
+ and eaten with fresh green figs; cocks’ combs and sheep
+ kidneys, chopped up with mutton chops and liver; small pieces
+ of some unknown part of a calf, twisted into small shreds,
+ fried, and served up in a great dish; and other curiosities of
+ that kind.
+
+ 14. Having supposed the Giant’s Causeway to be of great height,
+ I was somewhat disappointed at first for I found the Loom,
+ which is the highest part of it, to be but fifty feet from the
+ water.
+
+
+
+
+XC. PARTICIPIAL PHRASES IN THE PREDICATE
+
+
+=353.= Although the participial phrase is in the sentence for the purpose
+of telling something about some person or thing, still it does not always
+go with the noun that names that person or thing. In the sentence, “The
+children stood watching them out of the town,” the participial phrase
+_watching them out of the town_ tells something about the _children_, but
+it is not a direct modifier of the noun _children_, for it belongs in
+the predicate of the sentence. It does not modify the verb _stood_, for
+it does not tell how the standing was done. It really takes the place of
+a second predicate, _watched them out of the town_, but participles are
+not asserting words, hence we cannot call this phrase a predicate. The
+best way to tell about it is this: The verb _stood_ is accompanied by
+the participial phrase _watching them out of the town_, which denotes an
+action taking place at the same time as the standing.
+
+Tell about the participial phrases in these sentences:—
+
+ Fred entered the house _calling as usual for his mother_.
+
+ The Indians advanced, _shouting their war cries_.
+
+ She gazed forward, _shading her eyes with both hands_.
+
+ NOTE.—Sometimes the participle is used adverbially to modify a
+ verb; as in the sentence, “The children went scampering off to
+ the woods.” This sentence does not mean that the children went
+ _and_ scampered. They only scampered, and the scampering was
+ what made them go. Since the participial phrase tells just how
+ the children did the going, it must be a modifier of the verb
+ _went_.
+
+ What is the difference between the sentence just given and
+ the following?—“The children went singing to the woods.” It
+ is plain that not every verb can be modified by a participle.
+ Usually only a verb meaning _come_ or _go_ may be so modified.
+
+=354.= In Lesson LV it was shown that the past participle is often used
+as a subjective complement; as, “This dress is _soiled_,” “My money is
+_spent_.”
+
+=355.= In a few idiomatic expressions the participle is used adverbially
+to modify an adjective; as, _freezing_ cold, _steaming_ hot, _hopping_
+mad, _dripping_ wet. Here the participle tells how cold, how hot, etc.,
+and thus denotes degree.
+
+=356.= Sometimes the noun that a participle modifies is omitted, and the
+participle is said to be used as a noun; as, “The loving are the daring,”
+which means that loving persons are daring persons. We also speak of the
+_killed_ and _wounded_.
+
+=Summary.=—The participle or the participial phrase may be a part of the
+predicate in three ways.
+
+(1) It may be an accompaniment of the verb.
+
+(2) It may be a subjective complement of the verb.
+
+(3) It may be a modifier of a few verbs, denoting the way in which an
+action was performed.
+
+The participle may be used adverbially to modify an adjective and thus
+denote the degree of some quality.
+
+The participle may be used as a noun.
+
+=Exercise.=—Explain the use of all participles and participial phrases.
+Classify the participles.
+
+ 1. The little mare gave me all the sympathy I could ask,
+ repeatedly rubbing her soft nose over my face, and lapping up
+ my salt tears with evident relish.
+
+ 2.
+
+ Three fishers went sailing out into the west,
+ Out into the west as the sun went down.
+
+ 3. The warriors of the king were little pleased to hear such
+ talk from his lips.
+
+ 4. After her conference with the superintendent, this
+ undignified young schoolmistress went dancing and skipping home
+ to tell her mother of her promotion.
+
+ 5. The sun shining on the rippling water made it so dazzling
+ bright that we were almost blinded.
+
+ 6.
+
+ Little white Lily sat by a stone,
+ Drooping and waiting till the sun shone.
+
+ 7. On my first day in Tangiers the spectacle was bewildering,
+ and only by concentrating my attention on detached groups could
+ I form any distinct impression of it.
+
+ 8. Then Rustum made his way to the bazaar, taking his camel
+ drivers with him.
+
+ 9. After licking his lips and polishing his whiskers, the lynx
+ went loping off through the woods with the limp body of the
+ mink in his jaws, to eat it at leisure in his lair.
+
+ 10. In October the woods were a blaze of color,—clear gold,
+ flaming scarlet, crimson, amber, and coppery brown.
+
+ 11.
+
+ I watch him as he skims along,
+ Uttering his sweet and mournful cry.
+
+ 12. Society may be divided into two classes—the bores and the
+ bored.
+
+ 13.
+
+ O Captain! my Captain! our fearful trip is done,
+ The ship has weathered every rock, the prize we sought is won.
+
+ 14. Three kings came riding from far away.
+
+ 15. One day as the king sat drinking in one of the chambers of
+ his palace, and boasting after his custom, a genius, disguised
+ as a minstrel, desired to be admitted to the royal presence.
+
+ 16. The underfed dogs snapped and growled in the passages,
+ glaring at the cold stars, and snuffing into the bitter wind,
+ night after night.
+
+ 17. Drops of nightly dews trickle down to the seeds, moistening
+ the dryness, closing up the little hollows of the ground,
+ drawing the particles of maternal earth more closely.
+
+ 18. The barley and the rye are garnered and gone, the landscape
+ is bare and deserted.
+
+ 19. The air was stinging cold and felt like ice upon the boy’s
+ bare, hot throat.
+
+ 20. Her heart overflowed with sympathy for all the weary, the
+ beaten, the oppressed.
+
+Explain the use of the infinitive phrases in sentences 3, 4, 7, 9, 15.
+
+
+
+
+XCI. ABSOLUTE PARTICIPIAL PHRASES
+
+
+=357.= In the sentence, “When the snow had left the lawns bare, the
+crocuses appeared,” we have an adverbial clause. What is it? What does it
+denote? Such a clause is frequently condensed into a group of words like
+this, _the snow having left the lawns bare_. In this group there are two
+parts,—the noun element _the snow_, which was subject of the clause, and
+the participial phrase _having left the lawns bare_, which is made out of
+the predicate of the clause. It is clear then that the two parts of this
+group of words have the logical, though not the grammatical, relation of
+subject and predicate.
+
+Such a group of words is called an =absolute phrase=.
+
+=358.= The absolute phrase is generally spoken of by grammarians as an
+independent element; that is, it is not a modifier of any part of the
+sentence.
+
+=359.= Occasionally, as in the example given, the absolute phrase is an
+abridgment of an adverbial clause of time. Oftener it is used instead of
+a clause of cause, as in the sentence, “_The drought having lasted so
+long_, the foliage began to turn yellow.”
+
+=360.= Sometimes an absolute phrase is used instead of an independent
+clause, thus changing a compound sentence to a simple sentence; as, “The
+crew escaped from the ship in three boats, _only two reaching Siberia_.”
+What clause would you make out of the absolute phrase here? By what
+conjunction would you join it to the first independent proposition?
+
+=361.= The noun or the pronoun that is the base word of the noun element
+in an absolute phrase is said to be in the =nominative case=, used
+=absolutely=.
+
+=Summary.=—An =absolute phrase= is a group of words used independently
+and consisting of a noun or a pronoun and a participle, having to each
+other the logical relation of subject and predicate.
+
+An absolute phrase is an abridgment of an adverbial clause or an
+independent clause.
+
+=Exercise.=—Select all the absolute phrases. Separate them into their two
+parts. Expand them into adverbial clauses or independent clauses.
+
+ 1. His feet were clad in half slippers of red leather, the toes
+ being pointed and turned upward.
+
+ 2. She had paused in reverie, her hands clasped behind her head.
+
+ 3. Jack telling his condition, the giant bade him welcome.
+
+ 4. Grandma and Norman were sitting on the floor in front of the
+ ice box, the child having manifested a peculiar desire for cold
+ boiled potato.
+
+ 5. From a balcony above leaned the lovely Ermengarde, her
+ golden tresses crowned with a nightcap of rare and curious
+ design.
+
+ 6. The Frey home was made up of cheery workers, even little
+ Dorothea having her daily self-assumed tasks.
+
+ 7. The laws of that country being very severe against slaves,
+ Androcles was sentenced to be torn in pieces by a furious lion.
+
+ 8. Through wild and desolate scenes, by forests, rocks, and
+ waterfalls, we pass, the little locomotive always puffing and
+ pushing vigorously behind us.
+
+ 9. Mowgli had been looking from one to the other of his
+ friends, his chest heaving and his eyes full of tears.
+
+ 10. These eggs being sold, Jack and his mother got plenty of
+ money.
+
+ 11. Everywhere, scattered about the country, we have seen
+ windmills, their great arms moving slowly around.
+
+ 12. Under Rebecca’s delicately etched brows her eyes glowed
+ like two stars; their dancing lights half hidden in lustrous
+ darkness.
+
+ 13. The eagerness of Barnum to obtain a white elephant is
+ easily understood, that animal being considered by showmen the
+ greatest attraction in the country.
+
+
+
+
+XCII. AGREEMENT OF PARTICIPLES. OTHER WORDS IN -ING
+
+
+=362.= A sentence containing a participial phrase should be so
+constructed that there is no doubt as to what noun or pronoun the phrase
+modifies.
+
+In the sentence, “I had a fine view of your new hospital coming in on
+the train this morning,” the participial phrase seems by its position to
+modify the noun _hospital_; but it really modifies the pronoun _I_, and
+hence should be placed at the beginning of the sentence. If the phrase is
+expanded into an adverbial clause of time, it may remain where it is.
+
+=363.= In the sentence, “_Opening the door_, my lamp went out,” the
+participial phrase has nothing to modify.
+
+This is called a =dangling= or a =floating participle=. The best way to
+deal with such a sentence is to expand the participial phrase into an
+adverbial clause,—“When I opened the door.”
+
+=Exercise.=—Point out the error in each of these sentences. Reconstruct
+each sentence.
+
+ 1. We never once thought of the baby, rushing out of doors to
+ see the fire.
+
+ 2. I heard the whistles plainly, sailing across the bay.
+
+ 3. I met your sister coming home from my music lesson.
+
+ 4. Mother saw the flames first sitting on the veranda.
+
+ 5. Entering the hall, her foot slipped on the waxed floor and
+ she fell.
+
+ 6. Putting two and two together, it is quite plain that he
+ wants an appointment.
+
+ 7. Knitting mittens and piecing quilts, I think Grandmother is
+ very happy.
+
+ 8. Having been recently painted, Mr. Graham did not recognize
+ his own house.
+
+ 9. Grasping the rope and plunging into the surf, the huge
+ receding wave carried him out almost to the wreck.
+
+=364.= We have seen that certain participles are in form precisely like
+infinitives in _-ing_, and can be distinguished from them only by their
+use. The participle is used like an adjective, and the infinitive in
+_-ing_ is used like a noun.
+
+Take, for instance, the word _running_ in the following sentences:—
+
+ Water _running_ down hill acquires great force.
+
+ _Running_ races is a small boy’s pastime.
+
+ _Running_ water is clear.
+
+ I shall never forget the _running_ of that race.
+
+In the first sentence it is clear that _running_ is a participle, because
+the participial phrase _running down hill_ modifies the noun _water_ and
+is, therefore, used like an adjective.
+
+In the second sentence it is equally clear that _running_ is an
+infinitive, for the infinitive phrase _running races_ is subject of the
+sentence and is therefore used like a noun.
+
+In the third sentence _running_ is a participle, because it is derived
+from a verb and cannot be compared. (See § 352.) In other respects it
+resembles a pure descriptive adjective. In the phrase “an interesting
+book” _interesting_ is a pure adjective; it can be compared.
+
+In the fourth sentence _running_ is an infinitive in _-ing_. It is
+modified by an article and is used, like a noun, as the object of the
+verb.
+
+In the sentences, “It is a wise _saying_,” “Take my _blessing_,” _saying_
+and _blessing_ are pure nouns without verbal force, as is shown by the
+fact that they have plural forms.
+
+=Exercise 1.=—Classify the _-ing_ words in the following sentences as
+infinitives, participles, adjectives, or nouns:—
+
+ 1. The half back was cheered by the admiring crowd.
+
+ 2. The time of the singing of birds is come.
+
+ 3. I distinctly said that I wanted a singing bird.
+
+ 4. Singing hymns was her favorite diversion.
+
+ 5. Painting high buildings is a dangerous occupation.
+
+ 6. The old lady painting in the Louvre was an excellent copyist.
+
+ 7. Mr. Morgan paid a large sum for this small painting.
+
+ 8. The child was pleased with the painting book.
+
+ 9. A setting hen looks very placid.
+
+ 10. They should have been arrested for setting fire to the old
+ house.
+
+ 11. I will ask the photographer when he can give you a sitting.
+
+ 12. The child sitting on the curbing said sweetly, “Hello, old
+ lady.”
+
+ 13. The smiling days are not always the friendliest.
+
+ 14. “I am better,” said Agnes, smiling brightly.
+
+ 15. A short saying oft contains much wisdom.
+
+ 16. Ever charming, ever new, when will the landscape tire the
+ view?
+
+ 17. Health is a blessing that money cannot buy.
+
+ 18. Another duty the robin took upon himself,—to assist me in
+ seeing that every bird in the room had his daily outing.
+
+ 19. Turning a canary out into the world is about like turning a
+ two-year old baby out to get its own living.
+
+ 20. We require from buildings as from men two kinds of
+ goodness: first, the doing their practical duty well; then that
+ they be graceful and pleasing in doing it.
+
+=Exercise 2.=—Explain the use of each verbal in the following sentences.
+Analyze sentences 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8, 10, 13, 16, 17, 18, 20, 21.
+
+ 1. The garret is a fine place to sit of an afternoon and hear
+ the rain pattering on the roof.
+
+ 2. To be called to the principal’s office filled the stoutest
+ heart with alarm.
+
+ 3.
+
+ The curfew tolls the knell of parting day,
+ The lowing herd wind slowly o’er the lea.
+
+ 4. The old German carpenter packed Mrs. Howe’s heavy furniture
+ in an empty store beneath her apartment, and when she refused
+ to pay him an exorbitant sum, he locked the door on her and her
+ boxes and went off to find a policeman.
+
+ 5. I had views of many interesting scenes in this family of
+ crows, supposed by the wary parents to be visible only to the
+ cows stolidly feeding on the hillside.
+
+ 6. The chickens seemed to be well cared for by the women; but
+ the men appeared to be the laziest of mortals.
+
+ 7. Let us stand on the long iron bridge that spans the St.
+ Lawrence just above Montreal, the very place to study the river
+ as it narrows and runs swifter for its smashing plunge through
+ yonder rapids to the east,—the dreaded Lachine Rapids, whose
+ snarling teeth flash white in the sun.
+
+ 8. To keep Jim from following the regiment or from staying and
+ getting lost in search of it, the wagoner had tied him to the
+ rear axle of his wagon with a strong twine.
+
+ 9. The engine mounted the curve faster and faster, roaring
+ through a tunnel, growling over a bridge, and snarling at a
+ paling alongside, but no glimpse of the runaway locomotive
+ could the pursuers get.
+
+ 10. Daddy felt, like the midshipman, sadly perplexed when
+ the dog was finally missing, but he could suggest no mode of
+ revenge which was not too dangerous for them to put in practice.
+
+ 11. The thought of my shortcomings in this life falls like a
+ shadow on my life to come.
+
+ 12. Launching majestically from the edge of the nest, the great
+ eagle had swooped down into the cold shadow, and then, rising
+ into the light by a splendid spiral, he had taken a survey of
+ the empty, glimmering world.
+
+ 13. Our terrier was never known to spend a night away from home.
+
+ 14. It is inexplicable to me that any bird should be either so
+ unobservant as not to recognize a foreign egg at sight, or so
+ easy-tempered as not to insist on straightway being rid of it.
+
+ 15. It is easier to do what you please than to do what you
+ ought.
+
+ 16. The blue-white moon of midwinter, sharply glittering like
+ an icicle, hung high in a heaven clear as tempered steel.
+
+ 17. Sometimes the fox resorts to numerous devices to mislead
+ and escape the dog altogether,—walking in the bed of a small
+ creek, running along a rail fence, or leaping into a hollow
+ stump.
+
+ 18. The elephants simply moved their legs mechanically up
+ and down, and swung their trunks to and fro; but they were
+ determined not to pull or exert the slightest power, neither
+ did they move forward a single inch.
+
+ 19. The only way to mitigate the hard lot of a canary is to
+ make him so happy that he will not wish to be free.
+
+ 20. The best part of a journey is getting home again.
+
+ 21. Jefferson sent Lewis and Clark to penetrate the vast
+ regions west of the Mississippi.
+
+ 22. While the old turkey perched upon a tree top to keep an eye
+ on the enemy, the brood went sailing over the trees toward home.
+
+ 23. The officers ordered the crape to be instantly cut off from
+ the dogs’ legs.
+
+
+
+
+XCIII. SUMMARY OF PARTICIPLES
+
+
+=365.=
+
+ I. DEFINITION.—A participle is a verbal adjective.
+
+ II. FORMS.—
+ 1. Of =intransitive verbs=.
+ _Present_, going.
+ _Past_, gone.
+ _Perfect_, having gone, having been going.
+ 2. Of =transitive verbs=.
+ _Present_, seeing, being seen.
+ _Past_, seen.
+ _Perfect_, having seen, having been seeing, having been
+ seen.
+
+ III. USES.
+ 1. To form the =perfect tenses=, the =passive voice=, and the
+ =progressive conjugation=.
+ I have trusted you.
+ You were trusted by me.
+ I am trusting you.
+ 2. As an =adjective modifier= of a noun or a pronoun.
+ (a) _Restrictive._
+ Barking dogs seldom bite.
+ The picture painted by Leonardo da Vinci was stolen.
+ (b) _Unrestrictive._
+ (1) Used in place of an adjective clause.
+ The silver moon, shining in the rosy eastern sky,
+ must have looked upon the setting sun.
+ (2) Used in place of a clause of time or cause.
+ Having built a magnificent church, we had to have
+ a magnificent organ.
+ 3. As =subjective complement of a verb=.
+ Christ is risen.
+ Everybody is gone.
+ 4. As an =accompaniment of a verb=.
+ Then the blind girl came nearer, reaching out her hands
+ toward my face.
+ 5. As part of an =absolute phrase=.
+ The roast turkey having received due attention, the boys
+ were ready for mince pie.
+ IV. MODIFIERS AND COMPLEMENTS.
+ Participles have the same modifiers and complements as verbs.
+ Having earned the money, I spent it.
+ Growing tired, we walked slower.
+ Calling me a coward, he went on.
+ Turning sharply to the right, he struck the tree.
+ V. AGREEMENT.
+ 1. The construction of a sentence should leave no doubt as to
+ what word a participial phrase modifies.
+ 2. Dangling participles should be avoided.
+
+Make two good sentences to illustrate each use of the participle.
+
+
+
+
+XCIV. ANALYSIS OF SENTENCES
+
+
+=366.= A participial phrase is analyzed very much like an infinitive
+phrase. First the participle should be given as the base, then its
+complement and modifiers.
+
+MODEL.—_Behind each islet of tall reeds is a fishing boat held fast by
+two poles stuck in the bottom of the river._
+
+This is a simple, declarative sentence. The subject is _a fishing boat
+held fast by two poles stuck in the bottom of the river_. The predicate
+is _is behind each islet of tall reeds_.
+
+The base word of the subject is _boat_. It is modified by the infinitive
+_fishing_, the article _a_, and the participial phrase _held fast by two
+poles stuck in the bottom of the river_.
+
+The base word of this phrase is the participle _held_. It is modified
+by the adverb _fast_ and by the prepositional phrase _by two poles
+stuck in the bottom of the river_. The base word of the object of the
+preposition _by_ is the noun _poles_. It is modified by the adjective
+_two_ and the participial phrase _stuck in the bottom of the river_. The
+base word of this phrase is the participle _stuck_. It is modified by the
+prepositional phrase _in the bottom of the river_, etc.
+
+=367.= A sentence containing an absolute phrase should be analyzed as
+follows:—
+
+MODEL.—_Amy having gone to Vermont, the lady was lonely._
+
+This is a simple, declarative sentence containing the absolute phrase
+_Amy having gone to Vermont_, which is used instead of the adverbial
+clause of cause, _since Amy had gone to Vermont_.
+
+The subject is _the lady_. The predicate is _was lonely_, etc.
+
+The absolute phrase consists of the noun _Amy_ and the participial phrase
+_having gone to Vermont_, which have the logical relation of subject and
+predicate. The base of the participial phrase is the participle _having
+gone_, etc.
+
+=Exercise.=—Analyze the following sentences:—
+
+ 1. In one store I would find a catbird moping on a high shelf
+ or in a dark back room; in another a bluebird scared half to
+ death, and dumb in the midst of squawking parrots and singing
+ canaries.
+
+ 2. In that first battle, Jim ran barking after the very first
+ shell that came screaming over our heads.
+
+ 3. The island is supplied with the best water imaginable, small
+ streams leaping down from the sides of the hills and running
+ through every valley.
+
+ 4. The biting cold wind that shrunk our faces and pinched our
+ noses blue only brought a wild-rose bloom to mother’s delicate
+ cheeks.
+
+ 5. The doings of the people thus suddenly become his neighbors,
+ Bobby studied with all a bird’s curiosity.
+
+ 6. Coming out into the road on my way home again, I fell in
+ with an old friend.
+
+ 7. The soldiers were miserably clad, and asked whether we had
+ shoes to sell.
+
+ 8. It is difficult to describe the left-half’s agony as he
+ picked himself up and went limping back to his place.
+
+ 9. At daylight, directly ahead of us was the island of Juan
+ Fernandez, rising like a deep blue cloud out of the sea.
+
+ 10. Long ears twinkling, round eyes softly shining, the rabbits
+ leaped lightly hither and thither, pausing every now and then
+ to touch each other with their sensitive noses, or to pound on
+ the snow with their strong hind legs in mock challenge.
+
+ 11. In long, graceful leaps, barely touching the fence, the fox
+ went careering up the hill as fleet as the wind.
+
+ 12. Joel’s long legs began to ache, and seemed stiffening at
+ the thighs and knees.
+
+ 13. After their supper of milk and oatmeal porridge, the
+ children sat down, waiting and watching, and fancying they
+ heard sounds in the hills.
+
+ 14. Hearing loud cries of distress coming from the lawn, the
+ gardener rushed across and found the crow lying on his back,
+ his claw tightly gripping the end of one of the wings of a
+ large hawk.
+
+ 15. We soon found the vireo’s nest, suspended within the angle
+ of two horizontal twigs, and trimmed outwardly with some kind
+ of white silky substance.
+
+ 16. He lay like a warrior taking his rest.
+
+ 17. For four miles the pilot must race along a squirming,
+ twisting, plunging thread of water, that leaps ahead like a
+ greyhound, and changes its crookedness somewhat from day to day
+ with wind and tide.
+
+ 18. For centuries the trees had developed strength to resist
+ the winds when they were clad in all their leaves, or to carry
+ the load of those leaves weighted with raindrops, or to bear
+ the winter snows; but they had no strength that would enable
+ them to be coated thick with ice and then wrenched by angry
+ blasts.
+
+ 19. The servants having gone to their cabins, the great house
+ was filled with the quiet of a Sunday afternoon.
+
+
+
+
+XCV. ANTICIPATIVE SUBJECT
+
+
+=368.= We have learned that the pronoun _it_ may be used as an
+anticipative subject to throw the real subject after the predicate. This
+real subject may be a noun clause or an infinitive phrase.
+
+ It will never be known whether the lady came out of that door
+ or the tiger.
+
+ It is a mistake to suppose that the fox cannot be tamed.
+
+=369.= We must not conclude that the word _it_ at the beginning of
+a sentence is always an anticipative subject. Sometimes it is the
+real subject, that is, it is a neuter personal pronoun having for its
+antecedent some term perfectly understood by both speaker and listener;
+as, “Have you read ‘The Call of the Wild’? _It_ is the story of a dog
+that reverted.”
+
+=370.= Sometimes _it_ is used for subject with no special word for
+antecedent; as when we say, “It was blowing great guns.” (See § 252.)
+
+=371.= In the familiar expression, “It is time to get up,” the antecedent
+of _it_ is the word _now_ or the term _the present moment_.
+
+=372.= _It_ is not the only word used as anticipative subject. Another
+word is _there_; as in the sentence, “There is snow on the top of Pike’s
+Peak.” If we ask the question, _What is on the top of Pike’s Peak?_ the
+sensible answer is not _there_, but _snow_, hence _snow_ is the subject.
+The word _there_ does not denote place, hence it is not an adverb. It is
+used merely to fill a gap in a declarative sentence in which the subject
+has been placed after the verb, for if the gap were not filled and the
+sentence began with a verb, it would seem to be interrogative. When so
+used the word _there_ is called an =expletive=, which means a word used
+to fill up a gap.
+
+=373.= Of course _there_ at the beginning of a sentence is not always an
+expletive. Sometimes it is an adverb denoting place; as, “There will I
+build me a nest.”
+
+ NOTE.—When _there_ is an adverb we pronounce it distinctly, but
+ when it is an expletive used as anticipative subject, we slur
+ it.
+
+=Summary.=—The word _it_ is often used as an anticipative subject so that
+the real subject may come after the verb. The word _there_ may be an
+anticipative subject. It is then called an expletive.
+
+=Exercise.=—Analyze the following sentences. If there is an anticipative
+subject, state that fact before giving the real subject; thus,—In
+the sentence, “Once upon a time there were four little rabbits,” the
+anticipative subject is the expletive _there_; the real subject is _four
+little rabbits_. The predicate is _were once upon a time_.
+
+ 1. There would be several insuperable difficulties in adopting
+ the moon as a residence.
+
+ 2. Every object on the moon would be only one sixth as heavy as
+ the same object on the earth. There a box containing a pound of
+ chocolate bonbons would weigh only two or three ounces.
+
+ 3. It is a little curious that the effect of a short allowance
+ of food does not show itself in hunger.
+
+ 4. There never was such a hailstorm in Wisconsin.
+
+ 5. It is just the right time of the moon for planting sweet
+ peas.
+
+ 6. There were dances, theatricals, and sleighrides that winter.
+
+ 7. It would amuse me very much to sing while I am hunting.
+
+ 8. A cannon that breaks loose from its fastenings on a ship is
+ suddenly transformed into a supernatural beast. It is a monster
+ developed from a machine; it has the weight of an elephant, the
+ agility of a mouse, the obstinacy of the ox; it takes one by
+ surprise, like the surge of the sea; it flashes like lightning;
+ it is deaf as the tomb; it weighs ten thousand pounds, and it
+ bounds like a child’s ball.
+
+ 9. That day there came our first great snowstorm.
+
+ 10. There lay the beautiful piece of embroidery that mother had
+ put away so carefully and forgotten so completely.
+
+ 11. There’s a special providence that watches over idiots,
+ drunken men, and boys.
+
+ 12. There came to the beach a poor exile of Erin.
+
+ 13.
+
+ It made the children laugh and play,
+ To see a lamb at school.
+
+ 14. In the reign of King Arthur, and in the county of Cornwall,
+ near to the Land’s End in England, there lived a worthy farmer,
+ who had an only son, named Jack.
+
+ 15. There the two old dogs sat and talked of the wonderful
+ tenacity of rheumatism that has once settled in a dog’s
+ shoulder.
+
+ 16. There was one passenger in the coach,—a small, dark-haired
+ person in a glossy buff calico dress.
+
+ 17. Professor Boyesen describes what he calls the _saeter_, the
+ spring migration of the dairy and dairymaids. It is the great
+ event of the year in all the rural districts.
+
+ 18. There were three Catherines, two Annes, and a Jane.
+
+ 19. It is said in Ceylon that the cocoanut, like the magpie and
+ the robin, will flourish only within sound of the human voice.
+
+ 20. There is always a sad element in the departure of a steamer.
+
+
+
+
+XCVI. ELLIPTICAL SENTENCES
+
+
+=374.= We have noted several constructions in which there is an ellipsis,
+or omission of some word or words necessary to the grammatical structure
+of the sentence.
+
+(1) The subject of an imperative sentence, the pronoun _you_, _thou_, or
+_ye_ is usually omitted; as, “(_You_) Honor the flag.”
+
+(2) A noun is often omitted after a possessive modifier; as, “Let us go
+over to Baker’s (_house_) this evening.”
+
+(3) An auxiliary verb is often omitted; as, “Somebody has entered the
+hall and (_has_) taken my umbrella.”
+
+(4) The predicate is often omitted in a clause of comparison; as, “I am
+not so tired as you (_are_ or _are tired_).” “He has no better right than
+I (_have_ or _have right_).”
+
+(5) The relative pronoun _that_ is often omitted in an adjective clause;
+as, “The ring (_that_) you gave me is too small.”
+
+(6) The subordinate conjunction _that_ is often omitted in a noun clause;
+as, “You said (_that_) I might take your skates.”
+
+=375.= The elliptical sentence is very common, especially in
+conversation, where we do not have to depend entirely upon words to
+convey our meaning, as we have the help of emphasis, tone of voice, and
+gesture. It follows that in oral language we leave out many words that
+can easily be supplied by our listeners.
+
+(1) In answering questions, we seldom make complete statements, as,—
+
+ What is your name? (_My name is_) Donald.
+
+ Whose boy are you? (_I am_) Mr. Hill’s (_boy_).
+
+ Where do you live? (_I live_) On Jackson Street.
+
+(2) We often omit a word that has already been expressed in the sentence;
+as, “Our first maid was an Irish girl; our second (_maid was_) a
+Norwegian (_girl_).”
+
+(3) In sentences beginning with _no wonder_ or _no matter_ we omit the
+main verb and the anticipative subject _it_.
+
+ “No wonder he died,” means “It is no wonder that he died.”
+
+ “No matter what I said,” means “It is no matter what I said.”
+
+(4) Two very common questions are _What of it?_ and _What if I do?_ We
+may expand the first question thus, “What (_will come_) of it?” and the
+second thus, “What (_difference will it make_) if I do?”
+
+(5) In adverbial clauses we find many cases of ellipsis, but the words
+omitted can readily be supplied; as,—
+
+ I lived on the south side when (_I was_) a child.
+
+ I cut my finger while (_I was_) paring an apple.
+
+ She sings as if (_she were singing_) by note.
+
+ I will be there if (_it is_) possible.
+
+ Though (_we were_) tired and hungry we plodded on.
+
+ I will go (_though it_) rain or (_though it_) shine.
+
+=Exercise.=—Analyze the following sentences, supplying the words omitted
+wherever there is an ellipsis.
+
+ 1. Wisdom is better than rubies.
+
+ 2. A song to the oak, the brave old oak!
+
+ 3. The sun shall not smite thee by day nor the moon by night.
+
+ 4. She will close the house and go to her son’s.
+
+ 5. Cæsar had his Brutus; Charles the First his Cromwell.
+
+ 6. It is more blessed to give than to receive.
+
+ 7. And then to breakfast with what appetite you have.
+
+ 8. To-day he puts forth the tender leaves of hope; to-morrow
+ blossoms.
+
+ 9. Love’s wing moults when caged and captured.
+
+ 10. He that is slow to anger is better than the mighty, and he
+ that ruleth his spirit than he that taketh a city.
+
+ 11. Few and short were the prayers we said.
+
+ 12. All the world’s a stage and all the men and women merely
+ players.
+
+ 13.
+
+ Stone walls do not a prison make,
+ Nor iron bars a cage.
+
+ 14. Though mild, Calvin was also intolerant.
+
+ 15.
+
+ Happy the man whose wish and care
+ A few paternal acres bound.
+
+ 16. Drink to me only with thine eyes.
+
+ 17.
+
+ True hope is swift and flies with swallow’s wings,
+ Kings it makes gods and meaner creatures, kings.
+
+ 18. My true love hath my heart, and I have his.
+
+ 19.
+
+ Lives of great men all remind us
+ We can make our lives sublime.
+
+ 20. What if the river is too deep for the cattle to ford?
+
+ 21.
+
+ If all the year were playing holidays
+ To sport would be as tedious as to work.
+
+ 22. My kingdom for a horse!
+
+ 23.
+
+ No matter what the daisies say,
+ I know I’ll be married some fine day.
+
+ 24. Blessings on thee, little man!
+
+ 25.
+
+ Six white eggs on a bed of hay,
+ Flecked with purple, a pretty sight.
+
+ 26.
+
+ “Lady Moon, Lady Moon, where are you roving?”
+ “Over the sea.”
+
+ 27. The wind has a language, I would I could learn.
+
+
+
+
+XCVII. REVIEW OF ANALYSIS
+
+
+=Exercise.=—Analyze the following sentences. These sentences contain
+examples of the various constructions that have been presented in this
+book. If there is any doubt as to what part of speech a certain word
+is, the dictionary will usually enable you to decide. Where an ellipsis
+occurs, the word or words omitted should be supplied.
+
+ 1. How the black cat had captured the alert and restless
+ squirrel so quickly was a great mystery to me.
+
+ 2. If a woman puts on airs with her equals, she probably has
+ something about herself or her family that she is ashamed of.
+
+ 3. In writing these memoirs I shall yield to the inclination
+ so natural to old men, of talking of themselves and their own
+ actions.
+
+ 4.
+
+ When ye come where I have stepped,
+ Ye will wonder why ye wept.
+
+ 5. I sought out one of these few, Fred Ouillette, pilot and
+ son of a pilot, an idol in the company’s eyes, a hero to the
+ boys of Montreal, a figure to be stared at always by anxious
+ passengers.
+
+ 6. Must we conclude that the dignity of a bird depends upon the
+ length of his tail?
+
+ 7. During these gales, the top of the tableland is enveloped
+ in thick clouds, which the people of the Cape call the Devil’s
+ Table Cloth.
+
+ 8. The sand-hills were gashed with numberless ravines; and as
+ the sky had suddenly darkened, and a cold gusty wind arisen,
+ the strange shrubs and the dreary hills looked doubly wild and
+ desolate.
+
+ 9.
+
+ Floweret and hope may die,
+ But love with us shall stay.
+
+ 10. There are three beautiful dandelions out on the terrace.
+
+ 11.
+
+ I hope to see my Pilot face to face
+ When I have crossed the bar.
+
+ 12. Gray Brother did not come upon the night when I sent him
+ the word.
+
+ 13. The beasts cannot use me more cruelly than I have been used
+ by my fellow creatures.
+
+ 14. If I stroked the cat in my pet monkey’s presence, he would
+ get into a paroxysm of rage and make great efforts to bite me.
+
+ 15.
+
+ The spangled heavens, a shining frame,
+ Their great Original proclaim.
+
+ 16. He was a strange figure, this tattered, long-haired man,
+ with the spear and wallet, and his boots cut down into sandals.
+
+ 17. Gordon waited long for an opportunity to sing in the choir
+ at old St. George’s.
+
+ 18. When shall you leave Yarmouth? On the fifteenth, if
+ possible.
+
+ 19. The captain, whose ideas of hard riding were all derived
+ from trans-Atlantic sources, expressed the utmost amazement at
+ the feats of Sorel, who went leaping ravines, and dashing at
+ full speed up and down the sides of precipitous hills, lashing
+ his horse with the recklessness of a Rocky Mountain rider.
+
+ 20. The Great American Desert is a land where no man
+ permanently abides; for in certain seasons of the year there is
+ no food either for the hunter or his steed.
+
+ 21.
+
+ One constant element in luck
+ Is genuine, solid, old Teutonic pluck.
+
+ 22. Did you ever think why a dog’s nose is always wet?
+
+ 23. One of the most difficult things is to get any wild animal
+ to allow himself to be touched with the human hand.
+
+ 24. Old Trinity’s steeple probably sways eighteen inches
+ whenever an elevated train passes.
+
+ 25. Do steeple climbers always work in pairs?
+
+ 26. The chipmunk had made a well-defined path from his door out
+ through the weeds and dry leaves into the territory where his
+ feeding ground lay.
+
+ 27. No wonder Eve ate the forbidden fruit.
+
+ 28. In Bermuda the banana is as omnipresent as the onion.
+
+ 29. We called the mice Jack, Jill, and Jenny, and they seemed
+ to know their names.
+
+ 30. Shooting the Lachine Rapids is like taming a particularly
+ fierce lion.
+
+ 31. Turk slept at night outside his master’s door, and no
+ sentry could be more alert upon his watch than this faithful
+ mastiff, who had apparently only one ambition,—to protect and
+ to accompany his owner.
+
+ 32. We fancied we could hear the huge bodies of the whales
+ burrowing through the water.
+
+ 33. At length, finding my life very solitary, I accepted the
+ claw and heart of a rich and respectable green parrot, who
+ offered me a good home and the devotion of a lifetime.
+
+ 34. Be it ever so humble, there’s no place like home.
+
+ 35. Presently the doe stepped away, and left her little one
+ lying on a spotted heap of dead leaves and moss.
+
+ 36. While traveling along the Rhine, we observed that when the
+ German has nothing else to do, he eats and drinks.
+
+ 37. The Spaniards changed the whole character and habits of the
+ Indians when they brought the horse among them.
+
+ 38. The fires in the Australian bush are often the work of the
+ natives, to frighten away the white men; and sometimes the work
+ of the shepherds, to make the grass sprout afresh.
+
+ 39. Near the Pyramids, more wondrous and more awful than all
+ else in the land of Egypt, there sits the lonely Sphinx.
+
+ 40. The sexton had lived in Stratford for eighty years, and
+ seemed still to consider himself a vigorous man, with the
+ trivial exception that he had nearly lost the use of his legs.
+
+ 41. What if this were my last day at school?
+
+ 42. It was something to have seen the dust of Shakespeare.
+
+ 43. A queen bee will lay two hundred eggs in a few hours, and
+ in the year she will generally have laid twenty or thirty
+ thousand.
+
+ 44. The ground was carpeted with softest moss, into which the
+ boy’s feet sunk so deep that they were almost covered; and all
+ over the moss were sprinkled little star-shaped pink flowers.
+
+ 45. The wolf asked little Red Riding Hood whither she was going.
+
+ 46.
+
+ O happy harbor of God’s saints!
+ O sweet and pleasant soil!
+ In thee no sorrow can be found,
+ Nor grief, nor care, nor toil.
+
+ 47. She fell back upon the floor as if by the stroke of an
+ unseen hand.
+
+ 48. Whether she was attended by a physician from Canton or from
+ Milton, I was unable to say; but neither the gig with the large
+ allopathic sorrel horse, nor the gig with the homœopathic white
+ mare was ever seen hitched at the gate during the day.
+
+ 49. No sooner did I open their door than out the little
+ starlings would all fly, and seat themselves on my head and
+ shoulders.
+
+ 50. Neither eye nor ear revealed him anything.
+
+ 51. Small leisure have the poor for grief.
+
+ 52. By a flight of winding stairs we reached a covered balcony,
+ over which a tropical vine wanders at will.
+
+ 53. Dora heard Marjorie singing, laughing, chatting, as she
+ flashed here and there, helping and hindering in about equal
+ proportions.
+
+ 54. No matter what honors your ancestors attained, make your
+ own name honorable.
+
+ 55. As I trod the sounding pavement, there was something
+ intense and thrilling in the idea that the remains of
+ Shakespeare were moldering beneath my feet.
+
+ 56. The lark, springing up from the reeking bosom of the
+ meadow, towered away into the bright fleecy cloud, pouring
+ forth torrents of melody.
+
+ 57. I now found myself among noble avenues of oaks and elms,
+ whose vast size bespoke the growth of centuries.
+
+ 58. The air within the tunnel is somewhat damp, but fresh and
+ agreeably cool, and one can scarcely realize in walking along
+ the light passage, that a river is rolling above his head.
+
+ 59. No frog egg may hope to develop into a turtle, or a bird,
+ or anything but a frog.
+
+ 60. I heard my own mountain goats bleating aloft.
+
+ 61. Everybody knows that the porcupine is ridiculously
+ fastidious in his choice of food.
+
+ 62.
+
+ The daisy, by the shadow that it casts,
+ Protects the lingering dewdrop from the sun.
+
+ 63. If I choose to work eleven hours a day, what of it?
+
+ 64. Far below lay the earth, brown, dry, and desolate, from
+ drouth.
+
+ 65. There was no sleep that long night for the little duck
+ mother Quackalina.
+
+ 66. One evening, after the ice of a sleet storm had clogged
+ their wings, the pigeons settled on one of the highest
+ buildings they could find, and sat and shivered through the
+ long night.
+
+ 67. The taking down of a steeple two hundred and thirty-eight
+ feet high, that rises on a closely built city street, is not a
+ simple proceeding.
+
+ 68.
+
+ The legend of Felix is ended, the toiling of Felix is done;
+ The master has paid him his wages, the goal of his journey is won.
+
+ 69. There we were shown the chair on which the English monarchs
+ have been crowned for several hundred years.
+
+ 70. Under the seat is the stone brought from the Abbey of
+ Scone, whereon the kings of Scotland were crowned.
+
+ 71. Sleeping or waking, my thoughts are all of Ireland and of
+ you.
+
+ 72. Fortunately for us, our two lean, wiry little horses did
+ not object to being used as aquatic animals.
+
+ 73. Many Russian villages possess a public bath of the most
+ primitive construction, but in some parts of the country the
+ peasants take their vapor bath in the household oven in which
+ the bread is baked!
+
+ 74. This aptly illustrates a common Russian proverb, which says
+ that what is health to the Russian is death to the German.
+
+ 75. Scarfs, shawls, stuffs for dresses, morning gowns, and
+ vests, handkerchiefs, sashes, purses, and tobacco bags are
+ heaped in rich profusion.
+
+ 76. When a man of fourscore, he continued his weekly visits to
+ the schools.
+
+ 77. His master having been honorably discharged before the
+ close of the war, Jim was left with the regiment in care of
+ Wiggins, the wagoner.
+
+ 78. No other pigeon is so bold and fearless, so full of bulldog
+ tenacity, so full of royal courage, as the homer.
+
+ 79. The French carried their imitation of Indians so far that
+ they often disguised themselves to resemble their allies, with
+ paint, feathers, and all.
+
+ 80. It was sometimes impossible to tell in an attacking party
+ which were French and which were Indians.
+
+ 81. The sea was dotted everywhere with the heads of seals
+ hurrying to land and begin their share of fighting.
+
+ 82. Old Marley was as dead as a door-nail.
+
+ 83.
+
+ If eyes were made for seeing,
+ Then beauty is its own excuse for being.
+
+ 84.
+
+ Out on the lawn there arose such a clatter
+ I sprang from my bed to see what was the matter.
+
+ 85.
+
+ There is a pleasure in the pathless woods,
+ There is a rapture on the lonely shore.
+
+ 86. How I wish that when the Angel comes for me, I might reach
+ out and feel your hand!
+
+
+
+
+GENERAL REVIEW
+
+
+Exercise 1
+
+ (1) The family of the Lambs had long been among the most
+ thriving and popular in the neighborhood; the Miss Lambs
+ were the belles of Little Britain, and everybody was pleased
+ when old Lamb had made money enough to shut up shop, and put
+ his name on a brass plate on his door. (2) In an evil hour,
+ however, one of the Miss Lambs had the honor of being a lady in
+ attendance on the Lady Mayoress, at her great annual ball, on
+ which occasion she wore three towering ostrich feathers on her
+ head. (3) The family never got over it; they were immediately
+ smitten with a passion for high life; set up a one-horse
+ carriage, put a bit of gold lace round the errand-boy’s
+ hat, and have been the talk and detestation of the whole
+ neighborhood ever since. (4) They could no longer be induced
+ to play at Pope-Joan or blindman’s buff; they could endure no
+ dances but quadrilles, which nobody had ever heard of in Little
+ Britain; and they took to reading novels, talking bad French,
+ and playing upon the piano. (5) Their brother, too, who had
+ been articled to an attorney, set up for a dandy and a critic,
+ characters hitherto unknown in these parts; and he confounded
+ the worthy folks exceedingly by talking about Kean, the opera,
+ and the “Edinburgh Review.”
+
+ —WASHINGTON IRVING, _Sketch Book_.
+
+1. Consult the dictionary for the meaning of all words in this paragraph
+that you do not understand.
+
+2. Account for the capitalization and punctuation. Why is the term
+_Edinburgh Review_ inclosed in quotation marks?
+
+3. What kind of noun is _family_ in sentence (1)? Use it in a sentence so
+as to reveal its number and its gender. What is its number in sentence
+(3)? How do you account for it?
+
+4. What two plural forms has the term _Miss Lamb_? What is the plural
+of _Lady Mayoress_? What does the dictionary say about the plural form
+_folks_? What is the number of _everybody_ in sentence (1)? What is the
+plural of _attorney_? of _dandy_?
+
+5. Tell the part of speech and use of _long_, _enough_, sentence (1);
+_however_, _one_, _which_, sentence (2); _ever_, _since_, sentence (3);
+_no_, _longer_, _no_, _but_, sentence (4); _too_, _up_, _hitherto_,
+sentence (5). Which of these words can be used as other parts of speech?
+Illustrate in sentences.
+
+6. Are _thriving_ in sentence (1) and _towering_ in sentence (2)
+participles or adjectives? How do you decide? Is _pleased_ in sentence
+(1) a complement of _was_ or a part of a passive verb _was pleased_? How
+do you decide? How is _smitten_ used in sentence (3)? Find two passive
+verbs, and prove that they are passive.
+
+7. Supply the ellipsis before and after _popular_ in sentence (1); before
+_put_ in sentence (1).
+
+8. Tell the use of each of the following verbals: _being_ (2); _reading_,
+_talking_, _playing_ (4); _talking_ (5). Tell how each of these verbals
+is modified or completed.
+
+9. Select each prepositional phrase and tell what it modifies.
+
+10. Select all the infinitives with _to_ and tell the grammatical use of
+each.
+
+11. Parse the relative pronouns in sentences (4) and (5). Are the clauses
+that they introduce restrictive or unrestrictive?
+
+12. Tell the use and case of each of the following nouns: _belles_ (1);
+_talk_, _detestation_ (3); _characters_ (5).
+
+13. Tell the principal parts of each of these verbs: _put_ (1); _had_,
+_wore_ (2); _got_, _set_ (3); _took_ (4).
+
+
+Exercise 2
+
+ (1) Ahem! Dry work, this speechifying, especially to an
+ unpracticed orator. (2) I never conceived till now what toil
+ the temperance lecturers undergo for my sake; hereafter they
+ shall have the business to themselves. (3) Do, some kind
+ Christian, pump a stroke or two, just to wet my whistle. (4)
+ Thank you, sir! (5) My dear hearers, when the world shall have
+ been regenerated by my instrumentality, you will collect your
+ useless vats and liquor casks into one great pile and make a
+ bonfire in honor of the town pump. (6) And when I shall have
+ decayed like my predecessors, then, if you revere my memory,
+ let a marble fountain, richly sculptured, take my place upon
+ this spot. (7) Such monuments should be erected everywhere and
+ inscribed with the names of the distinguished champions of my
+ cause.
+
+ (8) One o’clock! (9) Nay, then, if the dinner bell begins to
+ speak, I may as well hold my peace. (10) Here comes a pretty
+ young girl of my acquaintance with a large stone pitcher for me
+ to fill. (11) May she draw a husband while drawing her water,
+ as Rachel did of old! (12) Hold out your vessel, my dear! (13)
+ There it is, full to the brim; so now run home, peeping at your
+ sweet image in the pitcher as you go, and forget not, in a
+ glass of my own liquor, to drink “Success to the town pump.”
+
+ —NATHANIEL HAWTHORNE, _Twice Told Tales_.
+
+1. Consult the dictionary for the meaning of words in these paragraphs
+that you do not understand.
+
+2. Classify each sentence both as to purpose and structure.
+
+3. What part of speech is _ahem_? What feeling does it express in
+sentence (1)?
+
+4. Supply the ellipsis in sentence (1). What part of speech is
+_speechifying_? What is its grammatical use?
+
+5. What does the adverb _especially_ in sentence (1) modify?
+
+6. Account for the use of _shall_ and _will_ in these paragraphs.
+
+7. Select all the dependent clauses. Tell the class and use of each, and
+the introductory word.
+
+8. Select all the terms of address. What is the base word of each?
+
+9. What is the use of _now_ sentence (2)? _old_ (11)? _dinner_ (9)?
+
+10. Parse each predicate verb in sentences (3), (5), (6), (7).
+
+11. Tell the part of speech and use of _themselves_, sentence (2);
+_stroke_, _two_ (3); _there_, _full_, _peeping_, _glass_, _own_ (13).
+
+12. Tell the use of all infinitive phrases in sentences (3), (6), (9),
+(10), (13).
+
+
+Exercise 3
+
+ (1) Once upon a time there came to this earth a visitor from a
+ neighboring planet. And he was met at the place of his descent
+ by a great philosopher, who was to show him everything.
+
+ (2) First of all they came through a wood, and the stranger
+ looked upon the trees. “Whom have we here?” said he.
+
+ (3) “These are only vegetables,” said the philosopher. “They
+ are alive, but not at all interesting.”
+
+ (4) “I don’t know about that,” said the stranger. “They seem to
+ have very good manners. Do they never speak?”
+
+ (5) “They lack the gift,” said the philosopher.
+
+ (6) “Yet I think I hear them sing,” said the other.
+
+ (7) “That is only the wind among the leaves,” said the
+ philosopher. “I will explain to you the theory of winds; it is
+ very interesting.”
+
+ (8) “Well,” said the stranger, “I wish I knew what they are
+ thinking.”
+
+ (9) “They cannot think,” said the philosopher.
+
+ (10) “I don’t know about that,” returned the stranger; and
+ then laying his hand upon a trunk: “I like these people,” said
+ he.
+
+ (11) “They are not people at all,” said the philosopher. “Come
+ along.”
+
+ (12) Next they came through a meadow where there were cows.
+
+ (13) “These are very dirty people,” said the stranger.
+
+ (14) “They are not people at all,” said the philosopher; and
+ he explained what a cow is in scientific words which I have
+ forgotten.
+
+ (15) “That is all one to me,” said the stranger. “But why do
+ they never look up?”
+
+ (16) “Because they are graminivorous,” said the philosopher;
+ “and to live upon grass, which is not highly nutritious,
+ requires so close an attention to business that they have
+ no time to think, or speak, or look at the scenery, or keep
+ themselves clean.”
+
+ (17) “Well,” said the stranger, “that is one way to live, no
+ doubt. But I prefer the people with the green heads.”
+
+ (18) Next they came into a city, and the streets were full of
+ men and women.
+
+ (19) “These are very odd people,” said the stranger.
+
+ (20) “They are the people of the greatest nation in the world,”
+ said the philosopher.
+
+ (21) “Are they indeed?” said the stranger. “They scarcely look
+ so.”
+
+ —R. L. STEVENSON, _Fables_.
+
+1. Rewrite this selection, changing the direct to indirect discourse and
+noting the changes made in verbs, pronouns, and other words.
+
+2. Fill out the elliptical sentences, and tell the grammatical use of
+each of the words that you supply.
+
+3. Comment on the use of _and_ (1), _but_ (15), and _but_ (17).
+
+4. Explain how each of the following verbs and verbals is completed and
+modified: _was_, _to show_, paragraph (1); _have_ (2); _are_, and _are_
+(3); _seem_ (4); _lack_ (5); _think_, _hear_, _said_ (6); _wish_, _knew_,
+_are thinking_ (8); _laying_ (10); _explained_, _is_, _have forgotten_
+(14); _is_ (15); _keep_ (16).
+
+5. Find the subject of _came_ in the first sentence, and explain the use
+of _there_. Prove that _was met_ in paragraph (1) is a true passive verb.
+
+6. Tell the grammatical use of each infinitive in paragraphs (16) and
+(17).
+
+7. Tell the part of speech and use of _once_, paragraph (1); _first_ (2);
+_highly_, _so_ (16); _well_ (17); _next_ (18); _very_ (19); _indeed_,
+_scarcely_, _so_ (21).
+
+8. Parse all the adjective pronouns, interrogative pronouns, and relative
+pronouns.
+
+9. Find all the prepositional phrases, and tell what each phrase
+modifies. Tell the object of each preposition, and if there is anything
+peculiar about any object, comment upon the peculiarity.
+
+10. Select all the dependent clauses. Tell the kind and use of each
+clause, and its introductory word. Classify the adjective clauses as
+restrictive or unrestrictive, and tell what the adverbial clauses denote.
+
+If a word is used in a peculiar or uncommon way, consult the dictionary
+for information regarding it.
+
+
+Exercise 4
+
+ (1) There troop the three most roguish boys that ever made
+ parents scold or laugh. (2) They have nothing to do but to
+ set each other on to mischief. (3) They pull off buds from
+ the unblossomed rose bushes; they pick cucumbers by the half
+ bushel that were to have been let alone; they break down rare
+ shrubbery to get whips, and instead get whippings; they kill
+ the guinea-pigs; chase the chickens; break up hens’ nests; get
+ into the carriages and wagons only to tumble out, and set all
+ the nurses a-running; they study every means of getting under
+ the horses’ feet, and, as the more dangerous act, they are
+ fond of tickling their hind legs, and pulling at their tails;
+ they fill the already fed horses with extra oats, causing the
+ hostler to fear for his charges’ health, since they refuse oats
+ at the next regular feeding; they paddle in all the mud on the
+ premises; sit down in the street and fill their pockets with
+ dirt; they wet their clothes in the brook, tear them in the
+ woods, lose their caps a dozen times a day, and go bare-headed
+ in the blazing sun; they cut up every imaginable prank with
+ their long-suffering nurses when meals are served, or when
+ bedtime comes, or when morning brings the washing and dressing.
+ (4) They are little, nimble, compact skinfuls of ingenious,
+ fertile, endless, untiring mischief. (5) They stub their toes,
+ or cut their fingers, or get stung, or eat some poisonous
+ berry, seed, or root, or make us think that they have, which
+ is just as bad; they fall down stairs, or eat green fruit till
+ they are as tight as a drum; and yet there is no peace to us
+ without them, as there certainly is none with them. Mischievous
+ darlings! Joyful plagues! Loving, rollicking, laughing rogues!
+
+ —HENRY WARD BEECHER, _Star Papers_.
+
+1. Give the principal parts of each predicate verb in this selection; its
+tense. Read the selection with the predicate verbs in the past tense.
+
+2. Explain how the following verbs are completed and modified: _made_,
+sentence (1); _have_ (2); _pull_, _were_, _lose_, _go_, _cut_ (3); _are_
+(4); _get_, _make_ (5).
+
+3. Select all the adjectives and tell what they modify. Classify them as
+limiting or descriptive. Compare them, if possible. If any of them do not
+admit of comparison, tell why.
+
+4. Tell the use of _there_, sentence (1) and _there_ (5).
+
+5. Tell the use and case of each of the following nouns: _boys_, sentence
+(1); _legs_ (3); _hostler_ (3); _times_ (3); _day_ (3); _drum_ (5);
+_darlings_ (5).
+
+6. Find three nouns in the possessive case, and tell what each of them
+modifies. Decline each of these nouns.
+
+7. Select all the infinitives with _to_ and tell the use of each.
+
+8. Select and classify all the words in _-ing_.
+
+9. Account for the punctuation of this selection.
+
+10. Select all the dependent clauses. Tell the kind and use of each, and
+the introductory word.
+
+11. Tell the part of speech and use of _on_ (2); _off_, _alone_, _down_,
+_up_, _already_ (3); _just_, _down_, _certainly_ (5).
+
+12. Select all the coördinate conjunctions in sentences (3) and (5) and
+tell what each conjunction joins.
+
+
+
+
+INDEX
+
+
+ Absolute phrases, 237.
+
+ Absolute use of noun, 237.
+
+ Abstract nouns, 14.
+
+ Active voice, 40.
+
+ Address, term of, 39, 40.
+
+ Adjective clauses, 171.
+ restrictive, 193.
+ unrestrictive, 194.
+
+ Adjective elements, 29.
+
+ Adjective phrases, 31.
+
+ Adjective pronouns, 121.
+ declension of, 122.
+
+ Adjectives, appositive, 88.
+ classified, 110.
+ comparison of, 116, 117.
+ defined, 25.
+ errors in use of, 118, 119.
+ misused for adverbs, 70, 71.
+ modifying pronouns, 26.
+ objective complement, 94.
+ parsing of, 120.
+ review of, 120.
+ subjective complement, 69.
+
+ Adverbial clauses, of cause, 183.
+ of comparison, 188, 189.
+ of concession, 186.
+ of condition, 186.
+ of manner, 181.
+ of place, 181.
+ of purpose, 184.
+ of result, 184.
+ of time, 180, 181.
+ office of, 171.
+
+ Adverbial nouns, 91.
+
+ Adverbial noun phrases, 91.
+ modifying adjectives or adverbs, 92.
+
+ Adverbial noun phrases, modifying verbs, 91.
+ what they denote, 91.
+
+ Adverbial phrases, 31.
+
+ Adverbs, comparison of, 170.
+ conjunctive, 172.
+ defined, 28.
+ formation of, 31.
+ interrogative, 170.
+ introducing noun clauses, 204, 205.
+ meaning of, 28.
+ misused for adjectives, 70, 71.
+ modifying adjectives, 29.
+ modifying adverbs, 29.
+ modifying sentences, 175.
+ modifying verbs, 28.
+ parsing of, 174.
+ simple, 170.
+ summary of, 173.
+
+ _After_, 178.
+
+ Agreement, of participle and noun, 239.
+ of subject and verb, 165, 166.
+
+ _Among_, 37.
+
+ Analysis, models for, 34, 48, 191, 225, 244.
+
+ Antecedent, of personal pronoun, 98.
+ of relative pronoun, 197.
+
+ Anticipative subject, 201, 212, 247.
+
+ Appositive, adjective, 88.
+ case of, 87.
+ in possessive case, 86.
+ infinitive, 215.
+ noun, 85, 86.
+
+ Appositive, noun clause, 201.
+ position of, 86.
+ punctuation of, 86, 87.
+
+ Articles, definite and indefinite, 113.
+ uses of, 114.
+
+ _As_, relative pronoun, 197.
+
+ _At_, 37.
+
+ Auxiliary verbs, 124.
+ _can_, _could_, etc., 154-156.
+ _shall_ and _will_, 151, 152.
+
+
+ _Before_, 178.
+
+ _Beside_, 38.
+
+ _Besides_, 38.
+
+ _Between_, 37.
+
+ _But_, conjunction and preposition, 46.
+ relative pronoun, 197.
+ uses of, 178.
+
+ _By_, 38.
+
+
+ _Can_ and _could_, 155, 156.
+
+ Capitalization, of proper adjectives, 111.
+ of proper nouns, 13, 14.
+
+ Case, 83-95, 100, 108, 196.
+
+ Cause, clauses of, 183.
+
+ Clauses, adjective, 171, 193-197.
+ adverbial, 171, 180-191.
+ defined, 48.
+ dependent, 52, 53.
+ independent, 48.
+ noun, 200, 201.
+ review of, 206.
+
+ Collective nouns, 166.
+
+ Common gender, 78.
+
+ Common nouns, 13, 14.
+
+ Comparative degree, 116.
+
+ Comparison, clauses of, 188, 189.
+ of adjectives, 116.
+ of adverbs, 170.
+ how denoted, 116, 117.
+ irregular, 117.
+
+ Complement, defined, 61.
+
+ Complement, direct object, 61.
+ double object, 216.
+ objective, 94, 145.
+ subjective, 67, 68.
+
+ Complex sentences, 53.
+
+ Compound personal pronouns, 106.
+ uses of, 106.
+
+ Compound predicate, 19, 20.
+
+ Compound sentences, 50.
+
+ Compound subject, 20.
+
+ Concession, clauses of, 186.
+
+ Condition, clauses of, 186.
+
+ Conjugation, active voice, 128-130, 132, 134.
+ defined, 127.
+ emphatic, 149.
+ imperative mode, 134.
+ indicative mode, 128-130.
+ interrogative, 129.
+ passive voice, 140-142.
+ progressive, 148.
+ subjunctive mode, 132.
+
+ Conjunctions, 46.
+ coördinate, 174.
+ correlative, 175.
+ in compound sentences, 50.
+ subordinate, 176, 177.
+
+ Conjunctive adverbs, 172.
+ in noun clauses, 204.
+
+ Contractions, 130.
+
+ Coördinate conjunctions, 174.
+
+ Correlative conjunctions, 175.
+
+
+ Dangling participles, 239.
+
+ Declarative sentences, 9, 10.
+
+ Declension, of nouns, 84.
+ of personal pronouns, 98.
+ of relative pronouns, 196.
+
+ Defective verbs, 154-157.
+
+ Demonstrative adjectives, 113.
+
+ Dependent clauses, 52.
+
+ Descriptive adjectives, 110, 111.
+
+ Direct and indirect discourse, 162-165.
+
+ Direct and indirect quotations, 162-165.
+
+ _Do_, as principal verb, 157.
+
+ Double object, of preposition _for_, 220.
+ of verb, 216-218.
+
+ Double possessive, 81, 104.
+
+
+ _Each other_, 122.
+
+ Elliptical sentences, 249, 250.
+
+ _Else_, as limiting adjective, 113.
+ uses of, 178.
+
+ Emphatic conjugation, 149, 150.
+
+ _Enough_, 113.
+
+ Errors, in adjectives, 70, 71, 118, 119.
+ in adverbs, 70, 71.
+ in infinitives, 221, 222.
+ in interrogative pronouns, 109, 110.
+ in participles, 239.
+ in personal pronouns, 101, 103.
+ in verbs, 130, 137-142.
+
+ Exclamatory nouns, 40.
+
+ Exclamatory sentences, 44, 45.
+
+
+ Feminine gender, 78.
+
+ Floating participle, 239.
+
+ _For_, 179.
+
+
+ Gender, 77, 78.
+ how denoted, 78.
+
+ Gerund, 211.
+
+ _Going_, in verb phrase, 156.
+
+
+ _Have_, as principal verb, 157.
+
+ _Hence_, 179.
+
+
+ Idiomatic expressions, 104, 201, 220, 235, 247.
+
+ Imperative mode, 134.
+ conjugation of, 134.
+
+ Imperative sentences, 41.
+ subject omitted, 42.
+
+ Impersonal verbs, 157.
+
+ _In_, 37, 38.
+
+ Independent elements, 39, 40.
+
+ Indicative mode, 127.
+
+ Indirect discourse, 162-165.
+
+ Indirect object, 89, 90.
+ becoming subject of passive verb, 141.
+ position of, 90.
+
+ Infinitive phrases, 211.
+
+ Infinitives, defined, 209.
+ errors in use of, 221, 222.
+ in apposition, 215.
+ in _-ing_, 210.
+ modified by possessive, 211.
+ modifier of adjective, 220, 221.
+ modifier of noun, 215.
+ modifier of verb, 218.
+ object of preposition, 220.
+ object of verb, 213.
+ part of double object, 216-218.
+ subjective complement, 213.
+ summary of, 224, 225.
+ used independently, 221.
+ with _to_, 209, 210.
+
+ Interjections, 43.
+
+ Interrogative adjectives, 113.
+
+ Interrogative adverbs, 170.
+
+ Interrogative conjugation, 129.
+
+ Interrogative pronouns, 108.
+ errors in use of, 109, 110.
+ in noun clause, 204.
+ uses of, 108.
+
+ Interrogative sentences, 23, 24.
+ order of, 24.
+
+ _Into_, 38.
+
+ Intransitive verbs, of action, 64.
+ of being, 64, 66, 67.
+
+ Irregular verbs, defined, 135, 136.
+ errors in use of, 137-140.
+ principal parts of, 137.
+
+ _It_, as anticipative subject, 201, 212, 247.
+
+
+ _Lay_ and _lie_, 137.
+
+ _Like_, 181.
+
+ Limiting adjectives, 110, 113, 114.
+
+
+ Manner, clauses of, 181.
+
+ Masculine gender, 77.
+
+ _May_ and _might_, 155, 156.
+
+ Mode, defined, 127.
+ imperative, 134.
+ indicative, 127.
+ subjunctive, 131, 132.
+
+ Modifier, 26.
+
+ _Must_, 155, 156.
+
+
+ Natural order, 22.
+
+ Neuter gender, 78.
+
+ Nominative case, 83, 84, 100.
+
+ Noun clauses, 200.
+ introductory word of, 203, 204.
+ uses of, 200, 201.
+
+ Nouns, abstract, 14.
+ adverbial, 91, 92.
+ as adjectives, 27.
+ as interjections, 43.
+ case of, 83, 84.
+ collective, 166.
+ common, 13, 14.
+ compound, 81.
+ declension of, 84.
+ defined, 11, 12.
+ direct object, 61.
+ gender of, 77, 78.
+ in apposition, 85-87.
+ in exclamation, 40.
+ in _-ing_, 240.
+ indirect object, 89.
+ number of, 74-76.
+ object of preposition, 35.
+ objective complement, 94.
+ parsing of, 96.
+ possessive, 79-82.
+ proper, 13, 14.
+ term of address, 39, 40.
+ used absolutely, 237.
+
+ Number, defined, 74.
+ singular and plural, 74, 75.
+
+ Numeral adjectives, 113.
+
+
+ _O_, 43.
+
+ Object, double, 216.
+ indirect, 89, 90, 141.
+ of preposition, 35, 36.
+ of verb, 61.
+ retained, 146.
+
+ Objective complement, 94.
+ becoming subjective complement of passive verb, 145.
+
+ _Off_, 38.
+
+ _One_, declined, 122.
+
+ _One another_, 122.
+
+ _Only_, 179.
+
+ _Other_, declined, 122.
+
+ _Own_, with possessives, 100.
+
+
+ Parsing, of adjectives, 120.
+ of adverbs, 174.
+ of nouns, 96.
+ of prepositions, 179.
+ of pronouns, 100, 208.
+ of verbs, 150, 168.
+
+ Participial phrases, 229.
+
+ Participles, agreement of, 239.
+ dangling, or floating, 239.
+ defined, 228, 229.
+ differing from adjectives, 231.
+ errors in use of, 239.
+ forms of, 228.
+ summary of, 243, 244.
+ uses of, 140, 144, 145, 148, 228, 229, 231, 235, 237.
+
+ Parts of speech, summary of, 57.
+
+ Passive voice, 140-142.
+
+ Past participle, 135, 228.
+ as subjective complement, 144, 145.
+ in passive conjugation, 140.
+
+ Person, of nouns, 98.
+ of pronouns, 98.
+ of verbs, 127.
+
+ Personal pronouns, 98.
+ compound, 106.
+ declension of, 98.
+ errors in use of, 101-103.
+ uses of, 100, 103-105.
+
+ Phrases, 31, 33.
+ absolute, 237.
+ adjective, 31.
+ adverbial, 31.
+ as subjective complement, 69.
+ defined, 33.
+ denoting possession, 81.
+ in a series, 32.
+ infinitive, 211.
+ participial, 229.
+ position of, 32.
+ prepositional, 35, 36.
+
+ Place, clauses of, 181.
+
+ Plurals, foreign, 75.
+ formation of, 74, 75.
+ compound nouns, 75.
+ letters and figures, 75.
+ titles, 75.
+ regular and irregular, 74.
+ same as singular, 74.
+
+ Positive degree, 116.
+
+ Possessive case, 83.
+ of compound nouns, 81.
+
+ Possessive nouns, 80, 83.
+ form of, 80, 81.
+ in double possessives, 81.
+ what they denote, 81.
+
+ Possessive pronouns, 103.
+ how used, 104.
+ in double possessives, 104.
+
+ Predicate, compound, 19, 20.
+ defined, 9, 10.
+ simple, 16.
+ transposed, 22.
+
+ Prepositions, 34, 35.
+ correct use of, 37-39.
+ parsing of, 179.
+
+ Present participle, in progressive conjugation, 148, 228.
+
+ Principal parts, 135.
+
+ Principal parts, of irregular verbs, 137.
+
+ Progressive conjugation, 148.
+
+ Pronouns, adjective, 121.
+ compound personal, 106.
+ defined, 18.
+ in clauses of comparison, 190, 191.
+ indefinite, 204.
+ interrogative, 108.
+ parsing of, 100, 208.
+ personal, 98, 100, 103.
+
+ Pronouns, relative, 196, 197.
+ review of, 207.
+
+ Proper adjectives, 111.
+
+ Proper nouns, 13, 14.
+
+ Punctuation, of a series, 20, 25, 26, 32.
+ of appositives, 86-88.
+ of compound sentences, 50.
+ of compound subject and predicate, 20.
+ of declarative sentences, 10.
+ of exclamatory sentences, 44.
+ of interrogative sentences, 24.
+ of phrases, 32.
+
+ Purpose, clauses of, 184.
+
+
+ _Raise_ and _rise_, 138.
+
+ Reflexive use of pronouns, 106.
+
+ Regular verbs, 135, 136.
+
+ Relative pronouns, 196, 197.
+ _what_, 204.
+
+ Result, clauses of, 184.
+
+ Retained object, 146.
+
+ Review, general, 257-264.
+ of adjectives, 120.
+ of adverbs, 173.
+ of analysis, 252.
+ of clauses, 206.
+ of infinitives, 224, 225.
+ of nouns, 96, 97.
+ of participles, 243.
+ of parts of speech, 57.
+ of prepositions, 179.
+
+ Review, general, of pronouns, 207.
+ of sentences, 55.
+ of verbs, 72, 168.
+
+
+ Sentences, complex, 53.
+ compound, 50.
+ declarative, 9, 10.
+ defined, 9, 10.
+ elliptical, 249, 250,
+ exclamatory, 44, 45.
+ imperative, 41.
+ interrogative, 23, 24.
+ review of, 55.
+ simple, 48.
+
+ Sequence of tenses, 125, 163.
+
+ Series, of adjectives, 25.
+ of phrases, 32.
+ of predicates, 20.
+
+ _Set_ and _sit_, 138.
+
+ _Shall_ and _will_, 151.
+ in indirect discourse, 163.
+ in interrogative sentences, 152.
+ rules for use of, 152.
+
+ _Should_ and _would_, 160-162.
+ in subjunctive mode, 155.
+
+ Simple adverbs, 170.
+
+ Simple predicate, 16.
+
+ Simple sentences, 48.
+
+ Simple subject, 11.
+
+ _Since_, 179.
+
+ Singular number, 74.
+
+ _So_, 179.
+
+ Subject, compound, 20.
+ defined, 9, 10.
+ how found, 16.
+ simple, 11.
+ transposed, 22.
+
+ Subjective complement, 67, 68.
+ adjective, 69.
+ infinitive, 213.
+ noun, 67, 69.
+ participle, 144, 145.
+ prepositional phrase, 69.
+
+ Subjunctive mode, 131.
+ conjugation of, 132.
+
+ Subjunctive mode, tenses of, 132.
+
+ Subordinate conjunctions, 176, 177.
+
+ Summary, of adverbs, 173.
+ of case relations, 97.
+ of infinitives, 224, 225.
+ of participles, 243, 244.
+
+ Superlative degree, 116.
+
+
+ Tense, 123.
+ errors in, 125, 126.
+ in noun clauses, 201.
+ primary, 124.
+ secondary, 124.
+ sequence of, 125, 163.
+
+ Term of address, 39.
+
+ _The_, an adverb, 170.
+
+ _There_, 247, 248.
+
+ _Till_, 179.
+
+ Time, clauses of, 180, 181.
+
+ _To_, omitted in infinitives, 217.
+
+ _To_, use of, 37.
+
+ Transitive verbs, 60, 61.
+ followed by indirect object, 90.
+ followed by objective complement, 94.
+ what they denote, 62.
+
+ Transposed order, 22.
+
+
+ _Until_, 179.
+
+ _Used_, in verb phrases, 156.
+
+
+ Verb phrases, 155, 156.
+
+ Verbals, 210, 211.
+
+ Verbs, defective, 154-157.
+ defined, 16.
+ errors in use of, 130, 137-142.
+ intransitive, 64, 66, 67.
+ mode of, 127, 131, 134.
+ parsing of, 150, 168.
+ principal parts of, 135, 137.
+ regular and irregular, 135, 136.
+ review of, 72, 168.
+ tense of, 123-126.
+ transitive, 60, 61.
+ used as interjections, 43.
+ used transitively or intransitively, 64, 66.
+ voice of, 140-142.
+
+ Voice, active and passive, 140.
+ conjugation of passive, 140-142.
+ test for passive, 145.
+
+
+ _With_, 38.
+
+ Words in _-ing_, 240.
+
+ Words used, as adjective or adverb, 59.
+ as adverb or preposition, 60.
+ as noun or adjective, 58.
+ as noun or verb, 58.
+ as preposition, conjunction, or adverb, 179.
+
+ _Would_, as principal verb, 155.
+
+
+ _Yet_, 179.
+
+
+
+*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 76768 ***
diff --git a/76768-h/76768-h.htm b/76768-h/76768-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5680899
--- /dev/null
+++ b/76768-h/76768-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,18125 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html>
+<html lang="en">
+<head>
+ <meta charset="UTF-8">
+ <title>
+ English Grammar | Project Gutenberg
+ </title>
+ <link rel="icon" href="images/cover.jpg" type="image/x-cover">
+ <style>
+
+a {
+ text-decoration: none;
+}
+
+body {
+ margin-left: 10%;
+ margin-right: 10%;
+}
+
+h1,h2,h3 {
+ text-align: center;
+ clear: both;
+}
+
+h2.nobreak {
+ page-break-before: avoid;
+}
+
+hr.chap {
+ margin-top: 2em;
+ margin-bottom: 2em;
+ clear: both;
+ width: 65%;
+ margin-left: 17.5%;
+ margin-right: 17.5%;
+}
+
+div.chapter {
+ page-break-before: always;
+}
+
+ul {
+ list-style-type: none;
+ margin: auto 10%;
+ padding: 0;
+}
+
+li {
+ margin-top: .25em;
+ padding-left: 2em;
+ text-indent: -1em;
+}
+
+li.indx {
+ margin-top: .5em;
+ padding-left: 2em;
+ text-indent: -2em;
+}
+
+li.ifrst {
+ margin-top: 2em;
+ padding-left: 2em;
+ text-indent: -2em;
+}
+
+li.isub1, li.sub1 {
+ padding-left: 4em;
+ text-indent: -2em;
+}
+
+li.sub2 {
+ padding-left: 6em;
+ text-indent: -2em;
+}
+
+li.sub3 {
+ padding-left: 8em;
+ text-indent: -2em;
+}
+
+li.sub4 {
+ padding-left: 10em;
+ text-indent: -2em;
+}
+
+p {
+ margin-top: 0.5em;
+ text-align: justify;
+ margin-bottom: 0.5em;
+ text-indent: 1em;
+}
+
+table {
+ margin: 1em auto 1em auto;
+ max-width: 40em;
+ border-collapse: collapse;
+}
+
+table#contents {
+ max-width: 30em;
+}
+
+#contents td {
+ text-align: justify;
+}
+
+th {
+ padding: 0.25em;
+ font-weight: normal;
+}
+
+td {
+ padding-left: 2.25em;
+ padding-right: 0.25em;
+ vertical-align: top;
+ text-indent: -2em;
+}
+
+.tdr, #contents .tdr {
+ text-align: right;
+}
+
+#contents .tdpg {
+ vertical-align: bottom;
+ text-align: right;
+}
+
+blockquote {
+ margin: auto 10%;
+}
+
+.break {
+ margin-top: 1em;
+}
+
+.center {
+ text-align: center;
+ text-indent: 0;
+}
+
+.footnotes {
+ margin-top: 1em;
+ border: dashed 1px;
+}
+
+.footnote {
+ margin-left: 10%;
+ margin-right: 10%;
+ font-size: 0.9em;
+}
+
+.footnote .label {
+ position: absolute;
+ right: 84%;
+ text-align: right;
+}
+
+.fnanchor {
+ vertical-align: super;
+ font-size: .8em;
+ text-decoration: none;
+}
+
+.noindent {
+ text-indent: 0;
+}
+
+.note {
+ font-size: 90%;
+}
+
+.pagenum {
+ position: absolute;
+ right: 4%;
+ font-size: smaller;
+ text-align: right;
+ font-style: normal;
+}
+
+.poetry-container {
+ text-align: center;
+}
+
+.poetry {
+ display: inline-block;
+ text-align: left;
+}
+
+.poetry .stanza {
+ margin: auto;
+}
+
+.poetry .stanza1 {
+ margin: 1em 0em 1em 0em;
+}
+
+.poetry .verse {
+ padding-left: 3em;
+}
+
+.poetry .indent0 {
+ text-indent: -3em;
+}
+
+.poetry .indent2 {
+ text-indent: -2em;
+}
+
+.right {
+ text-align: right;
+}
+
+.section {
+ margin-top: 2em;
+}
+
+.smaller {
+ font-size: 80%;
+}
+
+.smcap {
+ font-variant: small-caps;
+ font-style: normal;
+}
+
+.titlepage {
+ text-align: center;
+ margin-top: 3em;
+ text-indent: 0;
+}
+
+.x-ebookmaker .poetry {
+ display: block;
+ margin-left: 1.5em;
+}
+
+.x-ebookmaker blockquote {
+ margin: auto 5%;
+}
+
+ </style>
+ </head>
+<body>
+<div style='text-align:center'>*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 76768 ***</div>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_1">[1]</span></p>
+
+<h1>ENGLISH GRAMMAR</h1>
+
+<p class="titlepage">BY<br>
+LILLIAN G. KIMBALL<br>
+<span class="smaller">FORMERLY HEAD OF ENGLISH DEPARTMENT, STATE NORMAL<br>
+SCHOOL, OSHKOSH, WISCONSIN<br>
+AUTHOR OF “THE STRUCTURE OF THE ENGLISH SENTENCE”<br>
+“ELEMENTARY ENGLISH, BOOK ONE,” AND<br>
+“ELEMENTARY ENGLISH, BOOK TWO”</span></p>
+
+<p class="titlepage"><span class="smaller">NEW YORK ·:· CINCINNATI ·:· CHICAGO</span><br>
+AMERICAN BOOK COMPANY</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_2">[2]</span></p>
+
+<p class="titlepage smaller"><span class="smcap">Copyright, 1912, by<br>
+AMERICAN BOOK COMPANY.</span></p>
+
+<p class="center smaller"><span class="smcap">Entered at Stationers’ Hall, London.</span></p>
+
+<p class="center smaller">KIMBALL’S ENG. GRAMMAR.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_3">[3]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="PREFACE">PREFACE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p>The purpose of this book is to set forth in a simple and
+practical manner the principles of modern English Grammar.
+The aim has been not only to give the pupils an insight into
+the structure of the English sentence, but also to provide them
+with exercises helpful to the formation of good habits of
+speech.</p>
+
+<p>It is a matter of common knowledge among teachers of
+grammar that a mere understanding of the rules of syntax
+does not insure the avoidance of errors and the use of correct
+forms. The use of language by young persons is instinctive
+and spontaneous rather than reflective, hence the most effective
+way for them to secure correctness of speech is through imitation
+and practice. Recognizing this fundamental fact in language
+teaching, the author has provided many exercises both
+for the learning of correct forms and for practice in their use.
+These the teacher is expected to supplement by constant criticism,
+example, and stimulus.</p>
+
+<p>After the pupil has been led to appreciate and strive for
+correctness of speech, he naturally wishes to understand why
+a certain form is correct or incorrect, to have a test for his
+own speech and a standard by which to judge the speech of
+others. Only by such an understanding does he gain a mastery
+of the form of a language so that he can use it with ease,
+freedom, and certainty. To promote such a mastery of English,
+the author has made each construction perfectly clear,
+and has led the pupil through accurate reasoning to conclusions
+which are strengthened and established by their application
+to many illustrative sentences chosen from standard literature.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_4">[4]</span></p>
+
+<p>The selection and the arrangement of subject matter have
+been carefully considered in the light of experience in the
+classroom. The arrangement is at the same time pedagogical
+and logical. Each point is taken up where it is called for by
+the preceding lesson and where it will be of greatest use in
+making clear what follows. Technical points that have little
+or no practical value have been omitted, but whatever is of
+benefit in helping the pupil to use or to interpret the English
+language has been included.</p>
+
+<p>Thanks are due to many teachers for helpful criticisms of
+the manuscript of this book.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_5">[5]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="CONTENTS">CONTENTS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<table id="contents">
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr smaller">LESSON</td>
+ <td></td>
+ <td class="tdpg smaller">PAGE</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">I.</td>
+ <td>Declarative Sentences. Subject and Predicate</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#I">9</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">II.</td>
+ <td>Simple Subject. Nouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#II">11</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">III.</td>
+ <td>Classification of Nouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#III">13</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">IV.</td>
+ <td>Verbs</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#IV">15</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">V.</td>
+ <td>Pronouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#V">18</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">VI.</td>
+ <td>Compound Subject and Compound Predicate</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#VI">19</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">VII.</td>
+ <td>Transposed Subject and Predicate</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#VII">22</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">VIII.</td>
+ <td>Interrogative Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#VIII">23</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">IX.</td>
+ <td>Adjectives</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#IX">25</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">X.</td>
+ <td>Adverbs</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#X">28</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XI.</td>
+ <td>Phrases. Analysis of Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XI">31</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XII.</td>
+ <td>Prepositions</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XII">34</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XIII.</td>
+ <td>Term of Address. Exclamatory Noun</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XIII">39</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XIV.</td>
+ <td>Imperative Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XIV">41</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XV.</td>
+ <td>Interjections</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XV">43</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XVI.</td>
+ <td>Exclamatory Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XVI">44</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XVII.</td>
+ <td>Conjunctions</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XVII">46</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XVIII.</td>
+ <td>Clauses. Simple Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XVIII">48</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XIX.</td>
+ <td>Compound Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XIX">50</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XX.</td>
+ <td>Dependent Clauses. Complex Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XX">52</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXI.</td>
+ <td>Review: Classification of Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXI">55</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXII.</td>
+ <td>Review: Parts of Speech</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXII">57</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXIII.</td>
+ <td>Transitive Verbs. Object of Verb</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXIII">60</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXIV.</td>
+ <td>Intransitive Verbs asserting Action</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXIV">64</a><span class="pagenum" id="Page_6">[6]</span></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXV.</td>
+ <td>Intransitive Verbs asserting Being. Nouns as Subjective Complements</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXV">66</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXVI.</td>
+ <td>Adjectives as Subjective Complements</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXVI">69</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXVII.</td>
+ <td>Review of Verbs</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXVII">72</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXVIII.</td>
+ <td>Nouns: Number</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXVIII">74</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXIX.</td>
+ <td>Nouns: Gender</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXIX">77</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXX.</td>
+ <td>Possessive Nouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXX">80</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXXI.</td>
+ <td>Nouns: Case</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXXI">83</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXXII.</td>
+ <td>Nouns: The Appositive</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXXII">85</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXXIII.</td>
+ <td>Appositive Adjectives</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXXIII">88</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXXIV.</td>
+ <td>Indirect Object</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXXIV">89</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXXV.</td>
+ <td>Adverbial Noun Phrases</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXXV">91</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXXVI.</td>
+ <td>Adverbial Noun Phrases</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXXVI">92</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXXVII.</td>
+ <td>Objective Complement</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXXVII">94</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXXVIII.</td>
+ <td>Parsing of Nouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXXVIII">96</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XXXIX.</td>
+ <td>Personal Pronouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XXXIX">98</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XL.</td>
+ <td>Uses of Personal Pronouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XL">100</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XLI.</td>
+ <td>Uses of Possessive Personal Pronouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XLI">103</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XLII.</td>
+ <td>Compound Personal Pronouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XLII">106</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XLIII.</td>
+ <td>Interrogative Pronouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XLIII">108</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XLIV.</td>
+ <td>Descriptive Adjectives</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XLIV">110</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XLV.</td>
+ <td>Limiting Adjectives</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XLV">113</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XLVI.</td>
+ <td>Comparison of Adjectives</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XLVI">116</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XLVII.</td>
+ <td>Review of Adjectives</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XLVII">120</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XLVIII.</td>
+ <td>Adjective Pronouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XLVIII">121</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XLIX.</td>
+ <td>Verbs: Tense</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XLIX">123</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">L.</td>
+ <td>The Indicative Mode</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#L">127</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LI.</td>
+ <td>The Interrogative Form of the Indicative Mode</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LI">129</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LII.</td>
+ <td>The Subjunctive Mode</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LII">131</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LIII.</td>
+ <td>The Imperative Mode</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LIII">134</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LIV.</td>
+ <td>Principal Parts of Verbs. Regular and Irregular Verbs</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LIV">135</a><span class="pagenum" id="Page_7">[7]</span></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LV.</td>
+ <td>Voice</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LV">140</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LVI.</td>
+ <td>The Passive Voice</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LVI">144</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LVII.</td>
+ <td>The Progressive Conjugation</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LVII">148</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LVIII.</td>
+ <td>The Emphatic Conjugation</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LVIII">149</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LIX.</td>
+ <td>Parsing of Verbs</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LIX">150</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LX.</td>
+ <td>The Auxiliary Verbs <i>Shall</i> and <i>Will</i></td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LX">151</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXI.</td>
+ <td>Defective Verbs. Verb Phrases</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXI">154</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXII.</td>
+ <td>Direct and Indirect Discourse</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXII">162</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXIII.</td>
+ <td>Agreement of Verb and Subject. Collective Nouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXIII">165</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXIV.</td>
+ <td>Review of Verbs</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXIV">168</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXV.</td>
+ <td>Classification of Adverbs. Simple Adverbs</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXV">169</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXVI.</td>
+ <td>Conjunctive Adverbs</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXVI">171</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXVII.</td>
+ <td>Summary of Adverbs</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXVII">173</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXVIII.</td>
+ <td>Coördinate Conjunctions</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXVIII">174</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXIX.</td>
+ <td>Subordinate Conjunctions</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXIX">176</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXX.</td>
+ <td>Adverbial Clauses of Time, Place, and Manner</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXX">180</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXI.</td>
+ <td>Adverbial Clauses of Cause, Purpose, and Result</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXI">183</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXII.</td>
+ <td>Adverbial Clauses of Condition and Concession</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXII">186</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXIII.</td>
+ <td>Adverbial Clauses of Comparison</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXIII">188</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXIV.</td>
+ <td>Analysis of Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXIV">191</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXV.</td>
+ <td>Adjective Clauses</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXV">193</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXVI.</td>
+ <td>Relative Pronouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXVI">196</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXVII.</td>
+ <td>Noun Clauses</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXVII">200</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXVIII.</td>
+ <td>Introductory Words of Noun Clauses</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXVIII">203</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXIX.</td>
+ <td>Review of Clauses</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXIX">206</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXX.</td>
+ <td>Review of Pronouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXX">207</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXXI.</td>
+ <td>Infinitives</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXXI">209</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXXII.</td>
+ <td>Infinitives as Subjects or Complements</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXXII">212</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXXIII.</td>
+ <td>Infinitives as Modifiers of Nouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXXIII">215</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXXIV.</td>
+ <td>Infinitives as Parts of “Double Objects.” As Modifiers of Verbs</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXXIV">216</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXXV.</td>
+ <td>Other Uses of Infinitives</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXXV">220</a><span class="pagenum" id="Page_8">[8]</span></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXXVI.</td>
+ <td>Summary of Infinitives</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXXVI">224</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXXVII.</td>
+ <td>Analysis of Sentences containing Infinitive Phrases</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXXVII">225</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXXVIII.</td>
+ <td>Participles</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXXVIII">228</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">LXXXIX.</td>
+ <td>Participles modifying Nouns</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#LXXXIX">231</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XC.</td>
+ <td>Participial Phrases in the Predicate</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XC">234</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XCI.</td>
+ <td>Absolute Participial Phrases</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XCI">237</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XCII.</td>
+ <td>Agreement of Participles. Other Words in <i>-ing</i></td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XCII">239</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XCIII.</td>
+ <td>Summary of Participles</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XCIII">243</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XCIV.</td>
+ <td>Analysis of Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XCIV">244</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XCV.</td>
+ <td>Anticipative Subject</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XCV">247</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XCVI.</td>
+ <td>Elliptical Sentences</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XCVI">249</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdr">XCVII.</td>
+ <td>Review of Analysis</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#XCVII">252</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td colspan="2">General Review</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#GENERAL_REVIEW">257</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td colspan="2">Index</td>
+ <td class="tdpg"><a href="#INDEX">265</a></td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_9">[9]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="I">I. DECLARATIVE SENTENCES. SUBJECT AND PREDICATE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section1"><b>1.</b> The purpose of English Grammar is to set forth the
+laws and customs governing the use of the English language.
+We study grammar in order that we may express our thoughts
+correctly.</p>
+
+<p>A group of words, sometimes few, sometimes many, that
+completely expresses a thought is called a <b>sentence</b>. In
+speech one sentence is set off from another by a slight pause.
+On the written or printed page sentences are separated from
+each other by a slight space, while the first word of every
+sentence begins with a capital letter, and the last word is
+followed by some sort of terminal mark.</p>
+
+<p>Most sentences are made to state, or declare, something,
+and hence are called <b>declarative</b> sentences. The following
+are declarative sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Molly danced up and down with delight.</p>
+
+<p>My grandfather’s desk had the best light in the room.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section2"><b>2.</b> Declarative sentences consist of two distinct parts.
+One part names the person, place, or thing which the sentence
+tells something about. This part is called the subject.
+The other part is the telling part. It is called the predicate.</p>
+
+<p>In the first example <i>Molly</i> is the subject, because it names
+the person about whom something is told. <i>Danced up and
+down with delight</i> is the predicate, because it tells something
+about Molly.</p>
+
+<p>What is the subject in the second example? the predicate?
+How do you know? What terminal mark follows a declarative
+sentence?</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_10">[10]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>sentence</b> is a group of words that completely
+expresses a thought.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>declarative sentence</b> is one that states, or declares, something.</p>
+
+<p>A declarative sentence is always followed by a period.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>subject</b> of a sentence is the part which names that
+about which something is said.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>predicate</b> of a sentence is the part which says something
+about the subject.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Tell why each of the following sentences is
+declarative. Select the subject, and tell why it is the subject.
+Select the predicate, and tell why it is the predicate. Tell all
+this in good language. Write it about one of the sentences,
+and be sure to underline the words that should be printed
+in italics. (See <a href="#section2">§ 2</a>.) Remember that all the words in the
+sentence belong either in the subject or in the predicate.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The village street was as quiet as the fields.</p>
+
+<p>2. The great crashes of deep bass notes sent little thrills down
+our backs.</p>
+
+<p>3. The cat could not find anything to eat except a thin, dried-up
+old mole.</p>
+
+<p>4. Little gray-eyed Caroline went to live with her Aunt Fogg.</p>
+
+<p>5. The traveler, being quite faint for lack of food, helped himself
+to the leg of a roast chicken.</p>
+
+<p>6. Four is the right number for a pie.</p>
+
+<p>7. A young girl of wonderful beauty lay asleep on the bed.</p>
+
+<p>8. Mary shut the parlor door with a great slam.</p>
+
+<p>9. Beauty, full of surprise but very happy, permitted the prince
+to lead her to his palace.</p>
+
+<p>10. The magic song still rose from the vines outside the chamber
+window.</p>
+
+<p>11. We cats are confined entirely to the society of each other.</p>
+
+<p>12. The glassy water was sparkling with stars.</p>
+
+<p>13. Locusts devoured the green things of the valley.</p>
+
+<p>14. Not a living soul was to be seen.</p>
+
+<p>15. My little half-starved cat grew white and plump and pretty.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_11">[11]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Find five interesting declarative sentences
+in a story book. Write them with the subject underlined.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 3.</b>—Write a fitting predicate for each of the following
+subjects:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. A boy with a fish pole</p>
+
+<p>2. Abraham Lincoln</p>
+
+<p>3. My last dime</p>
+
+<p>4. The man on the ice wagon</p>
+
+<p>5. Our old white rooster</p>
+
+<p>6. Not a girl in the class</p>
+
+<p>7. The battered old musket</p>
+
+<p>8. The haymakers</p>
+
+<p>9. The miner’s cabin</p>
+
+<p>10. Moving picture shows</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="II">II. SIMPLE SUBJECT. NOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section3"><b>3.</b> It is evident from the sentences in Exercise 1, <a href="#Page_10">p. 10</a>, that
+the subject of a sentence may consist of one word or of a
+group of words. In the sentence, “Peter was sitting by
+himself,” the subject is only the one word <i>Peter</i>. In the
+sentence, “A lovely old lady with white hair and a gentle,
+noble face came to the door,” the subject is a group of twelve
+words. What are they?</p>
+
+<p>When the subject of a sentence is a group of words, there is
+always a base word in the group, which, more than any other
+word, names or designates the person, place, or thing about
+which something is said. This word is called the simple
+subject.</p>
+
+<p>What is the simple subject in the sentence that tells who
+came to the door? What are the simple subjects in sentences
+1, 2, 5, 7, 12, 14, and 15 in Exercise 1, <a href="#Page_10">p. 10</a>?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section4"><b>4.</b> Every word in a sentence is used for a particular purpose.
+Because words are used for different purposes they
+have been divided into classes called <b>parts of speech</b>.</p>
+
+<p>In the sentences just studied the words <i>Peter</i> and <i>lady</i> are
+used to name certain persons. Name words are called
+nouns. A noun is a part of speech.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_12">[12]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section5"><b>5.</b> Not every noun is the name of a person. Many are
+names of places; as, <i>Oshkosh</i>, <i>pasture</i>, <i>corner</i>. Many more
+are names of things of all sorts; as, <i>peach</i>, <i>violet</i>, <i>bee</i>, <i>thimble</i>,
+<i>automobile</i>.</p>
+
+<p>In the sentence about the lovely old lady, find three nouns
+that are names of things.</p>
+
+<p>Any noun may be used as the simple subject of a sentence.
+Write sentences in which the nouns <i>hair</i>, <i>face</i>, and <i>door</i> are
+so used.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The <b>simple subject</b> of a sentence is the base
+word, or most important word, of the subject.</p>
+
+<p><b>Parts of speech</b> are the classes into which words are divided
+according to their use.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>noun</b> is a name word.</p>
+
+<p>A noun may be used as the simple subject of a sentence.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Write a list of all the nouns you can find in
+the following paragraphs. Tell what each noun is the name
+of. Point out five nouns that are simple subjects. What
+are their predicates?</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. At last Purun Dass went to England on a visit, and had to pay
+enormous sums to the priests when he came back to India; for even
+so high-caste a Brahmin as he lost caste by crossing the black sea.
+In London he met and talked with every one worth knowing—men
+whose names go all over the world—and saw a great deal more
+than he said. He was given honorary degrees by learned universities,
+and he made speeches and talked of Hindu social reform to
+English ladies in evening dress, till all London cried, “This is the
+most fascinating man we have ever met at dinner since cloths were
+first laid.”</p>
+
+<p>2. Her godmother laughed, and touched Cinderella also with the
+wand; at which her wretched, threadbare jacket became stiff with
+gold, and sparkling with jewels; her woolen petticoat lengthened
+into a gown of sweeping satin, from underneath which peeped out her
+little feet, no longer bare, but covered with silk stockings and the
+prettiest glass slippers in the world. “Now, Cinderella, depart;
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_13">[13]</span>but remember, if you stay one instant after midnight, your carriage
+will become a pumpkin, your coachman a rat, your horses mice, and
+your footmen lizards; while you yourself will be the little cinder
+wench you were an hour ago.”</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="III">III. CLASSIFICATION OF NOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section6"><b>6.</b> There are certain beings in the world that are called
+men, and certain other beings that are called horses, certain
+things that are called cities, and certain other things
+that are called rivers, hence the words <i>man</i>, <i>horse</i>, <i>city</i>,
+and <i>river</i> are names, or nouns. Since these nouns belong in
+common to a great many individuals, we call them <b>common
+nouns</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section7"><b>7.</b> On the other hand, every man, every horse, every city,
+and every river is likely to have a <i>special</i> name that distinguishes
+that particular man or horse or city or river from all
+others. <i>Cæsar</i>, <i>Gypsy</i>, <i>Denver</i>, and <i>Penobscot</i> are such
+names. Since these names belong to only one thing instead
+of to a class of things, we call them <b>proper nouns</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section8"><b>8.</b> A common noun is a name that belongs to a person,
+a place, or a thing because of its nature or qualities. A
+boat is entitled to the name <i>boat</i> because it has the characteristics
+of boats. A proper noun is a name conferred or
+given by some person, as when a certain boat was named by
+its owners <i>Westernland</i>.</p>
+
+<p>It sometimes happens that the same name is conferred
+upon several objects. There is more than one city named
+Madison, more than one dog named Shep. Still these names
+are proper names, because they are names conferred upon
+a special city and a special dog to distinguish them from
+other cities and other dogs.</p>
+
+<p>A proper noun always begins with a capital letter.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_14">[14]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section9"><b>9.</b> When a word denoting relationship, like <i>father</i>, <i>mother</i>,
+<i>uncle</i>, is used as the name of a particular person, it is a proper
+noun and should therefore begin with a capital letter; as,
+“Did Father say that Grandma and Auntie are coming?”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section10"><b>10.</b> A title like <i>Colonel</i>, <i>Judge</i>, <i>Duke</i>, is a proper noun when
+it is used to denote a special person; as, “Thousands had
+gathered to welcome the Colonel home.” When such a
+word is the name of a class of persons, it is a common noun;
+as, “A new uniform was designed for the colonels.”</p>
+
+<p>When a title is followed by another name, as, <i>Colonel
+Bouck</i>, <i>Judge Gary</i>, the two words are considered as one
+proper noun. In the same way, any group of two or more
+words forming one special name may be considered as one
+proper noun; as, <i>Liberty Bell</i>, <i>Bay of Biscay</i>, <i>Mountains of
+the Moon</i>. In such groups of words, each important word
+begins with a capital letter.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—Names of qualities, conditions, or actions are often called
+<b>abstract nouns</b>; as, <i>honesty</i>, <i>power</i>, <i>boyhood</i>, the <i>passing</i> of the train,
+sound <i>thinking</i>, <i>suspense</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>common noun</b> is a noun that belongs in
+common to each one of a class of persons, places, or things.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>proper noun</b> is a name that has been conferred upon a
+particular person, place, or thing.</p>
+
+<p>Every proper noun should begin with a capital letter.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the nouns in the following sentences,
+and tell whether they are common or proper nouns. Give
+your reason in each case. Account for the capitalization.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The Bermudas are a cluster of small islands, lying as far
+south as Charleston, as far east as Nova Scotia.</p>
+
+<p>2. Hotel Hamilton is a large, commodious building with many
+pillars and broad verandas.</p>
+
+<p>3. The <i>Tenedos</i> is lying off Grassy Bay, making herself fine
+to receive the Princess Louise, and her jolly tars are in high
+spirits.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_15">[15]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. On the Sunday of the christening, Mrs. Howe and her children
+watched the merrymaking in Poverty Lane from a second
+story window.</p>
+
+<p>5. Where was Prospero’s cell? Where slept the fair Miranda?
+Upon what bank sat Ferdinand when Ariel sang?</p>
+
+<p>6. The Duluth High School is a fine structure built of red
+sandstone.</p>
+
+<p>7. The <i>Deliverance</i> was a ship of eighty tons.</p>
+
+<p>8. Old Lobo, or the King, as the Mexicans called him, was the
+gigantic leader of a remarkable pack of gray wolves, that had ravaged
+the Currumpaw Valley for a number of years.</p>
+
+<p>9. About this time I met with an odd volume of the <i>Spectator</i>.</p>
+
+<p>10.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Wynken, Blynken, and Nod one night</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Sailed off in a wooden shoe.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>11. Let us all go to the station Monday to meet Uncle.</p>
+
+<p>12.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The cows were coming one by one;</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Brindle, Ebony, Speckle, and Bess,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Shaking their horns in the evening wind.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>13. Gunpowder had been a favorite steed of his master’s, the
+choleric Van Ripper, who was a furious rider.</p>
+
+<p>14. Upstream, at the bend of the sluggish pool round the Peace
+Rock, stood Hathi, the wild elephant, with his sons, gaunt and gray
+in the moonlight.</p>
+
+<p>15. In his eighth year Charles Lamb entered Christ’s Hospital,
+a famous school in London.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>It is evident from this exercise that several different sorts
+of things, as hotels, streets, books, and ships, may have
+special names conferred upon them. Think of ten other
+things that may have special names, and write two names
+for each one.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="IV">IV. VERBS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section11"><b>11.</b> Just as the subject of a sentence may consist of only
+one word, so may the predicate. Hence it is that a declarative
+sentence may contain only two words, one being the subject
+and the other the predicate; as in the sentence, “Water
+runs.” Here the noun <i>water</i> names the thing about which something
+is told, and the word <i>runs</i> tells something about water.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_16">[16]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section12"><b>12.</b> In every predicate, no matter how long it is, there is
+always one word, or a little group of words, which does more
+of the telling than all the rest of the predicate. In fact, without
+this word or group of words, there would be no statement
+at all. In the sentence, “A red sash with fringes of gold
+wraps his waist several times,” the predicate consists of five
+words, but the one word that counts for most in making the
+statement is the word <i>wraps</i>. This word is called a verb.
+A verb is a part of speech.</p>
+
+<p>A verb, being the essential part of a predicate, is called
+the <b>simple predicate</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section13"><b>13.</b> Sometimes a verb consists of two, or three, or even
+four words. What is the verb in each of the following
+sentences?—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>All the cherries had been picked from the trees near the house.</p>
+
+<p>The watchman on the roof was listening for the first sounds of
+day.</p>
+
+<p>A tall, dark figure might have been seen at the end of the avenue.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section14"><b>14.</b> When the verb in a given sentence has been found, the
+subject may be discovered by asking the question formed by
+placing the word <i>who</i> or <i>what</i> before the verb. For example,
+in the sentence, “The parrot’s story, with the various
+pauses and interruptions, occupied a good deal of time,”
+<i>occupied</i> is the verb because it is the telling word. Asking
+the question <i>what occupied</i>? we get the answer, <i>the
+parrot’s story, with the various pauses and interruptions</i>,
+hence this group of words is the subject. What is the simple
+subject?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section15"><b>15.</b> In grammar we often use the word <i>assertion</i> instead of
+<i>statement</i>, and the word <i>assert</i> instead of <i>make a statement</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>verb</b> is an asserting word.</p>
+
+<p>A verb may consist of one word, two, three, or four words,
+but never of more than four words.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_17">[17]</span></p>
+
+<p>A verb is the necessary part of every predicate, hence it is
+called the <b>simple predicate</b>.</p>
+
+<p>To find the subject of a verb, ask the question made by
+using the word <i>who</i> or <i>what</i> before the verb.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Divide the following sentences into subject
+and predicate. Select the predicate verb, and tell why it is a
+verb. Find the simple subject of each sentence. Tell what
+part of speech it is, and why.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The procession moved from the palace to the church with
+great pomp.</p>
+
+<p>2. The blue eyes of the Greek sparkled.</p>
+
+<p>3. The magnificent buildings of the hospital stand on level
+land near the river.</p>
+
+<p>4. The gentle young bride was frightened by the silent, mysterious
+ways of the old Indian.</p>
+
+<p>5.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The poorest twig on the elm tree</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Was ridged inch deep with pearl.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>6. The great hall of the palace was illuminated with a thousand
+lamps.</p>
+
+<p>7. His anvil makes no music on Sunday.</p>
+
+<p>8. The raccoon’s story was received with general approbation.</p>
+
+<p>9. This old hunter must have told many tales.</p>
+
+<p>10. Our conference under the peepul tree had been growing
+noisier and noisier.</p>
+
+<p>11. One great name can make a country great.</p>
+
+<p>12. The camels slept.</p>
+
+<p>13. No European could have made five miles a day over the
+ice rubbish and the sharp-edged drifts.</p>
+
+<p>14. The cows should have been milked before sundown.</p>
+
+<p>15.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The deep waters of the bay</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Stir with the breath of hurrying day.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>16. Wully could not have imagined any greater being than his
+master.</p>
+
+<p>17. Everything out of doors was sheathed in silver mail.</p>
+
+<p>18. The duck mother would have liked the eel’s head herself.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>In sentence 18 is <i>herself</i> in the subject or in the predicate?</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_18">[18]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="V">V. PRONOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section16"><b>16.</b> When a person makes an assertion about himself he
+uses for the subject of his sentence, not his name, but the
+word <i>I</i> instead. Will Dunlap does not say, “Will Dunlap
+saw a flock of wild geese this morning, and heard them too.”
+He says, “I saw a flock of wild geese this morning, and heard
+them too.” The word <i>I</i>, which is used instead of a name, or
+noun, is called a <b>pronoun</b>. A pronoun is a part of speech.</p>
+
+<p>What pronoun besides <i>I</i> do you find in the sentence
+quoted? For what noun is it used?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section17"><b>17.</b> Pronouns are used a good deal, especially in conversation,
+for often instead of using the name of the person we
+are speaking to, we use the pronoun <i>you</i>; and in speaking <i>of</i>
+persons, we use, provided their names are already known to
+our listeners, the pronouns <i>he</i>, <i>she</i>, or <i>they</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>pronoun</b> is a word used instead of a noun.</p>
+
+<p>A pronoun can be the subject of a sentence.</p>
+
+<p>By the use of pronouns we avoid the repetition of nouns
+and the use of clumsy expressions.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—In the following conversation select all the
+pronouns. Rewrite a portion of the conversation, using the
+nouns that the pronouns stand for. In changing pronouns
+to nouns it is sometimes necessary to make a change in the
+verb also. After using nouns for pronouns, tell what you
+think about the usefulness of pronouns.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>“What do you think, Tirzah? I am going away.”</p>
+
+<p>Tirzah dropped her hands with amazement.</p>
+
+<p>“Going away! When? Where? For what?”</p>
+
+<p>Judah laughed, then said, “Three questions, all in a breath. What
+a body you are!” Next instant he became serious. “You know the
+law requires me to follow some occupation. Our good father set me
+an example. Even you would despise me if I spent in idleness the
+results of his industry and knowledge. I am going to Rome.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_19">[19]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Oh, I will go with you.”</p>
+
+<p>“You must stay with Mother. If both of us leave her, she will
+die.”</p>
+
+<p>The brightness faded from her face.</p>
+
+<p>“Ah, yes, yes! But—must you go? Here in Jerusalem you
+can learn all that is needed to be a merchant—if that is what you
+are thinking of.”</p>
+
+<p>“But that is not what I am thinking of. The law does not require
+the son to be what the father was.”</p>
+
+<p>“What else can you be?”</p>
+
+<p>“A soldier,” he replied, with a certain pride of voice.</p>
+
+<p>Tears came into her eyes.</p>
+
+<p>“You will be killed.”</p>
+
+<p>“If God’s will, be it so. But, Tirzah, the soldiers are not all
+killed.”</p>
+
+<p>She threw her arms around his neck, as if to hold him back.</p>
+
+<p>“We are so happy! Stay at home, my brother.”</p>
+
+<p>“Home cannot always be what it is. You yourself will be going
+away before long.”</p>
+
+<p>“Never!”</p>
+
+<p>He smiled at her earnestness.</p>
+
+<p>“A prince will come soon and claim my Tirzah, and ride away
+with her, to be the light of another house.”</p>
+
+<p>She answered with sobs.</p>
+
+<p>“War is a trade,” he continued, more soberly. “To learn it thoroughly,
+one must go to school, and there is no school like a Roman
+camp.”</p>
+
+<p class="right">—<span class="smcap">Lew Wallace.</span></p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="VI">VI. COMPOUND SUBJECT AND COMPOUND PREDICATE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section18"><b>18.</b> It frequently happens that a person performs several
+actions at the same time, and that all of them are worth
+telling. In such a case we do not make several separate
+sentences, but one sentence with several predicates; as,
+“I looked at my plate and winked back the tears.” Here
+we have two predicate verbs, <i>looked</i> and <i>winked</i>, hence two
+assertions. In such a sentence we say that there is a <b>compound
+predicate</b>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_20">[20]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section19"><b>19.</b> The compound predicate is used also when we tell of
+a number of actions performed in succession by one subject;
+as, “Father Wolf woke up from his day’s rest, scratched himself,
+yawned, and spread out his paws one after the other to
+get rid of the sleepy feeling in the tips.” How many predicates
+are there in this sentence? What mark separates
+them? Two or more predicates in succession, having the
+same subject, form what is called a <b>series</b>. Words or groups
+of words in a series are separated from each other by the
+comma unless some joining word is used; but when only the
+last two of a series are joined by some word, the comma is
+used before this word.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section20"><b>20.</b> We frequently wish to make the same assertion about
+several persons or things, but we do not make several sentences,
+repeating the predicate each time, for that would be
+tedious. Instead, we make one sentence with several subjects;
+as, “The fresh fruit and milk and the slices of cold
+chicken looked very nice.” This sentence has three distinct
+subjects. What are they? In such a sentence we say that
+there is a <b>compound subject</b>. Why is no comma used in this
+sentence?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>compound subject</b> is one that consists of
+two or more distinct subjects united into one.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>compound predicate</b> is one that consists of two or more
+distinct predicates united into one.</p>
+
+<p>Two parts of a compound predicate are separated from each
+other by a comma unless they are very short. When there
+are more than two parts, and the last two are joined by some
+such word as <i>and</i>, a comma is placed after each part, even
+before the joining word.</p>
+
+<p>When a compound subject consists of more than two parts,
+a comma is placed after each part, unless all the parts are
+joined by some word.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_21">[21]</span></p>
+
+<p>Any sentence may have a compound subject, or a compound
+predicate, or both.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Tell why the following sentences are declarative.
+Tell whether each has a compound subject, or a compound
+predicate, or both. Write each sentence, and draw
+a vertical line between subject and predicate. Underline
+the simple subjects, and tell what part of speech they are.
+Underline also the simple predicates, or predicate verbs.
+Account for the punctuation.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The oars dipped, arose, poised a moment, then dipped again,
+with winglike action, and in perfect time.</p>
+
+<p>2. The eyes and mouths of the auditors opened wide.</p>
+
+<p>3. This poor child became the scapegoat of the house, and was
+blamed for everything.</p>
+
+<p>4. The four cane-seated chairs, the walnut table, the haircloth
+sofa, and the little stand always spoke to me of my childhood days.</p>
+
+<p>5. She took the key bravely, but opened with a trembling hand
+the door of the little room.</p>
+
+<p>6. Such timber and such workmanship don’t come together
+often in houses built nowadays.</p>
+
+<p>7. Vast crowds of spectators lined the way, or gazed upon the
+scene from the housetops.</p>
+
+<p>8. The rider then put his foot upon the camel’s slender neck,
+and stepped upon the sand.</p>
+
+<p>9. The laborers paused, sat up, wrung the water from their
+hands, and returned the salutation.</p>
+
+<p>10. The statue of the Indian chief or the soldiers’ monument
+in the public square was given to the city by one of the pioneers.</p>
+
+<p>11. Spruce bachelors looked sidelong at the pretty maidens, and
+fancied that the Sabbath sunshine made them prettier than on week
+days.</p>
+
+<p>12. Grandmothers, mothers, and aunts sat across the end of the
+hall.</p>
+
+<p>13. He brought a carpet or square rug from the litter, and
+covered the floor of the tent on the side from the sun.</p>
+
+<p>14. Children with bright faces tripped merrily beside their
+parents, or mimicked a graver gait in the conscious dignity of their
+Sunday clothes.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_22">[22]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="VII">VII. TRANSPOSED SUBJECT AND PREDICATE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section21"><b>21.</b> The sentences studied thus far have been arranged so
+that the subject comes first, then the predicate. This is
+called the <b>natural order</b>. Sometimes, for the sake of emphasis,
+we reverse this order, as in the sentence, “In a
+long shed behind the church stood a score of wagons and
+chaises and carryalls.” This is called the <b>transposed order</b>.</p>
+
+<p>Sometimes, for the sake of a pleasing arrangement, we put
+only a portion of the predicate before the subject, as in the
+sentence, “Over the highest peaks a vulture sailed on broad
+wings into widening circles.” Here the subject is very
+short and the predicate very long. The sentence balances
+better with a portion of the predicate coming first. This
+also is a case of transposed order.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The <b>natural</b> order in a sentence is first the
+subject and then the predicate.</p>
+
+<p>When the words of a sentence are not in their natural
+order, we say that the sentence is <b>transposed</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Rearrange the following sentences so that
+they will be in the natural order, then proceed as you did
+with the sentences in the exercise on <a href="#Page_21">p. 21</a>. Tell in each case
+whether you like the natural or the transposed order better,
+and why.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Around him, within hand’s reach, lie osier boxes full of almonds,
+grapes, figs, and pomegranates.</p>
+
+<p>2. This challenge Fortunatus accepted.</p>
+
+<p>3. On traveled the lady and the bull through many dreadful
+forests and lonely wastes.</p>
+
+<p>4. On that first Christmas morning in their own home, the children
+found their gifts in little piles on two of the parlor chairs.</p>
+
+<p>5. Through the wide nostrils the camel drank the wind in great
+draughts.</p>
+
+<p>6. Out of the wide hall could be heard in the stillness the old
+clock.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_23">[23]</span></p>
+
+<p>7. At full speed a genuine Syrian dromedary overtakes the ordinary
+winds.</p>
+
+<p>8. Very hard Johnny worked on the house.</p>
+
+<p>9. “Come in,” said a warm, comfortable voice on the other side
+of the door.</p>
+
+<p>10.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Down will come Baby,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Bough, cradle, and all.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>11. In the garret meet together all the broken-down chairs of
+the household, all the spavined tables, all the seedy hats, all the
+intoxicated-looking boots, all the split walking sticks that have
+retired from business, “weary with the march of life.”</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Account for the commas in sentences 10 and 11.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Change the following sentences to the transposed
+order. Tell why you like them better so.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Pussy walked along with a slow and deliberate gait directly
+behind my sister and me.</p>
+
+<p>2. A red rose, a yellow rose, a woodbine, and a clematis grew up
+the four walls.</p>
+
+<p>3. The roll of the drum was hushed at the old man’s word and
+outstretched arm.</p>
+
+<p>4. A mat of long, uncombed hair hangs over his eyes and face,
+and down his back.</p>
+
+<p>5. The whole carpet came out right on my head.</p>
+
+<p>6. A little rabbit sat on a bank one morning.</p>
+
+<p>7. Daylight and safety were on the other side of that door.</p>
+
+<p>8. The bird flew on and on, up the steep mountain.</p>
+
+<p>9. A very amusing thing in this story comes now.</p>
+
+<p>10. The remains of a great elephant have been found in the curious
+potholes near Cohoes, New York.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="VIII">VIII. INTERROGATIVE SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section22"><b>22.</b> Most of the sentences in books are declarative sentences,
+written to make statements, but in speech we frequently
+make use of another kind of sentence, one that asks
+a question; as, “Do you know how to tell a sheep’s age?”
+This is called an <b>interrogative</b> sentence.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_24">[24]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section23"><b>23.</b> The interrogative sentence, “What dwarfs made that
+armor?” is in the natural order, but this is not the usual
+order in interrogative sentences. In the sentence, “Do you
+know how to tell a sheep’s age?” we find first a part of the
+verb, then the subject, then the other part of the verb and
+the rest of the predicate. How would this sentence read if
+it were in the natural order? Would it then be an interrogative
+sentence?</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—Since an interrogative sentence does not make a statement,
+it may seem strange to define the verb in such a sentence as
+an asserting word, but in making definitions we must think of the
+fundamental nature and the typical use of what we are defining.
+The primary office of the verb is to assert, as in declarative sentences;
+hence, we define the verb as an asserting word, though it may also
+be used in asking questions.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>interrogative sentence</b> is one that asks
+a question.</p>
+
+<p>An interrogative sentence is usually in the transposed
+order, and is always followed by a question mark.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Tell whether the following sentences are in
+the natural or the transposed order. Put into the natural
+order those which are transposed. Divide each sentence
+into subject and predicate. Select the simple subject and
+the predicate verb, or simple predicate.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Did you ever hear of a cat’s playing hide and seek?</p>
+
+<p>2. What became of you after the Princess’s death?</p>
+
+<p>3. Will no other diet serve you but poor Jack?</p>
+
+<p>4. Which flower does your mother like best?</p>
+
+<p>5. What harm can a naked frog do us?</p>
+
+<p>6. Will the town crier tell us of an auction, or of a lost pocket-book,
+or of a show of beautiful wax figures, or of some monstrous
+beast more horrible than any in the caravan?</p>
+
+<p>7. Why did no smile of welcome brighten upon his face?</p>
+
+<p>8. What did Peterson-Sahib mean by the elephant dance?</p>
+
+<p>9. How many people have ever come to know a wild animal?</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_25">[25]</span></p>
+
+<p>10. What important business made you late to dinner?</p>
+
+<p>11. What plant we in this apple tree?</p>
+
+<p>12. What other man would have discovered so many virtues
+under so mean a dress?</p>
+
+<p>13. What do people fish for in this country?</p>
+
+<p>14.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Does that star-spangled banner yet wave</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">O’er the land of the free, and the home of the brave?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>15. Where did you get your eyes so blue?</p>
+
+<p>16. Who will exchange old lamps for new ones?</p>
+
+<p>17. What makes your cheek like a warm, white rose?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="IX">IX. ADJECTIVES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section24"><b>24.</b> From the sentence, “The road led us to a gate, and
+that to a dooryard and a house,” we get a picture, but it is
+neither definite nor attractive. Contrast it with the picture
+that we get from this sentence, “The pleasant, elm-shaded
+road led us to a rustic gate, and that to a green dooryard,
+and a long, low, brown house.” The difference is caused
+by the descriptive words in the second sentence. Which
+words describe the road? the gate? the dooryard? the
+house?</p>
+
+<p>These descriptive words go with nouns, and describe the
+object named by the noun. We call them <b>adjectives</b>. An
+adjective is a part of speech.</p>
+
+<p>Adjectives are said to <b>modify</b> the nouns they go with, and
+are called <b>modifiers</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section25"><b>25.</b> Most adjectives describe objects by telling size, shape,
+color, texture, or other qualities. A few adjectives tell
+number or amount; as, <i>five</i> minutes, <i>much</i> patience. A
+few merely point out; as, <i>this</i> meadow, <i>next</i> Christmas.
+The words <i>a</i>, <i>an</i>, and <i>the</i> are adjectives.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section26"><b>26.</b> When several adjectives modify the same noun, they
+form a series, and are usually separated from each other by
+commas; as, “A hollow, booming, ominous cry rang out
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_26">[26]</span>suddenly, and startled the dark edges of the forest.” In
+such a sentence as this, “Four little old French ladies rose to
+dance the minuet,” no commas should be used, because the
+adjectives modify more than the noun <i>ladies</i>. <i>Four</i> modifies
+<i>little old French ladies</i>; <i>little</i> modifies <i>old French ladies</i>; <i>old</i>
+modifies <i>French ladies</i>; and <i>French</i> modifies <i>ladies</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section27"><b>27.</b> Sometimes adjectives modify a pronoun instead of a
+noun, as in the sentence, “Tom missed the word, and I,
+happy and triumphant, took his place at the head.” How
+do we know that the adjectives <i>happy</i> and <i>triumphant</i>
+modify the pronoun <i>I</i>?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>adjective</b> is a word used to point out or
+describe an object and modify a noun or a pronoun.</p>
+
+<p>Adjectives usually precede the nouns they modify but
+follow the pronouns.</p>
+
+<p>When several adjectives modify a single noun, they are
+separated by commas.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>modifier</b> is a word or a group of words that goes with
+another word to affect its meaning.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Select all the adjectives in the following
+sentences, and tell what they modify. Account for the
+punctuation.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. On another side stood an old piano, a tinkling, rattling, merrymaking
+old piano, played by a young lady with a melancholy smile.</p>
+
+<p>2. In the dark valley that ran down to a little river, Father
+Wolf heard the dry, angry, snarly, singsong whine of a tiger.</p>
+
+<p>3. A small girl, with twinkling eyes and a merry face, got up
+and made her way to the front.</p>
+
+<p>4. Only loving fingers could have taken those tiny, even stitches.</p>
+
+<p>5. Charles carried water for the circus men, while I, scornful
+and lazy but envious, sat on the fence and watched him.</p>
+
+<p>6. Mammy Tittleback is a splendid, great tortoise-shell cat.</p>
+
+<p>7. I found myself sinking into some horrible, soft, slimy, sticky
+substance.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_27">[27]</span></p>
+
+<p>8. Few ships come to Rivermouth now.</p>
+
+<p>9. Cæsar has one of the finest, deepest-toned voices I ever heard.</p>
+
+<p>10. You can speak and smile cheerfully while you are enjoying
+every comfort of a snug, warm fireside, but you should not expect
+us, hungry, wet, and cold, to be in the same cheerful mood.</p>
+
+<p>11. Suddenly the church clock tolled a deep, dull, hollow, melancholy
+“one.”</p>
+
+<p>12. The next best thing to cold potato and cream is cold roast
+chicken, and occasionally I found a good fat drumstick or a curling
+neck from whose corrugated bones I nibbled savory morsels.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Write sentences using the following words
+as adjectives. Make your sentences such that they reveal
+the meaning of the adjectives.</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>awkward</li>
+ <li>brilliant</li>
+ <li>clammy</li>
+ <li>false</li>
+ <li>glassy</li>
+ <li>graceful</li>
+ <li>greedy</li>
+ <li>huge</li>
+ <li>mild</li>
+ <li>moist</li>
+ <li>pathetic</li>
+ <li>shaggy</li>
+ <li>slight</li>
+ <li>sly</li>
+ <li>soggy</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 3.</b>—Write sentences containing the following
+nouns, each modified by two or more adjectives:—</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>cabbage</li>
+ <li>carpet</li>
+ <li>cloud</li>
+ <li>deed</li>
+ <li>garden</li>
+ <li>grapes</li>
+ <li>hand</li>
+ <li>hat</li>
+ <li>machine</li>
+ <li>mill</li>
+ <li>pupil</li>
+ <li>room</li>
+ <li>ship</li>
+ <li>story</li>
+ <li>teacher</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p class="section" id="section28"><b>28.</b> In the following sentences, what word describes the
+statue? the bureau? the lamp? the rings?</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>A bronze statue of Benjamin Franklin stood in Lafayette Park.</p>
+
+<p>The mahogany bureau contained a desk with many drawers
+and pigeon holes.</p>
+
+<p>We grew tired of the gorgeousness of our parlor lamp.</p>
+
+<p>Indians of both sexes are fond of bracelets, necklaces, and finger
+rings.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>These four descriptive words are name words, hence by
+nature they are nouns; but in these sentences they are used
+as adjectives, and should therefore be called adjectives.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_28">[28]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 4.</b>—Write sentences in which the following nouns
+are used as adjectives:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>silver, copper, tin, iron, steel.</p>
+
+<p>maple, oak, pine, hickory, cedar.</p>
+
+<p>kitchen, hall, cellar, roof, library.</p>
+
+<p>hand, head, foot, cheek, neck.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Think of ten other nouns that may be used as adjectives.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="X">X. ADVERBS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section29"><b>29.</b> In the sentence, “The donkey ate an armful of
+green grass,” we are told what action the donkey performed,
+but we are not told the manner in which he performed
+the action. Very often manner is worth telling, as in the
+sentence, “The donkey ate leisurely an armful of green
+grass.”</p>
+
+<p>Since the word <i>leisurely</i> tells how the donkey ate, it must
+go with the word <i>ate</i>. We say of it what we said of adjectives,
+that it <i>modifies</i> the word it goes with. Since it modifies a
+verb, it is different from any part of speech that we have
+studied before. We call it an <b>adverb</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section30"><b>30.</b> The great difference between adjectives and adverbs
+is this, that the adjective modifies a noun or a pronoun, and
+the adverb usually modifies a verb. Adjectives describe
+objects, which are named by nouns, and adverbs usually
+describe actions, which are asserted by verbs.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section31"><b>31.</b> Not all adverbs tell manner. They frequently tell
+time, place, direction, degree, or other circumstances; as
+in these sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p><i>Now</i> the cow would be eating in one place, and <i>then</i> she would
+walk to another.</p>
+
+<p><i>Here</i> and <i>there</i> a snag lifted its nose out of the water like a shark.</p>
+
+<p>For weeks his ship sailed <i>onward</i> over a lonely ocean.</p>
+
+<p>Mother’s sudden cry frightened me <i>terribly</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_29">[29]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section32"><b>32.</b> It was pointed out in <a href="#IX">Lesson IX</a> that adjectives frequently
+tell some quality of an object. Sometimes we wish
+to tell in what degree this quality is possessed, as in the
+expressions, <i>a very tall man</i>, <i>an exceedingly hot day</i>, <i>too ripe
+fruit</i>. Here the words <i>very</i>, <i>exceedingly</i>, and <i>too</i> go with the
+adjectives <i>tall</i>, <i>hot</i>, and <i>ripe</i> to denote degree. Such words
+are said to modify the adjectives they go with. Words that
+modify adjectives are also called adverbs.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—A group of words like <i>very tall</i> and <i>exceedingly hot</i> may
+be called an <b>adjective element</b>. Its base word is an adjective,
+modified by an adverb. It is the whole element, or group of words,
+that modifies the noun.</p>
+
+<p>Adverbs of degree may modify adverbs as well as adjectives,
+as in the sentences, “The fox ran very swiftly,” “You speak
+too rapidly.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>adverb</b> is a word that modifies a verb,
+an adjective, or another adverb.</p>
+
+<p>Adverbs usually tell time, place, manner, direction, or
+degree.</p>
+
+<p>Unless a sentence is transposed, the adverb should be as
+near as possible to the word it modifies.</p>
+
+<p>Adverbs in a series are separated from each other by
+commas.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Select all the adverbs in the following
+sentences. Tell what each adverb modifies, and what it
+denotes.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. People with lanterns rushed hither and thither.</p>
+
+<p>2. The island is separated from the mainland by a scarcely perceptible
+creek.</p>
+
+<p>3.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">And so the teacher turned him out,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">And still he lingered near,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And waited patiently about</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">Till Mary did appear.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_30">[30]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. Faintly, in gentle whiffs, the lilies on the low marble shelf
+threw off their delicate fragrance.</p>
+
+<p>5. Quackalina was sitting happily among the reeds with her dear
+ones under her wings, while Sir Sooty waddled proudly around her.</p>
+
+<p>6. In youth the tulip tree has a trunk peculiarly smooth.</p>
+
+<p>7. On one occasion Gypsy put in her head, and lapped up six
+custard pies that had been placed by the casement to cool.</p>
+
+<p>8. No wild animals were ever trained by the ancients.</p>
+
+<p>9. The paper was passed skillfully from desk to desk until it
+finally reached my hands.</p>
+
+<p>10. Messua’s husband had some remarkably fine buffaloes that
+worried him exceedingly.</p>
+
+<p>11. The charcoal burners went off very valiantly in single file.</p>
+
+<p>12. Sometimes my head almost aches with the variety of my
+knowledge.</p>
+
+<p>13. Knots of gossips lingered here and there near the place.</p>
+
+<p>14. This talk amused me greatly, but it went in at one ear and
+out at the other.</p>
+
+<p>15. My father invested his money so securely in the banking
+business that he was never able to get any of it out again.</p>
+
+<p>16. Yonder I shall sit down and get knowledge.</p>
+
+<p>17. Then he would crawl forward inch by inch, and wait till the
+seal came up to breathe.</p>
+
+<p>18. No one can work well without sleep.</p>
+
+<p>19. This jackal was peculiarly low, a cleaner-up of village rubbish
+heaps, desperately timid, or wildly bold, everlastingly hungry,
+and full of cunning that never did him any good.</p>
+
+<p>20. The Black Panther raised his head and yawned—elaborately,
+carefully, and ostentatiously.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Account for the commas in the last sentence.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Write sentences containing adverbs of
+manner modifying the following verbs:—</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>comes</li>
+ <li>goes</li>
+ <li>plays</li>
+ <li>reads</li>
+ <li>sings</li>
+ <li>skates</li>
+ <li>speaks</li>
+ <li>studies</li>
+ <li>walks</li>
+ <li>works</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 3.</b>—Write sentences containing the following
+adverbs:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>upward, downward, forward, backward, headlong, north, southward.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_31">[31]</span></p>
+
+<p>everywhere, nowhere, somewhere, anywhere.</p>
+
+<p>seldom, often, always, sometimes, forever.</p>
+
+<p>perfectly, unusually, unspeakably, positively, miserably.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Use the last five adverbs to modify adjectives or adverbs.
+What will they denote when so used?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 4.</b>—Form adverbs from the following adjectives:—</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>careless</li>
+ <li>dreary</li>
+ <li>firm</li>
+ <li>gentle</li>
+ <li>hasty</li>
+ <li>noble</li>
+ <li>painful</li>
+ <li>sharp</li>
+ <li>slow</li>
+ <li>wide</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p>What part of speech are the words <i>chilly</i>, <i>deadly</i>, <i>holy</i>,
+<i>kindly</i>, <i>lively</i>, <i>lovely</i>? Use them in sentences to find out.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XI">XI. PHRASES. ANALYSIS OF SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section33"><b>33.</b> We cannot always describe or point out objects as
+fully as we wish by means of adjectives, and so we use another
+sort of modifier, which is not a single word, but a group
+of words. In the sentence, “Broad, flat fields without fences
+stretch in every direction,” we describe the fields by the
+two adjectives <i>broad</i> and <i>flat</i>, and by the group of words,
+<i>without fences</i>. Thus the noun <i>fields</i> has three modifiers,
+and they are very well placed, two of them coming before the
+noun, and one of them after it.</p>
+
+<p>In the group of words <i>without fences</i>, the two words are
+closely related to each other. In fact, neither of them
+could be in the sentence at all without the other. Such a
+group of related words is called a <b>phrase</b>. When a phrase
+modifies a noun, we say it is an <b>adjective phrase</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section34"><b>34.</b> In the same sentence there is another phrase, <i>in every
+direction</i>, telling where the fields stretch. Since this phrase
+modifies the verb, it performs the same office as an adverb,
+and we therefore call it an <b>adverbial phrase</b>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_32">[32]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section35"><b>35.</b> Phrases never consist of fewer than two words, and
+they may consist of a good many, for it is possible to have
+one or more phrases within a phrase. In the sentence, “I
+was born in a stable on the outskirts of a small town in
+Maine,” the verb <i>was born</i> is modified by a long phrase, <i>in a
+stable on the outskirts of a small town in Maine</i>. The noun
+<i>stable</i> in this phrase is modified by the phrase <i>on the outskirts
+of a small town in Maine</i>. The noun <i>outskirts</i> in this second
+phrase is modified by the phrase <i>of a small town in Maine</i>.
+The noun <i>town</i> in this third phrase is modified by the fourth
+phrase, <i>in Maine</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section36"><b>36.</b> Phrases do not always modify the word they come
+next to; they modify the word whose meaning they tell
+something about. In the sentence, “I scrambled through
+the evergreens to my friend’s little hut just before sunset,”
+there is no phrase within another phrase, but there are three
+entirely distinct phrases. What are they?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section37"><b>37.</b> A series of phrases consists of two or more phrases
+each modifying the same word; as, “Ours is a government
+<i>of the people</i>, <i>for the people</i>, and <i>by the people</i>.” Phrases
+in a series are separated from each other by a comma.
+Why do not the phrases in the sentence in § 35 form a
+series?</p>
+
+<p>It might seem at first thought that the sentence in § 36
+contains a series of three phrases; but it does not, for the
+phrases do not modify the same word. <i>Through the evergreens</i>
+modifies <i>scrambled</i>; <i>to my friend’s little hut</i> modifies
+<i>scrambled through the evergreens</i>. What does the third phrase
+modify?</p>
+
+<p>In the punctuation of phrases a good deal must be left to
+the judgment of the writer. That punctuation is best which
+most clearly reveals the structure and meaning of the sentence.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_33">[33]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>phrase</b> is a group of related words having
+neither a subject nor a predicate, and used like a part of
+speech.</p>
+
+<p>A phrase is often used like an adjective to modify a noun,
+or like an adverb to modify a verb.</p>
+
+<p>Phrases in a series are separated from each other by a
+comma.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the phrases in these sentences,
+and tell what each phrase modifies. Account for the punctuation
+of the phrases in sentences 2 and 9. Why are
+commas omitted in sentence 5?</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. I passed a very comfortable night in the carrot bin.</p>
+
+<p>2. The four little rabbits lived with their mother, in a sand
+bank, underneath the root of a very big fir tree.</p>
+
+<p>3. He went along over hills and mountains, and on the third
+day came to a wide forest.</p>
+
+<p>4. During those long winter evenings I read six of Scott’s novels
+aloud to my mother.</p>
+
+<p>5. Mr. Jeremy Fisher lived in a little damp house amongst the
+buttercups at the edge of a pond.</p>
+
+<p>6. On that evening, before sunset, some women were washing
+clothes on the upper step of the flight that led down into the basin
+of the Pool of Siloam.</p>
+
+<p>7. On the fourth day after our arrival came a letter from my
+mamma.</p>
+
+<p>8. Jelly fishes generally float near the surface of the sea, and are
+often washed up on the shore by the waves.</p>
+
+<p>9. Where no human hand would have dared to rest, the young
+lions crawled fearlessly—across the knotty muscles of the back,
+over the sinewy neck, across the death-dealing paws, even between
+the frightful jaws.</p>
+
+<p>10. Tom arched his back like a contortionist at a circus.</p>
+
+<p>11. The women of the different provinces in Holland are known
+by their head dresses.</p>
+
+<p>12. The last words rang out like silver trumpets.</p>
+
+<p>13. A farm without a boy would very soon come to grief.</p>
+
+<p>14. In winter I get up at night.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_34">[34]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section38"><b>38.</b> <b>Analyzing</b> a sentence is the process of separating it
+into its parts, and telling the relation between those parts.
+In analyzing the sentences in the following exercise proceed
+according to this outline:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Tell whether the sentence is declarative or interrogative.</p>
+
+<p>(2) Divide it into subject and predicate.</p>
+
+<p>(3) Select the simple subject and give its modifiers.</p>
+
+<p>(4) Select the simple predicate and give its modifiers.</p>
+
+<p>(5) If a predicate is compound, select the two or more
+predicate verbs, and then give the modifiers of each.</p>
+
+<p>Tell the exact truth in good, clear English. For example,
+in analyzing the expression, <i>the four little rabbits</i>, do not say
+that <i>the</i>, <i>four</i>, and <i>little</i> are adjectives modifying <i>rabbits</i>, but
+say that <i>rabbits</i> is modified by the adjectives <i>little</i>, <i>four</i>, and
+<i>the</i>. Why should they be given in this order?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Analyze sentences 2, 3, 5, 7, 8, 11, 12, 13,
+and 14 in the exercise on <a href="#Page_33">p. 33</a>.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XII">XII. PREPOSITIONS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section39"><b>39.</b> In the preceding lesson we considered a phrase as a
+unit. We shall now examine its structure, and see what
+parts it is composed of. If we look carefully at these
+phrases,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>with their mother</p>
+
+<p>to a wide forest</p>
+
+<p>over the sinewy neck</p>
+
+<p>like silver trumpets</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="noindent">we see that the first word is not a noun, a pronoun, a verb,
+an adjective, or an adverb. If we try to put this word anywhere
+else in the phrase, we see that it must come at the
+beginning; in short, that it is the introductory word of the
+phrase. If we had only this introductory word given, the
+word <i>with</i>, for instance, we should ask at once <i>with what?</i>
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_35">[35]</span>or <i>with whom?</i> The answer to this second question is <i>their
+mother</i>, the rest of the phrase.</p>
+
+<p>If we examine the other three phrases in the same way,
+we shall come to the conclusion that a phrase is made up
+of two parts: (1) an introductory word, (2) an answer to
+the question made by putting <i>whom</i> or <i>what</i> after the introductory
+word. We call the introductory word a <b>preposition</b>,
+and we say that the rest of the phrase is the <b>object of the
+preposition</b>. A preposition is a part of speech.</p>
+
+<p>A phrase that consists of a preposition and its object is
+called a <b>prepositional phrase</b>. Not all phrases are of this
+kind. We shall study the other kinds later.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section40"><b>40.</b> There are not a great many prepositions in the English
+language, hardly more than a hundred in all. Most of them
+are short words, and of very great usefulness. Some of the
+commonest are: <i>across</i>, <i>after</i>, <i>before</i>, <i>between</i>, <i>by</i>, <i>for</i>,
+<i>from</i>, <i>in</i>, <i>over</i>, <i>to</i>, <i>through</i>, <i>toward</i>, <i>under</i>, <i>with</i>, <i>without</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section41"><b>41.</b> The object of a preposition may be a single word, as
+in the phrase <i>without fences</i>, but oftener it is a group of
+words. The base word of the group is usually a noun. A
+pronoun also may be the object of a preposition, as in the
+phrases <i>for me</i>, <i>to him</i>, <i>with us</i>. The object of a preposition
+may be compound, as in the phrases, <i>over land and sea</i>, <i>by
+day and night</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section42"><b>42.</b> In <a href="#XI">Lesson XI</a>, it was pointed out that a phrase modifies
+a noun or a verb. It does so because the preposition
+shows a certain relation between its object and the noun or
+verb that the phrase modifies. In the sentence, “The porters
+at the German railroad stations are dressed in fine green
+uniforms,” the preposition <i>at</i> shows a relation of place between
+the porters and the German railroad stations, and the
+preposition <i>in</i> shows a relation of manner between the act of
+dressing and the fine green uniforms.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_36">[36]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>prepositional phrase</b> consists of a preposition
+and its object.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>preposition</b> is a word that is used with its object to form
+a phrase, and shows the relation of its object to the word
+the phrase modifies.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—A prepositional phrase in its natural order consists of
+(1) the preposition and (2) its object.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>object</b> of a preposition is found by asking the question
+made by putting <i>whom</i> or <i>what</i> after the preposition.</p>
+
+<p>The object of a preposition may be simple or compound.</p>
+
+<p>The base word of the object may be a noun or a pronoun.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select the prepositional phrases in the following
+sentences. Tell what each phrase modifies. Divide
+each phrase into preposition and object. Find the base
+word of the object, and tell what part of speech it is.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. This monster lives in a den under yonder mountain with a
+brother of his.</p>
+
+<p>2. I carried both letters in my apron pocket.</p>
+
+<p>3. At the age of ten years he fled from the multiplication table
+and ran away to sea.</p>
+
+<p>4. In the dusk of spring evenings we sat on the window seat
+and watched the lights come out on the high bluff and the long
+bridge.</p>
+
+<p>5.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The stormy March is come at last,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">With wind, and cloud, and changing skies.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>6. With a fair and strong breeze we soon ran into the little cove
+to the northward of Fort Moultrie.</p>
+
+<p>7. On the projecting bluffs, and occasionally on the very mountain
+tops, stand the ruins of great castles of the olden times.</p>
+
+<p>8. In the ancient city of London on a certain autumn day in the
+second quarter of the sixteenth century, a boy was born to a poor
+family of the name of Canty.</p>
+
+<p>9. Now I was comforted by the thought of a tassel, and an ivory
+handle, and blue and gold changeable silk.</p>
+
+<p>10. A polar storm can blow for ten days without a break.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_37">[37]</span></p>
+
+<p>11. The aërial path of Hushwing, from his nest in the swamp
+to his watchtower on the clearing’s edge, led him past the pool and
+the crouching panther.</p>
+
+<p>12.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">All the little boys and girls,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">With rosy cheeks and flaxen curls,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And sparkling eyes and teeth like pearls,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Tripping and skipping, ran merrily after</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The wonderful music, with shouting and laughter.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>What part of speech are these words: <i>yonder</i>, sentence 1,
+<i>apron</i> 2, <i>multiplication</i> 3, <i>spring</i> 4, <i>very</i> 7, <i>autumn</i> 8, <i>break</i> 10?</p>
+
+<p>What is peculiar about the object of <i>at</i> in sentence 5, and
+of <i>to</i> in sentence 6?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section43"><b>43.</b> Good English requires accuracy in the use of prepositions.
+Study the following prepositions, and avoid errors
+in their use.</p>
+
+<p><b>Among</b> and <b>between</b>. The word <i>between</i> usually refers to
+only two persons or things, while <i>among</i> refers to more than
+two.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>I walked between my father and my mother.</p>
+
+<p>She walked among us like an angel.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><b>At</b> and <b>in</b>. We use <i>in</i> when speaking of countries and
+large cities, <i>at</i> when speaking of villages or buildings.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>The train arrives in Los Angeles at noon.</p>
+
+<p>The train stopped at every little station.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><b>At</b> and <b>to</b>. <i>At</i> conveys the idea of <i>being</i> in a place, and
+<i>to</i> conveys the idea of <i>going</i> to a place.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Were you at school yesterday?</p>
+
+<p>I came to school early this morning.</p>
+
+<p>My sister is at home.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>We speak of going to school, to church, to the factory,
+to the store, to the office, etc., but we do not use <i>to</i> before
+<i>home</i>. We say “I am <i>at</i> home,” or “Come home,” in the
+latter case omitting the preposition entirely.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_38">[38]</span></p>
+
+<p><b>Beside</b> and <b>besides</b>. <i>Beside</i> means by the side of, and
+<i>besides</i> means in addition to.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Little Em’ly sat beside David.</p>
+
+<p>Nobody remained besides the old nurse.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><b>By</b> and <b>with</b>. <i>By</i> refers to the agent, or doer of an action,
+and <i>with</i> to the instrument, or means employed.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>The cherry tree was cut down by George Washington with a
+little hatchet.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><b>In</b> and <b>into</b>. <i>In</i> usually conveys the idea of rest, and <i>into</i>
+of motion.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>We stayed in the library all the evening.</p>
+
+<p>Our hostess took us into the Simmons Library.</p>
+
+<p>I went into the Bank.</p>
+
+<p>I put my money in the Bank.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><b>Off.</b> This preposition should not be followed by <i>of</i>. We
+should say,</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>The pitcher fell off the table.</p>
+
+<p>I got off the car.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>In place of the word <i>onto</i> we should use <i>on</i> or <i>upon</i>.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>He climbed upon the roof of the pilot house.</p>
+
+<p>He stepped on a loose board.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Some words are followed by certain prepositions to express
+certain meanings; as,</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p><i>Agree with</i> thine adversary.</p>
+
+<p>Brutus <i>agreed to</i> the plan.</p>
+
+<p>Brutus <i>differed with</i> Cassius.</p>
+
+<p>My watch is <i>different from</i> yours.</p>
+
+<p>Imogen <i>parted from</i> him with tears.</p>
+
+<p>Imogen would not <i>part with</i> her bracelet.</p>
+
+<p>Many people <i>died of</i> yellow fever.</p>
+
+<p>I am <i>sorry for</i> the mistake.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_39">[39]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Supply the correct preposition in each of these
+sentences, and give your reason in each case:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The fugitive slave ran —— the trees, and took his stand
+—— two large cypresses.</p>
+
+<p>2. While we were —— New Orleans, we stayed —— the St.
+Charles Hotel.</p>
+
+<p>3.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">And so —— the silent sea</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">I wait the muffled oar.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>4. In that Sunday school class there was no girl —— Gertrude.</p>
+
+<p>5. This mark must have been made —— a knife.</p>
+
+<p>6. When you are —— Rome, you must do as the Romans do.</p>
+
+<p>7. Come —— the garden, Maud.</p>
+
+<p>8. Put the silver —— a safe place.</p>
+
+<p>9. John Gilpin’s wig fell —— his head.</p>
+
+<p>10. Get —— this stump so that you can see better.</p>
+
+<p>11. I left the programs —— home.</p>
+
+<p>12. Nobody agrees —— Kate about renting the cottage.</p>
+
+<p>13. Did Will agree —— your plans for the wedding?</p>
+
+<p>14. Charlie differed —— his family about saving his money.</p>
+
+<p>15. An apricot has a different flavor —— a peach.</p>
+
+<p>16. What did the crew die ——?</p>
+
+<p>17. Aren’t you sorry —— his misfortune?</p>
+
+<p>18. The child cried when he parted —— his playthings, and
+would not be comforted when he parted —— his old playmates.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XIII">XIII. TERM OF ADDRESS. EXCLAMATORY NOUN</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section44"><b>44.</b> When we speak directly to persons, we often call them
+by name; as,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Anne, sister Anne, do you see any one coming?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>We do this for several reasons,—sometimes for politeness,
+sometimes to show clearly just whom we are speaking
+to. This name is not necessary to the structure of the
+sentence; that is, it forms no part of the subject or the
+predicate. We say, therefore, that it is <b>independent</b>. We
+call it a <b>term of address</b>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_40">[40]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section45"><b>45.</b> Sometimes, instead of using a person’s name, we invent
+a term of address, as when the Arab said to his horse,</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>“We are far from home, O <i>racer with the swiftest winds</i>, but God
+is with us.”</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>What noun is the base word of this term of address?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section46"><b>46.</b> A term of address may come at the beginning of a
+sentence, or at the end, or somewhere within the sentence.
+It must be set off by commas to show that it is independent.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section47"><b>47.</b> Sometimes a noun or a noun with modifiers is used as
+an <b>exclamation</b>; thus,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>A rainbow! it is too late in the day for that.</p>
+
+<p>Joy to the world! the Lord has come.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>A noun used like <i>rainbow</i> and <i>joy</i> is called an <b>exclamatory
+noun</b>. What feeling does the exclamatory noun in the
+first sentence express? in the second?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>term of address</b> is a word or a group of
+words used as a name to show to whom a remark is made.</p>
+
+<p>The base word of a term of address is usually a noun.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>exclamatory noun</b> is a noun used to express strong or
+sudden feeling. It may be modified or unmodified.</p>
+
+<p>When a word or a group of words is no part of the subject
+or the predicate of a sentence, it is said to be <b>independent</b>.</p>
+
+<p>A term of address and an exclamatory noun are independent
+elements in a sentence.</p>
+
+<p>A term of address is set off from the rest of the sentence by
+a comma.</p>
+
+<p>An exclamatory noun is set off by an exclamation point.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select the terms of address in the following
+sentences. Find the base word of each. Select also the
+exclamatory nouns, and tell what feeling they express.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Little brother, canst thou raise me to my feet?</p>
+
+<p>2. “Now, my dears,” said old Mrs. Rabbit one morning, “you
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_41">[41]</span>may go into the fields or down the lane, but don’t go into Mr.
+McGregor’s garden.”</p>
+
+<p>3. Indeed I was seeking thee, Flathead, but each time we meet
+thou art longer and broader by the length of my arm.</p>
+
+<p>4. Come, Lillie, it is time to go to bed.</p>
+
+<p>5. Sweet, sweet home! there’s no place like home.</p>
+
+<p>6. Why, Father, you are rather old to play cat’s cradle.</p>
+
+<p>7.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Sail on, sail on, O ship of State!</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Sail on, O Union strong and great!</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>8. Sir, I humbly beg your pardon.</p>
+
+<p>9. I understand, noble lord, that you have lost two of your men.</p>
+
+<p>10. Jefferson, I think I will go down into the kitchen and bake
+a pie.</p>
+
+<p>11. A horse! a horse! my kingdom for a horse!</p>
+
+<p>12. There is none like thee in the jungle, wise, old, strong, and
+most beautiful Kaa.</p>
+
+<p>13. Our price, your royal highness, is three shillings.</p>
+
+<p>14. Grand old outlaw, hero of a thousand lawless raids, in a few
+minutes you will be but a great load of carrion.</p>
+
+<p>15.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Brood, kind creature, you need not fear</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Thieves and robbers while I am here.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>16. Catch me, cowardly knaves, if you can.</p>
+
+<p>17. The stately homes of England! how beautiful they stand!</p>
+
+<p>18. O Captain! my Captain! rise up and hear the bells.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XIV">XIV. IMPERATIVE SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section48"><b>48.</b> Besides declarative and interrogative sentences there
+is another kind of sentence used when we speak directly to a
+person for the purpose of telling him what to do; as, “Run
+into the garden, and fetch me the largest pumpkin you can
+find.” This is called an <b>imperative sentence</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section49"><b>49.</b> The imperative sentence is often used in giving orders,
+commands, or directions, but it is used also in giving advice,
+and in making requests or entreaties; as,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Fling away ambition.</p>
+
+<p>Kindly reply by return mail.</p>
+
+<p>Give us this day our daily bread.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_42">[42]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section50"><b>50.</b> Usually only the predicate of an imperative sentence
+is expressed, and so the first word of such a sentence is likely
+to be a verb. The subject is the pronoun <i>you</i>, <i>thou</i>, or <i>ye</i>,
+signifying the person or persons addressed. It is customary
+to omit this pronoun, and we say that the subject is “understood.”
+Occasionally, however, it is expressed in familiar
+conversation; as, “You go away.” Sometimes, too, in
+solemn commands the pronoun <i>thou</i> or <i>ye</i> is expressed;
+as, “Go and do thou likewise.” “Keep ye the law.”</p>
+
+<p>Note that the verb in an imperative sentence commands
+rather than asserts.</p>
+
+<p>An imperative sentence is frequently preceded by a term
+of address, but this must not be mistaken for the subject;
+as, “Father, hear our prayer.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>imperative sentence</b> is one that expresses
+a command or an entreaty.</p>
+
+<p>The subject of an imperative sentence is the pronoun <i>you</i>,
+<i>thou</i>, or <i>ye</i>. This pronoun is usually omitted.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Tell what the following imperative sentences
+denote. Select the predicate verbs, and the subjects whenever
+they are expressed. Select also the terms of address.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Open everything, go everywhere except to this little room.</p>
+
+<p>2. Come and hold this skein of yarn for me.</p>
+
+<p>3. Go and wash Kala Nag, and attend to his ears, and see that
+there are no thorns in his feet.</p>
+
+<p>4. Don’t count your chickens before they are hatched.</p>
+
+<p>5. Rouse to some high and holy work of love.</p>
+
+<p>6. Don’t you show your face here with a pocket on you. If
+your heavy pants have any in ’em, rip ’em out.</p>
+
+<p>7.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Give freely and receive, but take from none</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">By greed, or force, or fraud, what is his own.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>8. Learn to box, to ride, to pull an oar, and to swim.</p>
+
+<p>9. Polly dear, say good morning to Mrs. Chatterton, and then
+run away.</p>
+
+<p>10. Do the work first which is next at hand.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_43">[43]</span></p>
+
+<p>11.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Turn again, Whittington,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Lord Mayor of London.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>12. O Lord of Hosts, provide a champion for thy people.</p>
+
+<p>13.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">O brave marsh Mary-buds, rich and yellow,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Give me your money to hold.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>14.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">O Columbine, open your folded wrapper</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Where two twin turtledoves dwell.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>15.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">O Cuckoopint, toll me the purple clapper</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">That hangs in your clear, green bell.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Account for the commas in sentences 1, 3, 8, 9, and 11.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XV">XV. INTERJECTIONS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section51"><b>51.</b> There are certain words like <i>oh</i>, <i>alas</i>, <i>pshaw</i>, <i>ugh</i>, that
+are used to express strong feeling,—joy, surprise, pain,
+disgust, anger, etc. These words are called <b>interjections</b>.
+An interjection is a part of speech.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section52"><b>52.</b> Interjections are no part of the subject or the predicate
+of a sentence; hence, like terms of address, they are said
+to be independent. They are set off from the rest of the
+sentence by some mark of punctuation, usually an exclamation
+point, sometimes only a comma.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section53"><b>53.</b> We may use a noun or a verb in such a way that it
+becomes an interjection; as, “<i>Goodness!</i> what a fright you
+gave me!” “<i>Hurrah!</i> the lake is frozen over!” Such a
+verb as <i>hark</i> is often used as an interjection, not to express
+sudden feeling so much as to arrest attention; as, “<i>Hark!
+hark!</i> the dogs do bark.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section54"><b>54.</b> The interjection <i>O</i> is often used before a term of address;
+as, “O Lord, how manifold are thy works!”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>interjection</b> is a word used to express
+sudden or strong feeling.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_44">[44]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the interjections in the following
+sentences, and tell what each one is used for:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Boom! Boom!—two of the guns had gone off together.</p>
+
+<p>2. Alas! Amanda, by mistake, had waked up the little boys an
+hour too early.</p>
+
+<p>3. Bah! men are blood brothers of the monkey people.</p>
+
+<p>4. Hallelujah! in one day more we shall be sitting in the sunshine
+on our own doorstep.</p>
+
+<p>5.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">O mother dear, Jerusalem,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">When shall I come to thee?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>6. Ping! ping! ping! went the rifles; and Boom! boom!
+boom! answered the waves.</p>
+
+<p>7. Aha! the world is iron in these days.</p>
+
+<p>8. Alas! it was the head of old Silverspot.</p>
+
+<p>9. Scrooge said, “Pooh! Pooh!” and closed the door.</p>
+
+<p>10. Hark! hark! the lark at heaven’s gate sings.</p>
+
+<p>11. Alack-a-day! travelers encounter all the unusual bits of
+weather.</p>
+
+<p>12. Hey! Willie Winkie, are you coming then?</p>
+
+<p>13. O comrades, if we must fight, let us fight for ourselves.</p>
+
+<p>14. Hush! the winds roar hoarse and deep.</p>
+
+<p>15. Lo, the star which they saw in the east went before them till
+it came and stood over where the young child was.</p>
+
+<p>16. Piff! the packet landed exactly as it was intended, on the
+corn-husk mat in front of the screen door.</p>
+
+<p>17. Oh, London is a man’s town.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XVI">XVI. EXCLAMATORY SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section55"><b>55.</b> We have found that sentences are made to <i>state</i>, or to
+<i>ask</i>, or to <i>command</i>, and hence are classified as <i>declarative</i>,
+<i>interrogative</i>, and <i>imperative</i>.</p>
+
+<p>There is a fourth class of sentence which resembles an
+interjection, being used to express sudden or strong feeling;
+as, “How calm and lovely the river was!” “What a pity it
+is!” These are called <b>exclamatory sentences</b>. They are
+always followed by an exclamation point.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_45">[45]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section56"><b>56.</b> Such sentences as those just quoted, which begin with
+<i>how</i> or <i>what</i>, are exclamatory in form as well as in sense, and
+are therefore sometimes called pure exclamatory sentences.
+They are always in the transposed order. Some sentences,
+however, are exclamatory only in sense. They are in the
+natural order, and when printed, could not be distinguished
+from declarative or imperative sentences if it were
+not for the exclamation point, which indicates that they
+were spoken with strong feeling; as, “Now you may see that
+noblest of all ocean sights for beauty, a full-rigged ship under
+sail!” “Helen Maria! leave the room this moment!”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>exclamatory sentence</b> is one that expresses
+sudden or strong feeling.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Tell why each of these sentences is exclamatory.
+Rearrange in the natural order those which are
+transposed. Divide each of them into subject and predicate.
+Select the simple subject and the simple predicate.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. How soundly he sleeps! From what a depth he draws that
+easy breath!</p>
+
+<p>2. What tales he had told that day!</p>
+
+<p>3. How doubly delicious things tasted in the clear, spicy air
+of the woods!</p>
+
+<p>4. How keen a scent those children had for apples in the cellar!</p>
+
+<p>5. Oh, how sweet the water was! How it soothed the tender
+spots under her weary wings! How it cooled her ears and her
+tired eyelids!</p>
+
+<p>6. With what a glory comes and goes the year!</p>
+
+<p>7. What a racket those rusty cannon had made in the heyday of
+their unchastened youth! What stories they might tell now if
+their puffy, metallic lips could only speak!</p>
+
+<p>8. Burn the hut over their heads!</p>
+
+<p>9. Ugh! may the red mange destroy the dogs of this village!</p>
+
+<p>10. Talk of the curiosity of women!</p>
+
+<p>11. So blessedly evanescent is the memory of seasickness!</p>
+
+<p>12. Hark! how the music leaps out from his throat!</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_46">[46]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XVII">XVII. CONJUNCTIONS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section57"><b>57.</b> Notice the sentences,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Every pine and fir and hemlock wore ermine too dear for an earl.</p>
+
+<p>I stood and watched by the window.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>The parts of the compound subject in the first sentence
+and of the compound predicate in the second are joined by
+the word <i>and</i>. This very common word has a use different
+from that of any word studied thus far; hence it is considered
+another part of speech. Because it is a joining word, it is
+called a <b>conjunction</b>.</p>
+
+<p>There are many conjunctions besides <i>and</i> that we all have
+frequent occasion to use. Among these are <i>nor</i>, <i>or</i>, <i>but</i>,
+<i>yet</i>, <i>therefore</i>, <i>so</i>, and <i>hence</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section58"><b>58.</b> Conjunctions may join not only single words, such as
+nouns, verbs, pronouns, adjectives, and adverbs, but also
+phrases, and even whole sentences; as,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>You may enter without money and without price.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The stiff rails were softened to swan’s down,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And still fluttered down the snow.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section59"><b>59.</b> Although the word <i>but</i> is commonly used as a conjunction,
+yet, in the sentence, “I work every day but Sunday,”
+it is a preposition, and means <i>except</i>. What is its object?
+The great difference between a conjunction and a preposition
+is that a preposition always has an object, whereas a
+conjunction never has one.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>conjunction</b> is a word that joins sentences
+or parts of sentences.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the conjunctions in the following
+sentences, and tell what they join:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Crow was ten years old now, and he was very black and
+polished and thin.</p>
+
+<p>2. Mount St. Michael was not only strongly fortified, but it
+was well guarded by nature.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_47">[47]</span></p>
+
+<p>3. The horse neither switches his tail, nods his head, nor stamps
+his feet.</p>
+
+<p>4. Thirty years later, the remnants of her wedding gowns,—the
+blue silk, the black silk, the striped silk, and the plaid silk,—were
+cut into diamonds and squares, and then pieced together lovingly
+and proudly into a patchwork quilt.</p>
+
+<p>5. There are several steamboats which run up and down the
+Seine like omnibuses, and the charge to passengers is about two
+cents apiece.</p>
+
+<p>6. After steaming for several hours over the smooth river and
+between these flat lowlands, we reach the city of Rotterdam.</p>
+
+<p>7. These great ice streams are always moving slowly downwards;
+hence they carry off, year by year, the snow which falls upon the
+mountain above.</p>
+
+<p>8. The stars danced overhead, and by his side the broad and
+shallow river ran over its stony bed with a loud but soothing murmur
+that filled all the air with entreaty.</p>
+
+<p>9. The things that Mowgli did and saw and heard when he was
+wandering from one people to another, with or without his four
+companions, would make many stories.</p>
+
+<p>10. I drove the cows home through the sweet ferns and down
+the rocky slopes.</p>
+
+<p>11. The sucker’s mouth is not formed for the gentle angleworm
+nor the delusive fly of the fisherman.</p>
+
+<p>12. Our ancestors were very worthy people, but their wall
+papers were abominable.</p>
+
+<p>13. The keeper of the lodgings did not supply meals to his
+guests; so we breakfasted at a small chophouse in a crooked
+street.</p>
+
+<p>14. The Northmen had no compass; they must steer by the
+sun or by the stars, guess at their rate of sailing, and tell by that
+how many more days distant was their destination.</p>
+
+<p>15. Through this silence and through this waste, where the sudden
+lights flapped and went out again, the sleigh and the two that
+pulled it crawled like things in a nightmare.</p>
+
+<p>16. There may be times when you cannot find help, but there
+is no time when you cannot give help.</p>
+
+<p>17.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Over the meadows and through the woods,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">To grandfather’s house we go.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>18. The world has never had a good definition of the word
+liberty, and the American people are much in want of one.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_48">[48]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XVIII">XVIII. CLAUSES. SIMPLE SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section60"><b>60.</b> We have learned that a sentence must contain a subject
+and a predicate. We have another name for a combination
+of subject and predicate. We call it a <b>clause</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section61"><b>61.</b> When a sentence consists of but one clause, we call it a
+<b>simple sentence</b>; and we say that this clause is <b>independent</b>,
+because it can stand alone and make sense.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section62"><b>62.</b> A simple sentence may have a compound subject or a
+compound predicate, or both, and yet so long as these subjects
+and predicates go together, we say that there is only
+one clause; as in the sentence, “The lion and the mouse
+helped each other and became friends.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>clause</b> is any combination of subject and
+predicate.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>independent clause</b> is one that can stand alone and
+make sense.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>simple sentence</b> contains but one independent clause.</p>
+
+<p>A simple sentence may have a compound subject or a
+compound predicate, or both.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Analyze the following simple sentences:—</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Model.</span>—<i>Then a piece of mica, or a little pool, or even a
+highly polished leaf will flash like a heliograph.</i></p>
+
+<p>This is a simple, declarative sentence.</p>
+
+<p>The subject is <i>a piece of mica, or a little pool, or even a
+highly polished leaf</i>. The predicate is <i>will flash like a heliograph
+then</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The subject is compound. The simple subjects are the
+nouns <i>piece</i>, <i>pool</i>, and <i>leaf</i>, which are joined by the conjunction
+<i>or</i>. <i>Piece</i> is modified by the prepositional phrase <i>of
+mica</i> and the adjective <i>a</i>. <i>Pool</i>, is modified by the adjectives
+<i>little</i> and <i>a</i>. <i>Leaf</i> is modified by the adjective element
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_49">[49]</span><i>highly polished</i>, and the adjectives <i>a</i> and <i>even</i>. The base
+word of the adjective element is the adjective <i>polished</i>, which
+is modified by the adverb <i>highly</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The simple predicate is <i>will flash</i>. It is modified by the
+prepositional phrase <i>like a heliograph</i>, and the adverb <i>then</i>.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Through three good months the valley was wrapped in cloud
+and soaking mist.</p>
+
+<p>2. In the very heart of London stands the great Bank of England.</p>
+
+<p>3. Would not any boy respond to the sweet invitation of those
+ripe berries?</p>
+
+<p>4. A fool and his money are soon parted.</p>
+
+<p>5. A large, warm tear splashed down on the program.</p>
+
+<p>6. In the sunny days the sucker lies in the deep pools, by some
+big stone or near the bank.</p>
+
+<p>7. The feeling of a boy towards pumpkin pie has never been
+properly considered.</p>
+
+<p>8. Shall the adventures of the Peterkin family be published?</p>
+
+<p>9. No healthy boy could long exist without numerous friends in
+the animal kingdom.</p>
+
+<p>10. No sound of joy or sorrow was heard from either bank.</p>
+
+<p>11. At length has come the bridal day of beauty and of strength.</p>
+
+<p>12. On one hot summer morning a little cloud rose from the sea
+and floated lightly and happily across the blue sky.</p>
+
+<p>13. Donkeys, horses, negroes of every age, size, and shade, carts,
+crates, sacks, barrels, and boxes are mingled in seemingly inextricable
+confusion.</p>
+
+<p>14. In the midst of the wild confusion the voice of the Boots
+was heard.</p>
+
+<p>15. Then he strolled across the pasture, between the black
+stumps, the blueberry patches, the tangles of wild raspberry;
+pushed softly through the fringe of wild cherry and young birch
+saplings, and crept silently under the branches of a low hemlock.</p>
+
+<p>16. The moss was supported by solid earth or a framework
+of ancient tree roots.</p>
+
+<p>17. Alas! with every blow of the chisel the brick crumbled at
+my feet.</p>
+
+<p>18. A dish of apples and a pitcher of chilly cider were always
+served during the evening.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_50">[50]</span></p>
+
+<p>19. I sat down in the middle of the path and never stirred for a
+long time.</p>
+
+<p>20. The mayor and other civic authorities in London came down
+to Greenwich in barges.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XIX">XIX. COMPOUND SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section63"><b>63.</b> We have seen that sentences may be joined together
+by conjunctions. When two or more independent clauses
+are joined together in this way, we say that the sentence is
+<b>compound</b>; as, “Coral reefs resemble great rock ledges, and
+vessels are often wrecked upon them.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section64"><b>64.</b> The conjunctions most used in compound sentences
+are <i>and</i>, <i>or</i>, <i>but</i>, <i>yet</i>, <i>therefore</i>, and <i>so</i>.</p>
+
+<p><i>And</i> shows that two clauses are in the same line of thought;
+as, “His eye was bright, and his face was ruddy.”</p>
+
+<p><i>Or</i> shows a choice between two clauses; as, “You must
+work, or you must go hungry.”</p>
+
+<p><i>But</i> and <i>yet</i> show a contrast; as, “I mailed the letter, but
+Uncle Joe never received it.”</p>
+
+<p><i>Therefore</i> and <i>so</i> show that the second clause is a consequence
+of the first; as, “There are fires in the forests north
+of us, therefore the air is full of smoke.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section65"><b>65.</b> Sometimes when the relation between clauses is
+perfectly evident, the conjunction is omitted; as, “I came;
+I saw; I conquered.”</p>
+
+<p>In order that the reader may have no doubt as to where a
+clause ends, it is usually followed by a comma, which speaks
+to the eye of the reader just as a pause speaks to the ear of
+the listener. When the clauses are long or the conjunction
+is omitted, a semicolon may be used instead of the comma.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>compound sentence</b> contains two or more
+independent clauses.</p>
+
+<p>The clauses of a compound sentence are separated from
+each other by a comma or a semicolon.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_51">[51]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the clauses in the following compound
+sentences. Tell the relation between them, and how
+they are joined. Tell the subject and predicate of each
+clause. Account for the punctuation.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Over the porch grew a hop-vine, and a brandy-cherry tree
+shaded the door, and a luxuriant cranberry vine flung its delicious
+fruit across the window.</p>
+
+<p>2. Mr. Peterkin liked to take a doze on his sofa in the room, but
+the rest of the family liked to sit on the piazza.</p>
+
+<p>3. Prosperity makes friends; adversity tries them.</p>
+
+<p>4. The whole family planted the potatoes; George dug the
+holes with his hoe, Mollie dropped into each one three pieces of an
+old potato, Paul raked the black earth over them, and Mother
+supervised and praised them all.</p>
+
+<p>5. Some of the letter-carriers must take very long walks, but
+English people do not appear to object to that sort of thing.</p>
+
+<p>6. Oh, come ye in peace here, or come ye in war?</p>
+
+<p>7. At the end of the first year the young lions shed their teeth,
+the first indications of manes appeared on the males, and the
+playfulness between brother and sister ceased.</p>
+
+<p>8. The clumsy wheels of several old-fashioned coaches were
+heard, and the gentlemen and ladies composing the bridal party
+came through the church with the sudden and gladsome effect of
+a burst of sunshine.</p>
+
+<p>9. I had never been called pretty before, so I was flattered.</p>
+
+<p>10. The yellow cur has not the speed of the greyhound, but
+neither does he bear the seeds of lung and skin diseases.</p>
+
+<p>11. The party did not return to Skarpsno until half-past eight
+in the evening, yet the sun was still above the horizon.</p>
+
+<p>12. We cherish every memorial of our worthy ancestors; we celebrate
+their patience and fortitude; we admire their daring enterprise;
+we teach our children to venerate their piety.</p>
+
+<p>13. Every animal has some great strength, or it could not live;
+every animal has some great weakness, or the other animals could
+not live.</p>
+
+<p>14. Human action can be modified to some extent, but human
+nature cannot be changed.</p>
+
+<p>15. Captain John Smith was exasperatingly sure of himself, and
+older men found his pretensions well-nigh unbearable.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_52">[52]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XX">XX. DEPENDENT CLAUSES. COMPLEX SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section66"><b>66.</b> We have seen that in both simple and compound
+sentences the clauses are independent. There is a third
+class of sentences, however, containing <b>dependent clauses</b>.</p>
+
+<p>In the simple sentence, “At night his antelope skin was
+spread on the ground,” the prepositional phrase <i>on the ground</i>
+tells place, and modifies the verb <i>was spread</i>.</p>
+
+<p>In the sentence, “At night his antelope skin was spread
+<i>where the darkness overtook him</i>,” the group of words
+where the darkness overtook him has the same use as the phrase
+<i>on the ground</i>, for it tells place and modifies the verb <i>was
+spread</i>.</p>
+
+<p>But this group of words contains a subject and a predicate;
+hence it is a clause. It could not stand alone and
+make sense; hence it cannot be an independent clause. It
+could not be in the sentence at all unless the verb <i>was spread</i>
+were there too for it to modify. It is therefore dependent
+on the verb, and so we call it a <b>dependent clause</b>. It has
+the same use as an adverb, because it modifies a verb. We
+find many dependent clauses used in this way, because our
+language does not afford enough adverbs or even prepositional
+phrases to express our meaning.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section67"><b>67.</b> When dependent clauses modify verbs, they answer
+such questions as these,—<i>was spread where?</i> <i>was spread
+why?</i> <i>how?</i> <i>when?</i> <i>under what condition?</i> <i>for what purpose?</i></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section68"><b>68.</b> In the sentence, “They went into a small parlor,
+which smelt very spicy,” the parlor is described by the
+adjective <i>small</i> and by the group of words <i>which smelt very
+spicy</i>. What is this group of words? How do we know?
+What words does it modify? What, then, is the use of some
+dependent clauses? When dependent clauses modify nouns,
+they point out or describe objects just as adjectives do.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_53">[53]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section69"><b>69.</b> In the sentences that we have just been studying there
+is an independent clause as well as a dependent clause. A
+sentence of this kind is called a <b>complex sentence</b>.</p>
+
+<p>A complex sentence may contain any number of dependent
+clauses, but only one independent clause, for as soon as a
+sentence contains two independent clauses it becomes a
+compound sentence.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>dependent clause</b> is one that is used like
+a part of speech and does not make sense when it stands
+alone.</p>
+
+<p>A dependent clause may be used like an adjective to
+modify a noun, or like an adverb to modify a verb.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>complex sentence</b> consists of one independent clause and
+one or more dependent clauses.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the clauses in the following sentences,
+and classify them. Tell what the dependent clauses
+modify. Tell the subject and predicate of each clause.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—Frequently a dependent clause modifies more than the
+verb. In the sentence, “The little boys wanted a house with a great
+many doors, so that they could go in and out often,” the dependent
+clause <i>so that they could go in and out often</i> tells the purpose of their
+wanting a house with a great many doors; hence, it modifies not
+merely the verb <i>wanted</i>, but the whole predicate <i>wanted a house with
+a great many doors</i>. Try to tell the exact truth about each sentence
+that you study.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. He was always catching sculpins when every one else with
+the same bait was catching mackerel.</p>
+
+<p>2. If we cross the Atlantic by one of the fast steamships, we shall
+make the voyage in about a week.</p>
+
+<p>3. The Rotterdam quays, which stretch for more than a mile
+along the river, are busy and lively places.</p>
+
+<p>4. Every Sunday morning the wash boiler was filled with water,
+and the largest tub was set in the middle of the kitchen floor, so that
+the three children might have their weekly scrubbing.</p>
+
+<p>5. People who devote themselves too severely to study of the
+classics are apt to become dried up.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_54">[54]</span></p>
+
+<p>6. He charged upon the rows of the mullein stalks as if they
+were rebels in regimental ranks, and hewed them down without
+mercy.</p>
+
+<p>7. Every boy who is good for anything is a natural savage.</p>
+
+<p>8. Rude soldiers now eat, drink, and sleep, where popes and
+cardinals once moved about in state.</p>
+
+<p>9. Mowgli, who had never known the meaning of real hunger,
+fell back on stale honey three years old.</p>
+
+<p>10. Iron-clads are so called because their sides are covered with
+thick plates of iron or steel, capable of resisting very heavy shot.</p>
+
+<p>11. Although many people ascend Mont Blanc every year, the
+undertaking requires a great deal of muscular as well as nervous
+strength.</p>
+
+<p>12. If a boy repeats <i>Thanatopsis</i> while he is milking, that operation
+acquires a certain dignity.</p>
+
+<p>13. The thrill that ran into my fingers’ ends then has not run
+out yet.</p>
+
+<p>14. Even a dog, who is very far removed from the wild wolf,
+his ancestor, can be waked out of deep sleep by a cart wheel touching
+his flank, and can spring away unharmed before that wheel comes
+on.</p>
+
+<p>15. The boys slipped off down the roadside to a place where
+they could dig sassafras or the root of the sweet flag.</p>
+
+<p>16. The little company of Englishmen who, in 1620, exchanged
+Holland for America were not soldiers and traders like the men who
+had led and established the colony at Jamestown.</p>
+
+<p>17. Miles Standish came with the Pilgrims to America because
+he liked both them and their enterprise.</p>
+
+<p>18. The early settlers went to church in military array and laid
+their arms down close by them while they worshiped and heard
+the sermon.</p>
+
+<p>19. The colonists chose for their place of settlement a high bluff,
+which rose upon the eastern bank of a little stream.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Tell the part of speech and use of <i>always</i>, sentence 1,
+<i>Sunday</i> 4, <i>too</i> and <i>severely</i> 5, <i>now</i>, <i>once</i>, and <i>about</i> 8.</p>
+
+<p>Analyze the predicate <i>was set in the middle of the kitchen
+floor</i>.</p>
+
+<p>What is the grammatical use of the group of words <i>as well
+as</i> in sentence 11?</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_55">[55]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXI">XXI. REVIEW: CLASSIFICATION OF SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section70"><b>70.</b> We have seen that sentences are classified according
+to <b>purpose</b>, as declarative, interrogative, imperative, or exclamatory.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>declarative</b> sentence is one that states, or declares,
+something.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>interrogative</b> sentence is one that asks a question.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>imperative</b> sentence is one that expresses a command
+or an entreaty.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>exclamatory</b> sentence is one that expresses sudden or
+strong feeling.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section71"><b>71.</b> We have seen also that sentences may consist of one
+clause or of several, and that clauses may be independent
+or dependent. Sentences are therefore classified according
+to <b>structure</b>, as simple, compound, or complex.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>simple</b> sentence is one that contains but one independent
+clause.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>compound</b> sentence is one that contains two or more
+independent clauses.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>complex</b> sentence is one that contains one independent
+clause and one or more dependent clauses.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Write a complex declarative sentence, a compound
+interrogative sentence, a complex imperative sentence,
+and a simple exclamatory sentence.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Classify the following sentences according to
+both purpose and structure. Give the reasons for your
+classification. Tell what the dependent clauses modify.
+Tell also the subject and predicate of each clause.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The oxen sagged along in their great clumsy way.</p>
+
+<p>2. Give me quickly my seven-league boots, that I may go after
+those boys and catch them.</p>
+
+<p>3. How sweet and demure the girls looked!</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_56">[56]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. Within sight of that tall elm tree were passed my happiest
+years.</p>
+
+<p>5. Did you ever know a child who was not interested in animals?</p>
+
+<p>6. My grandfather never skipped over an advertisement, even
+if he had read it fifty times before.</p>
+
+<p>7.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Woodman, spare that tree!</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Touch not a single bough!</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>8. Must I keep order along the whole line?</p>
+
+<p>9. All the trees and the bushes and the bamboos and the mosses
+and the juicy-leaved plants wake with a noise of growing that you
+can almost hear.</p>
+
+<p>10.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">How dear to my heart are the scenes of my childhood,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">When fond recollection presents them to view!</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>11. Sometimes it is impolite to tell the truth, and then one can
+only say nothing or talk of the weather.</p>
+
+<p>12. Toll ye the church bell sad and slow.</p>
+
+<p>13. Some boys go scowling always through life, as if they had a
+stone bruise on each heel.</p>
+
+<p>14. Proud bird of the mountain, thy plume shall be torn!</p>
+
+<p>15. Mowgli had the good conscience that comes from paying
+debts.</p>
+
+<p>16. Cease to do evil; learn to do well.</p>
+
+<p>17. The first was a brass band, the second was a string band,
+the third was a rubber band, and the fourth was a man who played
+on the jew’s-harp.</p>
+
+<p>18.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Lo, all our pomp of yesterday</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Is one with Nineveh and Tyre!</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>19. On Sunday the hens went silently about, and the roosters
+crowed in psalm tunes.</p>
+
+<p>20.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Up! up! my friend, and quit your books,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Or surely you’ll grow double!</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>21. Is the world growing better or are we moving in a circle?</p>
+
+<p>22. Remember thy Creator in the days of thy youth.</p>
+
+<p>23. When a man has heard the great things calling to him, how
+they call and call, day and night!</p>
+
+<p>24. O ye who have young children, if it is possible, give them
+happy memories.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Find an interjection in this exercise.</p>
+
+<p>What independent elements do you find in sentences 7, 14,
+and 24? What is the base word of each?</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_57">[57]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXII">XXII. REVIEW: PARTS OF SPEECH</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section72"><b>72.</b> We have seen that words are classified according to
+their use into eight parts of speech,—nouns, verbs, pronouns,
+adjectives, adverbs, prepositions, conjunctions, and
+interjections.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>noun</b> is a name word.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>verb</b> is an asserting word.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>pronoun</b> is a word used instead of a noun.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>adjective</b> is a word used to point out or describe an
+object and modify a noun or a pronoun.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>adverb</b> is a word that modifies a verb, an adjective, or
+another adverb.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>preposition</b> is a word that is used with its object to form
+a phrase, and shows the relation of its object to the word the
+phrase modifies.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>conjunction</b> is a word that joins sentences or parts of
+sentences.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>interjection</b> is a word used to express sudden or strong
+feeling.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Tell what part of speech each word is in the
+following sentences. Tell in each case how you know.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Toto’s good grandmother bore this commotion quietly for
+some time.</p>
+
+<p>2. “Now, set those baskets down.” He spoke sharply.</p>
+
+<p>3. Mowgli knew the manners and customs of the villagers very
+fairly.</p>
+
+<p>4. No other mother ever made such deep, smooth, golden custard
+pies, or fried such light and spicy doughnuts.</p>
+
+<p>5. Queen Elizabeth and Mary Queen of Scots are strongly associated
+together in the minds of all readers of English history.</p>
+
+<p>6. The tamest tiger is a tiger still.</p>
+
+<p>7. The negro cleared for us a path to an enormously tall tree.</p>
+
+<p>8. Nobody scolded me or laughed at me.</p>
+
+<p>9. Then my eyes came back to the wall paper, and I studied
+out figures in its spreading vines.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_58">[58]</span></p>
+
+<p>10. Perhaps a little starch would have some effect.</p>
+
+<p>11. The roaring hot wind of the Jungle came and went between
+the rocks and the rattling branches.</p>
+
+<p>12. Ring-ting! I wish I were a primrose.</p>
+
+<p>13. O love, they die in yon rich sky.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section73"><b>73.</b> In sentence 13 in the preceding exercise, it is evident
+that the word <i>love</i>, which is often a verb, is used as a term of
+address, and therefore is a noun. Many words may be used
+as verbs or as nouns.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Tell what part of speech the italicized words
+are in the following sentences. Give your reason in each
+case.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Don’t scour your porcelain <i>sink</i> with sapolio.</p>
+
+<p>2. When bodies <i>sink</i> in Lake Superior, they never rise.</p>
+
+<p>3. Oh, what <i>fall</i> was there, my countrymen.</p>
+
+<p>4. We <i>fall</i> to rise, are baffled to fight better.</p>
+
+<p>5. Alice gave the branch a vigorous <i>shake</i>.</p>
+
+<p>6. Nay, do not <i>shake</i> your gory locks at me.</p>
+
+<p>7. Will you <i>show</i> me your lineage book?</p>
+
+<p>8. There are ten thousand moving picture <i>shows</i> in the United
+States.</p>
+
+<p>9. What a good <i>catch</i> our right fielder made.</p>
+
+<p>10. Did you <i>catch</i> this sturgeon last night?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Make sentences in which the following words shall be
+used as nouns and as verbs: <i>fight</i>, <i>pay</i>, <i>rap</i>, <i>shed</i>, <i>shoe</i>,
+<i>sting</i>, <i>tread</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section74"><b>74.</b> Many words that are usually adjectives may also be
+used as nouns. Such words fall into different classes:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Adjectives denoting color; as, <i>black</i>, <i>white</i>, <i>red</i>. We
+may say, “The blacks were once slaves of the whites.” We
+may also say, “Red and green are complementary colors.”</p>
+
+<p>(2) Certain adjectives denoting qualities of persons, which
+may also be used to name classes of persons having those
+qualities; as, <i>rich</i>, <i>poor</i>, <i>old</i>, <i>young</i>, <i>bad</i>, <i>good</i>. We say, “The
+rich should not scorn the poor,” “The good die young.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_59">[59]</span></p>
+
+<p>(3) Certain adjectives denoting qualities, which may also
+be used to name classes of things having those qualities;
+as, <i>good</i>, <i>evil</i>, <i>true</i>, <i>false</i>. We say, “Love the good, cherish
+the true, admire the beautiful.”</p>
+
+<p>(4) Certain other adjectives, such as <i>native</i>, <i>secret</i>, <i>fat</i>,
+<i>lean</i>, <i>thick</i>. We say, “The natives had no secrets,” “Jack
+Sprat would eat no fat,” “He was always in the thick of
+the fight.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Make sentences containing the following
+words used as adjectives and as nouns: <i>purple</i>, <i>blue</i>, <i>brave</i>,
+<i>righteous</i>, <i>evil</i>, <i>wet</i>, <i>cold</i>, <i>sweet</i>, <i>right</i>, <i>wrong</i>, <i>solid</i>, <i>strong</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section75"><b>75.</b> Some words may be used both as adjectives and as
+adverbs. When <i>well</i> means the opposite of <i>sick</i>, as in the
+sentence, “Grace never was a well child,” it is an adjective.
+When <i>well</i> means in a good manner, as in the sentence,
+“Esther sings well,” it is an adverb.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Tell what part of speech the italicized words
+are in the following sentences. Give your reason in each
+case.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The paper is large <i>enough</i>, but I have not <i>enough</i> string.</p>
+
+<p>2. As she came <i>near</i> I recognized one of my <i>near</i> neighbors.</p>
+
+<p>3. <i>All</i> flesh is grass.</p>
+
+<p>4. The girls playing basket ball are <i>all</i> tired out.</p>
+
+<p>5. The doctor liked a <i>fast</i> horse.</p>
+
+<p>6. We must walk <i>fast</i> this cold morning.</p>
+
+<p>7. Nobody could play golf <i>worse</i> than I.</p>
+
+<p>8. May I never do a <i>worse</i> deed!</p>
+
+<p>9. Have you <i>any</i> ribbon to match this sample?</p>
+
+<p>10. Will this color do <i>any</i> better?</p>
+
+<p>11. Somebody <i>else</i> will marry her then.</p>
+
+<p>12. How <i>else</i> could I get there in time?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Make sentences containing the following words used as
+adjectives and as adverbs: <i>high</i>, <i>last</i>, <i>long</i>, <i>low</i>, <i>much</i>, <i>round</i>,
+<i>slow</i>, <i>straight</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_60">[60]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section76"><b>76.</b> Some words may be used both as adverbs and as
+prepositions. In the sentence, “I looked in as I went by,”
+both <i>in</i> and <i>by</i> are adverbs. How do we know this? In
+the sentence, “As I went by the house, I looked in the
+window,” both <i>in</i> and <i>by</i> are prepositions. What are their
+objects? What do the phrases modify?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—What part of speech are the italicized words
+in the following sentences? Give your reason in each case.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. <i>Beyond</i> lay the city of their dreams.</p>
+
+<p>2. Our house stands <i>beyond</i> the church.</p>
+
+<p>3. <i>Over</i> the Alps lies Italy.</p>
+
+<p>4. Come <i>over</i> this evening if you can.</p>
+
+<p>5. She fainted and did not come <i>to</i> for an hour.</p>
+
+<p>6. The granary is <i>behind</i> the barn.</p>
+
+<p>7. Ichabod looked <i>behind</i> for an instant.</p>
+
+<p>8. A storm of sleet was raging <i>without</i>.</p>
+
+<p>9. Civilized man cannot do <i>without</i> cooks.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Make sentences in which the following words are used
+both as adverbs and as prepositions: <i>about</i>, <i>above</i>, <i>along</i>,
+<i>down</i>, <i>off</i>, <i>on</i>, <i>through</i>, <i>under</i>, <i>up</i>, <i>within</i>.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXIII">XXIII. TRANSITIVE VERBS. OBJECT OF VERB</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section77"><b>77.</b> We have seen that a noun may be related to a verb
+as its subject. When the verb asserts action, as in the
+sentence, “Many birds eat flies,” then the subject <i>many
+birds</i> names the doer, or performer, of the action.</p>
+
+<p>There is another very common relation that a noun may
+bear to a verb. In the sentence above, the verb <i>eat</i> asserts
+an action that is not only performed <i>by</i> something, but is
+also performed <i>upon</i> something. That is, there is a doer of
+the action, many birds, and a receiver of the action, flies.
+If we had merely the subject and the verb, our sentence
+would be incomplete, and we should ask at once, <i>eat what?</i></p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_61">[61]</span></p>
+
+<p>Since the word <i>flies</i> completes the meaning of the verb
+<i>eat</i>, we call it the <b>complement</b> of the verb. Since it names
+the receiver of the action that is asserted by the verb <i>eat</i>,
+we call it the <b>object</b> or <b>direct object</b> of the verb.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section78"><b>78.</b> Not all verbs require an object—only those which
+assert action which the subject performs <i>upon</i> some person
+or thing. Such verbs are called <b>transitive</b> verbs.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section79"><b>79.</b> The object of a verb is not always a single word. The
+object may be compound, as in the sentence, “Many birds
+eat flies and gnats and mosquitoes.” Again, the object may
+be a group of words, of which a noun is the base word.
+In the following sentence there are three transitive verbs.
+What is the object of each verb? What is the base word of
+each object?—“Miss Dorothea dusted the banisters round
+the porch, straightened the rows of shoes in mother’s closet,
+and folded the daily papers in the rack.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section80"><b>80.</b> Just as we can find the subject of a verb by asking
+the question made by placing <i>who</i> or <i>what</i> before the verb,
+so we can find the object of a verb that asserts action by
+asking the question made by placing <i>whom</i> or <i>what</i> after the
+verb.</p>
+
+<p>These questions are often a great help, especially if a sentence
+is long or transposed. In the sentence, “A more
+miserable little beast I had never seen,” what is the verb?
+Ask a question to find the subject. Ask a question to find
+the object.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>transitive verb</b> is one that asserts action
+performed upon some person or thing.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>complement</b> is a word or a group of words used to
+complete the meaning of a verb.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>direct object</b> of a verb is a word or a group of words
+that completes the meaning of a transitive verb and names
+the receiver of the action.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_62">[62]</span></p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—Not all transitive verbs denote action that is accompanied
+by motion. Some denote action of the senses; as, “I <i>see</i>
+the star,” “I <i>taste</i> the pepper.” Others denote action of the feelings;
+as, “I <i>love</i> the truth,” “I <i>hate</i> a lie.” Still others do not denote
+action at all; as, “I <i>mean</i> you,” “Our forefathers <i>owned</i> slaves,”
+“I <i>kept</i> her letter.” We must enlarge our notion of transitive verbs
+so as to make it include all verbs that take a complement which denotes
+a different person or thing from the subject.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Select all the transitive verbs in these sentences.
+Find both their subjects and their objects by asking
+the proper questions.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—A transitive verb may be modified before it is completed.
+This is true of <i>lifts</i> in sentence 2. Oftener the idea expressed by
+the verb and its object together is modified; as in sentence 1, where
+the phrase <i>in despair</i> modifies not <i>shook</i> but <i>shook her head</i>.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Dotty Dimple shook her head in despair.</p>
+
+<p>2. At the word of command, the two horsemen stop, each man
+lifts up his right leg, throws it over the back of his horse, and drops
+it to the ground so that the two boots tap the pavement at the same
+instant.</p>
+
+<p>3. Her father found a pleasant seat on the shady side, hung
+the basket in a rack, and opened a window.</p>
+
+<p>4. When the young surveyor left Detroit, he carried a huge green
+bandbox, and his wife in her far frontier home received in due time
+a beautiful blue bonnet.</p>
+
+<p>5. I threw off an overcoat, took an armchair by the crackling
+logs, and awaited patiently the arrival of my hosts.</p>
+
+<p>6. All the world likes molasses candy.</p>
+
+<p>7. The children brought home great bunches of the brilliant
+leaves, and some they pressed and varnished, while others Katherine
+dipped in melted wax.</p>
+
+<p>8. John trod down the exquisite ferns and the wonderful mosses
+without compunction. But he gathered from the crevices of the
+rocks the columbine and the eglantine and the blue harebell; he
+picked the high-flavored alpine strawberry, the blueberry, the boxberry,
+wild currants and gooseberries and fox grapes; he brought
+home armfuls of the pink and white laurel and the wild honeysuckle;
+he dug the roots of the fragrant sassafras and of the sweet
+flag; he ate the tender leaves of the wintergreen and its red berries;
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_63">[63]</span>he gathered the peppermint and the spearmint; he gnawed the
+twigs of the black birch; he dug the amber gum from the spruce-tree;
+he brought home such medicinal herbs for the garret as the
+goldthread, the tansy, and the loathsome “boneset,” and he laid
+in for the winter, like a squirrel, stores of beechnuts, hazelnuts,
+hickorynuts, chestnuts, and butternuts.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Analyze the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—If any part of a sentence is compound, state that
+fact before analyzing it. If the subject or object is compound,
+give the base words first, and then the modifiers of each. If the
+predicate is compound, analyze the first predicate completely, then
+the second, and so on. If any adverb or prepositional phrase
+modifies the idea denoted by the verb and the object, be sure to say
+so in your analysis. For instance, in the sentence, “We have seen
+his star in the east,” the predicate verb is <i>have seen</i>. It is completed
+by the direct object <i>his star</i>, and then modified by the prepositional
+phrase <i>in the east</i>.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Sometimes a perfume like absinthe sweetened all the air.</p>
+
+<p>2. The little brown field mouse ran along in the grass, poked his
+nose into everything, and finally spied a smooth, shiny acorn.</p>
+
+<p>3. My son, descend those steps and enter that door.</p>
+
+<p>4. Many and many a pair of mittens had those busy fingers
+knit.</p>
+
+<p>5. Always within a few moments the rabbits would resume their
+leaping progress through the white glitter and the hard, black
+shadows.</p>
+
+<p>6. The visit of the tax collector seldom gives unmixed joy.</p>
+
+<p>7. Scrooge took his melancholy dinner in his usual melancholy
+tavern.</p>
+
+<p>8. The first glimpse of a new country always quickens the
+sense of the traveler.</p>
+
+<p>9. Rebecca took off her hat and cape and hung them in the
+hall, put her rubber shoes and umbrella carefully in the corner,
+and then opened the door of paradise.</p>
+
+<p>10. The scent of herbs and the fragrance of fruit filled the great
+unfinished chamber.</p>
+
+<p>11. A polished brazen rod on a broad wooden pedestal beside
+the armchair held half a dozen lamps of silver on sliding arms.</p>
+
+<p>12. Messala hugged the stony wall with perilous clasp.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_64">[64]</span></p>
+
+<p>13. Amrah rubbed her eyes, bent closer down, clasped her hands,
+gazed wildly around, looked at the sleeper, then stooped and raised
+his hand, and kissed it fondly.</p>
+
+<p>14. The proprietor of the fruit stand has a bald head, a long face,
+and a nose like the beak of a hawk.</p>
+
+<p>15. Without more ado Mr. Cary grasped his arm firmly, and
+fairly lifted him into the room.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXIV">XXIV. INTRANSITIVE VERBS ASSERTING ACTION</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section81"><b>81.</b> Transitive verbs, as we have seen, assert action performed
+upon some person or thing. There are many other
+verbs in our language that assert action, but the action is not
+performed <i>upon</i> anything. On the contrary, the action ends
+in itself; as in the sentence, “The wind in the chimney sighed
+and moaned and shivered.” Here the wind is said to perform
+three actions, but these actions were not received by
+anything. Verbs like <i>sighed</i>, <i>moaned</i>, and <i>shivered</i> are said
+to be <b>intransitive verbs</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section82"><b>82.</b> Not all intransitive verbs assert action. The verb <i>be</i>
+and a few others (see <a href="#XXV">Lesson XXV</a>) which assert merely
+<i>being</i>, are also intransitive verbs; as, “I <i>am</i> hungry,” “You
+<i>are</i> kind,” “He <i>is</i> extravagant,” “They <i>were</i> careless.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section83"><b>83.</b> It frequently happens that the same verb may be
+used in one sentence as a transitive verb, and in another as
+an intransitive verb. If we say, “The horse kicked his
+master,” the verb <i>kicked</i> is transitive. Why? If we say,
+“The poor boy kicked and squirmed and groaned,” the verb
+<i>kicked</i> is intransitive. Why?</p>
+
+<p>We should always classify a verb as it is used in the particular
+sentence under consideration.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>intransitive verb</b> is one that asserts
+(1) being, or (2) action that is not received by any person or
+thing.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_65">[65]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Select all the verbs in the following sentences,
+and classify them as transitive or intransitive. Tell the
+subject of each verb. If the verb is transitive, tell its object.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The princess sat at table next to the king and queen.</p>
+
+<p>2. At these words a grave smile of approval lighted the gaunt
+face of the Hindu.</p>
+
+<p>3. The spring murmured drowsily beside him. The branches
+waved dreamily across the blue sky overhead. A deep sleep fell upon
+David Swan.</p>
+
+<p>4.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">While shepherds watched their flocks by night,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">All seated on the ground,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">An angel of the Lord came down,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">And glory shone around.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>5. Mr. Jeremy stuck his pole into the mud, and fastened the
+boat to it.</p>
+
+<p>6. The cat got up and stretched herself, and came and sniffed
+at the basket.</p>
+
+<p>7. I would have spared the woman who gave thee the milk.</p>
+
+<p>8. His hair had fallen about his shoulders.</p>
+
+<p>9. They sang patriotic songs, they told stories, they fired torpedoes,
+they frightened the cats.</p>
+
+<p>10. I could have killed a buck while thou wast striking.</p>
+
+<p>11. Away rolled the bogghun, away and away, over the meadows
+and into the forest; away and away bounded the Princess in pursuit.
+The golden nose ring flashed and glittered in the sunlight, the golden
+bangles on her wrists and ankles tinkled and rang their tiny bells
+as she went. The monkeys swinging by their tails from the
+branches, chattered with astonishment at us; the wild parrot
+screamed at us; all the birds sang and chirped and twittered.</p>
+
+<p>12. The chipmunk appeared at the mouth of his den, looked
+quickly about, took a few leaps to a tussock of grass, paused a
+breath with one foot raised, slipped quickly a few yards over some
+dry leaves, paused again by a stump beside a path, rushed across
+the path to the pile of loose stones, went under the first and over the
+second, gained the pile of posts, made his way through that, surveyed
+his course a half moment from the other side of it, and then
+darted on to some other cover, and presently beyond my range,
+where he must have gathered acorns, for no other nut-bearing trees
+than oaks grew near.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_66">[66]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Tell whether the italicized verbs in the following
+sentences are transitive or intransitive. Give your
+reason in each case. If a verb is transitive, tell how it is
+completed. If it is intransitive, tell how it is modified.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. All the brooks <i>have burst</i> their icy chains.</p>
+
+<p>2. The boiler <i>burst</i> with a tremendous noise.</p>
+
+<p>3. <i>Do</i> your duty; that is best.</p>
+
+<p>4. Such language <i>will</i> never <i>do</i> for a teacher.</p>
+
+<p>5. Miss Clarissa <i>draws</i> and paints very well.</p>
+
+<p>6. Giotto <i>drew</i> a perfect circle with one sweep of his arm.</p>
+
+<p>7. The swallow <i>flies</i> with a graceful dipping motion.</p>
+
+<p>8. The boys <i>are flying</i> their kites on the common.</p>
+
+<p>9. <i>Give</i> us this day our daily bread.</p>
+
+<p>10. The rope was stretched so tightly that it <i>did</i> not <i>give</i> with
+his weight.</p>
+
+<p>11. All day he sits in his arm chair and <i>reads</i>.</p>
+
+<p>12. <i>Have</i> you <i>read</i> “The Man without a Country”?</p>
+
+<p>13. The woodworkers <i>have struck</i> for shorter hours.</p>
+
+<p>14. David <i>struck</i> Uriah Heep on the cheek.</p>
+
+<p>15. Aunt Betsy <i>swept</i> down upon the trespassers.</p>
+
+<p>16. I <i>must sweep</i> the spiders off the porch.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXV">XXV. INTRANSITIVE VERBS ASSERTING BEING. NOUNS AS SUBJECTIVE COMPLEMENTS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section84"><b>84.</b> There is no other verb used oftener than the verb <i>be</i>,
+with its various forms,—<i>is</i>, <i>are</i>, <i>am</i>, <i>was</i>, <i>will be</i>, <i>has been</i>,
+etc. In the sentence, “The lake is the mother of the great
+rivers,” there would be no assertion without the verb <i>is</i>, and
+yet it does not assert action of any sort. The sentence plainly
+means that the lake and the mother of the great rivers are
+identical; that is, they are one and the same thing. The
+verb <i>is</i> enables us to assert identity. A verb of this kind is
+intransitive. It is often called a verb of <b>being</b>, to distinguish
+it from verbs that assert action.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section85"><b>85.</b> Some other verbs of this kind are <i>seem</i>, <i>appear</i>, <i>become</i>,
+<i>grow</i>, <i>feel</i>, <i>look</i>, <i>smell</i>, <i>taste</i>, and <i>sound</i>. They are classed as
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_67">[67]</span>verbs of being because they mean—to be in appearance, in
+looks, in smell, in taste, etc., as, “You appear ill,” “She
+looks young,” “The milk tastes sour.”</p>
+
+<p>Verbs that assert being are intransitive verbs.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section86"><b>86.</b> Intransitive verbs of being usually need a complement.
+In the sentence, “I am a spinner of long yarns,” if
+we had merely the subject and the verb, <i>I am</i>, we should ask,
+<i>am what?</i> The group of words <i>a spinner of long yarns</i> answers
+this question, and so completes the predicate. It is
+not an object complement, however, for it cannot name the
+receiver of an action since the verb does not assert action at
+all. This complement denotes identity with the subject;
+hence it is called a <b>subjective complement</b>.</p>
+
+<p>Often the subjective complement denotes the class to which
+the person or thing named by the subject belongs; as, “Corn
+is a grain,” “My friend is a farmer.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section87"><b>87.</b> The subject and the object complement denote two
+different persons or things, but the subject and the subjective
+complement always refer to the same person or thing.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section88"><b>88.</b> The subjective complement is sometimes a single noun,
+as in the sentence, “Stars are suns.” When the subjective
+complement is a group of words, a noun is usually the base
+word; as, “Procrastination is the thief of time.”</p>
+
+<p>In sentences containing a subjective complement, the subject
+comes before the verb, and the subjective complement
+after the verb, unless the sentence is transposed; as, “Lords
+of the sea are we.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section89"><b>89.</b> Sometimes, instead of having a complement, a verb
+of being is modified by a prepositional phrase, or even by an
+adverb, denoting place; as, “My bark is on the sea,” “Yonder
+is my home.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_68">[68]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—Verbs that assert <b>being</b> or <b>identity</b> are intransitive
+verbs.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>subjective complement</b> is a word or a group of words that
+completes a verb and refers to the same person or thing as
+the subject.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the intransitive verbs of being in
+the following sentences. Find their subjects and their complements,
+and the base words of each. Analyze sentences
+1, 3, 4, 5, 7, 9, 14.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. This palace was the residence of the queen consort of England.</p>
+
+<p>2.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The king was in his counting house, counting out his money,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The queen was in the parlor, eating bread and honey.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>3. My name is Beautiful Joe, and I am a brown dog of medium
+size.</p>
+
+<p>4. Her worship of God was unselfish service, and her prayers
+were worthy deeds.</p>
+
+<p>5. The one great poem of New England is her Sunday.</p>
+
+<p>6. This guinea pig’s name was Jeff, and he and I became good
+friends.</p>
+
+<p>7. Patient waiters are no losers.</p>
+
+<p>8. In this fine open square are magnificent fountains, handsome
+statuary on tall pedestals, and crowds of vehicles and foot passengers
+crossing it in every direction.</p>
+
+<p>9. A jackknife in his expert hand was a whole chest of tools.</p>
+
+<p>10. One of the best things in the world to be is a boy.</p>
+
+<p>11. Backbiting is the meanest kind of biting, not excepting the
+bite of fleas.</p>
+
+<p>12. The rattle of a bucket in a neighbor’s yard, no longer mixed
+with other weekday noises, seemed a new sound.</p>
+
+<p>13.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Little Boy Blue, come blow your horn.</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The sheep’s in the meadow, the cow’s in the corn.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>14. I became an enthusiastic little cook.</p>
+
+<p>15. King Arthur’s son was a handsome, polite, and brave knight.</p>
+
+<p>16. The bees are abroad under the calling sky, and the red of
+apple buds becomes a sign in the orchards.</p>
+
+<p>17. Always darker turns the growing hemp as it rushes upward.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Account for the punctuation of sentences 3, 4, 6, 8, and 15.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_69">[69]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXVI">XXVI. ADJECTIVES AS SUBJECTIVE COMPLEMENTS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section90"><b>90.</b> In the sentences, (1) “The tomato is a fruit,” (2)
+“That tall boy is the winner of the race,” the base word of
+the subjective complement is a noun, because we wish to assert
+(1) class, (2) identity.</p>
+
+<p>In the sentence, “The old gentleman’s face was serene and
+rosy,” the base words of the subjective complement are the
+two adjectives <i>serene</i> and <i>rosy</i>, because we wish to assert the
+characteristics, or qualities, of the old gentleman’s face.</p>
+
+<p>This is a very common use of the adjective, as seen in the
+familiar sentences, “Grass is green,” “Honey is sweet,”
+“Ice is cold.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section91"><b>91.</b> The verbs of being that were given in <a href="#XXV">Lesson XXV</a>,—<i>be</i>,
+<i>become</i>, <i>look</i>, <i>seem</i>, <i>appear</i>, <i>feel</i>, <i>smell</i>, <i>taste</i>, <i>sound</i>, and
+<i>grow</i>,—often take adjectives for subjective complements;
+as, “My head feels dizzy,” “This sentence sounds queer,”
+“Mary grew plump and strong.”</p>
+
+<p>In some cases where the language affords no adjectives
+that exactly express the meaning, we use a prepositional
+phrase as subjective complement; as in the common expressions,
+“The house is <i>on fire</i>,” “The girl is <i>in love</i>,” “The man
+is <i>in debt</i>.” None of these phrases denote place, but each of
+them denotes a condition.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—An adjective used as a subjective complement is often
+modified by a prepositional phrase. If we say “The bin is full,”
+somebody will ask “full of what?” If we say “full of apples,” it
+is evident that the phrase <i>of apples</i> modifies <i>full</i>. We also say <i>glad
+of it</i>, <i>tired of play</i>, <i>wild with joy</i>, <i>green with envy</i>, etc. These expressions
+are different, however, from what we find in the sentence,
+“I was tired in the evening,” where the phrase <i>in the evening</i>, denoting
+time, modifies not the adjective <i>tired</i>, but the two words <i>was
+tired</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_70">[70]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An adjective, or a group of words of which
+an adjective is the base word, may be the subjective complement
+of an intransitive verb.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the intransitive verbs of being in
+the following sentences. Find their subjects and their complements,
+and the base words of each. Analyze sentences
+1, 2, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 13, 15.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The sting of a bee is sometimes deadly.</p>
+
+<p>2. The woodchuck looked sulky, and scratched his nose expressively.</p>
+
+<p>3. The traveler’s limbs were numb, for the ride had been long
+and wearisome.</p>
+
+<p>4. She might be poor in purse and weak in body, this brave
+young mother, but she was rich in hope and strong in spirit.</p>
+
+<p>5. By the third day I felt too weak and sick to stir.</p>
+
+<p>6. At these words the king grew purple in the face.</p>
+
+<p>7. Conrad will keep quiet over his books.</p>
+
+<p>8. Mary was beautiful, feminine in spirit, and lovely. Elizabeth
+was talented, masculine, and plain. Mary was artless, unaffected,
+and gentle. Elizabeth was heartless, intriguing, and insincere.</p>
+
+<p>9. Your grandfather looked very funny in his red nightcap,
+and without his teeth.</p>
+
+<p>10. Very few poetic people are good at arithmetic.</p>
+
+<p>11. The garden at the back of the house was sweet with the
+scent of newly blossomed lilacs and the freshness of young grass.</p>
+
+<p>12. Snow-white was the foam that flashed upward underneath
+the curving prow.</p>
+
+<p>13. Is not Little Annie afraid of such a tumult?</p>
+
+<p>14. His mouth felt as dry and stiff and hard as a chip.</p>
+
+<p>15. The people went nearly mad for joy.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section92"><b>92.</b> A common error is the misuse of an adverb for an adjective
+as the subjective complement of a verb of being. We
+should say, “I feel <i>bad</i>, or <i>ill</i>, or <i>unhappy</i>” (not <i>badly</i>).</p>
+
+<p>Another common error is the misuse of an adjective for an
+adverb as a modifier of a verb of action. We should say,
+“The child learns <i>easily</i>” (not <i>easy</i>).</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_71">[71]</span></p>
+
+<p>If we wish to tell a quality or condition of the subject, we
+should use an adjective; as, “The oak leaves turned <i>brown</i>.”
+If we wish to tell the manner of an action, we should use an
+adverb; as, “The leaves turned <i>quickly</i> this fall.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Tell the part of speech of each italicized
+word in these sentences, and justify its use.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Mary dresses <i>neatly</i> and always looks <i>charming</i>.</p>
+
+<p>2. The children must keep <i>quiet</i> to-night.</p>
+
+<p>3. Stand <i>straight</i> and breathe <i>deeply</i>.</p>
+
+<p>4. Look at them <i>kindly</i> and speak <i>gently</i>.</p>
+
+<p>5. The old bishop looks <i>kind</i> and <i>gentle</i>.</p>
+
+<p>6. This pie tastes very <i>queer</i>.</p>
+
+<p>7. Mother feels <i>uneasy</i> if we are <i>out late</i>.</p>
+
+<p>8. The boy seemed <i>nervous</i> and felt <i>uneasily</i> of his watch chain.</p>
+
+<p>9. Poor oil made the lamp smell very <i>disagreeable</i>.</p>
+
+<p>10. All the doors stood <i>open</i>.</p>
+
+<p>11. The air grew <i>cold steadily</i>.</p>
+
+<p>12. Keep the box <i>carefully</i> till I return.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Select the right word for each of the following
+sentences, and give your reason in each case:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The light is so poor that I cannot see the picture (<i>plain</i> or
+<i>plainly</i>).</p>
+
+<p>2. I am frightened when she speaks (<i>cross</i> or <i>crossly</i>) to me.</p>
+
+<p>3. Sit with me so that you can hear (<i>good</i> or <i>well</i>).</p>
+
+<p>4. Does he always deal (<i>honest</i> or <i>honestly</i>) with you?</p>
+
+<p>5. The miser died (<i>miserable</i> or <i>miserably</i>).</p>
+
+<p>6. You came so (<i>sudden</i> or <i>suddenly</i>) that I was taken by surprise.</p>
+
+<p>7. No wonder you fell, you move too (<i>quick</i> or <i>quickly</i>).</p>
+
+<p>8. How (<i>stylish</i> or <i>stylishly</i>) she dresses.</p>
+
+<p>9. I (<i>sure</i> or <i>surely</i>) mailed the letter.</p>
+
+<p>10. Next time I shall act more (<i>sensible</i> or <i>sensibly</i>).</p>
+
+<p>11. Money comes (<i>easy</i> or <i>easily</i>) to him, and is soon gone.</p>
+
+<p>12. I felt so (<i>bad</i> or <i>badly</i>) that I cried.</p>
+
+<p>13. I was ill yesterday, but I feel pretty (<i>good</i> or <i>well</i>) this morning.</p>
+
+<p>14. All my rose bushes look (<i>fine</i> or <i>finely</i>).</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_72">[72]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXVII">XXVII. REVIEW OF VERBS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section93"><b>93.</b> A <b>verb</b> is an asserting word.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>transitive verb</b> is one that asserts action performed upon
+some person or thing.</p>
+
+<p>A transitive verb is completed by a <b>direct object</b>.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>direct object</b> of a transitive verb is a word or a group of
+words that completes the meaning of the verb and names
+the receiver of the action.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>base word</b> of a <b>direct object</b> is usually a noun.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>intransitive verb</b> is one that asserts, (1) being, or (2)
+action not performed upon any person or thing.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>intransitive verb of action</b> needs no complement.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>intransitive verb of being</b> is usually completed by a
+subjective complement.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>subjective complement</b> is a word or a group of words that
+completes a verb and refers to the same person or thing as
+the subject.</p>
+
+<p>A subjective complement denotes identity with the subject,
+or tells the class to which the subject belongs, or some quality
+of the subject.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>base word</b> of a <b>subjective complement</b> may be a noun
+or an adjective.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select and classify all the verbs in the following
+sentences. Tell the subject of each verb, and tell how
+each verb is completed or modified.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. As soon as he saw the cat in the soap barrel, he set the lamp
+down on the cellar bottom, and laughed so that he could hardly
+move.</p>
+
+<p>2. When night came, I felt still more lonesome.</p>
+
+<p>3. Little Toomai shall become a great tracker.</p>
+
+<p>4. The wind whistled around the low, unplastered chamber, but
+the beds were soft and warm, and the guests were ready for sleep.</p>
+
+<p>5. The youngest daughter was the gentlest and most beautiful
+creature ever seen, and the pride of all the people in the land.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_73">[73]</span></p>
+
+<p>6. I am too stiff and sore from a terrible fall I have had, to
+write more than one line.</p>
+
+<p>7. Next month, when the city had returned to its sunbaked
+quiet, the Hindu did a thing that no Englishman would have
+dreamed of doing; for, so far as the world’s affairs went,
+he died.</p>
+
+<p>8. The knoll in the tamarack swamp was a haven of peace amid
+the fierce but furtive warfare of the wilderness.</p>
+
+<p>9. Beauty rose by four o’clock every morning, lighted the fires,
+cleaned the house, and prepared the breakfast for the whole family.</p>
+
+<p>10. More years sped swiftly and tranquilly away.</p>
+
+<p>11. What a place the old market must have been in the days of
+Herod the Builder!</p>
+
+<p>12. The lizard belonging to my mistress was a very beautiful
+creature.</p>
+
+<p>13. The rocky walls are red with the scarlet of the geranium,
+aglow with the orange of the lantana, or they are hidden by the
+purple veil of the wild convolvulus. The dainty sweet alyssum
+clings to the rock in great patches, and the little rice plant lays its
+pink cheek against it lovingly.</p>
+
+<p>14. The spring had been a trying season for the lank she-bear.</p>
+
+<p>15. Right proud the baron was of his gallant steed.</p>
+
+<p>16. There is the house with the gate red-barred.</p>
+
+<p>17. The big male cuffed the cubs aside without ceremony, mounted
+the carcass with an air of lordship, glared about him, and suddenly
+with a snarl of wrath, fixed his eyes upon the green branches wherein
+the boy was concealed.</p>
+
+<p>18. Rip Van Winkle was a kind neighbor and an obedient, hen-pecked
+husband.</p>
+
+<p>19. The great error in Rip’s composition was an insuperable
+aversion to all kinds of profitable labor.</p>
+
+<p>20. The same sweet clover smell is in the breeze.</p>
+
+<p>21. David stooped down and piled the fagots in the hollow of
+his arm.</p>
+
+<p>22. Gentle are the days when the year is young.</p>
+
+<p>23. The winter sunshine on the fields seems full of rest.</p>
+
+<p>24. I feel out of place under this roof.</p>
+
+<p>25. Strips of snow still whitened the fields, but on the stumps
+were bluebirds, and they warbled of spring.</p>
+
+<p>26. The great limb of the cedar snapped off, rolled over in the
+air, and lay on the ground like a huge animal.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_74">[74]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXVIII">XXVIII. NOUNS: NUMBER</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section94"><b>94.</b> When we wish a noun to denote more than one object,
+we often change its form slightly. <i>Man</i> becomes <i>men</i>, <i>child</i>
+becomes <i>children</i>, <i>river</i> becomes <i>rivers</i>.</p>
+
+<p>This change in the form of a noun by which it denotes one
+object or more than one is called <b>number</b>.</p>
+
+<p>Number is said to be one of the <b>properties</b> of a noun.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section95"><b>95.</b> When a noun denotes one object, it is said to be in the
+singular number; as, <i>lion</i>, <i>mouse</i>, <i>knife</i>.</p>
+
+<p>When a noun denotes more than one object, it is said to
+be in the <b>plural</b> number; as, <i>lions</i>, <i>mice</i>, <i>knives</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section96"><b>96.</b> Most nouns form their plural by adding <i>s</i> or <i>es</i> to the
+singular; as, <i>key</i>, <i>keys</i>; <i>hand</i>, <i>hands</i>; <i>rope</i>, <i>ropes</i>; <i>mass</i>,
+<i>masses</i>; <i>fox</i>, <i>foxes</i>; <i>church</i>, <i>churches</i>; <i>bush</i>, <i>bushes</i>.</p>
+
+<p>This is said to be the <b>regular</b> way of forming the plural.
+Why is it that some words add <i>es</i> instead of <i>s?</i></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section97"><b>97.</b> Nouns ending in <i>o</i> preceded by a vowel form their
+plural by adding <i>s</i>; as, <i>folio</i>, <i>folios</i>; <i>cameo</i>, <i>cameos</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Some nouns ending in <i>o</i> preceded by a consonant add <i>es</i>,
+and others <i>s</i>; as, <i>potato</i>, <i>potatoes</i>; <i>mosquito</i>, <i>mosquitoes</i>; <i>solo</i>,
+<i>solos</i>; <i>piano</i>, <i>pianos</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section98"><b>98.</b> Some nouns form their plural <b>irregularly</b>.</p>
+
+<p>(1) A few nouns change the vowel; as, <i>man</i>, <i>men</i>; <i>goose</i>,
+<i>geese</i>; <i>mouse</i>, <i>mice</i>; <i>foot</i>, <i>feet</i>; <i>tooth</i>, <i>teeth</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(2) A few nouns add <i>en</i>; as, <i>ox, oxen</i>; <i>child, children</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(3) Nouns ending in <i>y</i>, preceded by a consonant sound,
+change <i>y</i> to <i>i</i> and add <i>es</i>; as, <i>fly, flies</i>; <i>fairy, fairies</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(4) Some nouns ending in <i>f</i> or <i>fe</i> change <i>f</i> or <i>fe</i> to <i>v</i> and
+add <i>es</i>; as, <i>wolf</i>, <i>wolves</i>; <i>knife</i>, <i>knives</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section99"><b>99.</b> Some nouns have the same form in both the singular
+and the plural; as, <i>deer</i>, <i>grouse</i>, <i>salmon</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_75">[75]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section100"><b>100.</b> Some nouns ending in <i>s</i> look like plural nouns, but
+are regarded as singular; as, <i>news</i>, <i>athletics</i>, <i>gymnastics</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section101"><b>101.</b> Some nouns are used only in the plural; as, <i>scissors</i>,
+<i>pincers</i>, <i>thanks</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section102"><b>102.</b> Compound nouns form their plural in three different
+ways:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) By adding <i>s</i> to the last word; as, <i>forget-me-not</i>, <i>forget-me-nots</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(2) By adding <i>s</i> to the principal word; as, <i>son-in-law</i>,
+<i>sons-in-law</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(3) By pluralizing both words; as, <i>manservant</i>, <i>menservants</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section103"><b>103.</b> When a title is used with one name, we may pluralize
+either the name or the title. We may say the <i>Misses Gray</i>
+or the <i>Miss Grays</i>, the <i>Messrs. Greenwood</i> or the <i>Mr. Greenwoods</i>.</p>
+
+<p>When a title is used with more than one name, we pluralize
+the title. We say the <i>Misses Morgan and Adams</i>. The title
+<i>Mrs.</i> has no plural, so we must say <i>Mrs. Morgan and Mrs.
+Adams</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section104"><b>104.</b> Letters, signs, or figures form their plurals by adding
+an apostrophe and <i>s</i>; as, 6’s, i’s, <i>t</i>’s.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section105"><b>105.</b> A few foreign nouns have kept their foreign plurals.
+Some of these in common use are <i>stratum</i>, <i>strata</i>; <i>alumnus</i>,
+<i>alumni</i>; <i>axis</i>, <i>axes</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section106"><b>106.</b> Some nouns have two plurals used with slightly
+different meanings; as, <i>penny</i> has <i>pennies</i> and <i>pence</i>; <i>brother</i>
+has <i>brothers</i> and <i>brethren</i>; <i>die</i> has <i>dies</i> and <i>dice</i>. Find out
+from the dictionary the meanings of these plurals.</p>
+
+<p>The correct plural of a noun cannot always be reasoned
+out. It should never be guessed. It can always be learned
+from a dictionary.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_76">[76]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—<b>Number</b> is that property of a noun by which
+it denotes one object or more than one.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>singular</b> noun denotes one object.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>plural</b> noun denotes more than one object.</p>
+
+<p>Nouns form their plural <b>regularly</b> by adding <i>s</i> or <i>es</i> to the
+singular.</p>
+
+<p>Many nouns form their plural <b>irregularly</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Tell the plural of each of the following nouns.
+Tell how it is formed. Consult the dictionary when you are
+in doubt.</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>alto</li>
+ <li>apostrophe</li>
+ <li>box</li>
+ <li>brush</li>
+ <li>calf</li>
+ <li>chromo</li>
+ <li>crisis</li>
+ <li>cupful</li>
+ <li>deer</li>
+ <li>Dutchman</li>
+ <li>elf</li>
+ <li>enemy</li>
+ <li>fez</li>
+ <li>fife</li>
+ <li>foot</li>
+ <li>German</li>
+ <li>half</li>
+ <li>hero</li>
+ <li>hoof</li>
+ <li>lasso</li>
+ <li>lioness</li>
+ <li>loaf</li>
+ <li>monkey</li>
+ <li>motto</li>
+ <li>mouse</li>
+ <li>negro</li>
+ <li>noose</li>
+ <li>Norman</li>
+ <li>oasis</li>
+ <li>piano</li>
+ <li>pony</li>
+ <li>sheaf</li>
+ <li>size</li>
+ <li>soprano</li>
+ <li>tableau</li>
+ <li>tooth</li>
+ <li>vertebra</li>
+ <li>volcano</li>
+ <li>wharf</li>
+ <li>court-martial</li>
+ <li>Dr. Wright</li>
+ <li>eyelash</li>
+ <li>flagstaff</li>
+ <li>General Allen</li>
+ <li>hanger-on</li>
+ <li>jack-in-the-pulpit</li>
+ <li>Miss Davis</li>
+ <li>passer-by</li>
+ <li>postmaster general</li>
+ <li>will-o’-the-wisp</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Select all the nouns in the following sentences,
+and tell whether they are singular or plural. Give
+the singular of each plural word, and the plural of each singular
+word.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Listen! In yonder pine woods what a cawing of crows!</p>
+
+<p>2. A washstand in the corner, a chest of carved mahogany
+drawers, a looking-glass in a filigree frame, and a high-backed chair
+studded with brass nails like a coffin constituted the furniture.</p>
+
+<p>3. There have always been medicine men, rain makers, wizards,
+conjurers, sorcerers, astrologers, and fortune tellers, ready to trade
+on the fears of the weak, the ignorant, and the superstitious.</p>
+
+<p>4. April brought the blue scylla and the sweet violet; May
+brought the much-loved narcissus and lily of the valley.</p>
+
+<p>5. In came the three Miss Fezziwigs, beaming and lovable.</p>
+
+<p>6. People hardly ever do know where to be born until it is too
+late.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_77">[77]</span></p>
+
+<p>7. The bell in the church tower was striking six, but I undressed
+for the night and buried myself under the bedclothes.</p>
+
+<p>8. As it fell out, the three princesses were talking one night of
+whom they would marry.</p>
+
+<p>9. Poor Mrs. Wise! I’m sure she’s to be pitied, living here
+with all these grandchildren.</p>
+
+<p>10. As soon as Pussy heard me shut the gate in the yard at
+noon, when school was done, she would run up the stairs as hard
+as she could go.</p>
+
+<p>11. The puppy’s nightly couch was outside the stable, even
+during the coldest weather.</p>
+
+<p>12. The fish, strange creatures called groupers, with great sluggish
+bodies and horribly human faces, come crowding up to be fed.</p>
+
+<p>13. What a hardy set of men they were, those Northmen of old!</p>
+
+<p>14. The streams that have entered into our American life come
+from springs very wide apart,—from the Puritan whom James I
+was persecuting, and from the courtiers whom he was patronizing;
+from the Dutchmen whom Charles II was fighting, and from the
+Covenanters whom he was trying to convert at the pistol’s point;
+from the Scotchmen who had captured the north of Ireland, and
+from the Huguenots who had been driven out of the south of France.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>What is the use of <i>listen</i>, sentence 1, <i>furniture</i>, 2, <i>horribly</i>,
+12?</p>
+
+<p>How are the adjectives <i>weak</i>, <i>ignorant</i>, and <i>superstitious</i>
+used in sentence 3?</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXIX">XXIX. NOUNS: GENDER</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section107"><b>107.</b> One of the characteristics of living things is sex; that
+is, all living things are male or female. Many nouns that are
+names of living things indicate sex. The noun <i>king</i> indicates
+the male sex. The noun <i>queen</i> indicates the female sex. The
+property of a noun by which it indicates the sex of the object
+named is called <b>gender</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section108"><b>108.</b> Since there are two sexes, there must be at least two
+genders. Nouns that indicate the male sex are said to be
+of the <b>masculine</b> gender; as, <i>hero</i>, <i>grandfather</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_78">[78]</span></p>
+
+<p>Nouns that indicate the female sex are said to be of the
+<b>feminine</b> gender; as, <i>hen</i>, <i>tigress</i>, <i>sister</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Note that sex, male or female, refers to a distinction, or
+difference, in the living creatures themselves, while gender
+is merely a property of their names that shows this distinction.
+It is absurd, therefore, to speak of a person of the masculine
+gender, but it is allowable to speak of masculine qualities,
+masculine attire, a masculine voice, etc.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section109"><b>109.</b> Since things without life have no sex, the nouns that
+name such things have no gender; as, <i>sky</i>, <i>tent</i>, <i>pie</i>. Such
+words are said to be of the <b>neuter</b> gender. <i>Neuter</i> means
+<i>neither</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section110"><b>110.</b> Some nouns that may be applied to persons of either
+male or female sex are said to be of <b>common</b> gender; as, <i>child</i>,
+<i>cousin</i>, <i>parent</i>, <i>clerk</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section111"><b>111.</b> Gender is denoted in three ways:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) By a pair of words; as, <i>man</i>, <i>woman</i>; <i>bull</i>, <i>cow</i>; <i>lad</i>,
+<i>lass</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(2) By inflection, that is, by adding a syllable to the masculine
+noun to form the feminine; as, <i>hero</i>, <i>heroine</i>; <i>lion</i>, <i>lioness</i>;
+<i>host</i>, <i>hostess</i>.</p>
+
+<p>What can you say of the words <i>widow</i> and <i>widower</i>?</p>
+
+<p>(3) By prefixing a word whose gender is well known; as,
+<i>bull moose</i>, <i>maidservant</i>, <i>she bear</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span> —Some feminine nouns are going out of use. We no
+longer use the words <i>poetess</i> or <i>authoress</i>. If a woman preaches,
+she is a minister; if she practices medicine, she is a doctor, not a
+“lady doctor.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—<b>Gender</b> is that property of a noun which indicates
+the sex or non-sex of the object named.</p>
+
+<p>There are four genders:—</p>
+
+<p>A noun of the <b>masculine gender</b> indicates the male sex.</p>
+
+<p>A noun of the <b>feminine gender</b> indicates the female sex.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_79">[79]</span></p>
+
+<p>A noun of the <b>neuter gender</b> indicates the absence of sex.</p>
+
+<p>A noun of <b>common gender</b> may indicate either the male
+or the female sex.</p>
+
+<p>Gender is denoted (1) by different words, (2) by inflection,
+(3) by prefixing some gender word.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Tell the gender of each noun in the following
+sentences. Tell how its gender is denoted. If you are in
+doubt about any word, consult the dictionary.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The she wolf lay agonizing in the darkest corner of the cave,
+licking in grim silence the raw stump of her right foreleg.</p>
+
+<p>2. The wild goose winging at the head of the V knew of good
+feeding grounds near by, which he was ready to revisit.</p>
+
+<p>3. Not vague was the fear of the brooding grouse in the far-off
+thicket, though the sound came to her but dimly.</p>
+
+<p>4. At the captain’s signal the <i>Seabird</i> came alongside, and Mr.
+Wintermute left Mrs. Howe and her little family to go on their
+journey alone.</p>
+
+<p>5. Having sniffed the air for several minutes, without discerning
+anything to interest him, the great bull moose bethought him
+of his evening meal.</p>
+
+<p>6. Here on the ridge a buck, with his herd of does and fawns,
+has established his winter “yard.”</p>
+
+<p>7. Without a second’s hesitation the cow flung up her tail,
+gave a short bellow, and charged the bear.</p>
+
+<p>8. Another thing that attracts attention is the animals tethered
+here, there, and everywhere. You see donkeys, goats, cows, even
+cats, hens, and turkeys, confined by the inevitable tether.</p>
+
+<p>9. Never before since the nestlings broke the shell had her mate
+been so long away.</p>
+
+<p>10. The pupils never entered the study except upon the most
+formal occasions.</p>
+
+<p>11. A fine cock grouse alighted on a log some forty paces distant,
+stretched himself, strutted, spread his ruff and wings and tail, and
+was about to begin drumming.</p>
+
+<p>12. Pedestrians walk where they will, here, there, or yonder.</p>
+
+<p>13. Several men-of-war, with a multitude of smaller craft, are
+at anchor in Grassy Bay, and the admiral’s ship is lying on the
+great floating dock for repairs.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_80">[80]</span></p>
+
+<p>14. Some civilians are buried here, and many little children;
+and I came upon a pathetic memorial to a fair young English wife,
+who followed her soldier husband hither with her little child, only
+to die on these far-off shores.</p>
+
+<p>15. Any animal that had died from natural causes the wolves
+would not touch, and they even rejected anything that had been
+killed by the stockmen. Their choice and daily food was the
+tenderer part of a freshly killed yearling heifer. An old bull or cow
+they disdained, and though they occasionally took a young calf or
+colt, it was quite clear that veal or horseflesh was not their favorite
+diet. It was also known that they were not fond of mutton, although
+they often amused themselves by killing sheep.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXX">XXX. POSSESSIVE NOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section112"><b>112.</b> Instead of saying, “I borrowed the knife belonging
+to Will,” we are likely to say, “I borrowed Will’s knife.”
+Here we have a new form of the noun <i>Will</i>. It is used with
+the noun <i>knife</i> to denote ownership of the knife, and is called
+a <b>possessive</b> noun.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section113"><b>113.</b> Since a possessive noun denotes ownership, it must
+be used with another noun, the name of the thing owned.
+The possessive noun is said to modify this other noun. In
+the expression <i>doctor’s car</i>, the possessive noun <i>doctor’s</i> modifies
+the noun <i>car</i>.</p>
+
+<p>When the name of the thing owned is well known, it is
+often omitted. We say, “I bought these skates at Percy’s,”
+and omit the word <i>store</i>. A word omitted in this way is said
+to be “understood.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section114"><b>114.</b> Possessive nouns have a certain form of their own.
+The possessive singular of a noun is formed by adding to it
+the apostrophe and <i>s</i>; as, <i>girl’s</i> desk; <i>friend’s</i> home; <i>George’s</i>
+boat.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—In a few common expressions, like <i>for Jesus’ sake</i>, <i>for conscience’ sake</i>,
+the possessive is formed, for the sake of euphony, by
+adding merely the apostrophe.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_81">[81]</span></p>
+
+<p>When the plural of a noun ends in <i>s</i>, the possessive plural
+is formed by adding an apostrophe; as, <i>girls’</i> league; <i>ladies’</i>
+bonnets.</p>
+
+<p>When the plural of a noun does not end in <i>s</i>, the possessive
+plural is formed by adding the apostrophe and <i>s</i>; as, <i>women’s</i>
+shoes; <i>oxen’s</i> yokes.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section115"><b>115.</b> When two persons are joint owners of one thing, we
+give the possessive form to the name of the second person
+only; as, <i>Lewis and Fred’s</i> boat.</p>
+
+<p>When two persons own separate things, the name of each
+person must have the possessive form; as, I went to <i>Mandel’s</i>
+and <i>Field’s</i>, meaning two different stores.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section116"><b>116.</b> Compound nouns form the possessive by adding the
+sign of possession to the last word; as, singular, <i>son-in-law’s</i>;
+plural, <i>sons-in-law’s</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section117"><b>117.</b> The possessive noun does not always express actual
+ownership. Thus, “an <i>hour’s</i> walk” means a walk lasting
+an hour, “<i>Lowell’s</i> poems,” means the poems written by
+Lowell, “a <i>child’s</i> grief” means the grief felt by a child.
+What is the meaning of <i>the day’s work</i>? <i>a good night’s rest</i>?
+<i>a year’s vacation</i>? <i>the king’s death</i>?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section118"><b>118.</b> Possession may be denoted by a phrase beginning with
+the preposition <i>of</i>. This phrase is much used. We say <i>the
+back of the chair</i>, not <i>the chair’s back</i>; <i>the roots of the elm</i>, not
+<i>the elm’s roots</i>. This phrase enables us to avoid some awkward
+possessives. What may we say instead of <i>my cousin’s
+wife’s sister</i>? <i>the king of Greece’s court</i>?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section119"><b>119.</b> In the expression “this book of John’s,” we have what
+is called a <b>double possessive</b>, for we have the possessive noun
+<i>John’s</i>, and the phrase introduced by <i>of</i>. We use the double
+possessive when the noun denoting the thing owned is first
+modified by some adjective, as <i>a</i>, <i>the</i>, <i>this</i>, <i>every</i>, <i>both</i>, <i>no</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_82">[82]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>possessive noun</b> denotes ownership.</p>
+
+<p>A possessive noun modifies another noun, expressed or
+understood.</p>
+
+<p>The possessive singular is formed by adding the apostrophe
+and <i>s</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The possessive plural is formed by adding the apostrophe
+and <i>s</i> if the noun does not end in <i>s</i>, and the apostrophe alone
+if the noun does end in <i>s</i>.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>double possessive</b> is a phrase consisting of the preposition
+<i>of</i> followed by some possessive word.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Write the possessive of each of these nouns.
+Tell whether it is singular or plural.</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>attorney-general</li>
+ <li>chairman</li>
+ <li>city</li>
+ <li>colonies</li>
+ <li>Colonel Cleveland</li>
+ <li>commander in chief</li>
+ <li>Charles Dickens</li>
+ <li>daughters-in-law</li>
+ <li>dwarfs</li>
+ <li>foxes</li>
+ <li>geese</li>
+ <li>goddess</li>
+ <li>groomsman</li>
+ <li>Frenchman</li>
+ <li>John Keats</li>
+ <li>ladies</li>
+ <li>major generals</li>
+ <li>Miss James</li>
+ <li>mulatto</li>
+ <li>sailor boy</li>
+ <li>thief</li>
+ <li>witches</li>
+ <li>woodpecker</li>
+ <li>yeoman</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Select all the possessive nouns in the following
+sentences. Tell what nouns they modify, and whether they
+are singular or plural. Tell also the gender of each possessive.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The lady’s fondness and the gentleman’s blindness were
+topics ably handled at every sewing circle in the town.</p>
+
+<p>2. St. Paul’s is the largest Protestant church in the world.</p>
+
+<p>3. Last year’s nuts are this year’s black earth.</p>
+
+<p>4. On the way home we stopped at the baker’s to get some
+cream puffs.</p>
+
+<p>5. Every debt of my partner’s has been paid.</p>
+
+<p>6. The woodsman’s aim was true.</p>
+
+<p>7. The singers’ seats, where the pretty girls sat, were the most
+conspicuous of all.</p>
+
+<p>8. A half hour’s tramp through difficult woods brought him to
+the nearest of the waters.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_83">[83]</span></p>
+
+<p>9. In August we had two weeks’ vacation.</p>
+
+<p>10. This editorial of Roosevelt’s is attracting much attention.</p>
+
+<p>11. Sulphur they could buy at the apothecary’s.</p>
+
+<p>12. The horse is coal-black, which is the regulation color of the
+Horse-Guards’ horses.</p>
+
+<p>13. My clothes and my father’s were packed in a little leather valise.</p>
+
+<p>14. The backwoodsman cast a tender look on the sleepers’ faces,
+and slipped out of the cabin door as silently as a shadow.</p>
+
+<p>15. Just where we leave the highway to go to Gibbs’s Hill we
+pass a ruined house.</p>
+
+<p>16. He had melted up his wife’s gold thimble and his great-grandfather’s
+gold-bowed spectacles.</p>
+
+<p>17. I called on Nancy because she was a friend of Miss Davis’s.</p>
+
+<p>18. Can you give a traveler a night’s lodging?</p>
+
+<p>19.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">When beechen buds begin to swell,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">And woods the bluebird’s warble know,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The yellow violet’s modest bell</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">Peeps from the last year’s leaves below.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Analyze sentences 2, 3, 5, 6, 8, 9, 11, 16.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXXI">XXXI. NOUNS: CASE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section120"><b>120.</b> We have seen that a noun may be used in different
+relations to other words in the sentence. It may be related
+to a verb, for instance, as subject, as object, and as subjective
+complement. That property of a noun which shows
+its relation to some other word in the sentence is called <b>case</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section121"><b>121.</b> The three most important and striking relations that
+a noun may bear are these: subject of a verb, object of a
+verb, and possessive modifier. Hence there are three cases.</p>
+
+<p>When a noun is the subject of a verb, we say that it is in
+the <b>nominative</b> case.</p>
+
+<p>When it is the object of a verb, we say that it is in the
+<b>objective</b> case.</p>
+
+<p>When it is a possessive modifier, we say that it is in the
+<b>possessive</b> case.</p>
+
+<p>The pronoun has the same three cases as a noun.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_84">[84]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section122"><b>122.</b> A noun is said to be <b>declined</b> when we give its three
+case forms in both the singular and the plural number.</p>
+
+<p class="center"><span class="smcap">Declension of</span> <i>child</i></p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Nom.</i></td>
+ <td>child</td>
+ <td>children</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Poss.</i></td>
+ <td>child’s</td>
+ <td>children’s</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Obj.</i></td>
+ <td>child</td>
+ <td>children</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="section" id="section123"><b>123.</b> The noun in the nominative case is used in other relations
+besides that of subject of a verb. The subjective
+complement is in the nominative case, as well as the noun
+used independently.</p>
+
+<p>When a noun is object of a preposition, it is in the objective
+case.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—<b>Case</b> is that property of a noun or a pronoun
+which shows its relation to some other word in the sentence.</p>
+
+<p>There are three cases.</p>
+
+<p>A noun used as subject of a verb, as subjective complement,
+as an exclamatory noun, or as a term of address is in the
+<b>nominative case</b>.</p>
+
+<p>A noun used as object of a verb or of a preposition is in the
+<b>objective case</b>.</p>
+
+<p>A noun used as a possessive modifier is in the <b>possessive
+case</b>.</p>
+
+<p><b>Declension</b> is the arrangement of the three case forms of a
+noun in the two numbers.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Tell the use, the case, the number, and the
+gender of every noun in these sentences.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The chill glitter of the northern summer sunrise was washing
+down over the rounded top of old Sugar Loaf.</p>
+
+<p>2. Thank him according to our customs, Mowgli.</p>
+
+<p>3. What a good draught the nag takes!</p>
+
+<p>4. Alas! Kitty Clover, they say it is wicked; that I must not
+catch grasshoppers for a pussy cat on Sunday.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_85">[85]</span></p>
+
+<p>5. Why doesn’t your mother make a fresh cup of coffee?</p>
+
+<p>6. We might shovel off the snow, and dig down to some of last
+year’s onions.</p>
+
+<p>7. Pilgrim fathers! why should we not glorify the pilgrim
+mothers?</p>
+
+<p>8. What did Peterson Sahib mean by the elephant dance?</p>
+
+<p>9. The boy is the shoemaker’s friend.</p>
+
+<p>10.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Mistress Mary, quite contrary,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">How does your garden grow?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>11. I didn’t ask the captain’s leave when I attended this ceremony,
+for I had a general idea that he wouldn’t give it.</p>
+
+<p>12. Cæsar is certainly the handsomest and most gentlemanly cat
+I ever saw.</p>
+
+<p>13. How was the Princess’s nose ring the cause of your misfortune?</p>
+
+<p>14.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Comrade, where wilt thou be to-night.</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">When the loosed storm breaks furiously?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>15. Indeed all the really pretty girls that you see are Americans.</p>
+
+<p>16. When I opened the goldfinch’s door on the morning of the
+blackbird’s arrival, he paid no attention to his beloved bath, but
+instantly flew over and alighted on the cage of the newcomer.</p>
+
+<p>17. These ten cows knew their names after a while, and would
+take their places as I called them.</p>
+
+<p>18. Oh! but he was a tight-fisted hand at the grindstone, was
+Scrooge.</p>
+
+<p>19.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">O time and change! how strange it seems</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">With so much gone to still live on!</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXXII">XXXII. NOUNS: THE APPOSITIVE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section124"><b>124.</b> It is frequently necessary to explain some term we
+use, and there is a convenient way for doing this without
+making a new sentence. For instance, an author writes,
+“One of these buildings belongs to the Horse Guards.” Then,
+for fear we may not know who the Horse Guards are, he adds
+these explanatory words, “a very fine body of English cavalry.”</p>
+
+<p>This group of words consists of the noun <i>body</i> used as a base
+word, modified by the prepositional phrase <i>of English cavalry</i>,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_86">[86]</span>the adjective element <i>very fine</i>, and the article <i>a</i>. The whole
+group is placed beside the term it explains, and is separated
+from it by a comma. Such a group of words is called an <b>appositive</b>,
+and the base word <i>body</i> is called <b>a noun in apposition</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section125"><b>125.</b> Sometimes we explain who a person is by using his
+name; as, “I heard your friend, <i>John Richards</i>, say that
+he was going to write to you.”</p>
+
+<p>Sometimes the name of a person or animal or place is used
+first, and then explained by a group of words; as, “Akela,
+<i>the great gray Lone Wolf</i>, lay out at full length on his rock.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section126"><b>126.</b> The appositive and the term it explains are in reality
+two names for the same person or thing. You might think
+that either one could be called the appositive, but this is
+not so. It is the explanatory term that is the appositive, and
+this is the second of the two terms.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section127"><b>127.</b> Sometimes, when there is no danger of any misunderstanding,
+the appositive comes at a little distance from the
+word it modifies; as, “Splendid buildings meet our eyes at
+every turn,—churches, private residences, places of business,
+and public edifices.” Can you account for this arrangement?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section128"><b>128.</b> Sometimes an appositive has been used so long with
+the word it modifies that the two have become united into
+one name; as, Peter the Hermit, Peter the Great, William
+the Conqueror. Such an appositive is not set off by a comma.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—In the term Peter the Great, the adjective <i>great</i> has
+become a noun, and is modified by the adjective <i>the</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section129"><b>129.</b> When ownership is to be denoted, the sign of possession
+is added to the appositive instead of to the term that it explains;
+as, “The poet Milton’s daughter,” “Mr. Taft, the
+president’s, cow,” “My friend Julia’s husband.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_87">[87]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>appositive</b> is a word or a group of words
+placed after a term to explain it.</p>
+
+<p>When the base word of an appositive is a noun, it is called
+a <b>noun in apposition</b>.</p>
+
+<p>The case of a noun in apposition is the same as that of the
+noun it explains.</p>
+
+<p>An appositive is a modifier of a noun or a pronoun.</p>
+
+<p>An appositive is set off from the rest of the sentence by
+commas unless it makes one term with the word it modifies.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the appositives in the following sentences,
+and tell what they modify. Find the nouns in apposition.
+Tell the case of each, giving the reason in each instance.
+Analyze sentences 1, 2, 3, 5, 6, 8, 9, 10, 11, 16.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Alfred the Great loved books and strangers and travelers.</p>
+
+<p>2. In the neatest, sandiest hole of all lived Benjamin’s aunt and
+his cousins,—Flopsy, Mopsy, Cottontail, and Peter.</p>
+
+<p>3. The conversation turned to rheumatism, a subject of very
+remote interest to Polly.</p>
+
+<p>4. My son William became a telegraph operator before he was
+seventeen.</p>
+
+<p>5. James II, the bigoted successor of Charles I, had annulled
+the charters of all the colonies.</p>
+
+<p>6. The geography lesson that day was the rivers of Asia,—the
+Obi, Yenisei, Lena, Amoor, Hoang Ho, and Yang-tse-kiang.</p>
+
+<p>7. Some writers tell us that Edward the Confessor had made a
+will appointing Duke William his successor.</p>
+
+<p>8. Foremost among the envious ones was the Princess Panka,
+the daughter of a neighboring king.</p>
+
+<p>9. Close to Charing Cross is Trafalgar Square, a fine open space
+with a fountain, and a column to Lord Nelson.</p>
+
+<p>10. The body of Warwick the kingmaker was exposed for three
+days on the pavement of St. Paul’s, and then deposited among the
+ashes of his fathers in the abbey of Bilsam.</p>
+
+<p>11. The pass was crowned with dense, dark forest,—deodar,
+walnut, wild cherry, wild olive, and wild pear.</p>
+
+<p>12. Kaa, the big Rock Python, had changed his skin for perhaps
+the two hundredth time since his birth.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_88">[88]</span></p>
+
+<p>13. Eric the Red, a wandering Norseman who was dwelling in
+Iceland, went to sea and discovered Greenland.</p>
+
+<p>14. There are so many things to distract a boy’s attention,—a
+chipmunk in the fence, a bird on a near tree, and a henhawk circling
+high in the air over the barnyard.</p>
+
+<p>15. Very soundly it slept, that doomed hare crouching under the
+fir bush!</p>
+
+<p>16. They had never been accounted for, Rebecca’s eyes.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXXIII">XXXIII. APPOSITIVE ADJECTIVES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section130"><b>130.</b> Adjectives are not always placed before the noun they
+modify. When they are used as subjective complements, they
+follow the verb, although they modify the subject; as, “Life
+is <i>real</i>,” “The air seems <i>moist</i>.” We also find many sentences
+like the following, “The camel, restless and weary,
+groans and occasionally shows his teeth.”</p>
+
+<p>Here it is evident that the adjectives <i>restless</i> and <i>weary</i> are
+in the sentence to describe the camel; hence they modify the
+noun <i>camel</i>; but instead of preceding this noun, they follow it.
+Because of their position such adjectives are called <b>appositive
+adjectives</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section131"><b>131.</b> An appositive adjective is usually set off by a comma
+or commas. It is frequently modified by a phrase, as in the
+expressions, “restless under his heavy load,” “weary with
+the long journey.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An adjective with or without modifiers may
+be used as an appositive.</p>
+
+<p>An appositive adjective is usually set off from the rest of
+the sentence by a comma.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the appositive adjectives in these
+sentences, and tell what they modify. Give the modifiers
+of each adjective. Account for the punctuation. Analyze
+sentences 2, 4, 5, 6, 7, 11, 12.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_89">[89]</span></p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. His tunic, scarlet in color, is of the softest woolen fabric.</p>
+
+<p>2. The skirt drops to the knee in folds heavy with embroidery.</p>
+
+<p>3. Grandfather Nutter was a hale, cheery old gentleman, as
+straight and as bald as an arrow.</p>
+
+<p>4. The pink rose, dear for its old associations, was transplanted
+to a sunny place close by the south door.</p>
+
+<p>5. Presently the Colonel came in, bluff, warm, and hearty.</p>
+
+<p>6. From the other window one saw the distant forest, so deep,
+black, and mysterious.</p>
+
+<p>7. The April night, softly chill and full of the sense of thaw,
+was closing down over the wide salt marshes!</p>
+
+<p>8. Presently, from far along the dark heights of the sky, came
+voices, hollow, musical, confused.</p>
+
+<p>9. Here is a foot passenger, dusty and tired, who comes with
+lagging steps.</p>
+
+<p>10. There is no nation known to history in which all citizens,
+male and female, old and young, native and foreign born, have had
+the suffrage.</p>
+
+<p>11. Ginger hurried off into the darkness, wild with excitement.</p>
+
+<p>12. The chief engineer entered the smoking room for a moment,
+red, smiling, and wet.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXXIV">XXXIV. INDIRECT OBJECT</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section132"><b>132.</b> We have seen that the direct object names the receiver
+of the action asserted by the verb. In the sentence,
+“Kotuko made his dog a tiny harness,” the direct object of the
+verb <i>made</i> is a <i>tiny harness</i>, for this group of words tells what
+received the making, and answers the question <i>made what?</i></p>
+
+<p>If we go further and ask the question, <i>made a harness for
+what?</i> the answer is, <i>his dog</i>. This group of words is called
+the indirect object. It names the receiver of the direct object;
+that is, the dog received the harness.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section133"><b>133.</b> An indirect object is always in the objective case, but
+it is not a complement of the verb, because it is not a necessary
+element of a sentence. We call it a modifier of the verb. The
+sentence, “In the morning the old wife gave the princess
+three nuts,” would be complete if we left out the indirect
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_90">[90]</span>object <i>the princess</i>, and merely told what the old wife gave,
+namely, three nuts.</p>
+
+<p>Notice that the indirect object comes between the verb
+and the direct object. If we place it after the direct object,
+we must supply the preposition <i>to</i> or <i>for</i>, and then instead of
+an indirect object we shall have a prepositional phrase.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>indirect object</b> is a word or a group of
+words that tells to whom or for whom, to what or for what,
+something is done.</p>
+
+<p>An indirect object names the receiver of the direct object.</p>
+
+<p>An indirect object precedes the direct object.</p>
+
+<p>An indirect object is a modifier of a verb.</p>
+
+<p>An indirect object is in the objective case.</p>
+
+<p>Only a few transitive verbs take both direct and indirect
+objects. Some of them are <i>bring</i>, <i>buy</i>, <i>do</i>, <i>get</i>, <i>give</i>, <i>lend</i>, <i>make</i>
+<i>pass</i>, <i>pay</i>, <i>promise</i>, <i>sell</i>, <i>send</i>, <i>show</i>, <i>take</i>, <i>tell</i>, <i>write</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Write sentences containing both direct and
+indirect objects, using verbs in the list above.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Select both the direct and the indirect objects
+in the following sentences, giving reasons:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Carry your grandmamma a custard and a little pot of butter.</p>
+
+<p>2. Aladdin made his mother very little reply.</p>
+
+<p>3. I showed my comrades a large heap of stones.</p>
+
+<p>4. Mrs. Howe had promised the children presents, so she bought
+George a gun, Mollie two gold rings, and Paul a checkerboard.</p>
+
+<p>5. I wish the Lord would give horses voices for just one week.</p>
+
+<p>6. Bring my mother six women slaves to attend her.</p>
+
+<p>7. If you offer Dash a bit of sheep’s wool now, he tucks his tail
+between his legs, and runs for home.</p>
+
+<p>8. I never told my schoolmates that I was a Yankee.</p>
+
+<p>9. I paid Gypsy a visit every half hour during the first day of
+my arrival.</p>
+
+<p>10. Then the magician gave Aladdin a handful of small money.</p>
+
+<p>11. Father Andrew also taught Tom a little Latin.</p>
+
+<p>12. The sultan granted Aladdin his request and again embraced
+him.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_91">[91]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXXV">XXXV. ADVERBIAL NOUN PHRASES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section134"><b>134.</b> We have learned that a frequent modifier of a verb
+is a prepositional phrase telling the place or time of an action;
+as, “So off we go in the cool, clear morning.”</p>
+
+<p>Sometimes a noun, or a group of words of which a noun is
+the base word, takes the place of this prepositional phrase;
+as, “<i>Last summer</i> the apple trees bore no fruit.”</p>
+
+<p>The words <i>last summer</i> tell time, and modify the predicate
+<i>bore no fruit</i>, but there is no preposition in this group of words.
+<i>Summer</i> is a noun modified by the adjective <i>last</i>. Such a
+group of words we call an <b>adverbial noun phrase</b>. The noun
+used as base word we call an <b>adverbial noun</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section135"><b>135.</b> An adverbial noun phrase tells not only time and
+place, but it often answers such questions as <i>how far?</i> <i>how
+long?</i> <i>how much?</i> as, “We walked <i>the whole distance</i> before
+sunset.” “She stayed in London <i>ten days</i>.” “One orange
+weighed <i>twelve ounces</i>.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>adverbial noun phrase</b> is a group of words
+of which a noun is the base word, that tells the time or place
+of an action, or how long, how far, or how much.</p>
+
+<p>An adverbial noun phrase modifies a verb.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>adverbial noun</b> is always in the objective case.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select the adverbial noun phrases and the
+nouns used as base words. Tell what the phrases modify,
+and what questions they answer. (Notice that these phrases
+often modify more of the predicate than just the verb.) Analyze
+sentences 1, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. He followed her to school one day.</p>
+
+<p>2. Each boy who failed to report himself was fined one cent.</p>
+
+<p>3. Elizabeth Eliza went home directly.</p>
+
+<p>4. Morning, noon, and night, Dame Van Winkle’s tongue was
+incessantly going.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_92">[92]</span></p>
+
+<p>5. His keen, sonorous, passionate cry rang strangely on the
+night, three times.</p>
+
+<p>6. The trail was an easy one this time.</p>
+
+<p>7. There the wild plum each summer fruited abundantly; and
+there a sturdy brotherhood of beeches each autumn lavished their
+treasure of three-cornered nuts.</p>
+
+<p>8. I worked a whole week to get the traps properly set out.</p>
+
+<p>9. The next instant the panther received a smart blow on the
+top of his head.</p>
+
+<p>10. Kala Nag, the elephant, stood ten fair feet at the shoulder.</p>
+
+<p>11. Ere the cow had gone twenty-five yards, Lobo was upon her.</p>
+
+<p>12. The next morning Mrs. Peterkin began by taking out the
+things that were already in her trunk.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXXVI">XXXVI. ADVERBIAL NOUN PHRASES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section136"><b>136.</b> When we wish to tell how long, or wide, or deep, or
+thick a thing is, we frequently make use of such statements
+as these:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>The valley is nine miles long.</p>
+
+<p>The street is sixty feet wide.</p>
+
+<p>The water is ten fathoms deep.</p>
+
+<p>The slices were an inch thick.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>It is evident that in the first sentence the question <i>how
+long?</i> is answered by the words <i>nine miles</i>. Hence this group
+of words modifies the adjective <i>long</i>, having the same use as
+the adverb <i>very</i> in, “The valley is very long.” But the base
+word of this group is the noun <i>miles</i>, hence the whole group
+must be an adverbial noun phrase. We conclude from this
+familiar sentence that an adverbial noun phrase may modify
+an adjective.</p>
+
+<p>What adverbial noun phrase modifies <i>wide</i>? <i>deep</i>? <i>thick</i>?</p>
+
+<p>Make sentences in which an adverbial noun phrase modifies
+the adjectives <i>old</i>, <i>tall</i>, <i>high</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section137"><b>137.</b> The adverbial noun phrase may also modify an adverb,
+as in the sentence, “She came two hours afterward,”
+where <i>two hours</i> answers the question <i>how long afterward?</i>
+How do we know that <i>afterward</i> is an adverb?</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_93">[93]</span></p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—A common illustration of this use is found in the familiar
+expression <i>a short time ago</i>, where the adverb <i>ago</i> (which is never used
+by itself) is modified by the adverbial noun phrase <i>a short time</i>.
+Think of five other noun phrases often used to modify <i>ago</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An adverbial noun phrase may modify an adjective
+or an adverb. In such a case it denotes a measure
+of some sort.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select the adverbial nouns and the phrases of
+which they are the base words. Tell what these phrases
+modify, and what questions they answer.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. About an hour later a big red fox came trotting into the
+glade.</p>
+
+<p>2. When the stone was pulled up, there appeared a staircase
+about three or four feet deep, leading to a door.</p>
+
+<p>3. The trail was perhaps an hour old.</p>
+
+<p>4. After viewing old Fort Snelling, we walked a mile farther to
+the parade ground, and watched the soldiers drill.</p>
+
+<p>5. An ordinary wolf’s forefoot is four and one half inches long.</p>
+
+<p>6. Lobo stood three feet high at the shoulder, and weighed one
+hundred and fifty pounds.</p>
+
+<p>7. If the crows do not kill the owl, they at least worry him half
+to death and drive him twenty miles away.</p>
+
+<p>8. It is a curious fact about boys that two will be a great deal
+slower in doing anything than one.</p>
+
+<p>9. When the eagle returned an hour later to the point of shoals,
+the net looked less strange to him.</p>
+
+<p>10. Twenty-five years ago the American minister at the court
+of Turin was conversing with a young Italian of high rank from the
+island of Sardinia.</p>
+
+<p>11. The largest aboriginal structure of stone within the limits of
+the United States has a circuit of 1480 feet, is five stories high, and
+once included five hundred separate rooms.</p>
+
+<p>12. How many years did Jacob serve for Rachel?</p>
+
+<p>13. The week before the election one of the candidates for mayor
+spoke to an audience of laboring men every evening.</p>
+
+<p>14. That day I left the university, and my trial took place a
+little while later.</p>
+
+<p>15. David reflected a few moments longer.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_94">[94]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXXVII">XXXVII. OBJECTIVE COMPLEMENT</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section138"><b>138.</b> In the sentence, “The boys called the turtles Harry
+Blake’s sheep,” the verb is followed by two noun elements.
+What are they? The second element is not an appositive
+of the first, neither have we here a direct and an indirect
+object. Prove this.</p>
+
+<p>If we ask the question, <i>What</i> did the boys call Harry
+Blake’s sheep? the answer is, <i>the turtles</i>; hence this must be
+the direct object of <i>called</i>. But the sentence is not complete
+here. We do not mean that the boys <i>called</i> the turtles, that
+is, <i>summoned</i> them. We mean that they <i>named</i> the turtles.
+If we ask the question, “What did the boys call the turtles?”
+the answer is, “<i>Harry Blake’s sheep</i>.” This group of words
+is necessary as a second complement of the verb, and at the
+same time it tells what the turtles became as a result of calling,
+or naming, them. Such an element is called an <b>objective
+complement</b>, because it tells something about the direct object.</p>
+
+<p>The base word of an objective complement is in the objective
+case.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section139"><b>139.</b> Not all transitive verbs take an objective complement;
+but only verbs of making or causing, such as <i>make</i>,
+<i>call</i>, <i>name</i>, <i>elect</i>, <i>appoint</i>, <i>choose</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section140"><b>140.</b> Sometimes the objective complement has an adjective
+for its base word instead of a noun; as, “The great wood-fire
+in the tiled chimney place made our sitting room <i>very
+cheerful</i> of winter nights.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>objective complement</b> is a word or a
+group of words that helps to complete the verb, and tells what
+the direct object becomes as a result of the action asserted
+by the verb.</p>
+
+<p>The base word of an objective complement may be either
+a noun or an adjective.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_95">[95]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Find all the objective complements in the
+following sentences and tell about them in this way:—</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Model.</span>—<i>Ben called this room his cabin.</i></p>
+
+<p><i>His cabin</i> is a noun element used as objective complement
+of the verb <i>called</i>, because it tells what the direct object,
+<i>this room</i>, becomes as a result of the calling. The base word
+of this objective complement is the noun <i>cabin</i>.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. His blue beard made him so ugly and so terrible in appearance
+that women and children fled from him.</p>
+
+<p>2. She kept the cottage always as neat as a new pin.</p>
+
+<p>3. By much trampling we had made the salt marsh a mere
+quagmire.</p>
+
+<p>4. This mother, proud of her knowledge of French, always
+called her little daughter Mademoiselle.</p>
+
+<p>5. If ever I have a boy to bring up in the way he should go, I
+shall make Sunday a cheerful day to him.</p>
+
+<p>6. To the great amusement of my grandfather, Sailor Ben
+painted the cottage a light sky-blue.</p>
+
+<p>7. Then, inch by inch, the untempered heat crept into the
+heart of the Jungle, turning it yellow, brown, and at last black.</p>
+
+<p>8. The fish had buried themselves deep in the dry mud.</p>
+
+<p>9. The natives of Bermuda call the tamarisk the “salt-cedar.”</p>
+
+<p>10. Nature meant him for a frontiersman, but circumstances
+made him an innkeeper.</p>
+
+<p>11. The only way that they could set the king’s head straight was
+to remove it.</p>
+
+<p>12. Columbus rechristened the island San Salvador, but its precise
+identity has always been a little doubtful.</p>
+
+<p>13. A parrot would shriek me wild in a week.</p>
+
+<p>14. Skin changing always makes a snake moody and depressed
+till the new skin begins to shine and look beautiful.</p>
+
+<p>15. The giver makes the gift precious.</p>
+
+<p>16. The sound of a bell struck the merrymakers dumb.</p>
+
+<p>17. Who appointed you judge of your brother?</p>
+
+<p>18. The dim light of stars rendered large objects near at hand
+visible in bulk and outline.</p>
+
+<p>19. We call domestic animals dependent creatures; but who
+made them dependent?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_96">[96]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXXVIII">XXXVIII. PARSING OF NOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section141"><b>141.</b> When we tell all that is true about a noun from a
+grammatical point of view, we are said to <b>parse</b> it.</p>
+
+<p>In parsing a noun we should tell:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Its class,—common or proper.</p>
+
+<p>(2) Its person,—first, second, or third. (See Note.)</p>
+
+<p>(3) Its number,—singular or plural.</p>
+
+<p>(4) Its gender,—masculine, feminine, neuter, or common.</p>
+
+<p>(5) Its case,—nominative, possessive, or objective.</p>
+
+<p>(6) Its use in the sentence.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—Nouns do not change their <i>form</i> for <b>person</b>. Since they
+are almost always the names of persons or things spoken of, they
+are usually in the <i>third person</i>. A noun is in the <i>first person</i> when
+it is used in apposition with a pronoun of the first person. (See <a href="#Page_98">p. 98</a>.)
+A noun is in the <i>second person</i> (1) when it is used in apposition with
+a pronoun of the second person; (2) when it is used as a term of
+address.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Parse each noun in the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. All the great men of the neighborhood were there on horseback,—militia
+officers in uniform, the member of Congress, the
+sheriff of the county, the editors of newspapers, and many a farmer,
+too, had mounted his patient steed or come on foot.</p>
+
+<p>2. Next day Mowgli himself fell into a very cunning leopard trap.</p>
+
+<p>3. The Bermudas are, with the exception of Gibraltar, England’s
+most strongly fortified hold.</p>
+
+<p>4. Then Mrs. Howe graciously showed the admiring ladies her
+collection of fine lace and embroideries.</p>
+
+<p>5. The thoughtful, lonely ways of their admiral made Columbus
+an object of terror to his ignorant seamen.</p>
+
+<p>6. I thought that nothing in the world was so beautiful as the
+sultan my father’s palace.</p>
+
+<p>7. Perhaps your fish is eighteen inches long.</p>
+
+<p>8. Here comes the boat! This is your waterproof, Hetty.
+Be careful now, Miss Alice. Mrs. Blank, you will need your sun
+umbrella. Hold on a minute, skipper, till I get that basket.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_97">[97]</span></p>
+
+<p>9. At nine o’clock, Williams, a bronze Hercules, low-voiced,
+gentle-mannered, a trusty boatman, and an enthusiast in his calling,
+met us at the dock.</p>
+
+<p>10. The savage sticks bright feathers in his hair, carries a tomahawk,
+and wears moccasins upon his nimble feet.</p>
+
+<p>11. Some evenings afterward the same thing happened at another
+corner of the pasture.</p>
+
+<p>12. The innocent savages gave Columbus a new world for Castile
+and Leon, and he gave them some glass beads and little red caps.</p>
+
+<p>13. The sultan received the present from Aladdin’s mother’s hand.</p>
+
+<p>14. The elephant was thoughtfully chewing the green stem of a
+young plantain tree.</p>
+
+<p>15. In the good old days the boys on the coast ran away and
+became sailors.</p>
+
+<p>16. I was a favorite with the cooks, and so, although they denied
+my cousins certain privileges of the kitchen, they freely granted
+these to me.</p>
+
+<p>17. The Norsemen called gold “the serpent’s bed.”</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<h3><span class="smcap">Summary of Case Relations</span></h3>
+
+<p>Nominative.</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>(1) Subject of a verb.</li>
+ <li>(2) Term of address.</li>
+ <li>(3) Exclamatory noun.</li>
+ <li>(4) Subjective complement of a verb.</li>
+ <li>(5) Appositive.</li>
+ <li>(6) Nominative absolute (see <a href="#Page_237">p. 237</a>).</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p>Possessive.</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>(1) Modifier of a noun.</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p>Objective.</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>(1) Object of a verb.</li>
+ <li>(2) Object of a preposition.</li>
+ <li>(3) Appositive.</li>
+ <li>(4) Indirect object.</li>
+ <li>(5) Adverbial noun.</li>
+ <li>(6) Objective complement.</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p>Make an original sentence to illustrate each of the case relations
+of a noun.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_98">[98]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XXXIX">XXXIX. PERSONAL PRONOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section142"><b>142.</b> Certain pronouns, as <i>I</i>, <i>you</i>, <i>he</i>, <i>it</i>, etc., show by their
+form that they refer to the person speaking, the person spoken
+to, or the person or thing spoken of.</p>
+
+<p>The pronoun <i>I</i> denotes the person speaking, and is said to
+be a pronoun of the <b>first person</b>.</p>
+
+<p>The pronoun <i>you</i> denotes the person spoken to, and is said
+to be a pronoun of the <b>second person</b>.</p>
+
+<p>The pronouns <i>he</i>, <i>she</i>, and <i>it</i> denote the person or thing
+spoken of, and are said to be pronouns of the <b>third person</b>.</p>
+
+<p>Such pronouns are called <b>personal</b> pronouns.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section143"><b>143.</b> The noun that a pronoun stands for, whether it is
+expressed somewhere in the sentence or merely understood,
+is called the <b>antecedent</b> of the pronoun.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section144"><b>144.</b> All the personal pronouns have several different forms,
+and if we wish to speak our language correctly, we must know
+these forms and be careful in their use. The personal pronouns
+are declined as follows:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">First Person</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Second Person</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Nom.</i></td>
+ <td>I</td>
+ <td>we</td>
+ <td>you</td>
+ <td>you</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Poss.</i></td>
+ <td>my, mine</td>
+ <td>our, ours</td>
+ <td>your, yours</td>
+ <td>your, yours</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Obj.</i></td>
+ <td>me</td>
+ <td>us</td>
+ <td>you</td>
+ <td>you</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th colspan="4"><span class="smcap">Third Person</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th colspan="3"><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Masculine</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Feminine</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Neuter</span></th>
+ <th></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Nom.</i></td>
+ <td>he</td>
+ <td>she</td>
+ <td>it</td>
+ <td>they</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Poss.</i></td>
+ <td>his</td>
+ <td>her, hers</td>
+ <td>its</td>
+ <td>their, theirs</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Obj.</i></td>
+ <td>him</td>
+ <td>her</td>
+ <td>it</td>
+ <td>them</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="section" id="section145"><b>145.</b> There is another personal pronoun of the second person—<i>thou</i>.
+It is not used in conversation nowadays, but
+is frequently found in the Bible and in poetry. It is declined
+as follows:—</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_99">[99]</span></p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Nom.</i></td>
+ <td>thou</td>
+ <td>ye</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Poss.</i></td>
+ <td>thy, thine</td>
+ <td>your, yours</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Obj.</i></td>
+ <td>thee</td>
+ <td>you</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>personal pronoun</b> is one that shows by
+its form whether it denotes the person speaking, the person
+spoken to, or the person or thing spoken of.</p>
+
+<p>The personal pronouns are <i>I</i>, <i>thou</i>, <i>you</i>, <i>he</i>, <i>she</i>, <i>it</i>, and their
+various case forms in the two numbers.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>antecedent</b> of a pronoun is the word for which it stands.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the personal pronouns. Tell from
+the form of each its person and number, and, if it is a pronoun
+of the third person, tell also its gender. Where it is possible,
+tell the antecedent of the pronoun.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Hide me in the oven.</p>
+
+<p>2. First lay aside your black veil, then tell us why you put it on.</p>
+
+<p>3. While we were following the direction of his finger, a sound of
+distant oars fell on our ears.</p>
+
+<p>4. If you want a thing, and have no money to buy it, go without
+it until you can pay for it.</p>
+
+<p>5. Though the Jungle People drink seldom, they must drink
+deep.</p>
+
+<p>6. The whelps were evidently very young, but their ears were
+wide open, and they stood up on strong legs when the boy touched
+them gently with his palm.</p>
+
+<p>7. “Well,” said grandfather, “I tell you one thing; the game
+will last me till that poor cat gets well again.”</p>
+
+<p>8. They sent him for troops only the sweepings of the galleys.</p>
+
+<p>9.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">My driftwood fire will burn so bright!</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">To what warm shelter canst thou fly?</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">I do not fear for thee, though wroth</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The tempest rushes through the sky.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>10. Caught in a steel trap, she had gnawed off her own paw as
+the price of freedom.</p>
+
+<p>11. At recess he gave me the core of his apple, though there were
+several applicants for it.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_100">[100]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XL">XL. USES OF PERSONAL PRONOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section146"><b>146.</b> The personal pronoun, since it takes the place of a
+noun, has almost all the uses of a noun. It may be,—</p>
+
+<p>(1) The subject of a verb; as, “<i>I</i> only know <i>I</i> cannot
+drift beyond His love and care.”</p>
+
+<p>The subject of an imperative sentence is always the pronoun
+<i>you</i>, <i>thou</i>, or <i>ye</i>, but this pronoun is seldom expressed;
+as, “Telegraph for staterooms at once.”</p>
+
+<p>(2) The base word of a term of address; as, “Ho, <i>ye</i> who
+suffer, know ye suffer for yourselves.”</p>
+
+<p>(3) The subjective complement of a verb; as, “This man,
+good Ilderim, is <i>he</i> who told you of me.”</p>
+
+<p>(4) The base word of an appositive phrase; as, “The
+fourth lackey, <i>he</i> of the two gold watches, poured the chocolate
+out.”</p>
+
+<p>(5) A possessive modifier; as, “All the harmless wood folk
+were <i>his</i> friends.”</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—The possessive pronoun is often intensified by the adjective
+<i>own</i>, which modifies the same noun that the possessive pronoun
+modifies; as, “This is <i>my own</i>, my native land.”</p>
+
+<p>(6) The direct object of a verb; as, “The farm boy spreads
+the grass after the men have cut <i>it</i>.”</p>
+
+<p>(7) The object of a preposition; as, “What a new world
+did that party open to <i>him</i>!”</p>
+
+<p>(8) An indirect object; as, “Here will the cattle come to
+drink, and I will kill <i>me</i> a yearling heifer.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select and parse all the personal pronouns
+in the following sentences. In parsing a personal pronoun
+we should tell its person, number, gender, antecedent, case,
+and use in the sentence.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. I verily believe that my ill looks alone saved me a flogging.</p>
+
+<p>2. Taste the tamarisk, and you get the very flavor of the brine.</p>
+
+<p>3. Then I swung my lasso, and sent it whistling over his head.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_101">[101]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. They worked together, read together, walked together,
+planned together, she and her daughter, and in all things were
+friends and companions.</p>
+
+<p>5. Mother Wolf would throw up her head, and sniff a deep
+snuff of satisfaction as the wind brought her the smell of the tiger
+skin on the Council Rock.</p>
+
+<p>6. The old crow spread the shells out in the sun, turned them
+over, lifted them one by one in his beak, dropped them, nestled on
+them as though they were eggs, toyed with them, and gloated over
+them like a miser.</p>
+
+<p>7. The spirits have spoken to Kotuko. They will show him
+open ice. He will bring us the seal again.</p>
+
+<p>8. The rank swamp grass concealed the nest where Raggylug’s
+mother had hidden him.</p>
+
+<p>9.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Across the lowly beach we flit,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">One little sandpiper and I.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>10. Up jumped Scarface, for it was he, and ran.</p>
+
+<p>11.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">And a voice that was calmer than silence said,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">“Lo! It is I. Be not afraid.”</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>12. Nearly every cottage in England has its little garden full of
+blooming plants and shrubs.</p>
+
+<p>13.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">“Who gives himself with his alms feeds three,—</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Himself, his hungering neighbor, and Me.”</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>14. This is he that was spoken of by the prophet.</p>
+
+<p>15. Arise, and take the young child and his mother, and flee into
+Egypt, and be thou there until I bring thee word.</p>
+
+<p>16.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">I called my servant, and he came;</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">How kind it was of him</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">To mind a slender man like me,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">He of the mighty limb.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>17. Prepare ye the way of the Lord, make his paths straight.</p>
+
+<p>18. It is so slippery and shiny down here, and the stage is so
+much too big for me, that I rattle round in it till I’m almost black
+and blue.</p>
+
+<p>19. These are they who have passed through much tribulation.</p>
+
+<p>20. O thou that rollest above, round as the shield of my fathers,
+whence comes thy everlasting light?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section147"><b>147.</b> Many errors are made in the form of personal pronouns.</p>
+
+<p>(1) When a pronoun is used as the subject of a verb, it
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_102">[102]</span>must have the nominative form, hence the correct answer to
+the question, Who is there? is <i>I</i> (not <i>me</i>).</p>
+
+<p>(2) When several pronouns are used as the subject of the
+same verb, the pronoun of the second person should come
+first, and the pronoun of the first person should come last.
+We should say,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p><i>You and he and I</i> have been chosen.</p>
+
+<p><i>You and I</i> were on time.</p>
+
+<p><i>He and I</i> read the book.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Can you justify Whittier’s lines?</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Ah, brother, only <i>I and thou</i></div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Are left of all that circle now.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>(3) For the subject of a sentence we may use the expressions
+<i>we boys</i>, <i>we girls</i>, <i>we Americans</i>, etc.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p><i>We girls</i> bought the pictures.</p>
+
+<p><i>We boys</i> set up the tents.</p>
+
+<p><i>We Baptists</i> had a church supper.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>(4) A pronoun used as the complement of an intransitive
+verb of being must have the nominative form. We should
+say,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Yes, it was <i>I</i>.</p>
+
+<p>No, it was not <i>she</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Perhaps it is <i>he</i>.</p>
+
+<p>It is surely <i>they</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>(5) A pronoun used as object of a verb must have the objective
+form. We should say,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Mrs. Albee invited mother and <i>me</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Did you see Julia and <i>me</i> in the gallery?</p>
+
+<p>Didn’t you expect <i>him and her</i>?</p>
+
+<p>She will never suspect <i>you and me</i>.</p>
+
+<p>That team can’t beat <i>us boys</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_103">[103]</span></p>
+
+<p>(6) A pronoun used as object of a preposition must have
+the objective form. We should say,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Leo wrote first to <i>her</i> and <i>me</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Father will call for <i>you</i> and <i>me</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Between <i>you</i> and <i>me</i> he was afraid.</p>
+
+<p>There is a great difference between Carrie and <i>me</i>.</p>
+
+<p>They can never catch up with <i>us girls</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Fill each blank in the following sentences with
+a pronoun having the correct case form. Give your reasons.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Mother says that it was —— and not —— that paid off the
+mortgage.</p>
+
+<p>2. Who left the room first? ——, but Mary was close behind
+——.</p>
+
+<p>3. —— fellows are going to have a debating society.</p>
+
+<p>4. The German teacher gave you and —— the same passage to
+translate.</p>
+
+<p>5. There must be no secrets between —— and ——.</p>
+
+<p>6. When do you expect Grandmother and ——?</p>
+
+<p>7. Perhaps —— girls are most to blame.</p>
+
+<p>8. Nobody chose —— or ——, so —— and —— sat on the stairs
+and talked.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XLI">XLI. USES OF POSSESSIVE PERSONAL PRONOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section148"><b>148.</b> When we studied the declension of personal pronouns,
+we learned that all of them except <i>it</i> and <i>he</i> have two
+forms in the possessive case. These forms are <i>my</i>, <i>mine</i>;
+<i>our</i>, <i>ours</i>; <i>thy</i>, <i>thine</i>; <i>your</i>, <i>yours</i>; <i>her</i>, <i>hers</i>; and <i>their</i>, <i>theirs</i>.
+There is a difference in the use of these two forms.</p>
+
+<p>The pronouns of the first form,—<i>my</i>, <i>our</i>, <i>thy</i>, <i>your</i>, <i>her</i>,
+and <i>their</i>, as well as <i>his</i> and <i>its</i>, are used with nouns as possessive
+modifiers. We say, <i>my father</i>, <i>our school</i>, <i>her hat</i>, <i>its
+population</i>, etc.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section149"><b>149.</b> The pronouns of the second form,—<i>mine</i>, <i>ours</i>,
+<i>thine</i>, <i>yours</i>, <i>hers</i>, <i>theirs</i>, and also <i>his</i>, are used alone, that is,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_104">[104]</span>they are not followed by a noun, the name of the thing possessed.
+We say, “<i>Mine</i> is too heavy,” when the object
+spoken of—a waterproof, for instance—is well known by
+both speaker and listener. Or we say, “Her writing is clear,
+but I like <i>his</i> better,” where it is unnecessary to repeat the
+noun <i>writing</i> after <i>his</i>.</p>
+
+<p>In the first sentence <i>mine</i> is the subject of the verb is, and
+in the second <i>his</i> is the object of the verb <i>like</i>. We even find
+the possessive form used as the object of a preposition; as,
+“If the book isn’t in my desk, it must be in <i>yours</i>.”</p>
+
+<p>This use of the possessive forms <i>mine</i>, <i>his</i>, <i>yours</i> as subject
+or object is <b>idiomatic</b>; that is, it is peculiar to itself in grammatical
+construction. The one word <i>mine</i> really means <i>my
+waterproof</i>, <i>his</i> means <i>his writing</i>, and <i>yours</i> means <i>your desk</i>.
+But we cannot say that the noun is understood after these
+pronouns, for we cannot supply it except after <i>his</i>. It is not
+English to say <i>mine waterproof</i> or <i>yours desk</i>. Instead of
+being understood, the nouns are included in the pronouns. In
+speaking of such pronouns we may say that they are possessive
+in form, but are used idiomatically as subject, object, etc.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—The two pronouns <i>mine</i> and <i>thine</i> are sometimes used to
+modify a noun expressed, especially in poetry; as, “Mine eyes have
+seen the glory of the coming of the Lord.” It is worth noting that
+they are not used before words beginning with a consonant sound.
+We do not say <i>mine country</i>, nor <i>thine liberty</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section150"><b>150.</b> In the expression “a friend of mine,” we have in the
+phrase <i>of mine</i> a “double possessive” (see <a href="#section119">§ 119</a>); for the
+preposition <i>of</i> denotes possession, and so does the object, the
+possessive pronoun <i>mine</i>. In this use there is no noun included
+in the pronoun. <i>Mine</i> does not mean <i>my friends</i>.
+It means <i>me</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The possessive pronouns <i>mine</i>, <i>ours</i>, <i>thine</i>,
+<i>yours</i>, <i>hers</i>, <i>his</i>, and <i>theirs</i> may be used idiomatically without
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_105">[105]</span>a noun to modify. These pronouns have then the same use
+that the noun would have if it were expressed.</p>
+
+<p>These pronouns may be used as the object of the preposition
+<i>of</i> to form “double possessives.”</p>
+
+<p><i>Mine</i> and <i>thine</i> are sometimes used to modify nouns expressed,
+the same as <i>my</i> and <i>thy</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the possessive pronouns in these sentences,
+and tell their use:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. You have no uncle by your father’s side or mine.</p>
+
+<p>2. To thine own self be true.</p>
+
+<p>3. The people of Europe did not know that America, this great
+country of ours, was in the world at all.</p>
+
+<p>4. This young girl came to Wisconsin to live with an uncle of
+hers who had seven sons and no daughters.</p>
+
+<p>5. Early in the spring I had begun Bingo’s education. Very
+shortly afterward he began mine.</p>
+
+<p>6. Stand! The ground’s your own, my braves!</p>
+
+<p>7. A boy who lived in a street behind ours had an awkward
+three-wheeled machine that he called a “verlosophy.”</p>
+
+<p>8.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">He will say, “O Love, thine eyes</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Build the shrine my soul abides in;</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And I kneel here for thy grace.”</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>9. The boy saw big, clutching talons outstretched from thick-feathered
+legs, while round eyes, fiercely gleaming, flamed upon his
+in passing, as they searched the bush.</p>
+
+<p>10. Time hath his work to do, and we have ours.</p>
+
+<p>11. The sultan ordered that the princess’s attendants should
+come and carry the trays into their mistress’s apartment.</p>
+
+<p>12. Susie could sew like a woman, and her patchwork quilts were
+masterpieces of their kind. Neither mine nor Marty’s were well made.</p>
+
+<p>13. Your worthy father was my own brother.</p>
+
+<p>14. There was more joy in this little brown, battened house of ours
+than in their mansion with its onyx mantels and mahogany doors.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Are the verbs in sentences 1, 7, 10, transitive or intransitive?
+How do you know?</p>
+
+<p>Account for the punctuation of sentences 3, 6, 10, 12, and
+14.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_106">[106]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XLII">XLII. COMPOUND PERSONAL PRONOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section151"><b>151.</b> Besides the personal pronouns that have already been
+considered there are certain other forms such as <i>myself</i> and
+<i>ourselves</i>, formed by uniting the noun <i>self</i> to a singular personal
+pronoun, and the noun <i>selves</i> to a plural personal pronoun.</p>
+
+<p>These are called <b>compound personal pronouns</b>.</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>First person</i></td>
+ <td>myself,</td>
+ <td>ourselves</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Second person</i></td>
+ <td>thyself, yourself,</td>
+ <td>yourselves</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Third person</i></td>
+ <td>himself, herself, itself,</td>
+ <td>themselves</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>What is the number of each of these pronouns?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section152"><b>152.</b> Compound personal pronouns are never in the possessive
+case. They never change their form for case, but are
+in the nominative or the objective case according to their
+use. They have two main uses:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) A compound personal pronoun may be used for emphasis,
+and is then in apposition with the noun it makes
+emphatic; as, “Cæsar himself refused the crown.” The pronoun
+does not always come next to the noun. We may say,
+“Cæsar refused the crown himself.” The pronoun is in the
+same case as the word it goes with.</p>
+
+<p>(2) It may be used reflexively, that is, to show that an
+action comes back to the doer of it; as, “I scratched myself
+with a pin.” Here the pronoun is object of a verb, hence in
+the objective case.</p>
+
+<p>It may also be the object of a preposition; as, “I was
+talking to myself.”</p>
+
+<p>It may even be an indirect object; as, “She bought herself
+a watch.”</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—The compound personal pronoun is used as object of a
+preposition in some familiar idiomatic expressions; as, “He was
+<i>beside himself</i> with joy.” “She was sitting <i>all by herself</i>.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_107">[107]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The <b>compound personal pronouns</b> are <i>myself</i>,
+<i>ourselves</i>, <i>thyself</i>, <i>yourself</i>, <i>yourselves</i>, <i>himself</i>, <i>herself</i>,
+<i>itself</i>, and <i>themselves</i>.</p>
+
+<p>They are commonly used for two purposes:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) For emphasis, (2) reflexively.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select and parse all the compound personal
+pronouns in the following sentences. Tell their person, number,
+case, and use.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Love thyself last.</p>
+
+<p>2. The men folks, having worked in the regular hours, lie down
+and rest, stretch themselves idly in the shade at noon, or lounge
+about after supper.</p>
+
+<p>3. Very stupid people are never aware of their stupidity themselves.</p>
+
+<p>4. On cold, stormy evenings we would make ourselves toast at
+the sitting room fire, and eat our supper on the little sewing table.</p>
+
+<p>5. At the more remote end of the island Legrand had built
+himself a small hut.</p>
+
+<p>6. A masterly retreat is in itself a victory.</p>
+
+<p>7. Now make yourselves at home, and if you find an eel’s head,
+you may bring it to me.</p>
+
+<p>8. The little fox ground his pearly milk teeth into the mouse with
+a rush of inborn savageness that must have surprised even himself.</p>
+
+<p>9. They were returning home for the holidays in high glee, and
+promising themselves a world of enjoyment.</p>
+
+<p>10. Pity for his gallant horse, rage and mortification at the ridiculous
+plight he was in, anxiety lest he should be late for the tournament,
+all combined to make the baron for a time beside himself.</p>
+
+<p>11. Rivermouth itself is full of hints and flavors of the sea.</p>
+
+<p>12. I think the ugly duckling will grow up strong, and be able to
+take care of himself.</p>
+
+<p>13. With what awe, yet with what pride, did I look forward to the
+day when I myself should enter the doorway of the high school.</p>
+
+<p>14. That I may have nobody to blame but myself should my
+marriage turn out amiss, I will choose for myself.</p>
+
+<p>15. Although the English and we ourselves both speak the same
+tongue, we do not speak it in the same way.</p>
+
+<p>16. Heaven helps those who help themselves.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Analyze sentences 1, 3, 4, 6, 9, 11.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_108">[108]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XLIII">XLIII. INTERROGATIVE PRONOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section153"><b>153.</b> If we ask the question, “Who killed cock robin?”
+the answer may be the declarative sentence, “The sparrow
+killed cock robin.” The sentences are alike, except that in
+the declarative sentence <i>the sparrow</i> is the subject, while in the
+interrogative sentence <i>who</i> is the subject. It is clear then
+that <i>who</i> is used instead of the noun <i>sparrow</i>. <i>Who</i> is therefore
+a pronoun, and since it is used in asking a question, we
+call it an <b>interrogative pronoun</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section154"><b>154.</b> The other interrogative pronouns are <i>whose</i>, <i>whom</i>,
+<i>which</i>, and <i>what</i>. <i>Whose</i> is the possessive form of <i>who</i>, and
+is used, like other possessive pronouns, to modify some noun
+expressed or understood; as, “Whose house is the gray stone
+mansion on the corner?”</p>
+
+<p><i>Whom</i> is the objective form of <i>who</i>, and is used as the object
+of a verb or of a preposition; as, “Whom did he marry?”
+“To whom did you speak?”</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—In conversation, the preposition governing an interrogative
+pronoun is often placed at the end of the question; as, “Whom
+did you come for?”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section155"><b>155.</b> <i>What</i> is used when we inquire for the name, not of a
+person but of a thing; as, “What did he have on his head?”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section156"><b>156.</b> <i>Which</i> is used when we wish to know the particular
+one of several persons or things; as, “Which of these moon-stones
+do you like best?”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section157"><b>157.</b> In a sentence like this, “Who is that tall man?” it
+may be difficult at first thought to decide whether <i>who</i> is the
+subject of <i>is</i> or the subjective complement. We can always
+tell by the answer. In this case the answer is, “That tall
+man is Joseph Choate.” It is clear that <i>Joseph Choate</i> is the
+subjective complement, hence in the question the word <i>who</i>,
+which means <i>Joseph Choate</i>, is the subjective complement.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_109">[109]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>interrogative pronoun</b> is one used in asking
+a question.</p>
+
+<p>The interrogative pronouns are <i>who</i>, <i>which</i>, and <i>what</i>.</p>
+
+<p><i>Who</i> is declined: Nominative, <i>who</i>; possessive, <i>whose</i>;
+objective, <i>whom</i>.</p>
+
+<p>An interrogative pronoun has the same use in the question
+that the word which takes its place has in the answer.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the interrogative pronouns in these
+sentences. Tell the use and case of each. Determine this
+by answering the question that is asked.</p>
+
+<p>Analyze sentences 1, 4, 6, 8, 10, 11, 12, 15.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. What made you so late?</p>
+
+<p>2. Who is there?</p>
+
+<p>3. Who is this young and handsome officer now entering the
+door of the tavern?</p>
+
+<p>4. Whose work is this crayon drawing of a castle in the moonlight?</p>
+
+<p>5. What do you mean by telling me such nonsense as that?</p>
+
+<p>6. What may so bold a hunter kill?</p>
+
+<p>7. Who should know better than I?</p>
+
+<p>8. What is all this talk about the Red Flower?</p>
+
+<p>9. What is gingerbread?</p>
+
+<p>10. Whose is this image and superscription?</p>
+
+<p>11. With whom did you take that memorable trip on Lake
+Superior?</p>
+
+<p>12. Whose little girl are you, with your rosy cheeks and pretty
+red hood?</p>
+
+<p>13. Whom did the superintendent mean when he announced that
+the youngest pupil in the grammar school had made one hundred in
+all her examinations?</p>
+
+<p>14. Which should you rather be, an artist or a poet?</p>
+
+<p>15. Which shall I take, a new piano or a trip to California?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section158"><b>158.</b> A common error in the use of interrogative pronouns
+is the use of the nominative form <i>who</i> when the objective
+<i>whom</i> is required. This error arises from the fact that the
+pronoun comes at the beginning of the sentence, and is separated
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_110">[110]</span>by intervening words from the verb or the preposition
+of which it is the object, as in these sentences,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Whom did the ball hit?</p>
+
+<p>Whom do you sit with this term?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Supply the proper pronoun, <i>who</i> or <i>whom</i>, in
+each of the following sentences, and give your reasons:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. —— does the baby look like?</p>
+
+<p>2. —— do I see in the orchard?</p>
+
+<p>3. —— did you go to the station for this morning?</p>
+
+<p>4. —— are you smiling at, George?</p>
+
+<p>5. —— does Mr. Coburn work for now?</p>
+
+<p>6. —— will open this window for me?</p>
+
+<p>7. —— can we depend upon?</p>
+
+<p>8. —— is that child playing with?</p>
+
+<p>9. —— have you invited to your party?</p>
+
+<p>10. —— can keep a secret?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XLIV">XLIV. DESCRIPTIVE ADJECTIVES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section159"><b>159.</b> We learned in <a href="#IX">Lesson IX</a> that adjectives are used (1)
+to describe objects, (2) to point them out. Adjectives are
+therefore divided into two classes,—(1) <b>descriptive adjectives</b>,
+and (2) <b>limiting adjectives</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section160"><b>160.</b> Descriptive adjectives tell the qualities of objects.
+They are very useful words, for they enable us to see things
+with the imagination. In the following sentence the well-chosen
+adjectives make us feel that we are looking into the
+very eyes of the eagle,—“His eyes, clear, direct, unacquainted
+with fear, had a certain hardness in their vitreous brilliancy,
+perhaps by reason of the sharp contrast between the bright
+gold iris and the unfathomable pupil.”</p>
+
+<p>It is also through descriptive adjectives that we are able
+to identify things when we do see them. After reading this
+sentence we could pick out a moose calf from a score of other
+animals,—“The moose calf is uncouth, to be sure, with his
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_111">[111]</span>high, humped fore shoulders, his long, lugubrious, overhanging
+snout, his big ears set low on his big head, his little eyes
+crowded back toward his ears, his long, big-knuckled legs,
+and the spindling lank diminutiveness of his hind quarters.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section161"><b>161.</b> One variety of descriptive adjective is the adjective
+derived from a proper noun; as, <i>Scotch</i> from <i>Scotland</i>, <i>French</i>
+from <i>France</i>, and <i>Greek</i> from <i>Greece</i>. These are called <b>proper
+adjectives</b>.</p>
+
+<p>Proper adjectives include within themselves many other
+adjectives. If we speak of a Scotch collie, a French costume,
+or a Grecian nose, the listener gets the same picture that
+he would get if we used a long series of other adjectives.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section162"><b>162.</b> Many proper adjectives may be used as proper nouns,
+naming a class of people, as when we speak of the Scotch,
+the French, the Russians, the Americans.</p>
+
+<p>What proper noun have we to name the inhabitants of
+Spain? of Turkey? of Denmark? of Sweden?</p>
+
+<p>What proper noun have we to designate one man who is a
+native of England? of Scotland? of France? of China?
+Italy? Germany? What is the plural of each of these nouns?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Supply the correct word in each of the following
+sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Three (<i>French</i> or <i>Frenchmen</i>) spent the evening at the house.</p>
+
+<p>2. The (<i>French</i> or <i>Frenchmen</i>) are said to be very polite.</p>
+
+<p>3. Why are so many (<i>Scotch</i> or <i>Scotchmen</i>) captains of steamships?</p>
+
+<p>4. Are the (<i>Irish</i> or <i>Irishmen</i>) as thrifty as the Germans?</p>
+
+<p>5. Are there many (<i>Welsh</i> or <i>Welshmen</i>) in this locality?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—<b>Descriptive adjectives</b> are those which tell
+the qualities of objects.</p>
+
+<p><b>Proper adjectives</b> are those derived from proper nouns.
+They always begin with a capital letter.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_112">[112]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Write a list of the proper adjectives derived
+from the following proper nouns. Use them in sentences to
+modify appropriate nouns.</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>Africa</li>
+ <li>Alaska</li>
+ <li>Asia</li>
+ <li>China</li>
+ <li>Christ</li>
+ <li>Denmark</li>
+ <li>England</li>
+ <li>Germany</li>
+ <li>India</li>
+ <li>Ireland</li>
+ <li>Italy</li>
+ <li>Japan</li>
+ <li>Jew</li>
+ <li>Malta</li>
+ <li>Norway</li>
+ <li>Paris</li>
+ <li>Portugal</li>
+ <li>Spain</li>
+ <li>Sweden</li>
+ <li>Turkey</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—In the following sentences select all the
+descriptive adjectives and tell what objects they describe.
+In so far as you can, tell what qualities the adjectives denote,
+as color, size, form, texture, surface, material, nature, etc.
+Account for the punctuation and capitalization.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. All the time the crocodile’s little eyes burned like coals under
+the heavy, horny eyelids on the top of his triangular head, as he
+shoved his bloated barrel body along between his crutched legs.</p>
+
+<p>2. It is a little village of great antiquity, having been founded
+by some of the Dutch colonists in the early times of the province.</p>
+
+<p>3. The dog and his master hunted together, fur-wrapped boy
+and savage, long-haired, narrow-eyed, white-fanged, yellow brute.</p>
+
+<p>4. We always smiled to hear the judge’s wife talk about her
+Turkish carpets, her little Chippendale chairs, her Wedgwood
+china, and her Persian shawls.</p>
+
+<p>5. This crowded, lively, and interesting thoroughfare is over
+two miles long.</p>
+
+<p>6. In queer little <i>châlets</i>, or Swiss huts, live the people who
+attend to the cattle, and make butter and cheese.</p>
+
+<p>7. The split and weatherworn rocks of the gorge had been used
+since the beginning of the Jungle by the Little People of the Rocks,—the
+busy, furious, black, wild bees of India.</p>
+
+<p>8. At every stride the loose-hung, wide-cleft, spreading hoofs
+of the moose came sharply together with a flat, clacking noise.</p>
+
+<p>9. Out comes the negro pilot, and scrambles up on deck.</p>
+
+<p>10. Yonder lies a Norwegian ship, with her sailors climbing the
+shrouds like so many monkeys.</p>
+
+<p>11. Mowgli’s voice could be heard in all sorts of wet, starlighted,
+blossoming places, helping the big frogs through their choruses, or
+mocking the upside-down owls that hoot through the white nights.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_113">[113]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XLV">XLV. LIMITING ADJECTIVES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section163"><b>163.</b> Limiting adjectives are those which merely point out
+an object without telling any quality of it. The most useful
+limiting adjectives are <i>this</i>, <i>that</i>, and their plural forms <i>these</i>
+and <i>those</i>. These four words are often called <b>demonstrative
+adjectives</b>.</p>
+
+<p>Some limiting adjectives tell number or amount, but in a
+somewhat indefinite way, as <i>all</i>, <i>some</i>, <i>several</i>, <i>few</i>, <i>much</i>, <i>little</i>,
+<i>more</i>, <i>most</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Some tell number definitely, as <i>one</i>, <i>two</i>, <i>six hundred</i>, <i>three
+million</i>, <i>first</i>, <i>second</i>, <i>fiftieth</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Number words, like <i>one</i>, <i>two</i>, <i>three</i>, <i>four</i>, <i>five</i>, etc., are often
+called <b>numeral adjectives</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section164"><b>164.</b> The limiting adjective <i>enough</i> may precede or follow
+the noun it modifies. We may say <i>enough butter</i> or <i>butter
+enough</i>; <i>enough time</i> or <i>time enough</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The limiting adjective <i>else</i> always follows the noun or pronoun
+that it modifies. We say <i>who else</i>, <i>nobody else</i>, <i>everybody
+else</i>, <i>nothing else</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section165"><b>165.</b> When the interrogative pronouns <i>which</i> and <i>what</i> are
+used to modify a noun, as in <i>which picture?</i> <i>what city?</i> they
+cease to be pronouns, and become limiting adjectives. Since
+they are used to ask questions, we call them <b>interrogative
+adjectives</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—<i>Which</i> and <i>what</i>, when used as adjectives, are sometimes
+called <b>pronominal adjectives</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section166"><b>166.</b> Three very common words, <i>a</i>, <i>an</i>, and <i>the</i>, are classed
+with limiting adjectives. They are called <b>articles.</b> <i>The</i> is
+a <b>definite article</b>; <i>an</i> and <i>a</i> are the <b>indefinite article</b>. <i>A</i> is
+really the same word as <i>an</i>, but when it is used before a word
+beginning with a consonant sound, as <i>bicycle</i>, the <i>n</i> is dropped
+for the sake of a more pleasing sound.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_114">[114]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section167"><b>167.</b> We use <i>the</i> when we wish to specify a particular object,
+and <i>an</i> or <i>a</i> when we do not care to be specific. What is the
+difference between these sentences?</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>The man on horseback came to the turn in the road.</p>
+
+<p>A man on horseback came to a turn in the road.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section168"><b>168.</b> We use <i>the</i> before a singular noun to designate a whole
+class of objects; as, “The oak is a sturdy tree,” “The cow
+is a domestic animal.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section169"><b>169.</b> We repeat the article when we wish to denote more
+than one person or thing. What is the difference between
+these pairs of sentences?</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p class="noindent">(<i>a</i>) The secretary and treasurer came late.<br>
+(<i>b</i>) The secretary and the treasurer came together.</p>
+
+<p class="noindent">(<i>a</i>) I saw a red and green signal.<br>
+(<i>b</i>) I saw a red and a green signal.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section170"><b>170.</b> We use <i>an</i> or <i>a</i> after the adjectives <i>many</i> and <i>such</i>
+instead of before them; as, <i>many</i> a man, <i>such</i> a storm.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section171"><b>171.</b> The sentence, “I have <i>few</i> books,” means I have few
+compared with many; but the sentence, “I have <i>a few</i>
+books,” means I have a few compared with none. What is
+the difference in meaning between these sentences?</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>I have little time for sewing.</p>
+
+<p>I have a little time for sewing.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—<b>Limiting adjectives</b> are those which merely
+point out.</p>
+
+<p>Limiting adjectives that denote a definite number are
+called <b>numerals</b>.</p>
+
+<p><i>Which</i> and <i>what</i> may be used as <b>interrogative adjectives</b>.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>articles</b> are <i>the</i>, <i>an</i>, and <i>a</i>.</p>
+
+<p><i>The</i> is a <b>definite article</b>. <i>An</i> and <i>a</i> are <b>indefinite articles</b>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_115">[115]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Select all the limiting adjectives, including
+articles, and tell what they modify. Give reasons for the
+articles used.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. What business brings you here?</p>
+
+<p>2. In that same village, and in one of these very houses, there
+lived, many years since, a simple, good-natured fellow of the name
+of Rip Van Winkle.</p>
+
+<p>3. Every change of season, every change of weather, indeed,
+every hour of the day, produces some change in the magical hues
+and shapes of these mountains.</p>
+
+<p>4. Which fan did your mother carry when she was a young lady
+in Maine?</p>
+
+<p>5. Lobo had only five followers during the latter part of his reign.</p>
+
+<p>6. What excuse shall I make to Dame Van Winkle?</p>
+
+<p>7. The dog managed so that each fresh rush should be toward
+the settlement.</p>
+
+<p>8. No wild animal dies of old age.</p>
+
+<p>9. Which part in the play of <i>Julius Cæsar</i> did Edwin Booth take?</p>
+
+<p>10. When this dog of marvelous wind saw that the wolf was dead,
+he gave him no second glance.</p>
+
+<p>11. After much pains on my behalf and many pains on his,
+Bingo learned to go at the word in quest of our old yellow cow.</p>
+
+<p>12.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">I only ask a hut of stone,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">A very plain brown stone will do,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">That I may call my own;</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And close at hand is such a one</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">In yonder street that fronts the sun.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>13. No other living thing can go so slow as a boy sent on an
+errand.</p>
+
+<p>14. What courage can withstand the ever-during and all-besetting
+terrors of a woman’s tongue?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Classify the words <i>which</i> and <i>what</i> in the
+following sentences as interrogative pronouns or interrogative
+adjectives. Where they are pronouns, tell their case. Where
+they are adjectives, tell what they modify.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. What have you in your basket?</p>
+
+<p>2. What manner of man is this?</p>
+
+<p>3. Which of these pictures did you paint?</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_116">[116]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. Which is it, a toadstool or a mushroom?</p>
+
+<p>5. Which city has the larger population?</p>
+
+<p>6. Which boy threw the stone?</p>
+
+<p>7. What stone did he throw?</p>
+
+<p>8. What did the man come for?</p>
+
+<p>9. What do you want?</p>
+
+<p>10. Which will you take?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XLVI">XLVI. COMPARISON OF ADJECTIVES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section172"><b>172.</b> Since different objects may possess the same quality
+in different degrees, there must be some means of telling this.
+We do it by changing the form of adjectives. For instance,
+wool, snow, and feathers have the same quality of softness,
+but not in the same degree, so we say that wool is <i>soft</i>, snow
+is <i>softer</i>, and feathers are <i>softest</i>. This change in the adjective
+soft to denote the degree of softness is called <b>comparison</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section173"><b>173.</b> Comparison is a <b>property</b> of adjectives. There are
+three <b>degrees</b> of comparison,—the <b>positive</b>, the <b>comparative</b>,
+and the <b>superlative</b>.</p>
+
+<p>The positive degree denotes the simple quality, the comparative
+degree denotes more or less of this quality, and the
+superlative denotes most or least of this quality. When we
+give the three forms of an adjective, we are said to <b>compare</b>
+it. We compare <i>bold</i> by saying: positive, <i>bold</i>; comparative,
+<i>bolder</i>; superlative, <i>boldest</i>; or positive, <i>bold</i>; comparative,
+<i>less bold</i>; superlative, <i>least bold</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section174"><b>174.</b> Comparison is denoted in three ways:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) By adding the suffixes <i>er</i> and <i>est</i>. These are added to
+adjectives of one syllable, and to a few of two syllables; as,
+<i>fine</i>, <i>finer</i>, <i>finest</i>; <i>lovely</i>, <i>lovelier</i>, <i>loveliest</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(2) By prefixing the adverbs <i>more</i> and <i>most</i>. This method
+is used in comparing longer adjectives; as, <i>spacious</i>, <i>more
+spacious</i>, <i>most spacious</i>; <i>disagreeable</i>, <i>more disagreeable</i>, <i>most
+disagreeable</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_117">[117]</span></p>
+
+<p>(3) By prefixing the adverbs <i>less</i> and <i>least</i>; as, <i>rough</i>, <i>less</i>
+<i>rough</i>, <i>least rough</i>; <i>elegant</i>; <i>less elegant</i>, <i>least elegant</i>. This is
+a mode of comparing adjectives on a descending scale instead
+of an ascending scale.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section175"><b>175.</b> Some adjectives cannot be compared at all; as,
+<i>asleep</i>, <i>dead</i>, <i>correct</i>, <i>round</i>, <i>square</i>, <i>principal</i>. Instead of
+saying <i>rounder</i>, we may say <i>more nearly round</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section176"><b>176.</b> Some adjectives are compared irregularly. The following
+are examples:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Positive</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Comparative</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Superlative</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>good</td>
+ <td>better</td>
+ <td>best</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>ill</td>
+ <td>worse</td>
+ <td>worst</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>bad</td>
+ <td>worse</td>
+ <td>worst</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>many</td>
+ <td>more</td>
+ <td>most</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>much</td>
+ <td>more</td>
+ <td>most</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>little</td>
+ <td>less</td>
+ <td>least</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>far</td>
+ <td>farther <i>or</i> further</td>
+ <td>farthest <i>or</i> furthest</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—<b>Comparison</b> in an adjective is a change of
+form to express quality or quantity in different degrees.</p>
+
+<p>There are three <b>degrees</b> of comparison,—<b>positive</b>, <b>comparative</b>,
+and <b>superlative</b>.</p>
+
+<p>Short adjectives are compared by adding the suffixes <i>er</i>
+and <i>est</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Longer adjectives are compared by prefixing <i>more</i> and <i>most</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Many adjectives may be compared on a descending scale
+by prefixing <i>less</i> and <i>least</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the adjectives, and tell the kind and
+the degree of each. Compare each adjective. If any cannot
+be compared, state that fact.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. There was nothing in these woods bigger than a weasel.</p>
+
+<p>2. The way led through the deepest and most perilous part of
+the swamp.</p>
+
+<p>3. This brother was younger and handsomer, and much more
+amiable than William.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_118">[118]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. As she grew older, she became less exacting and more tolerant,
+less certain and more hopeful, less vigorous in body, but gentler
+in manner and sweeter in spirit.</p>
+
+<p>5. The Hotel de Cluny is one of the quaintest, queerest, pleasantest,
+and most homelike places we are likely to meet with.</p>
+
+<p>6. The other captive was of a more restless temperament,
+slenderer in build, more eager and alert of eye, less companionable
+of mood.</p>
+
+<p>7. Least vague of all was the terror of the usually unterrified
+weasel.</p>
+
+<p>8. Those men are most apt to be obsequious and conciliating
+abroad, who are under the discipline of shrews at home.</p>
+
+<p>9. At the least flourish of a broomstick or a ladle, Wolf would
+fly to the door with yelping precipitation.</p>
+
+<p>10. The lynx was smaller than her mate, somewhat browner in
+hue, leaner, and of a peculiarly malignant expression.</p>
+
+<p>11. The women of the village used to employ Rip to do such little
+odd jobs as their less obliging husbands would not do for them.</p>
+
+<p>12. The singing master’s hair was a little longer, his hands were
+a little whiter, his shoes a little thinner, his manner a trifle more
+polished than that of his soberer mates.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Tell the use of adjectives in sentences 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 12.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section177"><b>177.</b> Sometimes errors are made in the use of adjectives.</p>
+
+<p>The comparative degree should be used in comparing two
+objects, the superlative in comparing more than two. If
+only two roads are open to us, we ought to say that we shall
+take the <i>shorter</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select the proper adjective for each of these
+sentences, and give your reasons:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Which would be the (<i>cheapest</i> or <i>cheaper</i>) route—by water
+or by rail?</p>
+
+<p>2. Prince is the (<i>swifter</i> or <i>swiftest</i>) horse, but Pete is the (<i>stronger</i>
+or <i>strongest</i>).</p>
+
+<p>3. Which is the (<i>higher</i> or <i>highest</i>)—the Eiffel Tower or the
+Washington Monument?</p>
+
+<p>4. Of the two leading candidates, Wilson and Harmon, which is
+(<i>more likely</i> or <i>most likely</i>) to be nominated?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_119">[119]</span></p>
+
+<p>Sometimes an ill-chosen adjective is used after the verb
+<i>feel</i>. The sentence, “I feel <i>good</i>,” is correct only when it
+means “I feel righteous,” while “I feel <i>well</i>,” means “I am
+in good health.” In this sentence <i>well</i> is an adjective meaning
+the opposite of <i>sick</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—We also have the adverb <i>well</i>, denoting manner, as in
+the sentence, “LaFollette spoke <i>well</i>.”</p>
+
+<p>The sentence, “Rufus looks <i>good</i>,” is correct when we
+mean that Rufus looks as if he were a good man; but we
+should say, “Rufus looks <i>well</i> (not <i>good</i>) in gray.” Here
+<i>well</i> is an adjective meaning pleasing or acceptable.</p>
+
+<p>The limiting adjectives <i>this</i> and <i>these</i> should not be followed
+by the word <i>here</i>. We point out sufficiently when we say
+<i>this book</i>, <i>these books</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The personal pronoun <i>them</i> should never be used for the
+limiting adjective <i>those</i>. We should say <i>those horses</i>, <i>those
+wagons</i>, <i>those tents</i>.</p>
+
+<p>If we modify a noun by the limiting adjective <i>each</i>, <i>every</i>,
+<i>either</i>, <i>neither</i>, or <i>no</i>, we must use a singular pronoun to represent
+that noun; as,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Each man took <i>his</i> appointed place.</p>
+
+<p>Every girl made <i>her</i> own costume.</p>
+
+<p>Neither man lost <i>his</i> job.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Supply the correct pronoun in each of these
+sentences:—</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—The masculine pronoun should be used when there is no
+word in the sentence that indicates whether the male or the female
+sex is referred to.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Everybody came and brought —— appetite.</p>
+
+<p>2. Each lady contributed whatever —— chose.</p>
+
+<p>3. No young person can afford to waste —— time.</p>
+
+<p>4. Neither doctor will give —— assistance.</p>
+
+<p>5. No day is without —— disappointments.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_120">[120]</span></p>
+
+<p>6. If either man calls, tell —— that I am busy.</p>
+
+<p>7. Every girl in the class said that —— did not understand the
+lesson.</p>
+
+<p>8. Every boy wishes that —— might be president.</p>
+
+<p>9. No soldier acknowledged that —— was afraid.</p>
+
+<p>10. Neither chair is in —— place.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XLVII">XLVII. REVIEW OF ADJECTIVES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section178"><b>178.</b> In our study of adjectives in Lessons <a href="#IX">IX</a>, <a href="#XXVI">XXVI</a>,
+<a href="#XXXIII">XXXIII</a>, <a href="#XXXVII">XXXVII</a>, <a href="#XLIV">XLIV</a>, <a href="#XLV">XLV</a>, and <a href="#XLVI">XLVI</a> we have
+learned that adjectives may be classified as limiting adjectives
+and descriptive adjectives; that <i>which</i> and <i>what</i>
+are interrogative adjectives; that adjectives have the
+property of comparison; and that adjectives may be
+used in four different ways: (1) before a noun to modify
+that noun; (2) after a noun as an appositive modifier; (3) as
+a subjective complement of certain intransitive verbs, and
+(4) as the objective complement of certain transitive
+verbs.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Make an outline of the subject, Adjectives, to
+recite from in class. Illustrate each point you make with a
+good sentence of your own composition.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section179"><b>179.</b> When we parse an adjective, we should tell:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Its class,—descriptive, limiting, or interrogative.</p>
+
+<p>(2) Its degree (if it admits of comparison).</p>
+
+<p>(3) Its use, and what it modifies.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Parse each adjective in the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The puppy grew bigger and clumsier each day. His most
+friendly overtures to the cat were wholly misunderstood.</p>
+
+<p>2. Paris is an immense city, full of broad and handsome streets,
+magnificent buildings, grand open places with fountains and statues,
+great public gardens and parks free to everybody.</p>
+
+<p>3. His gray eyes, clear and kind, flashed like fire when he spoke
+of his adventures.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_121">[121]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. Which picture shall we hang between these two front windows—the
+little Nydia or this pretty landscape?</p>
+
+<p>5. It was clear that the whelps of last spring had betaken themselves
+to other and safer hunting grounds.</p>
+
+<p>6. For a moment the boy felt afraid—afraid in his own woods.</p>
+
+<p>7. Below us lies a lake, clear and cold, whereon fairies might
+launch their airy shallops.</p>
+
+<p>8. Jo Calone threw down his saddle on the dusty ground, and
+turned his horses loose.</p>
+
+<p>9. What fun the rabbits must have been having!</p>
+
+<p>10. The full moon of October, deep orange in a clear, deep sky,
+hung large and somewhat distorted just over the wooded hills.</p>
+
+<p>11. For a long time pain and hunger kept me awake.</p>
+
+<p>12. How sweet and demure those girls looked!</p>
+
+<p>13. Do you suppose that any old Roman ever had twenty-four
+different kinds of pie at one dinner?</p>
+
+<p>14. There was something in their cries that sounded strangely
+wild and fierce.</p>
+
+<p>15. The cardinal bird drew herself up very straight, raised her
+crest, and opened her big beak.</p>
+
+<p>16. What harm can a naked frog do us?</p>
+
+<p>17. Land in London is so valuable that a single acre of it has been
+sold for four and a half million dollars.</p>
+
+<p>18. The old servant made our lives miserable by her cantankerous
+ways.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XLVIII">XLVIII. ADJECTIVE PRONOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section180"><b>180.</b> When we say, “This ring was my mother’s,” we use the
+word <i>this</i> as an adjective modifying the noun <i>ring</i>. When we
+say, “This was my mother’s ring,” we use the one word <i>this</i>
+in place of <i>this ring</i> as subject of the sentence, hence <i>this</i> is no
+longer an adjective, but has become a pronoun. Since its ordinary
+use is that of an adjective, we call it an <b>adjective pronoun</b>.</p>
+
+<p>Many limiting adjectives may be used as pronouns. We
+often make such sentences as these:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p><i>Few</i> shall part where <i>many</i> meet.</p>
+
+<p>If honor is lost, then <i>all</i> is lost.</p>
+
+<p>When <i>two</i> or <i>three</i> are gathered together in Thy name, Thou wilt
+grant their requests.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_122">[122]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section181"><b>181.</b> The commonest adjective pronouns are <i>all</i>, <i>any</i>, <i>each</i>,
+<i>either</i>, <i>few</i>, <i>first</i>, <i>former</i>, <i>last</i>, <i>little</i>, <i>many</i>, <i>more</i>, <i>most</i>, <i>much</i>,
+<i>neither</i>, <i>one</i>, <i>other</i>, <i>several</i>, <i>some</i>, <i>this</i>, <i>that</i>, <i>these</i>, <i>those</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Make sentences containing five of these adjective pronouns.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section182"><b>182.</b> Two adjective pronouns, <i>one</i> and <i>other</i>, may be declined.</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Nom.</i></td>
+ <td>one</td>
+ <td>ones</td>
+ <td>other</td>
+ <td>others</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Poss.</i></td>
+ <td>one’s</td>
+ <td>ones’</td>
+ <td>other’s</td>
+ <td>others’</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Obj.</i></td>
+ <td>one</td>
+ <td>ones</td>
+ <td>other</td>
+ <td>others</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>Sentences like these are common:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>One sometimes tires of <i>one’s</i> occupation.</p>
+
+<p>Each envied the <i>other’s</i> good fortune.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>The two adjective pronouns, <i>one</i> and <i>other</i>, may be modified
+by adjectives; as, “Many others came,” “The green
+ones are the prettiest.”</p>
+
+<p><i>Each other</i> and <i>one another</i>, though consisting of two words,
+may be considered as one adjective pronoun.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section183"><b>183.</b> Some adjective pronouns may be modified by articles.
+We say, “<i>The last</i> is the best of all the game,” “I like
+gooseberries, so I picked <i>a few</i>.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>adjective pronoun</b> is a limiting adjective
+used in place of a noun.</p>
+
+<p>The adjective pronouns <i>one</i> and <i>other</i> may be declined.</p>
+
+<p>Some adjective pronouns may be modified by adjectives.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select the adjective pronouns in these sentences.
+Tell the use and case of each. Tell the noun that
+each pronoun stands for. Supply this noun where you can.
+What part of speech does the adjective pronoun become then?</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. This is the story of a bad boy.</p>
+
+<p>2. Many of the protozoa are very beautiful. Some build shells
+for themselves of strange and curious shapes.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_123">[123]</span></p>
+
+<p>3. The ham turned out to be a very remarkable one.</p>
+
+<p>4. There is a vast difference between the styles of 1860 and
+1900. The former favored Paisley shawls and flounced skirts,
+the latter sanctioned the tailor-made suit and the shirt waist.</p>
+
+<p>5. A little made us very happy once.</p>
+
+<p>6. From time to time one or another of the leaping rabbits would
+take himself off through the fir trees, while others continued to
+arrive along the moonlight trails.</p>
+
+<p>7. All is of God that is or is to be.</p>
+
+<p>8. A bluejay and a red squirrel were loudly berating each other
+for stealing.</p>
+
+<p>9. The convenience of resting one’s self in the open air is one
+of the comforts of Paris.</p>
+
+<p>10. Each of these was a wolf of renown; most of them were
+above the ordinary size; one in particular, the second in command,
+was a veritable giant. Several of the band were especially
+noted. One of them was a beautiful white wolf, that the Mexicans
+called Blanca; this was supposed to be a female, possibly Lobo’s
+mate. Another was a yellow wolf of remarkable swiftness.</p>
+
+<p>11. It is not easy to change one’s life all in a minute.</p>
+
+<p>12. It is a blessed fact that one’s own home is the hub of the
+universe.</p>
+
+<p>13. Every one said that I was a tomboy.</p>
+
+<p>14. Some wore short doublets, others jerkins, with long knives
+in their belts, and most of them had enormous breeches of similar
+style with that of the guide’s.</p>
+
+<p>15. The years hurry onward, treading in their haste on one
+another’s heels.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>What noun is understood after <i>guide’s</i> in sentence 14?</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XLIX">XLIX. VERBS: TENSE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section184"><b>184.</b> Three very common words are <i>yesterday</i>, <i>to-day</i>, and
+<i>to-morrow</i>. The word <i>yesterday</i> refers to time that has gone,
+or past time; <i>to-day</i> refers to time that now is, or <b>present</b>
+time; and <i>to-morrow</i> refers to time that is to come, or <b>future</b>
+time.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section185"><b>185.</b> Every event takes place in time, and so when we tell
+of the occurrence of any event, we must have some way of
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_124">[124]</span>making clear whether that event took place in the past, or
+is taking place in the present, or will take place in the future.
+Of course, we might tell this by adverbs or adverbial phrases,
+but we have a very much better way,—we tell it by the form
+of the verb we use. What time do we think of when we see
+the verbs <i>eats</i>, <i>works</i>, <i>plays</i>, <i>sleeps</i>? What time is told by
+the verbs <i>ate</i>, <i>worked</i>, <i>played</i>, <i>slept</i>? What change is made
+in the form of the two sets of verbs? What time is told by
+the verbs <i>will eat</i>, <i>will work</i>, <i>will play</i>, <i>will sleep</i>?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section186"><b>186.</b> In the last group of verbs, where each verb consists of
+two words, it is the first word <i>will</i> that denotes future time.
+Such a word is called a helping word, or <b>auxiliary</b> verb.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section187"><b>187.</b> The change in the form of a verb to denote time is
+called <b>tense</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section188"><b>188.</b> Tense is a property of all verbs. It is evident that
+there must be three tenses,—present, past, and future, as
+shown in the three sets of verbs that have just been examined.
+These are called <b>primary</b> tenses.</p>
+
+<p>There are three other tenses, called <b>secondary</b> tenses.
+We may say, “I <i>have eaten</i> my supper,” “I <i>had eaten</i> my
+supper,” “I <i>shall have eaten</i> my supper.” These verbs call
+attention not so much to the time of the action as to the fact
+that it is completed, or perfected.</p>
+
+<p><i>Have eaten</i> means that a past action is completed at the
+present time. This form is called the <b>present perfect</b> tense.</p>
+
+<p><i>Had eaten</i> means that a past action was completed before
+some particular past time. This form is called the <b>past
+perfect</b> tense.</p>
+
+<p><i>Shall have eaten</i> means that an action will be completed
+before some definite future time. This is called the <b>future
+perfect</b> tense.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—<b>Tense</b> is that property of a verb which denotes
+the time of an action or an event.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_125">[125]</span></p>
+
+<p>There are six tenses:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) The <b>present tense</b> denotes that an action is taking place.
+It usually consists of one word, the simplest form of the verb.</p>
+
+<p>(2) The <b>past tense</b> denotes that an action did take place.
+It usually consists of one word.</p>
+
+<p>(3) The <b>future tense</b> denotes that an action will take
+place. It consists of two words, one of which is the auxiliary
+<i>shall</i> or <i>will</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(4) The <b>present perfect tense</b> denotes that a past action
+is now completed. It consists of two words, one of which is
+the auxiliary <i>have</i> or <i>has</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(5) The <b>past perfect tense</b> denotes that a past action was
+completed before a particular past time. It consists of two
+words, one of which is the auxiliary <i>had</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(6) The <b>future perfect tense</b> denotes that a future action
+will be completed before a particular future time. It consists
+of three words, one of which is the auxiliary <i>have</i>, and
+another the auxiliary <i>shall</i> or <i>will</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Notes.</span>—1. The present tense is used also to denote (1) that something
+is true at all times; as “Waste makes want,” and (2) that
+something occurs habitually; as, “She teaches school.”</p>
+
+<p class="note">2. When a predicate consists of a series of verbs in the same tense,
+the auxiliary is usually expressed only with the first verb. In the
+sentence, “Now that he has eaten and slept, he is ready for work,”
+the second verb is <i>has slept</i>, with the auxiliary understood.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section189"><b>189.</b> A common error is the use of the present perfect
+tense for the past tense. We say, “I <i>have been</i> in Florida
+several times,” because we mean several times before now;
+but we say, “I <i>was</i> in Florida last year,” because we mean
+that our being there occurred in past time with no reference
+whatever to the present. If we are still in Florida we may
+say, “I <i>have been</i> in Florida a long time”; but if we are no
+longer in Florida we say, “I <i>was</i> in Florida a long time.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_126">[126]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Justify the use of the past or the present
+perfect tense in each of these sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. I learned the poem last evening.</p>
+
+<p>2. I have learned the poem already.</p>
+
+<p>3. I bought my hat at Stone’s.</p>
+
+<p>4. I have bought a new spring hat.</p>
+
+<p>5. I came home last Monday.</p>
+
+<p>6. I have come to stay a week.</p>
+
+<p>7. I tried my skates this afternoon.</p>
+
+<p>8. I haven’t tried my new skates.</p>
+
+<p>9. I have walked ever since sunrise.</p>
+
+<p>10. I walked from sunrise until noon.</p>
+
+<p>11. I spoke to the President this morning.</p>
+
+<p>12. I have never spoken to the President.</p>
+
+<p>13. I spoke to him twice when I was in Washington.</p>
+
+<p>14. I have spoken to him several times.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Using the subject <i>I</i>, form the six tenses of
+the following verbs. Consult the dictionary for forms of
+which you are not sure.</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>break</li>
+ <li>bring</li>
+ <li>buy</li>
+ <li>come</li>
+ <li>drive</li>
+ <li>go</li>
+ <li>leave</li>
+ <li>love</li>
+ <li>run</li>
+ <li>see</li>
+ <li>sing</li>
+ <li>take</li>
+ <li>turn</li>
+ <li>wait</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 3.</b>—Select all the verbs in these sentences, and
+tell the tense of each:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Trees wave, flowers bloom, and bright-winged birds flit from
+palm to cedar.</p>
+
+<p>2. The lynx turned to the right, along a well-worn trail, ran up a
+tree, descended hastily, and glided away among the thickets.</p>
+
+<p>3. Tommy and I had played together till five o’clock that
+Saturday afternoon.</p>
+
+<p>4. The children thought, “how long the vacation will be!” but
+the mother thought, “how soon it will have come and gone.”</p>
+
+<p>5. He who knows nothing fears nothing.</p>
+
+<p>6. The duck had never seen a guinea egg before in all her life.</p>
+
+<p>7. The boy comes nearer to perpetual motion than anything
+else in nature.</p>
+
+<p>8. Nobody has yet discovered how many grasshoppers a turkey
+will hold.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_127">[127]</span></p>
+
+<p>9. I have made no addition to my cabinet since we met.</p>
+
+<p>10. The big black pots swinging from the cranes had bubbled and
+gurgled and sent out puffs of appetizing steam.</p>
+
+<p>11. “How many pieces shall I cut this pie into?” said she.</p>
+
+<p>12. I have seen wild bees and butterflies feeding at a height of
+13,000 feet above the sea.</p>
+
+<p>13. You shall go to bed, and I will remain with you a few days
+until you get over this fever.</p>
+
+<p>14. The daisies have shut up their sleepy red eyes.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Analyze sentences 2, 3, 6, 9, 14.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="L">L. THE INDICATIVE MODE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section190"><b>190.</b> Each of the six verb forms that we have been studying,—I
+<i>eat</i>, I <i>ate</i>, I <i>shall eat</i>, I <i>have eaten</i>, I <i>had eaten</i>, I <i>shall
+have eaten</i>,—is used in the statement of a fact, and is said
+to be in the <b>indicative mode</b>.</p>
+
+<p>Mode is that property of a verb which denotes the manner
+of an assertion.</p>
+
+<p>The indicative mode is used in the statement of a fact.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section191"><b>191.</b> In some tenses there is a slight difference between the
+singular and the plural form of a verb, hence verbs are said
+to have the property of <b>number</b>. We should always use the
+verb form that agrees with the number of the subject. In
+the present tense, for example, we say in the singular, “The
+man <i>goes</i>;” and in the plural, “The men <i>go</i>.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section192"><b>192.</b> In some tenses there is a slight difference in the form
+of the verb to denote person, hence verbs are said to have the
+property of <b>person</b>. In the present perfect tense, we say in
+the first person, “I <i>have</i> gone;” and in the third person,
+“He <i>has</i> gone.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section193"><b>193.</b> When we give all the forms of a verb in the three persons
+and the two numbers of each tense, we are said to <b>conjugate</b>
+the verb.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_128">[128]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section194"><b>194.</b> Conjugation of the verb <i>be</i> in the indicative mode:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I am</td>
+ <td>we are</td>
+ <td>I was</td>
+ <td>we were</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou art</td>
+ <td>you are</td>
+ <td>thou wast</td>
+ <td>you were</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he is</td>
+ <td>they are</td>
+ <td>he was</td>
+ <td>they were</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Future Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I shall be</td>
+ <td>we shall be</td>
+ <td>I have been</td>
+ <td>we have been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou wilt be</td>
+ <td>you will be</td>
+ <td>thou hast been</td>
+ <td>you have been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he will be</td>
+ <td>they will be</td>
+ <td>he has been</td>
+ <td>they have been</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I had been</td>
+ <td>we had been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou hadst been</td>
+ <td>you had been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he had been</td>
+ <td>they had been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Future Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I shall have been</td>
+ <td>we shall have been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou wilt have been</td>
+ <td>you will have been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he will have been</td>
+ <td>they will have been</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="section" id="section195"><b>195.</b> Conjugation of <i>see</i> in the indicative mode:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I see</td>
+ <td>we see</td>
+ <td>I saw</td>
+ <td>we saw</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou seest</td>
+ <td>you see</td>
+ <td>thou sawest</td>
+ <td>you saw</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he sees</td>
+ <td>they see</td>
+ <td>he saw</td>
+ <td>they saw</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Future Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I shall see</td>
+ <td>we shall see</td>
+ <td>I have seen</td>
+ <td>we have seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou wilt see</td>
+ <td>you will see</td>
+ <td>thou hast seen</td>
+ <td>you have seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he will see</td>
+ <td>they will see</td>
+ <td>he has seen</td>
+ <td>they have seen<span class="pagenum" id="Page_129">[129]</span></td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I had seen</td>
+ <td>we had seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou hadst seen</td>
+ <td>you had seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he had seen</td>
+ <td>they had seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Future Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I shall have seen</td>
+ <td>we shall have seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou wilt have seen</td>
+ <td>you will have seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he will have seen</td>
+ <td>they will have seen</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Conjugate the verbs in Exercise 2, <a href="#Page_126">p. 126</a>, in
+the six tenses of the Indicative Mode.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LI">LI. THE INTERROGATIVE FORM OF THE INDICATIVE MODE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section196"><b>196.</b> The indicative mode is used not only in stating facts,
+but also in asking questions. In interrogative sentences the
+order of the words that make up the verb is changed somewhat.
+In a simple statement we say, <i>I have paid</i>. In a question we
+say, <i>Have I paid?</i> putting the auxiliary before the subject.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section197"><b>197.</b> Conjugation of <i>be</i> in the indicative mode, interrogative
+form:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>am I</td>
+ <td>are we</td>
+ <td>was I</td>
+ <td>were we</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>art thou</td>
+ <td>are you</td>
+ <td>wast thou</td>
+ <td>were you</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>is he</td>
+ <td>are they</td>
+ <td>was he</td>
+ <td>were they</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Future Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>shall I be</td>
+ <td>shall we be</td>
+ <td>have I been</td>
+ <td>have we been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>wilt thou be</td>
+ <td>will you be</td>
+ <td>hast thou been</td>
+ <td>have you been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>will he be</td>
+ <td>will they be</td>
+ <td>has he been</td>
+ <td>have they been</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>had I been</td>
+ <td>had we been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>hadst thou been</td>
+ <td>had you been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>had he been</td>
+ <td>had they been<span class="pagenum" id="Page_130">[130]</span></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Future Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>shall I have been</td>
+ <td>shall we have been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>wilt thou have been</td>
+ <td>will you have been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>will he have been</td>
+ <td>will they have been</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="section" id="section198"><b>198.</b> When we use the present and past tenses of any verb
+except <i>be</i> for asking questions, we do not say <i>sings she?</i> or
+<i>sang she?</i> but <i>does she sing?</i> <i>did she sing?</i> that is, we use the
+auxiliaries <i>do</i> and <i>did</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Conjugate the verb <i>see</i> in the indicative mode, interrogative
+form.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Conjugate the verbs in Exercise 2, <a href="#Page_126">p. 126</a>, in
+the indicative mode, interrogative form.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section199"><b>199.</b> The use of the negative word <i>not</i> after a verb gives
+rise to many contractions which are permissible in familiar
+conversation. The contractions for which incorrect forms
+are often used are the following:—</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>isn’t</li>
+ <li>wasn’t</li>
+ <li>aren’t</li>
+ <li>weren’t</li>
+ <li>don’t</li>
+ <li>doesn’t</li>
+ <li>haven’t</li>
+ <li>hasn’t</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p>There is no contraction for <i>am not</i>; the word <i>ain’t</i> is incorrect.</p>
+
+<p>Contractions are oftenest misused in questions. Notice
+the following correct forms:—</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>Isn’t it too bad?</li>
+ <li>Isn’t he tall?</li>
+ <li>Isn’t she pretty?</li>
+ <li>Aren’t you cold?</li>
+ <li>Aren’t they coming?</li>
+ <li>Wasn’t it long?</li>
+ <li>Weren’t you there?</li>
+ <li>Weren’t they slow?</li>
+ <li>Don’t you believe me?</li>
+ <li>Doesn’t it hurt?</li>
+ <li>Doesn’t she work hard?</li>
+ <li>Doesn’t he like it?</li>
+ <li>Haven’t you been there?</li>
+ <li>Hasn’t he any friends?</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p>We should be careful never to say, <i>you was</i> or <i>was you</i>;
+for the pronoun <i>you</i>, even when it denotes one person, is
+followed by a verb in the plural form. We should say,
+“You <i>were</i> late,” “<i>Were you</i> late?” “<i>Weren’t you</i> late?”</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_131">[131]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LII">LII. THE SUBJUNCTIVE MODE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section200"><b>200.</b> When we say, “If I were you, I should be a doctor,”
+we have a dependent proposition, <i>If I were you</i>, which states
+not a fact, but an imaginary condition. This condition is,
+moreover, directly contrary to fact, for I am not you, and
+never can be. The verb used in expressing such a condition
+is said to be in the <b>subjunctive</b> mode.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section201"><b>201.</b> The subjunctive mode is found not only in dependent
+propositions introduced by if, but in those introduced by
+<i>lest</i>, <i>whether</i>, <i>although</i>, etc.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>(a) Be quiet lest the baby <i>wake</i>.</p>
+
+<p>(b) We cannot tell whether he <i>be</i> the rightful heir or not.</p>
+
+<p>(c) Though he <i>wait</i> long, yet he will come at last.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>In each of these sentences the subjunctive mode is used to
+express doubt or uncertainty, or something imagined but
+not actually realized.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section202"><b>202.</b> The subjunctive mode is so named because it is found
+principally in dependent, or subjoined propositions. It is,
+however, found also in independent propositions expressing a
+wish; as, “Long <i>live</i> the King!” “God <i>bless</i> thee, dear!”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section203"><b>203.</b> The subjunctive mode is used in the statement of
+something that is uncertain; as, “If he <i>come</i> in time, dinner
+will be served at six.” This sentence means that his coming
+is to take place in the future, hence we cannot tell whether
+it will be a fact or not. In the sentence, “If he <i>comes</i> in
+time, dinner is served at six,” we use the indicative mode
+because we mean that sometimes he really does come in time.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section204"><b>204.</b> The subjunctive mode is little used, especially in
+conversation; but we find many instances of it in the Bible
+and in the works of Shakespeare, hence we should understand
+its meaning. Nowadays, except to express a wish, as,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_132">[132]</span>“Heaven <i>defend</i> thee!” and to express a condition contrary
+to fact, as, “If the ring <i>were</i> gold, it would not discolor your
+finger,” most persons use the indicative mode or some other
+verb phrase. Instead of saying, “If to-morrow <i>be</i> fair,”
+most persons say, “If to-morrow <i>is</i> fair,” or “If to-morrow
+<i>should be</i> fair.” (See <a href="#LXI">Lesson LXI</a>.)</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section205"><b>205.</b> There are four tenses in the subjunctive mode, but
+the forms do not differ greatly from those of the indicative
+mode. There is no interrogative form.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section206"><b>206.</b> Conjugation of <i>be</i> in the subjunctive mode:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I be</td>
+ <td>we be</td>
+ <td>I were</td>
+ <td>we were</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>you be</td>
+ <td>you be</td>
+ <td>thou were</td>
+ <td>you were</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he be</td>
+ <td>they be</td>
+ <td>he were</td>
+ <td>they were</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I have been</td>
+ <td>we have been</td>
+ <td>I had been</td>
+ <td>we had been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou have been</td>
+ <td>you have been</td>
+ <td>thou had been</td>
+ <td>you had been</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he have been</td>
+ <td>they have been</td>
+ <td>he had been</td>
+ <td>they had been</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="section" id="section207"><b>207.</b> Conjugation of <i>see</i> in the subjunctive mode:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I see</td>
+ <td>we see</td>
+ <td>I saw</td>
+ <td>we saw</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou see</td>
+ <td>you see</td>
+ <td>thou saw</td>
+ <td>you saw</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he see</td>
+ <td>they see</td>
+ <td>he saw</td>
+ <td>they saw</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Perfect Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I have seen</td>
+ <td>we have seen</td>
+ <td>I had seen</td>
+ <td>we had seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou have seen</td>
+ <td>you have seen</td>
+ <td>thou had seen</td>
+ <td>you had seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he have seen</td>
+ <td>they have seen</td>
+ <td>he had seen</td>
+ <td>they had seen</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The <b>subjunctive mode</b> is used in an exclamative
+sentence to express a wish, and in a dependent proposition
+to express something contrary to fact or something
+uncertain.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_133">[133]</span></p>
+
+<p>The subjunctive mode has no future tenses.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Conjugate all the verbs in Exercise 2, <a href="#Page_126">p. 126</a>,
+in the subjunctive mode.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Select all the verbs in the subjunctive mode
+in these sentences, and tell why that mode is used:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Misery loves company—even though it be very poor company.</p>
+
+<p>2. If the weather be fine, there breaks upon the eye, as we rise
+higher and higher, a succession of those views of mountain, lake
+and forest, which can be had only from an elevated position.</p>
+
+<p>3. The Lord be between thee and me when we are absent one
+from the other.</p>
+
+<p>4. If the whole world were put into one scale and my mother
+into the other, the world could not outweigh her.</p>
+
+<p>5. If a boy were obliged to work at nut gathering in order to
+procure food for the family, he would find it very irksome.</p>
+
+<p>6.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Green be the turf above thee,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Friend of my better days!</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>7. John convinces himself that he must watch the hawk lest it
+pounce upon the chicken.</p>
+
+<p>8. If chicadee seem preoccupied or absorbed, you may know that
+he is building a nest.</p>
+
+<p>9. If I were a millionaire, city life would be agreeable enough,
+for I could always get away from it.</p>
+
+<p>10.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">And Death, whenever he come to me,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Shall come on the wide, unbounded sea.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>11. In their hands they shall bear thee up, lest at any time thou
+dash thy foot against a stone.</p>
+
+<p>12.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Christ save us all from a death like this,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">On the reef of Norman’s Woe!</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>13. If wishes were horses, beggars might ride.</p>
+
+<p>14. God be merciful to us, and bless us, and show us the light of
+his countenance.</p>
+
+<p>15. If a man say that he hath no sin, he deceiveth himself, and
+the truth is not in him.</p>
+
+<p>16. If he had told the truth, somebody would have believed him.</p>
+
+<p>17. If impressment were the law of the world, if it formed part
+of the code of nations and were usually practiced, then it might be
+defended as a common right.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_134">[134]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LIII">LIII. THE IMPERATIVE MODE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section208"><b>208.</b> We learned in <a href="#XIV">Lesson XIV</a> that sentences expressing
+a command or an entreaty are called imperative sentences;
+that the subject of the verb in an imperative sentence is a
+pronoun of the second person,—<i>you</i>, <i>thou</i>, or <i>ye</i>; and that
+this subject is seldom expressed. The verb in an imperative
+sentence is said to be in the <b>imperative mode</b>; as, “<i>Sleep</i>,
+baby, <i>sleep</i>.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section209"><b>209.</b> There is only one form for the imperative mode, hence
+it is not said to have tense at all.</p>
+
+<p>Conjugation of <i>be</i> in the imperative mode:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>be (<i>you</i> or <i>thou</i>)</td>
+ <td>be (<i>you</i> or <i>ye</i>)</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>Conjugation of <i>see</i> in the imperative mode:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>see (<i>you</i> or <i>thou</i>)</td>
+ <td>see (<i>you</i> or <i>ye</i>)</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The <b>imperative mode</b> is used in expressing a
+command or an entreaty. It has but one form. Its subject
+is always the pronoun <i>you</i>, <i>thou</i>, or <i>ye</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—From these sentences select the verbs in the
+imperative mode. Conjugate these verbs in the indicative,
+subjunctive, and imperative modes.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Ring, happy bells, across the snow.</p>
+
+<p>2. Break, break, break, on thy cold, gray stones, O sea!</p>
+
+<p>3. Repent ye, for the kingdom of heaven is at hand.</p>
+
+<p>4. Run upstairs and get my glasses.</p>
+
+<p>5. Blow, winds, and crack your cheeks.</p>
+
+<p>6.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Build thee more stately mansions, O my soul!</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">As the swift seasons roll.</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Leave thy low-vaulted past,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Let each new temple, nobler than the last,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Shut thee from heaven with a dome more vast....</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_135">[135]</span></p>
+
+<p>7. Laugh, and the world laughs with you.</p>
+
+<p>8.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Work till the last beam fadeth,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Fadeth to shine no more.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>9. Come unto me, all ye that labor and are heavy laden, and I
+will give you rest.</p>
+
+<p>10. Whatsoever thy hand findeth to do, do it with thy might.</p>
+
+<p>11. Suffer the little children, and forbid them not to come unto
+me, for of such is the kingdom of heaven.</p>
+
+<p>12. Honor thy father and thy mother.</p>
+
+<p>13.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Tell me not in mournful numbers</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Life is but an empty dream.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Find all the terms of address in the sentences above.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LIV">LIV. PRINCIPAL PARTS OF VERBS. REGULAR AND IRREGULAR VERBS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section210"><b>210.</b> If we examine the conjugation of the verb <i>see</i>, we
+shall discover that most of the tenses are formed by the use
+of auxiliary verbs, and that only four forms of the verb <i>see</i>
+itself are made use of; namely, <i>see</i>, <i>sees</i>, <i>saw</i>, <i>seen</i>. The
+form <i>sees</i> occurs only once, but the other three forms occur
+often. These three forms—<i>see</i>, <i>saw</i>, <i>seen</i>—are called the
+<b>principal parts</b> of the verb <i>see</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The principal parts of any verb are the present indicative,
+as, <i>go</i>, <i>take</i>; the past indicative, as, <i>went</i>, <i>took</i>; and another
+form, as, <i>gone</i>, <i>taken</i>, called the <b>past participle</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section211"><b>211.</b> The past participle is used in forming all the perfect
+tenses. It is plain, then, that we should say <i>I have gone</i> (not
+<i>have went</i>), <i>I had taken</i> (not <i>had took</i>); since <i>went</i> and <i>took</i>
+are past tense forms, not past participles.</p>
+
+<p>The past participle is never used in the primary tenses.
+That is why we say <i>I saw</i> (not <i>seen</i>), <i>I did</i> (not <i>done</i>).</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—The very common word <i>ought</i> is, as we use it to-day, an
+old past tense form of the verb <i>owe</i>, and not a past participle.
+Hence, we should say <i>ought to go</i>, or <i>ought not to go</i> (not <i>had ought to
+go</i> or <i>hadn’t ought to go</i>).</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_136">[136]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section212"><b>212.</b> Most verbs form their past tense and past participle
+by adding <i>d</i> or <i>ed</i> to the present tense. The past tense and
+the past participle of <i>move</i> are <i>moved</i> and <i>moved</i>; of <i>plow</i> are
+<i>plowed</i> and <i>plowed</i>; of <i>lift</i> are <i>lifted</i> and <i>lifted</i>. Such verbs
+are called <b>regular verbs</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section213"><b>213.</b> Many verbs in very common use form their past tense
+or past participle, not by the addition of a suffix, but by some
+change within the word, such as a change in the vowel. The
+past tense and past participle of <i>sing</i> are <i>sang</i> and <i>sung</i> respectively;
+of <i>leave</i> are <i>left</i> and <i>left</i>; of <i>write</i> are <i>wrote</i> and
+<i>written</i>. These verbs are called <b>irregular verbs</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section214"><b>214.</b> Some verbs, like <i>put</i> and <i>set</i>, have the same form for
+each of their principal parts. These also are irregular verbs.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section215"><b>215.</b> The verb <i>be</i> is very irregular. Its principal parts
+are: present tense <i>am</i>, past tense <i>was</i>, past participle <i>been</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section216"><b>216.</b> If we know the proper auxiliaries for the different
+tenses, we can conjugate any verb correctly by first ascertaining
+its principal parts. These can always be found in a dictionary.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The <b>principal parts</b> of a verb are the present
+tense, the past tense, and the past participle.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>regular verb</b> is one that forms its past tense and past
+participle by adding <i>d</i> or <i>ed</i> to the present tense.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>irregular verb</b> is one whose past tense or past participle
+is formed in some other way than by adding <i>d</i> or <i>ed</i> to the
+present tense.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—Webster’s New International Dictionary gives the
+present tense form of every verb. If the verb is irregular, the
+dictionary gives also the past tense form preceded by <i>pret.</i>, and the
+past participle preceded by <i>p.p.</i> The abbreviation <i>pret.</i> stands for
+<i>preterit</i>, which means past tense. If the verb is regular, the abbreviations
+are omitted, and the form <i>d</i> or <i>ed</i> is printed but once.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_137">[137]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Find in the dictionary the past tense and the
+past participle of each of the following verbs. Use the three
+forms of each verb correctly in sentences.</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>awake</li>
+ <li>bear</li>
+ <li>beat</li>
+ <li>begin</li>
+ <li>bid</li>
+ <li>bind</li>
+ <li>bite</li>
+ <li>bleed</li>
+ <li>blow</li>
+ <li>break</li>
+ <li>bring</li>
+ <li>build</li>
+ <li>buy</li>
+ <li>catch</li>
+ <li>choose</li>
+ <li>cling</li>
+ <li>come</li>
+ <li>cost</li>
+ <li>creep</li>
+ <li>cut</li>
+ <li>dare</li>
+ <li>dig</li>
+ <li>do</li>
+ <li>draw</li>
+ <li>drink</li>
+ <li>drive</li>
+ <li>eat</li>
+ <li>fall</li>
+ <li>feed</li>
+ <li>fight</li>
+ <li>find</li>
+ <li>flee</li>
+ <li>fling</li>
+ <li>fly</li>
+ <li>forget</li>
+ <li>freeze</li>
+ <li>get</li>
+ <li>give</li>
+ <li>go</li>
+ <li>grind</li>
+ <li>grow</li>
+ <li>hang</li>
+ <li>have</li>
+ <li>hide</li>
+ <li>hit</li>
+ <li>hold</li>
+ <li>hurt</li>
+ <li>keep</li>
+ <li>kneel</li>
+ <li>knit</li>
+ <li>know</li>
+ <li>lay</li>
+ <li>lead</li>
+ <li>lend</li>
+ <li>let</li>
+ <li>lie</li>
+ <li>lose</li>
+ <li>make</li>
+ <li>meet</li>
+ <li>pay</li>
+ <li>read</li>
+ <li>ride</li>
+ <li>ring</li>
+ <li>rise</li>
+ <li>run</li>
+ <li>say</li>
+ <li>seek</li>
+ <li>sell</li>
+ <li>shake</li>
+ <li>shed</li>
+ <li>shine</li>
+ <li>shoot</li>
+ <li>show</li>
+ <li>shrink</li>
+ <li>shut</li>
+ <li>sink</li>
+ <li>sit</li>
+ <li>slay</li>
+ <li>sleep</li>
+ <li>slide</li>
+ <li>sling</li>
+ <li>smite</li>
+ <li>speak</li>
+ <li>spend</li>
+ <li>spin</li>
+ <li>spread</li>
+ <li>spring</li>
+ <li>stand</li>
+ <li>steal</li>
+ <li>stick</li>
+ <li>sting</li>
+ <li>stride</li>
+ <li>strike</li>
+ <li>string</li>
+ <li>strive</li>
+ <li>swear</li>
+ <li>sweat</li>
+ <li>sweep</li>
+ <li>swim</li>
+ <li>swing</li>
+ <li>take</li>
+ <li>tell</li>
+ <li>think</li>
+ <li>throw</li>
+ <li>tread</li>
+ <li>wear</li>
+ <li>weave</li>
+ <li>weep</li>
+ <li>wet</li>
+ <li>win</li>
+ <li>wind</li>
+ <li>wring</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p class="section" id="section217"><b>217.</b> Many errors are made in using the different forms of
+irregular verbs.</p>
+
+<p>Certain verbs, the meaning and principal parts of which are
+somewhat alike, occasion a good deal of trouble to some persons.
+The most important of these are <i>lie</i> and <i>lay</i>, <i>sit</i> and
+<i>set</i>, and <i>rise</i> and <i>raise</i>. The first word of each pair, <i>lie</i>, <i>sit</i>,
+and <i>rise</i> is an intransitive verb. The second verb of each pair,
+<i>lay</i>, <i>set</i>, and <i>raise</i>, is a transitive verb.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Supply the correct form of <i>lie</i> or <i>lay</i> in each
+of these sentences, and give your reason in each case.</p>
+
+<p><i>Lie</i> means to be at rest in a reclining position.</p>
+
+<p><i>Lay</i> means to place a thing down in a reclining position.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. —— down, Phiz, and be a good dog.</p>
+
+<p>2. Phiz —— at the foot of my couch and gazed out of the
+nearest window.</p>
+
+<p>3. After he had —— there an hour or more, he whined to go out
+on the street.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_138">[138]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. Phiz brought in a notebook and —— it at my feet.</p>
+
+<p>5. Go and —— it on your master’s chair, Phiz.</p>
+
+<p>6. Did the soldiers —— on the damp ground?</p>
+
+<p>7. This land —— too low for grain fields.</p>
+
+<p>8. How long has my fan been —— on the window sill?</p>
+
+<p>9. Grant —— in bed dictating his Memoirs.</p>
+
+<p>10. The tools have —— here in the wet and are rusted.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Supply the correct form of <i>sit</i> or <i>set</i> in each
+of these sentences, and give your reason in each case.</p>
+
+<p><i>Sit</i> means to be in a sitting position.</p>
+
+<p><i>Set</i> means to place a thing down in a position of rest.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. By and by we looked in, and there —— Miss Eugene.</p>
+
+<p>2. Have you —— here long, or did you just come?</p>
+
+<p>3. I will —— my suit case here, and then —— in your seat.</p>
+
+<p>4. Why did you —— there so long without speaking?</p>
+
+<p>5. Father —— the white hen to-day, so she will be —— for about
+three weeks.</p>
+
+<p>6. The little bird —— and sings at his door in the sun.</p>
+
+<p>7. Who has been —— in my chair?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 3.</b>—Supply the correct form of <i>rise</i> and <i>raise</i> in
+each of these sentences, and give your reason in each case.</p>
+
+<p><i>Rise</i> means to move from a lower to a higher position.</p>
+
+<p><i>Raise</i> means to cause to rise.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The bread —— very slowly that cold day.</p>
+
+<p>2. Bread —— because of the yeast in it.</p>
+
+<p>3. After the bread had ——, we set the pans in the oven.</p>
+
+<p>4. They —— the old house so as to put a furnace in the cellar.</p>
+
+<p>5. The Black River —— sixteen inches yesterday.</p>
+
+<p>6. If the river continues to ——, the dam will go out.</p>
+
+<p>7. Shall we —— the flag at sunrise?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>The present tense form of some verbs is misused for the
+past tense. We should say, “The tailor <i>came</i> (not <i>come</i>)
+last night,” “I <i>ran</i> (not <i>run</i>) a mile yesterday,” “And then
+he <i>said</i> (not <i>says</i>), ‘Hurry up.’” The verbs oftenest misused
+in this way are <i>come</i>, <i>give</i>, <i>run</i>, <i>say</i>, and <i>see</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_139">[139]</span></p>
+
+<p>Study the following correct sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>He <i>came</i> last night.</p>
+
+<p>She <i>came</i> to meet me.</p>
+
+<p>It <i>came</i> without warning.</p>
+
+<p>I <i>ran</i> a mile yesterday.</p>
+
+<p>He <i>ran</i> in front of me.</p>
+
+<p>She <i>ran</i> out of sugar.</p>
+
+<p>At last he <i>said</i>, “I will go.”</p>
+
+<p>John <i>said</i>, “The schoolhouse is
+on fire.”</p>
+
+<p>I <i>said</i>, “Ring the bells.”</p>
+
+<p>He <i>gave</i> me a dollar.</p>
+
+<p>I <i>gave</i> the child a penny.</p>
+
+<p>She <i>gave</i> it to me.</p>
+
+<p>They <i>ran</i> up a bill.</p>
+
+<p>The dog <i>ran</i> behind.</p>
+
+<p>The baby <i>ran</i> to his mother.</p>
+
+<p>I <i>saw</i> the parade yesterday.</p>
+
+<p>He <i>saw</i> me go out.</p>
+
+<p>She <i>saw</i> them at the window.</p>
+
+<p>I <i>came</i>, I <i>saw</i>, I <i>conquered</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Some persons make a wrong past tense for certain verbs,
+and use such forms as <i>blowed</i> and <i>drawed</i>, when they should
+use <i>blew</i> and <i>drew</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 4.</b>—Supply the correct form for the past tense
+in each of these sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. <i>Blow.</i> The wind soon —— the smoke away.</p>
+
+<p>2. <i>Draw.</i> The boat —— four feet of water.</p>
+
+<p>3. <i>Grow.</i> Lucy —— too fast to be strong.</p>
+
+<p>4. <i>Know.</i> Nobody —— the right date but me.</p>
+
+<p>5. <i>Throw.</i> Who —— the ball last?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Some persons use the past participle of <i>see</i> and <i>do</i> for the
+past tense. We should say, “I <i>saw</i> (not <i>seen</i>) my duty, and
+I <i>did</i> (not done) it.”</p>
+
+<p>Study these correct sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>I <i>saw</i> the boat go down.</p>
+
+<p>Who <i>saw</i> the star first?</p>
+
+<p>We <i>saw</i> the elephant dance.</p>
+
+<p>He <i>did</i> his own work.</p>
+
+<p>She <i>did</i> it too fast.</p>
+
+<p>Everybody <i>did</i> what he could.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Another common error is the use of the past tense of a
+verb for the past participle, as in the expressions <i>is broke</i>
+and <i>had froze</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_140">[140]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 5.</b>—Supply the correct form in each of these
+sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. <i>Begin.</i> First we must finish what we have ——.</p>
+
+<p>2. <i>Break.</i> Dear me! I have —— the bird’s seed dish.</p>
+
+<p>3. <i>Drink.</i> Have you —— all the milk?</p>
+
+<p>4. <i>Freeze.</i> If the lagoon is ——, we can go skating.</p>
+
+<p>5. <i>Steal.</i> Why do you think that the purse was ——?</p>
+
+<p>6. <i>Swim.</i> Have you ever —— out to the island?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LV">LV. VOICE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section218"><b>218.</b> When we say, “The fish swallowed the worm,” we
+have a sentence made up of a subject, a verb, and an object
+complement. The subject names the doer of the action,
+while the object names the receiver of the action. The verb
+<i>swallowed</i> could have nothing for subject but some word that
+indicates the doer of the action. How is it with the verbs
+<i>broke</i>, <i>struck</i>, <i>whittled</i>? A verb that requires for its subject
+the name of the doer of an action is said to be in the <b>active
+voice</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section219"><b>219.</b> When we say, “The worm was swallowed by the
+fish,” we have a sentence made up of a subject, a verb, and
+a prepositional phrase. The subject names the receiver of
+the action, and the phrase tells by whom the action was performed.
+The verb <i>was swallowed</i> could have nothing for subject
+but some word that indicates the receiver of the action.
+How is it with the verbs <i>was swept</i>, <i>has been eaten</i>, <i>will be cut</i>?
+A verb that requires for its subject the name of the receiver
+of the action is said to be in the <b>passive voice</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section220"><b>220.</b> When a verb is changed from the active to the passive
+voice, the object of the active verb becomes the subject of
+the passive verb. Hence it is evident that only transitive
+verbs can have the passive voice.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section221"><b>221.</b> A verb is conjugated in the passive voice by adding the
+past participle of the verb to the conjugation of the verb <i>be</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_141">[141]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section222"><b>222.</b> Conjugation of the verb <i>see</i> in the passive voice:—</p>
+
+<p class="center">INDICATIVE MODE</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Tense</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I am seen</td>
+ <td>we are seen</td>
+ <td>I was seen</td>
+ <td>we were seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou art seen</td>
+ <td>you are seen</td>
+ <td>thou wast seen</td>
+ <td>you were seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he is seen</td>
+ <td>they are seen</td>
+ <td>he was seen</td>
+ <td>they were seen</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Future Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I shall be seen</td>
+ <td>we shall be seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou wilt be seen</td>
+ <td>you will be seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he will be seen</td>
+ <td>they will be seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I have been seen</td>
+ <td>we have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou hast been seen</td>
+ <td>you have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he has been seen</td>
+ <td>they have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I had been seen</td>
+ <td>we had been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou hadst been seen</td>
+ <td>you had been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he had been seen</td>
+ <td>they had been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Future Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I shall have been seen</td>
+ <td>we shall have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou wilt have been seen</td>
+ <td>you will have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he will have been seen</td>
+ <td>they will have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="center">SUBJUNCTIVE MODE</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I be seen</td>
+ <td>we be seen</td>
+ <td>I were seen</td>
+ <td>we were seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou be seen</td>
+ <td>you be seen</td>
+ <td>thou were seen</td>
+ <td>you were seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he be seen</td>
+ <td>they be seen</td>
+ <td>he were seen</td>
+ <td>they were seen</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I have been seen</td>
+ <td>we have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou have been seen</td>
+ <td>you have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he have been seen</td>
+ <td>they have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I had been seen</td>
+ <td>we had been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou had been seen</td>
+ <td>you had been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he had been seen</td>
+ <td>they had been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_142">[142]</span></p>
+
+<p class="center">IMPERATIVE MODE</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td>be seen (<i>you</i> or <i>thou</i>)</td>
+ <td>be seen (<i>you</i> or <i>ye</i>)</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="section" id="section223"><b>223.</b> Conjugation of the verb <i>see</i> in the passive voice, indicative
+mode, interrogative form:—</p>
+
+<p class="center">INDICATIVE MODE</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present</span></th>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>am I seen</td>
+ <td>are we seen</td>
+ <td>was I seen</td>
+ <td>were we seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>art thou seen</td>
+ <td>are you seen</td>
+ <td>wast thou seen</td>
+ <td>were you seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>is he seen</td>
+ <td>are they seen</td>
+ <td>was he seen</td>
+ <td>were they seen</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Future</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>shall I be seen</td>
+ <td>shall we be seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>shalt thou be seen</td>
+ <td>shall you be seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>will he be seen</td>
+ <td>will they be seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>have I been seen</td>
+ <td>have we been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>hast thou been seen</td>
+ <td>have you been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>has he been seen</td>
+ <td>have they been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>had I been seen</td>
+ <td>had we been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>hadst thou been seen</td>
+ <td>had you been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>had he been seen</td>
+ <td>had they been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Future Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>shall I have been seen</td>
+ <td>shall we have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>shalt thou have been seen</td>
+ <td>shall you have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>will he have been seen</td>
+ <td>will they have been seen</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—<b>Voice</b> is that property of a verb which shows
+whether the subject names the doer or the receiver of an action.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>active voice</b> shows that the subject names the doer of
+an action.</p>
+
+<p>The <b>passive voice</b> shows that the subject names the receiver
+of an action.</p>
+
+<p>A verb is conjugated in the passive voice by adding the
+past participle of the verb to the conjugation of the verb <i>be</i>.</p>
+
+<p>No intransitive verb has a passive voice.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_143">[143]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Conjugate the verbs <i>draw</i>, <i>take</i>, <i>find</i>, <i>forget</i>,
+and <i>leave</i> in the passive voice, both declaratively and interrogatively.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Select the verbs in the following sentences.
+Tell whether they are transitive or intransitive. Give the
+tense, mode, voice, and subject of each. Change the active
+verbs to the passive voice and the passive to the active.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—When the verb is passive, the name of the doer of the
+action is often omitted. Sometimes we do not know who the doer
+is; as, “The art of printing was invented in China long ago.”
+Sometimes we do not wish to tell who the doer is; as, “A window
+was broken in the basement yesterday.” Sometimes the subject is
+so obvious as not to be worth telling; as, “Lying is despised.” In
+changing sentences like these three to the active voice, we must
+supply a subject for the verb. For instance, in changing the sentence,
+“The pie was cut into four pieces,” we might say, “Mother
+cut the pie into four pieces.”</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The babe was conveyed to the church in a grand procession.
+The road, all the way, was carpeted with green rushes. Over this
+road the little infant Elizabeth was borne by one of her godmothers.
+She was wrapped in a mantle of purple velvet, with a long train.
+This train was trimmed with ermine, a very costly kind of fur, and
+was borne by lords and ladies of high rank. These dignitaries were
+appointed for the purpose by the king.</p>
+
+<p>2. The height of the pinnacle is determined by the breadth of
+the base.</p>
+
+<p>3. Leicester Hospital supports twelve old soldiers and their
+wives.</p>
+
+<p>4. After the housework had been done, they went out to the
+sunny garden, and picked the luscious red raspberries, not forgetful
+of the time when Mrs. Howe had set out the bushes with her own
+hands.</p>
+
+<p>5. Many of these splendid castles on the Rhine have been
+destroyed in modern times.</p>
+
+<p>6. It is wonderful and beautiful how a man and his dog will
+stick to one another through thick and thin.</p>
+
+<p>7. The door had been very firmly fastened, but the crowd tore
+it away bodily, and the light of the torches streamed into the room.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_144">[144]</span></p>
+
+<p>8. This garden is shaded by long lines of trees, and adorned with
+fountains and statues.</p>
+
+<p>9.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Away to the window I flew like a flash,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Tore open the shutters, and threw up the sash.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>10. Elephants are very strictly preserved by the English government.</p>
+
+<p>11. The farm boy picks up the potatoes after they have been
+dug; he drives the cows night and morning; he brings wood and
+water and splits kindling; he gets up the horse and puts out the
+horse; whether he is in the house or out of it, there is always something
+for him to do.</p>
+
+<p>12.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">They who do their souls no wrong,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">But keep at eve the faith of morn,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Shall daily hear the angel song,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">“To-day the Prince of Peace is born.”</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>13. Mr. Marley has been dead these seven years.</p>
+
+<p>14. The Peterkins told how their mother had put salt in the
+coffee, and how the chemist had made it worse instead of better.</p>
+
+<p>15. We climbed the Alps, veiled our faces before the awful
+splendors of Mont Blanc, trembled on the verge of dizzy heights,
+shrank back from fathomless abysses, picked our way across the
+<i>Mer de Glace</i>, and cowered beneath the weight of the whole incumbent
+mass of mountains as we went through the tunnel.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Tell the part of speech and use of <i>way</i>, sentence 1, <i>forgetful</i>
+4, <i>one another</i> 6, <i>open</i> 9, <i>up</i> 9, <i>souls</i> 12, <i>years</i> 13, <i>worse</i> 14.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LVI">LVI. THE PASSIVE VOICE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section224"><b>224.</b> Every combination of some form of the verb <i>be</i> with
+the past participle of a transitive verb is not necessarily a
+passive verb.</p>
+
+<p>For example, one passive form of the verb <i>do</i> is <i>is done</i>, but
+it does not follow that <i>is done</i> is always a passive verb. In
+the sentence, “The meat is done now,” we do not mean that
+the meat is receiving an action, hence <i>is done</i> cannot be a
+passive verb. We mean to tell the condition of the meat,
+that it is <i>done</i> meat. The word <i>done</i> is used in precisely the
+same way as an adjective; as if we should say, “The meat is
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_145">[145]</span><i>good</i> now,” In other words, the participle <i>done</i> is a subjective
+complement.</p>
+
+<p>Past participles are used as subjective complements to tell
+the condition of something <i>after</i> an action has been performed
+on it; as, “Every window in the house is <i>broken</i>,” “My
+dress is badly <i>torn</i>,” “The old house is <i>deserted</i>.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section225"><b>225.</b> When we are in doubt as to whether we have a true
+passive verb or not, we may apply these tests: (1) Does
+the sentence mean that the subject is acted upon? (2) Can
+we add a phrase, telling the performer of the action? (3) Can
+we change the sentence to the active voice, keeping, of course,
+the same tense?</p>
+
+<p>Let us take, for instance, the sentence, “Courage is praised.”
+We do mean that courage receives the praising. We can
+add the phrase <i>by everybody</i>. And we can change the sentence
+to the active sentence, “Everybody praises courage.”
+Hence <i>is praised</i> is the verb, and is in the passive voice.</p>
+
+<p>But in the sentence, “Every seat in the balcony is taken,”
+if <i>is taken</i> is a passive verb, it must mean, since it is present
+tense, that every seat is receiving an action now. It does not
+mean this, but it does mean that every seat is a <i>taken</i> seat,
+hence <i>taken</i> is used as a subjective complement, and the verb
+is just the one word <i>is</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section226"><b>226.</b> We learned in <a href="#XXXVII">Lesson XXXVII</a> that some verbs like
+<i>make</i>, <i>elect</i>, <i>appoint</i>, and <i>call</i>, are often followed by a direct
+object and an objective complement; as, “We called our
+canary Buttercup.”</p>
+
+<p>When such a sentence is changed to the passive voice, the
+direct object becomes, of course, the subject, and we have the
+sentence, “Our canary was called Buttercup.” The word
+<i>Buttercup</i> has now become a subjective complement. How
+do we know this?</p>
+
+<p>When the objective complement is an adjective, as in the
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_146">[146]</span>sentence, “She kept the polished floor as <i>bright</i> as a mirror,”
+if we change the sentence to the passive voice, the adjective
+becomes a subjective complement; as, “The polished
+floor was kept as bright as a mirror.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section227"><b>227.</b> We learned in <a href="#XXXIV">Lesson XXXIV</a> that certain verbs
+may be followed by both an indirect and a direct object; as,
+“Fred told Arthur the news.”</p>
+
+<p>In changing this sentence to the passive voice we may use
+the direct object for the subject of the passive verb; as,
+“The news was told to Arthur by Fred”; or we may use
+the indirect object for the subject of the passive verb; as,
+“Arthur was told the news by Fred.” In the latter case
+we have an idiomatic construction—a passive verb <i>was told</i>
+taking a direct object <i>the news</i>. The direct object of a passive
+verb is often called a <b>retained object</b>, because it remains
+as an object after the sentence has been changed to the passive
+voice.</p>
+
+<p>Not all sentences containing a direct and an indirect object
+can be changed to the passive voice in two ways. We
+say, “A rose was given to me,” or “I was given a rose.”
+We say, “A holiday was promised to the children,” or “The
+children were promised a holiday.” But we do not say, “I
+was passed the bread,” “I was written a note,” or “I was
+poured a cup of tea.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The past participle of a transitive verb may
+be used as the subjective complement of some form of the
+verb <i>be</i>. In such a case it denotes the condition of the subject.</p>
+
+<p>When a sentence containing a direct object and an objective
+complement is changed to the passive voice, the direct object
+becomes the subject, and the objective complement becomes
+a subjective complement.</p>
+
+<p>Some sentences containing both an indirect and a direct
+object may be changed to the passive voice in two ways,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_147">[147]</span>either the direct object or the indirect object becoming the
+subject.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Select each verb in the following sentences.
+Tell its voice, and how it is completed.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The time of the singing of birds is come, and the voice of the
+turtle is heard in the land.</p>
+
+<p>2. Queen Elizabeth is often familiarly called Queen Bess.</p>
+
+<p>3. Rebecca’s face was so swollen with tears and so sharp with
+misery that for a moment Uncle Jerry scarcely recognized her.</p>
+
+<p>4. To put it mildly, Mrs. Howe was greatly pleased when she
+was elected first president of the Murray Hill Society.</p>
+
+<p>5. When the eggs had been beaten stiff, the little cook sifted the
+sugar.</p>
+
+<p>6. Christ the Lord is risen to-day.</p>
+
+<p>7. The colonists were so disheartened and alarmed that they
+sailed at once for England.</p>
+
+<p>8. The youngest girl in the senior class was chosen valedictorian.</p>
+
+<p>9. When the automobile ran off the bridge, every one was surprised
+at the driver’s escape.</p>
+
+<p>10. The black colt had been named Odin, but he was always
+called Teddy.</p>
+
+<p>11.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The day is past and gone,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The evening shades appear.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>12. Those people are mistaken who say that hard work does not
+pay—they have never really tried it.</p>
+
+<p>13. The room was made cool and dark, so that the lady might
+sleep.</p>
+
+<p>14. The roofs of the long red barns, which had been stained green
+by the weather, were struck by the level rays of the low, western sun.</p>
+
+<p>15. The fabric of common order in America is sound and strong
+at the center; the pattern is well marked, and the threads are firmly
+woven.</p>
+
+<p>16. Harvard College may be regarded as the legitimate child of
+Emmanuel College at Cambridge in England.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Make either one or two passive sentences
+out of each sentence in Exercise 2, <a href="#Page_90">page 90</a>. Tell in each
+case what becomes of the subject, the direct object, and the
+indirect object.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_148">[148]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LVII">LVII. THE PROGRESSIVE CONJUGATION</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section228"><b>228.</b> We have learned to conjugate verbs both declaratively
+and interrogatively, in both the active and the passive voice.
+There is another form of conjugation, as shown in the statements,
+<i>I am laughing</i>, <i>I was laughing</i>, <i>I shall be laughing</i>, <i>I
+have been laughing</i>, etc.</p>
+
+<p>We use this form of conjugation when we wish to call attention
+to the <i>continuance</i> of the action asserted by the verb, and
+we call it the <b>progressive conjugation</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section229"><b>229.</b> Just as we use the past participle in conjugating a
+verb in the passive voice, so we use the <b>present participle</b> in
+conjugating a verb in the progressive form. <i>Laughing</i> is the
+present participle of the verb <i>laugh</i>. The present participle
+of every verb ends in <i>ing</i>; as, <i>running</i>, <i>hoping</i>, <i>tying</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section230"><b>230.</b> Synopsis of the progressive conjugation of the verb
+<i>see</i>:—</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—In the <b>synopsis</b> of a conjugation we give only one form
+for each tense, instead of six forms.</p>
+
+<p class="center">INDICATIVE MODE</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Present</i></td>
+ <td>I am seeing</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Past</i></td>
+ <td>I was seeing</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Future</i></td>
+ <td>I shall be seeing</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Present Perfect</i></td>
+ <td>I have been seeing</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Past Perfect</i></td>
+ <td>I had been seeing</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Future Perfect</i></td>
+ <td>I shall have been seeing</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="center">SUBJUNCTIVE MODE</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Present</i></td>
+ <td>I be seeing</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Past</i></td>
+ <td>I were seeing</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Present Perfect</i></td>
+ <td>I have been seeing</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Past Perfect</i></td>
+ <td>I had been seeing</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="center">IMPERATIVE MODE</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td>be seeing (you, thou, ye)</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_149">[149]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section231"><b>231.</b> The progressive conjugation may be made interrogative
+by changing the position of the auxiliary; as, <i>am I seeing?</i>
+<i>was I seeing?</i> etc.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The <b>progressive conjugation</b> is used to denote
+a continued action.</p>
+
+<p>It is made by joining the present participle of a given verb
+to the conjugation of the verb <i>be</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Conjugate the verbs <i>lift</i>, <i>dine</i>, and <i>get</i> in the
+progressive form, both declaratively and interrogatively.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LVIII">LVIII. THE EMPHATIC CONJUGATION</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section232"><b>232.</b> In the indicative mode, present tense, we may say,
+<i>I study</i>, which is the common form, or <i>I am studying</i>, which
+is the progressive form, or <i>I do study</i>, which is the <b>emphatic
+form</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section233"><b>233.</b> The emphatic conjugation is made by using the auxiliary
+verb <i>do</i>. It is found only in the present and past tenses
+of the indicative mode, and in the imperative mode.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section234"><b>234.</b> Conjugation of the verb <i>try</i> in the emphatic form.</p>
+
+<p class="center">INDICATIVE MODE</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Present Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I do try</td>
+ <td>we do try</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou dost try</td>
+ <td>you do try</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he does try</td>
+ <td>they do try</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <th colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Past Tense</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I did try</td>
+ <td>we did try</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou didst try</td>
+ <td>you did try</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he did try</td>
+ <td>they did try</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="center">IMPERATIVE MODE</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td>do try (thou, you, or ye)</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_150">[150]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section235"><b>235.</b> The two tenses of the indicative mode, emphatic
+form, may be made interrogative, as we learned in <a href="#LI">Lesson LI</a>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section236"><b>236.</b> The emphatic form is used for other purposes than
+for emphasis. It is generally used instead of the ordinary
+forms when the adverb <i>not</i> modifies the predicate. We say,
+“I do not love thee, Dr. Fell,” instead of “I love thee not.”
+And in the imperative mode with <i>not</i> we say, “Do not run
+with the ball,” instead of “Run not with the ball.”</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LIX">LIX. PARSING OF VERBS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section237"><b>237.</b> When we parse a verb, we should tell,—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Its class as to form,—regular or irregular.</p>
+
+<p>(2) Its principal parts.</p>
+
+<p>(3) Its class as to use,—transitive or intransitive.</p>
+
+<p>(4) Its voice,—active or passive.</p>
+
+<p>(5) Its mode,—indicative, subjunctive, or imperative.</p>
+
+<p>(6) Its tense.</p>
+
+<p>(7) Its person.</p>
+
+<p>(8) Its number.</p>
+
+<p>(9) Its form of conjugation,—interrogative, progressive,
+or emphatic.</p>
+
+<p>(10) Its simple subject.</p>
+
+<p>(11) Its complement (if any),—direct object, subjective
+complement, or objective complement.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Parse each verb in the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. What are you smiling at, Lady Mother?</p>
+
+<p>2. The shades were lowered at the windows, the lamps were
+lighted, the great family table was drawn towards the fire.</p>
+
+<p>3. When he went out from the village at the head of his men one
+fine day, while the sun was shining brightly, and the birds were
+singing, he did not neglect a single one of the many things which
+he had been told always brought good luck to the hunting.</p>
+
+<p>4. “No,” said Mrs. Howe, “I don’t enjoy moving, but the
+children do. They have been transporting clocks, and pictures,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_151">[151]</span>and lamps all the forenoon, when they haven’t been loading the
+dray, but they don’t seem a bit tired.”</p>
+
+<p>5. What shall it profit a man if he gain the whole world and lose
+his own soul?</p>
+
+<p>6. Child, was not your father called Mustapha the tailor?</p>
+
+<p>7. Do look at those gateposts!</p>
+
+<p>8. The hens had been mysteriously disappearing for over a
+month.</p>
+
+<p>9. Stir not a step till I come again.</p>
+
+<p>10. Do you wonder that I missed a word in spelling?</p>
+
+<p>11. Son, have any told thee that thou art beautiful beyond all
+men?</p>
+
+<p>12. Hadn’t you been putting on airs?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LX">LX. THE AUXILIARY VERBS <i>SHALL</i> AND <i>WILL</i></h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section238"><b>238.</b> In conjugating a verb in the future tense, indicative
+mode, we make use of the auxiliaries <i>shall</i> and <i>will</i>.</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th><i>Singular</i></th>
+ <th><i>Plural</i></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I shall go</td>
+ <td>we shall go</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou wilt go</td>
+ <td>you will go</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he will go</td>
+ <td>they will go</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>These verb phrases express simple futurity,—they assert
+an intention on the part of the person indicated by the subject,
+but not a promise.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section239"><b>239.</b> We have another set of verb phrases belonging to
+the future tense, indicative mode:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I will go</td>
+ <td>we will go</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>thou shalt go</td>
+ <td>you shall go</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>he shall go</td>
+ <td>they shall go</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>These phrases are used to express a promise, a vow, or a
+threat on the part of the speaker; that is, the speaker will see
+to it that the action is carried out. There is more of certainty
+in these phrases than in those of the first set.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section240"><b>240.</b> <i>Shall</i> and <i>will</i> with <i>have</i> are used also in forming the
+future perfect tense; as, <i>I shall have gone</i>, <i>he will have come</i>,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_152">[152]</span>etc. There is much less occasion to use the future perfect
+tense than there is to use the simple future tense, so we shall
+discuss the use of <i>shall</i> and <i>will</i> only in the future tense.
+When that is mastered, the future perfect tense will present
+no difficulties.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section241"><b>241.</b> Frequent errors are made in the use of <i>shall</i> and <i>will</i>.
+Perhaps the commonest occur in interrogative sentences.
+Many persons say carelessly, “Will I open this window for
+you?” This question means, “Am I going to open this
+window for you?” and the only possible answer is, “I am
+sure I don’t know.” What is really intended by the question
+is this, “Do you wish me to open this window?” hence we
+should say, “<i>Shall</i> I open this window for you?” The rule
+is,—When the subject of an interrogative sentence is <i>I</i> or
+<i>we</i>, the auxiliary <i>shall</i> should be used instead of <i>will</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section242"><b>242.</b> In questions where the subject is a word of the second
+or the third person, we should use in the question the form we
+expect in the answer. A boy should say to his employer,
+“Shall you be in your office this afternoon?” because he
+expects the reply, “I shall,” meaning, “I intend to be there.”
+But a boy says to another boy, “Will you pitch for us to-morrow?”
+because he expects the reply, “I will,” meaning
+“I promise.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—Rules for the use of <i>shall</i> and <i>will</i>:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) To assert simple futurity use <i>shall</i> in the first person,
+and <i>will</i> in the second and third persons.</p>
+
+<p>(2) To assert determination, a promise, or a threat, use
+<i>will</i> in the first person, <i>shall</i> in the second and third
+persons.</p>
+
+<p>(3) In questions use <i>shall</i> in the first person. In the second
+and third persons use <i>will</i> or <i>shall</i> according to the answer
+you should get. The form of the answer is to be determined
+by rules 1 and 2.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_153">[153]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Account for the use of <i>shall</i> and <i>will</i> in the
+following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. “What shall we do next?” said I, with a long breath.</p>
+
+<p>2. Thou shalt hang for laying thy hand upon me.</p>
+
+<p>3. Will you please tell me whether Mrs. Josiah Wheeler lives
+on this road?</p>
+
+<p>4. You shall have a birthday party on the lawn, and I will
+make you a soldier suit, and papa will get you a drum, and the
+supper table shall be set under the balm-of-Gilead tree.</p>
+
+<p>5. “No,” said the fairy, “this is my ax, and it shall lie upon the
+shelf, while you must dive for yours, yourself.”</p>
+
+<p>6. “We will come into the crop lands to play with thee by
+night,” said Gray Brother to Mowgli.</p>
+
+<p>7. Blessed are the peacemakers; for they shall be called the
+children of God.</p>
+
+<p>8. The first social problem is the problem of rule: who shall
+exercise it, how far shall it go, and by what means shall it be enforced?</p>
+
+<p>9. Whosoever will lose his life for my sake shall find it.</p>
+
+<p>10. Let us rest ourselves, and then we shall be better able to
+pursue our walk.</p>
+
+<p>11.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">When shall we three meet again</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">In thunder, lightning, or in rain?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>12. I will lift up mine eyes unto the hills, whence cometh my
+strength.</p>
+
+<p>13.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Who will fill our vacant places?</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Who will sing our songs to-night?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>14.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The daisies will be there, love.</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The stars in heaven will shine;</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">But I shall not feel thy wish, love,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Nor thou my hand in thine.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Tell the part of speech and use of <i>thy</i>, sentence 2, <i>me</i> 3,
+<i>you</i> 4, <i>this</i> 5, <i>yours</i> 5, <i>yourself</i> 5, <i>children</i> 7, <i>we</i> 11, <i>mine</i> 12.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Fill the blanks with the proper auxiliary,
+and give your reason in each case.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. O mother dear, Jerusalem, when —— I come to thee?</p>
+
+<p>2.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">We —— meet, but we —— miss him,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">There —— be one vacant chair.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_154">[154]</span></p>
+
+<p>3. There is no market in the world in which money —— buy
+brains.</p>
+
+<p>4. You —— always have this little blue Wedgwood tea set to
+remember her by.</p>
+
+<p>5. —— you wear the hat even if it is not becoming?</p>
+
+<p>6. I —— know him when he comes, happy youth.</p>
+
+<p>7. —— you get my watch that was left at the jeweler’s?</p>
+
+<p>8.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Oh, who —— walk a mile with me</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Along life’s merry way?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>9. If you do not promise to be home before midnight, you ——
+not go to the ball.</p>
+
+<p>10.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Three years she grew in sun and shower,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Then Nature said, “A lovelier flower</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">On earth was never sown;</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">This Child I to myself —— take;</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">She —— be mine, and I —— make</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">A Lady of my own.</div>
+ </div>
+ <div class="stanza1">
+ <div class="verse indent0">“The stars of midnight —— be dear</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">To her; and she —— lean her ear</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">In many a secret place</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Where rivulets dance their wayward round,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And beauty born of murmuring sound</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">—— pass into her face.</div>
+ </div>
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent2">“And vital feelings of delight</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">—— rear her form to stately height,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Her virgin bosom swell;</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Such thoughts to Lucy I —— give</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">While she and I together live</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Here in this happy dell.”</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXI">LXI. DEFECTIVE VERBS. VERB PHRASES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section243"><b>243.</b> Some verbs lack one or more of their principal parts.
+Such verbs are called <b>defective verbs</b>.</p>
+
+<p>A very common defective verb, which has only one form,
+is <i>ought</i>. (See <a href="#Page_135">page 135</a>.)</p>
+
+<p>Other defective verbs are <i>can</i>, <i>may</i>, <i>must</i>, <i>shall</i>, and <i>will</i>.
+The past tense forms of these verbs are <i>could</i>, <i>might</i>, <i>must,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_155">[155]</span>should</i>, and <i>would</i>, respectively. No one of these verbs is
+ever used as a principal verb, except <i>would</i>, as in the familiar
+expressions, “I <i>would</i> I were a bird,” “<i>Would</i> that he were
+here!”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section244"><b>244.</b> <i>Shall</i> and <i>will</i> are used as auxiliary verbs to form the
+future tenses. <i>Can</i>, <i>could</i>, <i>may</i>, <i>might</i>, <i>must</i>, <i>should</i>, and
+<i>would</i> are used to form certain very useful verb phrases that
+are in the present, the past, or the future perfect tense, and
+in either the indicative or the subjunctive mode according to
+their meaning.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section245"><b>245.</b> Using these verb phrases in the indicative mode we
+say,—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I <i>may go</i> to Japan.</td>
+ <td>He <i>may have gone</i> home early.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I <i>can see</i> seven stars.</td>
+ <td>It <i>cannot have come</i> yet.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>We <i>must go</i> early.</td>
+ <td>He <i>must have sold</i> it.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>You <i>might hurry</i> a little.</td>
+ <td>We <i>might have hurried</i>.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>He <i>could not tell</i> a lie.</td>
+ <td>I <i>could have eaten</i> more.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>She <i>would talk</i> in church.</td>
+ <td>He <i>would have helped</i> me.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>We <i>should honor</i> the flag.</td>
+ <td>You <i>should have earned</i> it.</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>If we look closely at the meaning of these sentences, and
+think of others containing the same auxiliaries, we shall conclude
+(1) that <i>may</i> and <i>might</i> denote possibility or permission,
+(2) that <i>can</i> and <i>could</i> denote power or ability, (3) that
+<i>must</i> denotes necessity, (4) that <i>would</i> denotes determination,
+(5) that <i>should</i> denotes obligation or duty.</p>
+
+<p>Any one of the verb phrases just studied may be made interrogative
+by transposition; as,—<i>May I borrow</i> your knife?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section246"><b>246.</b> <i>Can</i> and <i>must</i> are used only in the indicative mode.
+Using <i>may</i>, <i>might</i>, <i>could</i>, <i>would</i>, and <i>should</i> in subjunctive
+verb phrases, we say,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Long <i>may</i> it <i>wave</i>!</p>
+
+<p>Oh, that he <i>would help</i>!</p>
+
+<p>Though he <i>might be telling</i> the truth, he would not be believed.</p>
+
+<p>If I <i>could go</i> with father, I should be happy.</p>
+
+<p>If it <i>should freeze</i>, we could go skating.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_156">[156]</span></p>
+
+<p>If we look closely at these sentences, we shall see that the
+verbs denote (1) a wish, (2) something contrary to fact, (3)
+something uncertain. (See <a href="#LII">Lesson LII</a>.)</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section247"><b>247.</b> The seven auxiliaries just studied may be used in
+making passive verb phrases. Use the following phrases or
+similar ones in sentences:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td>may be broken</td>
+ <td>may have been taken</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>can be cut</td>
+ <td>can have been heard</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>must be paid</td>
+ <td>must have been bought</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>might be driven</td>
+ <td>might have been kept</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>could be seen</td>
+ <td>could have been done</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>would be hurt</td>
+ <td>would have been stung</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>should be met</td>
+ <td>should have been thrown</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="section" id="section248"><b>248.</b> Other verb phrases in very common use in speech are
+formed by means of the participle <i>going</i>. It is easy to imagine
+the following conversation as really taking place.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>“I <i>am going to go</i> to Niagara Falls next summer.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, <i>you were going to go</i> there last summer. In fact, you
+<i>have been going to go</i> there every summer since I have known you.”</p>
+
+<p>“True enough. My intentions are good, but my purse is light.
+Perhaps I <i>shall be going to go</i> all my life, and then get to heaven first
+after all.”</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Each of the four groups of italicized words is a verb phrase
+denoting an intention. Make ten similar phrases; as, <i>am
+going to sing</i>, <i>was going to eat</i>. Notice that <i>going</i> does not
+denote the act of going anywhere to sing or to eat, as it does
+in “I am going to the Park to hear the band play,” but
+only the <i>purpose</i> or <i>intention</i> of singing or eating.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section249"><b>249.</b> Just as we denote an intended future action by using
+the word <i>going</i>, so we often denote a customary past action
+by a phrase in which we employ the verb <i>used</i>; as, “She
+<i>used to wear</i> a little red cape,” “Johnson <i>used to touch</i> every
+fence post that he passed.” The italicized words should
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_157">[157]</span>not be separated here, but should be considered as one group
+or verb phrase.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section250"><b>250.</b> In speaking of any of the verb phrases described in
+this lesson, we may call them verbs; we decide their person
+and number by their subject, their voice and mode by their
+meaning, and their tense by their form.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section251"><b>251.</b> The verbs <i>have</i> and <i>do</i> are not always auxiliaries.
+They are sometimes principal verbs, and as such are conjugated
+in the various ways. What are the principal parts of
+<i>have?</i> of <i>do</i>?</p>
+
+<p>Conjugate <i>have</i> in the indicative mode; <i>do</i> in the emphatic
+form; <i>have</i> in the progressive form; <i>do</i> in the passive voice,
+in the third person, singular number, using <i>it</i> for the subject.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section252"><b>252.</b> Verbs like <i>rain</i>, <i>snow</i>, <i>hail</i>, etc., are sometimes called
+<b>impersonal verbs</b>, because they are used only in the third
+person singular with the pronoun <i>it</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>defective verb</b> is one that lacks one or
+more of its principal parts.</p>
+
+<p>Defective verbs are used as auxiliary verbs.</p>
+
+<p>The auxiliaries <i>may</i>, <i>can</i>, <i>must</i>, <i>might</i>, <i>could</i>, <i>would</i>, and
+<i>should</i> are used to form certain common verb phrases.</p>
+
+<p>These verb phrases may be active or passive, declarative
+or interrogative, indicative or subjunctive mode, present,
+past, or present perfect tense.</p>
+
+<p><i>Going</i> is used to form verb phrases that denote a future or
+intended action.</p>
+
+<p><i>Used</i> is employed to form verb phrases that denote a customary
+past action.</p>
+
+<p><i>Have</i> and <i>do</i> may be principal verbs as well as auxiliary verbs.</p>
+
+<p><b>Impersonal verbs</b> are used only in the third person singular,
+with the neuter pronoun <i>it</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_158">[158]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Select all the verb phrases in the following
+sentences. Tell their voice, person, number, subject, and
+complement if they have any.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. What a bird it must be that could utter such wondrous
+sounds!</p>
+
+<p>2. From time to time the two rabbits would halt, sit up on their
+hind quarters, erect their long, attentive ears, and glance about
+warily with their bulging eyes.</p>
+
+<p>3.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The rich man’s son inherits cares;</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The bank may break, the factory burn,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">A breath may burst his bubble shares,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And soft white hands could hardly earn</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">A living that would serve his turn.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>4. All the girls in the class are going to wear pink chambray
+dresses, and mother is going to make mine by hand.</p>
+
+<p>5. We can go by the North Road, the South Road, or the
+Middle Road.</p>
+
+<p>6. Instead of candy, mother used to give him sugar in a cup,
+and then he would stretch out on the sunny doorstep and feed his
+sweet crystals to the flies.</p>
+
+<p>7. The Cottontails were now sole owners of the holes, and did
+not go near them when they could help it, lest anything like a
+path should be made that might betray their last retreats to an
+enemy.</p>
+
+<p>8. If you are going to make orange marmalade to-morrow, you
+must peel the oranges this evening.</p>
+
+<p>9. I should think that something might be done about covering
+the cow’s horns; perhaps they might be padded with cotton.</p>
+
+<p>10. Governor Winthrop wrote his third wife tender messages in
+a way that could only have come of long practice.</p>
+
+<p>11. The children used to stand at the window in the twilight, and
+watch the lights appear in the houses; and when they had counted
+ten, they used to clap their hands, and say, “Now, mother, it is time
+to light the lamp.”</p>
+
+<p>12. On the usual crisp mornings of sugar season the snow at such
+an hour would have borne a crust to crackle sharply under every
+footstep.</p>
+
+<p>13. I had not told the horse that I was going to whip him, so he
+was taken by surprise and started forward.</p>
+
+<p>14. Grandpa would not be helped into his overcoat.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_159">[159]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Select all the verb phrases containing any
+form of <i>have</i> or <i>do</i>. Tell whether this form is used as an auxiliary
+or as a principal verb.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Shere Khan does us great honor.</p>
+
+<p>2. Whoever has made a voyage up the Hudson must remember
+the Kaatskill Mountains.</p>
+
+<p>3. Do you ever wonder how so much sin and wrong and suffering
+can be in God’s world?</p>
+
+<p>4. Mother never forgot the millionaire’s daughter who said that
+she did up her father’s shirts.</p>
+
+<p>5. All the Offal Court boys had this same hard time, so Tom
+supposed it was the correct and comfortable thing.</p>
+
+<p>6. Where does amber get its strange, poetic charm?</p>
+
+<p>7. I never had the pleasure of meeting a crowing hen; but I
+have known a great many whistling girls, and I cannot recall an
+instance where their ends were any worse than those of other girls.</p>
+
+<p>8. If I could have committed suicide without killing myself,
+I should certainly have done so.</p>
+
+<p>9. She had eaten as many mouthfuls of breakfast as she possibly
+could in her excited condition, had kissed everybody good-by twice
+over, and now thought it was time to be starting.</p>
+
+<p>10. I can’t write a composition unless I have something to say,
+can I?</p>
+
+<p>11. On these hard, smooth roads one horse will do the work of
+two.</p>
+
+<p>12. I do not feel wholly sure that my Pussy wrote these letters
+herself.</p>
+
+<p>13. The Boy had no fear of the undisputed Master of the Woods,
+the big black bear.</p>
+
+<p>14. Do the duty that lies nearest thee; thy second duty will
+already have become clearer.</p>
+
+<p>15. Jakie had been stolen from the nest before he could fly.</p>
+
+<p>16. I do wish that you and your father would turn around
+directly and come home.</p>
+
+<p>17. Jane had had the inestimable advantage of a sorrow.</p>
+
+<p>18. The old bell had things all its own way up in the steeple.</p>
+
+<p>19. Boys always do the nice splendid things, and girls can only
+do the nasty dull ones that get left over.</p>
+
+<p>20. After the twins had had measles and mumps, whooping cough
+descended on the household.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_160">[160]</span></p>
+
+<p>Tell the part of speech and use of <i>us</i>, sentence 1, <i>honor</i> 1,
+<i>shirts</i> 4, <i>same</i> 5, <i>great</i> 7, <i>two</i> 11, <i>wholly</i> 12, <i>herself</i> 12, <i>bear</i> 13,
+<i>clearer</i> 14, <i>father</i> 16, <i>home</i> 16.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section253"><b>253.</b> Many errors are made in the use of the auxiliaries
+<i>may</i> and <i>can</i>, <i>would</i> and <i>should</i>.</p>
+
+<p>We should use <i>may</i> to denote permission, liberty, or possibility,
+and <i>can</i> to denote power or ability.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Supply the correct word in each of these
+sentences, and give your reason in each case:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. What —— I do to help you?</p>
+
+<p>2. You —— have a watch when you graduate.</p>
+
+<p>3. I —— go by boat, but it is doubtful.</p>
+
+<p>4. —— you run an automobile?</p>
+
+<p>5. —— we have a school paper?</p>
+
+<p>6. Do you think that I —— earn ten dollars a week?</p>
+
+<p>7. Fred, you —— open the east windows.</p>
+
+<p>8. If we walk fast, we —— surely get there in time.</p>
+
+<p>9. We —— get there in time, but we shall have to hurry.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Make three good sentences containing <i>may</i> and three containing
+<i>can</i>.</p>
+
+<p><i>Would</i> is used to denote,—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Determination; as, “Albert <i>would</i> leave school.”</p>
+
+<p>(2) Inclination; as, “I <i>would</i> read more if I could.”</p>
+
+<p>(3) Customary past action; as, “We <i>would</i> listen to her
+songs hour after hour.”</p>
+
+<p><i>Should</i> is used to denote,—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Simple intention; as, “I <i>should</i> come often if you did
+not live so far.”</p>
+
+<p>(2) Obligation or duty; as, “We <i>should</i> honor our parents.”
+Perhaps these auxiliaries are oftenest misused when associated
+with the verb <i>like</i>. The expression, “I would like to
+go,” is wrong, because it means “I am inclined or determined
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_161">[161]</span>to like something,” which is not good sense. We
+should say,—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td>I should like to go</td>
+ <td>We should like to go</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>You would like to go</td>
+ <td>You would like to go</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>He would like to go</td>
+ <td>They would like to go</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>In a dependent clause <i>should</i> denotes merely an imaginary
+condition, and <i>would</i> denotes inclination as well as an imaginary
+condition.</p>
+
+<p>The clauses, “If I should lose my watch,” “If you should
+lose your watch,” “If he should lose his watch,” are equivalent
+to the present tense of the subjunctive mode, and denote
+merely an imaginary condition.</p>
+
+<p>The clauses, “If I would study harder,” “if you would
+study harder,” “if he would study harder,” denote an imaginary
+condition that may become real according to the inclination
+of the subject.</p>
+
+<p>What is the meaning of the familiar dependent clause in
+the following sentence: “If it would only snow, we could
+have a sleigh ride?”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Supply the correct word in each of these sentences,
+and give your reason in each case:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. You —— study the text before you undertake the exercise.</p>
+
+<p>2. What —— you do with him, Mr. Dick?</p>
+
+<p>3. I —— wash him and put him to bed.</p>
+
+<p>4. Neither of the boys —— obey me.</p>
+
+<p>5. As soon as day broke, the canary —— begin to sing.</p>
+
+<p>6. I —— like to meet your grandfather.</p>
+
+<p>7. Any girl —— be satisfied with two new hats.</p>
+
+<p>8. They —— all like to come, I am sure.</p>
+
+<p>9. I —— not take one cent of his money.</p>
+
+<p>10. I —— think that you —— be glad to work.</p>
+
+<p>11. Each man —— keep himself loyal to truth.</p>
+
+<p>12. If I —— tell the story, the children —— not be satisfied.</p>
+
+<p>13. If I —— tell them stories all day long, they —— not be satisfied.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_162">[162]</span></p>
+
+<p>Make five good sentences containing <i>would</i>, and five containing
+<i>should</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The verb <i>have got</i> is often misused for the verb <i>have</i>. “I
+have it” means “I possess it,” while “I have got it” means
+“I have procured it.” “I have to go” means “I must go,”
+while “I have got to go” is an incorrect expression.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 3.</b>—Supply <i>has</i> or <i>have</i>, <i>has got</i>, or <i>have got</i> in
+each of the following sentences, and give your reason in each
+case. Use the negative word <i>not</i>, if necessary.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. —— you tickets for the entertainment?</p>
+
+<p>2. No, I —— them yet.</p>
+
+<p>3. Can he buy a farm if he —— no money?</p>
+
+<p>4. —— you a chisel, Albert?</p>
+
+<p>5. No, I —— one, but Herman —— one.</p>
+
+<p>6. At last he —— a position on the police force.</p>
+
+<p>7. We —— a fruit farm and father —— a new tenant on it.</p>
+
+<p>8. We —— to practice at four o’clock.</p>
+
+<p>9. I can’t go to the football game for I —— to work Saturday
+afternoons.</p>
+
+<p>10. Nobody —— to leave before nine o’clock.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>What correct expressions can you substitute for <i>has got</i>
+in the familiar sentence, “Madge has got to do as I say”?</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXII">LXII. DIRECT AND INDIRECT DISCOURSE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section254"><b>254.</b> In the sentence,—Ruth said, “<i>I like your cake</i>,”
+we have a <b>direct quotation</b>, the exact words spoken by Ruth.
+A direct quotation is often called <b>direct discourse</b>.</p>
+
+<p>In the sentence,—<i>Ruth said that she liked my cake</i>,
+we have an <b>indirect quotation</b> containing the substance, or
+thought, of Ruth’s remark, but not her exact words. An
+indirect quotation is often called <b>indirect discourse</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section255"><b>255.</b> In changing from direct to indirect discourse, we are
+likely to make a change in personal pronouns, as well as in
+the tense of verbs. An indirect quotation usually takes the
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_163">[163]</span>form of a dependent clause beginning with the word <i>that</i>. If
+the verb of saying that usually precedes an indirect quotation
+is in the present tense, then the verb in the quotation is likely
+to be in the present or the future tense; but if the verb of saying
+is in the past tense, then the verb in the quotation is likely
+to be in the past tense; as,</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Father <i>says</i> that he <i>is</i> on the jury.</p>
+
+<p>Father <i>said</i> that he <i>was</i> on the jury.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Can you account for the tense of the verb in the indirect
+quotation in this sentence,—Somebody once said that the
+pen is mightier than the sword?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section256"><b>256.</b> When a direct quotation containing the word <i>shall</i>
+is changed to an indirect quotation, <i>shall</i> is retained if the
+verb of saying preceding the quotation is in the present tense;
+but if this verb is in the past tense, then <i>shall</i> is changed to
+<i>should</i>. In like manner <i>will</i> is changed to <i>would</i>; as,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Mother says, “I shall be voting soon.”</p>
+
+<p>Mother says that she shall be voting soon.</p>
+
+<p>Mother said that she should be voting soon.</p>
+
+<p>Mother says, “I will make him a pillow.”</p>
+
+<p>Mother says that she will make him a pillow.</p>
+
+<p>Mother said that she would make him a pillow.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section257"><b>257.</b> If a direct quotation is a question, it becomes an indirect
+question when changed to indirect discourse; as,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>He asked, “Why do you tremble so?”</p>
+
+<p>He asked me why I trembled so.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section258"><b>258.</b> A command may be changed from direct to indirect
+discourse; as,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Christ said, “Love your enemies.”</p>
+
+<p>Christ said that we should love our enemies.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_164">[164]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Account for the use of <i>shall</i>, <i>will</i>, <i>should</i>, and
+<i>would</i> in the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The teacher said, “I shall be pleased to go.”</p>
+
+<p>2. The teacher said that she should be pleased to go.</p>
+
+<p>3. Aunt Elsie said, “I will tell you the story to-morrow.”</p>
+
+<p>4. Aunt Elsie said that she would tell us the story to-morrow.</p>
+
+<p>5. The principal said, “You shall have no recess to-day.”</p>
+
+<p>6. The principal said that we should have no recess to-day.</p>
+
+<p>7. Mother said, “You will be late.”</p>
+
+<p>8. Mother said that I should be late.</p>
+
+<p>9. The mayor said, “The matter shall be investigated.”</p>
+
+<p>10. The mayor said that the matter should be investigated.</p>
+
+<p>11. The director said, “The celebration will be on Tuesday.”</p>
+
+<p>12. The director said that the celebration would be on Tuesday.</p>
+
+<p>13. The teacher said, “David and Harry shall not take part.”</p>
+
+<p>14. David and Harry, the teacher said that you should not take
+part.</p>
+
+<p>15. The boys said, “David and Harry will be sorry.”</p>
+
+<p>16. David and Harry, the boys said that you would be sorry.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Change the following sentences from direct
+to indirect discourse:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Longfellow said, “Life is real, life is earnest.”</p>
+
+<p>2. John wrote, “I know that Shep will give you a warm welcome
+when you come.”</p>
+
+<p>3. The lawyer demanded, “Mr. Christoff, what have you done
+with the company’s books?”</p>
+
+<p>4. The Bible says, “Give to him that asketh.”</p>
+
+<p>5. Patrick Henry asked, “When shall we be stronger?”</p>
+
+<p>6. The eloquent speaker said, “The declaration of our independence
+will strengthen us at home, and give us character abroad.”</p>
+
+<p>7. The great orator declared, “If we fail, it can be no worse for
+us. But we shall not fail. The cause will raise up armies.”</p>
+
+<p>8. He admitted, “We may not live to the time when this declaration
+shall be made good.”</p>
+
+<p>9. Then he uttered this prophecy: “This declaration must
+cost treasure, and it may cost blood; but it will stand, and it will
+richly compensate for both.”</p>
+
+<p>10. Every listener was moved when the statesman said, “If it
+be the pleasure of Heaven that my country shall require the poor
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_165">[165]</span>offering of my life, the victim shall be ready at the appointed hour
+of sacrifice.”</p>
+
+<p>11. His closing words were these: “All that I have, and all that
+I am, and all that I hope, in this life, I am now ready here to stake
+upon it; and I leave off as I began, that live or die, survive or
+perish, I am for the declaration.”</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 3.</b>—Make the following sentences clear by changing
+them from indirect to direct discourse:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The teacher told Mrs. Gray that her little girl lost the report
+she had given her.</p>
+
+<p>2. Jennie told Ada that her mother was willing that she should
+go to the concert with her and her brother.</p>
+
+<p>3. Bertrand told George that he ought to sell his sailboat and
+buy his launch.</p>
+
+<p>4. The teachers asked the young men why they had made such
+a disturbance in the corridor when they had forbidden them to
+congregate there.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXIII">LXIII. AGREEMENT OF VERB AND SUBJECT. COLLECTIVE NOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section259"><b>259.</b> A verb must agree with its subject in number, and
+since the verb changes its form sometimes to denote number,
+we must be careful to employ the correct form. We should
+say, “The rose <i>is</i> red, the roses <i>are</i> red; the wind <i>does</i>
+blow, the winds <i>do</i> blow; the bird <i>flies</i>, the birds <i>fly</i>.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section260"><b>260.</b> This agreement of the subject and the verb is a simple
+matter in English, for in our language verbs have the
+same form in the singular and the plural, except in four
+cases:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) The verb <i>be</i>, which changes its form considerably to
+indicate number, in the present and past tenses. See <a href="#Page_128">page 128</a>.</p>
+
+<p>(2) Any verb in the second person conjugated in the solemn
+style. See <a href="#Page_128">page 128</a>.</p>
+
+<p>(3) Any verb in the third person of the present tense, indicative
+mode; as, he <i>speaks</i>, they <i>speak</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_166">[166]</span></p>
+
+<p>(4) Any verb in the third person of the present perfect
+indicative; as, he <i>has</i> spoken, they <i>have</i> spoken.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section261"><b>261.</b> As <i>don’t</i> is a contraction of <i>do not</i>, it should be used
+only with a plural subject, or with the singular pronouns <i>I</i>
+and <i>you</i>. We say, “I <i>don’t</i> know,” “You <i>don’t</i> know,”
+“They <i>don’t</i> know,” but “He <i>doesn’t</i> know,” “She <i>doesn’t</i>
+know,” “It <i>doesn’t</i> come.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section262"><b>262.</b> A compound subject composed of two or more singular
+nouns should have a plural verb when the parts are joined
+by any conjunction but <i>or</i> or <i>nor</i>. We say, “Either John or
+Byron <i>is</i> her cousin,” and “Both John and Joe <i>are</i> her cousins.”</p>
+
+<p>When two singular subjects refer to one person, the verb,
+of course, should be singular. We say, “The secretary and
+treasurer <i>was</i> absent.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section263"><b>263.</b> When a singular noun is modified by the limiting
+adjective <i>each</i>, <i>every</i>, <i>either</i>, <i>neither</i>, <i>any</i>, or <i>no</i>, and used as
+subject of a clause, its verb must be singular; as, “Each flower
+<i>is</i> a thing of beauty,” “No man <i>lives</i> but loves something.”</p>
+
+<p>In declarative sentences this rule is not likely to be violated,
+but it is often violated in interrogative sentences, where the
+verb precedes the subject. We should say, “<i>Has</i> either book
+been returned?” “<i>Is</i> either of you willing to stay?” “<i>Was</i>
+neither of the speakers on time?”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section264"><b>264.</b> There is a class of nouns like <i>flock</i>, <i>army</i>, <i>herd</i>, <i>company</i>,
+which mean a collection of individuals, and so seem
+to be plural; but since the individuals forming the collection
+are thought of as one body, these nouns are in reality singular.
+They are <b>collective nouns</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section265"><b>265.</b> The verb of which a collective noun is subject is a
+singular verb, and the pronoun that stands for a collective
+noun is the neuter singular pronoun <i>it</i>. We say, “The company
+<i>is</i> on <i>its</i> way to the Philippines.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_167">[167]</span></p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—When a collective noun is plural in meaning, that is,
+when the individuals are thought of as acting separately, it takes
+a plural verb; as, “The faculty <i>are</i> not going to trouble <i>their</i> heads
+about the kind of shoes we wear.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A verb must agree with its subject in person
+and in number.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>collective</b> noun is one that names a group of individuals
+considered as one body.</p>
+
+<p>A collective noun is usually singular and neuter.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—If you do not already know, find out from
+the dictionary to what sort of individuals each of these collective
+nouns is applied.</p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>bevy</li>
+ <li>choir</li>
+ <li>committee</li>
+ <li>constellation</li>
+ <li>covey</li>
+ <li>crew</li>
+ <li>drove</li>
+ <li>family</li>
+ <li>fleet</li>
+ <li>flock</li>
+ <li>gang</li>
+ <li>hive</li>
+ <li>horde</li>
+ <li>jury</li>
+ <li>mob</li>
+ <li>orchestra</li>
+ <li>regiment</li>
+ <li>swarm</li>
+ <li>tribe</li>
+ <li>troop</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Find all the collective nouns in these sentences.
+Find evidence as to whether they are singular or
+plural. If they are plural, tell why. Give the reason for
+the number of each verb.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Forty wolves make a very fair pack indeed.</p>
+
+<p>2. At the edge of the thicket was a straggling colony of low blueberry
+bushes.</p>
+
+<p>3. Here, in course of days, there accumulated a shining cluster
+of six large white eggs.</p>
+
+<p>4. At last cousin Eben came with a double sleigh and the team
+of prancing grays, and then the whole family was off for Christmas
+dinner at Aunt Mary’s.</p>
+
+<p>5. Has either of the critics ever heard the new organ?</p>
+
+<p>6. No man in his senses takes such a risk.</p>
+
+<p>7. A school of porpoises were ducking and tearing through the
+water.</p>
+
+<p>8. Through the ancient forest, which was a mixed growth of
+cedar, water ash, black poplar, and maple, with here and there a
+group of hemlocks on a knoll, the light drained down confusedly.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_168">[168]</span></p>
+
+<p>9. The opinions of this junto were completely controlled by
+Nicholas Vedder.</p>
+
+<p>10. Is either of you going up the river in the houseboat?</p>
+
+<p>11. This band of crows numbered about two hundred.</p>
+
+<p>12. Each year the old crow came with his troop, and for about
+six weeks took up his abode on the hill.</p>
+
+<p>13. Here and there a band of chimney sweeps were staring in
+stupid wonder at the miracle of a showman’s box.</p>
+
+<p>14. Butler tells of an Indian tribe in the Far North that was all
+but exterminated by a feud over a dog.</p>
+
+<p>15. On a level spot was a company of odd-looking personages
+playing at ninepins.</p>
+
+<p>16. Every word on his papers was correctly spelled.</p>
+
+<p>17. The rest of the horses swept dutifully into line, and the
+herd was off.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXIV">LXIV. REVIEW OF VERBS: PARSING</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section266"><b>266.</b> Study again Lessons <a href="#XXIII">XXIII-XXVII</a>, <a href="#XLIX">XLIX-LXIII</a>.
+Make an outline of verbs, having the following main topics:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Classification.</p>
+
+<p>(2) Properties.</p>
+
+<p>(3) Conjugation.</p>
+
+<p>(4) Principal Parts.</p>
+
+<p>(5) Auxiliaries.</p>
+
+<p>(6) Agreement.</p>
+
+<p>Fill in the subtopics and recite in detail from your outline
+with illustrations of every point.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Parse the verbs in the following sentences
+according to the outline on <a href="#Page_150">p. 150</a>:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. If you have a Halloween party, shall you invite the Cromers?</p>
+
+<p>2. At first the chemist said he couldn’t do anything about it;
+but when Agamemnon said they would pay in gold if he would
+only go, he packed up his bottles in a leather case, and went back
+with the Peterkins.</p>
+
+<p>3.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Faith’s journeys end is welcome to the weary,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And heaven, the heart’s true home, will come at last.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_169">[169]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. We are going to have a tile well, and Mr. Jones is going to
+oversee the men who dig it.</p>
+
+<p>5. This woodchuck was neither handsome nor interesting, but
+he knew how to take care of himself.</p>
+
+<p>6. Sheep are usually kept in flocks of from one thousand to
+three thousand under one or more shepherds.</p>
+
+<p>7. Rabbits telegraph each other by thumping on the ground
+with their hind feet.</p>
+
+<p>8. Lady Moon, Lady Moon, where are you roving?</p>
+
+<p>9.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Breast the wave, Christian, when it is strongest.</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Watch for day, Christian, when the night’s longest.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>10. Even so did men talk round the king’s cages at Oodeypore.</p>
+
+<p>11. Your Uncle Nathan and I used to be called the bothering
+Bodleys, because we were always teasing to find out something.</p>
+
+<p>12. The Peterkins had been so busy inside the house that they
+had not noticed the ceasing of the storm outside.</p>
+
+<p>13. For thou, Lord, wilt give thy blessing unto the righteous,
+and with thy favorable kindness wilt thou defend him as with a
+shield.</p>
+
+<p>14. My father’s, like every other young ladies’ school near a
+village, was very much disturbed by the attentions of the village
+young men.</p>
+
+<p>15. If any man have a hundred sheep, and one of them be gone
+astray, doth he not leave the ninety and nine and go into the mountains
+and seek that which goeth astray?</p>
+
+<p>16. They were sitting round the breakfast table and wondering
+what they should do because the lady from Philadelphia had gone
+away.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXV">LXV. CLASSIFICATION OF ADVERBS. SIMPLE ADVERBS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section267"><b>267.</b> In <a href="#X">Lesson X</a> it was shown that an adverb modifies
+a verb, an adjective, or another adverb. Select the adverbs
+in the following sentences, and tell what words they modify:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>We proceeded through a tract of country excessively wild and
+desolate.</p>
+
+<p>People with lanterns rushed hither and thither.</p>
+
+<p>John knew that he could spend a day very pleasantly in going
+over to that pasture.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_170">[170]</span></p>
+
+<p>All the adverbs in these sentences are called <b>simple adverbs</b>
+because they have but one office in the sentence,—they
+merely modify the word they go with.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section268"><b>268.</b> In the sentence, “Perhaps my pony can carry the
+load,” the word <i>perhaps</i> tells nothing whatever about the
+action of carrying, but rather serves to make the whole statement
+doubtful. Such a word is said to modify the whole
+sentence. Some other adverbs used in this way are <i>certainly</i>,
+<i>indeed</i>, <i>fortunately</i>, and <i>not</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The common use of the adverb <i>not</i> is to change an affirmative
+statement to a negative statement, as in the sentence,
+“I will not wear my heart upon my sleeve.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section269"><b>269.</b> The simple adverbs, <i>when</i>, <i>where</i>, <i>why</i>, <i>how</i>, <i>whence</i>,
+<i>whither</i>, are used in asking questions; as, “<i>When</i> shall we be
+stronger?” “<i>Why</i> do you answer me so?” Such adverbs
+modify the whole predicate. They are called <b>interrogative
+adverbs</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—<i>The</i> is sometimes used as an adverb before comparatives;
+as, “<i>The</i> more you have, <i>the</i> more you want.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section270"><b>270.</b> When the meaning permits, adverbs may be compared
+in the same manner as adjectives; as, <i>fast</i>, <i>faster</i>, <i>fastest</i>;
+<i>pleasantly</i>, <i>more pleasantly</i>, <i>most pleasantly</i>; <i>fortunately</i>,
+<i>less fortunately</i>, <i>least fortunately</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>simple adverb</b> is one that merely modifies
+the word or the group of words that it goes with.</p>
+
+<p>Some simple adverbs, like <i>not</i>, <i>perhaps</i>, <i>certainly</i>, modify
+the whole sentence.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>interrogative adverb</b> is a simple adverb that is used in
+asking a question.</p>
+
+<p>Some adverbs may be compared.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the simple adverbs in the following
+sentences, and tell what each modifies. In so far as you
+can, tell what each adverb denotes. (See <a href="#X">Lesson X</a>.)</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_171">[171]</span></p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. How the huge breakers foam and fret!</p>
+
+<p>2. People living by the sea are always more or less superstitious.</p>
+
+<p>3. No one can work well without sleep.</p>
+
+<p>4. Whence came that blessed mother love, so strong, so dauntless,
+so pure, and whither has it fled?</p>
+
+<p>5. Where had the stone been before? Why did it come there?
+When would it go away?</p>
+
+<p>6. Heaven is not reached at a single bound.</p>
+
+<p>7. Luckily, poor Pepper was not seriously hurt.</p>
+
+<p>8. Meanwhile Mrs. Peterkin was getting quite impatient for
+her coffee.</p>
+
+<p>9. How do you like to go up in a swing, up in the air so blue?</p>
+
+<p>10. Why should one hurry when days are long and calm and
+sweet?</p>
+
+<p>11. You may lead a horse to water, but you cannot make him
+drink.</p>
+
+<p>12. Presently a huge black bear poked his nose out of the bushes,
+and sniffed inquiringly.</p>
+
+<p>13. How quickly we learn to claim as our own that in which we
+delight!</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXVI">LXVI. CONJUNCTIVE ADVERBS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section271"><b>271.</b> In <a href="#XX">Lesson XX</a> we learned that a dependent clause is
+one that does not make sense when standing alone; also that
+such a clause sometimes has the office of an adverb, modifying
+a predicate, and sometimes that of an adjective, modifying
+a noun. It is, therefore, called an <b>adverbial clause</b>
+or an <b>adjective clause</b>.</p>
+
+<p>Select and classify the dependent clauses in each of the
+following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>(<i>a</i>) Old Stony Phiz set out on a visit to the valley where he was
+born.</p>
+
+<p>(<i>b</i>) When I first came to Rivermouth, I looked upon girls as
+rather tame company.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section272"><b>272.</b> A dependent clause is usually introduced by some
+word which indicates that it is a dependent clause. In the
+clause <i>where he was born</i>, this introductory word is <i>where</i>.
+What is the introductory word in the clause in sentence (<i>b</i>)?</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_172">[172]</span></p>
+
+<p>This introductory word does more than introduce the
+clause; it joins the clause to the word the clause modifies.
+What does <i>where</i> join in (<i>a</i>)? What does the introductory
+word in (<i>b</i>) join?</p>
+
+<p>But these words do more than join. <i>Where</i> denotes place,
+and modifies the verb <i>was born</i>. Hence it is an adverb.
+What does <i>when</i> denote? What does it modify?</p>
+
+<p>Since these words have two uses, that of an adverb and
+that of a joining word, we call them <b>conjunctive adverbs</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>conjunctive adverb</b> is one that introduces
+a clause, modifies some part of the clause, generally the predicate,
+and joins the clause to that part of the sentence which
+the clause modifies.</p>
+
+<p>Some common conjunctive adverbs are <i>when</i>, <i>where</i>, <i>whence</i>,
+<i>whenever</i>, <i>wherever</i>, <i>while</i>, <i>why</i>, <i>how</i>. (See note, <a href="#Page_177">p. 177</a>.)</p>
+
+<p>An <b>adverbial clause</b> is a dependent clause that is used like
+an adverb.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>adjective clause</b> is a dependent clause that is used like
+an adjective.</p>
+
+<p>Both the adjective and the adverbial clause may be introduced
+by a conjunctive adverb.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the conjunctive adverbs in the following
+sentences. Tell what clause they introduce, what they
+join, what they denote, and what they modify.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. When his eyes got command of the dusk, he saw to his surprise
+that the den was empty.</p>
+
+<p>2. Mr. Gathergold bethought himself of his native valley, and
+resolved to go back thither, and end his days where he was born.</p>
+
+<p>3. The canals in Amsterdam are crossed by a great many drawbridges,
+and the people must sometimes wait while a ship or barge
+is passing.</p>
+
+<p>4. Our lunch was only bread and tea and blueberries and cream,
+but do you remember how delicious it tasted that day when you
+came home from the circus as tired as a dog and as hungry as a
+bear?</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_173">[173]</span></p>
+
+<p>5.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Whenever I cross the river</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">On its bridge with wooden piers,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Like the odor of brine from the ocean,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">Comes the thought of other years.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>6. The reason why men succeed who mind their own business
+is because there is so little competition.</p>
+
+<p>7.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The frugal snail, with forecast of repose,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Carries his house with him where’er he goes.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>8. When all the trees in the forest have the same number of
+leaves, then will all men be alike in their power and skill.</p>
+
+<p>9.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">While the breath’s in his mouth, he must bear without fail,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">In the name of the Empress the Overland Mail.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>10.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Where’er our footsteps range,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Comes the chilling breath of change,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And the best of friends look strange</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">When the purse is low.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>11. The reason why men do not obey us is because they see the
+mud at the bottom of our eye.</p>
+
+<p>12.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">So shut your eyes while mother sings</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">Of wonderful sights that be.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>13. Chip answered me with a cheery little note or two whenever
+I spoke to him.</p>
+
+<p>14.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">My heart leaps up when I behold</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">A rainbow in the sky.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXVII">LXVII. SUMMARY OF ADVERBS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section273"><b>273.</b> We have learned,—</p>
+
+<p>(1) That adverbs may be simple adverbs or conjunctive
+adverbs.</p>
+
+<p>(2) That simple adverbs merely modify some word or
+group of words.</p>
+
+<p>(3) That conjunctive adverbs modify, and at the same time
+introduce a dependent clause and join it to whatever the
+clause modifies.</p>
+
+<p>(4) That one kind of simple adverb is the interrogative
+adverb, which is used in asking a question.</p>
+
+<p>(5) That an adverb may modify a verb, an adjective, an
+adverb, a whole predicate, or even a whole statement.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_174">[174]</span></p>
+
+<p>(6) That adverbs may denote time, place, manner, degree,
+and direction.</p>
+
+<p>(7) That some adverbs may be compared.</p>
+
+<p>Give a good illustration of each point in this summary.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section274"><b>274.</b> When we parse an adverb we should tell,—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Its class as to use,—simple, interrogative, conjunctive.</p>
+
+<p>(2) Its class as to meaning,—time, place, manner, etc.</p>
+
+<p>(3) Its degree (if it admits of comparison).</p>
+
+<p>(4) Its use, and what it modifies.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Parse each adverb in the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Virtue and intelligence will lead our country ever onward in
+her happy career.</p>
+
+<p>2. Oh, why should the spirit of mortal be proud?</p>
+
+<p>3. The man in the moon came down too soon.</p>
+
+<p>4. Fortunately, what seemed to be a barrel of apples turned out
+to be an electric lamp.</p>
+
+<p>5. The old horse cars rocked along scarcely faster than we could
+walk.</p>
+
+<p>6. Calmly I await the hour when the summons comes for me.</p>
+
+<p>7. Somewhere the birds are singing evermore.</p>
+
+<p>8. I will lock the door most willingly, but I will not cover the
+bird.</p>
+
+<p>9. Probably Frank was mightily relieved when he saw the
+mayor’s automobile.</p>
+
+<p>10. Our side made a remarkably good score.</p>
+
+<p>11. Where shall we sit in the new church?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXVIII">LXVIII. COÖRDINATE CONJUNCTIONS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section275"><b>275.</b> We have learned that such words as <i>and</i>, <i>but</i>, and <i>or</i>
+are conjunctions. Their use is merely to join, and they may
+join either words, phrases, or clauses. Since they join like
+elements,—a word to a word, a phrase to a phrase, a clause
+to a clause, a sentence to a sentence, we call them <b>coördinate</b>
+conjunctions.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_175">[175]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section276"><b>276.</b> In the sentence, “Either the well was very deep or
+she fell very slowly,” the coördinate conjunction <i>or</i>, which
+joins two sentences, is preceded by the word <i>either</i>, which
+hints that <i>or</i> is coming. When <i>either</i> and <i>or</i> are used in this
+way, they are called <b>correlatives</b>; that is, they are words
+related to each other. Other correlatives are <i>neither</i>, <i>nor</i>;
+<i>not only</i>, <i>but</i>; <i>both</i>, <i>and</i>. It is always the second word of
+these pairs that does the joining. The first merely tells the
+listener or reader what sort of sentence is to follow.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—Frequently a coördinate conjunction has another word
+going with it to change or emphasize its meaning. In the sentence,
+“He is rich and yet he is not generous,” the word <i>yet</i> going with <i>and</i>
+changes its meaning to <i>but</i>. In the sentence, “He is poor, but still
+he is generous,” the word <i>still</i> reinforces the meaning of <i>but</i>. Such
+a word associated with a conjunction may be said to be a part of the
+conjunction, that is, the two words together do the joining. In the
+same way the two words <i>not only</i> form the correlative of <i>but</i> or <i>but
+also</i>; as, “He is not only a teacher but also a student.” What does
+<i>but also</i> join here?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>coördinate conjunction</b> is one that joins
+like elements. It is sometimes more than one word.</p>
+
+<p><b>Correlative coördinate conjunctions</b> are pairs of words, the
+second of which does the joining.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—When we parse a coördinate conjunction we
+tell its class and what it joins. If it has a correlative, we
+state that fact. Parse the coördinate conjunctions in the
+following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The writer who professes to care nothing for fame is probably
+deceiving himself, or else his liver is out of order.</p>
+
+<p>2. Everybody took a holiday, and high and low, rich and poor,
+feasted and danced and sang, and got very mellow.</p>
+
+<p>3. There was neither dust nor mud nor noise to annoy one.</p>
+
+<p>4. The mahogany arm chair is very handsome, and the green
+plush rocker is very comfortable, but still I choose this little chair
+with the flowers painted on the back, that mother gave to me when
+I was only five.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_176">[176]</span></p>
+
+<p>5. On its southern side is an elevated walk, or terrace, very
+broad and handsome, and about half a mile long.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—In the preceding sentence, try to discover under what
+circumstances an appositive is joined to the word it explains by <i>or</i>.
+Notice the punctuation. Make other sentences illustrating this
+use of <i>or</i>.</p>
+
+<p>6. The road to Paradise is rough and thorny.</p>
+
+<p>7. His chief amusements were gunning and fishing, or sauntering
+along the beach and through the myrtles.</p>
+
+<p>8. Neither hare nor grouse was stirring in the brushy opens.</p>
+
+<p>9. You know Mary always bangs things when she is cross, but
+I never could see what good it does.</p>
+
+<p>10. When the two children went down to the river to play, they
+not only disobeyed their mothers, but they also ran away from
+school.</p>
+
+<p>11. I never looked either neat or clean, though I had my daily
+bath and a generous allowance of clothes.</p>
+
+<p>12. Over the tree tops and from the open spaces in the wood
+could be seen the first pallor of approaching day.</p>
+
+<p>13. In deep snow the moose can neither flee nor fight.</p>
+
+<p>14. They always put Mammy Tittleback in the carriage too;
+but before they had carried her far, she generally jumped out, and
+walked the rest of the way by their side.</p>
+
+<p>15. These Spaniards wished to build ships and to get away;
+but they had neither knowledge nor tools nor iron nor forge nor tow
+nor resin nor rigging.</p>
+
+<p>16.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">He prayeth best who loveth best</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">All things both great and small.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Tell the part of speech and use of <i>himself</i>, sentence 1, <i>high</i>,
+<i>low</i> 2, <i>mellow</i> 2, <i>when</i> 4, <i>neat</i> 11, <i>allowance</i> 11, <i>pallor</i> 12.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXIX">LXIX. SUBORDINATE CONJUNCTIONS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section277"><b>277.</b> We have learned that a dependent clause is often
+used as an adverb to modify a predicate. When so used, it is
+joined to the predicate it modifies by some connecting word.</p>
+
+<p>Sometimes this connecting word is a conjunctive adverb,
+as was pointed out in <a href="#LXVI">Lesson LXVI</a>, but more often it is
+some other word, as in the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_177">[177]</span></p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Sheep are such senseless creatures <i>that</i> they are liable to be stampeded
+by the veriest trifle.</p>
+
+<p>You cannot catch a muskrat <i>unless</i> you put tar on his nose.</p>
+
+<p>I love hens <i>because</i> they are such good mothers.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>What is the dependent clause in each of these sentences?
+What does it modify? What word joins it to that part of
+the sentence which it modifies?</p>
+
+<p>These connecting words,—<i>that</i>, <i>unless</i>, and <i>because</i>,—are
+not adverbs, for they do not modify any word. They merely
+connect, hence they are conjunctions. Since they connect
+elements not alike, not equal in rank, they are called <b>subordinate
+conjunctions</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section278"><b>278.</b> There are many subordinate conjunctions. The most
+common are <i>after</i>, <i>although</i>, <i>as</i>, <i>because</i>, <i>before</i>, <i>for</i>, <i>if</i>, <i>in order
+that</i>, <i>lest</i>, <i>provided</i>, <i>since</i>, <i>so that</i>, <i>than</i>, <i>that</i>, <i>though</i>, <i>till</i>, and <i>unless</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—There is little distinction between the subordinate conjunction
+and the conjunctive adverb. Both connect a dependent
+to a principal clause; and some subordinate conjunctions, like conjunctive
+adverbs, express time, cause, or manner, etc. For this
+reason, <i>as</i>, <i>after</i>, <i>before</i>, <i>since</i>, <i>till</i>, etc. are included by some
+authors among conjunctive adverbs. Compare, “I came <i>when</i> you
+called me” with “I came <i>before</i> you called me.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>subordinate conjunction</b> is one that introduces
+a dependent clause, and joins it to that part of the
+sentence which it modifies.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Parse the conjunctions in the following sentences.
+Tell their class and what they join.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The four cubs, running down hill on their bellies, melted into
+the thorn and underbrush as a mole melts into a lawn.</p>
+
+<p>2. Boys will do any amount of work provided it is called play.</p>
+
+<p>3. The great horned owl stood so erect and motionless that he
+seemed a portion of the pine trunk itself.</p>
+
+<p>4. Since the maples were cut down, the elms have flourished.</p>
+
+<p>5. Androclus had not lain long quiet in the cavern, before he
+heard a dreadful noise, which seemed to be the roar of some wild
+beast, and terrified him very much.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_178">[178]</span></p>
+
+<p>6. Harry laughed till the tears ran down his cheeks.</p>
+
+<p>7. Unless you have sat on a stone fence and beaten russet
+apples soft on its hard top, you have missed one of the greatest
+delicacies that the orchard gives.</p>
+
+<p>8. I liked the doctor very much, for he would let me drive around
+with him, and hold his horse while he made his professional calls.</p>
+
+<p>9. Fast the ivy stealeth on, though he wears no wings.</p>
+
+<p>10. Even after the invitations were sent out, it seemed to Dolly
+that the party day would never come.</p>
+
+<p>11. The shawl doll was my favorite because it was more nearly
+the size of a real baby.</p>
+
+<p>12. The two young Cratchits crammed spoons into their mouths
+lest they should shriek for goose before their turn came to be helped.</p>
+
+<p>13. A man would laugh if you told him that he had never really
+seen a burdock.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Select all the verbs in the sentences above. Classify them
+as transitive or intransitive. Tell their voice, mode, and
+tense.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section279"><b>279.</b> Some words may be used as conjunctions, as prepositions,
+or as adverbs.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>After.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—I came <i>after</i> you called me the second time.</p>
+
+<p>Adv.—We look before and <i>after</i>, and pine for what is not.</p>
+
+<p>Prep.—Let us walk to the lake <i>after</i> school.</p>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>Before.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—The roosters woke me <i>before</i> the sun rose.</p>
+
+<p>Adv.—They had never seen mountains <i>before</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Prep.—In winter we get up <i>before</i> daylight.</p>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>But.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—I am weak, <i>but</i> Thou art mighty.</p>
+
+<p>Prep.—He relishes no fruit <i>but</i> apples.</p>
+
+<p>Adv.—We can <i>but</i> die.</p>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>Else.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—You must tell the truth, <i>else</i> you will not be trusted.</p>
+
+<p>Adv.—How <i>else</i> can we get to Berlin?</p>
+
+<p>Adv.—Where <i>else</i> shall I look for your glasses?</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—What part of speech is <i>else</i> in the sentences, “What <i>else</i>
+can I do for you?” “Who <i>else</i> was there?”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_179">[179]</span></p>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>For.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—Work <i>for</i> the night is coming.</p>
+
+<p>Prep.—The faithful slave died <i>for</i> his young master.</p>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>Hence.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—Smoke is coming out of the chimney, <i>hence</i> the house
+must be occupied.</p>
+
+<p>Adv.—Let me go <i>hence</i> and be no more seen.</p>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>Only.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—I should be glad to go, <i>only</i> I have nothing to wear.</p>
+
+<p>Adv.—I made the cake; mother <i>only</i> baked it.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—What part of speech is <i>only</i> in the sentence, “Grace is
+an <i>only</i> child”?</p>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>Since.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—I have been happy <i>since</i> you became my friend.</p>
+
+<p>Prep.—Prices have never gone down <i>since</i> the war.</p>
+
+<p>Adv.—One day the dog disappeared, and he has never been heard
+of <i>since</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>So.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—The baby monopolized her time, <i>so</i> she withdrew from
+the club.</p>
+
+<p>Adv.—Don’t speak <i>so</i> loud, Caroline.</p>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>Till</b> or <b>Until.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—Tarry thou <i>till</i> I come.</p>
+
+<p>Prep.—We work hard <i>until</i> noon.</p>
+
+<p class="noindent"><b>Yet.</b></p>
+
+<p>Conj.—She speaks much, <i>yet</i> she says very little.</p>
+
+<p>Adv.—Has the case been settled <i>yet</i>?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Explain the use of each italicized word in the sentences
+above.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section280"><b>280.</b> When we parse a preposition, we tell (1) what phrase
+it introduces, and (2) what words it shows a relation between;
+thus, “In the sentence, ‘I bring you tidings of great joy,’
+the preposition <i>of</i> introduces the adjective phrase <i>of great joy</i>,
+and shows a relation between its object <i>great joy</i> and the
+noun <i>tidings</i>.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_180">[180]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Parse all the conjunctions, adverbs, and
+prepositions in the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Roger Conant came over from England before 1630.</p>
+
+<p>2. We had a cold spell in April, so the peach crop is small.</p>
+
+<p>3. Our flag was still there.</p>
+
+<p>4. The barn was strongly built, so it was made over into a good
+house.</p>
+
+<p>5. Ours is a government of the people, for the people, and by
+the people.</p>
+
+<p>6. Look before you leap.</p>
+
+<p>7. Years have passed since anybody remembered my birthday.</p>
+
+<p>8. The poet saw the daffodils beside the lake.</p>
+
+<p>9. After the boy arrived in Richmond, he slept under a sidewalk.</p>
+
+<p>10. Did anybody besides Rufus go with you to Janesville?</p>
+
+<p>11. Mr. Micawber would pay his debts if something would only
+turn up.</p>
+
+<p>12. Jill came tumbling after.</p>
+
+<p>13. The turkey was steamed first, else it would not have been so
+tender.</p>
+
+<p>14. The fern has grown fast since Easter.</p>
+
+<p>15. I can’t paint well if you look over my shoulder.</p>
+
+<p>16. There is nothing to breathe but air.</p>
+
+<p>17. Wait till the clouds roll by.</p>
+
+<p>18. Disappointments will surely come, yet they need not crush
+us.</p>
+
+<p>19. I will go before the king.</p>
+
+<p>20. Did you make your will before you went round the world?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXX">LXX. ADVERBIAL CLAUSES OF TIME, PLACE, AND MANNER</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section281"><b>281.</b> Adverbial clauses are used in many different relations.
+Frequently they denote the <b>time</b> when an action is performed;
+as, “When the pie was opened, the birds began to sing.”
+Here the clause tells when the birds began to sing, and hence
+modifies the predicate. It is joined to <i>began to sing</i> by the
+conjunctive adverb <i>when</i>.</p>
+
+<p>A subordinate connective does not have to come <i>between</i>
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_181">[181]</span>the elements that it joins. This enables us to put a dependent
+clause at the beginning of a sentence. What is the
+advantage of such an arrangement?</p>
+
+<p>An adverbial clause of time answers such questions as
+<i>when?</i> <i>how often?</i> <i>how long?</i> It is joined to what it modifies
+by the conjunctive adverbs <i>when</i>, <i>while</i>, <i>whenever</i>, or by the
+subordinating conjunctions <i>before</i>, <i>after</i>, <i>till</i>, <i>until</i>, <i>since</i>, <i>as</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Sometimes, if the connective is <i>when</i>, and the clause comes
+first, we begin the principal proposition with the simple
+adverb <i>then</i>, which we call a correlative of <i>when</i>. Illustrate
+this.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section282"><b>282.</b> The adverbial clause may be used to tell the <b>place</b>
+where some action is performed; as, “The maid is standing
+with reluctant feet where the brook and river meet.” Here
+the clause tells where the maid is standing, and is joined to
+<i>is standing</i> by the conjunctive adverb <i>where</i>.</p>
+
+<p>An adverbial clause of place answers such questions as <i>in
+what place?</i> <i>to what place?</i> <i>from what place?</i> It is introduced
+by the conjunctive adverbs <i>where</i>, <i>whence</i>, <i>whither</i>, <i>wherever</i>.
+Sometimes <i>there</i> is used in the principal proposition as a correlative
+of <i>where</i> in the clause. Which of these correlatives
+is the connective?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section283"><b>283.</b> Frequently the <b>manner</b> of an action, the way in which
+it was performed, is told by an adverbial clause; as, “Not
+as the conqueror comes, they the true-hearted came.” What
+is the clause here? What does it tell? What does it modify?
+What is the connective? What is the use of <i>not</i>?</p>
+
+<p>A clause of manner answers the question <i>in what way?</i> It
+is joined to what it modifies by the subordinate conjunction
+<i>as</i>, <i>as if</i>, or <i>as though</i>. The simple adverb <i>so</i> may be used as
+a correlative of <i>as</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section284"><b>284.</b> The word <i>like</i> is never a subordinate conjunction,
+hence it cannot properly be used for <i>as</i> or <i>as if</i>. We should
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_182">[182]</span>say, “Walk <i>as</i> (not <i>like</i>) I do;” “She walks <i>as if</i> she were
+tired (not <i>like</i> she was tired).” <i>Like</i> may be used as a preposition
+to introduce a phrase; as, “Elizabeth walks <i>like him</i>.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Fill the blank in each of these sentences with
+the proper word, and explain your choice:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Mary sings —— a bird.</p>
+
+<p>2. It looks —— it would rain.</p>
+
+<p>3. The man speaks —— he knew his subject.</p>
+
+<p>4. March came in —— a lion.</p>
+
+<p>5. You knit just —— my grandmother does.</p>
+
+<p>6. The children ate —— they were hungry.</p>
+
+<p>7. Can you dance —— the gypsies do?</p>
+
+<p>8. Plant the seeds exactly —— I told you to.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An adverbial clause of <b>time</b> tells when a condition
+exists, or when an action was performed.</p>
+
+<p>An adverbial clause of <b>place</b> tells where a condition exists,
+or where an action was performed.</p>
+
+<p>An adverbial clause of <b>manner</b> tells in what way something
+was done.</p>
+
+<p>The connectives <i>when</i>, <i>where</i>, and <i>as</i> are sometimes accompanied
+by the correlatives <i>then</i>, <i>there</i>, and <i>so</i> respectively.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Select all the adverbial clauses in the following
+sentences. Tell what each clause denotes, what it modifies,
+and what its connective is. Study the punctuation
+of these sentences, and make a rule for the punctuation of
+adverbial clauses:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Your bicycle is a stationary bit of iron and india rubber,
+until you put your feet upon the pedals and use your mind to guide
+the wheel.</p>
+
+<p>2. The old man sits as if he were carved in stone.</p>
+
+<p>3. Where the snowflakes fall thickest, there nothing can freeze.</p>
+
+<p>4. When mother awoke and saw the burglar, she quietly ordered
+him to leave; and only after she had pursued his obedient figure to
+the door did it occur to her that the proper thing to do was to
+scream.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_183">[183]</span></p>
+
+<p>5. Where the peak leaned to the valley, the trunk of a giant pine
+jutted forth slantingly from a roothold a little below the summit.</p>
+
+<p>6. As we came up the harbor I had noticed that the houses were
+huddled together on an immense hill.</p>
+
+<p>7.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">I have come to meet judges so wise and so grand</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">That I shake in my shoes while they’re shaking my hand.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>8.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">She struck where the white and fleecy waves</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Looked soft as carded wool.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>9. Whither thou goest, I will go; and where thou lodgest, I
+will lodge.</p>
+
+<p>10. When the blackbird approached that side of the cage, the
+goldfinch dashed away as though he feared his strange neighbor
+might come through.</p>
+
+<p>11.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">I love to hear thine earnest voice wherever thou art hid,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Thou testy little dogmatist, thou pretty Katydid!</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>12. At every little station a man popped out as if he were worked
+by machinery, and waved a red flag, and appeared as though he
+would like to have us stop.</p>
+
+<p>13. The little bandy-legged dogs had been trotting steadily for
+many an hour, until their tongues hung out for want of breath.</p>
+
+<p>14. Years had passed since that particular panther had strayed
+from his high fastnesses, where game was plentiful and none dared
+poach on his preserves.</p>
+
+<p>15. I stood up and “hollered” with all my might, as everybody
+does with oxen, as if they were born deaf, and whacked them with
+the long lash over the head, just as the big folks did when they
+drove.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXI">LXXI. ADVERBIAL CLAUSES OF CAUSE, PURPOSE, AND RESULT</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section285"><b>285.</b> One action or condition may cause some other action
+or condition, and when we tell this, we often make such a sentence
+as the following, “Most caged birds are not happy,
+because few of them are well cared for.” Here the dependent
+proposition, <i>because few of them are well cared for</i> is an adverbial
+clause of <b>cause</b>, for it tells the cause of the fact in the
+principal clause, or why most caged birds are not happy.</p>
+
+<p>The adverbial clause of cause answers the question <i>why?</i>
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_184">[184]</span>or <i>how do you know?</i> and is usually joined to the predicate
+that it modifies by the subordinate conjunction <i>for</i>, <i>because</i>,
+or <i>since</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section286"><b>286.</b> Sometimes an action is performed in order that some
+other action or condition may come to pass. We say then
+that the action is performed for a <b>purpose</b>, and we express
+this purpose by means of an adverbial clause; as, “Leonardo
+da Vinci would walk the whole length of Milan that he might
+alter a single tint in his picture of the Last Supper.” Here
+the clause <i>that he might alter a single tint in his picture of the
+Last Supper</i> tells the purpose that the artist had in walking
+the whole length of Milan. What does this clause modify?
+What is it introduced by?</p>
+
+<p>A clause of purpose answers the question <i>what for?</i> It is
+usually joined to the predicate that it modifies by the subordinate
+conjunction <i>that</i>, <i>so that</i>, or <i>in order that</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section287"><b>287.</b> A clause of purpose tells an intention without
+saying that this intention ever really comes to pass. But
+there is another clause which tells what really happens
+as an outcome of the action or condition in the principal
+clause. This is called a clause of <b>result</b>; for instance, “So
+porous is the limestone of the roads that in five minutes after
+a brisk shower one has no need of overshoes.” Here the principal
+clause tells us that the roads are porous, and the clause
+tells us what is the result, or outcome, of their being porous.
+What is the clause in this sentence? What does it modify?
+What is it introduced by?</p>
+
+<p>A clause of result answers the question <i>what of it?</i>, and is
+generally introduced by the subordinate conjunction <i>that</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A clause of <b>cause</b> tells what produces a certain
+act or condition.</p>
+
+<p>A clause of <b>purpose</b> tells the intended consequence of some
+action.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_185">[185]</span></p>
+
+<p>A clause of <b>result</b> tells the real consequence of some action
+or condition.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select the adverbial clauses, classify them,
+giving your reason in each case, tell what they modify, and
+what they are joined by. Account for the punctuation.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. I have explained thus carefully about my Bird Room because
+I do not approve of keeping wild birds in cages.</p>
+
+<p>2. When Chipee had eaten all she could, she would quietly sit
+down in the seed dish so that Chip couldn’t get any.</p>
+
+<p>3. Of course this bird could not be set free, for he did not know
+how to take care of himself.</p>
+
+<p>4. One little nugget of purest gold the surveyor carefully preserved,
+that it might one day become a wedding ring for the gray-eyed
+girl in Maine.</p>
+
+<p>5. Had his nerves grown so sensitive that the staring of a chipmunk
+or a rabbit had power to break his sleep?</p>
+
+<p>6. So strong was Polly’s liking for green peas that the sight of
+raw peas made her wild till some were given to her.</p>
+
+<p>7. Master Fox said to the Crow, “Sing but one song to me,
+that I may greet you as the Queen of Birds.”</p>
+
+<p>8. It is very convenient to be a reasonable creature, since it
+enables you to find or make a reason for everything you have a
+mind to do.</p>
+
+<p>9. Rebecca left the screen door ajar, so that flies came in.</p>
+
+<p>10. Rolf was called the Goer because he had such long legs that
+when he mounted one of the little Norwegian horses, his feet touched
+the ground.</p>
+
+<p>11. Dikes are built that the spread and flow of the water may be
+regulated, and the land protected from destructive floods.</p>
+
+<p>12. The sun burned down so fiercely that the people were fainting
+in its rays; it seemed as if they must die of heat, and yet they
+were obliged to go on with their work, for they were very poor.</p>
+
+<p>13. Then the people ran as only hill folk can run, for they knew
+that in a landslip you must climb for the highest ground across the
+valley.</p>
+
+<p>14.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Lord God of Hosts, be with us yet,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Lest we forget, lest we forget!</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>15. I go to prepare a place for you, that where I am there ye
+may be also.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_186">[186]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXII">LXXII. ADVERBIAL CLAUSES OF CONDITION AND CONCESSION</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section288"><b>288.</b> Very often an action cannot take place except under
+a certain condition, and this condition is often expressed in
+a dependent clause; as in the sentence, “A man can buy a
+vote only if some other man is willing to sell a vote.” Here
+the one condition under which a man can buy a vote is told
+in the adverbial clause, <i>if some other man is willing to sell a
+vote</i>. This is called a clause of <b>condition</b>. It is generally introduced
+by <i>if</i>, <i>unless</i> (which means <i>if not</i>), <i>provided</i>, or <i>providing</i>.
+In the illustration what does the clause modify?
+What is the use of <i>only</i>?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section289"><b>289.</b> Sometimes an action takes place in spite of something
+else, and we tell this in such a sentence as the following,
+“Though He slay me, yet will I trust Him.” Here the fact
+that I trust Him is true in spite of the fact that He may slay
+me. Such a clause as <i>though He slay me</i> is called a clause
+of <b>concession</b>, for it concedes, or grants, something that
+seems to be in direct opposition to what is in the principal
+clause. What does it modify? What can you say of the
+word <i>yet</i>?</p>
+
+<p>A clause of concession is generally joined by the subordinate
+conjunction <i>though</i>, or by some such word as <i>notwithstanding</i>,
+or <i>even if</i>, which means <i>though</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Sometimes <i>though</i> has a correlative, the word <i>yet</i>, <i>still</i>, or
+<i>nevertheless</i> used at the beginning of the principal clause.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A clause of <b>condition</b> answers the question
+<i>provided what?</i> It tells the circumstance under which the
+principal statement is true.</p>
+
+<p>A clause of <b>concession</b> answers the question <i>in spite of
+what?</i> It tells the circumstance in spite of which the principal
+statement is true.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_187">[187]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all adverbial clauses. Tell what each
+clause denotes, what it modifies, what it is joined by. Account
+for the punctuation.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. If your everyday language is not fit for a letter or for print,
+it is not fit for talk.</p>
+
+<p>2. In Bermuda, if you are in want of some choice cologne, do
+not fail to ask for it at the nearest shoe shop.</p>
+
+<p>3. Though delicate in his tastes, an elephant likes quantity as
+well as quality, and at his meals makes nothing of bales of hay and
+gallons of water.</p>
+
+<p>4. Though the weeping willow and the mountain ash could not
+endure the cold northeast storms, yet the sturdy elms grew apace
+and soon spread their branches far.</p>
+
+<p>5. Half the pleasure in going out to murder another man with a
+gun would be wanting, if one did not wear feathers, and gold lace,
+and stripes on his pantaloons.</p>
+
+<p>6. There is something queer about thoughts; you cannot have
+a good time with them if you have done anything naughty.</p>
+
+<p>7.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Though watery deserts hold apart the worlds of East and West,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Still beats the selfsame human heart in each proud Nation’s breast.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>8. If our forefathers had not chosen to emigrate to America,
+we should now be English people ourselves.</p>
+
+<p>9. Rebecca was so slender and so stiffly starched that she slid
+from space to space on the leather cushions, though she braced
+herself against the middle seat with her feet, and extended her
+cotton-gloved hands on each side.</p>
+
+<p>10.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">If the men were so wicked, I’ll ask my papa</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">How he dared to propose to my darling mamma.</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Was he like the rest of them? Goodness! Who knows?</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And what should I say if a wretch should propose?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>11. Though he looked like a bird, he behaved like a monkey.</p>
+
+<p>12.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Though the mills of God grind slowly, yet they grind exceeding small,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Though with patience he stands waiting, with exactness grinds he all.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>13. If the scythes cut well and swing merrily, it is due to the boy
+who turned the grindstone.</p>
+
+<p>14. If a man write little, he had need have a great memory;
+if he confer little, he had need have a present wit; and if he read
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_188">[188]</span>little, he had need have much cunning to seem to know that he
+doth not.</p>
+
+<p>15.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Men must work and women must weep.</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Though storms be sudden and waters deep.</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And the harbor bar be moaning.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Account for the mode of the verb in each dependent clause
+in the preceding sentences.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXIII">LXXIII. ADVERBIAL CLAUSES OF COMPARISON</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section290"><b>290.</b> Often we are not satisfied to say, “Cousin John is
+good.” We wish to tell <i>how</i> good he is, and a common way
+of doing this is by means of a comparison. We say, “Cousin
+John is as good as gold.” Here the group of words <i>as gold</i>
+is a clause with the word <i>is</i> omitted. It is called a clause of
+<b>comparison</b>. It denotes an <b>equality</b> between John’s goodness
+and that of gold. Since this clause answers the question
+<i>how good?</i> it must modify the adjective <i>good</i>.</p>
+
+<p>What is the introductory word of the clause of comparison?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section291"><b>291.</b> Sometimes we compare two things and yet denote
+an <b>inequality</b> between them; as in the sentence, “The river
+is bluer than the sky.” Here the clause of comparison is
+introduced by the subordinating conjunction <i>than</i>. It modifies
+the word <i>bluer</i>. We know this because it is the word
+<i>bluer</i> that needs the clause, and without the word <i>bluer</i> the
+clause would not be in the sentence at all.</p>
+
+<p>Notice that a clause of equality modifies an adjective in
+the positive degree, while a clause of inequality modifies an
+adjective in the comparative degree.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section292"><b>292.</b> A clause of comparison may modify an adverb as
+well as an adjective, as in these sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>The old man moved as slowly as a cloud.</p>
+
+<p>More swiftly than eagles, his coursers they flew.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_189">[189]</span></p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—The adverb <i>rather</i> is seldom used without being modified
+by a clause of comparison; as, “Henry Clay said that he would
+rather be right than be president.” When we supply the words
+understood, the clause reads, <i>than he would be president</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Complete the clauses in the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Some people would rather have money than brains.</p>
+
+<p>I should rather earn a college education than go without it.</p>
+
+<p>A wise American would rather go to Yellowstone Park than to
+Switzerland.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A clause of <b>comparison</b> tells the degree of
+some quality or quantity by pointing out a likeness or a
+difference.</p>
+
+<p>A clause of comparison pointing out a <b>likeness</b> is introduced
+by <i>as</i>, and modifies an adjective or an adverb in the
+positive degree.</p>
+
+<p>A clause of comparison pointing out a <b>difference</b> is introduced
+by <i>than</i>, and modifies an adjective or an adverb in the
+comparative degree.</p>
+
+<p>A clause of comparison is seldom completely expressed.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the clauses of comparison. Tell
+what they denote, what they modify, and what they are introduced
+by.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Sitting up on the driver’s high seat is almost as good as
+climbing the meeting-house steeple.</p>
+
+<p>2.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The muscles of his brawny arms</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Are strong as iron bands.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>3. The loons could dive quicker than the eagle could swoop and
+strike.</p>
+
+<p>4. Gertrude was prouder than ever when the president of the
+college said, “Your mother is handsomer than you will ever be,
+young lady.”</p>
+
+<p>5.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The hearts that were thumping like ships on the rocks</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Beat as quiet and steady as meeting-house clocks.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>6. Truth is stranger than fiction.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_190">[190]</span></p>
+
+<p>7. I had rather have a fool to make me merry than experience
+to make me sad.</p>
+
+<p>8.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Blue were her eyes as the fairy flax,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">Her cheeks like the dawn of day,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Her bosom white as the hawthorn buds,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">That ope in the month of May.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>9. One syllable of woman’s speech can dissolve more love than
+a man’s heart can hold.</p>
+
+<p>10.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">I am nearer my home to-day</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Than I ever have been before.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>11. Whiter than snow were his locks, and his cheeks were as
+brown as the oak leaves.</p>
+
+<p>12.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">A steed as black as the steeds of night</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Was seen to pass as with eagle flight.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>13. Weeds are sure to grow quicker in my garden than anywhere
+else.</p>
+
+<p>14.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Dark as winter was the flow</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Of Iser rolling rapidly.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>15. I should rather see the friezes of the Parthenon molder to
+dust under the blue veil of the Grecian atmosphere than have
+them preserved in the grand halls of the British Museum.</p>
+
+<p>16. The huge body of the elephant needs less sleep than anything
+else that lives.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section293"><b>293.</b> Since the predicate is usually omitted in clauses of
+comparison, it follows that these clauses often consist of only
+two words; as, “I am as old as Mary.” “I am older than
+Mary.” One of these words is the connective, and the other
+is often the subject of the clause. When the subject is a
+pronoun, we must be careful to use the nominative form.
+We should say, “Are you older than <i>I</i>? than <i>he</i>? than <i>she</i>?”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Fill the blank in each of these sentences.
+Then supply the words omitted, and thus show that you have
+chosen the right pronouns:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Our parents are wiser than (<i>we</i> or <i>us</i>).</p>
+
+<p>2. You are not always so careful as (<i>she</i> or <i>her</i>).</p>
+
+<p>3. Who knows the day better than (<i>me</i> or <i>I</i>)?</p>
+
+<p>4. What! You are stronger than (<i>who</i> or <i>whom</i>)?</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_191">[191]</span></p>
+
+<p>5. The Preston girls were just as friendly as (<i>me</i> or <i>I</i>).</p>
+
+<p>6. No man could be more faithful than (<i>him</i> or <i>he</i>).</p>
+
+<p>7. Who stands higher in this city than (<i>they</i> or <i>them</i>).</p>
+
+<p>8. Are you older or younger than (<i>her</i> or <i>she</i>)?</p>
+
+<p>9. Well, perhaps I am not so polite as (<i>he</i> or <i>him</i>).</p>
+
+<p>10. Our geese are whiter than (<i>them</i> or <i>they</i>).</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Justify the case of the italicized pronoun
+in each of these sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Jessie likes Julia as well as <i>me</i>.</p>
+
+<p>2. I found her brother more easily than <i>her</i>.</p>
+
+<p>3. I expect an angel sooner than <i>them</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXIV">LXXIV. ANALYSIS OF SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section294"><b>294.</b> We are ready now to analyze sentences containing
+adverbial clauses. In analyzing such sentences we should
+state as soon as we come to an adverbial clause, (1) what it
+denotes and (2) what part of speech its introductory word is.
+We should not analyze any dependent clause in detail, however,
+until we have completed our analysis of the principal
+clause.</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Model.</span>—<i>The lion fixed his great hind claws in the softer
+skin of the crocodile’s throat, and ripped it open as one would
+rip a glove.</i></p>
+
+<p>This is a complex, declarative sentence.</p>
+
+<p>The subject is <i>the lion</i>. The predicate is <i>fixed his great hind
+claws in the softer skin of the crocodile’s throat, and ripped it
+open as one would rip a glove</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The predicate is compound, the two parts being joined by
+the conjunction <i>and</i>. The first predicate verb is <i>fixed</i>. It
+is completed by the direct object <i>his great hind claws</i>, and
+then modified by the prepositional phrase <i>in the softer skin
+of the crocodile’s throat</i>. The base word of the object is
+<i>claws</i>; it is modified by the adjectives <i>hind</i> and <i>great</i>, and by
+the possessive pronoun <i>his</i>. The base word of the object of
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_192">[192]</span>the preposition <i>in</i> is <i>skin</i>. It is modified by the adjectives
+<i>softer</i> and <i>the</i>, and by the prepositional phrase of <i>the crocodile’s
+throat</i>. The base word of the object of the preposition <i>of</i> is
+<i>throat</i>; it is modified by the possessive noun <i>crocodile’s</i>, which
+is modified by the adjective <i>the</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The second predicate verb is <i>ripped</i>. It is completed by the
+direct object <i>it</i> and the objective complement <i>open</i>, and then
+modified by the adverbial clause of manner <i>as one would rip
+a glove</i>, which is introduced by the subordinate conjunction <i>as</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The subject of this clause is the adjective pronoun <i>one</i>.
+The predicate is <i>would rip a glove</i>. The predicate verb is
+<i>would rip</i>. It is completed by the direct object <i>a glove</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Analyze the following sentences. When you
+write the analysis of a sentence, use abbreviations, and instead
+of writing out a group of words in full, as is done in
+the model, write only the first and last words of the group
+with a dash between them. Be sure to underline all words
+quoted from the sentence.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">He looks the whole world in the face,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">For he owes not any man.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>2. The young lion was growing so fast that the milk of three
+goats was scarcely sufficient for him.</p>
+
+<p>3.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">When the glorious sun is set,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">When the grass with dew is wet,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Then you show your little light.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>4. When Charles was studying shorthand, his mother read
+sermons to him for an hour every morning, so that he might have
+practice in the writing of long words.</p>
+
+<p>5. If you save the pennies, the dollars will take care of themselves.</p>
+
+<p>6.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Where the purple violet grows,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Where the bubbling water flows,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Where the grass is fresh and fine,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Pretty cow, go there and dine.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>7. Tommy, though he was getting a big boy, retained some of
+the habits of a baby.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_193">[193]</span></p>
+
+<p>8. I was sitting on the top rail of the front fence, when a party of
+gypsies went by on their way to a camp.</p>
+
+<p>9.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The day is done, and the darkness</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">Falls from the wings of night,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">As a feather is wafted downward</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">From an eagle in his flight.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>10. Whenever you see many drones, you will find plenty of
+young bees.</p>
+
+<p>11. After the robins have pinched and shaken all the life out of
+an earthworm, as Italian cooks pound all the spirit out of a steak,
+and then gulped him, they stand up in honest self-confidence,
+expand their red waistcoats with a virtuous air, and outface you with
+their bold calm eyes.</p>
+
+<p>12. Moti Guj, the elephant, never trampled the life out of his
+master Deesa, for, after the beating was over, Deesa would embrace
+his trunk, and call him his love and his life and the liver of his soul,
+and give him some liquor.</p>
+
+<p>13. If imitation be the sincerest form of flattery, the mischief
+of the monkey should be regarded more leniently.</p>
+
+<p>14. I liked dolls well enough, though my assortment was not a
+choice one.</p>
+
+<p>15. Her nails were so hard that they would yield to the scissors
+only after a day’s soaking in hot soapsuds.</p>
+
+<p>16.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">His words were shed softer than leaves from the pine,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And they fell on Sir Launfal as snows on the brine.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXV">LXXV. ADJECTIVE CLAUSES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section295"><b>295.</b> We learned in <a href="#XX">Lesson XX</a> that a dependent clause often
+has the use of an adjective, that is, it modifies a noun; as in
+the sentence, “This is the house that Jack built.” Such a
+clause as <i>that Jack built</i> is called an adjective clause. Why?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section296"><b>296.</b> An adjective clause may be used for two different
+purposes.</p>
+
+<p>(1) It may serve to point out a particular person, place,
+or thing; as, “This is the maiden all forlorn that milked the
+cow with the crumpled horn.” Here the clause tells what
+particular maiden is meant. A clause of this sort is called a
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_194">[194]</span><b>restrictive</b> clause, because it limits, or restricts, the application
+of the word it modifies.</p>
+
+<p>(2) An adjective clause may serve merely to bring in a
+new thought, something that is worth telling, of course, but
+still not necessary to the truth of the sentence; as, “My
+father had ten cows, which I had to escort to and from pasture
+night and morning.” This clause does not tell what particular
+cows my father had, but merely tells an additional fact
+about them. Such a clause as this is called an <b>unrestrictive</b>
+clause. It is set off by a comma.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section297"><b>297.</b> A restrictive clause is usually necessary to the truth
+of a sentence; as, “A city that is set on a hill cannot be
+hid,” “A prince that is a tyrant is unfit to rule.”</p>
+
+<p>To find out whether a clause is restrictive or not, determine
+first what word it modifies; then ask yourself the question,
+Did the author put this clause into the sentence to point
+out a particular object?</p>
+
+<p>Could such a term as <i>The Declaration of Independence</i>, <i>my
+mother’s father</i>, <i>Theodore Roosevelt</i>, <i>the planet Mars</i>, or <i>Boston</i>
+be modified by a restrictive adjective clause?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>adjective clause</b> is a dependent clause that
+modifies a noun or a pronoun.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>restrictive</b> adjective clause is one that points out a particular
+person, place, or thing. A restrictive clause is not
+set off by commas.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>unrestrictive</b> adjective clause is one that merely adds
+a new thought to the sentence. An unrestrictive clause is
+set off by a comma.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Select the adjective clauses. Tell what
+they modify. Then find out whether they are restrictive
+or not, and why.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—Always test an adjective clause first to find out whether
+it is restrictive. If you decide that it is not restrictive, then it must
+be unrestrictive.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_195">[195]</span></p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Charley Marden, whose father had promised to cane him if
+he ever set foot on sail or row boat, came down to the wharf in a
+sour-grape humor to see us off.</p>
+
+<p>2. A sharp tongue is the only edged tool that grows keener with
+constant use.</p>
+
+<p>3. From one corner of St. Paul’s churchyard runs the lively
+street called Cheapside, from which John Gilpin started on his
+famous ride.</p>
+
+<p>4. The reason why the women and children slept upon the floor
+was their fear lest the Indians should fire through the windows and
+kill them in their beds.</p>
+
+<p>5. The king whose despotic power was felt over the entire extent
+of the cattle range was an old gray wolf.</p>
+
+<p>6. The monks who put peas in their shoes as a penance do not
+suffer more than the country boy in his penitential Sunday shoes.</p>
+
+<p>7. There is a girl in the carriage, who looks out at John, who is
+suddenly aware that his trousers are patched on each knee and in
+two places behind.</p>
+
+<p>8. He could see the pale and naked trunk of a pine tree, which
+the lightning had shattered.</p>
+
+<p>9. The night that was so favorable to the wild rabbits was
+favorable also to the fox, the wildcat, and the weasel.</p>
+
+<p>10. The only days that I can remember in Yonkers were hot.</p>
+
+<p>11.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">All things that are on earth shall wholly pass away,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Except the love of God, which shall live and last for aye.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>12. Sleek, unwieldy porkers were grunting in the repose and
+abundance of their pens, whence sallied forth, now and then, troops
+of sucking pigs, as if to snuff the air.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Write sentences containing restrictive adjective
+clauses pointing out a certain river, a certain boy, a
+certain bridge, a certain house, a certain day.</p>
+
+<p>Write sentences containing unrestrictive clauses that tell
+something about the moon, the President of the United States,
+Salt Lake City, the Sistine Madonna, the Eiffel Tower.</p>
+
+<p>Write sentences containing adjective clauses introduced
+by the conjunctive adverbs <i>when</i>, <i>where</i>, and <i>why</i>. (See
+<a href="#LXVI">Lesson LXVI</a>.) Tell whether your clauses are restrictive or
+unrestrictive.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_196">[196]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXVI">LXXVI. RELATIVE PRONOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section298"><b>298.</b> Just as an adverbial clause is joined to what it modifies
+by a conjunctive adverb or a subordinate conjunction,
+so an adjective clause must be joined to the noun it modifies
+by some connecting word.</p>
+
+<p>In <a href="#LXVI">Lesson LXVI</a> it was shown that this word may be a
+conjunctive adverb, as in the sentence, “I can never forget
+the night when I first heard the whippoorwill sing.” What
+is the clause here? What does it modify? How is it joined
+to the word that it modifies?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section299"><b>299.</b> Most adjective clauses are introduced by some other
+word than a conjunctive adverb. In the sentence, “The
+hand that rocks the cradle rules the world,” the adjective
+clause <i>that rocks the cradle</i> is joined to the noun <i>hand</i>, which
+it modifies, by the word <i>that</i>. This word is used as subject
+of the verb <i>rocks</i>, and really means <i>hand</i>. Since it takes the
+place of a noun, it is a pronoun; and since this noun, or antecedent,
+precedes the pronoun, we say that the pronoun <i>relates</i>
+to its antecedent, and we call it a <b>relative</b> pronoun.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section300"><b>300.</b> The relative pronouns that introduce adjective
+clauses are <i>who</i>, <i>which</i>, and <i>that</i>.</p>
+
+<p><i>Who</i> has three case forms: nominative, <i>who</i>; possessive,
+<i>whose</i>; objective, <i>whom</i>.</p>
+
+<p><i>Which</i> has the possessive form <i>whose</i>; <i>that</i> has no possessive
+form.</p>
+
+<p><i>Which</i> and <i>that</i> do not change their form for the objective
+case.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section301"><b>301.</b> A relative pronoun always has a use in the adjective
+clause that it introduces. This is the same use that the antecedent
+would have if it were used in place of the pronoun.</p>
+
+<p>The four common uses are:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Subject of a verb; as, “He who fights and runs away
+may live to fight another day.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_197">[197]</span></p>
+
+<p>(2) Object of a verb; as, “This is the day that the Lord
+hath made.”</p>
+
+<p>(3) Object of a preposition; as, “I saw the room in which
+Shakespeare was born.”</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—Sometimes the pronoun comes before the preposition;
+as, “The buggy that we rode in was low and light.”</p>
+
+<p>(4) Possessive modifier; as, “Any boy whose memory is
+good can learn a history lesson.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section302"><b>302.</b> The relative pronoun <i>that</i> introduces only restrictive
+adjective clauses. The pronouns <i>who</i>, <i>whose</i>, <i>whom</i>, and
+<i>which</i> may introduce either restrictive or unrestrictive clauses.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section303"><b>303.</b> <i>Who</i> has for its antecedent the name of some person;
+<i>which</i> has for its antecedent the name of some thing. The
+antecedent of <i>that</i> may be the name of a person or a thing.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section304"><b>304.</b> The word <i>but</i> may be used as a relative pronoun as
+a substitute for the two words <i>that not</i>. Instead of saying,
+“There is no day that has not an end,” we may say, “There
+is no day <i>but</i> has an end.” This is a better sentence than the
+first because it contains only one negative word.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section305"><b>305.</b> The word <i>as</i> may be used as a relative pronoun following
+the words <i>such</i>, <i>same</i>, or <i>as many</i>. We say,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>I like <i>such</i> flowers <i>as</i> you sent me.</p>
+
+<p>Your dress is the <i>same</i> color <i>as</i> mine.</p>
+
+<p>I will take <i>as many</i> apples <i>as</i> will fill this basket.</p>
+
+<p>I want <i>such</i> a chair <i>as</i> you are sitting in now.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>In each of the sentences above, what is the use of the relative
+pronoun <i>as</i> in the clause that it introduces?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>relative pronoun</b> is one that refers to a preceding
+noun or pronoun, and joins to it an adjective clause.</p>
+
+<p>The relative pronouns that introduce adjective clauses
+are <i>who</i>, <i>which</i>, and <i>that</i>.</p>
+
+<p><i>As</i> and <i>but</i> are sometimes used as relative pronouns.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_198">[198]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section306"><b>306.</b> When we parse a relative pronoun we tell,—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Its antecedent.</p>
+
+<p>(2) What adjective clause it joins to its antecedent.</p>
+
+<p>(3) Its case.</p>
+
+<p>(4) Its use in the adjective clause.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Parse all the relative pronouns in the following
+sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. In came the six young followers whose hearts the Misses
+Fezziwig broke.</p>
+
+<p>2. There were the wide sweeps of forest through which the
+winter tempests howled, upon which hung the haze of summer
+heat, over which the great shadows of summer clouds traveled.</p>
+
+<p>3. Susie was a well-behaved child, who took care of her clothes
+and played quiet games.</p>
+
+<p>4. And now the dandelion is a pest—the same yellow dandelion
+with its long, bitter, milky stem that we children sought for
+in the shady fence corners to make into spiral curls.</p>
+
+<p>5. Buffers had a small moustache, which he fostered much, and
+a cane with which he was not yet very familiar.</p>
+
+<p>6. She bade me good-by as if I were a friend of her family whom
+she would gladly meet again.</p>
+
+<p>7. There is only one bird that terrifies the crow, and that is the
+owl.</p>
+
+<p>8. Solomon John proposed that they should open the window, a
+thing which Agamemnon could easily do with his long arms.</p>
+
+<p>9. There was one lady whose conversation at the best of times
+made my mother sleepy.</p>
+
+<p>10. The two men shared those mysterious rites of smoking and
+shaving and discussing stocks which occupy men when they are left
+to themselves.</p>
+
+<p>11. The turkey cock, who had been born into the world with
+spurs, and thought he was a king, puffed himself out like a ship
+with full sails, and flew at the duckling.</p>
+
+<p>12. In a few moments Ned arrived at a small open glade in the
+middle of the forest, in which, to his horror, he saw a lion upon the
+body of a man, whom he seized by the throat, while Nero stood
+within a few yards, baying him furiously.</p>
+
+<p>13. He lives longest who does most.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_199">[199]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Analyze the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">No time is like the old time when you and I were young,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">When the buds of April blossomed, and the birds of spring-time sung.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>2.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">No place is like the old place, where you and I were born,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Where we lifted first our eyelids on the splendor of the morn.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>3. No friend is like the old friend, who has shared our morning
+days.</p>
+
+<p>4. At the teachers’ meeting, which she regularly attended with
+her mother, Gertrude saw the pale-faced little lady whom the children
+called a “Grahamite.”</p>
+
+<p>5. The old broken gate which a gentleman would not tolerate
+an hour upon his grounds is a great beauty in the picture which
+hangs in his parlor.</p>
+
+<p>6. Often the road passes between lofty walls of solid rock, from
+the crevices of which all lovely growths are springing.</p>
+
+<p>7.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Read from some humbler poet,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Whose songs gushed from his heart,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">As rain from the clouds in summer,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Or tears from the eyelids start.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>8. Michel was a vivacious, lean little Frenchman, who fulfilled
+the duties of a chambermaid very adroitly.</p>
+
+<p>9. The first thing that my pet starling imitated was the rumbling
+of carts and carriages on the street.</p>
+
+<p>10. In one corner of the fireplace sat a superannuated crony,
+whom the sexton called John Ange, and who had been his companion
+from childhood.</p>
+
+<p>11. The good ship <i>Humber</i> is taking home a regiment whose term
+of service has expired.</p>
+
+<p>12. Madame took for breakfast two fresh eggs, which her two
+hens laid for her every morning with the perfect regularity that is
+the politeness of all well-bred poultry.</p>
+
+<p>13.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The boy stood on the burning deck,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Whence all but him had fled.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>14. Lay up for yourselves treasures in heaven, where neither
+moth nor rust doth corrupt, and where thieves do not break through
+and steal.</p>
+
+<p>15. Sycamore Ridge might have been one of the dreary villages
+that dot the wind-swept plain to-day, instead of the bright, prosperous
+elm-shaded town that it is.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_200">[200]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXVII">LXXVII. NOUN CLAUSES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section307"><b>307.</b> We have seen that a dependent clause may have the
+use of an adverb or of an adjective. It may also have another
+use, as may be seen in the sentence, “Whatever
+Midas touched with his finger immediately glistened and
+grew yellow.” If we ask the question, <i>What glistened and
+grew yellow?</i> we get the answer, <i>Whatever Midas touched with
+his finger</i>; hence this group of words must be the subject.
+But this group is a clause, for it contains the subject <i>Midas</i>
+and the verb <i>touched</i>. A clause used as the subject of a
+predicate is used like a noun, hence we call it a <b>noun clause</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section308"><b>308.</b> The noun clause has several other uses of a noun besides
+that of subject. It may be,—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Object of a verb; as, “I think that life would be very
+dull without meals.”</p>
+
+<p>(2) Subjective complement; as, “The sad part of this
+tale is that the trouble was not with poor little Quackalina’s
+eyes at all.”</p>
+
+<p>(3) In apposition; as, “He had a theory that the big
+horned owl might be tamed.” Here the clause explains the
+noun <i>theory</i> telling exactly what the theory is. This may
+seem at first like an adjective clause, but there is a clear difference.
+We can make a sentence by putting the verb <i>is</i> between
+the noun <i>theory</i> and the clause. This shows that the
+two are identical, but we cannot do this with the noun <i>theory</i>
+and an adjective clause, as in this sentence, “I do not believe
+in the theory that he sets forth in his book.”</p>
+
+<p>(4) Object of a preposition; as, “Aladdin’s mother listened
+with surprise to what her son told her.” If you ask
+the question, <i>listened to what?</i> you get the answer, <i>what her
+son told her</i>. Therefore, the group of words <i>what her son told
+her</i>, which is a dependent proposition, must be the object of
+the preposition <i>to</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_201">[201]</span></p>
+
+<p>(5) Some adjectives, like <i>anxious</i>, <i>aware</i>, <i>careful</i>, <i>certain</i>,
+<i>glad</i>, <i>hopeful</i>, <i>sorry</i>, and <i>sure</i>, especially when used as subjective
+complements, are modified by noun clauses that take
+the place of adverbial prepositional phrases. We may say,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>I am sure <i>of his election</i>.</p>
+
+<p>I am sure <i>that he will be elected</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>In the first sentence the adjective <i>sure</i> is modified by the
+phrase <i>of his election</i>. In the second sentence the adjective
+<i>sure</i> is modified by the noun clause <i>that he will be elected</i>,
+which answers the question <i>sure of what?</i> This may be called
+the adverbial use of the noun clause.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section309"><b>309.</b> Often, when a noun clause is used as subject, it is
+placed after the predicate, and the sentence begins with the
+word <i>it</i>; as, “It is curious that almost every nation on earth
+has some particular traditions regarding the dog.” If we ask
+the question, <i>what is curious?</i> the answer is not <i>it</i>, for that
+tells nothing, but the clause. The word <i>it</i> is called an <b>anticipative
+subject</b>, because it comes before the real subject,
+and signifies also to the reader that the real subject may be
+expected after the predicate.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section310"><b>310.</b> The tense of the verb in a noun clause is determined
+partly by the meaning of the sentence and partly by the
+tense of the verb in the independent clause. What is the
+meaning of each of the following sentences, and what is the
+tense of each verb?</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>I understand that he builds bridges.</p>
+
+<p>I understand that he will build the bridge.</p>
+
+<p>I understand that he has built the bridge.</p>
+
+<p>I understood that he builds bridges.</p>
+
+<p>I understood that he would build the bridge.</p>
+
+<p>I understood that he had built the bridge.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A noun clause is a dependent clause having
+the use of a noun.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_202">[202]</span></p>
+
+<p>The noun clause may be used adverbially to modify certain
+adjectives.</p>
+
+<p>The word <i>it</i> may be used as an anticipative subject to
+throw the real subject, a noun clause, after the verb.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Select all the noun clauses, and explain the
+use of each.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Just then a shout from the boys’ tent proclaimed that the
+twins were awake.</p>
+
+<p>2. There were two summer houses at one end of what we called
+a park.</p>
+
+<p>3. The probability is very great that the Vikings did land on our
+coast.</p>
+
+<p>4. What made the little silver teapot so alluring was that it
+held just enough for two.</p>
+
+<p>5. Be careful how you handle my razor.</p>
+
+<p>6. It so happened that one of his neighbors had two very beautiful
+daughters.</p>
+
+<p>7. I discovered that the world was not created exclusively on
+my account.</p>
+
+<p>8. Mr. Cobb had a feeling that he was being hurried from peak
+to peak of a mountain range without time to take a good breath in
+between.</p>
+
+<p>9. That supply follows demand is a sure rule of political
+economy.</p>
+
+<p>10. The truth is that my dancing days are over.</p>
+
+<p>11. In choosing words it is to be remembered that there is not a
+really poor one in any language.</p>
+
+<p>12. Are you aware that Phio has gone to the hospital?</p>
+
+<p>13. On the very day of his inauguration Jefferson took a step
+toward what he called simplicity, and what his opponents thought
+vulgarity.</p>
+
+<p>14. I knew that I was born at the North, but I hoped that nobody
+in New Orleans would find it out.</p>
+
+<p>15. The Austrian commander noticed this peculiarity about the
+firing,—that every shot seemed to come from the same place.</p>
+
+<p>16. That the monkeys had stolen the snuffbox was obvious,
+for both of them were seized with convulsions of sneezing.</p>
+
+<p>17. I am glad that you are going to talk on the peace movement.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_203">[203]</span></p>
+
+<p>18. The disadvantage of being a boy is that it does not last long
+enough.</p>
+
+<p>19. We are all sorry that some days never come but once.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Justify the tense of the verb in the noun
+clause in each of these sentences—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>I know that fever produces thirst.</p>
+
+<p>I knew that tennis is a healthful sport.</p>
+
+<p>I know that the lake will freeze to-night.</p>
+
+<p>I knew that the lake would freeze last night.</p>
+
+<p>I know that my turn comes next.</p>
+
+<p>I knew that my turn came next.</p>
+
+<p>I know that she has heard the news.</p>
+
+<p>I knew that she had heard the news.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXVIII">LXXVIII. INTRODUCTORY WORDS OF NOUN CLAUSES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section311"><b>311.</b> We have learned that adjective clauses and adverbial
+clauses are joined to what they modify by some connective.
+This word also serves to show that the clause it introduces
+is not independent but dependent.</p>
+
+<p>The noun clause also is introduced by some connecting
+word. In the sentence, “That you have wronged me doth
+appear in this,” the first word <i>that</i> could be placed nowhere
+in the clause except at the beginning, and it reveals at once
+that the clause it introduces is dependent.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section312"><b>312.</b> The introductory word of a noun clause may be several
+parts of speech:</p>
+
+<p>(1) The subordinating conjunctions <i>if</i>, <i>that</i>, and <i>whether</i>.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Go and see <i>if</i> your father is coming home.</p>
+
+<p>I believe <i>that</i> all men are created free and equal.</p>
+
+<p>I do not know <i>whether</i> Mary is a suffragist or a suffragette.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Often the connective <i>that</i> is omitted; as, “You said you
+were coming home early,” “David thought Dora was an
+angel.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_204">[204]</span></p>
+
+<p>(2) The interrogative pronouns <i>who</i>, <i>whose</i>, <i>whom</i>, <i>which</i>,
+<i>what</i>.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Nobody knows <i>who</i> first wrote the story of little Red Riding Hood.</p>
+
+<p>Can you tell <i>whose</i> picture this is?</p>
+
+<p>We cannot tell <i>whom</i> the baby looks like.</p>
+
+<p>Have you heard <i>which</i> came out ahead?</p>
+
+<p>Tell me <i>what</i> you like, and I will tell you <i>what</i> you are.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>In sentences of this sort the interrogative pronoun is not
+used in a direct question, but always when a noun clause is
+introduced by an interrogative pronoun there is an indirect,
+or implied question. Make a direct question out of each of
+the noun clauses above.</p>
+
+<p>The interrogative pronoun always has a use in the noun
+clause that it introduces, just as the relative pronoun has a
+use in the adjective clause. What is the use of each interrogative
+pronoun in the preceding sentences?</p>
+
+<p>(3) The relative pronoun <i>what</i>. This pronoun is always
+equivalent to the two words <i>that which</i>, and there is no question
+implied in a noun clause introduced by this pronoun.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p><i>What</i> Martha told me about the will did not surprise me.</p>
+
+<p>Getting dinner is <i>what</i> takes most of my time.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>(4) The indefinite pronouns <i>whoever</i>, <i>whichever</i>, <i>whatever</i>, etc.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p><i>Whoever</i> came was made welcome.</p>
+
+<p>Take <i>whichever</i> you like.</p>
+
+<p><i>Whatever</i> is, is right.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>What is the use of each noun clause in these sentences?
+What is the use in the clause of each indefinite pronoun?</p>
+
+<p>(5) The conjunctive adverbs <i>when</i>, <i>where</i>, <i>why</i>, <i>how</i>,
+<i>whither</i>, etc.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Do you know <i>when</i> the steamer sails?</p>
+
+<p>I cannot remember <i>where</i> I put my spectacles.</p>
+
+<p>Can you tell <i>why</i> he never wears a muffler?</p>
+
+<p>I never understood <i>how</i> the purse was returned.</p>
+
+<p>It is strange <i>how</i> the memory clings to some things.</p>
+
+<p>Who knows <i>whither</i> the clouds have fled?</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_205">[205]</span></p>
+
+<p>The adverb introducing a noun clause modifies some word
+within the clause, usually the verb.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The noun clause may be introduced by
+(1) a subordinate conjunction, (2) an interrogative pronoun,
+(3) the relative pronoun <i>what</i>, (4) an indefinite pronoun,
+(5) a conjunctive adverb.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the noun clauses, and tell the use
+of each in the sentence. Tell the introductory word of each
+clause, and its use in the clause.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. What disgusted them still more was that Bluebeard had
+already been married several times, and no one knew what had
+become of his wives.</p>
+
+<p>2. Ernest was always ready to believe in whatever seemed
+beautiful and good.</p>
+
+<p>3. We asked the boatman why he did not speak Gaelic to his
+dog as well as to his family.</p>
+
+<p>4. Whoever has been hypnotized by a book agent will understand
+how mother felt about the spectacles that she bought and
+could not wear.</p>
+
+<p>5. I wonder if Burbank ever really produced a deodorized
+onion.</p>
+
+<p>6. Shakespeare’s chair stands in the chimney nook of a small
+gloomy chamber, just behind what was his father’s shop.</p>
+
+<p>7. Whatever was iron or brass in other houses was silver or
+gold in this.</p>
+
+<p>8. The apothecary listened as calmly as he could to the story of
+how Mrs. Peterkin had put salt in her coffee.</p>
+
+<p>9. The lady from Philadelphia asked where the milk was kept.</p>
+
+<p>10. Fortunately, what God expects of us is not <i>the</i> best, but <i>our</i>
+best.</p>
+
+<p>11. Why this spot was selected for a mansion was always a
+mystery, unless it was that the newcomer desired to isolate himself
+completely.</p>
+
+<p>12. Whether the Indians were not early risers, or whether they
+were away just then on a warpath I couldn’t determine.</p>
+
+<p>13. What passes for laziness in a boy is very often an unwillingness
+to farm in a particular way.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_206">[206]</span></p>
+
+<p>14. The direction of a man’s life follows the unseen influence of
+what he admires and loves and believes in.</p>
+
+<p>15. Her only noteworthy achievement was that she had named
+her twin sons Marquis de Lafayette Randall and Lorenzo de Medici
+Randall.</p>
+
+<p>16. I wonder who could describe those wonderful coral gardens on
+which we gazed through twenty fathoms of crystal water.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXIX">LXXIX. REVIEW OF CLAUSES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section313"><b>313.</b> We have learned that clauses may be independent or
+dependent; that dependent clauses may be used like nouns,
+adjectives, or adverbs; that adjective clauses may be restrictive
+or unrestrictive; that adverbial clauses may denote various
+circumstances, such as time, place, manner, etc.; that
+dependent clauses are introduced by some word that indicates
+their dependence.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Study again Lessons <a href="#XVIII">XVIII</a>, <a href="#XX">XX</a>, <a href="#LXVI">LXVI-LXXVIII</a>,
+and then make an outline of the subject, Clauses,
+having for your main topics,—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Classification.</p>
+
+<p>(2) Introductory word.</p>
+
+<p>(3) Use.</p>
+
+<p>Make a good original sentence to illustrate each point.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Analyze the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Though Diana looked very old, she looked exactly the same
+during all the years in which I knew her; and Aunt Maria, who
+had known her all her life, said that she had never looked any
+younger.</p>
+
+<p>2. The only difference between the sisters was that while Miranda
+only wondered how they could endure Rebecca, Jane had
+flashes of inspiration in which she wondered how Rebecca would
+endure them.</p>
+
+<p>3. Whether the pigeons dropped exhausted on some ship and
+were helped across the ocean, or whether some storm at sea swept
+them away forever, no one ever knew.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_207">[207]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. Did mother know who brought the scarlet-runner seeds
+from Whittier’s birthplace?</p>
+
+<p>5. I never quite understood why a girl who climbed trees, clung
+to the tail end of carts, and otherwise deported herself as a well-conditioned
+girl should not, was called a tomboy.</p>
+
+<p>6. The boy remembers how his mother’s anxiety was divided
+between the set of his turn-over collar, the parting of his hair, and
+his memory of the Sunday-school verses.</p>
+
+<p>7. Most people think that the best thing they can give to a
+caged bird is his liberty.</p>
+
+<p>8. The horrible thought came coldly over me that the tiger was
+keeping me company until a good chance offered for a spring.</p>
+
+<p>9. Possibly the reason why monkeys have been so little on the
+stage is that their appearance there would emphasize too strongly
+the striking similarity between man and monkey.</p>
+
+<p>10. An elephant who will not work and is not tied up is about as
+manageable as an eighty-one ton gun in a heavy seaway.</p>
+
+<p>11. Nothing cleverer than was Moufflou had ever walked upon
+four legs.</p>
+
+<p>12. The truth is that boys have always been so plenty that they
+are not half appreciated.</p>
+
+<p>13. The professor was so pleased with his witticism that I was
+let off without even a scolding.</p>
+
+<p>14. Those Indian nations who still preserve their ancient mode
+of life, have dogs which bear a strong resemblance to wolves.</p>
+
+<p>15. The partridge remembered the time when the chickadees
+had seemed such big, important creatures.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Criticize the use of <i>between</i> in sentence 6.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXX">LXXX. REVIEW OF PRONOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section314"><b>314.</b> We have learned that pronouns may be classified as
+follows:—</p>
+
+<p>(1) Personal pronouns.</p>
+
+<p>(2) Compound personal pronouns.</p>
+
+<p>(3) Interrogative pronouns.</p>
+
+<p>(4) Adjective pronouns.</p>
+
+<p>(5) Relative pronouns.</p>
+
+<p>(6) Indefinite pronouns.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_208">[208]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Study again Lessons <a href="#V">V</a>, <a href="#XXXIX">XXXIX-XLIII</a>,
+<a href="#XLVIII">XLVIII</a>, <a href="#LXXVI">LXXVI</a>, <a href="#LXXVIII">LXXVIII</a>, and then be prepared to explain
+each class of pronoun, and to tell the various uses of
+each class. Illustrate each point with an original sentence
+or with one that you yourself have found in some book.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Parse all the pronouns in the following sentences.
+If there is anything peculiar in the use of any pronoun,
+comment upon it. (See pp. <a href="#Page_100">100</a>, <a href="#Page_106">106</a>,
+<a href="#Page_108">108</a>, <a href="#Page_122">122</a>, <a href="#Page_197">197</a>.)</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. What was the Great Stone Face?</p>
+
+<p>2. To make a quarrel needs, indeed, two; but to make peace
+needs only one.</p>
+
+<p>3. When the swarm comes out, it consists of both old and young
+bees, and, indeed, some say that the old queen leads them, and the
+young one takes her vacant throne.</p>
+
+<p>4. We could easily surmise who the Halloween rascals were,
+but what was the terrifying apparatus they applied to our window
+panes we could not imagine.</p>
+
+<p>5. All of this is mine and thine.</p>
+
+<p>6. Attracted by the smell either of the newly killed waterbuck
+or of ourselves, the hungry lions were storming our position.</p>
+
+<p>7. Oh, give me my lowly thatched cottage again.</p>
+
+<p>8. The interior of St. Paul’s is just what one would expect after
+viewing the outside. A maze of grand arches on every side encompasses
+the dome, which you gaze up at as at the sky; and from
+every pillar and wall look down the marble forms of the dead.</p>
+
+<p>9. By the wholesome law of the prairie, he who falls asleep on
+guard is condemned to walk all day.</p>
+
+<p>10.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Who has sight so keen and strong</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">That it can follow the flight of song?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>11. The schoolhouse was a high brick building, and the yard
+itself was made of brick.</p>
+
+<p>12. The Eskimo dogs are of great use to their masters in discovering
+by the scent the winter retreats which the bears make under
+the snow.</p>
+
+<p>13. The Taj Mahal is a Mohammedan tomb, the tomb of the
+favorite wife of an Indian Mogul. It is her tomb, and also his own,
+for he lies beside her, and it was built in compliance with a request
+of hers before she died.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_209">[209]</span></p>
+
+<p>14. I procured a bowl of soup from the steward, but as I was
+not able to eat it, I gave it to an old man whose hungry look and
+wistful eyes convinced me it would not be lost on him.</p>
+
+<p>15.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">What’s a fair or noble face</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">If the mind ignoble be?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>16.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Keep fresh the grass on Wordsworth’s grave,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">O Rotha, with thy living wave!</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Sing him thy best! for few or none</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Hears thy voice right, now he is gone.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXXI">LXXXI. INFINITIVES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section315"><b>315.</b> Look at the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Dare <i>to be</i> true.</p>
+
+<p>It is high time <i>to go</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The bishop seemed <i>to have talked</i> with angels.</p>
+
+<p>You ought <i>to have been paying</i> attention.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>We have here certain verb forms,—<i>to be</i>, <i>to go</i>, <i>to have
+talked</i>, <i>to have been paying</i>,—which are very familiar to all
+of us, but which we have not yet studied. They are not
+forms of the indicative, subjunctive, or imperative mode, nor
+are they like any of the verb phrases that we have examined.
+They all begin with the word <i>to</i>, and they contain two, three,
+or four words, the last of which is the important one. We
+call these groups of words <b>infinitives</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section316"><b>316.</b> An intransitive verb has four infinitives, two of them
+denoting a present action, hence called <b>present infinitives</b>;
+and the other two denoting an action already completed,
+hence called <b>perfect infinitives</b>.</p>
+
+<p>The four infinitives of the intransitive verb <i>laugh</i> are
+these:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Present</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>to laugh</td>
+ <td>to have laughed</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>to be laughing</td>
+ <td>to have been laughing</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>Which two of these infinitives belong to the progressive
+conjugation?</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_210">[210]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section317"><b>317.</b> Transitive verbs have six infinitives. The infinitives
+of the transitive verb <i>eat</i> are these:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Present</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Active</i></td>
+ <td>to eat</td>
+ <td>to have eaten</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Active Progressive</i></td>
+ <td>to be eating</td>
+ <td>to have been eating</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Passive</i></td>
+ <td>to be eaten</td>
+ <td>to have eaten</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p class="section" id="section318"><b>318.</b> The infinitives above are called <b>infinitives with <i>to</i></b>,
+because they begin with the word <i>to</i>. This word is not used
+as a preposition, but merely as a sort of handle, or introduction,
+to the infinitive.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section319"><b>319.</b> Besides the infinitive with <i>to</i> there is another form
+called the <b>infinitive in <i>-ing</i></b>. The infinitives in <i>-ing</i> of the
+verb <i>eat</i> are these:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Present</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Active</i></td>
+ <td>eating</td>
+ <td>having eaten</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Active Progressive</i></td>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>having been eating</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Passive</i></td>
+ <td>being eaten</td>
+ <td>having been eaten</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>What are the infinitives in <i>-ing</i> of the verb <i>laugh</i>? Which
+two forms does it lack?</p>
+
+<p>Find the infinitives in <i>-ing</i> in these sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>He was fined for losing his temper.</p>
+
+<p>“Being a Boy” is the title of a book.</p>
+
+<p>He was vexed at having misspelled so many words.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section320"><b>320.</b> All infinitives are forms of verbs, but they cannot be
+predicate verbs because they do not assert. They are spoken
+of as <b>verbals</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section321"><b>321.</b> A verbal is used in a sentence like some part of speech,—a
+noun, an adjective, or an adverb. The infinitive is
+most frequently used like a noun. The infinitive in <i>-ing</i> is
+very much like a noun in another respect too,—it <i>names</i> the
+action or state that the predicate verb <i>asserts</i>. If we should
+ask for the name of any action that we saw a person performing,
+the answer would be an infinitive in <i>-ing</i>; as, <i>reaping</i>,
+<i>mowing</i>, <i>plowing</i>, <i>driving</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_211">[211]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section322"><b>322.</b> The infinitive in <i>-ing</i> is so much like a noun that it
+can be modified by a possessive noun or pronoun. We say,
+“<i>Your</i> winning the victory depends on your keeping cool.”
+“The farmer’s chagrin was due to his <i>hay’s</i> having spoiled.”
+Explain the use of all the possessives in these sentences.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—The infinitive in <i>-ing</i> is often called a <b>gerund</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section323"><b>323.</b> The infinitive may take the same complements and
+modifiers that any other form of the same verb might take.
+The infinitive, together with all the words associated with it,
+makes an <b>infinitive phrase</b>. The base word of an infinitive
+phrase is always an infinitive. What are the infinitive phrases
+in all the illustrative sentences in this lesson?</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>verbal</b> is a verb form that denotes action
+or being without asserting it.</p>
+
+<p>A verbal is used in a sentence as a noun, an adjective,
+or an adverb.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>infinitive</b> is a verbal that is generally used as a noun.</p>
+
+<p>There are two classes of infinitives,—the infinitive with
+<i>to</i>, and the infinitive in <i>-ing</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The infinitive has two tenses,—present and perfect.</p>
+
+<p>The infinitive may be active or passive or progressive.</p>
+
+<p>An <b>infinitive phrase</b> is a group of words consisting of an infinitive
+together with its complement and modifiers.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Write all the infinitives of the verbs <i>be</i>, <i>bring</i>,
+<i>come</i>, <i>find</i>, <i>freeze</i>, <i>go</i>, <i>leave</i>, <i>seem</i>, <i>taste</i>, <i>turn</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Select all the infinitive phrases in the following
+sentences. Tell the voice and tense of each infinitive.</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Model</span>—<i>It is hard to teach an old dog new tricks.</i> <i>To
+teach an old dog new tricks</i> is an infinitive phrase. <i>To teach</i>
+is the present active infinitive of the transitive verb <i>teach</i>.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Am I to give a reason for all I choose to do?</p>
+
+<p>2. The cherry pie seemed to have been left in the refrigerator
+for that hungry young pair.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_212">[212]</span></p>
+
+<p>3. Driving between these long lines of dainty-flowering and
+sweet-smelling rows of hedges is very delightful.</p>
+
+<p>4. All the lines of pain smoothed out of her brow, and she
+seemed to be peacefully sleeping.</p>
+
+<p>5. The lights had been extinguished, the buoys removed, and
+the whole coast seemed to have gone back hundreds of years.</p>
+
+<p>6. Your having given me the opera glasses is no reason that
+you have a right to borrow them continually.</p>
+
+<p>7. Any child should know that a hot stove is a thing to be
+avoided, but I did not seem to realize the fact.</p>
+
+<p>8. The boy would like to have thrown a stone at the wagon.</p>
+
+<p>9. Did you mind being reproved by your mother for sitting up
+so late?</p>
+
+<p>10. It was already past the appointed hour for Mr. Cobb and his
+coach to be lumbering down the street.</p>
+
+<p>11. From her having been staying at the Antlers the entire season,
+I should judge her to be wealthy.</p>
+
+<p>12. Scrooge was not a man to be frightened by echoes.</p>
+
+<p>13. There’s no use in making two bites of a cherry.</p>
+
+<p>14. The fact of the letter’s having been opened was evident, but
+it could not be proved against the mail carrier.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Tell the part of speech and use of <i>your</i>, sentence 6, <i>her</i> 11,
+<i>letter’s</i> 14.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXXII">LXXXII. INFINITIVES AS SUBJECTS OR COMPLEMENTS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section324"><b>324.</b> If we wish to make an assertion about a person, a
+place, or an object, we use a noun for the base word of our
+subject; but if we wish to make an assertion about an action,
+we use an infinitive or an infinitive phrase for subject; as,
+“Just to breathe the air and feel one’s self alive was enough,”
+“Going after the cows was a serious thing in my day.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section325"><b>325.</b> We have seen that a noun clause used as subject may
+be thrown to the end of the sentence by means of the anticipative
+subject <i>it</i>; as, “It is a good thing <i>that somebody
+likes to cook</i>.” In the same way an infinitive phrase used as
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_213">[213]</span>subject may come after the predicate; as, “It pleased the
+jackal to see Mother and Father Wolf look uncomfortable.”
+Recast this sentence, omitting <i>it</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section326"><b>326.</b> The infinitive phrase is often used as the object of a
+verb. Not all transitive verbs, however, can be completed
+by infinitives—only those which can take for an object the
+name of an action or a condition; as, “The cloud began to
+sink softly down to the earth,” “After a struggle Bess gave
+up using two lumps of sugar in her coffee.”</p>
+
+<p>Why cannot the verbs <i>break</i>, <i>bring</i>, <i>buy</i>, <i>cut</i>, <i>eat</i>, and <i>plow</i>
+take infinitives for objects?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section327"><b>327.</b> The infinitive is used as a subjective complement of
+an intransitive verb in two ways that differ slightly; as, “The
+hunter’s first impulse was to laugh at his own folly,” “No
+trees of any magnitude were to be seen.”</p>
+
+<p>In the first sentence the infinitive phrase, <i>to laugh at his
+own folly</i>, completes the verb <i>was</i> and explains just what the
+impulse was, hence it denotes identity with the subject. Its
+use is precisely like that of the word <i>dime</i> in the sentence,
+“My ‘lucky penny’ is a silver <i>dime</i>,” hence we say that it
+is used like a noun.</p>
+
+<p>In the second sentence it is clear that the infinitive <i>to be
+seen</i> completes the verb <i>were</i> and tells something about the
+subject, hence it must be a subjective complement. But
+instead of being used like a noun to denote identity with the
+subject, it is equivalent to the adjective <i>visible</i>, hence may
+be said to be used like an adjective.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The infinitive phrase may be the subject of
+a verb, the object of a verb, or a subjective complement.</p>
+
+<p>By means of the anticipative subject <i>it</i>, the real subject,
+an infinitive phrase, may be placed at the end of the sentence.</p>
+
+<p>As subjective complement the infinitive phrase may have
+the use of a noun or of an adjective.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_214">[214]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Tell the grammatical use of all infinitive
+phrases in these sentences, and classify all infinitives:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Mowgli said that he never wished to see, or hear, or smell
+man again.</p>
+
+<p>2. That which most resembles living one’s life over again is
+recalling all the circumstances of it and recording them in writing.</p>
+
+<p>3. To fit out a fleet, and to levy and equip an army, and to
+continue the forces thus raised in action during a long and uncertain
+campaign would cost a large sum of money.</p>
+
+<p>4.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">When the days begin to lengthen,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Then the cold begins to strengthen.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>5. It is delightful to look upon the charming country which
+springs up under a watering-pot sky.</p>
+
+<p>6. One of the best things in farm life is gathering the chestnuts,
+hickory nuts, butternuts, and beechnuts.</p>
+
+<p>7. Speaking of Latin reminds me that I once taught my cows
+Latin.</p>
+
+<p>8. The quaint, picturesque old town seems to bristle with forts.</p>
+
+<p>9. When I wanted to hit a mark, my usual way was to aim at
+something else.</p>
+
+<p>10. The one idea in Mowgli’s head was to get Messua and her
+husband out of the trap.</p>
+
+<p>11. This boy was so forward in domestic arts that he undertook
+sewing on the machine when he was only five years old.</p>
+
+<p>12. It is bad manners to find fault with your food at the table.</p>
+
+<p>13. To climb a tree and shake it, to club it, to strip it of its
+fruit, and pass to the next, is the sport of a brief time.</p>
+
+<p>14. One of Jakie’s amusements was dancing across the back of
+a tall chair, taking funny little steps, coming down hard, jouncing
+his body, and whistling as loud as he could.</p>
+
+<p>15. The Englishman learned to fight from behind a tree, to follow
+a trail, and to cover his body with hemlock boughs for disguise.</p>
+
+<p>16. It exactly suits the temperament of a real boy to be very
+busy about nothing.</p>
+
+<p>17. Trotting on city pavements is very hard on the dray horses.</p>
+
+<p>18. The reward of a good sentence is to have written it.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Tell the part of speech and use of <i>that</i> and <i>which</i> in sentence
+2, <i>sum</i> 3, <i>then</i> 4, <i>years</i> 11. What is the object of <i>from</i>
+in sentence 15? Think of similar expressions.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_215">[215]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXXIII">LXXXIII. INFINITIVES AS MODIFIERS OF NOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section328"><b>328.</b> The infinitive phrase is often a modifier of a noun,
+and may be used either like an adjective or like an appositive.</p>
+
+<p>In the sentence, “Ulf still had a name to win,” what noun
+does the infinitive modify? How do you know?</p>
+
+<p>In the sentence, “The mayor gave the order to close the
+skating rink,” the infinitive phrase <i>to close the skating rink</i>
+modifies the noun <i>order</i> by telling exactly what the order was;
+hence we must say that it is in apposition with <i>order</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section329"><b>329.</b> The infinitive in <i>-ing</i> is not used as an adjective modifier
+of a noun except in some compound words like these:
+<i>rolling-pin</i>, <i>laughingstock</i>, <i>meetinghouse</i>, <i>drawing-room</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section330"><b>330.</b> Often the infinitive in <i>-ing</i> is used in apposition, as in
+the sentence, “Her household tasks, keeping the bedrooms
+tidy and caring for the canary birds, left her little time for
+music practice.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The infinitive phrase may modify a noun
+either as an adjective or as an appositive.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the infinitive phrases, and explain
+the use of each. Classify also each infinitive, as in the preceding
+exercise.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Is this a time to be cloudy and sad</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">When our Mother Nature laughs around?</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>2. As the Cloud became larger, this wish to do something for
+the people of earth was ever greater in her heart.</p>
+
+<p>3. This is your last chance to see Chicago, Tom.</p>
+
+<p>4. Day after day mother sat at the east window engaged in her
+favorite pastime—making something dainty and beautiful with
+her needle.</p>
+
+<p>5. Almost all persons who travel in Switzerland have a great
+desire to go to the top of at least one of the towering peaks they see
+about them.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_216">[216]</span></p>
+
+<p>6. Now bring us something to eat. I have not patience to
+wait, for I am ravenously hungry.</p>
+
+<p>7. The first tracks to meet our eyes were the delicate footprints
+of the red squirrel.</p>
+
+<p>8. The Colonel’s only form of exercise, riding horseback every
+evening, made him a familiar figure throughout the city.</p>
+
+<p>9. Nothing pleased the dog more than an order to go and fetch
+the cow.</p>
+
+<p>10. To the deer a mystery means something to be solved.</p>
+
+<p>11. A strange longing to follow the swan took possession of
+each of the young birds.</p>
+
+<p>12. A queer freak of my chewink was her determination to get her
+feet into her food.</p>
+
+<p>13. Never lose an opportunity to see anything beautiful.</p>
+
+<p>14. This father was the comrade of his son, made so by the
+memory of his own boyhood sports,—playing baseball on the
+common, swimming in the lake off Miller’s Point, skating out to
+Garlic Island, and gathering hickory nuts and hazelnuts in the
+autumn woods.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Classify the dependent clauses in sentences, 1, 2, 5, 9.
+Tell the part of speech and use of <i>figure</i>, sentence 8.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXXIV">LXXXIV. INFINITIVES AS PARTS OF “DOUBLE OBJECTS.” AS MODIFIERS OF VERBS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section331"><b>331.</b> In the sentence, “I want my friends to believe in
+me,” we find the verb to be <i>want</i>. If we ask the question
+<i>want what</i>? the answer is the group of words <i>my friends to
+believe in me</i>; hence we are sure that this group of words is
+the object.</p>
+
+<p>But this object is different from any group of words that
+we have studied hitherto. It does not consist of a base word
+and modifiers, but instead it consists of two parts that are
+equally important. These are <i>my friends</i> and the infinitive
+phrase <i>to believe in me</i>. The phrase is not a modifier of
+<i>friends</i>, but has the logical relation of predicate to <i>friends</i>,
+as may be proved by changing the whole group of words to
+a noun clause, <i>that my friends should believe in me</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_217">[217]</span></p>
+
+<p>When the object of a verb consists of two parts, a noun
+element and an infinitive, having to each other the logical relation
+of subject and predicate, we call the whole group a
+<b>double object</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section332"><b>332.</b> Although the relation between the two parts of a
+double object is logically that of subject and predicate, still
+this relation is not grammatically expressed. A double object
+does not make sense standing alone, and we cannot speak of
+the infinitive in a double object as a predicate, for an infinitive
+cannot assert. It is customary, however, to speak of the
+noun element in a double object as the subject of the infinitive.
+The subject of an infinitive is always in the objective
+case, as may be plainly seen by substituting a pronoun for
+the noun used as subject. In the sentence quoted, the pronoun
+that might take the place of <i>my friends</i> is the objective
+pronoun <i>them</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section333"><b>333.</b> An infinitive in <i>-ing</i> is often used as part of a double
+object; as, “I hear their voices <i>ringing</i> in merry childish
+glee,” “I can see his gallant figure <i>coming</i> down the road.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section334"><b>334.</b> Notice that a double object is not two objects of
+equal rank, as in the sentence, “I want <i>peace and quiet</i>;”
+but is one object consisting of two equal parts so closely
+related, that neither of these parts could be the object if used
+without the other.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section335"><b>335.</b> When the infinitive with <i>to</i> is used after the verbs
+<i>hear</i> and <i>see</i>, as well as after <i>feel</i>, <i>let</i>, <i>make</i>, the <i>to</i> of the infinitive
+is omitted; as, “Did you hear me (<i>to</i>) <i>rap</i> at your
+door?” “Let us (<i>to</i>) <i>be</i> true to one another,” “The mosquitoes
+made us (<i>to</i>) <i>go</i> indoors.”</p>
+
+<p>Find and explain the double objects in each of these three
+sentences.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section336"><b>336.</b> When a sentence containing a double object is changed
+to the passive voice, the noun element of the double object
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_218">[218]</span>becomes the subject of the passive verb, and the infinitive
+phrase becomes the subjective complement of the verb.
+Change this sentence to the passive voice and explain the
+change, “We expected John to decorate the banquet room.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section337"><b>337.</b> We have seen that the infinitive may be used as the
+complement of a verb in several ways: it may be the direct
+object of a verb, or the subjective complement, or part of a
+double object. There is another very common relation of
+the infinitive to a verb, as shown in the sentence, “Some
+persons live to eat.” The infinitive <i>to eat</i> is in the predicate,
+but it is not an object of the verb <i>live</i>, neither is it a
+subjective complement. How do we know this? As the infinitive
+answers the question <i>for what purpose</i>? we conclude
+that it is a modifier of the verb <i>live</i>. Furthermore, it could
+be expanded into the adverbial clause of purpose, <i>that they
+may eat</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The infinitive denoting purpose is very common, as seen
+in the familiar sentences: “We go to school to learn,” “We
+stood up to see,” “I sat down to rest.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An infinitive phrase and a noun, having the
+logical relation of subject and predicate, may form the <b>double
+object</b> of some transitive verbs.</p>
+
+<p>An infinitive phrase denoting the purpose of an action may
+be used to modify a verb.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Write sentences containing double objects of
+the verbs <i>cause</i>, <i>desire</i>, <i>expect</i>, <i>feel</i>, <i>hear</i>, <i>let</i>, <i>make</i>, <i>order</i>, <i>see</i>, <i>wish</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Explain why there are no double objects in these
+sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. They could get no water to drink.</p>
+
+<p>2. He has an ax to grind.</p>
+
+<p>3. We found plenty to eat.</p>
+
+<p>4. She bought a rose to wear.</p>
+
+<p>5. I made a cake to sell.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_219">[219]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Explain the use of all infinitive phrases in
+these sentences. Classify the infinitives.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The boy made up his mind that he would take two of the
+whelps home with him to be brought up in the ways of civilization.</p>
+
+<p>2.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">In happy homes he saw the light</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Of household fires gleam warm and bright.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>3. More rarely a fox or a hyena quickened his gallop to study
+the intruder at a safe distance.</p>
+
+<p>4. When the car stopped and I looked up at the window with
+the pink geranium, I saw mother waiting to welcome me.</p>
+
+<p>5. The whole family went to the station to see us off.</p>
+
+<p>6. I do not quite know what caused me to lift my head from the
+friendly shelter of the blanket.</p>
+
+<p>7. He felt his swift craft quiver with life beneath him in response
+to the rhythmic stroke of the oarsmen.</p>
+
+<p>8. Jupiter bustled about to prepare some marsh hens for
+supper.</p>
+
+<p>9. To keep the artillery dry, we stuffed wads of loose hemp into
+the muzzles, and fitted wooden pegs to the touch holes.</p>
+
+<p>10. Down the elm-bordered road we two walked toward the sunset,
+and watched the mists rising ghostlike from the fields.</p>
+
+<p>11. Mowgli heard the sound rumble, and rise, and fall, and die
+off in a creepy sort of whine behind him.</p>
+
+<p>12. At recess the next noon the Centipedes met in a corner of
+the schoolyard to talk over the proposed lark.</p>
+
+<p>13. Our Heavenly Father himself has planted that pea, and made
+it grow and blossom to bring joy to you and hope to me, my blessed
+child.</p>
+
+<p>14. Nearly all the finest diamonds in the world are brought to
+Amsterdam to be cut into shape.</p>
+
+<p>15. It was Long Tom who taught Harvey to shoot at a mark
+with a revolver.</p>
+
+<p>16. He’s gone to fight the French for King George upon his
+throne.</p>
+
+<p>17. We heard the meadow larks singing their wistful songs, but
+always instead of the black hearts upon their yellow breasts they
+showed us just the two white feathers in their tails.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Change sentences 2, 4, 10, 11, 13, 17 to the passive voice,
+and explain the change in the use of the infinitive.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_220">[220]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXXV">LXXXV. OTHER USES OF INFINITIVES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section338"><b>338.</b> The most frequent use of the infinitive in <i>-ing</i> is as
+the object of a preposition; as, “I am tired of <i>doing</i> nothing,”
+“He earned a living by <i>sharpening</i> scissors.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section339"><b>339.</b> The infinitive in <i>-ing</i>, like the noun, may be the object
+of any preposition, but the infinitive with <i>to</i> is used as the
+object of very few prepositions, only <i>about</i>, <i>except</i>, <i>but</i>, and
+<i>save</i>, the last two meaning <i>except</i>.</p>
+
+<p>In the sentence, “He ate nothing but bananas,” the object
+of the preposition <i>but</i> must be a noun because it must be the
+name of a food. But in the sentence, “He did nothing but
+play tennis,” the object of <i>but</i> must be an infinitive because
+it must be the name of an action.</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—We often hear the expression “I was about to say.” In
+this familiar idiom the prepositional phrase <i>about to say</i> is used as
+the subjective complement of the verb <i>was</i>. How do we know this?
+What is the use of the infinitive <i>to say</i>?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section340"><b>340.</b> In the sentence, “The gentleman drew out the chair
+for the lady to sit down,” if we ask the question <i>for what?</i>
+we get the answer <i>the lady to sit down</i>, hence the group of
+words <i>the lady to sit down</i> must be the object of the preposition
+<i>for</i>. But this group of words consists of two parts, <i>the lady</i>
+and the infinitive phrase <i>to sit down</i>, which have the logical
+relation of subject and predicate, hence we conclude that
+the preposition <i>for</i> may take a double object.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section341"><b>341.</b> The sentences, “Sheep are apt,” “I am sorry,”
+“The traveler was glad,” are all incomplete. We wish to
+know in what respect sheep are apt, what I am sorry about,
+what the traveler was glad of. In other words, the adjectives
+<i>apt</i>, <i>sorry</i>, and <i>glad</i> need a modifier to make the sentence complete
+in meaning. This modifier may be an infinitive, “Sheep
+are apt <i>to get lost</i>,” “I am sorry <i>to leave Warwick</i>,” “The
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_221">[221]</span>traveler was glad <i>to see his home again</i>.” We learn from these
+sentences that an infinitive phrase may modify an adjective.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Complete the following sentences by infinitive
+phrases. What do your phrases modify? How do you know?</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. This child is too young—</p>
+
+<p>2. A man of twenty-five is old enough—</p>
+
+<p>3. The water was so deep as—</p>
+
+<p>4. The general was anxious—</p>
+
+<p>5. Some lessons are not easy—</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section342"><b>342.</b> The infinitive may be used independently; as, “<i>To
+be frank</i>, I do not like it.” “<i>To make a long story short</i>, we
+were utterly defeated.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section343"><b>343.</b> A common error is the use of the perfect infinitive for
+the present. It is proper to say, “I ought to have gone,”
+when we mean that the time of the going was in the past;
+as, “I ought to have gone then, or yesterday, or a year ago.”
+But when we mean that the going is at the present time or
+is to be in the future, then we should use the present infinitive,
+and say, “I ought to go.”</p>
+
+<p>What is the difference in the meaning of the following
+pairs of sentences?</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td>1.</td>
+ <td>I am sorry to offend you.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>I am sorry to have offended you.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>2.</td>
+ <td>I am glad to see you.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>I am glad to have seen you.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>3.</td>
+ <td>The train is reported to be late.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>The train is reported to have been late.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>4.</td>
+ <td>The man is said to be a candidate.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>The man is said to have been a candidate.</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>It is evident from the four pairs of sentences above that
+some verbs in the present tense may be followed by either a
+present or a perfect infinitive. This is likewise true of some
+verbs in the past tense. We say, “He seemed to be sleeping,”
+meaning that he was sleeping at the time we noted his appearance.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_222">[222]</span>We also say, “He seemed to have been sleeping,”
+meaning that he had slept before we noted his appearance.</p>
+
+<p>What is the difference in the meaning of the following pairs
+of sentences:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <td>1.</td>
+ <td>Washington was never known to fight a duel.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>Hamilton was known to have fought a duel.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>2.</td>
+ <td>The ship was reported to be wrecked.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>The ship was reported to have been wrecked.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td>3.</td>
+ <td>The child appeared to lead the old man.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>The child appeared to have led the old man.</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>Since the verbs <i>desire</i>, <i>expect</i>, <i>hope</i>, <i>want</i>, and <i>wish</i> refer to
+something in the present or the future, but never in the past,
+they cannot be followed by a perfect infinitive. It is absurd
+to say, “I hoped to have seen you,” “I expected to have
+gone,” “I wished to have stayed.” We should say:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>I desire to go. I desired to go.</p>
+
+<p>I expect to be there. I expected to be there.</p>
+
+<p>I hope to pass. I hoped to pass.</p>
+
+<p>I want to know. I wanted to know.</p>
+
+<p>I wish to speak. I wished to speak.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The infinitive phrase may be used as the object
+of a preposition. The preposition <i>for</i> may take a double
+object.</p>
+
+<p>The infinitive phrase may modify an adjective.</p>
+
+<p>The infinitive phrase may be used independently.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Explain the use of each infinitive phrase.
+Classify each infinitive.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The cat was just about to spring upon the window sill where
+the bird cage sat, when Paul shouted out a warning.</p>
+
+<p>2. I am perfectly willing to dine in the kitchen beside this cool
+north window.</p>
+
+<p>3. The gay youths spent their time in walking, hunting, fishing,
+feasting, and dancing.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_223">[223]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. It was so cold at Petoskey in July that the hotel proprietor
+furnished a large lamp for us to heat our room by.</p>
+
+<p>5. The cherries grew too high to be picked except by the robins.</p>
+
+<p>6. My lot was indeed a hard one; I was too old to play out of
+doors with my brothers, and too young to go to parties with my
+sisters.</p>
+
+<p>7. After supper, the boy who has done nothing all day but turn
+grindstone, and spread hay, and run his little legs off at everybody’s
+beck and call, is sent on some errand or some household chore lest
+time may hang heavy on his hands.</p>
+
+<p>8. Bark is only good to sharpen claws.</p>
+
+<p>9. John was hungry enough to have eaten the New England
+Primer.</p>
+
+<p>10. Franklin was employed in cutting wicks for the candles,
+filling the molds for cast candles, attending the shop, going of
+errands, etc.</p>
+
+<p>11. To tell the truth, I prefer to stay at home.</p>
+
+<p>12. The only way to make the world better is for each man to do
+his best.</p>
+
+<p>13. A dog is good to bite peddlers and small children, and to
+run out and yelp at wagons that pass by, and to howl all night when
+the moon shines.</p>
+
+<p>14. To sum up, the infinitive is used chiefly as a noun, but also as
+an adjective and an adverb.</p>
+
+<p>15. The teacher’s eyes glanced half a dozen different ways at
+once,—a habit probably acquired from watching the boys.</p>
+
+<p>16.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">None knew thee but to love thee,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Nor named thee but to praise.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>17. To see the sparks rush like swarms of red bees skyward
+through the smoke is an experience long to be remembered.</p>
+
+<p>18. To make way for hemp the magnificent forests of Kentucky
+were felled.</p>
+
+<p>19. The crow and the blackbird seem to love these plants.</p>
+
+<p>20. It takes a hundred days to lift out of the tiny seed these
+powerful hollow stalks.</p>
+
+<p>21. The seeds fall to the ground, there to be folded in against
+the time when they shall rise again.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Classify the dependent clauses in sentence 1. What is
+the object of <i>except</i> in sentence 5?</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_224">[224]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXXVI">LXXXVI. SUMMARY OF INFINITIVES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section344"><b>344.</b></p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>I. <span class="smcap">Definition.</span>—An infinitive is a verbal noun.</li>
+ <li>II. <span class="smcap">Forms.</span></li>
+ <li class="sub1">1. The infinitive with <i>to</i>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(a) Intransitive verbs.</li>
+ <li class="sub3"><i>Present</i>, to go, to be going.</li>
+ <li class="sub3"><i>Perfect</i>, to have gone, to have been going.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(b) Transitive verbs.</li>
+ <li class="sub3"><i>Present</i>, to see, to be seeing, to be seen.</li>
+ <li class="sub3"><i>Perfect</i>, to have seen, to have been seeing, to have been seen.</li>
+ <li class="sub1">2. The infinitive in <i>-ing</i>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(a) Intransitive verbs.</li>
+ <li class="sub3"><i>Present</i>, going.</li>
+ <li class="sub3"><i>Perfect</i>, having gone, having been going.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(b) Transitive verbs.</li>
+ <li class="sub3"><i>Present</i>, seeing, being seen.</li>
+ <li class="sub3"><i>Perfect</i>, having seen, having been seeing, having been seen.</li>
+ <li>III. <span class="smcap">Uses.</span></li>
+ <li class="sub1">1. As a <b>noun</b>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(a) <i>Subject of a verb.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">To err is human.</li>
+ <li class="sub3">Hunting is a sport.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(b) <i>Object of a verb.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">He expects to win.</li>
+ <li class="sub3">They stopped working.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(c) <i>Subjective complement.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">My desire is to own a boat.</li>
+ <li class="sub3">His task is feeding the sheep.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(d) <i>Appositive.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">His idea, to use coal ashes, was carried out.</li>
+ <li class="sub3">His work, running a machine, is monotonous.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_225">[225]</span></li>
+ <li class="sub2">(e) <i>Object of a preposition.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">The patient did nothing but eat and sleep.</li>
+ <li class="sub3">The child was praised for telling the truth.</li>
+ <li class="sub1">2. As an <b>adjective</b>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(a) <i>Modifying a noun.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">I have a garden to make.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(b) <i>Completing a verb.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">These boats are not to let.</li>
+ <li class="sub1">3. As an <b>adverb</b>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(a) <i>Modifying a verb.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">I went back to get some matches.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(b) <i>Modifying an adjective.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">We are sure to succeed.</li>
+ <li class="sub1">4. As part of a <b>double object</b>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(a) <i>Of a verb.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">I made her tell me.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(b) <i>Of a preposition.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">I made room for her to sit with me.</li>
+ <li class="sub1">5. <b>Independent use.</b></li>
+ <li class="sub3">To speak plainly, I don’t believe it.</li>
+</ul>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXXVII">LXXXVII. ANALYSIS OF SENTENCES CONTAINING INFINITIVE PHRASES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section345"><b>345.</b> The infinitive phrase is analyzed very much like a
+predicate. First, the infinitive should be given as the base
+word; then its complement and modifiers should be given.</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Model.</span>—<i>By the law of the jungle the tiger has no right to
+change his quarters without fair warning.</i></p>
+
+<p>This is a simple, declarative sentence.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_226">[226]</span></p>
+
+<p>The subject is <i>the tiger</i>. The predicate is <i>has by the law
+of the jungle no right to change his quarters without fair
+warning</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The predicate verb is <i>has</i>; it is completed by the direct
+object <i>no right to change his quarters without fair warning</i>, and
+then modified by the prepositional phrase <i>by the law of the
+jungle</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The base word of the object is the noun <i>right</i>; it is modified
+by the infinitive phrase <i>to change his quarters without fair
+warning</i>, and then denied by the adjective <i>no</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The base word of the infinitive phrase is the infinitive <i>to
+change</i>; it is completed by the direct object <i>his quarters</i> and
+modified by the prepositional phrase <i>without fair warning</i>.
+The base word of the object is the noun <i>quarters</i>, modified by
+the possessive pronoun <i>his</i>. The base word of the object of
+the preposition <i>without</i> is the infinitive <i>warning</i>, which is
+modified by the adjective <i>fair</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The base word of the object of the preposition <i>by</i> is the
+noun <i>law</i>, which is modified by the prepositional phrase <i>of
+the jungle</i> and the article <i>the</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Analyze the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Turning grindstones to grind scythes is one of those heroic
+but unobtrusive occupations for which one gets no credit.</p>
+
+<p>2. Some books are to be tasted, others to be swallowed, and
+some few to be chewed and digested.</p>
+
+<p>3. When Kotick felt his skin tingle all over, his mother told him
+he was learning the feel of the water.</p>
+
+<p>4. Mother made and embroidered a white linen pocket for me
+to wear at my belt.</p>
+
+<p>5. The neighbors and friends did not wait for an invitation to go to
+the house of the young wife, so impatient were they to see her treasures.</p>
+
+<p>6. The Boy had no desire to investigate further, with the risk
+of finding the lynx at home.</p>
+
+<p>7. It seems hard any day to think what to have for dinner.</p>
+
+<p>8. The next thing was to cord up the trunk, and Mr. Peterkin
+tried to move it.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_227">[227]</span></p>
+
+<p>9. I have seen wild bees and butterflies feeding at a height of
+13,000 feet above the sea.</p>
+
+<p>10. If you wear an automobile veil to pick cherries in, I must get
+an automobile to take you to the cherry trees.</p>
+
+<p>11. No person but yourself is permitted to lift this stone or enter
+the cave.</p>
+
+<p>12. Very sweet were the child’s ways of loving her father,—putting
+flowers on his study table, learning to read so that she could
+read his books, reaching up to rub her cheek against his, praying for
+him, and letting him put her to bed.</p>
+
+<p>13. The Oldest Inhabitant refused to go to bed on any terms,
+but persisted in sitting up in a rocking-chair until daybreak.</p>
+
+<p>14. The Eskimo never knows when his own time may come to beg.</p>
+
+<p>15. Fate tried to conceal him by naming him Smith.</p>
+
+<p>16. The only department of life in which Mr. Randall failed to
+shine was the making of sufficient money to live upon.</p>
+
+<p>17. He saw an eagle swoop across the gigantic hollow, but the
+great bird dwindled to a dot ere it was halfway over.</p>
+
+<p>18. After she began wearing the bracelet, she was unwilling to go
+without it even for a day.</p>
+
+<p>19. Hewing wood and sawing plank leave me no time to take part
+in disputes.</p>
+
+<p>20. The one object of Polly’s life was to get out of her cage.</p>
+
+<p>21. The skipper had taken his little daughter to bear him company.</p>
+
+<p>22. Every boy is anxious to be a man.</p>
+
+<p>23. A man has no more right to say a rude thing to another than
+to knock him down.</p>
+
+<p>24. To travel in Switzerland it is generally necessary to cross the
+mountains, to go around the sides, or to go through them.</p>
+
+<p>25. Even the blind men’s dogs appeared to know Scrooge.</p>
+
+<p>26. Let dogs delight to bark and bite.</p>
+
+<p>27. When a bear kills a sheep, he skins it deftly and has the
+politeness to leave the pelt in a neat bundle, just to indicate to the
+farmer that he has been robbed by a gentleman.</p>
+
+<p>28. The first tracks to meet their eyes were the delicate footprints
+of the red squirrel.</p>
+
+<p>29. It is not good to make a jest of thy teacher.</p>
+
+<p>30. Angels seemed to have sat with Ernest by the fireside.</p>
+
+<p>31. My joy was greater than I can express when I saw the tiger
+rise and slink into the jungle.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_228">[228]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXXVIII">LXXXVIII. PARTICIPLES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section346"><b>346.</b> In <a href="#LIV">Lesson LIV</a> we learned that the perfect tenses of
+any verb are formed by combining certain auxiliaries with the
+<b>past participles</b> of the verb; as, “I have <i>heard</i>,” “I had
+<i>heard</i>,” “I shall have <i>heard</i>.” We learned also that the past
+participle is one of the principal parts of a verb.</p>
+
+<p>In <a href="#LV">Lesson LV</a> we learned that the passive voice of any transitive
+verb is formed by adding its past participle to the conjugation
+of the verb <i>be</i>; as, “It is <i>caught</i>,” “It was <i>caught</i>,”
+“It will be <i>caught</i>.”</p>
+
+<p>In <a href="#LVI">Lesson LVI</a> we learned that the past participle of a verb
+may be used like an adjective as the subjective complement
+of a verb; as, “The potatoes seem <i>done</i>,” “The flowers are
+<i>withered</i> now.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section347"><b>347.</b> In <a href="#LVII">Lesson LVII</a> we learned that the <b>present participle</b>
+of a verb always ends in <i>-ing</i>, and that this participle is used
+in forming the progressive conjugation, as, “I am <i>sleeping</i>,”
+“I was <i>sleeping</i>,” “I shall be <i>sleeping</i>.”</p>
+
+<p>We are ready now to study participles in all their relations.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section348"><b>348.</b> Intransitive verbs have four participles:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Present</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Past</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>coming</td>
+ <td>come</td>
+ <td>having come</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Progressive</i></td>
+ <td></td>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>having been coming</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>Transitive verbs have six participles:—</p>
+
+<table>
+ <tr>
+ <th></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Present</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Past</span></th>
+ <th><span class="smcap">Perfect</span></th>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Active</i></td>
+ <td>writing</td>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>having written</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Active Progressive</i></td>
+ <td></td>
+ <td></td>
+ <td>having been writing&#x2060;<a id="FNanchor_1" href="#Footnote_1" class="fnanchor">[1]</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td><i>Passive</i></td>
+ <td>being written</td>
+ <td>written</td>
+ <td>having been written</td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+
+<div class="footnotes">
+<div class="footnote"><p><a id="Footnote_1" href="#FNanchor_1" class="label">[1]</a> This form is rarely used.</p></div>
+</div>
+
+<p>The active participles denote action performed; they make
+us think of the doer of the action. On the other hand, the
+passive participles denote action received; they make us
+think of the receiver of the action.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_229">[229]</span></p>
+
+<p>The present participle expresses action as still in progress;
+the past participle expresses action completed in past time;
+the perfect participle expresses past action completed before
+some particular past time.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section349"><b>349.</b> The participle, like the infinitive, is a verbal, because
+it is a verb form without the power to assert. Just as an
+infinitive is oftenest used as a noun, so the participle is oftenest
+used as an adjective; that is, it is usually associated with
+some noun. Indeed, it is by their adjective use that we
+are able to distinguish participles from infinitives in <i>-ing</i>,
+for in form they are almost exactly the same.</p>
+
+<p>What nouns do the participles belong with in the following
+sentences?</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>I hear the sound of trickling water.</p>
+
+<p>The lost child had wandered far.</p>
+
+<p>The diamonds sparkling in her dark hair rivaled the stars.</p>
+
+<p>The chair made two hundred years ago tilted one forward very
+uncomfortably.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section350"><b>350.</b> The participles used oftenest are the simplest of all,
+the present active participle and the past passive participle.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section351"><b>351.</b> A participle, like an infinitive, may have all the complements
+and modifiers that a verb may have; as, “The man
+<i>turning the switch</i> is faithful,” “<i>Feeling sleepy after lunch</i>, I
+took a nap.”</p>
+
+<p>The participle and all its accompanying words form together
+a <b>participial phrase</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—A <b>participle</b> is a verbal that is generally used
+as an adjective.</p>
+
+<p>Participles may be active or passive or progressive in meaning.</p>
+
+<p>Participles have three tenses,—present, past, and perfect.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_230">[230]</span>The present participle expresses continuing action, the past
+participle completed action, and the perfect participle past
+action completed before a particular time.</p>
+
+<p>Participles have the same complements and modifiers as
+verbs.</p>
+
+<p>A <b>participial phrase</b> is a group of words consisting of a
+participle and its complement and modifiers.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Form all the participles of the verbs <i>choose</i>,
+<i>draw</i>, <i>drink</i>, <i>go</i>, <i>find</i>, <i>know</i>, <i>tell</i>, <i>think</i>, <i>turn</i>, <i>shine</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Select all the participial phrases in these
+sentences. Tell what noun or pronoun they belong with.
+Classify the participles.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Two children sat on the grass under the lilacs, making dandelion
+chains and talking happily.</p>
+
+<p>2. Those three tall poles now being lifted to position will enable
+us to have a telephone.</p>
+
+<p>3. From a little hill called Hutchinson’s Hill you could look over
+three and a half miles of ground covered with fighting seals.</p>
+
+<p>4. Having given away the old candle mold, she was anxious
+to get it back again.</p>
+
+<p>5. Mrs. Merrithew, knowing well that little folk are generally
+troubled with a wonderful thirst, had also brought a cup and
+a bottle of lemonade.</p>
+
+<p>6. The floors were bird’s-eye maple, and having been lately
+waxed, they looked too fine for my desecrating tread.</p>
+
+<p>7. The workmen, having been painting for hours on the sunny
+side of the house, grew faint and dizzy.</p>
+
+<p>8. The boy took his seat, frowning and blinking at the candle
+light, while his mother, placing his coffee before him, let her hand
+rest on his shoulder.</p>
+
+<p>9. Having passed at the turnstile into the campus, David stood
+before the college.</p>
+
+<p>10. In one hand he carried a faded valise made of Brussels
+carpet sprinkled with pink roses.</p>
+
+<p>11. The old peasant woman, having eaten three meals with the
+servants and three with the mistress, declared at evening that she
+was satisfied.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_231">[231]</span></p>
+
+<p>12. If all the money being spent for ice-cream sodas were put to
+some useful purpose—cement sidewalks, for instance,—few of us
+would be stubbing our toes on old board walks.</p>
+
+<p>13. A snowball soaked in water and left out to cool was a projectile
+which had been resorted to with disastrous results.</p>
+
+<p>14. No flying or crawling creature escapes the sharp little eyes
+of the birds.</p>
+
+<p>15. Its roots having been cut, the top of the tree suffered.</p>
+
+<p>16. The tourists, having watched the bears nose about among
+the tin cans in the garbage piles, went back to the hotel to avoid
+being devoured by mosquitoes.</p>
+
+<p>17. Very soon their path led them out into a wide glade, fenced
+all about with the serried and formal ranks of the young firs.</p>
+
+<p>18. That log just being sawed will produce eight hundred feet
+of lumber.</p>
+
+<p>19. The whale is the largest animal now living in the world.</p>
+
+<p>20. Having been told by his master that he too could go to the
+village, Shep bounded away down the road like mad.</p>
+
+<p>21. Sleep, having descended upon him, spread a quiet mist
+through his brain.</p>
+
+<p>22. Having been tramped down by the cattle, the snow was
+smooth like a floor.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Tell the use of all the infinitive phrases in sentences 2, 4,
+10, 13.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="LXXXIX">LXXXIX. PARTICIPLES MODIFYING NOUNS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section352"><b>352.</b> The participle may be associated with a noun in
+several ways.</p>
+
+<p>(1) The participle may modify a noun precisely like an
+adjective, as when we say <i>boiling</i> water, <i>pleading</i> eyes, <i>revolving</i>
+turret, <i>educated</i> men, <i>hammered</i> brass, <i>plowed</i> land, <i>dried</i>
+apples.</p>
+
+<p>The participle in this use can be distinguished from a real
+adjective in two ways:—(<i>a</i>) it comes from a verb, (<i>b</i>) it
+cannot be compared.</p>
+
+<p>Apply these two tests to the seven participles just given.</p>
+
+<p>Some participles have become real adjectives, as <i>loving,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_232">[232]</span>learned</i>, <i>striking</i> (in <i>striking appearance</i>), <i>annoying</i>, <i>exciting</i>.
+Any one of these adjectives may be compared.</p>
+
+<p>(2) The participle or participial phrase may take the place
+of an adjective clause. Sometimes it is used instead of a
+restrictive clause, thus pointing out a particular thing or
+class of things; as, “The men <i>shoveling coal on the docks</i> were
+prostrated by the heat.” Sometimes the participial phrase
+takes the place of an unrestrictive clause, thus adding a new
+thought to the sentence; as, “Here comes a turbaned negress,
+<i>balancing a basket of lemons on her head</i>.”</p>
+
+<p>In both the sentences just given the participial phrase
+comes after the noun it modifies, thus taking in the sentence
+the same position as the appositive adjective.</p>
+
+<p>The restrictive participial phrase is not set off by a comma.
+The unrestrictive participial phrase is set off by a comma.</p>
+
+<p>(3) The participial phrase may take the place of a clause
+of time or cause, and yet modify a noun, as in the following
+sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Those pens, <i>having been given to me by my dear master</i>, were never
+put to any common uses.</p>
+
+<p><i>Having said these words</i>, Beowulf plunged into the water and
+disappeared among the dark waves.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>In the first sentence, change the phrase to a clause of cause.
+What noun does the phrase modify?</p>
+
+<p>In the second sentence, what does the participial phrase
+modify? What can you say of its position? Change it to
+a clause of time.</p>
+
+<p>Note that although the participial phrase may take the
+place of a clause of time or cause, it is still an adjective element;
+for, as shown in the sentences just studied, such a
+participial phrase may modify a noun.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The participle may be used alone to modify
+a noun precisely like an adjective.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_233">[233]</span></p>
+
+<p>The participial phrase may modify a noun, taking the place
+of a clause.</p>
+
+<p>The participial phrase sometimes comes before, and sometimes
+after, the noun it modifies.</p>
+
+<p>A participial phrase is set off by a comma when it is unrestrictive,
+whether it follows or precedes the word it modifies.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Explain the use of all the participial phrases.
+Classify the participles. Account for the punctuation.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The breaking waves dashed high</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">On a stern and rock-bound coast.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>2. Being direct descendants of Adam and Eve, we had much of
+their inquiring turn of mind.</p>
+
+<p>3. Worms are elongated, soft-bodied animals, differing greatly
+in form and habits.</p>
+
+<p>4. The books bound in red morocco belonged to my mother, and
+the “Iliad” illustrated by Flaxman was one of my father’s treasures.</p>
+
+<p>5. The Temple School was a two-story brick building, standing
+in the center of a great square piece of land, surrounded by a high
+picket fence.</p>
+
+<p>6.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Then [comes] the whining schoolboy with his satchel</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">And shining morning face, creeping like snail</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">Unwillingly to school.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>7. That tree toad squatting on the trellis and peering down at
+us reminds me of the gargoyles on the Cathedral of Notre Dame.</p>
+
+<p>8. The boys looked like a legion of imps, coming and going in
+the twilight, busy in raising some infernal edifice.</p>
+
+<p>9. At last, finding himself hungry and weary, and seeing that
+there were herds of wild asses in the plain which he was traversing,
+Rustum thought that he would catch one of them for his meal,
+and rest for the night.</p>
+
+<p>10. It is only he who is weary of life that throws himself in the
+way of a roaring lion.</p>
+
+<p>11. Like most things connected in their first associations with
+schoolbooks and schooltimes, the Leaning Tower of Pisa seemed
+much too small.</p>
+
+<p>12. In the morning it was raining, with little prospect of fair
+weather, but having expected nothing better, we set out on foot for
+the Causeway.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_234">[234]</span></p>
+
+<p>13. In this tavern the visitor may derive good entertainment
+from real Genoese dishes,—sausages, strong of garlic, sliced and
+eaten with fresh green figs; cocks’ combs and sheep kidneys,
+chopped up with mutton chops and liver; small pieces of some
+unknown part of a calf, twisted into small shreds, fried, and served
+up in a great dish; and other curiosities of that kind.</p>
+
+<p>14. Having supposed the Giant’s Causeway to be of great height,
+I was somewhat disappointed at first for I found the Loom, which
+is the highest part of it, to be but fifty feet from the water.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XC">XC. PARTICIPIAL PHRASES IN THE PREDICATE</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section353"><b>353.</b> Although the participial phrase is in the sentence for
+the purpose of telling something about some person or thing,
+still it does not always go with the noun that names that
+person or thing. In the sentence, “The children stood watching
+them out of the town,” the participial phrase <i>watching
+them out of the town</i> tells something about the <i>children</i>, but it
+is not a direct modifier of the noun <i>children</i>, for it belongs in
+the predicate of the sentence. It does not modify the verb
+<i>stood</i>, for it does not tell how the standing was done. It
+really takes the place of a second predicate, <i>watched them out
+of the town</i>, but participles are not asserting words, hence we
+cannot call this phrase a predicate. The best way to tell
+about it is this: The verb <i>stood</i> is accompanied by the participial
+phrase <i>watching them out of the town</i>, which denotes an
+action taking place at the same time as the standing.</p>
+
+<p>Tell about the participial phrases in these sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Fred entered the house <i>calling as usual for his mother</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The Indians advanced, <i>shouting their war cries</i>.</p>
+
+<p>She gazed forward, <i>shading her eyes with both hands</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—Sometimes the participle is used adverbially to modify
+a verb; as in the sentence, “The children went scampering off to
+the woods.” This sentence does not mean that the children went
+<i>and</i> scampered. They only scampered, and the scampering was
+what made them go. Since the participial phrase tells just how the
+children did the going, it must be a modifier of the verb <i>went</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_235">[235]</span></p>
+
+<p class="note">What is the difference between the sentence just given and the
+following?—“The children went singing to the woods.” It is plain
+that not every verb can be modified by a participle. Usually only
+a verb meaning <i>come</i> or <i>go</i> may be so modified.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section354"><b>354.</b> In <a href="#LV">Lesson LV</a> it was shown that the past participle
+is often used as a subjective complement; as, “This dress is
+<i>soiled</i>,” “My money is <i>spent</i>.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section355"><b>355.</b> In a few idiomatic expressions the participle is used
+adverbially to modify an adjective; as, <i>freezing</i> cold, <i>steaming</i>
+hot, <i>hopping</i> mad, <i>dripping</i> wet. Here the participle
+tells how cold, how hot, etc., and thus denotes degree.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section356"><b>356.</b> Sometimes the noun that a participle modifies is
+omitted, and the participle is said to be used as a noun; as,
+“The loving are the daring,” which means that loving persons
+are daring persons. We also speak of the <i>killed</i> and <i>wounded</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The participle or the participial phrase may
+be a part of the predicate in three ways.</p>
+
+<p>(1) It may be an accompaniment of the verb.</p>
+
+<p>(2) It may be a subjective complement of the verb.</p>
+
+<p>(3) It may be a modifier of a few verbs, denoting the way
+in which an action was performed.</p>
+
+<p>The participle may be used adverbially to modify an adjective
+and thus denote the degree of some quality.</p>
+
+<p>The participle may be used as a noun.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Explain the use of all participles and participial
+phrases. Classify the participles.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The little mare gave me all the sympathy I could ask, repeatedly
+rubbing her soft nose over my face, and lapping up my
+salt tears with evident relish.</p>
+
+<p>2.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Three fishers went sailing out into the west,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Out into the west as the sun went down.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>3. The warriors of the king were little pleased to hear such talk
+from his lips.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_236">[236]</span></p>
+
+<p>4. After her conference with the superintendent, this undignified
+young schoolmistress went dancing and skipping home to
+tell her mother of her promotion.</p>
+
+<p>5. The sun shining on the rippling water made it so dazzling
+bright that we were almost blinded.</p>
+
+<p>6.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Little white Lily sat by a stone,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Drooping and waiting till the sun shone.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>7. On my first day in Tangiers the spectacle was bewildering,
+and only by concentrating my attention on detached groups could
+I form any distinct impression of it.</p>
+
+<p>8. Then Rustum made his way to the bazaar, taking his camel
+drivers with him.</p>
+
+<p>9. After licking his lips and polishing his whiskers, the lynx
+went loping off through the woods with the limp body of the mink
+in his jaws, to eat it at leisure in his lair.</p>
+
+<p>10. In October the woods were a blaze of color,—clear gold,
+flaming scarlet, crimson, amber, and coppery brown.</p>
+
+<p>11.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">I watch him as he skims along,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Uttering his sweet and mournful cry.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>12. Society may be divided into two classes—the bores and the
+bored.</p>
+
+<p>13.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">O Captain! my Captain! our fearful trip is done,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The ship has weathered every rock, the prize we sought is won.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>14. Three kings came riding from far away.</p>
+
+<p>15. One day as the king sat drinking in one of the chambers of
+his palace, and boasting after his custom, a genius, disguised as a
+minstrel, desired to be admitted to the royal presence.</p>
+
+<p>16. The underfed dogs snapped and growled in the passages, glaring
+at the cold stars, and snuffing into the bitter wind, night after night.</p>
+
+<p>17. Drops of nightly dews trickle down to the seeds, moistening
+the dryness, closing up the little hollows of the ground, drawing the
+particles of maternal earth more closely.</p>
+
+<p>18. The barley and the rye are garnered and gone, the landscape
+is bare and deserted.</p>
+
+<p>19. The air was stinging cold and felt like ice upon the boy’s
+bare, hot throat.</p>
+
+<p>20. Her heart overflowed with sympathy for all the weary, the
+beaten, the oppressed.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Explain the use of the infinitive phrases in sentences 3, 4, 7,
+9, 15.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_237">[237]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XCI">XCI. ABSOLUTE PARTICIPIAL PHRASES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section357"><b>357.</b> In the sentence, “When the snow had left the lawns
+bare, the crocuses appeared,” we have an adverbial clause.
+What is it? What does it denote? Such a clause is frequently
+condensed into a group of words like this, <i>the snow
+having left the lawns bare</i>. In this group there are two parts,—the
+noun element <i>the snow</i>, which was subject of the clause,
+and the participial phrase <i>having left the lawns bare</i>, which is
+made out of the predicate of the clause. It is clear then
+that the two parts of this group of words have the logical,
+though not the grammatical, relation of subject and
+predicate.</p>
+
+<p>Such a group of words is called an <b>absolute phrase</b>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section358"><b>358.</b> The absolute phrase is generally spoken of by grammarians
+as an independent element; that is, it is not a modifier
+of any part of the sentence.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section359"><b>359.</b> Occasionally, as in the example given, the absolute
+phrase is an abridgment of an adverbial clause of time.
+Oftener it is used instead of a clause of cause, as in the sentence,
+“<i>The drought having lasted so long</i>, the foliage began
+to turn yellow.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section360"><b>360.</b> Sometimes an absolute phrase is used instead of an
+independent clause, thus changing a compound sentence to a
+simple sentence; as, “The crew escaped from the ship in
+three boats, <i>only two reaching Siberia</i>.” What clause would
+you make out of the absolute phrase here? By what conjunction
+would you join it to the first independent proposition?</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section361"><b>361.</b> The noun or the pronoun that is the base word of the
+noun element in an absolute phrase is said to be in the <b>nominative
+case</b>, used <b>absolutely</b>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_238">[238]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—An <b>absolute phrase</b> is a group of words used
+independently and consisting of a noun or a pronoun and a
+participle, having to each other the logical relation of subject
+and predicate.</p>
+
+<p>An absolute phrase is an abridgment of an adverbial clause
+or an independent clause.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Select all the absolute phrases. Separate them
+into their two parts. Expand them into adverbial clauses
+or independent clauses.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. His feet were clad in half slippers of red leather, the toes
+being pointed and turned upward.</p>
+
+<p>2. She had paused in reverie, her hands clasped behind her
+head.</p>
+
+<p>3. Jack telling his condition, the giant bade him welcome.</p>
+
+<p>4. Grandma and Norman were sitting on the floor in front of
+the ice box, the child having manifested a peculiar desire for cold
+boiled potato.</p>
+
+<p>5. From a balcony above leaned the lovely Ermengarde, her
+golden tresses crowned with a nightcap of rare and curious design.</p>
+
+<p>6. The Frey home was made up of cheery workers, even little
+Dorothea having her daily self-assumed tasks.</p>
+
+<p>7. The laws of that country being very severe against slaves,
+Androcles was sentenced to be torn in pieces by a furious lion.</p>
+
+<p>8. Through wild and desolate scenes, by forests, rocks, and
+waterfalls, we pass, the little locomotive always puffing and pushing
+vigorously behind us.</p>
+
+<p>9. Mowgli had been looking from one to the other of his friends,
+his chest heaving and his eyes full of tears.</p>
+
+<p>10. These eggs being sold, Jack and his mother got plenty of
+money.</p>
+
+<p>11. Everywhere, scattered about the country, we have seen windmills,
+their great arms moving slowly around.</p>
+
+<p>12. Under Rebecca’s delicately etched brows her eyes glowed like
+two stars; their dancing lights half hidden in lustrous darkness.</p>
+
+<p>13. The eagerness of Barnum to obtain a white elephant is easily
+understood, that animal being considered by showmen the greatest
+attraction in the country.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_239">[239]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XCII">XCII. AGREEMENT OF PARTICIPLES. OTHER WORDS IN -ING</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section362"><b>362.</b> A sentence containing a participial phrase should be
+so constructed that there is no doubt as to what noun or pronoun
+the phrase modifies.</p>
+
+<p>In the sentence, “I had a fine view of your new hospital
+coming in on the train this morning,” the participial phrase
+seems by its position to modify the noun <i>hospital</i>; but it
+really modifies the pronoun <i>I</i>, and hence should be placed at
+the beginning of the sentence. If the phrase is expanded
+into an adverbial clause of time, it may remain where it is.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section363"><b>363.</b> In the sentence, “<i>Opening the door</i>, my lamp went
+out,” the participial phrase has nothing to modify.</p>
+
+<p>This is called a <b>dangling</b> or a <b>floating participle</b>. The best
+way to deal with such a sentence is to expand the participial
+phrase into an adverbial clause,—“When I opened the
+door.”</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Point out the error in each of these sentences.
+Reconstruct each sentence.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. We never once thought of the baby, rushing out of doors to
+see the fire.</p>
+
+<p>2. I heard the whistles plainly, sailing across the bay.</p>
+
+<p>3. I met your sister coming home from my music lesson.</p>
+
+<p>4. Mother saw the flames first sitting on the veranda.</p>
+
+<p>5. Entering the hall, her foot slipped on the waxed floor and she
+fell.</p>
+
+<p>6. Putting two and two together, it is quite plain that he wants
+an appointment.</p>
+
+<p>7. Knitting mittens and piecing quilts, I think Grandmother is
+very happy.</p>
+
+<p>8. Having been recently painted, Mr. Graham did not recognize
+his own house.</p>
+
+<p>9. Grasping the rope and plunging into the surf, the huge receding
+wave carried him out almost to the wreck.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_240">[240]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section364"><b>364.</b> We have seen that certain participles are in form
+precisely like infinitives in <i>-ing</i>, and can be distinguished from
+them only by their use. The participle is used like an adjective,
+and the infinitive in <i>-ing</i> is used like a noun.</p>
+
+<p>Take, for instance, the word <i>running</i> in the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>Water <i>running</i> down hill acquires great force.</p>
+
+<p><i>Running</i> races is a small boy’s pastime.</p>
+
+<p><i>Running</i> water is clear.</p>
+
+<p>I shall never forget the <i>running</i> of that race.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>In the first sentence it is clear that <i>running</i> is a participle,
+because the participial phrase <i>running down hill</i> modifies the
+noun <i>water</i> and is, therefore, used like an adjective.</p>
+
+<p>In the second sentence it is equally clear that <i>running</i> is
+an infinitive, for the infinitive phrase <i>running races</i> is subject
+of the sentence and is therefore used like a noun.</p>
+
+<p>In the third sentence <i>running</i> is a participle, because it is
+derived from a verb and cannot be compared. (See <a href="#section352">§ 352</a>.)
+In other respects it resembles a pure descriptive adjective.
+In the phrase “an interesting book” <i>interesting</i> is a pure
+adjective; it can be compared.</p>
+
+<p>In the fourth sentence <i>running</i> is an infinitive in <i>-ing</i>. It is
+modified by an article and is used, like a noun, as the object
+of the verb.</p>
+
+<p>In the sentences, “It is a wise <i>saying</i>,” “Take my <i>blessing</i>,”
+<i>saying</i> and <i>blessing</i> are pure nouns without verbal force,
+as is shown by the fact that they have plural forms.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 1.</b>—Classify the <i>-ing</i> words in the following
+sentences as infinitives, participles, adjectives, or nouns:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The half back was cheered by the admiring crowd.</p>
+
+<p>2. The time of the singing of birds is come.</p>
+
+<p>3. I distinctly said that I wanted a singing bird.</p>
+
+<p>4. Singing hymns was her favorite diversion.</p>
+
+<p>5. Painting high buildings is a dangerous occupation.</p>
+
+<p>6. The old lady painting in the Louvre was an excellent copyist.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_241">[241]</span></p>
+
+<p>7. Mr. Morgan paid a large sum for this small painting.</p>
+
+<p>8. The child was pleased with the painting book.</p>
+
+<p>9. A setting hen looks very placid.</p>
+
+<p>10. They should have been arrested for setting fire to the old house.</p>
+
+<p>11. I will ask the photographer when he can give you a sitting.</p>
+
+<p>12. The child sitting on the curbing said sweetly, “Hello, old lady.”</p>
+
+<p>13. The smiling days are not always the friendliest.</p>
+
+<p>14. “I am better,” said Agnes, smiling brightly.</p>
+
+<p>15. A short saying oft contains much wisdom.</p>
+
+<p>16. Ever charming, ever new, when will the landscape tire the view?</p>
+
+<p>17. Health is a blessing that money cannot buy.</p>
+
+<p>18. Another duty the robin took upon himself,—to assist me
+in seeing that every bird in the room had his daily outing.</p>
+
+<p>19. Turning a canary out into the world is about like turning a
+two-year old baby out to get its own living.</p>
+
+<p>20. We require from buildings as from men two kinds of goodness:
+first, the doing their practical duty well; then that they be
+graceful and pleasing in doing it.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise 2.</b>—Explain the use of each verbal in the following
+sentences. Analyze sentences 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8, 10, 13,
+16, 17, 18, 20, 21.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. The garret is a fine place to sit of an afternoon and hear the
+rain pattering on the roof.</p>
+
+<p>2. To be called to the principal’s office filled the stoutest heart
+with alarm.</p>
+
+<p>3.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The curfew tolls the knell of parting day,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The lowing herd wind slowly o’er the lea.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>4. The old German carpenter packed Mrs. Howe’s heavy furniture
+in an empty store beneath her apartment, and when she refused
+to pay him an exorbitant sum, he locked the door on her and her
+boxes and went off to find a policeman.</p>
+
+<p>5. I had views of many interesting scenes in this family of
+crows, supposed by the wary parents to be visible only to the cows
+stolidly feeding on the hillside.</p>
+
+<p>6. The chickens seemed to be well cared for by the women;
+but the men appeared to be the laziest of mortals.</p>
+
+<p>7. Let us stand on the long iron bridge that spans the St. Lawrence
+just above Montreal, the very place to study the river as it
+narrows and runs swifter for its smashing plunge through yonder
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_242">[242]</span>rapids to the east,—the dreaded Lachine Rapids, whose snarling
+teeth flash white in the sun.</p>
+
+<p>8. To keep Jim from following the regiment or from staying
+and getting lost in search of it, the wagoner had tied him to the rear
+axle of his wagon with a strong twine.</p>
+
+<p>9. The engine mounted the curve faster and faster, roaring
+through a tunnel, growling over a bridge, and snarling at a paling
+alongside, but no glimpse of the runaway locomotive could the
+pursuers get.</p>
+
+<p>10. Daddy felt, like the midshipman, sadly perplexed when the
+dog was finally missing, but he could suggest no mode of revenge
+which was not too dangerous for them to put in practice.</p>
+
+<p>11. The thought of my shortcomings in this life falls like a shadow
+on my life to come.</p>
+
+<p>12. Launching majestically from the edge of the nest, the great
+eagle had swooped down into the cold shadow, and then, rising into
+the light by a splendid spiral, he had taken a survey of the empty,
+glimmering world.</p>
+
+<p>13. Our terrier was never known to spend a night away from home.</p>
+
+<p>14. It is inexplicable to me that any bird should be either so
+unobservant as not to recognize a foreign egg at sight, or so easy-tempered
+as not to insist on straightway being rid of it.</p>
+
+<p>15. It is easier to do what you please than to do what you ought.</p>
+
+<p>16. The blue-white moon of midwinter, sharply glittering like
+an icicle, hung high in a heaven clear as tempered steel.</p>
+
+<p>17. Sometimes the fox resorts to numerous devices to mislead
+and escape the dog altogether,—walking in the bed of a small
+creek, running along a rail fence, or leaping into a hollow stump.</p>
+
+<p>18. The elephants simply moved their legs mechanically up and
+down, and swung their trunks to and fro; but they were determined
+not to pull or exert the slightest power, neither did they
+move forward a single inch.</p>
+
+<p>19. The only way to mitigate the hard lot of a canary is to make
+him so happy that he will not wish to be free.</p>
+
+<p>20. The best part of a journey is getting home again.</p>
+
+<p>21. Jefferson sent Lewis and Clark to penetrate the vast regions
+west of the Mississippi.</p>
+
+<p>22. While the old turkey perched upon a tree top to keep an eye
+on the enemy, the brood went sailing over the trees toward home.</p>
+
+<p>23. The officers ordered the crape to be instantly cut off from the
+dogs’ legs.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_243">[243]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XCIII">XCIII. SUMMARY OF PARTICIPLES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section365"><b>365.</b></p>
+
+<ul>
+ <li>I. <span class="smcap">Definition.</span>—A participle is a verbal adjective.</li>
+ <li>II. <span class="smcap">Forms.</span>—</li>
+ <li class="sub1">1. Of <b>intransitive verbs</b>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2"><i>Present</i>, going.</li>
+ <li class="sub2"><i>Past</i>, gone.</li>
+ <li class="sub2"><i>Perfect</i>, having gone, having been going.</li>
+ <li class="sub1">2. Of <b>transitive verbs</b>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2"><i>Present</i>, seeing, being seen.</li>
+ <li class="sub2"><i>Past</i>, seen.</li>
+ <li class="sub2"><i>Perfect</i>, having seen, having been seeing, having been seen.</li>
+ <li>III. <span class="smcap">Uses.</span></li>
+ <li class="sub1">1. To form the <b>perfect tenses</b>, the <b>passive voice</b>, and the <b>progressive conjugation</b>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">I have trusted you.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">You were trusted by me.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">I am trusting you.</li>
+ <li class="sub1">2. As an <b>adjective modifier</b> of a noun or a pronoun.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(a) <i>Restrictive.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">Barking dogs seldom bite.</li>
+ <li class="sub3">The picture painted by Leonardo da Vinci was stolen.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">(b) <i>Unrestrictive.</i></li>
+ <li class="sub3">(1) Used in place of an adjective clause.</li>
+ <li class="sub4">The silver moon, shining in the rosy eastern sky, must have looked upon the setting sun.</li>
+ <li class="sub3">(2) Used in place of a clause of time or cause.</li>
+ <li class="sub4">Having built a magnificent church, we had to have a magnificent organ.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_244">[244]</span></li>
+ <li class="sub1">3. As <b>subjective complement of a verb</b>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">Christ is risen.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">Everybody is gone.</li>
+ <li class="sub1">4. As an <b>accompaniment of a verb</b>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">Then the blind girl came nearer, reaching out her hands toward my face.</li>
+ <li class="sub1">5. As part of an <b>absolute phrase</b>.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">The roast turkey having received due attention, the boys were ready for mince pie.</li>
+ <li>IV. <span class="smcap">Modifiers and Complements.</span></li>
+ <li class="sub1">Participles have the same modifiers and complements
+as verbs.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">Having earned the money, I spent it.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">Growing tired, we walked slower.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">Calling me a coward, he went on.</li>
+ <li class="sub2">Turning sharply to the right, he struck the tree.</li>
+ <li>V. <span class="smcap">Agreement.</span></li>
+ <li class="sub1">1. The construction of a sentence should leave no doubt
+ as to what word a participial phrase modifies.</li>
+ <li class="sub1">2. Dangling participles should be avoided.</li>
+</ul>
+
+<p>Make two good sentences to illustrate each use of the participle.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XCIV">XCIV. ANALYSIS OF SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section366"><b>366.</b> A participial phrase is analyzed very much like an
+infinitive phrase. First the participle should be given as the
+base, then its complement and modifiers.</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Model.</span>—<i>Behind each islet of tall reeds is a fishing boat held
+fast by two poles stuck in the bottom of the river.</i></p>
+
+<p>This is a simple, declarative sentence. The subject is <i>a
+fishing boat held fast by two poles stuck in the bottom of the river</i>.
+The predicate is <i>is behind each islet of tall reeds</i>.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_245">[245]</span></p>
+
+<p>The base word of the subject is <i>boat</i>. It is modified by the
+infinitive <i>fishing</i>, the article <i>a</i>, and the participial phrase <i>held
+fast by two poles stuck in the bottom of the river</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The base word of this phrase is the participle <i>held</i>. It is
+modified by the adverb <i>fast</i> and by the prepositional phrase
+<i>by two poles stuck in the bottom of the river</i>. The base word of
+the object of the preposition <i>by</i> is the noun <i>poles</i>. It is modified
+by the adjective <i>two</i> and the participial phrase <i>stuck in
+the bottom of the river</i>. The base word of this phrase is the
+participle <i>stuck</i>. It is modified by the prepositional phrase
+<i>in the bottom of the river</i>, etc.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section367"><b>367.</b> A sentence containing an absolute phrase should be
+analyzed as follows:—</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Model.</span>—<i>Amy having gone to Vermont, the lady was lonely.</i></p>
+
+<p>This is a simple, declarative sentence containing the absolute
+phrase <i>Amy having gone to Vermont</i>, which is used instead
+of the adverbial clause of cause, <i>since Amy had gone
+to Vermont</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The subject is <i>the lady</i>. The predicate is <i>was lonely</i>, etc.</p>
+
+<p>The absolute phrase consists of the noun <i>Amy</i> and the
+participial phrase <i>having gone to Vermont</i>, which have the
+logical relation of subject and predicate. The base of the
+participial phrase is the participle <i>having gone</i>, etc.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Analyze the following sentences:—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. In one store I would find a catbird moping on a high shelf or
+in a dark back room; in another a bluebird scared half to death,
+and dumb in the midst of squawking parrots and singing canaries.</p>
+
+<p>2. In that first battle, Jim ran barking after the very first shell
+that came screaming over our heads.</p>
+
+<p>3. The island is supplied with the best water imaginable, small
+streams leaping down from the sides of the hills and running through
+every valley.</p>
+
+<p>4. The biting cold wind that shrunk our faces and pinched our
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_246">[246]</span>noses blue only brought a wild-rose bloom to mother’s delicate
+cheeks.</p>
+
+<p>5. The doings of the people thus suddenly become his neighbors,
+Bobby studied with all a bird’s curiosity.</p>
+
+<p>6. Coming out into the road on my way home again, I fell in
+with an old friend.</p>
+
+<p>7. The soldiers were miserably clad, and asked whether we had
+shoes to sell.</p>
+
+<p>8. It is difficult to describe the left-half’s agony as he picked
+himself up and went limping back to his place.</p>
+
+<p>9. At daylight, directly ahead of us was the island of Juan
+Fernandez, rising like a deep blue cloud out of the sea.</p>
+
+<p>10. Long ears twinkling, round eyes softly shining, the rabbits
+leaped lightly hither and thither, pausing every now and then to
+touch each other with their sensitive noses, or to pound on the
+snow with their strong hind legs in mock challenge.</p>
+
+<p>11. In long, graceful leaps, barely touching the fence, the fox
+went careering up the hill as fleet as the wind.</p>
+
+<p>12. Joel’s long legs began to ache, and seemed stiffening at the
+thighs and knees.</p>
+
+<p>13. After their supper of milk and oatmeal porridge, the children
+sat down, waiting and watching, and fancying they heard sounds in
+the hills.</p>
+
+<p>14. Hearing loud cries of distress coming from the lawn, the
+gardener rushed across and found the crow lying on his back, his
+claw tightly gripping the end of one of the wings of a large hawk.</p>
+
+<p>15. We soon found the vireo’s nest, suspended within the angle
+of two horizontal twigs, and trimmed outwardly with some kind of
+white silky substance.</p>
+
+<p>16. He lay like a warrior taking his rest.</p>
+
+<p>17. For four miles the pilot must race along a squirming, twisting,
+plunging thread of water, that leaps ahead like a greyhound,
+and changes its crookedness somewhat from day to day with wind
+and tide.</p>
+
+<p>18. For centuries the trees had developed strength to resist the
+winds when they were clad in all their leaves, or to carry the load
+of those leaves weighted with raindrops, or to bear the winter snows;
+but they had no strength that would enable them to be coated thick
+with ice and then wrenched by angry blasts.</p>
+
+<p>19. The servants having gone to their cabins, the great house
+was filled with the quiet of a Sunday afternoon.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_247">[247]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XCV">XCV. ANTICIPATIVE SUBJECT</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section368"><b>368.</b> We have learned that the pronoun <i>it</i> may be used as
+an anticipative subject to throw the real subject after the
+predicate. This real subject may be a noun clause or an infinitive
+phrase.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>It will never be known whether the lady came out of that door
+or the tiger.</p>
+
+<p>It is a mistake to suppose that the fox cannot be tamed.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p class="section" id="section369"><b>369.</b> We must not conclude that the word <i>it</i> at the beginning
+of a sentence is always an anticipative subject. Sometimes
+it is the real subject, that is, it is a neuter personal
+pronoun having for its antecedent some term perfectly understood
+by both speaker and listener; as, “Have you read ‘The
+Call of the Wild’? <i>It</i> is the story of a dog that reverted.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section370"><b>370.</b> Sometimes <i>it</i> is used for subject with no special
+word for antecedent; as when we say, “It was blowing great
+guns.” (See <a href="#section252">§ 252</a>.)</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section371"><b>371.</b> In the familiar expression, “It is time to get up,” the
+antecedent of <i>it</i> is the word <i>now</i> or the term <i>the present moment</i>.</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section372"><b>372.</b> <i>It</i> is not the only word used as anticipative subject.
+Another word is <i>there</i>; as in the sentence, “There is snow on
+the top of Pike’s Peak.” If we ask the question, <i>What is on
+the top of Pike’s Peak?</i> the sensible answer is not <i>there</i>, but
+<i>snow</i>, hence <i>snow</i> is the subject. The word <i>there</i> does not
+denote place, hence it is not an adverb. It is used merely
+to fill a gap in a declarative sentence in which the subject has
+been placed after the verb, for if the gap were not filled and
+the sentence began with a verb, it would seem to be interrogative.
+When so used the word <i>there</i> is called an <b>expletive</b>,
+which means a word used to fill up a gap.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_248">[248]</span></p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section373"><b>373.</b> Of course <i>there</i> at the beginning of a sentence is not
+always an expletive. Sometimes it is an adverb denoting
+place; as, “There will I build me a nest.”</p>
+
+<p class="note"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—When <i>there</i> is an adverb we pronounce it distinctly,
+but when it is an expletive used as anticipative subject, we slur it.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Summary.</b>—The word <i>it</i> is often used as an anticipative
+subject so that the real subject may come after the verb.
+The word <i>there</i> may be an anticipative subject. It is then
+called an expletive.</p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Analyze the following sentences. If there is
+an anticipative subject, state that fact before giving the real
+subject; thus,—In the sentence, “Once upon a time there
+were four little rabbits,” the anticipative subject is the expletive
+<i>there</i>; the real subject is <i>four little rabbits</i>. The predicate
+is <i>were once upon a time</i>.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. There would be several insuperable difficulties in adopting
+the moon as a residence.</p>
+
+<p>2. Every object on the moon would be only one sixth as heavy
+as the same object on the earth. There a box containing a pound
+of chocolate bonbons would weigh only two or three ounces.</p>
+
+<p>3. It is a little curious that the effect of a short allowance of
+food does not show itself in hunger.</p>
+
+<p>4. There never was such a hailstorm in Wisconsin.</p>
+
+<p>5. It is just the right time of the moon for planting sweet peas.</p>
+
+<p>6. There were dances, theatricals, and sleighrides that winter.</p>
+
+<p>7. It would amuse me very much to sing while I am hunting.</p>
+
+<p>8. A cannon that breaks loose from its fastenings on a ship is
+suddenly transformed into a supernatural beast. It is a monster
+developed from a machine; it has the weight of an elephant, the
+agility of a mouse, the obstinacy of the ox; it takes one by surprise,
+like the surge of the sea; it flashes like lightning; it is deaf as the
+tomb; it weighs ten thousand pounds, and it bounds like a child’s
+ball.</p>
+
+<p>9. That day there came our first great snowstorm.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_249">[249]</span></p>
+
+<p>10. There lay the beautiful piece of embroidery that mother had
+put away so carefully and forgotten so completely.</p>
+
+<p>11. There’s a special providence that watches over idiots, drunken
+men, and boys.</p>
+
+<p>12. There came to the beach a poor exile of Erin.</p>
+
+<p>13.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">It made the children laugh and play,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">To see a lamb at school.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>14. In the reign of King Arthur, and in the county of Cornwall,
+near to the Land’s End in England, there lived a worthy farmer,
+who had an only son, named Jack.</p>
+
+<p>15. There the two old dogs sat and talked of the wonderful
+tenacity of rheumatism that has once settled in a dog’s shoulder.</p>
+
+<p>16. There was one passenger in the coach,—a small, dark-haired
+person in a glossy buff calico dress.</p>
+
+<p>17. Professor Boyesen describes what he calls the <i>saeter</i>, the
+spring migration of the dairy and dairymaids. It is the great event
+of the year in all the rural districts.</p>
+
+<p>18. There were three Catherines, two Annes, and a Jane.</p>
+
+<p>19. It is said in Ceylon that the cocoanut, like the magpie and
+the robin, will flourish only within sound of the human voice.</p>
+
+<p>20. There is always a sad element in the departure of a steamer.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XCVI">XCVI. ELLIPTICAL SENTENCES</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="section" id="section374"><b>374.</b> We have noted several constructions in which there
+is an ellipsis, or omission of some word or words necessary to
+the grammatical structure of the sentence.</p>
+
+<p>(1) The subject of an imperative sentence, the pronoun <i>you</i>,
+<i>thou</i>, or <i>ye</i> is usually omitted; as, “(<i>You</i>) Honor the flag.”</p>
+
+<p>(2) A noun is often omitted after a possessive modifier; as,
+“Let us go over to Baker’s (<i>house</i>) this evening.”</p>
+
+<p>(3) An auxiliary verb is often omitted; as, “Somebody
+has entered the hall and (<i>has</i>) taken my umbrella.”</p>
+
+<p>(4) The predicate is often omitted in a clause of comparison;
+as, “I am not so tired as you (<i>are</i> or <i>are tired</i>).” “He
+has no better right than I (<i>have</i> or <i>have right</i>).”</p>
+
+<p>(5) The relative pronoun <i>that</i> is often omitted in an adjective
+clause; as, “The ring (<i>that</i>) you gave me is too small.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_250">[250]</span></p>
+
+<p>(6) The subordinate conjunction <i>that</i> is often omitted in
+a noun clause; as, “You said (<i>that</i>) I might take your skates.”</p>
+
+<p class="section" id="section375"><b>375.</b> The elliptical sentence is very common, especially
+in conversation, where we do not have to depend entirely
+upon words to convey our meaning, as we have the help of
+emphasis, tone of voice, and gesture. It follows that in oral
+language we leave out many words that can easily be supplied
+by our listeners.</p>
+
+<p>(1) In answering questions, we seldom make complete
+statements, as,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>What is your name? (<i>My name is</i>) Donald.</p>
+
+<p>Whose boy are you? (<i>I am</i>) Mr. Hill’s (<i>boy</i>).</p>
+
+<p>Where do you live? (<i>I live</i>) On Jackson Street.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>(2) We often omit a word that has already been expressed
+in the sentence; as, “Our first maid was an Irish girl; our
+second (<i>maid was</i>) a Norwegian (<i>girl</i>).”</p>
+
+<p>(3) In sentences beginning with <i>no wonder</i> or <i>no matter</i> we
+omit the main verb and the anticipative subject <i>it</i>.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>“No wonder he died,” means “It is no wonder that he died.”</p>
+
+<p>“No matter what I said,” means “It is no matter what I said.”</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>(4) Two very common questions are <i>What of it?</i> and <i>What
+if I do?</i> We may expand the first question thus, “What
+(<i>will come</i>) of it?” and the second thus, “What (<i>difference
+will it make</i>) if I do?”</p>
+
+<p>(5) In adverbial clauses we find many cases of ellipsis, but
+the words omitted can readily be supplied; as,—</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>I lived on the south side when (<i>I was</i>) a child.</p>
+
+<p>I cut my finger while (<i>I was</i>) paring an apple.</p>
+
+<p>She sings as if (<i>she were singing</i>) by note.</p>
+
+<p>I will be there if (<i>it is</i>) possible.</p>
+
+<p>Though (<i>we were</i>) tired and hungry we plodded on.</p>
+
+<p>I will go (<i>though it</i>) rain or (<i>though it</i>) shine.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_251">[251]</span></p>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Analyze the following sentences, supplying the
+words omitted wherever there is an ellipsis.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Wisdom is better than rubies.</p>
+
+<p>2. A song to the oak, the brave old oak!</p>
+
+<p>3. The sun shall not smite thee by day nor the moon by night.</p>
+
+<p>4. She will close the house and go to her son’s.</p>
+
+<p>5. Cæsar had his Brutus; Charles the First his Cromwell.</p>
+
+<p>6. It is more blessed to give than to receive.</p>
+
+<p>7. And then to breakfast with what appetite you have.</p>
+
+<p>8. To-day he puts forth the tender leaves of hope; to-morrow
+blossoms.</p>
+
+<p>9. Love’s wing moults when caged and captured.</p>
+
+<p>10. He that is slow to anger is better than the mighty, and he
+that ruleth his spirit than he that taketh a city.</p>
+
+<p>11. Few and short were the prayers we said.</p>
+
+<p>12. All the world’s a stage and all the men and women merely
+players.</p>
+
+<p>13.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Stone walls do not a prison make,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Nor iron bars a cage.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>14. Though mild, Calvin was also intolerant.</p>
+
+<p>15.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Happy the man whose wish and care</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">A few paternal acres bound.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>16. Drink to me only with thine eyes.</p>
+
+<p>17.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">True hope is swift and flies with swallow’s wings,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Kings it makes gods and meaner creatures, kings.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>18. My true love hath my heart, and I have his.</p>
+
+<p>19.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Lives of great men all remind us</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">We can make our lives sublime.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>20. What if the river is too deep for the cattle to ford?</p>
+
+<p>21.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">If all the year were playing holidays</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">To sport would be as tedious as to work.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>22. My kingdom for a horse!</p>
+
+<p>23.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">No matter what the daisies say,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">I know I’ll be married some fine day.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>24. Blessings on thee, little man!</p>
+
+<p>25.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Six white eggs on a bed of hay,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Flecked with purple, a pretty sight.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>26.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">“Lady Moon, Lady Moon, where are you roving?”</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">“Over the sea.”</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>27. The wind has a language, I would I could learn.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_252">[252]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="XCVII">XCVII. REVIEW OF ANALYSIS</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<p class="break"><b>Exercise.</b>—Analyze the following sentences. These sentences
+contain examples of the various constructions that
+have been presented in this book. If there is any doubt as
+to what part of speech a certain word is, the dictionary will
+usually enable you to decide. Where an ellipsis occurs, the
+word or words omitted should be supplied.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>1. How the black cat had captured the alert and restless squirrel
+so quickly was a great mystery to me.</p>
+
+<p>2. If a woman puts on airs with her equals, she probably has
+something about herself or her family that she is ashamed of.</p>
+
+<p>3. In writing these memoirs I shall yield to the inclination so
+natural to old men, of talking of themselves and their own actions.</p>
+
+<p>4.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">When ye come where I have stepped,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Ye will wonder why ye wept.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>5. I sought out one of these few, Fred Ouillette, pilot and son
+of a pilot, an idol in the company’s eyes, a hero to the boys of
+Montreal, a figure to be stared at always by anxious passengers.</p>
+
+<p>6. Must we conclude that the dignity of a bird depends upon
+the length of his tail?</p>
+
+<p>7. During these gales, the top of the tableland is enveloped in
+thick clouds, which the people of the Cape call the Devil’s Table
+Cloth.</p>
+
+<p>8. The sand-hills were gashed with numberless ravines; and
+as the sky had suddenly darkened, and a cold gusty wind arisen,
+the strange shrubs and the dreary hills looked doubly wild and desolate.</p>
+
+<p>9.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Floweret and hope may die,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">But love with us shall stay.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>10. There are three beautiful dandelions out on the terrace.</p>
+
+<p>11.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">I hope to see my Pilot face to face</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">When I have crossed the bar.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>12. Gray Brother did not come upon the night when I sent him
+the word.</p>
+
+<p>13. The beasts cannot use me more cruelly than I have been
+used by my fellow creatures.</p>
+
+<p>14. If I stroked the cat in my pet monkey’s presence, he would
+get into a paroxysm of rage and make great efforts to bite me.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_253">[253]</span></p>
+
+<p>15.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The spangled heavens, a shining frame,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Their great Original proclaim.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>16. He was a strange figure, this tattered, long-haired man,
+with the spear and wallet, and his boots cut down into sandals.</p>
+
+<p>17. Gordon waited long for an opportunity to sing in the choir
+at old St. George’s.</p>
+
+<p>18. When shall you leave Yarmouth? On the fifteenth, if possible.</p>
+
+<p>19. The captain, whose ideas of hard riding were all derived
+from trans-Atlantic sources, expressed the utmost amazement at
+the feats of Sorel, who went leaping ravines, and dashing at full
+speed up and down the sides of precipitous hills, lashing his horse
+with the recklessness of a Rocky Mountain rider.</p>
+
+<p>20. The Great American Desert is a land where no man permanently
+abides; for in certain seasons of the year there is no food
+either for the hunter or his steed.</p>
+
+<p>21.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">One constant element in luck</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Is genuine, solid, old Teutonic pluck.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>22. Did you ever think why a dog’s nose is always wet?</p>
+
+<p>23. One of the most difficult things is to get any wild animal to
+allow himself to be touched with the human hand.</p>
+
+<p>24. Old Trinity’s steeple probably sways eighteen inches whenever
+an elevated train passes.</p>
+
+<p>25. Do steeple climbers always work in pairs?</p>
+
+<p>26. The chipmunk had made a well-defined path from his door
+out through the weeds and dry leaves into the territory where his
+feeding ground lay.</p>
+
+<p>27. No wonder Eve ate the forbidden fruit.</p>
+
+<p>28. In Bermuda the banana is as omnipresent as the onion.</p>
+
+<p>29. We called the mice Jack, Jill, and Jenny, and they seemed
+to know their names.</p>
+
+<p>30. Shooting the Lachine Rapids is like taming a particularly
+fierce lion.</p>
+
+<p>31. Turk slept at night outside his master’s door, and no sentry
+could be more alert upon his watch than this faithful mastiff, who
+had apparently only one ambition,—to protect and to accompany
+his owner.</p>
+
+<p>32. We fancied we could hear the huge bodies of the whales
+burrowing through the water.</p>
+
+<p>33. At length, finding my life very solitary, I accepted the claw
+and heart of a rich and respectable green parrot, who offered me a
+good home and the devotion of a lifetime.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_254">[254]</span></p>
+
+<p>34. Be it ever so humble, there’s no place like home.</p>
+
+<p>35. Presently the doe stepped away, and left her little one lying
+on a spotted heap of dead leaves and moss.</p>
+
+<p>36. While traveling along the Rhine, we observed that when the
+German has nothing else to do, he eats and drinks.</p>
+
+<p>37. The Spaniards changed the whole character and habits of
+the Indians when they brought the horse among them.</p>
+
+<p>38. The fires in the Australian bush are often the work of the
+natives, to frighten away the white men; and sometimes the work
+of the shepherds, to make the grass sprout afresh.</p>
+
+<p>39. Near the Pyramids, more wondrous and more awful than all
+else in the land of Egypt, there sits the lonely Sphinx.</p>
+
+<p>40. The sexton had lived in Stratford for eighty years, and
+seemed still to consider himself a vigorous man, with the trivial
+exception that he had nearly lost the use of his legs.</p>
+
+<p>41. What if this were my last day at school?</p>
+
+<p>42. It was something to have seen the dust of Shakespeare.</p>
+
+<p>43. A queen bee will lay two hundred eggs in a few hours, and in
+the year she will generally have laid twenty or thirty thousand.</p>
+
+<p>44. The ground was carpeted with softest moss, into which the
+boy’s feet sunk so deep that they were almost covered; and all
+over the moss were sprinkled little star-shaped pink flowers.</p>
+
+<p>45. The wolf asked little Red Riding Hood whither she was going.</p>
+
+<p>46.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">O happy harbor of God’s saints!</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">O sweet and pleasant soil!</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">In thee no sorrow can be found,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent2">Nor grief, nor care, nor toil.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>47. She fell back upon the floor as if by the stroke of an unseen
+hand.</p>
+
+<p>48. Whether she was attended by a physician from Canton or
+from Milton, I was unable to say; but neither the gig with the large
+allopathic sorrel horse, nor the gig with the homœopathic white
+mare was ever seen hitched at the gate during the day.</p>
+
+<p>49. No sooner did I open their door than out the little starlings
+would all fly, and seat themselves on my head and shoulders.</p>
+
+<p>50. Neither eye nor ear revealed him anything.</p>
+
+<p>51. Small leisure have the poor for grief.</p>
+
+<p>52. By a flight of winding stairs we reached a covered balcony,
+over which a tropical vine wanders at will.</p>
+
+<p>53. Dora heard Marjorie singing, laughing, chatting, as she flashed
+here and there, helping and hindering in about equal proportions.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_255">[255]</span></p>
+
+<p>54. No matter what honors your ancestors attained, make your
+own name honorable.</p>
+
+<p>55. As I trod the sounding pavement, there was something intense
+and thrilling in the idea that the remains of Shakespeare were
+moldering beneath my feet.</p>
+
+<p>56. The lark, springing up from the reeking bosom of the
+meadow, towered away into the bright fleecy cloud, pouring forth
+torrents of melody.</p>
+
+<p>57. I now found myself among noble avenues of oaks and elms,
+whose vast size bespoke the growth of centuries.</p>
+
+<p>58. The air within the tunnel is somewhat damp, but fresh and
+agreeably cool, and one can scarcely realize in walking along the light
+passage, that a river is rolling above his head.</p>
+
+<p>59. No frog egg may hope to develop into a turtle, or a bird, or
+anything but a frog.</p>
+
+<p>60. I heard my own mountain goats bleating aloft.</p>
+
+<p>61. Everybody knows that the porcupine is ridiculously fastidious
+in his choice of food.</p>
+
+<p>62.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The daisy, by the shadow that it casts,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Protects the lingering dewdrop from the sun.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>63. If I choose to work eleven hours a day, what of it?</p>
+
+<p>64. Far below lay the earth, brown, dry, and desolate, from
+drouth.</p>
+
+<p>65. There was no sleep that long night for the little duck mother
+Quackalina.</p>
+
+<p>66. One evening, after the ice of a sleet storm had clogged their
+wings, the pigeons settled on one of the highest buildings they
+could find, and sat and shivered through the long night.</p>
+
+<p>67. The taking down of a steeple two hundred and thirty-eight
+feet high, that rises on a closely built city street, is not a simple
+proceeding.</p>
+
+<p>68.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">The legend of Felix is ended, the toiling of Felix is done;</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">The master has paid him his wages, the goal of his journey is won.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>69. There we were shown the chair on which the English monarchs
+have been crowned for several hundred years.</p>
+
+<p>70. Under the seat is the stone brought from the Abbey of Scone,
+whereon the kings of Scotland were crowned.</p>
+
+<p>71. Sleeping or waking, my thoughts are all of Ireland and of you.</p>
+
+<p>72. Fortunately for us, our two lean, wiry little horses did not
+object to being used as aquatic animals.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_256">[256]</span></p>
+
+<p>73. Many Russian villages possess a public bath of the most
+primitive construction, but in some parts of the country the peasants
+take their vapor bath in the household oven in which the bread is
+baked!</p>
+
+<p>74. This aptly illustrates a common Russian proverb, which says
+that what is health to the Russian is death to the German.</p>
+
+<p>75. Scarfs, shawls, stuffs for dresses, morning gowns, and vests,
+handkerchiefs, sashes, purses, and tobacco bags are heaped in rich
+profusion.</p>
+
+<p>76. When a man of fourscore, he continued his weekly visits to
+the schools.</p>
+
+<p>77. His master having been honorably discharged before the close
+of the war, Jim was left with the regiment in care of Wiggins, the
+wagoner.</p>
+
+<p>78. No other pigeon is so bold and fearless, so full of bulldog
+tenacity, so full of royal courage, as the homer.</p>
+
+<p>79. The French carried their imitation of Indians so far that
+they often disguised themselves to resemble their allies, with paint,
+feathers, and all.</p>
+
+<p>80. It was sometimes impossible to tell in an attacking party
+which were French and which were Indians.</p>
+
+<p>81. The sea was dotted everywhere with the heads of seals
+hurrying to land and begin their share of fighting.</p>
+
+<p>82. Old Marley was as dead as a door-nail.</p>
+
+<p>83.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">If eyes were made for seeing,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">Then beauty is its own excuse for being.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>84.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">Out on the lawn there arose such a clatter</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">I sprang from my bed to see what was the matter.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>85.</p>
+
+<div class="poetry-container">
+ <div class="poetry">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <div class="verse indent0">There is a pleasure in the pathless woods,</div>
+ <div class="verse indent0">There is a rapture on the lonely shore.</div>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<p>86. How I wish that when the Angel comes for me, I might reach
+out and feel your hand!</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_257">[257]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="GENERAL_REVIEW">GENERAL REVIEW</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<h3>Exercise 1</h3>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>(1) The family of the Lambs had long been among the
+most thriving and popular in the neighborhood; the Miss
+Lambs were the belles of Little Britain, and everybody was
+pleased when old Lamb had made money enough to shut
+up shop, and put his name on a brass plate on his door.
+(2) In an evil hour, however, one of the Miss Lambs had
+the honor of being a lady in attendance on the Lady Mayoress,
+at her great annual ball, on which occasion she wore
+three towering ostrich feathers on her head. (3) The family
+never got over it; they were immediately smitten with a
+passion for high life; set up a one-horse carriage, put a bit
+of gold lace round the errand-boy’s hat, and have been the
+talk and detestation of the whole neighborhood ever since.
+(4) They could no longer be induced to play at Pope-Joan
+or blindman’s buff; they could endure no dances but quadrilles,
+which nobody had ever heard of in Little Britain; and
+they took to reading novels, talking bad French, and playing
+upon the piano. (5) Their brother, too, who had been articled
+to an attorney, set up for a dandy and a critic, characters
+hitherto unknown in these parts; and he confounded
+the worthy folks exceedingly by talking about Kean, the
+opera, and the “Edinburgh Review.”</p>
+
+<p class="right">—<span class="smcap">Washington Irving</span>, <i>Sketch Book</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Consult the dictionary for the meaning of all words
+in this paragraph that you do not understand.</p>
+
+<p>2. Account for the capitalization and punctuation. Why
+is the term <i>Edinburgh Review</i> inclosed in quotation marks?</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_258">[258]</span></p>
+
+<p>3. What kind of noun is <i>family</i> in sentence (1)? Use it
+in a sentence so as to reveal its number and its gender. What
+is its number in sentence (3)? How do you account for it?</p>
+
+<p>4. What two plural forms has the term <i>Miss Lamb</i>?
+What is the plural of <i>Lady Mayoress</i>? What does the dictionary
+say about the plural form <i>folks</i>? What is the number
+of <i>everybody</i> in sentence (1)? What is the plural of
+<i>attorney</i>? of <i>dandy</i>?</p>
+
+<p>5. Tell the part of speech and use of <i>long</i>, <i>enough</i>, sentence
+(1); <i>however</i>, <i>one</i>, <i>which</i>, sentence (2); <i>ever</i>, <i>since</i>, sentence
+(3); <i>no</i>, <i>longer</i>, <i>no</i>, <i>but</i>, sentence (4); <i>too</i>, <i>up</i>, <i>hitherto</i>, sentence
+(5). Which of these words can be used as other parts
+of speech? Illustrate in sentences.</p>
+
+<p>6. Are <i>thriving</i> in sentence (1) and <i>towering</i> in sentence (2)
+participles or adjectives? How do you decide? Is <i>pleased</i>
+in sentence (1) a complement of <i>was</i> or a part of a passive
+verb <i>was pleased</i>? How do you decide? How is <i>smitten</i>
+used in sentence (3)? Find two passive verbs, and prove
+that they are passive.</p>
+
+<p>7. Supply the ellipsis before and after <i>popular</i> in sentence
+(1); before <i>put</i> in sentence (1).</p>
+
+<p>8. Tell the use of each of the following verbals: <i>being</i> (2);
+<i>reading</i>, <i>talking</i>, <i>playing</i> (4); <i>talking</i> (5). Tell how each of
+these verbals is modified or completed.</p>
+
+<p>9. Select each prepositional phrase and tell what it modifies.</p>
+
+<p>10. Select all the infinitives with <i>to</i> and tell the grammatical
+use of each.</p>
+
+<p>11. Parse the relative pronouns in sentences (4) and (5).
+Are the clauses that they introduce restrictive or unrestrictive?</p>
+
+<p>12. Tell the use and case of each of the following nouns:
+<i>belles</i> (1); <i>talk</i>, <i>detestation</i> (3); <i>characters</i> (5).</p>
+
+<p>13. Tell the principal parts of each of these verbs: <i>put</i> (1);
+<i>had</i>, <i>wore</i> (2); <i>got</i>, <i>set</i> (3); <i>took</i> (4).</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_259">[259]</span></p>
+
+<h3>Exercise 2</h3>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>(1) Ahem! Dry work, this speechifying, especially to an
+unpracticed orator. (2) I never conceived till now what
+toil the temperance lecturers undergo for my sake; hereafter
+they shall have the business to themselves. (3) Do,
+some kind Christian, pump a stroke or two, just to wet my
+whistle. (4) Thank you, sir! (5) My dear hearers, when
+the world shall have been regenerated by my instrumentality,
+you will collect your useless vats and liquor casks into
+one great pile and make a bonfire in honor of the town pump.
+(6) And when I shall have decayed like my predecessors,
+then, if you revere my memory, let a marble fountain, richly
+sculptured, take my place upon this spot. (7) Such monuments
+should be erected everywhere and inscribed with the
+names of the distinguished champions of my cause.</p>
+
+<p>(8) One o’clock! (9) Nay, then, if the dinner bell begins
+to speak, I may as well hold my peace. (10) Here comes a
+pretty young girl of my acquaintance with a large stone
+pitcher for me to fill. (11) May she draw a husband while
+drawing her water, as Rachel did of old! (12) Hold out your
+vessel, my dear! (13) There it is, full to the brim; so now
+run home, peeping at your sweet image in the pitcher as you
+go, and forget not, in a glass of my own liquor, to drink
+“Success to the town pump.”</p>
+
+<p class="right">—<span class="smcap">Nathaniel Hawthorne</span>, <i>Twice Told Tales</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Consult the dictionary for the meaning of words in these
+paragraphs that you do not understand.</p>
+
+<p>2. Classify each sentence both as to purpose and structure.</p>
+
+<p>3. What part of speech is <i>ahem</i>? What feeling does it
+express in sentence (1)?</p>
+
+<p>4. Supply the ellipsis in sentence (1). What part of speech
+is <i>speechifying</i>? What is its grammatical use?</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_260">[260]</span></p>
+
+<p>5. What does the adverb <i>especially</i> in sentence (1) modify?</p>
+
+<p>6. Account for the use of <i>shall</i> and <i>will</i> in these paragraphs.</p>
+
+<p>7. Select all the dependent clauses. Tell the class and use
+of each, and the introductory word.</p>
+
+<p>8. Select all the terms of address. What is the base word
+of each?</p>
+
+<p>9. What is the use of <i>now</i> sentence (2)? <i>old</i> (11)? <i>dinner</i>
+(9)?</p>
+
+<p>10. Parse each predicate verb in sentences (3), (5), (6), (7).</p>
+
+<p>11. Tell the part of speech and use of <i>themselves</i>, sentence
+(2); <i>stroke</i>, <i>two</i> (3); <i>there</i>, <i>full</i>, <i>peeping</i>, <i>glass</i>, <i>own</i> (13).</p>
+
+<p>12. Tell the use of all infinitive phrases in sentences (3),
+(6), (9), (10), (13).</p>
+
+<h3>Exercise 3</h3>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>(1) Once upon a time there came to this earth a visitor
+from a neighboring planet. And he was met at the place of
+his descent by a great philosopher, who was to show him
+everything.</p>
+
+<p>(2) First of all they came through a wood, and the stranger
+looked upon the trees. “Whom have we here?” said he.</p>
+
+<p>(3) “These are only vegetables,” said the philosopher.
+“They are alive, but not at all interesting.”</p>
+
+<p>(4) “I don’t know about that,” said the stranger. “They
+seem to have very good manners. Do they never speak?”</p>
+
+<p>(5) “They lack the gift,” said the philosopher.</p>
+
+<p>(6) “Yet I think I hear them sing,” said the other.</p>
+
+<p>(7) “That is only the wind among the leaves,” said the
+philosopher. “I will explain to you the theory of winds;
+it is very interesting.”</p>
+
+<p>(8) “Well,” said the stranger, “I wish I knew what
+they are thinking.”</p>
+
+<p>(9) “They cannot think,” said the philosopher.</p>
+
+<p>(10) “I don’t know about that,” returned the stranger;
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_261">[261]</span>and then laying his hand upon a trunk: “I like these people,”
+said he.</p>
+
+<p>(11) “They are not people at all,” said the philosopher.
+“Come along.”</p>
+
+<p>(12) Next they came through a meadow where there were
+cows.</p>
+
+<p>(13) “These are very dirty people,” said the stranger.</p>
+
+<p>(14) “They are not people at all,” said the philosopher;
+and he explained what a cow is in scientific words which I
+have forgotten.</p>
+
+<p>(15) “That is all one to me,” said the stranger. “But
+why do they never look up?”</p>
+
+<p>(16) “Because they are graminivorous,” said the philosopher;
+“and to live upon grass, which is not highly nutritious,
+requires so close an attention to business that they
+have no time to think, or speak, or look at the scenery, or
+keep themselves clean.”</p>
+
+<p>(17) “Well,” said the stranger, “that is one way to live,
+no doubt. But I prefer the people with the green heads.”</p>
+
+<p>(18) Next they came into a city, and the streets were
+full of men and women.</p>
+
+<p>(19) “These are very odd people,” said the stranger.</p>
+
+<p>(20) “They are the people of the greatest nation in the
+world,” said the philosopher.</p>
+
+<p>(21) “Are they indeed?” said the stranger. “They
+scarcely look so.”</p>
+
+<p class="right">—<span class="smcap">R. L. Stevenson</span>, <i>Fables</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Rewrite this selection, changing the direct to indirect
+discourse and noting the changes made in verbs, pronouns,
+and other words.</p>
+
+<p>2. Fill out the elliptical sentences, and tell the grammatical
+use of each of the words that you supply.</p>
+
+<p>3. Comment on the use of <i>and</i> (1), <i>but</i> (15), and <i>but</i> (17).</p>
+
+<p>4. Explain how each of the following verbs and verbals is
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_262">[262]</span>completed and modified: <i>was</i>, <i>to show</i>, paragraph (1); <i>have</i>
+(2); <i>are</i>, and <i>are</i> (3); <i>seem</i> (4); <i>lack</i> (5); <i>think</i>, <i>hear</i>, <i>said</i>
+(6); <i>wish</i>, <i>knew</i>, <i>are thinking</i> (8); <i>laying</i> (10); <i>explained</i>, <i>is</i>,
+<i>have forgotten</i> (14); <i>is</i> (15); <i>keep</i> (16).</p>
+
+<p>5. Find the subject of <i>came</i> in the first sentence, and explain
+the use of <i>there</i>. Prove that <i>was met</i> in paragraph (1) is a
+true passive verb.</p>
+
+<p>6. Tell the grammatical use of each infinitive in paragraphs
+(16) and (17).</p>
+
+<p>7. Tell the part of speech and use of <i>once</i>, paragraph (1);
+<i>first</i> (2); <i>highly</i>, <i>so</i> (16); <i>well</i> (17); <i>next</i> (18); <i>very</i> (19);
+<i>indeed</i>, <i>scarcely</i>, <i>so</i> (21).</p>
+
+<p>8. Parse all the adjective pronouns, interrogative pronouns,
+and relative pronouns.</p>
+
+<p>9. Find all the prepositional phrases, and tell what each
+phrase modifies. Tell the object of each preposition, and if
+there is anything peculiar about any object, comment upon
+the peculiarity.</p>
+
+<p>10. Select all the dependent clauses. Tell the kind and use
+of each clause, and its introductory word. Classify the adjective
+clauses as restrictive or unrestrictive, and tell what
+the adverbial clauses denote.</p>
+
+<p>If a word is used in a peculiar or uncommon way, consult
+the dictionary for information regarding it.</p>
+
+<h3>Exercise 4</h3>
+
+<blockquote>
+
+<p>(1) There troop the three most roguish boys that ever made
+parents scold or laugh. (2) They have nothing to do but
+to set each other on to mischief. (3) They pull off buds
+from the unblossomed rose bushes; they pick cucumbers
+by the half bushel that were to have been let alone; they
+break down rare shrubbery to get whips, and instead get
+whippings; they kill the guinea-pigs; chase the chickens;
+break up hens’ nests; get into the carriages and wagons only
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_263">[263]</span>to tumble out, and set all the nurses a-running; they study
+every means of getting under the horses’ feet, and, as the more
+dangerous act, they are fond of tickling their hind legs, and
+pulling at their tails; they fill the already fed horses with
+extra oats, causing the hostler to fear for his charges’ health,
+since they refuse oats at the next regular feeding; they paddle
+in all the mud on the premises; sit down in the street and
+fill their pockets with dirt; they wet their clothes in the
+brook, tear them in the woods, lose their caps a dozen times
+a day, and go bare-headed in the blazing sun; they cut up
+every imaginable prank with their long-suffering nurses when
+meals are served, or when bedtime comes, or when morning
+brings the washing and dressing. (4) They are little, nimble,
+compact skinfuls of ingenious, fertile, endless, untiring mischief.
+(5) They stub their toes, or cut their fingers, or get
+stung, or eat some poisonous berry, seed, or root, or make us
+think that they have, which is just as bad; they fall down
+stairs, or eat green fruit till they are as tight as a drum;
+and yet there is no peace to us without them, as there certainly
+is none with them. Mischievous darlings! Joyful
+plagues! Loving, rollicking, laughing rogues!</p>
+
+<p class="right">—<span class="smcap">Henry Ward Beecher</span>, <i>Star Papers</i>.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>1. Give the principal parts of each predicate verb in this
+selection; its tense. Read the selection with the predicate
+verbs in the past tense.</p>
+
+<p>2. Explain how the following verbs are completed and
+modified: <i>made</i>, sentence (1); <i>have</i> (2); <i>pull</i>, <i>were</i>, <i>lose</i>, <i>go</i>,
+<i>cut</i> (3); <i>are</i> (4); <i>get</i>, <i>make</i> (5).</p>
+
+<p>3. Select all the adjectives and tell what they modify.
+Classify them as limiting or descriptive. Compare them,
+if possible. If any of them do not admit of comparison,
+tell why.</p>
+
+<p>4. Tell the use of <i>there</i>, sentence (1) and <i>there</i> (5).</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_264">[264]</span></p>
+
+<p>5. Tell the use and case of each of the following nouns:
+<i>boys</i>, sentence (1); <i>legs</i> (3); <i>hostler</i> (3); <i>times</i> (3); <i>day</i> (3);
+<i>drum</i> (5); <i>darlings</i> (5).</p>
+
+<p>6. Find three nouns in the possessive case, and tell what
+each of them modifies. Decline each of these nouns.</p>
+
+<p>7. Select all the infinitives with <i>to</i> and tell the use of
+each.</p>
+
+<p>8. Select and classify all the words in <i>-ing</i>.</p>
+
+<p>9. Account for the punctuation of this selection.</p>
+
+<p>10. Select all the dependent clauses. Tell the kind and
+use of each, and the introductory word.</p>
+
+<p>11. Tell the part of speech and use of <i>on</i> (2); <i>off</i>, <i>alone</i>,
+<i>down</i>, <i>up</i>, <i>already</i> (3); <i>just</i>, <i>down</i>, <i>certainly</i> (5).</p>
+
+<p>12. Select all the coördinate conjunctions in sentences (3)
+and (5) and tell what each conjunction joins.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_265">[265]</span></p>
+
+<h2 class="nobreak" id="INDEX">INDEX</h2>
+
+</div>
+
+<ul>
+ <li class="ifrst">Absolute phrases, <a href="#Page_237">237</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Absolute use of noun, <a href="#Page_237">237</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Abstract nouns, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Active voice, <a href="#Page_40">40</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Address, term of, <a href="#Page_39">39</a>, <a href="#Page_40">40</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adjective clauses, <a href="#Page_171">171</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">restrictive, <a href="#Page_193">193</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">unrestrictive, <a href="#Page_194">194</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adjective elements, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adjective phrases, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adjective pronouns, <a href="#Page_121">121</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">declension of, <a href="#Page_122">122</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adjectives, appositive, <a href="#Page_88">88</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">classified, <a href="#Page_110">110</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">comparison of, <a href="#Page_116">116</a>, <a href="#Page_117">117</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_25">25</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">errors in use of, <a href="#Page_118">118</a>, <a href="#Page_119">119</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">misused for adverbs, <a href="#Page_70">70</a>, <a href="#Page_71">71</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">modifying pronouns, <a href="#Page_26">26</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">objective complement, <a href="#Page_94">94</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">parsing of, <a href="#Page_120">120</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">review of, <a href="#Page_120">120</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">subjective complement, <a href="#Page_69">69</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adverbial clauses, of cause, <a href="#Page_183">183</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of comparison, <a href="#Page_188">188</a>, <a href="#Page_189">189</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of concession, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of condition, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of manner, <a href="#Page_181">181</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of place, <a href="#Page_181">181</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of purpose, <a href="#Page_184">184</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of result, <a href="#Page_184">184</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of time, <a href="#Page_180">180</a>, <a href="#Page_181">181</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">office of, <a href="#Page_171">171</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adverbial nouns, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adverbial noun phrases, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">modifying adjectives or adverbs, <a href="#Page_92">92</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adverbial noun phrases, modifying verbs, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">what they denote, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adverbial phrases, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Adverbs, comparison of, <a href="#Page_170">170</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">conjunctive, <a href="#Page_172">172</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_28">28</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">formation of, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">interrogative, <a href="#Page_170">170</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">introducing noun clauses, <a href="#Page_204">204</a>, <a href="#Page_205">205</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">meaning of, <a href="#Page_28">28</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">misused for adjectives, <a href="#Page_70">70</a>, <a href="#Page_71">71</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">modifying adjectives, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">modifying adverbs, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">modifying sentences, <a href="#Page_175">175</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">modifying verbs, <a href="#Page_28">28</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">parsing of, <a href="#Page_174">174</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">simple, <a href="#Page_170">170</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">summary of, <a href="#Page_173">173</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>After</i>, <a href="#Page_178">178</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Agreement, of participle and noun, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of subject and verb, <a href="#Page_165">165</a>, <a href="#Page_166">166</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Among</i>, <a href="#Page_37">37</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Analysis, models for, <a href="#Page_34">34</a>, <a href="#Page_48">48</a>, <a href="#Page_191">191</a>, <a href="#Page_225">225</a>, <a href="#Page_244">244</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Antecedent, of personal pronoun, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of relative pronoun, <a href="#Page_197">197</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Anticipative subject, <a href="#Page_201">201</a>, <a href="#Page_212">212</a>, <a href="#Page_247">247</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Appositive, adjective, <a href="#Page_88">88</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">case of, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in possessive case, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">infinitive, <a href="#Page_215">215</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">noun, <a href="#Page_85">85</a>, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_266">[266]</span></li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Appositive, noun clause, <a href="#Page_201">201</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">position of, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">punctuation of, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Articles, definite and indefinite, <a href="#Page_113">113</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">uses of, <a href="#Page_114">114</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>As</i>, relative pronoun, <a href="#Page_197">197</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>At</i>, <a href="#Page_37">37</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Auxiliary verbs, <a href="#Page_124">124</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1"><i>can</i>, <i>could</i>, etc., <a href="#Page_154">154-156</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1"><i>shall</i> and <i>will</i>, <a href="#Page_151">151</a>, <a href="#Page_152">152</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst"><i>Before</i>, <a href="#Page_178">178</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Beside</i>, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Besides</i>, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Between</i>, <a href="#Page_37">37</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>But</i>, conjunction and preposition, <a href="#Page_46">46</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">relative pronoun, <a href="#Page_197">197</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">uses of, <a href="#Page_178">178</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>By</i>, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst"><i>Can</i> and <i>could</i>, <a href="#Page_155">155</a>, <a href="#Page_156">156</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Capitalization, of proper adjectives, <a href="#Page_111">111</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of proper nouns, <a href="#Page_13">13</a>, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Case, <a href="#Page_83">83-95</a>, <a href="#Page_100">100</a>, <a href="#Page_108">108</a>, <a href="#Page_196">196</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Cause, clauses of, <a href="#Page_183">183</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Clauses, adjective, <a href="#Page_171">171</a>, <a href="#Page_193">193-197</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">adverbial, <a href="#Page_171">171</a>, <a href="#Page_180">180-191</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_48">48</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">dependent, <a href="#Page_52">52</a>, <a href="#Page_53">53</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">independent, <a href="#Page_48">48</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">noun, <a href="#Page_200">200</a>, <a href="#Page_201">201</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">review of, <a href="#Page_206">206</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Collective nouns, <a href="#Page_166">166</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Common gender, <a href="#Page_78">78</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Common nouns, <a href="#Page_13">13</a>, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Comparative degree, <a href="#Page_116">116</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Comparison, clauses of, <a href="#Page_188">188</a>, <a href="#Page_189">189</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of adjectives, <a href="#Page_116">116</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of adverbs, <a href="#Page_170">170</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">how denoted, <a href="#Page_116">116</a>, <a href="#Page_117">117</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">irregular, <a href="#Page_117">117</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Complement, defined, <a href="#Page_61">61</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Complement, direct object, <a href="#Page_61">61</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">double object, <a href="#Page_216">216</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">objective, <a href="#Page_94">94</a>, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">subjective, <a href="#Page_67">67</a>, <a href="#Page_68">68</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Complex sentences, <a href="#Page_53">53</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Compound personal pronouns, <a href="#Page_106">106</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">uses of, <a href="#Page_106">106</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Compound predicate, <a href="#Page_19">19</a>, <a href="#Page_20">20</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Compound sentences, <a href="#Page_50">50</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Compound subject, <a href="#Page_20">20</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Concession, clauses of, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Condition, clauses of, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Conjugation, active voice, <a href="#Page_128">128-130</a>, <a href="#Page_132">132</a>, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_127">127</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">emphatic, <a href="#Page_149">149</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">imperative mode, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">indicative mode, <a href="#Page_128">128-130</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">interrogative, <a href="#Page_129">129</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">passive voice, <a href="#Page_140">140-142</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">progressive, <a href="#Page_148">148</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">subjunctive mode, <a href="#Page_132">132</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Conjunctions, <a href="#Page_46">46</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">coördinate, <a href="#Page_174">174</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">correlative, <a href="#Page_175">175</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in compound sentences, <a href="#Page_50">50</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">subordinate, <a href="#Page_176">176</a>, <a href="#Page_177">177</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Conjunctive adverbs, <a href="#Page_172">172</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in noun clauses, <a href="#Page_204">204</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Contractions, <a href="#Page_130">130</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Coördinate conjunctions, <a href="#Page_174">174</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Correlative conjunctions, <a href="#Page_175">175</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst">Dangling participles, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Declarative sentences, <a href="#Page_9">9</a>, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Declension, of nouns, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of personal pronouns, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of relative pronouns, <a href="#Page_196">196</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Defective verbs, <a href="#Page_154">154-157</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Demonstrative adjectives, <a href="#Page_113">113</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Dependent clauses, <a href="#Page_52">52</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Descriptive adjectives, <a href="#Page_110">110</a>, <a href="#Page_111">111</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Direct and indirect discourse, <a href="#Page_162">162-165</a>.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_267">[267]</span></li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Direct and indirect quotations, <a href="#Page_162">162-165</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Do</i>, as principal verb, <a href="#Page_157">157</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Double object, of preposition <i>for</i>, <a href="#Page_220">220</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of verb, <a href="#Page_216">216-218</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Double possessive, <a href="#Page_81">81</a>, <a href="#Page_104">104</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst"><i>Each other</i>, <a href="#Page_122">122</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Elliptical sentences, <a href="#Page_249">249</a>, <a href="#Page_250">250</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Else</i>, as limiting adjective, <a href="#Page_113">113</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">uses of, <a href="#Page_178">178</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Emphatic conjugation, <a href="#Page_149">149</a>, <a href="#Page_150">150</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Enough</i>, <a href="#Page_113">113</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Errors, in adjectives, <a href="#Page_70">70</a>, <a href="#Page_71">71</a>, <a href="#Page_118">118</a>, <a href="#Page_119">119</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in adverbs, <a href="#Page_70">70</a>, <a href="#Page_71">71</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in infinitives, <a href="#Page_221">221</a>, <a href="#Page_222">222</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in interrogative pronouns, <a href="#Page_109">109</a>, <a href="#Page_110">110</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in participles, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in personal pronouns, <a href="#Page_101">101</a>, <a href="#Page_103">103</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in verbs, <a href="#Page_130">130</a>, <a href="#Page_137">137-142</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Exclamatory nouns, <a href="#Page_40">40</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Exclamatory sentences, <a href="#Page_44">44</a>, <a href="#Page_45">45</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst">Feminine gender, <a href="#Page_78">78</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Floating participle, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>For</i>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst">Gender, <a href="#Page_77">77</a>, <a href="#Page_78">78</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">how denoted, <a href="#Page_78">78</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Gerund, <a href="#Page_211">211</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Going</i>, in verb phrase, <a href="#Page_156">156</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst"><i>Have</i>, as principal verb, <a href="#Page_157">157</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Hence</i>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst">Idiomatic expressions, <a href="#Page_104">104</a>, <a href="#Page_201">201</a>, <a href="#Page_220">220</a>, <a href="#Page_235">235</a>, <a href="#Page_247">247</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Imperative mode, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">conjugation of, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Imperative sentences, <a href="#Page_41">41</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">subject omitted, <a href="#Page_42">42</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Impersonal verbs, <a href="#Page_157">157</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>In</i>, <a href="#Page_37">37</a>, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Independent elements, <a href="#Page_39">39</a>, <a href="#Page_40">40</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Indicative mode, <a href="#Page_127">127</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Indirect discourse, <a href="#Page_162">162-165</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Indirect object, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>, <a href="#Page_90">90</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">becoming subject of passive verb, <a href="#Page_141">141</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">position of, <a href="#Page_90">90</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Infinitive phrases, <a href="#Page_211">211</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Infinitives, defined, <a href="#Page_209">209</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">errors in use of, <a href="#Page_221">221</a>, <a href="#Page_222">222</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in apposition, <a href="#Page_215">215</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in <i>-ing</i>, <a href="#Page_210">210</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">modified by possessive, <a href="#Page_211">211</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">modifier of adjective, <a href="#Page_220">220</a>, <a href="#Page_221">221</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">modifier of noun, <a href="#Page_215">215</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">modifier of verb, <a href="#Page_218">218</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">object of preposition, <a href="#Page_220">220</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">object of verb, <a href="#Page_213">213</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">part of double object, <a href="#Page_216">216-218</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">subjective complement, <a href="#Page_213">213</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">summary of, <a href="#Page_224">224</a>, <a href="#Page_225">225</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">used independently, <a href="#Page_221">221</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">with <i>to</i>, <a href="#Page_209">209</a>, <a href="#Page_210">210</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Interjections, <a href="#Page_43">43</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Interrogative adjectives, <a href="#Page_113">113</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Interrogative adverbs, <a href="#Page_170">170</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Interrogative conjugation, <a href="#Page_129">129</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Interrogative pronouns, <a href="#Page_108">108</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">errors in use of, <a href="#Page_109">109</a>, <a href="#Page_110">110</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in noun clause, <a href="#Page_204">204</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">uses of, <a href="#Page_108">108</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Interrogative sentences, <a href="#Page_23">23</a>, <a href="#Page_24">24</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">order of, <a href="#Page_24">24</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Into</i>, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Intransitive verbs, of action, <a href="#Page_64">64</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of being, <a href="#Page_64">64</a>, <a href="#Page_66">66</a>, <a href="#Page_67">67</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Irregular verbs, defined, <a href="#Page_135">135</a>, <a href="#Page_136">136</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">errors in use of, <a href="#Page_137">137-140</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">principal parts of, <a href="#Page_137">137</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>It</i>, as anticipative subject, <a href="#Page_201">201</a>, <a href="#Page_212">212</a>, <a href="#Page_247">247</a>.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_268">[268]</span></li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst"><i>Lay</i> and <i>lie</i>, <a href="#Page_137">137</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Like</i>, <a href="#Page_181">181</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Limiting adjectives, <a href="#Page_110">110</a>, <a href="#Page_113">113</a>, <a href="#Page_114">114</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst">Manner, clauses of, <a href="#Page_181">181</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Masculine gender, <a href="#Page_77">77</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>May</i> and <i>might</i>, <a href="#Page_155">155</a>, <a href="#Page_156">156</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Mode, defined, <a href="#Page_127">127</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">imperative, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">indicative, <a href="#Page_127">127</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">subjunctive, <a href="#Page_131">131</a>, <a href="#Page_132">132</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Modifier, <a href="#Page_26">26</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Must</i>, <a href="#Page_155">155</a>, <a href="#Page_156">156</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst">Natural order, <a href="#Page_22">22</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Neuter gender, <a href="#Page_78">78</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Nominative case, <a href="#Page_83">83</a>, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>, <a href="#Page_100">100</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Noun clauses, <a href="#Page_200">200</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">introductory word of, <a href="#Page_203">203</a>, <a href="#Page_204">204</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">uses of, <a href="#Page_200">200</a>, <a href="#Page_201">201</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Nouns, abstract, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">adverbial, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>, <a href="#Page_92">92</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">as adjectives, <a href="#Page_27">27</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">as interjections, <a href="#Page_43">43</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">case of, <a href="#Page_83">83</a>, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">collective, <a href="#Page_166">166</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">common, <a href="#Page_13">13</a>, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">compound, <a href="#Page_81">81</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">declension of, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_11">11</a>, <a href="#Page_12">12</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">direct object, <a href="#Page_61">61</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">gender of, <a href="#Page_77">77</a>, <a href="#Page_78">78</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in apposition, <a href="#Page_85">85-87</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in exclamation, <a href="#Page_40">40</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in <i>-ing</i>, <a href="#Page_240">240</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">indirect object, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">number of, <a href="#Page_74">74-76</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">object of preposition, <a href="#Page_35">35</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">objective complement, <a href="#Page_94">94</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">parsing of, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">possessive, <a href="#Page_79">79-82</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">proper, <a href="#Page_13">13</a>, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">term of address, <a href="#Page_39">39</a>, <a href="#Page_40">40</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">used absolutely, <a href="#Page_237">237</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Number, defined, <a href="#Page_74">74</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">singular and plural, <a href="#Page_74">74</a>, <a href="#Page_75">75</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Numeral adjectives, <a href="#Page_113">113</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst"><i>O</i>, <a href="#Page_43">43</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Object, double, <a href="#Page_216">216</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">indirect, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>, <a href="#Page_90">90</a>, <a href="#Page_141">141</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of preposition, <a href="#Page_35">35</a>, <a href="#Page_36">36</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of verb, <a href="#Page_61">61</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">retained, <a href="#Page_146">146</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Objective complement, <a href="#Page_94">94</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">becoming subjective complement of passive verb, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Off</i>, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>One</i>, declined, <a href="#Page_122">122</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>One another</i>, <a href="#Page_122">122</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Only</i>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Other</i>, declined, <a href="#Page_122">122</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Own</i>, with possessives, <a href="#Page_100">100</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst">Parsing, of adjectives, <a href="#Page_120">120</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of adverbs, <a href="#Page_174">174</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of nouns, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of prepositions, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of pronouns, <a href="#Page_100">100</a>, <a href="#Page_208">208</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of verbs, <a href="#Page_150">150</a>, <a href="#Page_168">168</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Participial phrases, <a href="#Page_229">229</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Participles, agreement of, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">dangling, or floating, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_228">228</a>, <a href="#Page_229">229</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">differing from adjectives, <a href="#Page_231">231</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">errors in use of, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">forms of, <a href="#Page_228">228</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">summary of, <a href="#Page_243">243</a>, <a href="#Page_244">244</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">uses of, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>, <a href="#Page_144">144</a>, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>, <a href="#Page_148">148</a>, <a href="#Page_228">228</a>, <a href="#Page_229">229</a>,
+ <a href="#Page_231">231</a>, <a href="#Page_235">235</a>, <a href="#Page_237">237</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Parts of speech, summary of, <a href="#Page_57">57</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Passive voice, <a href="#Page_140">140-142</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Past participle, <a href="#Page_135">135</a>, <a href="#Page_228">228</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">as subjective complement, <a href="#Page_144">144</a>, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in passive conjugation, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Person, of nouns, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of pronouns, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of verbs, <a href="#Page_127">127</a>.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_269">[269]</span></li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Personal pronouns, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">compound, <a href="#Page_106">106</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">declension of, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">errors in use of, <a href="#Page_101">101-103</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">uses of, <a href="#Page_100">100</a>, <a href="#Page_103">103-105</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Phrases, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>, <a href="#Page_33">33</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">absolute, <a href="#Page_237">237</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">adjective, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">adverbial, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">as subjective complement, <a href="#Page_69">69</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_33">33</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">denoting possession, <a href="#Page_81">81</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in a series, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">infinitive, <a href="#Page_211">211</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">participial, <a href="#Page_229">229</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">position of, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">prepositional, <a href="#Page_35">35</a>, <a href="#Page_36">36</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Place, clauses of, <a href="#Page_181">181</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Plurals, foreign, <a href="#Page_75">75</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">formation of, <a href="#Page_74">74</a>, <a href="#Page_75">75</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">compound nouns, <a href="#Page_75">75</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">letters and figures, <a href="#Page_75">75</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">titles, <a href="#Page_75">75</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">regular and irregular, <a href="#Page_74">74</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">same as singular, <a href="#Page_74">74</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Positive degree, <a href="#Page_116">116</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Possessive case, <a href="#Page_83">83</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of compound nouns, <a href="#Page_81">81</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Possessive nouns, <a href="#Page_80">80</a>, <a href="#Page_83">83</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">form of, <a href="#Page_80">80</a>, <a href="#Page_81">81</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in double possessives, <a href="#Page_81">81</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">what they denote, <a href="#Page_81">81</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Possessive pronouns, <a href="#Page_103">103</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">how used, <a href="#Page_104">104</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in double possessives, <a href="#Page_104">104</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Predicate, compound, <a href="#Page_19">19</a>, <a href="#Page_20">20</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_9">9</a>, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">simple, <a href="#Page_16">16</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">transposed, <a href="#Page_22">22</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Prepositions, <a href="#Page_34">34</a>, <a href="#Page_35">35</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">correct use of, <a href="#Page_37">37-39</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">parsing of, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Present participle, in progressive conjugation, <a href="#Page_148">148</a>, <a href="#Page_228">228</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Principal parts, <a href="#Page_135">135</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Principal parts, of irregular verbs, <a href="#Page_137">137</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Progressive conjugation, <a href="#Page_148">148</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Pronouns, adjective, <a href="#Page_121">121</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">compound personal, <a href="#Page_106">106</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_18">18</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in clauses of comparison, <a href="#Page_190">190</a>, <a href="#Page_191">191</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">indefinite, <a href="#Page_204">204</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">interrogative, <a href="#Page_108">108</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">parsing of, <a href="#Page_100">100</a>, <a href="#Page_208">208</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">personal, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>, <a href="#Page_100">100</a>, <a href="#Page_103">103</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Pronouns, relative, <a href="#Page_196">196</a>, <a href="#Page_197">197</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">review of, <a href="#Page_207">207</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Proper adjectives, <a href="#Page_111">111</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Proper nouns, <a href="#Page_13">13</a>, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Punctuation, of a series, <a href="#Page_20">20</a>, <a href="#Page_25">25</a>, <a href="#Page_26">26</a>, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of appositives, <a href="#Page_86">86-88</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of compound sentences, <a href="#Page_50">50</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of compound subject and predicate, <a href="#Page_20">20</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of declarative sentences, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of exclamatory sentences, <a href="#Page_44">44</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of interrogative sentences, <a href="#Page_24">24</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of phrases, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Purpose, clauses of, <a href="#Page_184">184</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst"><i>Raise</i> and <i>rise</i>, <a href="#Page_138">138</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Reflexive use of pronouns, <a href="#Page_106">106</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Regular verbs, <a href="#Page_135">135</a>, <a href="#Page_136">136</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Relative pronouns, <a href="#Page_196">196</a>, <a href="#Page_197">197</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1"><i>what</i>, <a href="#Page_204">204</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Result, clauses of, <a href="#Page_184">184</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Retained object, <a href="#Page_146">146</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Review, general, <a href="#Page_257">257-264</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of adjectives, <a href="#Page_120">120</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of adverbs, <a href="#Page_173">173</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of analysis, <a href="#Page_252">252</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of clauses, <a href="#Page_206">206</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of infinitives, <a href="#Page_224">224</a>, <a href="#Page_225">225</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of nouns, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>, <a href="#Page_97">97</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of participles, <a href="#Page_243">243</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of parts of speech, <a href="#Page_57">57</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of prepositions, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_270">[270]</span></li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Review, general, of pronouns, <a href="#Page_207">207</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of sentences, <a href="#Page_55">55</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of verbs, <a href="#Page_72">72</a>, <a href="#Page_168">168</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst">Sentences, complex, <a href="#Page_53">53</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">compound, <a href="#Page_50">50</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">declarative, <a href="#Page_9">9</a>, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_9">9</a>, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">elliptical, <a href="#Page_249">249</a>, <a href="#Page_250">250</a>,</li>
+ <li class="isub1">exclamatory, <a href="#Page_44">44</a>, <a href="#Page_45">45</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">imperative, <a href="#Page_41">41</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">interrogative, <a href="#Page_23">23</a>, <a href="#Page_24">24</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">review of, <a href="#Page_55">55</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">simple, <a href="#Page_48">48</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Sequence of tenses, <a href="#Page_125">125</a>, <a href="#Page_163">163</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Series, of adjectives, <a href="#Page_25">25</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of phrases, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of predicates, <a href="#Page_20">20</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Set</i> and <i>sit</i>, <a href="#Page_138">138</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Shall</i> and <i>will</i>, <a href="#Page_151">151</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in indirect discourse, <a href="#Page_163">163</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in interrogative sentences, <a href="#Page_152">152</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">rules for use of, <a href="#Page_152">152</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Should</i> and <i>would</i>, <a href="#Page_160">160-162</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in subjunctive mode, <a href="#Page_155">155</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Simple adverbs, <a href="#Page_170">170</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Simple predicate, <a href="#Page_16">16</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Simple sentences, <a href="#Page_48">48</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Simple subject, <a href="#Page_11">11</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Since</i>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Singular number, <a href="#Page_74">74</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>So</i>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Subject, compound, <a href="#Page_20">20</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_9">9</a>, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">how found, <a href="#Page_16">16</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">simple, <a href="#Page_11">11</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">transposed, <a href="#Page_22">22</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Subjective complement, <a href="#Page_67">67</a>, <a href="#Page_68">68</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">adjective, <a href="#Page_69">69</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">infinitive, <a href="#Page_213">213</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">noun, <a href="#Page_67">67</a>, <a href="#Page_69">69</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">participle, <a href="#Page_144">144</a>, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">prepositional phrase, <a href="#Page_69">69</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Subjunctive mode, <a href="#Page_131">131</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">conjugation of, <a href="#Page_132">132</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Subjunctive mode, tenses of, <a href="#Page_132">132</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Subordinate conjunctions, <a href="#Page_176">176</a>, <a href="#Page_177">177</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Summary, of adverbs, <a href="#Page_173">173</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of case relations, <a href="#Page_97">97</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of infinitives, <a href="#Page_224">224</a>, <a href="#Page_225">225</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">of participles, <a href="#Page_243">243</a>, <a href="#Page_244">244</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Superlative degree, <a href="#Page_116">116</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst">Tense, <a href="#Page_123">123</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">errors in, <a href="#Page_125">125</a>, <a href="#Page_126">126</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">in noun clauses, <a href="#Page_201">201</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">primary, <a href="#Page_124">124</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">secondary, <a href="#Page_124">124</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">sequence of, <a href="#Page_125">125</a>, <a href="#Page_163">163</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Term of address, <a href="#Page_39">39</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>The</i>, an adverb, <a href="#Page_170">170</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>There</i>, <a href="#Page_247">247</a>, <a href="#Page_248">248</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Till</i>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Time, clauses of, <a href="#Page_180">180</a>, <a href="#Page_181">181</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>To</i>, omitted in infinitives, <a href="#Page_217">217</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>To</i>, use of, <a href="#Page_37">37</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Transitive verbs, <a href="#Page_60">60</a>, <a href="#Page_61">61</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">followed by indirect object, <a href="#Page_90">90</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">followed by objective complement, <a href="#Page_94">94</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">what they denote, <a href="#Page_62">62</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Transposed order, <a href="#Page_22">22</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst"><i>Until</i>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Used</i>, in verb phrases, <a href="#Page_156">156</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst">Verb phrases, <a href="#Page_155">155</a>, <a href="#Page_156">156</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Verbals, <a href="#Page_210">210</a>, <a href="#Page_211">211</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Verbs, defective, <a href="#Page_154">154-157</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">defined, <a href="#Page_16">16</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">errors in use of, <a href="#Page_130">130</a>, <a href="#Page_137">137-142</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">intransitive, <a href="#Page_64">64</a>, <a href="#Page_66">66</a>, <a href="#Page_67">67</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">mode of, <a href="#Page_127">127</a>, <a href="#Page_131">131</a>, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">parsing of, <a href="#Page_150">150</a>, <a href="#Page_168">168</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">principal parts of, <a href="#Page_135">135</a>, <a href="#Page_137">137</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">regular and irregular, <a href="#Page_135">135</a>, <a href="#Page_136">136</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">review of, <a href="#Page_72">72</a>, <a href="#Page_168">168</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">tense of, <a href="#Page_123">123-126</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">transitive, <a href="#Page_60">60</a>, <a href="#Page_61">61</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">used as interjections, <a href="#Page_43">43</a>.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_271">[271]</span></li>
+ <li class="isub1">used transitively or intransitively, <a href="#Page_64">64</a>, <a href="#Page_66">66</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">voice of, <a href="#Page_140">140-142</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Voice, active and passive, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">conjugation of passive, <a href="#Page_140">140-142</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">test for passive, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst"><i>With</i>, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Words in <i>-ing</i>, <a href="#Page_240">240</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx">Words used, as adjective or adverb, <a href="#Page_59">59</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">as adverb or preposition, <a href="#Page_60">60</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">as noun or adjective, <a href="#Page_58">58</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">as noun or verb, <a href="#Page_58">58</a>.</li>
+ <li class="isub1">as preposition, conjunction, or adverb, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="indx"><i>Would</i>, as principal verb, <a href="#Page_155">155</a>.</li>
+
+ <li class="ifrst"><i>Yet</i>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</li>
+</ul>
+
+<div style='text-align:center'>*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 76768 ***</div>
+</body>
+</html>
+
diff --git a/76768-h/images/cover.jpg b/76768-h/images/cover.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..538593b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/76768-h/images/cover.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..96ea058
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for eBook #76768
+(https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/76768)